31.12.2018 BP 20-F Combined Document


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
FORM 20-F
 
 
(Mark One)
¨
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) or (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR
 
x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended 31 December 2018
OR
 
¨

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR
 
¨

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number: 1-6262

BP p.l.c.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
England and Wales
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

1 St James’s Square, London SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom
(Address of principal executive offices)

Dr Brian Gilvary
BP p.l.c.
1 St James’s Square, London SW1Y 4PD
United Kingdom
Tel +44 (0) 20 7496 5311
Fax +44 (0) 20 7496 4573
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)





Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act
 
 
 
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Ordinary Shares of 25c each
 
New York Stock Exchange*
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2019
 
New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2021
 
New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Guaranteed Notes due 2022
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.237% Guaranteed Notes due 2019
 
New York Stock Exchange
1.676% Guaranteed Notes due 2019
 
New York Stock Exchange
1.768% Guaranteed Notes due 2019
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.315% Guaranteed Notes due 2020
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.521% Guaranteed Notes due 2020
 
New York Stock Exchange
4.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2020
 
New York Stock Exchange
4.742% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.561% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.112% Guaranteed Notes due 2021
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.500% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.520% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.245% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.062% Guaranteed Notes due 2022
 
New York Stock Exchange
2.750% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.216% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.994% Guaranteed Notes due 2023
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.535% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.814% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.224% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.790% Guaranteed Notes due 2024
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.506% Guaranteed Notes due 2025
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.796% Guaranteed Notes due 2025
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.119% Guaranteed Notes due 2026
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.410% Guaranteed Notes due 2026
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.017% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.279% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.588% Guaranteed Notes due 2027
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.723% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
 
New York Stock Exchange
3.937% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
 
New York Stock Exchange
4.234% Guaranteed Notes due 2028
 
New York Stock Exchange
 
*
Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.
None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.
None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.





 
 
Ordinary Shares of 25c each
21,525,464,027

Cumulative First Preference Shares of £1 each
7,232,838

Cumulative Second Preference Shares of £1 each
5,473,414

 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Note—Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or an emerging growth company. See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer  x     Accelerated filer  ¨    Non-accelerated filer  ¨ Emerging growth company ¨

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ¨

† The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:
U.S. GAAP  ¨
    
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued
by the International Accounting Standards Board  x
  
Other  ¨

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

Item 17  ¨                Item  18  ¨

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x




BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Growing the business and advancing the energy transition BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Advancing energy to improve people’s lives Contents Strategic report Financial statements Helge Lund succeeded Overview Carl-Henric Svanberg 113 Consolidated financial statements 2 BP at a glance as chairman. Helge of the BP group 4 How we run our business joined the board in July 134 Notes on financial statements and took the chair on 6 Chairman’s letter 210 Supplementary information on 1 January 2019. oil and natural gas (unaudited) 8 Group chief executive’s letter See page 6. 9 The changing energy mix   Strategy 10 Our strategy Additional disclosures Corporate governance 12 BP investor proposition 273 Contents 14 Major project start-ups 58 Board of directors Including information on liquidity 63 Executive team and capital resources, oil and gas Performance 68 Introduction from the chairman disclosures, upstream regional 16 Measuring our progress analysis and legal proceedings. 70 Board activity in 2018 18 Global energy markets 74 Shareholder engagement 19 Group performance 74 International advisory board Shareholder information 22 Upstream 75 Audit committee 305 Contents 28 Downstream 81 Safety, ethics and environment Including information on dividends, 34 Rosneft assurance committee our annual general meeting 37 Other businesses and corporate 83 Remuneration committee and share prices. 38 Alternative energy 84 Geopolitical committee 315 Glossary 40 Innovation in BP 85 Chairman’s committee 320 Non-GAAP measures reconciliations 43 Sustainability 86 Nomination and governance committee 323 Signatures 43 Safety and security 87 Directors’ remuneration report 45 Climate change 324 Cross-reference to Form 20-F 48 Managing our impacts 325 Information about this report 49 Value to society 49 Human rights 50 Ethical conduct 51 Our people 53 How we manage risk Glossary 55 Risk factors Words and terms with this symbol are defined in the glossary on page 315. Cautionary statement This document should be read in conjunction with the cautionary statement on page 303.


 
What we do Our people We provide customers with fuel for and our values transport, energy for heat and light, power for industry, lubricants to keep The BP values express who we are engines moving and the petrochemicals and what we stand for. They capture the products used to make everyday items individual and collective behaviours we such as paints, clothes and packaging. expect from everyone who works for us. Our people help build enduring  Find out more about our activities on page 4. relationships based on mutual trust with governments, customers, partners, suppliers and communities.  Read more about our people on page 51 Informing our thinking or visit bp.com/values. Global prosperity is shaping economic and energy trends. Safety By 2040: Respect GDP doubling Excellence >2.5 billion people lifted from low incomes Courage  See how we consider a range of One team scenarios on page 9. Our performance in 2018 See how our businesses have performed and how we are reducing our emissions, Our strategy improving our products and creating low Our four strategic priorities are designed carbon businesses. to allow us to be competitive at a time   Find out more on pages 16 to 56. when prices, policy, technology and customer preferences are evolving rapidly.   Find out more on page 10. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 1


 
BP at a glance We are a global energy business Scale with wide reach across the 73,000 78 19,945 world’s energy system. We have employees countries million barrels of oil operations in Europe, North and equivalent – proved South America, Australasia, Asia hydrocarbon reservesa and Africa. 18,700 63,000 Data as at or for the year ended 31 December 2018 retail sites square kilometres of unless otherwise stated. new exploration a On a combined basis of access subsidiaries and equity- accounted entities. Completed a significant Acquired Chargemaster, Purchased a 16.5% interest BP in action turnaround at our largest operator of the UK’s in the UK’s Clair field from Highlights of some of refinery, Whiting in largest electric vehicle ConocoPhillips – increasing our activities in 2018. the US. charging network. our share to 45.1%. Opened more than 220 REWE to Go® convenience retail sites in Germany. Signed a production-sharing Acquired a portfolio of agreement with SOCAR to unconventional assets from BHP explore and develop in the in some of the best basins across North Absheron basin in Texas and Louisiana. Azerbaijan’s Caspian Sea. Signed an agreement with the governments of Opened our 440th Mauritania and Senegal BP-branded retail site to enable development of in Mexico. the BP-operated Greater Tortue Ahmeyim gas Formed a strategic alliance project. with Petrobras to explore joint projects in upstream, downstream, trading and low carbon. And accessed new acreage in the Santos basin, Gained approval for the offshore Brazil, making us the Ghazeer project to develop second-largest exploration the second phase of the holder in the basin. Khazzan field in Oman. 2 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – overview Performance Six major projects $9.4bn 3.7 16 started up in 2018 profit attributable million barrels of oil tier 1 process to BP shareholders equivalent per day – safety events hydrocarbon productiona (2017 $3.4 billion) KPI (2017 3.6mmboe/d) KPI (2017 18) KPI $12.7bn 100% underlying replacement group proved reserves cost profit replacement ratio a a On a combined basis of KPI See key performance subsidiaries and equity- indicators on page 16. (2017 $6.2 billion) KPI (2017 143%) KPI accounted entities.  See pages 14 and 15. Completed a deal to Invested in PowerShare – a Chinese More on our develop resources in company that’s connecting EV renewables activity the Kharampurskoe and drivers, charge point operators Festivalnoye licence and power suppliers. And signed areas in Russia, jointly a memorandum of understanding with Rosneft. with NIO Capital to explore opportunities in advanced mobility.  Investments in electric vehicle technology on page 42.  Low carbon ambitions on pages 46-48. Took delivery of British Partner – the first of six state-of-the-art liquefied natural gas ships being constructed in South Korea. Fuelled the first non-stop flight from Perth to London with Air BP jet fuel produced at our nearby Kwinana refinery. Lightsource BP delivered its first Indian solar project. And BP sanctioned the second phase of the KG D6 development in the ‘Satellite cluster’ deepwater gas fields in India with Reliance. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Glossary 3


 
How we run our business Business model foundations   Safe and reliable operations   Talented people From the deep sea to the desert, We strive to create and maintain a safe We work to attract, motivate, develop and from rigs to retail, we deliver operating culture where safety is front and retain the best talent the world offers and energy products and services centre. This is not only safer for people equip our people with the right skills for and the environment – it also improves the the future. Our performance and ability to people around the world. reliability of our assets. to thrive globally depend on it. We provide customers with fuel for   See Safety and security on page 43.   See Our people on page 51. transport, energy for heat and light, power for industry, lubricants to keep engines moving and the petrochemicals products used to make everyday items such as paints, clothes and packaging. 1 Finding oil and gas We have a diverse portfolio across businesses, resource types and geographies. Having upstream, downstream and renewables businesses, along with well-established trading capabilities, helps to mitigate the impact of commodity pricing cycles. Our geographic reach gives us access to growing markets and new resources, as well as diversifying exposure to geopolitical events. We are helping to meet the dual challenge of society’s need for more energy while reducing emissions through our ‘reduce, improve, create’ framework (see page 46). We believe that our long history, well-recognized brands and customer offers, combined with our unique partnership with Rosneft, help differentiate us from our peers. 2 Developing and extracting oil and gas Creating value Our role in society The energy we produce helps support 1 Finding oil and gas We also seek to grow or extend the life of existing fields – such as our Clair Ridge project, economic growth and improve quality New access allows us to renew our portfolio, which is helping unlock additional resources of life for millions of people. We strive to discover additional resources and replenish from the Clair field in the UK North Sea. be a world-class operator, a responsible our development options. We focus our corporate citizen and a great employer. exploration activities in the areas that are   See Upstream on page 22. We believe the societies and competitive in the portfolio, and develop and 3 Transporting and trading communities we work in should benefit use technology to reduce costs and risks. We move oil and gas through pipelines and by from our presence. We aim to create 2 Developing and extracting ship, truck and rail. We also trade a variety of positive, meaningful and sustainable oil and gas impacts in those communities through products including oil, natural gas, liquefied our social investments. We develop the resources that meet our natural gas, power and carbon products, as return threshold and produce hydrocarbons well as derivatives and currencies. BP’s traders We contribute to economies around that we then sell to the market or distribute serve more than 12,000 customers across the world by employing local people, to our downstream facilities. Our upstream some 140 countries in a year. Our customers helping to develop national and local pipeline of future projects gives us choice range from independent power producers to suppliers, and through the funds we about which we pursue. utilities and municipalities. We are the largest pay to governments from taxes and trader of natural gas in North America. other agreements. We use our market intelligence to analyse  See bp.com/society for more information supply and demand for commodities across on how we generate value to society. our global network. 4 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – overview 5 isk management systems and policy Venturing See bp.com/venturing. See Alternative energy on page 38 and Climate change on page 45. See How we manage risk on page 53 See How we manage risk on page 57. and Corporate governance       Governance and oversight 6 And in solar energy we target the growing large-scaledemand for projects solar BP. Lightsource worldwide through   Our r provide a consistent and clear framework The board reporting risks. and managing for regularly reviews how we identify, evaluate risks. manage and We invest in high-tech companies help to new commercialize and accelerate business and products technologies, models. Our focus is on five areas that are core our to strategy for advancing the advancedenergy transition: mobility, carbon carbon products, low and bio management, digital and transformation storage. and power BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Generating renewable energy Generating renewable 5 o build enduring relationships Generating renewable energy renewable Generating See Downstream on page 28. See Rosneft on page 34 and Upstream analysis See Rosneft on page 34 and by region on page 279.     Partnerships collaboration and 5 to thirdto parties. In petrochemicals our proprietary technology solutions deliver leading cost positions to addition In competitors. our to compared our own petrochemicals plants, we work with partners technology our license and We aim t partners, customers, with governments, suppliers countriesthe communities and in operate. we where   using one of the world’s most sustainable and renewable produce to feedstocks advantaged ethanol and We also power. provide renewable power through our significant interests in onshore wind energy in the US, and develop and deploy technology drive to efficiency. We have been investing in renewables for many years. Our focus is on biofuels, solar energy wind energy. and biopower, We operate a biofuels business in Brazil, Manufacturing and marketing 4 Venturing 6 echnologies help us produce energy  Manufacturing and marketing fuels fuels marketing and Manufacturing and products products and See Innovation in BP on page 40. See Innovation in BP on page Transporting and trading and Transporting   Technology and innovation 3 4 safely and more efficiently. We selectively invest in areas with the potential add to greatest value our to business, now and in the future, carbon businesses. lower building including   New t We produce refined petroleum products at our refineries and supply distinctive fuels and convenience retail services to consumers. Our advantaged infrastructure, logistics network and partnerships key help us have to differentiated fuels businesses offers, compelling deliver customer and carbon products. lower including premium has business lubricants Our brands and access growth to markets. It also leverages technology and customer relationships, all of which we believe gives us competitive advantage. We serve energy industrial, and marine automotive, world. the across markets lubricant


 
Chairman’s letter I am of the view that more energy with fewer emissions – the dual challenge – can be met if a progressive and pragmatic approach is taken to the energy transition. Dear fellow shareholder, 2018 has been a year of very good operating performance, important strategic progress and continued change. Our teams have delivered strong results across the business and we are well positioned to continue to deliver value as we play our part in the dual challenge of delivering more energy with fewer emissions. It was an honour to be appointed chairman of BP. I have huge respect for the responsibilities that come with the role and I will do my utmost to provide thoughtful leadership to the board of directors and support for Bob Dudley and his team as we advance BP in a changing energy landscape. BP’s strong position is a great tribute to my predecessor as chairman, Carl-Henric Svanberg. During his nine-year tenure Carl-Henric did an outstanding job of guiding our company through difficult times. On behalf of the board, I want to thank him for his contribution. It has been a pleasure to get to know my new colleagues on the board, and I believe we have a wide ranging combination of diversity, skills, experience and knowledge that we need to steer the company through a landscape that is both uncertain and presents possibilities. Last year we welcomed Dame Alison Carnwath and Pamela Daley to the board, each with extensive experience gained in a range of executive and non-executive roles in large companies. And this year we say farewell to Alan Boeckmann and Admiral Frank ‘Skip’ Bowman. Alan and Skip have $8.1bn both made valuable contributions during their tenures, particularly total dividends distributed through their leadership and membership of our safety, ethics and to BP shareholders environment assurance committee. Strengthening organizational culture and capability 6.3% The work of the board will continue to evolve over time to make sure that BP is best positioned to advance the energy transition, embrace ordinary shareholders digital disruption and meet society’s changing expectations of major annual dividend yield companies. In my short time so far at BP I have already seen for myself many examples of the commitment of our people. Their drive and determination have brought BP to where it is today, and I want to thank 6.4% them for their hard work. It is critically important we continue to strengthen our organizational capabilities – both by developing our ADS shareholders people and by continuing to attract the world’s top talent. We look annual dividend yield forward to doing this by continuing to foster a diverse and inclusive culture, where everyone feels valued. 6 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – overview 7 More information   Corporate governance Page 57 29 March 2019 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Our clear purpose Finally, I think it is important for BP’s success that we have a clear purpose – one that is strongly linked society’s to needs. That is why one of the first things I have done with the board reviewis our purpose in line with our strategy and values. Our purpose is advance to energy Lund Helge Chairman to improveto people’s lives. the world Today needs more energy than ever butwith emissions. fewer help meet this To dual challenge we have be to financially strong and sure we make continueto be an energy transition. the through attractive investment I look forward working to with Bob and the team as we advance the values our guided by strategy, our through energy delivering transition, and inspired by our purpose. I alsolook forward hearing to from you, and meeting many of you, in the coming months and years as we look to confidence and trust your BP. in reward This the board year, is pleased support to a resolution that has been proposed by a group of investors at our annual general meeting in May. The resolution, if passed, will pave the way for additional reporting to help investors better understand how BP’s strategy is consistent with the Paris climate goals. We see this as an important opportunity for investors appraise to our progress in responding the to dual challenge. Further details can be found in the Notice of Meeting, be to published in April. in to playto our part in reducing greenhouse gas emissions. I am of the view that more energy with emissions fewer – the dual challenge – can be met if a progressive and pragmatic approach is taken the to energy transition. In BP we recognize that energy in many forms willbe required, produced in ways that are cleaner and better. That is why we see ourselves not just as an oil and gas business but as a global energy business. We also recognize that we must be constantly improving and seeking out new ideas and possibilities. We must be able learn to fast and harness all the potential of the rapid advances in digital and other new technologies. share. I believe they help build to trust with our people, partners, company. the Above all, our primary focus has always to be on operating safely and reliably, minute by minute, day after Protecting day. people, the environment and our assets is always our top priority and the bedrock on which success is built. I think of it as having the tightest defence in the league, a good like football team. If you have a strong defence, you can be more forward looking, compete harder and be better positioned to win. We value the dialogue we have with you and others, sharing our achievements, our challenges and our plans and seeking your views. This report is one of many ways we update you on our activities progress. and Earning trust through strong values Pursuing this approach, BP is guided by its values of safety, respect, excellence, courage and one team. These are values I personally more energy meet to growing global demand as emerging economies develop and provide people with a better quality of life. The other is the communities in which we work, and with you, the owners of There are two defining prioritiesfor our industry. One to is produce Our progressive,Our pragmatic approach the to energy transition


 
Group chief executive’s letter Our strategy is delivering value for you, our shareholders, while being flexible and agile for the energy transition underway. Advancing the energy transition The deals we made and the strategy we have in place are evidence that BP is a forward-looking energy business. One that is already playing an active role in advancing the energy transition. That’s why we are making bold changes across our entire business to reduce emissions in our operations, improve products to help customers reduce their own emissions, and to create new low carbon businesses. This is our ‘reduce, improve, create’ (RIC) framework which we are backing up with clear targets. I am pleased to report we are making good progress against these targets. BP is also working with peers on a range of fronts, in particular to tackle methane emissions and create opportunities for carbon capture, utilization and storage. You’ll see this in our work with the Oil and Gas Dear fellow shareholder, Climate Initiative, which I chair, and whose members now represent 30% of global oil and gas production. I am pleased to report that 2018 was another remarkable year for BP. Our safety performance continued to improve overall, helping to create As well as action across the industry, at BP we understand that meeting record operational reliability, which led to strong production, and record our own low carbon ambitions is a shared responsibility across our refining throughput. entire business. That’s why we are now incentivizing around 36,000 employees who are eligible for an annual cash bonus to play a role by Strength in numbers linking their reward to one of our emissions reduction targets. This ultimately contributed to us maintaining a healthy balance sheet Possibilities everywhere as we more than doubled our underlying profit, nearly doubled our return on average capital employed, and significantly increased We will continue to be open and transparent about our ambitions, plans operating cash flow. and progress, recognizing that the trust of our shareholders and other stakeholders is essential to BP remaining a reliable and attractive It was a year in which we secured our biggest deal in 20 years, acquiring long-term investment. And only by ensuring we remain a world-class BHP’s world-class unconventional oil and gas onshore US assets. We investment, can we most effectively play our part in advancing a low also made progressive moves in mobility, such as the acquisition carbon future. of the UK’s leading electric vehicle charging network to create BP Chargemaster. As a global energy business with scale, expertise and strong relationships around the world, we don’t just believe we have an BP is in good shape. Our strategy is delivering value for you, important part to play in the dual challenge, we see value-generating our shareholders, while being flexible and agile for the energy opportunities for BP throughout the energy transition. transition underway. We’re making good progress delivering our strategy while flexing and • We continued to focus on advantaged oil and gas in the Upstream, adapting to an environment that is changing fast. We have a great team delivering new supplies of gas from four of our six new major projects at BP and I would like to thank them all for their continued dedication and brought online in 2018. We are also expanding our LNG portfolio and relentless commitment to advancing the energy transition. developing new markets in transport and power. • In the Downstream, we expanded our retail offer, as seen by more than 25% growth in our convenience partnerships, to around 1,400 sites worldwide. • As we pursue venturing and low carbon across multiple fronts, Lightsource BP doubled its global solar presence to 10 countries. Bob Dudley • And we underpinned all this by continuing to modernize our plants, Group chief executive processes, and portfolio by harnessing the potential of digital and new 29 March 2019 technologies to provide greater efficiencies, reliability and safety. GAAP equivalents Profit attributable to shareholders: $9.4bn (2017: $3.4bn) Average capital employed: $165.5bn (2017: $159.4bn) 8 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – overview 9 Rapid transition Rapid Evolving transition Evolving 2 1 This scenario is consistent with the with consistent This scenario is Paris goals, and is broadly similar to the reduction in carbon emissions in Sustainable Development IEA’s the Scenario. This scenario assumes that This scenario assumes government policies, technology and social preferences continue to to continue preferences social and evolve in a manner and speed seen past. recent the over More information 20   BP Energy Outlook See bp.com/energyoutlook for more information on our projections of future energy trends and factors that could affect them out to 2040. BP Technology Outlook See bp.com/technologyoutlook for information on how technology could influence the way we meet the energy challenge into the future. 1�� le� 2�� e�a� Ren �� 1� BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 and storage. and Gas offers a cleaner alternative coal to for power generation and can lower emissions at scale. It also provides a valuable partner for temperatures high the at heating delivers intermittency, renewables required by industry and is increasingly used in transportation. Across Thatsaid, oil and gas could meet at least 50% of the world’s energy needs in 2040 – even in a scenario consistent with the Paris goals, with the share of gas growing aided by increasing use of carbon capture, use our scenarios, gas grows robustly, overtaking coal as the second-largest source of energy by 2030. Oil demand grows for the next years 10 in our evolving transition scenario, before gradually levelling out due factors to such as accelerating gains in vehicle efficiency and greater use of biofuels, natural gas and electricity. The largest source of oildemand growth is the non-combusted use of oil, for example as a feedstock for petrochemicals. �� �� 20� �� ��dro �� �� 28� mand in 2040 decreases by 14Mb/d. al energy consumption grows by emissions from energy decline emissions use from 2 �� Rapid transition Biofuels grow by 4Mb/d. by around 45% by 2040. fifth. one around Glob Oil de CO 10 2 • • • 2�� �lear �� �u 2�� 2�� �oal � 2�� ��� 2�� �a� d gas account for more than half of d energy demand increases by one third emissions from energy increase emissions use from 2 BP Outlook Energy explores the forces shaping the ��l Evolving transition Evolving Worl CO Oil an global energy in 2040. by 7% by 2040.by 7% from 2017 to 2040. to from 2017 1 Rapid transition 20�0 Actual energy mix 201� Evolving transition 20�0 ��ll�on tonne� o� o�l e�u��alent� ��e �um o� t�e �uel ��are� ma� not e�ual 100� due to round�n�� 0 Energy consumption 2040 – projections In all the scenarios considered, world GDP more than doubles by 2040 economies. fast-growing developing prosperity in increasing by driven In the evolving transition scenario, this improvement in living standards causes energy demand increase to by a third by 2040, driven mainly by India, China and other developing Asian economies. The rate of growth however is slower than in the previous 20 years, as the world increasingly learns produce to more with less energy. Despite this, a substantial proportion of the world’s population in 2040 could live in countries where low. energy per person relatively consumption average is the Atthe same time, the energy mix is changing as technology advances, Renewables shift evolve. policy and measures preferences consumer The demand for energy is set increase to significantly – growing supporteconomies need energy to industry their infrastructure. and are now the fastest-growing energy source in the world today and in our evolving transition scenario we estimate that they could account for 15% of all energy15% consumption in 2040 – and in other scenariosmore. • • • global energy transitionout to 2040 and the key uncertainties surrounding that transition. use We the scenarios the in Outlook together with a range of other analysis and information when forming our long-term strategy. The The changing energy mix


 
Our strategy Society is demanding solutions for more energy, delivered in new Growing advantaged oil and better ways for a low carbon and gas in the upstream future. Our strategy is designed to meet this dual challenge. Through new technologies, energy will be produced more efficiently and in new ways, helping to meet the expected rise in demand. Our strategy allows us to be competitive at a Invest in more oil and gas, time when prices, policy, technology and producing both with increasing customer preferences are evolving rapidly. efficiency. We believe having a balanced portfolio with advantaged oil and gas, a competitive Key highlights downstream and a range of low carbon activities, with the flexibility of our strategy, Transforming US onshore gives us optionality whatever path the transition takes. With the experience we have and the portfolio we’ve created, we can embrace the energy transition in a way that enhances our investor proposition, while continuing to meet the need for energy.   More information Purchased unconventional assets from BHP, Financial framework How this underpins our commitment giving us access to some of the best basins to disciplined investment and growing in the onshore US. shareholder value. See page 13.   See Upstream on page 24. Collaborative partnerships Signed a new production-sharing agreement with SOCAR, Azerbaijan’s state oil and gas company, to jointly explore and develop block D230 in the Caspian Sea. And formed a strategic alliance with Petrobras to explore joint projects in upstream, downstream, trading and low carbon in Brazil.   See Upstream analysis by region on page 279. Project approvals Sanctioned Ghazeer in Oman – the second phase of development in the Khazzan gas field; Alligin and Vorlich in the UK North Sea; the Cassia Compression and Matapal gas projects in Trinidad; KG D6 Satellites in India; Zinia 2 in Angola; Manuel and Atlantis Phase 3 in the Gulf of Mexico; and Tortue in Mauritania and Senegal.   See Upstream on page 22. Major project start-ups Started up six major projects, making a significant contribution to the 900,000 barrels per day of expected new production from major project start-ups between 2016 and 2021.   See Upstream on page 22. 10 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – strategy 11 See page 52. See Innovation in BP on page 40. See Innovation in BP on page 40.       four platforms in the US Gulf of Mexico. The cloud-based tool helps reduce the time it problem a diagnose to engineers take could from hours minutes. to Trialled new technologies, such as smart glasses in the US and digital vests in Oman, helpto increase safety and efficiency at our operations. Cloud-based technologies Deployed Plant Operations Advisor on our Intelligent operations Installed APEX technology across all our BP-operatedupstream data gather to assets identifyabout help and every efficiency well improvements. Process automation Reduced the time it takes complete to manual contract as management such tasks, and customer data processing, by using robotic process automation. This is helping optimize to productivity and drive processes, business our satisfaction. customer improve Modernizing the whole group wearableUsing technologies Simplify our processes and enhanceSimplify our processes digitalour productivity through solutions. for ® by pipeline for 2 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Innovation in BP on page 42. See Climate change on page 45. See bp.com/sustainability for more information. See Climate change on page 45.         use at their planned their US commercial-scale at use waste-to-fuels plant. Venturing and lowVenturing carbon across multiple fronts Cleaner powerCleaner Working with the Oil and Gas Climate Initiative progressto the Clean Gas Project, which plans then and power, generate gas to natural use to transport and capture CO the of Chargemaster, operator of the largest UK’s network. charging electric vehicle Advancing solar Lightsource BP has doubled the number of countries where it has a presence since 2017. December waste to fuelTurning Licensed technology, developed by BP and Johnson Matthey, Fulcrum to BioEnergy to meet evolving technology, trends. consumer and policy Harnessing battery power Made a series of investments in electric vehicle technology and infrastructure help to battery for demand rising to respond us charging facilities, including acquisition the Pursue new opportunities storage in a formation under the southern North Sea. sponsorship and sponsorship retail sites in Germany, taking the total See Downstream page 28. See Downstream on page 28. See Downstream on page 28. ®       Market-led growth in the downstream Strong brands and partnerships lubricants our Strengthened fuels and partnership with Renault Sport Racing – extending our BP Castrol broadening the relationship include to joint development of advanced mobility solutions technologies. new and Sustainable aviation fuel Entered an into innovative collaboration between Air BP and Neste, a leading renewable products producer, secure to and promote the supply of sustainable aviation fuel. Expanded our network 440 to BP-branded retail sites in Mexico and opened our first Indonesia. in sites Growing retail new in markets Convenience partnerships Opened more than 220 additional REWE to Go number of convenience partnership to convenience of number sites around 1,400 across our global retail network. Innovate with advanced productsInnovate with advanced and strategic partnerships. Key highlightsKey


 
BP investor proposition of demand in a low carbon world. We have strong incumbent positions in many of the world’s top hydrocarbon basins and a robust pipeline of growth opportunities – see page 27. We started up six major projects in 2018. Fit for the Focused on Safer The Downstream business has a strong and focused presence. We future returns have advantaged manufacturing facilities, considerable potential for growth in our marketing businesses, and are expanding our retail network in rapidly growing markets such as Mexico, Indonesia and China. We also provide products – such as fuels with ACTIVE technology Safe, reliable A distinctive Value based, – and offers that help consumers lower their emissions – see page 28. and efficient portfolio fit for a disciplined Through our well-established supply and trading function we generate execution changing world investment and value by providing the link between our businesses and third-party cost focus customers. In November BP and partners in banking and trading launched VAKT, the world’s first blockchain platform for managing post-trade oil and commodities commercially. And we’re increasing our activity in renewables, building on our existing solar, wind and biofuels businesses, and creating new business models. For example Lightsource BP has doubled the number of countries Growing sustainable free where it has a presence since December 2017 – see page 47. cash flow and distributions Embedded within our strategy is our commitment to advance a low to shareholders over the long term carbon future. We plan to deliver this across our entire business by reducing emissions in our operations, improving our products and services, and creating low carbon businesses.   See Our low carbon ambitions on page 46. Our investor proposition is to grow sustainable free cash flow and distributions to shareholders over the long term. We believe our strategy We are actively managing the portfolio to remain resilient in a enables this, through a focus on safe, reliable and efficient execution, changing world and believe we have enough flexibility in our portfolio leveraging our distinctive portfolio, and disciplined investment to support to reshape our business and balance sheet in around 10 years should growing returns. we need to. This enables us to monitor changing trends and legislation, and provides us with optionality to adjust our portfolio and adapt to  Safer the future. Safety is one of our core values and our number one priority. We are focused on being systematic, disciplined and process driven.   Focused on returns A safe business doesn’t just protect people, it also helps improve We have a disciplined financial framework that is central to our strategy, operating performance, leading to improved business and financial and clear growth plans out to 2021 and beyond. performance. In recent years overall safety events have declined, and Recent portfolio additions and new long-term agreements – for example we’ve increased upstream plant reliability and downstream refining our purchase of BHP’s unconventional onshore assets in the US and availability . the new production-sharing agreement we signed with SOCAR in Azerbaijan – have strengthened our position.   See Measuring our progress on page 16 and Safety on page 43. We have held our capital frame of $15-17 billion a year for organic   Fit for the future expenditure for the past three years and expect to do so at least out to As an integrated business, we benefit from having upstream, 2021. We believe we can continue to generate robust organic growth downstream, renewable energy businesses and an established trading within this framework and that the strength of our balance sheet will function. Our balanced portfolio spans resource types and geographies allow us to deal with any near-term volatility. with a strong and distinctive set of assets, brands and relationships. We remain confident in our guidance on returns of greater than 10% In the Upstream we are growing ‘advantaged’ oil and gas – that by 2021 at an oil price of $55/bbl (based on real 2017 Brent oil prices). means low cost or high margin. This improves the likelihood that   See Group performance on page 19. the hydrocarbons we produce are resilient and competitive in terms   Distributions to shareholders Our commitment to growing distributions to shareholders is underpinned 2.5% $8.1bn by our progressive dividend policy and share buyback programme. dividend increase total dividends distributed in July to BP shareholders in 2018 In July 2018 we announced a 2.5% increase to our dividend, and over the year distributed total dividends to shareholders of $8.1 billion. We have remained active in our share buyback programme, buying back 50 million ordinary shares in 2018 at a cost of $355 million including fees and stamp duty. 12 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – strategy Our financial framework We maintain a disciplined financial framework, which underpins our investment choices and supports growth in sustainable free cash flow, returns and distributions to shareholders. Our balance sheet and cash cover metrics are strong, and during 2018 this enabled us to acquire the BHP Lower 48 assets, funded using available cash. Alongside the real momentum across our businesses, and in line with growing free cash flow and the receipt of divestment proceeds, we continue to expect to deliver the 2021 targets laid out two years ago. 2018 outcome Guidance 2019-2021 Capital expenditure Organic capital expenditure was $15.1 We expect organic capital expenditure to be billion*, at the bottom end of our guidance. in the range of $15-17 billion per year. Divestments Total divestment and other proceeds of We expect more than $10 billion of $3.5 billiona achieved. This was in line with divestments over the next two years. This guidance of more than $3 billion for the year. includes divestments announced as part of the BHP transaction. Gulf of Mexico oil spill 2018 payments totalled $3.2 billion, in line We expect payments of around $2 billion in payments with our guidance of just over $3 billion. 2019, stepping down to around $1 billion per year for the next 14 years. Gearing Gearing at the end of 2018 was 30.3%**. We expect gearing to be in the range of 20-30%. Group return on average ROACE was 11.2%***, almost double that We expect ROACE to be more than 10% by capital employed (ROACE) in 2017. 2021 at $55/bbl (based on real 2017 Brent oil prices). Distributions We increased the quarterly dividend by 2.5% Progressive dividend and a continued share in July and repurchased 50 million ordinary buyback programme, which is expected to shares at a cost of $355 million in 2018. fully offset the impact of scrip dilution since the third quarter of 2017 by the end of 2019. Our published guidance will be updated for any impacts associated with the new lease accounting standard, IFRS 16 ‘Leases’, during 2019. a This includes a $0.6 billion loan repayment to BP relating to the refinancing of Trans Adriatic Pipeline AG. Divestment proceeds for 2018 were $2.9 billion.   Nearest equivalent GAAP measures * Capital expenditure: $25.1 billion. ** Gross debt ratio: 39.3%. ***Numerator: Profit attributable to BP shareholders $9.4 billion; Denominator: Average capital employed $165.5 billion. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Glossary 13


 
Major project start-ups Atoll Phase 1, Egypt Thunder Horse Northwest Expansion, US We developed and delivered first gas from Atoll Phase 1 less than three years after its discovery. It supports our commitment to help realize Egypt’s oil and gas potential and meet the increasing demand from its growing population. Operator Pharaonic Petroleum Company Partners BP (100%) Project type Conventional gas 16 months from sanction to first oil Cairo We started up the Thunder Horse 110km Northwest Expansion project 16 months subsea tieback after it was sanctioned. The project is on our largest platform in the deepwater 6,400 Gulf of Mexico. metres Operator BP well depth, <3 years Partners BP (75%), ExxonMobil more than Mount to deliver (25%) Kilimanjaro Project type Deepwater oil Suez Clair Ridge, UK North Sea Clair Ridge is the second phase development of the Clair field – the largest in the UK continental shelf. Operator BP Partners BP (45.1%), Shell (28%), Chevron (19.4%), Conoco Phillips (7.5%), Project type Conventional oil 14 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – strategy 15 Turkey 2,760 metres the highest point of the pipeline, TANAP 1,850km Turkey eastern in Georgia 2 new compressor stations the approximately each of 20size football pitches Conventional oil and gas BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Conventional gas Taas Rosneft Oil India, (50.1%), Indian Oil, Bharat PetroResources (29.9%), BP (20%) BP BP (28.8%), SOCAR PETRONAS (16.7%), (15.5%), Lukoil NICO (10%), TPAO (19%) (10%), Partners type Project Taas-Yuryakh expansion, RussiaTaas-Yuryakh Led by our partner Rosneft, the Taas-Yuryakh expansion project in Eastern Siberia is an example of successful collaboration in the remote Russian region of Sakha (Yakutia). Operator 2 new bridge-2 new linked platforms constructed by 5,000+ workers and installed in Caspianthe Sea Azerbaijan Shah Deniz Stage was 2 our biggest major project start-up in 2018. It includes complex offshore and onshore projects with Southern the across Gas developments pipeline Corridor. Operator Partners type Project LNG Woodside BP, BHP, Chevron, WoodsideShell, and Japan LNG Australia (16.67% each) subsea wells 26 500km Photo credit: Woodside Energy Ltd. Shah Deniz Stage Azerbaijan 2, Operator Partners Located off the north-west coast of Australia, the Western Flank B project develops five fields via an eight subsea well tie back the to Goodwynplatform. A Project type Project Western Flank Australia B, of subsea flow lines


 
Measuring our progress We assess our performance Safer across a wide range of measures and indicators that ���� � ������� ������ ������� �������� ���������� ������ ���������� are consistent with our strategy ��� ��� ��� ��� and investor proposition. ���� �� ���� ���� 201� 18 201� 0�22 Our key performance indicators (KPIs) provide 201� 1� 201� 0�21 a balanced set of metrics that give emphasis 201� 20 201� 0�2� to both financial and non-financial measures. 201� 28 201� 0��1 These help the board and executive 10 20 �0 �0 0�1 0�2 0�� 0�� management assess performance against We report tier 1 process safety events which are losses of Reported recordable injury frequency (RIF) measures the number primary containment of greatest consequence – causing harm of reported work-related employee and contractor incidents our strategic priorities and business plans, to a member of the workforce, costly damage to equipment or that result in a fatality or injury per 200,000 hours worked. with non-financial metrics playing a useful role exceeding defined quantities. 2018 performance We have seen a decrease in our RIF as leading indicators of future performance. 2018 performance We have seen a slight decrease in tier 1 compared with 2017. Our goals stay the same – to have BP management uses these measures to process safety events. However there is always more we can no accidents, no harm to people and no damage to the do and we remain focused on achieving better results today environment. evaluate operating performance and make and in the future. financial, strategic and operating decisions.   More information Focused on returns Strategy Underlying replacement cost profit Operating cash flow �� ��ll�on� Pages 10-13 ($ billion) REM REM REM REM 9.4 2018 22.9 Changes to KPIs 2018 12.7 201� 18�� In 2018 we introduced a target to achieve 3.4 2017 201� 10�� 3.5 million tonnes of sustainable GHG 6.2 0.1 201� 1��1 emissions reductions in our operations 2016 2.6 201� �2�8 worldwide by 2025. Progress towards this (6.5) 20 �0 �0 2015 target has now been incorporated into the 5.9 3.8 assessment of the group’s performance that 2014 12.1 is a factor in determining annual bonuses for 0 eligible BP employees worldwide. This will Profit (loss) for the year apply to our performance assessment in Underlying RC profit for the year (non-GAAP) 2019 and beyond. We are also changing Underlying RC profit is a useful measure for investors downstream refining availability to BP- because it is one of the profitability measures BP management Operating cash flow is net cash flow provided by operating uses to assess performance. It assists management activities, as reported in the group cash flow statement. operated downstream refining availability in understanding the underlying trends in operational Operating activities are the principal revenue-generating to more closely align with our BP-operated performance on a comparable year-on-year basis. activities of the group and other activities that are not investing or financing activities. upstream plant reliability measure. It reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains 2018 performance Operating cash flow was higher due to and losses from profit or loss. Adjustments are also made improved business results, including the benefit of higher Remuneration for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects . oil prices and lower Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments, which amounted to $3.2 billion in 2018, partly offset by higher To help align the focus of our board and 2018 performance The significant increase in both profit for working capital. executive management with the interests of the year and underlying RC profit was largely due to higher profits in Upstream, reflecting major project start-ups and our shareholders, certain measures are used higher prices, partly offset by higher taxes. for executive remuneration. REM Measures used for the remuneration policy ������ �� ������� ������� �������� ��� ����� ����������� ������ ��� approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM. ��� ��� ��� Measures for the annual bonus are focused ���� ���� ����� ���� on safety, reliable operations and financial 201� ��8 ��� 20�0 performance. Measures for performance 201� 2�8 201� ��� shares are focused on shareholder value, 201� ��� 2��0 201� capital discipline and future growth. 201� ��� ���� �12�8� 201� �8��� These measures were used for executive Return on average capital employed (non-GAAP) gives an REM �1���� remuneration under the terms of our indication of a company’s capital efficiency, dividing the 201� �11��� discontinued 2014-16 policy. underlying RC profit after adding back net interest by average capital employed, excluding cash and goodwill. See page -20 0 20 �0 �0 321 for more information including the nearest equivalent A�� �a��� �rd�nar� ��are �a���   More information GAAP data. 2018 performance The increase reflects improved business Total shareholder return (TSR) represents the change in value Directors’ remuneration results, including the impact of higher prices and the benefit of of a BP shareholding over a calendar year. It assumes that Page 87  further upstream major project start-ups in the year. dividends are reinvested to purchase additional shares at the closing price on the ex-dividend date. Footnotes key We are committed to maintaining a progressive and a This represents reported incidents occurring within BP’s sustainable dividend policy. operational HSSE reporting boundary. That boundary includes BP’s own operated facilities and certain other 2018 performance Reduced TSR reflects a reduction in the locations or situations. share price in 2018 compared with share price growth in 2017, largely offset by higher dividend in 2018. b Relates to BP employees. 16 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 17 �� �� �1 ���� ���� �� ���0 �� 12��� ���� activity and the 10��� is calculated as is ���� 8��� (%) ���� ��11 SeeGlossary The result was a record, reflecting our . We changed our survey questions in 2017 e �0 1� 018 performanc 018 ��� ��� ���� 201� 201� 201� 201� ���� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 20 ���� We conduct an annual employee survey to understand and understand to survey employee annual an conduct We monitor levels of employee engagement and identify areas for improvement. performance 2018 to reflect the new priorities set out in our refreshed strategy. The scores prior to 2017 are based on questions on priorities set out in 2012, so the numbers are not directly comparable. Theupstream unit production cost indicator shows how supply chain, headcount and scope optimization impact cost efficiency. 2018 performance compared costs, production unit Higher with were due 2017, to increased well-work impact of higher prices on production entitlements. production on prices higher of impact �������� ���������� �������� ���� ���������� ����� ����oe� ���� ���������� ����� �������� BP-operated reliability plant upstream by installed production capacity. production installed by 2 focus on efficiency of execution, and use of advanced new applications. digital and technologies 100% less the ratio of total unplanned plant deferrals divided �������� ����� ����������� ��� 8 0 � ���00 ��� � � ����� 2�20 �� �� 2� 2� ���00 � � ����� � 22 21 21 21 1� 18 ��� � � BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 � 1� ��200 ��2�8 ��2�� 2 We started up six major projects in �on ����� ��1�1 � 10 �omen ��000 ���� 201� 201� 201� 201� ���� 201� 201� 201� 201� ���� 201� 201� 201� 201� P��������� �m�oe�d� P��������� Australia, Azerbaijan, Egypt, Russia, the UK and US. We monitor the progress of our major projects to gauge whether we are delivering our core pipeline of projects under time. on construction Projects take many years to complete, requiring differing amounts of resource, so a smooth or increasing trend should not be anticipated. Major projects are defined as those with a BP net investment of at least $250 million, or considered to be of strategic importance or of a high to BP, degree of complexity. performance 2018 Production is a useful measure for tracking how our major projects are helping to grow our business. We report production of crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGLs), natural bitumen and natural gas on a volume per day basis for equity-accounted and subsidiaries our is gas Natural entities. converted to barrels of oil equivalent at 5,800 standard cubic feet of natural gas = 1 boe. 2018 performance including production, reported total BP’s Upstream and Rosneft segments, was 2.4% higher than in This2017. was due to major project ramp-ups and improved reliability.plant Each year we report the percentage of women and individuals from countries other than the UK and the US among BP’s leaders. group 2018 performance While the percentage of our group leaders who are non-UK/US remained the same, the percentage of female group leaders rose. As a global business we are committed to increasing the diversity of our workforce and leadership. ��������� ��� ��������� ����� ������� �������� �0 �0 ��� ���� ���� 1�� �0�1 94.9 ���0 �8�� ���� ���� 1�0 1 ���� ���� 10� ��� �0 120 and methane. Our GHG 2 , other than BP’s share 100 e�u��alent� �� 2 �1 and equity-accounted and entities. 20 80 ever, lower than 2017reflecting increased how and associates and   �0 �0 Fit for the future REM 2018 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� ���� 201� 201� 201� ���� 201� This measure helps to demonstrate our success in accessing, resources. extracting and exploring 2018 performance The ratio of 100.4% was in line with our five-year average reserves replacement ratio, due to new projects. existing our in revisions and investments project maintenance, particularly at our Gelsenkirchen refinery. Gelsenkirchen particularly our maintenance, at Refining availability represents Solomon Associates’ Associates’ Solomon represents availability Refining operational availability. The measure shows the percentage of the year that a unit is available for processing after deducting the time spent on turnaround activity and all mechanical, process and regulatory downtime. operational the of indicator important an is availability Refining businesses. Downstream performance our of 2018 performance Refiningavailability remained strong, programmes. improvement reliability global our by underpinned The result was, Proved reserves replacement ratio is the extent to whichthe year’s production has been replaced by proved reserves added base. reserve our to Theratio is expressed in oil-equivalent terms and includes recovery and improved discoveries, from resulting changes extensions and revisions to previous estimates, but excludes disposals. acquisitions and The ratio from changes resulting subsidiaries both reflects We provide data on greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions material to our business on a carbon dioxide-equivalent basis. This comprises direct emissions of CO KPI comprises 100% emissions from subsidiaries and the percentage of emissions equivalent to our share of joint arrangements of Rosneft. 2018 performance The primary reasons for the overall decrease include actions taken by our businesses to reduce emissions in areas such as flaring, methane and energy increased gas as such changes operational and efficiency, being captured and exported to the liquefied natural gas facility Angola. in Refining availability ��� ���������� ��� ��������� �m�ll�on tonne� o� �� �������� ����������� ����� ��� �������� �����������


 
Global energy markets Average oil prices increased again in 2018, but remained well below the prices seen in 2011-13. Co-ordinated OPEC and non-OPEC production restraint early in the year and robust global demand growth were countered by record growth in US production. The world economy grew at 3% in 2018, reflecting slower growth in year average for much of the year. But with the reversal of production both advanced and emerging economies. This was slightly lower than restraint inventories began to rise, and by the end of December were the 3.1% seen in 2017, but around the average of nearly 3% over the slightly above the five-year average, standing at 2,858 million barrels. past 20 years. Growth in advanced economies slightly decelerated to 2.2% from 2.4% in 2017, reflecting temporary factors, such as natural Natural gas disasters in Japan, slowing net exports in Europe and the ongoing trade disputes. Emerging markets showed a similar broad-based deceleration, ������� ��� ������ ���mm�tu � �uarterl� a�era�e� �enr� �u� growing by 4.2% in 2018, compared with 4.3% in 2017. The slowdown 12 in emerging markets activity reflects softening global trade and 10 tightening monetary conditions. 8 Oil � � ����� ��� ������ �����l � �uarterl� a�era�e� �rent dated 2 1�0 0� 10 11 12 1� 1� 1� 1� 1� ���� 120 Prices Gas prices rebounded in all key markets in 2018. Asian and European �0 gas prices have increased to $9.76/mmBtu and 60.38 pence per therm respectively, up from $7.13/mmBtu and 44.95 pence per therm in 2017. �0 This was driven by higher oil, coal, and CO2 prices (in Europe) as well as a relatively tight liquefied natural gas (LNG) market. Asian prices 0� 10 11 12 1� 1� 1� 1� 1� ���� were strong at above $10/mmBtu during summer due to high Asian Prices LNG demand and a tight LNG market, but dropped below $9/mmBtu Dated Brent crude oil prices averaged $71.31 per barrel in 2018 – a in late 2018 due to warm weather in Asia and growing LNG supplies. second consecutive annual increase but still well below the average While LNG supply increased strongly, all of these incremental LNG of over $110 seen in 2011-13. Prices drifted higher over the first half of supplies were absorbed by Asia – with China accounting for around half the year as production restraint remained in place among OPEC and of that growth. US spot prices averaged $3.11/mmBtu – after being flat co-operating non-OPEC countries, then rose more rapidly to reach their at $3/mmBtu for most of the year, they rebounded during the last annual peak near $85 in October. In the face of rising prices, producers quarter due to low storage levels. relaxed their restraint at mid-year and prices fell sharply late in the year, Consumption ending 2018 at their annual low point of about $50. Global consumption is estimated to have increased more rapidly in Consumptiona 2018 than in 2017, driven by strong growth in the US and China. US Global consumption increased by 1.3 million barrels per day (mmb/d) to demand growth was largely driven by increasing gas use in the power 99.2mmb/d for the year (1.3%) – a fourth consecutive increase greater sector as power generation recovered and an estimated 14GW of coal than the 10-year average – due to continued lower than average oil capacity was retired in 2018. Chinese gas demand continued to grow at prices and stronger world economic growth. Demand once again grew a double-digit rate on the back of coal-to-gas switching in the industrial most rapidly in Asia’s emerging economies (+0.8mmb/d), but OECD and buildings sectors. demand also increased for a fourth consecutive year. Production Productiona Total gas production increased substantially in 2018. Significant Global oil production grew by a robust 2.6mmb/d (2.7%) to average production increases were achieved in the US and Australia – supported 100.0mmb/d, with non-OPEC countries (+2.7mmb/d) accounting for all by the start of new LNG trains – and Russia. Global LNG supply of the increase. The US saw record production growth of 2.2mmb/d. In capacity expanded slightly faster than in 2017, with around 28mtpa contrast OPEC production declined by 0.1mmb/d – the second consecutive of LNG capacity starting commercial operations. Several trains came annual decline – although it began to recover later in the year. online in Australia, Russia, the US and Cameroon. Inventoriesa These changes resulted in global supply significantly exceeding demand in 2018, especially later in the year. In the face of production a From IEA Oil Market Report, 13 restraint from OPEC and co-operating non-OPEC countries early in the February 2019 ©, OECD/IEA 2019   More information year, commercial oil inventories in the OECD were below the five- Prices and margins Pages 25 and 30 18 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 19 25 20 15 Other businesses and corporate Page 37 Oil and gas disclosures for the group Page 285 SeeGlossary ax 10 (57) 115 2016 483 and t Group RC profit (loss) before interest and tax and interest before (loss) profit RC Group (430) (999) 6,746 2,467 2,585 (3,162) (1,597) (1,865) $ million $ 29.418 5 erest More information   Upstream Page 22 Downstream Page 28 Rosneft Page 34 (79) 2017 225 (325) 40.0 40.0 (853) ore int neft 6,166 9,474 2,761 3,730 3,389 (3,712) (2,294) 30.979 except per share amounts Ros e (includes (5) 0 55) 55) 78 2018 801 (195) (198) 40.5 (643) 9,986 9,383 3,380 (7,145) (2,6 12,723 19,3 30.568 wnstream nt – UPII UPII – stment (10) Do nd corporat es and dju a RC profit (loss) bef tion siness u lida BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 b t ent (15) ream nso her Co Ot costs related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill) Upst 2018 2017 2016 ($ billion) Segm and fair value fair and ts operating cash flow (2017 $18.9 billion) $22.9bn fi , before tax e expense relating pensions to – pence nanc a fi , before tax t fi s) s) fors) the year t (los t fi t (loss) before interest and taxation t (los fi fi accounting effects accounting effects and other post-retirement bene post-retirement other and $9.4bn to attributable profit shareholders BP (2017 $3.4 billion) $12.7bn (RC) cost replacement underlying profit (2017 $6.2 billion) Profit (loss) attributable to BP shareholders. BP to attributable (loss) Profit Dr Brian Gilvary Group chief financial officer We saw significant growth in earnings, cash and returns. The and returns. in earnings, cash significant growth We saw balance cash flow growth underpins the continued strong more the BHP acquisition and deliver sheet as we absorb than $10 billion of divestments over the next two years. than $10 billion of Underlying RC pro Dividends paid per share – cents Taxation Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses pro RC Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items and fair value Inventory holding (gains) losses (gains) holding Inventory Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items a Non-controlling interests Pro Pro Financial and operating performance Finance costs and net Group performanceGroup


 
Results Adjusting for inventory holding impacts, non-operating items which Profit for the year ended 31 December 2018 was $9.4 billion, compared include the impact of the US tax rate change, fair value accounting with $3.4 billion in 2017. Including inventory holding losses, replacement effects and the deferred tax adjustments as a result of the reduction cost (RC) profit was $10.0 billion, compared with $2.8 billion in 2017. in the UK North Sea supplementary charge in 2016, the adjusted ETR After adjusting for a net charge for non-operating items of $2.8 billion on RC profit was 38% in 2018 (2017 38%, 2016 23%). The adjusted and net favourable fair value accounting effects of $68 million (both on ETR for 2017 was higher than 2016, predominantly due to changes a post-tax basis), underlying RC profit for the year ended 31 December in the geographical mix of profits, notably the impact of the renewal 2018 was $12.7 billion, an increase of $6.6 billion compared with 2017. of our interest in the Abu Dhabi onshore oil concession. In the current The increase was predominantly due to higher results in Upstream, environment the adjusted ETR in 2019 is expected to be around 40%. as well as Downstream and Rosneft segments, partly offset by Cash flow and net debt information higher taxes. The upstream result reflected higher oil prices, record plant reliability and the benefit of new major projects start-ups. The $ million 2018 2017 2016 downstream result reflected stronger refining margins and strong fuels Operating cash flow 22,873 18,931 10,691 marketing growth. The Rosneft segment result primarily reflected Net cash used in investing higher oil prices. activities (21,571) (14,077) (14,753) Profit for the year ended 31 December 2017 was $3.4 billion, compared Net cash provided by (used in) with $115 million in 2016. Excluding inventory holding gains, RC profit financing activities (4,079) (3,296) 1,977 was $2.8 billion, compared with a loss of $1.0 billion in 2016. After Cash and cash equivalents at end adjusting for a net charge for non-operating items of $3.3 billion and of year 22,468 25,586 23,484 net adverse fair value accounting effects of $96 million (both on a Capital expenditure post-tax basis), underlying RC profit for the year ended 31 December Organic capital expenditure (15,140) (16,501) (16,675) 2017 was $6.2 billion, an increase of $3.6 billion compared with 2016. Inorganic capital expenditure (9,948) (1,339) (777) The increase was predominantly due to higher results in both Upstream (25,088) (17,840) (17,452) and Downstream segments. The upstream result reflected higher oil and gas prices and increased production. The downstream result Gross debt 65,799 63,230 58,300 reflected strong refining performance, including an improved margin Net debt 44,144 37,819 35,513 environment and growth in fuels marketing. Gross debt ratio (%) 39.3% 38.6% 37.6% Net debt ratio (%) 30.3% 27.4% 26.8% Non-operating items The net charge for non-operating items was $2.8 billion post-tax in Operating cash flow 2018, mainly related to additional charges for the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended 31 environmental and other provisions, and further restructuring costs. December 2018 was $22.9 billion, $4.0 billion higher than the $18.9 The group restructuring programme originally announced in 2014 has billion reported in 2017. Operating cash flow in 2018 reflects $3.5 billion now been completed. of pre-tax cash outflows related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill (2017 The net charge for non-operating items was $3.3 billion post-tax in $5.3 billion). Compared with 2017, operating cash flows in 2018 2017. This includes a charge of $1.7 billion recognized in the fourth reflected improved business results, including a more favourable price quarter relating to business economic loss and other claims associated environment and higher production, partly offset by working capital with the Gulf of Mexico oil spill and a $0.9 billion deferred tax charge effects, and a $1.7 billion increase in income taxes paid. following the change in the US tax rate enacted in December 2017. Movements in working capital adversely impacted cash flow in the In addition, the net charge also reflected an impairment charge year by $4.8 billion. There was an adverse impact on working capital in relation to upstream assets. from the Gulf of Mexico oil spill of $3.1 billion. Other working capital More information on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, principally an increase in other current and non-current assets effects can be found on pages 276 and 320. See Financial statements – partially offset by a decrease in inventory, had an adverse effect of Note 2 for further information on the impact of the Gulf of Mexico $1.7 billion. BP actively manages its working capital balances to oil spill on BP’s financial results. optimize and reduce volatility in cash flow. Taxation There was an increase in net cash provided by operating activities of The charge for corporate income taxes was $7,145 million in 2018 $8.2 billion in 2017 compared with 2016, of which $1.7 billion related compared with $3,712 million in 2017. The increase mainly reflects the to lower pre-tax cash outflows related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. higher level of profit in 2018. In 2017 the charge for corporate income Compared with 2016, operating cash flows in 2017 were impacted taxes included a one-off deferred tax charge of $0.9 billion in respect by improved business results, including a more favourable price of the revaluation of deferred tax assets and liabilities following the environment and higher production, working capital effects, and reduction in the US federal corporate income tax rate. A further credit of a $2.5-billion increase in income taxes paid. $121 million following a clarification of the legislation has been included in 2018. The effective tax rate (ETR) on the profit or loss for the year was 43% in 2018, 52% in 2017 and 107% in 2016. The ETR for all three years was impacted by various one-off items. 20 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 21 2016 a 1,329 1,939 8,679 3,268 2,048 17,810 10,333 43,368 supported by 2017 7,744 7,075 2,164 1,431 2,260 3,595 8,949 18,441 10,672 45,060 SeeGlossary 2018 2,191 9,757 1,355 3,683 8,659 2,328 11,456 19,945 49,239 b c (mmboe) (mmb) Equity-accounted entities (net of royalties) Subsidiaries Equity-accounted entities Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. Includes BP’s share of Rosneft. See Rosneft on page 34 and Supplementary information on oil and natural gas on page for 210 further information. Includes BP’s share of Rosneft. See Rosneft on page 34 and Oil and gas disclosures for the group on page 285 for further information. divestment proceeds, we expect gearing move to towards the middle of our targeted range of 20-30% in 2020. Net debt and the net debt ratio are non-GAAP measures. See Financial statements – Note 27 for gross debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis, and for further information on net debt. Cash and cash equivalents at the end of were For $3.12018 billion information lower than on 2017. financing the activities,group’s see Financial statements – Note 29 and Liquidity and capital resources on page 277. Group reserves and production (including Rosneft segment) Natural gas (bcf) Total hydrocarbons Total by 8% compared with The December 31 change includes 2017. net a acquisitionsincrease from disposals and 1,498mmboe of (increase of 993mmboe within our subsidiaries, increase of 505mmboe within equity-accountedour Acquisition activity entities). subsidiaries our in occurred in the US and the UK, and divestment activity in our subsidiaries was inthe US and the UK. In our equity-accounted acquisitionsentities, occurred Russia. in hydrocarbonTotal production for the group was higher 2% compared The increasewith comprised 2017. decrease an 8% increase (1% for liquids increase and for 17% gas) for subsidiaries and a 5% decrease (5% decrease for liquids decrease and 5% for gas) for equity-accounted entities. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Liquids a b c hydrocarbonTotal proved reserves at December 31 2018, on an oil- equivalent basis including equity-accounted increased entities, Estimated net proved reserves Production (net of royalties) (mb/d)Liquids Of which: Debt Gross debt at the end increased of 2018 by $2.6 billion from the end of The gross debt ratio2017. at the end increased of 2018 Net by 0.7%. debt at the end increased of 2018 by $6.3 billion from year-end the 2017 position. The net debt ratio at the end increased of 2018 by 2.9%. At current oil prices, and in line with growing free cash flow Of which: Natural gas (mmcf/d) Total hydrocarbons (mboe/d) (mboe/d) hydrocarbons Total for 2018 were for $2.9 2018 billion $3.4 (2017 billion, . In addition, we received $0.8 billion in relation the to 2016 $2.62016 billion). In addition, we received a $0.6-billion loan repayment relating the to refinancingTrans Adriatic of Pipeline AG, andtotal divestment and other proceeds amounted for 2018 $3.5 to billion. In divestment2017 proceeds included amounts received for the disposal of our interest in the Shanghai SECCO Petrochemical Company Limited joint venture initial public offering of BP Midstream Partners LP’s common units, shown within financing activities in the group cash flow statement, and total divestment and other proceeds amounted for 2017 $4.3 to billion. BP intends complete to more than billion $10 of divestments over the next two years, which includes plans announced following theBHP transaction. activities financing in used cash Net Net cash used in financing activitiesfor theyear ended31 December was2018 $4.1 billion,compared with $3.3 billion used in financing activities This was mainly in 2017. the result of an increase of $0.9 billion in net proceeds from financing offset billion reductionby a of $1.1 in cash received in relation non-controlling to interests and an increase in dividend payments of $0.5 billion. the netIn cash 2017 used in financing activitiesreflected a reduction of $3.5 billion in net proceeds from financing. Thetotal dividend paid in cash was billion $1.5 in 2017 higher than in 2016. dividendsTotal distributed shareholders to were in 40.50 2018 cents per share, 0.50 cents This higher amounted than a total to distribution 2017. shareholdersto of $8.1 billion billion, billion), $7.9 (2017 $7.5 2016 of which shareholders elected receive to billion, billion $1.4 $1.7 (2017 $2.92016 billion) in shares under the scrip dividend programme. The total amount distributed in cash during the year amounted $6.7 to billion $6.2(2017 billion, $4.6 2016 billion). of which organic capital expenditure billion $16.5 (2017 was $15.1 billion). Sources of funding are fungible, but the majority of the group’s funding requirements for new investment comes from cash generated by existing operations. We expect organic capital expenditure be to in the range billion of $15-17 in 2019. Divestment proceeds of $6.7 billion in relation the to BHP acquisition and a reduction of $0.6 billion in net disposal proceeds. The decrease of $0.7 billion compared in 2017 with mainly 2016 reflected an increase of $0.8 billion in disposal proceeds. There were no significant cash flows in respect of acquisitions in2017 and 2016. capitalTotal expenditure billion), was for 2018 billion $25.1 $17.8 (2017 by $3.4billion. There was an adverse impact on working capital from the Gulf of Mexico oil spill$5.2 of billion. Other working capital effects, arising from variety a of different factors had a favourable effectof $1.8 billion. Receivables and inventories increased during the year principally due higher to oil prices. The effect of this on operating cash flow was more than offset by a corresponding increase in payables. Net cash used in investing activities Net cash used in investing activitiesfor the year ended December 31 increased2018 billion by $7.5 compared with 2017. The increase mainly reflected higher inorganic capitalexpenditure Movements in working capital adversely impacted cash flow in 2017


 
Upstream 2018 has been a good year for Upstream, where we increased confidence in 2021 delivery and underpinned our ability to continue growth well into the next decade. Bernard Looney Chief executive, Upstream 63,000km 2 95.7% 7 Upstream profitability ($ billion) 14.3 new exploration access BP-operated upstream successful completion 2018 14.6 plant reliability of turnarounds 5.2 2017 (2017 28,000km2) (2017 94.7%) (2017 6) 5.9 0.6 2016 -0.5 -0.9 2015 9 6 2.5 1.2 8.9 2014 final investment decisions major project start-ups million barrels of oil equivalent 15.2 per day – hydrocarbon production Replacement cost (RC) profit (loss) before interest and tax (2017 3) (2017 7) (2017 2.5mmboe/d) Underlying RC profit (loss) before interest and tax Business model The Upstream segment is responsible for our activities in oil and natural gas exploration, field development and production. We do this through five global technical and operating functions. Exploration Wells and projects Global operations organization The exploration function is responsible The global wells organization and The global operations organization is for renewing our resource base through the global projects organization are responsible for safe, reliable and compliant access, exploration and appraisal, while responsible for the safe, reliable and operations, including upstream production the reservoir development function is compliant execution of wells (drilling and assets and midstream transportation and responsible for the stewardship of our completions) and major projects. processing activities. resource portfolio over the life of each field. Strategy Our strategy has three parts and is enabled by: Quality execution Growing advantaged oil and gas Returns-led growth We want to be the best at what we do – We will manage our portfolio through We want to grow – but not at any cost. We everywhere we work. This starts with disciplined investment in many of the world’s always look to grow returns and value. We executing our activity safely. In every basin, great oil and gas basins. We plan to grow both believe this growth will come from many we will benchmark against the competition oil and gas production. Natural gas is a big lever sources – production growth, expanding and and aim to be the best – whether it be for reducing greenhouse gas emissions. This managing our margins, operational efficiency, operating facilities reliably and cost effectively, means taking a leadership role in tackling the unit cost reduction, and capital efficiency with with a focus on emissions, drilling wells, challenge of methane. Our gas portfolio will disciplined levels of capital reinvestment. managing our reservoirs, exploring, building be complemented by advantaged oil assets – projects, or deploying technology. Through oil we can produce at a lower cost or higher the quality of our execution, scale and margin, creating a portfolio that is flexible for infrastructure, we aim to be competitive in different price environments. every basin, and as a business, get more from a unit of capital than our peers. 22 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 23 574 2016 1.90 2.46 2.84 (542) 17.31 (1,116) 43.73 28.24 38.27 39.99 34.63 43.34 $ million $ 33,188 14,344 $ per barrel $ per barrel pence per therm per pence 2017 644 3.11 3.19 2.36 51.71 54.19 50.79 5,221 26.00 49.92 35.38 5,865 44.95 13,763 45,440 $ per thousand cubic feet cubic thousand per $ $ per barrel of oil equivalent SeeGlossary $ per million British thermal units 2018 222 2.43 3.92 3.09 29.42 60.38 67.81 64.98 43.47 71.31 65.20 12,027 14,550 14,328 56,399 f b e and and c gas price d e a d marker prices fair value accounting value effectsfair revenues Point gas price interest and tax and interest of non-operating items Includes sales to other segments. A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 275. Realizations are based on sales by consolidated subsidiaries only, which excludes equity-accounted entities. bitumen. and condensate Includes All traded days average. Henry Hub First of Month Index. US natural gas Liquids Natural gas liquids liquids gas Natural West Texas Intermediate Texas West Average natural gas gas natural Average Average Henry Hub Average UK NationalAverage Balancing a b c d e f Financial performance operatingSales other and oil Crude Natural gas hydrocarbons Total Brent Average oil marker prices Underlying RC profit (loss) before before (loss) profit RC Underlying BP averageBP realizations Net (favourable)adverse impact RC profit before interest and tax Organic capital expenditure BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 bal technical ve glove fi on average than our than average on e, procurement and supply ural gas (LNG), power and natural nanc fi ed nat fi gas liquids (NGL). In our 2018 activities took place in 33 countries. The US Lower 48 business continues operate to as a separate, asset-focused, onshore business, and changed its name BPX to Energy in October. With the exception of BPX Energy, we deliver our exploration, development and production activities through in the Upstream. We believe in the potential of this agenda transform to the efficiency of our business, and we are deliveringreal valuetoday theto bottom line. In addition our to core Upstream exploration, development and production activities, the segment is responsible for midstream trade and market also We processing. and transportation, storage natural gas, including lique functions. operating and We optimize and integrate the delivery of our activities across regions,12 with support provided by global functions in specialist areas of expertise: technology, chain, human resources, information technology and legal. In we identified 2016 a future growth target of 900,000 barrels of oil equivalent per day of production from new major projects by 2021 and we remain on track deliver to that. We expect this production to operating higher cash margins 35% deliver at sustainably improving both performance and how it feels work to Underpinning our business model and strategy is our transformation modelUnderpinning our business strategy is our and agenda. We have around 1,000 projects across the Upstreamaimed 2015 upstream2015 assets, which supports our value over volume strategy. We see our scale and long history in many of the great basins in the world as a differentiator for BP and believe in the strength of our incumbent positions. We believe we are balanced and flexible – in terms of geography, hydrocarbon type and geology – and rather than being restricted by a traditional way of working, we have and will continue use to creative business models generate to value.


 
Growing advantaged oil and gas in the upstream 470,000 acres of access Transforming United States US onshore 194,000 Oklahoma ~720 ~85,000 BP is transforming its US New Mexico onshore oil and gas business Texas with our purchase of world-class Haynesville Permian Houston unconventional assets from BHP. Louisiana This acquisition gives us access Eagle Ford to some of the best basins in the 83,000 194,000 onshore US and positions BP as a top producer in the region. ~3,400 ~1,400 The transaction includes 470,000 acres ~29,000 ~83,000 of licences across a new position in the liquids-rich Permian-Delaware basin, and two premium positions in the Eagle Ford and Size Number of Current production Haynesville basins. Together these assets will (acres) drilling sites (boe/d) significantly increase the liquid hydrocarbon Permian • Delaware sub-basin of the Permian in proportion of our production and resources – West Texas. helping to upgrade and reposition BPX Energy, • 83,000 acres with around 3,400 drilling sites. which was previously known as the US Lower • Current production – around 29,000boe/d 48 business. (~70% liquids). BPX Energy has operated as a separate Eagle Ford • Karnes Trough and Eagle Ford in South Texas. business since 2015. Its innovative approach • 194,000 acres with 1,400 gross to using new technology such as big-data drilling locations. analytics, augmented reality, drones and • Current production – around 83,000boe/d advanced drilling techniques, have helped (~70% liquids). the business achieve significant improvements Haynesville • East Texas and Louisiana. in operational and financial performance. • 194,000 acres with 720 gross drilling locations. We plan to apply this approach to operations • Current production – around 85,000boe/d, at our newly acquired basins. all gas. As at 31 December 2018. 24 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 25 SeeGlossary to be to higher than due 2018 to . ct underlying production ct oil prices will continue be to volatile in the near term. reamcapital investment is expected increase, to largely as resulta OPEC quotas and entitlement impacts in our production-sharing major projects. The actual reported outcome will depend on the exact timing of project start-ups, acquisitions and divestments, agreements Five new major projects expected start to up in 2019. We expe Upst of our increased presence in the onshore US. We expe lower exploration write-offs. exploration lower Compared with result the 2016 reflected 2017 higher liquidsrealizations, and higher production including the impact of the Abu Dhabi onshore concession renewal and major projects start-ups, partly offset by higher exploration higher and amortization, and depletion depreciation, write-offs. Organic capital expenditure billion. was $12.0 In total, disposal transactions generated billion $2.1 in proceeds in 2018, with a corresponding reduction in net proved reserves of 229mmboe subsidiaries. our Thewithin major disposal transactions 2018 during were the disposal of our interests in the Bruce, Keith and Rhum fields in the UK North Sea and our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area in the US, the consideration for which was a 16.5% interest in the Clair field in North Sea. More information on disposals is provided in Upstream analysis by region on page 279 and Financial statements – Note 4. tax was significantly higher in compared2018 This primarily with 2017. reflected higher liquids and gasrealizations, higher production and Fair value accounting effects had an adverse impact of $39 million relative management’s to view of performance. The result included 2017 a net non-operating charge of $671 million, primarilyrelated impairment to charges associated with a number of assets, following changes in reserves estimates, and the decision to dispose of certain assets. Fair value accounting effects had a favourable impact of $27 million relative management’s to view of performance. The result 2016 included a net non-operating gain of $1,753 million, primarilyrelated the to reversal of impairment charges associated with a number of assets, following a reduction in the discount rate applied and changes future to price assumptions. Fair value accounting effects had an adverse impact of $637 million. non-operatingAfter for adjusting accounting value fair and items and interest before result cost underlyingeffects, replacement the following changes in reserves estimates, the decision dispose to of certain assets and the decision relinquish to a number of leases expiring in the near future, partially offset by reversals of prior year impairment charges. See Financial statements – Note 5 for further information. Outlook for 2019 • • Exploration The group explores for oil and natural gas under a wide range contractual agreements. other arrangement and licensing, joint of We may do this alone more frequently, or, with partners. Our exploration and new access teams work optimize to our resource base and provide us with a greater number of options. In the current environment, we are spending less on exploration and we will spend a material part of our exploration budget on lower-risk, shorter-cycle-time opportunities positions. incumbent our around • • BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 �e� �e� F��e-�ear ran�e F��e-�ear ran�e prices. Asian spotprices rose $9.76/ to 2 201� 201� 201� 201� �mm�tu� �� ���l� �� 2018 2018 �an Fe� �ar Apr �a� �un �ul Au� �ep ��t �o� �an Fe� �ar Apr �a� �un �ul Au� �ep ��t �o� � � � 120 �0 �0 �0 1�0 Henry Hub prices decreased $3.09/mmBtu to from in 2018 $3.11/ The UK NationalmmBtu in 2017. Balancing Point hub price was 60.38 pence per therm in 2018, 34% higher than (44.95), in 2017 on the back of increasing coal, oil and CO of more than $110 seen in 2011-13. Prices drifted seen in 2011-13. of more than higher $110 over the first half then of the year, rose more rapidly reach to an annual peak near $85 in October, before falling sharply and ending the year at an annual low point of about $50. Oil demand recorded a fourth consecutive above-average increase, growing by 1.3mmb/d. Global production increased by an even more robust 2.6mmb/d, with all of the increase coming from non-OPEC countries (2.7mmb/d); the US recorded record production growth of 2.2mmb/d. OPEC production fell slightly (-0.1mmb/d) for a second consecutive year as the group engaged with co-operating non-OPEC countries in production restraint early in the althoughyear, OPEC production began recover to in the second half of the year as production restraint was eased. Dated Brent crude oil prices averaged $71.31 per barrel – a in 2018 second consecutive annual increase but still well below the average which a significant proportion of production is priced directly or indirectly. Market prices Market Brent remains an integral marker the to production portfolio, from higher production and higher gas marketing and trading revenues. Replacement cost profit before interest and taxfor the segment included a net non-operating charge of $183 million. This primarily relates impairment to charges associated with a number of assets, mmBtu supported in 2018, up from $7.13/mmBtu by higher coal, and oil prices as well as a relatively tight LNG market – except in the later part of 2018, where ample LNG supplies combined with warm weather caused Asian spot prices drop to below to $9/mmBtu. For more information on global energy markets see in 2018 page 18. Financial results Sales and other operating revenues increased for 2018 compared with primarily reflectingrealizations,higherliquids higher production 2017, and higher gas marketing and trading revenues. The increase in 2017 compared with primarily 2016 reflected higher liquidsrealizations, ����� ��� B����


 
New access in 2018 Estimated net proved reservesa (net of royalties) 2 We gained access to new acreage covering around 63,000km in 2018 2017 2016 10 countries – Australia, Azerbaijan, Brazil, Canada, Egypt, Madagascar, Liquids million barrels Mexico, São Tomé and Príncipe, the UK North Sea and the US Gulf Crude oilb of Mexico. Subsidiaries 4,378 4,129 3,778 Exploration success Equity-accounted entitiesc 794 674 771 We participated in three potentially commercial discoveries in 2018 – 5,172 4,803 4,549 Manuel and Nearly Headless Nick in the US Gulf of Mexico and Bongos Natural gas liquids in Trinidad. Subsidiaries 576 318 373 Exploration and appraisal costs Equity-accounted entitiesc 15 18 16 Excluding lease acquisitions, the costs for exploration and appraisal 590 336 389 were $1,298 million (2017 $1,655 million, 2016 $1,402 million). Total liquids These costs included exploration and appraisal activities, which were d capitalized within intangible fixed assets, and geological and geophysical Subsidiaries 4,954 4,447 4,151 c exploration costs, which were charged to income as incurred. Equity-accounted entities 808 692 787 5,762 5,139 4,938 Approximately 5% of exploration and appraisal costs were directed Natural gas billion cubic feet towards appraisal activity. We participated in 29 gross (19 net) e exploration and appraisal wells in eight countries. Subsidiaries 30,355 29,263 28,888 Equity-accounted entitiesc 4,559 2,274 2,580 Exploration expense 34,914 31,537 31,468 Total exploration expense of $1,445 million (2017 $2,080 million, Total hydrocarbons million barrels of oil equivalent 2016 $1,721 million) included the write-off of expenses related to Subsidiaries 10,188 9,492 9,131 unsuccessful drilling activities, lease expiration or uncertainties around c development in the Gulf of Mexico ($450 million), Egypt ($236 million), Equity-accounted entities 1,594 1,085 1,232 and others ($759 million), as well as geological and geophysical 11,782 10,577 10,363 exploration costs (see Financial statements – Note 8). a Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component Reserves booking parts. b Reserves bookings from new discoveries will depend on the results Includes condensate and bitumen. c BP’s share of reserves of equity-accounted entities in the Upstream segment. During 2018 of ongoing technical and commercial evaluations, including appraisal upstream operations in Argentina, Bolivia, Mexico, Russia and Norway as well as some of drilling. The segment’s total hydrocarbon reserves on an oil-equivalent our operations in Angola were conducted through equity-accounted entities. d basis, including the segment’s equity-accounted entities at 31 Includes 12 million barrels (14 million barrels at 31 December 2017 and 16 million barrels at 31 December 2016) in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad & December 2018, increased by 11% (an increase of 7% for subsidiaries Tobago LLC. and an increase of 47% for equity-accounted entities) compared with e Includes 1,573 billion cubic feet of natural gas (1,860 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2017 proved reserves at 31 December 2017. and 2,026 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2016) in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad & Tobago LLC. Proved reserves replacement ratio The proved reserves replacement ratio for the segment in 2018 was Developments 69% for subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (2017 127%), 66% We achieved six major project start-ups in 2018 – in Azerbaijan, for subsidiaries alone (2017 133%) and 106% for equity-accounted Australia, the Gulf of Mexico, Egypt, Russia and the UK North Sea. entities alone (2017 78%). For more information on proved reserves In addition to these, we made good progress on projects in Trinidad, replacement for the group see page 285. Egypt and the UK North Sea. • Trinidad – Work on the Angelin project progressed well after we �������� ������ ���������mm�oe� started the drilling programme in late 2018, and we announced first gas production in February 2019. ������� • Egypt – Raven, the third phase of the West Nile Delta development 1� �u���d�ar�e� ����� � project is on target to achieve first gas in second half of 2019 with well 2� ��u�t�-a��ounted ent�t�e� 808 commissioning activities underway. ����� ����� 1 • UK North Sea – At Culzean, perforation of wells on the Total-operated project is about to get underway after completion of trees installation. ��� Production is expected in the first half of 2019. �� �u���d�ar�e� ��2�� � �� ��u�t�-a��ounted ent�t�e� �8� Subsidiaries’ development expenditure incurred, excluding midstream ����� ����� 2 activities, was $9.9 billion (2017 $10.7 billion, 2016 $11.1 billion). 26 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 27 82 86 2016 179 184 494 943 1,122 1,025 1,939 5,796 8 4 85 93 64 2017 2017 199 207 547 302 269 889 5,302 064 1,149 2,1 1,263 1,356 1,208 1, 2,466 2,208 6,436 5, thousand barrels per day per thousand barrels million cubic feet per day SeeGlossary 8 96 88 211 474 121 129 2018 1,172 1,139 7,374 1,051 1,268 2,328 6,900 2,539 thousand barrels of oil equivalent per day a c c c c c b y-accounted entities y-accounted entities y-accounted entities y-accounted entities y-accounted entities idiaries idiaries idiaries idiaries Subs Subsidiaries Subsidiaries Equit Subsidiaries Equit Subsidiaries Equit Subs Equit Equit Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. bitumen. and condensate Includes Includes BP’s share of production of equity-accounted entities in the Upstream segment. Total liquids Total Natural gas Production (net of royalties) of commodity derivative contracts. It also enhances margins and generates fee income from sourcessuch as the management of risk and creating incremental trading opportunities through the use price risk on behalf of third-party customers. Our trading financial risk governance framework is described in Financial statements – Note 29 and the range of contracts used is described in Glossary – commodity trading contracts on page 315. on production see Oil and gas disclosures for the group on page 285. In aggregate, underlying production increased versus 2017. The group and its equity-accounted entities have numerous long-term sales commitments in their various business activities, all of which are expected be to sourced from supplies available the to group that arenot subject priorities, to curtailments or other restrictions. No single contract or group of related contracts is material the to group. and compliance trading of set consistent one and markets trading gas risk management processes, systems and controls. We are expanding our LNG portfolio, which includes global partnerships with utility companies. gas and oil national and distributors gas companies, The activity primarily takes place in North America, Europe and price market managing LNG supports activities, Asia, and group a b c Our total hydrocarbon production for the segment was in 2018 3.0% higher compared The increase with comprised 2017. increase a 7.6% (0.9% decrease increase for liquids for gas) and for subsidiaries 17.2% and a 30.0% decrease for liquids (37.6% for gas) and 13.4% for equity-accounted entities compared For more information with 2017. Gas and power marketing and trading activities Our integrated supply and trading function markets and trades our own and third-party natural gas (including LNG), biogas, power and NGLs. This provides us with routes liquid into markets for the gas we produce and generates margins and fees from selling physical products parties, asset third with income from together derivatives to and optimization and trading. This means we have a single interface with Liquids oil Crude Natural gas liquids hydrocarbons Total BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Oil Gas Type . Location Trinidad Egypt US Gulf of Mexico Trinidad UK North Sea India India Oman Indonesia Egypt UK North Sea US Gulf of Mexico US Gulf of Mexico US Gulf of Mexico UK North Sea Angola Azerbaijan Australia Egypt UK North Sea Russia US Gulf of Mexico a a esource types: oil, conventional across split e of development types: brownfield to exploration from a raphic spread: across six of the seven continents. a mix of r unconventionals and gas conventional oil, deepwater and near-field.and geog a rang Production commenced in early 2019. a 2021 Beyond We have a deep hopper of projects that are currently under appraisal. Our focus here is ensure to we maximize value and select the optimum project concept before we move it forward design.into We do not expect progress to all of the projects – only the best. This includes: • Alligin* Phase 3 Atlantis Constellation Mad Dog Phase 2* Manuel* Vorlich* Zinia 2 KG D6KG R-Series D6KG Satellites Khazzan Phase 2* Expansion* Tangguh West Nile Delta Giza and Fayoum* West Nile Delta Raven* Expected start-ups 2019-2021 Expected start-ups Projects under construction currently Angelin* Compression* Cassia Culzean 2018 start-ups 2018 Shah Deniz Stage 2* Western Flank B Atoll Phase 1* Ridge* Clair ExpansionTaas Thunder Horse North West Expansion* *BP operated Project • • Our project pipeline Production Our offshore and onshore oil and natural gas production assets include wells, gathering centres, in-field flow lines,processing facilities,storage facilities, offshore platforms, export systems (e.g. transit lines), pipelines and LNG plant facilities. These includeproduction from conventional and unconventional assets. Our principal areas of production are Angola, Argentina, Australia, Azerbaijan, Egypt, Oman, Trinidad, the UAE, the UK and the US. With BP-operated plant reliability increasing from around 96% to 86% in 2018, in 2011 efficient delivery of turnarounds and strong infill drilling performance, we have maintained base decline at less than on 3% average over thelast fiveyears. Our long-term expectation for managed base decline remains at the 3-5% per annum guidance we have previously given.


 
Downstream In 2018 we have continued to demonstrate, through the execution of our strategy, that we have a competitively advantaged business. Our strategy is fit for now and fit for the future. Tufan Erginbilgic Chief executive, Downstream 10% 1,400 46% Downstream profitability ($ billion) fuels marketing earnings convenience of lubricant sales 6.9 2018 7.6 growth (17% on an partnership sites were premium grade 7.2 underlying RC profit basis) 2017 7.0 5.2 (2017 >10%) (2017 1,100) (2017 44%) 2016 5.6 7.1 2015 7.5 3.7 94.9% 1.7 11.9 2014 4.4 refining availability million barrels of oil million tonnes of refined per day petrochemicals produced Replacement cost (RC) profit before interest and tax Underlying RC profit before interest and tax (2017 95.3%) (2017 1.7mmb/d) (2017 15.3mmte) Business model The Downstream segment has global marketing and manufacturing operations. It is the product and service-led arm of BP, made up of three businesses Fuels Lubricants Petrochemicals Includes refineries, logistic networks and Manufactures and markets lubricants and Manufactures and markets products that are fuels marketing businesses, which together related products and services to the produced using industry-leading proprietary with global oil supply and trading activities, automotive, industrial, marine and energy BP technology, and are then used by others make up our integrated fuels value chains markets globally. We add value through to make essential consumer products such (FVCs). We sell refined petroleum products brand, technology and relationships, such as food packaging, textiles and building including gasoline, diesel and aviation fuel, as collaboration with original equipment materials. We also license our technologies and have a significant presence in the manufacturing partners. to third parties. convenience retail sector and a growing presence in the advanced mobility and low carbon sectors. Strategy We aim to run safe and reliable operations across all our businesses, supported by leading brands and technologies, to deliver high-quality products and services that meet our customers’ needs. Our strategy is to deliver underlying earnings growth and build competitively advantaged businesses. It is fit for now and fit for the future. The execution of our strategy in 2018 has continued to deliver, with underlying replacement cost profit growing to $7.6 billion in the year. Safe and reliable operations Advantaged manufacturing Simplification and efficiency This remains our core value and first priority We aim to have a competitively advantaged This remains central to what we do to support and we continue to drive improvements in refining and petrochemicals portfolio performance improvement and make our personal and process safety performance. underpinned by operational excellence and businesses even more competitive. to grow earnings potential, making the businesses more resilient to margin volatility. Profitable marketing growth Transition to a lower carbon We invest in higher-returning fuels marketing and digitally enabled future and lubricants businesses with growth We are delivering and developing new potential and reliable cash flows. products, offers and business models that support the transition to a lower carbon and digitally enabled future. 28 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Market-led growth in the downstream Strategic report – performance Convenience partnerships Throughout 2018 BP continued We increased the number of convenience to transform its global retail partnership sites by over 25% in 2018 – taking the total to around 1,400 sites across our business. We’ve refreshed our network. Much of this growth was in Germany, We have rolled out our forecourts, rolled out more BP where our strategic partnership with REWE fuels with ACTIVE technology and to Go® is expanding rapidly. Since opening Ultimate fuel to forecourts further enhanced our customer our first site in 2014, we now have over 460 in China. offers. And that’s not all, we’re in the country, and around half of those opened in 2018. Our REWE to Go® sites also rapidly expanding our deliver substantially higher returns than convenience partnerships. an industry average site, driven by our Global markets differentiated customer offer including fresh, Our footprint in Mexico is growing and we quality food and drink. now have 440 BP-operated sites, more than We also continue to grow our convenience 300 of which were opened in 2018. We are partnership model in established markets also continuing to progress our plans for >25% such as the UK with M&S Simply Food® and growth in China, and in Indonesia we opened increase in convenience in October we opened our first partnership our first sites at the end of the year. partnership sites site in Luxembourg with MyAuchan®. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 29


 
Financial performance Our fuels business $ million Our fuels strategy focuses primarily on fuels value chains (FVCs). This 2018 2017 2016 includes building an advantaged refining portfolio through operating Sale of crude oil through spot reliability and efficiency, location advantage and feedstock flexibility, as and term contracts 62,484 47,702 31,569 well as commercial optimization opportunities. We believe that having Marketing, spot and term sales a quality refining portfolio connected to strong marketing positions is of refined products 195,020 159,475 126,419 core to our integrated FVC businesses as this provides optimization Other sales and operating opportunities in highly competitive markets. revenues 13,185 12,676 9,695 Our fuels marketing business comprises retail, business-to-business Sales and other operating and aviation fuels. It is a material part of Downstream with a strong revenuesa 270,689 219,853 167,683 track record of growth. We have an advantaged portfolio of assets with b RC profit before interest and tax good growth potential, attractive returns and reliable cash flows. We Fuels 5,261 4,679 3,337 continue to grow our fuels marketing business through our differentiated Lubricants 1,065 1,457 1,439 marketing offers and strategic convenience partnerships. We also Petrochemicals 614 1,085 386 partner with leading retailers, creating distinctive retail offers that aim 6,940 7,221 5,162 to deliver good returns and reliable profit growth and cash generation. Net (favourable) adverse impact Underlying RC profit before interest and tax for our fuels business of non-operating items and was higher compared with 2017, reflecting continued growth in fuels fair value accounting effects marketing and refining despite 2018 having one of the highest levels Fuels 381 193 390 of turnaround activity in our history. This was partially offset by a weaker Lubricants 227 22 84 contribution from supply and trading. Compared with 2016, the 2017 Petrochemicals 13 (469) (2) result was higher, reflecting stronger refining performance and growth 621 (254) 472 in fuels marketing, partially offset by a weaker contribution from supply Underlying RC profit before and trading. interest and taxb Refining marker margin Fuels 5,642 4,872 3,727 We track the refining margin environment using a global refining marker Lubricants 1,292 1,479 1,523 margin (RMM). Refining margins are a measure of the difference Petrochemicals 627 616 384 between the price a refinery pays for its inputs (crude oil) and the market 7,561 6,967 5,634 price of its products. Although refineries produce a variety of petroleum Organic capital expenditure c 2,781 2,399 2,102 products, we track the margin environment using a simplified indicator that reflects the margins achieved on gasoline and diesel only. The a Includes sales to other segments. b Income from petrochemicals produced at our Gelsenkirchen and Mülheim sites in Germany RMM may not be representative of the margin achieved by BP in any is reported in the fuels business. Segment-level overhead expenses are included in the fuels period because of BP’s particular refinery configurations and crude and business result. product slates. In addition, the RMM does not include estimates of c A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 275. energy or other variable costs. Financial results Sales and other operating revenues in 2018 were higher due to higher $ per barrel Region Crude marker 2018 2017 2016 crude and product prices. Sales and other operating revenues in 2017 Alaska North were higher than 2016 due to higher crude and product prices as well US North West Slope 16.2 18.8 16.9 as higher sales volumes. West Texas Replacement cost (RC) profit before interest and tax for 2018 included US Midwest Intermediate 16.0 16.9 13.2 a net non-operating charge of $716 million, primarily reflecting Northwest Europe Brent 11.1 11.7 10.0 restructuring costs. The 2017 result included a net non-operating gain Mediterranean Azeri Light 9.8 10.4 9.0 of $389 million, primarily reflecting the gain on disposal of our share in Australia Brent 11.5 12.9 10.9 the Shanghai SECCO Petrochemical Company Limited (SECCO) joint BP RMM 13.1 14.1 11.8 venture in petrochemicals, while the 2016 result included a net non-operating charge of $24 million, mainly relating to a gain on disposal in our fuels business which was more than offset by restructuring and The global RMM averaged $13.1/bbl in 2018, $1/bbl lower than in 2017. other charges. In addition fair value accounting effects had a favourable The RMM was lower mainly due to weaker gasoline margins as a result impact of $95 million, compared with an adverse impact of $135 million of lower demand growth and higher inventory levels in the US. in 2017 and $448 million in 2016. BP refining marker margin �����l� After adjusting for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, �2 underlying RC profit before interest and tax in 2018 was $7,561 million. Outlook for 2019 2� We anticipate lower industry refining margins, narrower North American heavy crude oil discounts and a lower level of turnaround activity than 1� in 2018. 8 2018 201� 201� F��e-�ear ran�e �an Fe� �ar Apr �a� �un �ul Au� �ep ��t �o� �e� 30 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 31 SeeGlossary in operational and transactional processes and deliver compelling compelling deliver and processes transactional and operational in customer offers in the various markets where we operate. Through our retail business, we supply fuel and convenience retail services partnerships, convenience technology retail our of strength the by such as our advanced fuels and use of digital technology, as well as our enables growth This our differentiation in relationships. customer existing markets and supports our growth plans in new material markets such as Mexico, India, Indonesia and China. During we continued 2018 our expansion in Mexico with 440 BP-branded sites operational at the end In the of the fourth year. quarter we also of 2018 opened our first retail sites in Indonesia. Fuels marketing and logistics Across our fuels marketing businesses, we operate an advantaged storage pipelines, includes that network logistics and infrastructure terminals and tankers for road and rail. seek We drive to excellence consumersto through company-owned and franchised retail sites, as well as other channels, including dealers and jobbers. We also transport the supply in commercial customers industrial sectors. and Retail is the most material part of our fuels marketing business and a significant source of earnings growth through our strong market underpinned is This offers. customer distinctive and brands positions, BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 % 2016 236 803 646 a 5.3 95.3 713 216 2017 773 9 1,702 1,685 thousand barrels per day per thousand barrels 241 781 2018 703 94.9 1,725 rates at 91% (2017 90%). (2017 As a result rates at 91% ab , a measure of the competitiveness of our refinery portfolio, ning availability nery throughputs fi fi This does not include BP’s interest in Pan American Energy Group, which is reported through segment. Upstream the volumes. feedstock other and oil reflect crude Refinerythroughputs Total Re a b Re US Europe Rest of world Refining DecemberAt31 we owned 2018 refineries or had a share in 11 and extended lower carbon bio-processing more into of our refineries. The refiningresult was higher reflecting in compared2018 with 2017, in which operations, strong and optimization commercial increased North America allowed us capture to the benefits from higher North American heavy crude oil discounts, partially offset by lower industry refining margins and a higher level of turnaround activity. Compared with 2016, refining performance capturingcontinuedto improve in 2017, efficiency industryhigher and margins refining well as benefits as increased commercial optimization including the benefits of higher levels of advantaged feedstock. This was, partially however, offset by a higher level of planned turnaround activity. producing refined petroleum products that we supplyretailto and commercial customers. For a summary of our interests in refineries and average daily crude distillation capacities see page 284. Underlying growth in our refining business is underpinned by our multi-year business improvement plans, which comprise globally efficiency, and reliability operating on focused programmes consistent Operating optimization. commercial and feedstocks advantaged reliability is a core foundation of our refining business and in 2018 operations remained strong, with refining availability of 94.9% (2017 refinery utilization 95.3%) and we achieved record levels of refining throughput on a current portfolio basis despite high turnaround activity. Our refinery portfolio – along with our supply capability – enables us processto advantaged crudes. For example, in the US, our three location-advantaged crudes to have Canadian all access refineries In we delivered 2018 continued improvement in our net cash margin per barrel which are typically cheaper than other crudes. Our commercial optimization programme aims maximize to value from our refineries by capturing opportunities in every step of the value chain, from crude selection through yield to optimization and utilization improvements.


 
We have a clear strategy and focused activity set for the transition to a Aviation lower carbon and digitally enabled future. We are actively implementing Our Air BP business is one of the world’s largest suppliers of aviation and developing new offers and business models centred around digital fuels and services, selling fuel to commercial airlines, the military and advanced mobility trends. In 2018 we acquired Chargemaster, the and general aviation customers at around 800 locations across more operator of the UK’s largest electric vehicle charging network and than 50 countries. We have marketing sales of more than 430,000 invested in StoreDot, a leading developer of ultra-fast charging battery barrels per day. Air BP’s services include the design, build and operation technology and FreeWire, a manufacturer of mobile rapid charging of fuelling facilities, technical consultancy and training, supporting systems for electric vehicles. Our ambition is to roll out more than 2,000 customers to meet their lower carbon goals and digital fuelling solutions additional charging points in the UK, bringing the total to around 9,000 to increase efficiency and reduce risk. Our Air BP business is by 2021, including more than 400 new ultra-fast chargers at our retail differentiated through its strong market positions, brand strength, forecourts – see page 42. These investments and our differentiated partnerships, technology and customer relationships. Our strategy is fuels and convenience offers support BP’s aim to become the leading to maintain a strong presence in our core geographies of Australia, fuel provider for both conventional and electric vehicles. New Zealand, Europe, the Middle East and the US, while expanding into major growth markets that offer long-term competitive advantages, Fuels marketing performance in 2018 was significantly higher compared such as Asia, Africa and Latin America. with 2017, reflecting the benefits from our strategic improvement programmes, enabling improved margin capture and supply chain In 2018 we continued to develop new offers and solutions in response optimization. Our convenience partnership model is now in around to the needs of our customers. This included a collaboration with Neste, 1,400 sites across our network, with more than 460 sites in Germany a leading producer of renewable products, to advance the supply with our REWE to Go® offer. Compared with 2016, fuels marketing of sustainable aviation fuels. We also launched the world’s first performance in 2017 was higher, reflecting continued earnings growth commercially deployed airfield automation system that actively supported by higher premium fuel volumes, and the continued roll out of helps prevent misfuelling. This digital platform for operators and airports our convenience partnership model. provides an integrated, real-time, global solution to strengthen safety barriers and mitigate risks during the fuelling process. thousand barrels per day Sales volumes 2018 2017 2016 Oil supply and trading Marketing salesa 2,736 2,799 2,825 Our integrated supply and trading function is responsible for delivering Trading/supply salesb 3,194 3,149 2,775 value across the overall crude and oil products supply chain. This Total refined product sales 5,930 5,948 5,600 structure enables our downstream businesses to maintain a single interface with oil trading markets and operate with one set of trading Crude oilc 2,624 2,616 2,169 compliance and risk management processes, systems and controls. Total 8,554 8,564 7,769 It has a two-fold purpose: a Marketing sales include branded and unbranded sales of refined fuel products and lubricants First, it seeks to identify the best markets and prices for our crude oil, to both business-to-business and business-to-consumer customers, including service station dealers, jobbers, airlines, small and large resellers such as hypermarkets as well source optimal raw materials for our refineries and provide competitive as the military. supply for our marketing businesses. We will often sell our own crude b Trading/supply sales are fuel sales to large unbranded resellers and other oil companies. and purchase alternative crudes from third parties for our refineries c Crude oil sales relate to transactions executed by our integrated supply and trading function, primarily for optimizing crude oil supplies to our refineries and in other trading. 2018 includes where this will provide incremental margin. 102 thousand barrels per day relating to revenues reported by the Upstream segment. Second, it aims to create and capture incremental trading opportunities Number of BP-branded retail sites by entering into a full range of exchange-traded commodity derivatives, Retail sitesd 2018 2017 2016 over-the-counter contracts and spot and term contracts. In combination US 7,200 7,200 7,100 with rights to access storage and transportation capacity, it seeks to Europe 8,200 8,100 8,100 access advantageous price differences between locations and time periods, and to arbitrage between markets. Rest of world 3,300 3,000 2,800 Total 18,700 18,300 18,000 The function has trading offices in Europe, North America and Asia. Our presence in the more actively traded regions of the global oil markets d Reported to the nearest 100. Includes sites not operated by BP but instead operated by dealers, jobbers, franchisees or brand licensees under a BP brand. These may move to supports overall understanding of the supply and demand forces across or from the BP brand as their fuel supply or brand licence agreements expire and are these markets. renegotiated in the normal course of business. Retail sites are primarily branded BP, ARCO and Aral. Our trading financial risk governance framework is described in Financial statements – Note 29 and the range of contracts used is described in Glossary – commodity trading contracts on page 315. 32 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 33 SeeGlossary in Asia, where our partners are leading a number of joint arrangements Our petrochemicals business main three markets and Our petrochemicals manufactures business product lines: purifiedterephthalic acid (PTA), paraxylene (PX) and acetic acid. These have a large range of uses including polyester fibre,food packaging and building materials. We also produce a number of other specialty petrochemicals products. In addition, we manufacture olefins Germany, in Mülheim at solvents and Gelsenkirchen derivatives at and the income fromwhich is reported in our fuels business. Along with the assets we own and operate, we have also invested in and PX licences announced globally. In we also 2018 signed a heads of agreement with SOCAR evaluate to the creation of a joint venture build to and operate a world-scale petrochemicals This complex facility in Turkey. would be the largest We do this through the executionof our business improvement our deploying efficiency, operational include which programmes and optimization commercial industry-leading technology, proprietary competitive feedstocksourcing. We also aim grow to our third-party technology licensing income create to additional value. We continue work to on reducing our carbon footprint through the application of our proprietary technologies, and are assessing further opportunities advance to the circular economy in the chemicals and plastics sector. In the 2018 petrochemicals business delivered an underlying RC profit before interest and tax that was higher compared with– 2017 which in turn was higher than 2016. The result 2018 reflected an improved margin environment, increased margin optimization and continued cost management focus, partially offset by a higher level of turnaround activity and the divestment of our 50% shareholding in the SECCO joint venture, which completed in the fourth quarter of 2017. Compared with 2016, the higher result reflected in 2017 an improved margin environment, higher margin optimization, the benefits from our efficiency programmes and a lower level of turnaround activity. This was partially offset by the impact of the divestment of our interest lower and than 15.3mmte, (2017 2016 2017 14.2mmte) 2016 due to interest activity our turnaround of of divestment the levels and higher in the SECCO joint venture in 2017. Our technology remains a significant source of competitive advantage. In we secured 2018 six new licensing agreements out PTA of the 10 and most competitive integrated PTA, PX and aromatics complex hemisphere. western the in companies in their domestic market. market. domestic their companies in Our strategy is grow to our underlying earnings and ensure the business is resilient margin to volatility, positioning ourselves capture to growth opportunities attractive market. an investment and in growing and in the SECCO joint venture. Our petrochemicals production million tonnes was in 2018 of 11.9 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 is a Castrol . and Aral BP , into China, into an engine oil that uses plant-derived 25% Our lubricants business We manufacture and market lubricants and related products and energy markets industrial, and marine services automotive, the to across the world. Our brands key are Castrol our expertise create to differentiated, premium lubricants and high- performance fluidsfor customers in on-road, off-road, sea and industrial applications. In we extended 2018 the roll out of Castrol EDGE BIO-SYNTHETIC oil compounds while delivering a high level of performance. The lubricants business delivered an underlying RC profit before interest and tax The that results was 2018 lower reflected than 2017. continued premium brand growth, more than offset by the adverse lag impact of increasing base oil prices, as well as adverse foreign exchange rate movements. The results 2017 reflected growth in premium brands recognized brand worldwide that we believe provides us with significant competitive advantage. We are one of the largest purchasers of base oil in the market but have chosen not produce to it or manufacture additives at scale. Our participation choices in the value chain are focused on strength. and competitive differentiation can leverage we where areas Our strategy is focus to on our premium lubricants and growth markets customer and technology brands, strong our leveraging while relationships – all of which are sources of differentiation for our business. With 65% of profit generated from growth markets and 46%of our sales from premium grade lubricants, we have a strong base for further expansion and sustained profit growth. significantly Renaultwith relationship we strengthened our 2018 In through the continuation of our Renault Formula 1 sponsorship with Renault SportRacing, and are exploring new opportunities work to globally with the Renault-Nissan-Mitsubishi Alliance.This includes collaborating innumber a of areas including fuel andlubricants supply and the joint development of advanced mobility solutions and new technologies. We have a robust pipeline of technology development through which we seek respond to engine to developments and evolving consumer apply We carbon options. lower including preferences, and needs and growth markets, offset by the adverse lag impact of increasing base oil prices.


 
Rosneft Rosneft is the largest oil company in Russia, with a strong portfolio of current and future opportunities. Russia has one of the largest and lowest-cost hydrocarbon resource bases in the world and its resources play an important role in long-term energy supply to the global economy. BP ����� �� ������� �������� 19.75% 8,163 1.1 �� m�ll�on�� BP’s shareholding in Rosneft million barrels of oil equivalent million barrels of oil equivalent – BP share of Rosneft proved per day – BP share of Rosneft ���� ��� ��� reserves hydrocarbon production 201� 12� 1�0 (2017 7,864mmboe) (2017 1.1mmboe/d) 201� ��2 18 2.33 >2,960 201� 2�1 201� ��� refineries – owned million barrels of oil retail service stations, or hold a stake in refined per day in Russia and abroad �nter�m Annual �or pre��ou� �ear� le�� �nter�m (2017 18) (2017 2.29mmb/d) (2017 >2,960) ��et o� ��t��old�n� ta�e�� Rosneft is the largest oil company in Russia and the largest publicly traded oil company in the world, based on hydrocarbon production New fuels volume. Rosneft has a major resource base of hydrocarbons onshore and offshore, with assets in all Russia’s key hydrocarbon regions. Rosneft is the leading Russian refining company based on throughput. It owns and operates 13 refineries in Russia, and also holds stakes in three refineries in Germany, one in India and one in Belarus. Downstream operations include jet fuel, bunkering, bitumen and lubricants. Rosneft also owns and operates Rosneft-branded retail service stations, as well as BP-branded sites operating under a licensing agreement. Rosneft’s largest shareholder is Rosneftegaz JSC (Rosneftegaz), which is wholly owned by the Russian government. Rosneftegaz’s shareholding in Rosneft is 50% plus one share. 2018 summary • BP received $620 million, net of withholding taxes, (2017 $314 million, 2016 $332 million), representing its share of Rosneft’s dividends. • Rosneft implemented a new dividend policy in 2017, which provides for a target level of dividends of no less than 50% of IFRS net profit, and a target frequency of dividend payments of at least twice a year. • Rosneft and BP launched a new range of fuels featuring ACTIVE technology at all BP retail service stations in Russia. • BP remains committed to our strategic investment in Rosneft, while complying with all relevant sanctions. 34 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 35 t-ups 2018 in SeeGlossary 6 major project star Taas – one of BP’sTaas llaborates on the provision of technical, HSE and See Innovation in BP on page 41. See Innovation in BP on page   Collaboration   BP co non-technical services on a contractual basis improve to functional asset performance.functional asset BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 started up ember Rosneft 2017 and BP announced an ds a 20% interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha eft (51%) and BP (49%)eft jointly (51%) own Neftegaz Yermak rtners with Rosneft generate to incremental value from Rosn in 2018. The project was delivered under budget and on schedule. In BP 2018 received the first dividends from of $48Taas million, net of withholding taxes. BP’s interest is reportedin Taas through the Upstream segment. BP hol In Dec is reported through the Upstream segment. LLC (Yermak). This joint venture conducts onshore exploration in the West Siberian andYenisei-Khatanga basins and currently holds seven exploration and production licences. The venture has also carried out further appraisal work on the Baikalovskoye field,existing an Rosneft discovery in the Yenisei-Khatanga area of mutual interest. In September Rosneft and BP also agreed jointly to explore two additional oil and gas licence areas located in Sakha (Yakutia) republic of the Russian Federation via Yermak. Completion of the deal, subject external to approvals, is expected in 2019. BP’s interest in Yermak This was the second of six BP major projects (Taas), together with and a consortium Rosneft (50.1%) Corporation Limited Oil Indian Limited, India Oil comprising and Bharat PetroResources Limited (29.9%). Taas completed commissioning of the main project facilities for the Srednebotuobinskoye oil and gas condensate field. agreement to develop resources within the Kharampurskoe the within resources develop to agreement Yamalo-Nenets in licence areas Festivalnoye and in northern Russia. In the second quarter BP of 2018 acquired a 49% stake in LLC Kharampurneftegaz and in December the2018 licence transfer was completed. BP’s interest is reported through the Upstream segment. Joint ventures s a 19.75% shareholdings a 19.75% and two directors on the 11-person • BP pa   joint ventures and associates that are separate from BP’s core shareholding. 19.75% • • Rosneft Board of Directors   BP ha board. Bob Dudley and Guillermo Quintero are currently elected to roles. those BP’s strategy Russia in Our strategy is work to in co-operation with Rosneft increase to total shareholder return. This comprises support for our shareholding and partnering with Rosneft in building a material business in addition to the shareholding. This strategy is implemented through our activities in the following areas.


 
Rosneft segment performance Balance sheet $ million BP’s investment in Rosneft is managed and reported as a separate 2018 2017 2016 segment under IFRS. The segment result includes equity-accounted Investments in associates c earnings, representing BP’s 19.75% share of the profit or loss of (as at 31 December) 10,074 10,059 8,243 Rosneft, as adjusted for the accounting required under IFRS relating to BP’s purchase of its interest in Rosneft and the amortization of the Production and reserves deferred gain relating to the disposal of BP’s interest in TNK-BP. 2018 2017 2016 See Financial statements – Note 17 for further information. Production (net of royalties) (BP share) $ million Liquids (mb/d) 2018 2017 2016 Crude oild 919 900 836 Profit before interest and taxa b 2,288 923 643 Natural gas liquids 4 4 4 Inventory holding (gains) losses (67) (87) (53) Total liquids 923 904 840 RC profit before interest and tax 2,221 836 590 Natural gas (mmcf/d) 1,285 1,308 1,279 Net charge (credit) for non-operating items 95 – (23) Total hydrocarbons (mboe/d) 1,144 1,129 1,060 Underlying RC profit before interest and tax 2,316 836 567 Estimated net proved reservese Average oil marker prices $ per barrel (net of royalties) (BP share) Urals (Northwest Europe – CIF) 69.89 52.84 41.68 Liquids (million barrels) a BP’s share of Rosneft’s earnings after finance costs, taxation and non-controlling interests Crude oild 5,539 5,402 5,330 is included in the BP group income statement within profit before interest and taxation. Natural gas liquids 154 131 65 b Includes $(5) million (2017 $(2) million, 2016 $3 million) of foreign exchange (gain)/losses arising on the dividend received. Total liquidsf 5,693 5,533 5,395 Natural gas (billion cubic feet)g 14,325 13,522 11,900 Market price The price of Urals delivered in North West Europe (Rotterdam) averaged Total hydrocarbons (mmboe) 8,163 7,864 7,447 $69.89/bbl in 2018. The discount to dated Brent was $1.42/bbl, similar c See Financial statements – Note 17 for further information. to 2017 ($1.35/bbl). d Includes condensate. e Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts. f Includes 356 million barrels of liquids (338 million barrels at 31 December 2017 and 347 Financial results million barrels at 31 December 2016) in respect of the 6.32% non-controlling interest Replacement cost (RC) profit before interest and tax for the segment (6.31% at 31 December 2017 and 6.58% at 31 December 2016) in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 24 million barrels (6 million barrels at 31 December 2017 and 6 million included a non-operating charge of $95 million for 2018 and a non- barrels at 31 December 2016) held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft. operating gain of $23 million for 2016, whereas the 2017 results did g Includes 1,211 billion cubic feet of natural gas (306 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2017 not include any non-operating items. and 300 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2016) in respect of the 8.60% non-controlling interest (2.30% at 31 December 2017 and 2.53% at 31 December 2016) in Rosneft held After adjusting for non-operating items, the increase in the underlying assets in Russia including 480 billion cubic feet (2 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2017 and 1 billion cubic feet at 31 December 2016) held through BP’s interests in Russia other RC profit before interest and tax compared with 2017 primarily reflected than Rosneft. higher oil prices and favourable foreign exchange, partially offset by adverse duty lag effects. Compared with 2016, the 2017 result was affected by higher oil prices partially offset by adverse foreign exchange effects. The 2017 result also benefited from a $163-million gain representing the BP share of a voluntary out-of-court settlement between Sistema, Sistema-Invest and the Rosneft subsidiary, Bashneft. See also Financial statements – Notes 17 and 32 for other foreign exchange effects. 36 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Other businesses and corporate Strategic report – performance Comprises our alternative energy business, shipping, treasury and corporate activities, including centralized functions and the costs of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. $ million 2018 2017 2016 Sales and other operating revenuesa 1,678 1,469 1,667 RC profit (loss) before interest and tax Gulf of Mexico oil spill (714) (2,687) (6,640) Other (2,807) (1,758) (1,517) RC profit (loss) before interest and tax (3,521) (4,445) (8,157) Net adverse impact of non-operating items Gulf of Mexico oil spill 714 2,687 6,640 Other 1,249 160 279 Net charge (credit) for non-operating items 1,963 2,847 6,919 Underlying RC profit (loss) before interest and tax (1,558) (1,598) (1,238) Organic capital expenditure b 332 339 229 a Includes sales to other segments. b A reconciliation to GAAP information at the group level is provided on page 275. The replacement cost (RC) loss before interest and tax for the year Treasury ended 31 December 2018 was $3,521 million (2017 $4,445 million, Treasury manages the financing of the group centrally, with 2016 $8,157 million). The 2018 result included a net charge for non- responsibility for managing the group’s debt profile, share buyback operating items of $1,963 million, including Gulf of Mexico oil spill programmes and dividend payments, while ensuring liquidity is related costs of $714 million (non-operating items in 2017 $2,847 sufficient to meet group requirements. It also manages key financial million, 2016 $6,919 million). For further information, see Financial risks including interest rate, foreign exchange, pension funding and statements – Note 2. investment, and financial institution credit risk. From locations in the UK, US and Singapore, treasury provides the interface between BP and After adjusting for these non-operating items, the underlying RC the international financial markets and supports the financing of BP’s loss before interest and tax for the year ended 31 December 2018 projects around the world. Treasury holds foreign exchange and interest was $1,558 million, similar to prior year (2017 $1,598 million, 2016 rate products in the financial markets to hedge group exposures. In $1,238 million). addition, treasury generates incremental value through optimizing and Outlook managing cash flows and the short-term investment of operational cash Other businesses and corporate annual charges, excluding non- balances. For further information, see Financial statements – Note 29. operating items, are expected to be around $1.4 billion in 2019. Insurance Shipping The group generally restricts its purchase of insurance to situations BP’s shipping and chartering activities help to ensure the safe where this is required for legal or contractual reasons. Some risks are transportation of our hydrocarbon products using a combination insured with third parties and reinsured by group insurance companies. of BP-operated, time-chartered and spot-chartered vessels. At This approach is reviewed on a regular basis or if specific circumstances 31 December 2018 BP had three time-chartered vessels to support require such a review. operations in Alaska and 34 BP-operated and 22 time-chartered vessels for our international oil and gas shipping operations. In 2018 three new technically advanced LNG tankers were delivered into the BP-operated fleet, with a further three to be delivered in 2019. All vessels conducting BP shipping activities are required to meet BP approved health, safety, security and environmental standards. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Glossary 37


 
Alternative energy 2.8 million tonnes of CO2 equivalent avoided in 2018. BP has been in the renewable energy business for more than 20 years. Biofuels We remain one of the largest operators among our peers and we’re We believe that biofuels offer one of the best large-scale solutions expanding in areas where we see opportunities for growth. to reduce emissions in the transportation system. Renewables are the fastest-growing energy source in the world today We produce ethanol from sugar cane in Brazil, which has life-cycle and we estimate that they could provide at least 15% of the global greenhouse gas emissions around 70% lower than conventional energy mix by 2040. transport fuels. In 2018 our three sites produced 765 million litres of ethanol equivalent. As part of our approach to building our alternative energy business, we aim to grow our existing businesses and to develop new businesses Brazil is one of the world’s largest markets for ethanol fuel. In order and partnerships to deliver competitive value in the fastest-growing to better connect our ethanol production with the country’s main fuels energy sector. markets, we established a joint venture in 2018 with Copersucar – one of the world’s leading ethanol and sugar traders. This includes operating Solar energy a major ethanol storage terminal in Brazil’s main fuels distribution hub. Solar could generate 12% of total global power by 2040, in a scenario based on recent trends. That could grow to 21% in a scenario consistent Our Tropical and Ituiutaba biofuels sites are certified to Bonsucro, an with the Paris climate goals. independent standard for sustainable sugar cane production. We are working towards certification for Itumbiara in 2019. We have a 43% share in Lightsource BP and plan to invest $200 million over a three-year period. Lightsource BP aims to play a vital role in Our strategy is enabled by: shaping the future of global energy delivery by developing substantial • Safe and reliable operations – continuing to drive improvements solar capacity around the world, and we are working with Lightsource in safety performance. BP to expand its global presence. • Driving quality and improved efficiency in our feedstock – Lightsource BP has doubled the number of countries where it has concentrating our efforts in Brazil, which has one of the most a presence since December 2017 – see Climate change on page 45. cost-competitive biofuel sources in the world. • Domestic and international markets – selling ethanol and sugar domestically in Brazil and to international markets such as the US. Renewable products Butamax®, our 50/50 joint venture with DuPont, has developed technology that converts sugars from corn into bio-isobutanol, an energy-rich bio product. Bio-isobutanol has a wide variety of applications. For example, it can be used in the production of paints, coatings and lubricant components. It can also be blended with gasoline at higher concentrations than ethanol, which can be transported through existing fuel pipelines and infrastructure. Butamax® has upgraded its ethanol facility in Kansas to produce bio-isobutanol. 38 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 39 see SeeGlossary More information   Low carbon ambitions to reduce emissions in our operations, improve We have set targets and aims reduce their emissions and create low carbon our products to help customers businesses – see pages 46-48. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Harnessing battery power on page 42. In we divested 2018 three wind energy operations as part in Texas, At our Titan 1 wind energy site in South Dakota, partnered we’ve testwith to how effectively Tesla wind energy canbe stored – of a broader restructuring programme designed optimize to our US long-term portfoliowind growth. for travelled a day 45,000km of just emitted from 2 absorbed by sugar cane during 2 martLog programme is helping improve Using technology in biofuels Our S   performance across our three biofuels sites in Brazil. SmartLog is designed increase to efficiency across sugar cane cutting, loading and – transportation operations and consequently reduces the costs involved. Every day across our sites we make around 800 trips covering 45,000 kilometres. This takes place in remote locations with coverage. communications and poor network Using a combination of mobile satellite technology, sensors and radios we can connect our people and their vehicles a to central control room. Here we receive 24-hour real-time information about what’s happening in the fieldto help manage activitiesremotely, as well as monitoring and analysing behaviours and giving advice or intervening about safety or efficiency. improvements on workers guides Automation such as how prioritize to harvest activities and indicates the optimum speed for harvesters runto at based on prevailing conditions. Since introducing SmartLog in 2018, we’ve reduced equipment needed by 20% and our remote monitoring is helping reinforce to our safety culture in the field. It has also helped lowerto emissions as the reduction in equipment means we use less diesel. Biopower We create biopower from bagasse, the fibre thatremains after crushing sugar cane stalks. In our 2018 three biofuels manufacturing facilities produced around 892GWh of electricity – enough renewable energy power to all of these sites, with the remaining 70% exported theto local electricity grid. This is a low carbon power source, with part of the CO its growth.its energy Wind BP has significant interests in onshore wind energy in the US. We operate sites in 10 seven states and hold an interest in another facility in Hawaii. they Together have a net generating capacity over 1,000MW. burning bagasse offset by the CO


 
Innovation in BP Across the business we face the dual challenge of meeting society’s need for more energy, while at the same time working to reduce carbon emissions. Our industry is changing rapidly, and the energy mix is shifting towards lower carbon sources, driven by technological advances and growing environmental concerns. Technology is ever-present in all that we do – from safely discovering and recovering oil and gas, to renewable energy and lower carbon fuels and products. And digital, big data and advanced technologies, as well BPme available in as an innovative mindset, are driving rapid > retail sites development of new ways to tackle emissions 6,000 and improve efficiency at BP. We also invest in high-tech companies A new way to pay to help accelerate and commercialize new Customers in six countries now have the technologies, products and business models. option to pay for fuel from their vehicle using BPme. And since its launch our smartphone app has been downloaded more than one million times. Using a phone’s GPS signal BPme locates the nearest BP site and provides details of opening times and facilities. Customers can use the app to activate their fuel pump and pay from inside their car. BPme is designed to appeal to people who don’t want to leave children, pets or valuables 8 major alone while they go to pay for fuel, and it saves time queuing at the checkout. Over the coming technology months we plan to roll it out to new markets centres and introduce the option to order coffee and in the US, UK, receive offers and discounts from the app. Asia and Germany Group highlights $429 million invested in research and development ~$200 million used to develop options for new lower carbon businesses Collaborations with innovative academic programmes 24 hours to 20 minutes with APEX >4,000 granted and pending patent applications held by BP and its subsidiaries throughout 150 million+ the world data points a day with POA   bp.com/technology 40 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 41 to hours hour 23 1 Robot inspections Robot Inspection robots are helping us deliver against our strategic priority of modernizing and Attransforming our Cherry BP. Point refinery in the adapted US we’ve a robotic solution that allows us inspect to equipment such as the hydrocracker reactor. The robot uses ultrasound technology spot to microscopic cracks in its walls by crawling along the reactor. This process would have previously taken more than 23 work hours, with engineers working inside the hydrocracker unit during a planned shutdown. Now they can gather the same information in just one hour with robots. and vehicles needed as well as a simplified derigging process – which is otherwise very consumingtime and challenging. The new node is the lightest, smallest and the world, and the lowest-cost in system project is on course help to change how future seismic is acquired. Its development will be completed with a large-scale field trial in early 2019. Soon after this we plan begin to the first commercial survey. 01 1101 10 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 10101010101 01010101010101010101 01010101010101010101 01010101010101010101 01010101010101010101 0101010101010 01010101010101010101 01010101 0101010101 01010101 Wolfspar ~1,000km of data acquired in 143 hours and Schlumberger. The project aims move to beyond the existing limitations of bulky, heavy and expensive equipment, seismic onshore and at the same time provide better images of the reservoir. Following successful initial field trials in Norway and Abu the Dhabi in 2017, ‘nimble node‘ system was used safely to acquire 3D seismic data in the challenging climate of West Siberia in 2018. Early images show better data quality compared to people equipment, with fewer conventional And following our successful pilot in the Atlantis field, we are now using Plant Operations Advisor (POA), which was developed in partnership with BHGE, on all four BP-operated platforms in the US Gulf of Mexico. The cloud-based tool gives performance 1,200 important around on information pieces of process equipment – with more than 150 million data points analysed every If theday. system identifies an issue with any of the equipment, it sends an alert to our engineers so they can respond quickly. operations in anomalies pinpointing By and identifyingand causes, the problems that might once have taken hours for engineers to workto through manually can be diagnosed in minutes. Following its success in the Gulf of Mexico, we now plan use to the tool at more than 30 upstream locations worldwide by the end of 2019. . The. ultra-low-frequency system New technologies are helping us build operations business. our throughout intelligent Across all our upstream-operatedassets, we are creating ‘virtual copies’ of our production systems using APEX – our highly sophisticated simulation, surveillance and optimization toolkit. The technology recreates every element of a well network in digital ‘twin’ Intelligent operations form, and works in near real time gather to data about every well across our business. It can pinpoint where efficiency can be improved and helps our production engineers run simulations in seconds. With APEX, a full-field optimization that usedto hourstake now takes minutes. a few Engineers from proactively their sharing are world the around know-how and expertise across our global operations, as they embed the use of APEX it. startfrom and benefiting and conditions, BP’s developments in seismic seismic in developments BP’s conditions, and technology are allowing us see to deeper earth the with better accuracyinto ever than before. And the better we can see, the easier and safer it is find to oil and gas and unlock more of it from our existing assets. One of the big challenges for conventional seismic sources when surveying offshore in the Gulf of Mexico is the ability look to deep theinto earth without the thick horizontal salt layers above distorting the images captured. help tackleTo this we designed and built Wolfspar advanced other with our recordingworks technologies help to overcome the subsalt imaging challenge. We believe the clearer view will help reduce uncertainty about where the resources are, resulting in more drillable targets in the region. Having completed a series of successful proof-of-concept tests, BP plans move industrialize to to the technology with our strategic seismic partners, so that it can be used across our global subsurface portfolio. We also reached a major milestone in the development of an innovative land seismic recording system, in partnership with Rosneft Below land and sea, in challenging terrains terrains challenging in sea, and land Below A clearer view below view A clearer theearth


 
Venturing and low carbon across multiple fronts >6,500 UK charging points with BP Chargemaster in 2018 12 million electric vehicles projected on UK roads by 2040 in the BP Energy Outlook . Harnessing battery power As we support the transition to We also invested $20 million in StoreDot, a lower carbon future and to help a company that develops ultra-fast charging battery technology for mobile and industrial meet our customers’ changing markets. We anticipate the technology will Storing wind energy needs, we’re making investments be used in mobile devices by 2020 and BP We’ve partnered with Tesla to test in electric vehicle technology and will be working with them to help transfer this how effectively wind energy can be infrastructure. Our work aims to technology to electric vehicles. StoreDot aims stored at our Titan 1 wind energy site support electric vehicle adoption to bring recharging times down to five minutes, in South Dakota. The electricity captured making the time it takes to charge an electric is then available for the site to use by tackling issues such as poor vehicle similar to that of filling a tank. battery life and slow charging whenever we need it – even when the wind isn’t blowing. times. BP now has more than 6,500 charging points in the UK, through BP Chargemaster. The The pilot will help develop valuable To allow us to respond rapidly to demand business combines the complementary insights for energy storage applications for charging facilities at our forecourts, we expertise, experience and assets of BP and across our diverse portfolio. invested $5 million in FreeWire. The US-based Chargemaster and is an important step company manufactures mobile rapid charging towards offering widened access to fast and systems, which we successfully piloted at a ultra-fast charging at BP sites across the UK. BP retail site in the UK, and are now exploring The chargers will start to become available options to offer FreeWire’s innovative charging across our UK forecourts throughout 2019. StoreDot – aim to reduce services across the retail networks. electric vehicle recharging time to five minutes. 42 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Sustainability Strategic report – performance BP Sustainability Report 2018 We aim to create long-term value for our publishes April shareholders, partners and society by helping to meet growing energy demand in a safe and responsible way. > >   Our 2018 sustainability focus areas Safety and security Value to society > Climate change > Ethical conduct These sustainability issues are the ones that could impact our business the most and that are of greatest interest to > Managing our impacts > Our people our stakeholders. Safety and security P������ ������ ������ ������� �� ���������� Safety is our number one priority and a core value. Our aim is to have no accidents, no harm to people and no damage to the environment. 1�0 We are working to continuously embed and improve personal and process safety and operational risk management across BP and to 100 strengthen our safety management. Our approach builds on our experience, including learning from �0 incidents, operations audits, annual risk reviews and sharing lessons learned with our industry peers. �01� �01� �01� �01� ���� Managing safety ���� 1 ���� � BP-operated businesses are responsible for identifying and managing operating risks and bringing together people with the right skills and competencies to address them. Our safety and operational risk team ���������� ������ ��������� works alongside BP-operated businesses to provide oversight and ���������� ��������� ��� �00�000 ����� ������� technical guidance, while our group audit team visits sites on a risk-prioritized basis to check how they are managing risks. 0�� Our operating management system 0�� Our operating management system (OMS) is a group-wide framework designed to help us manage risks in our operating activities and drive 0�� performance improvements. It brings together BP requirements on 0�� health, safety, security, the environment, social responsibility and operational reliability, as well as related issues, such as maintenance, �01� �01� �01� �01� ���� contractor relations and organizational learning, into a common ��������� 0��1 0��� 0��1 0��� ���� management system. ��������� 0��� 0��0 0�1� 0��0 ���� ����������� 0��� 0��� 0��� 0��� ���� Our OMS also helps us improve the quality of our activities by setting �������� ��������� ��������� �� ���������� a common framework that our operations must work to. We review ������������� ����������� �� ��� � ��� ��������� ���������� and amend these requirements from time to time to reflect our ���� ��� ���� �01� ���� ������� ��� ��� ��������� ����� ��� �01�� priorities. Any variations in the application of OMS, in order to meet local regulations or circumstances, are subject to a governance process. Recently acquired operations need to transition to our OMS. See page 44 for information about contractors and joint arrangements . Preventing incidents We carefully plan our operations, with the aim of identifying potential hazards and having rigorous operating and maintenance practices applied by capable people to manage risks at every stage. We design our new facilities in line with process safety – the application of good design and engineering principles. We track our safety performance using industry metrics such as the American Petroleum Institute recommended practice 754 and the International Association of Oil & Gas Producers recommended practice 456. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Glossary 43


 
2018 2017 2016 Cyber threats Tier 1 process safety events a 16 18 16 Cyber attacks are on the rise and our industry is subject to evolving risks Tier 2 process safety eventsb 56 61 84 from a variety of cyber threat actors, including nation states, criminals, Oil spills – numberc 124 139 149 terrorists, hacktivists and insiders. We have experienced threats to the   Oil spills contained 63 81 91 security of our digital infrastructure, but none of these had a significant impact on our business in 2018.   Oil spills reaching land and water 57 58 58 Oil spilled – volume (thousand litres) 538 886 677 We have a range of measures to manage this risk, including the use   Oil unrecovered (thousand litres) 131 265 311 of cyber security policies and procedures, security protection tools, ongoing detection and monitoring of threats, and testing of response a Tier 1 process safety events are losses of primary containment of greater consequence – such as causing harm to a member of the workforce, costly damage to equipment or and recovery procedures. exceeding defined quantities. To encourage vigilance among our employees, our cyber security b Tier 2 events are those of lesser consequence. c Number of spills greater than or equal to one barrel (159 litres, 42 US gallons). training programme covers topics such as email phishing and the correct classification and handling of our information. We collaborate closely In 2018 we saw a reduction in the number of tier 1 and tier 2 process with governments, law enforcement and industry peers to understand safety events. We investigate incidents including near misses. And we and respond to new and emerging threats. use leading indicators, such as inspections and equipment tests, to monitor the strength of controls to prevent incidents. We also use Security and response techniques that help teams to analyse and redesign tasks to reduce the We monitor for hostile actions that could harm our people or disrupt chance of mistakes occurring. our operations, focusing on areas affected by political and social unrest, Keeping people safe terrorism, armed conflict or criminal activity. We take steps to help All our employees and contractors have the responsibility and the people stay safe when they are travelling on business. Our 24-hour authority to stop unsafe work. Our safety rules guide our workers on response information centre monitors global events and related staying safe while performing tasks with the potential to cause most developments which means we can assess the safety of our people harm. The rules are aligned with our OMS and focus on areas such as and provide timely advice if there is an emergency. working at heights, lifting operations and driving safety. We run exercises and drills to test our procedures to help ensure our We monitor and report on key workforce personal safety metrics in line people are prepared in the event of an emergency. We conducted a with industry standards. We include both employees and contractors in two-day oil spill response drill in the UK North Sea involving more than our data. 200 people, including regulators. This was designed to test plans as part of our annual crisis and continuity management programme. We also Tragically we suffered one fatality in 2018. In our lubricants business a held a number of large-scale exercises in the US. heavy goods driver working for one of our contractors in the US was struck by a passing vehicle while checking a tyre. We are deeply Working with contractors and partners saddened by this loss and are working closely with our contractors to More than half of the hours worked by BP are carried out by contractors. continue to improve safety and to seek to prevent injuries in our work Through bridging and other documents, we define the way our safety together. management system co-exists with those of our contractors to manage risk on a site. For our contractors facing the most serious risks, we 2018 2017 2016 conduct quality, technical, health, safety and security audits before Recordable injury frequencyd 0.20 0.22 0.21 awarding contracts. Once they start work, we continue to monitor their Day away from work case safety performance. frequencye 0.048 0.055 0.051 Severe vehicle accident rate 0.04 0.03 0.05 Our OMS includes requirements and practices for working with contractors. Our standard model contracts include health, safety and d Incidents that result in a fatality or injury per 200,000 hours worked. security requirements. We expect and encourage our contractors and e Incidents that result in an injury where a person is unable to work for a day (shift) or more per 200,000 hours worked. their employees to act in a way that is consistent with our code of conduct and take appropriate action if those expectations, or their We saw an overall decrease in our recordable injury frequency and day contractual obligations, are not met. away from work case frequency. Our goals stay the same – to have no accidents, no harm to people and no damage to the environment. There Our partners in joint arrangements is always more we can do and we remain focused on achieving better In joint arrangements where we are the operator, our OMS, code results today and in the future. of conduct and other policies apply. We aim to report on aspects of our business where we are the operator – as we directly manage the Technology performance of these operations. We monitor performance and how New technologies are helping us increase the amount and quality of data risk is managed in our joint arrangements, whether we are the operator we gather from our operations and speed up our analysis, allowing us to or not. act more quickly. For example, our Brazilian biofuels business is spread across geographically remote locations, so we introduced a digital Where we are not the operator, our OMS is available as a reference platform to connect our people and vehicles to a central control room. point for BP businesses when engaging with operators and This provides 24-hour, real-time information about what’s happening, co-venturers. We have a group framework to assess and manage helps us monitor and analyse behaviour and aids improvements around BP’s exposure related to safety, operational and bribery and corruption learning and safety. We also use in-vehicle monitoring systems and risk from our participation in these types of arrangements. Where cameras to improve transportation safety. appropriate, we may seek to influence how risk is managed in arrangements where we are not the operator. Emergency preparedness The scale and spread of BP’s operations means we must be prepared to respond to a range of possible disruptions and emergency events. We maintain disaster recovery, crisis and business continuity management plans and work to build day-to-day response capabilities to support local management of incidents. 44 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance consistent with the Paris goals. Subject to shareholder approval at our annual general meeting, we will provide more information on this in Climate change future reports. Risk management The world needs more energy but with fewer carbon We recognize the significance of the energy transition and the risks and emissions. BP is playing an active role in meeting opportunities it presents. As part of their review of BP’s strategy, the this dual challenge. board and executive team considered risks and opportunities associated with climate change and the energy transition, in the context of different The Taskforce for Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) was paths expressed in the BP Energy Outlook – which looks at long-term established by the Financial Stability Board with the aim of improving the trends and develops projections for world energy markets over the next reporting of climate-related risks and opportunities. We support this aim. two decades. Our reporting provides information supporting the principles of the Under BP’s risk management policy and the associated risk TCFD recommended disclosures. management procedures, our operating businesses are responsible for   See bp.com/tcfd. identifying and managing their risks. Risks which may be identified include potential effects on operations at the asset level, performance at Strategy the business level and developments at the regional level from extreme Our strategy is designed to grow shareholder value while also helping weather or the transition to a lower carbon economy. to meet the dual challenge. We believe it is consistent with the climate goals of the Paris Agreement, which calls for the world to rapidly reduce As part of our annual planning process we review the group’s principal greenhouse gas emissions in the context of sustainable development risks and uncertainties. Climate change and the transition to a lower and eradicating poverty. carbon economy has been identified as a principal risk (see page 55). This covers various aspects of how risks associated with the energy A key element of our strategy is our ‘reduce, improve, create’ transition could manifest such as in the policy, legal and regulatory framework, where we have set measurable, near-term targets for environment, technological developments and market changes. reducing greenhouse gas emissions in our own operations and Similarly, physical climate-related risks such as extreme weather ambitions for improving products to help our customers and are covered in our principal risks related to safety and operations. consumers lower their emissions, and creating low carbon businesses. See page 46.   See page 53 for more information on how we manage risk. In 2019 we are supporting a resolution from a group of institutional investors to describe in our corporate reporting how our strategy is Climate governance BP’s governance framework applies equally to the management and committees in BP bring together cross-segment and of the various aspects of climate change and the transition to a cross-functional expertise of relevance to this area, including lower carbon economy. In addition to the oversight provided by the those set out below. executive team, the board and relevant committees, various groups BP governance framework   See page 69 Renewal committee Reviews strategic, commercial and investment decisions outside of core activity and related to new lines of business. Chaired by our deputy chief executive. New energy frontiers steering committee Oversees strategy and development of growth opportunities in low carbon business models that can be scaled up to create new businesses for BP. Chaired by our deputy chief executive. Carbon steering group Focuses on strategy, policy, performance oversight and collaboration relating to carbon management activities across the group. Chaired by our vice president of carbon management. Upstream carbon Downstream advancing the steering committee energy transition committee Focuses on the delivery of lower carbon plans in the Upstream. Develops and drives the implementation of advancing the energy Chaired by our chief operating officer of production, transformation transition in the Downstream. Chaired by our head of technology, and carbon, Upstream. Downstream and BP chief scientist. Key: Executive-level committee Cross-functional committee Business and segment committee BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 45


 
Our low carbon ambitions We have set targets and aims to reduce emissions in our operations, improve our products to help customers reduce their emissions and We aim to advance a low carbon future through what create low carbon businesses. We are already in action and have made we call our ‘reduce, improve, create’ framework. good progress in 2018 against these ambitions.  See bp.com/sustainability for more information on the actions we are taking and bp.com/targets for specifics on our goals. Reducing Improving emissions in our operations our products We are targeting zero net growth in our operational emissions out We are continuing to innovate with fuels, lubricants and chemicals that to 2025. We aim to deliver this through sustainable greenhouse gas can help our customers and consumers lower their emissions. (GHG) emissions reductions totalling 3.5Mte by 2025, by targeting a methane intensity of 0.2% and, as necessary, with offsets to keep net emissions growth to zero. 2018 progress 2018 progress • Zero net growth in operational emissions. • Collaborated with Neste to explore opportunities to • 2.5Mte of sustainable GHG emissions reductions increase supply of sustainable aviation fuel. since the beginning of 2016. This includes actions • Launched Castrol GTX ECO, made using a base oil to improve energy efficiency and reduce methane blend of at least 50% re-refined base oil, in the US. emissions and flaring. • Gave UK drivers the option to offset the CO2 • Methane intensity of 0.2%. emissions from the fuel they buy from us, through our BPme fuel payment app.   From waste to fuel We’ve invested in Fulcrum BioEnergy®, which is constructing the first commercial scale waste-to-fuels plant in the US. The facility aims to use technology, developed by BP and Johnson Matthey, to help convert household rubbish that would otherwise be sent to landfill, into fuel for transport. Fulcrum, in which BP owns an 8% interest, estimates that when it begins commercial operations, the plant will be able to convert around 175,000 tons of waste into about 11 million gallons of fuel each year. 175,000 tons of waste to 11 million gallons of fuel   Detecting methane As a colourless and odourless gas – detecting leaks of methane can be challenging. For several years we’ve used hand-held infrared cameras to detect small leaks before they become larger ones. Improvements in technology now make it possible to quantify the emissions that these cameras detect, helping us to better target and prioritize our responses. We piloted this technology in Azerbaijan and the US in 2018 and plan to deploy the cameras more widely in 2019. 46 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 2018 progress Creating low carbon businesses • Invested $500 million in low carbon activities, such as FreeWire – which supports development of rapid mobile electric vehicle charging. We are building up our renewable energy portfolio – focusing on biofuels, biopower, wind and solar. And together with our dynamic • Worked with OGCI to help progress the Clean Gas venturing arm we are working on multiple fronts – through joint Project, see page 48. ventures, creative collaborations and new business models. As at 31 December 2018   Advancing solar Lightsource BP has doubled the number of countries UK Australia where it has a presence since December 2017. Completed the UK’s biggest- Awarded the project to provide ever unsubsidized solar power 105MW of solar power to Belfast Lightsource BP sites deal to supply AB InBev, the Snowy Hydro, the country’s Budweiser brewer, with fourth-largest national energy Wales 100MW of solar power at its retailer, through a 15-year UK operations in South Wales power purchase agreement. London Bath and Lancashire. US Agreed to bring 25MW of locally generated solar power to western US, Dublin and through new collaborations Limerick Amsterdam in California and New Mexico San Francisco Milan over 20+ year terms. Philadelphia Madrid Cairo Brazil Mumbai Announced plans to develop solar and smart energy storage Chennai solutions for Brazil’s domestic, commercial and industrial sectors. São Paulo Sydney Melbourne India 5 new Egypt Established EverSource Capital Formed a joint venture with Everstone to manage the countries Europe with Hassan Allam Green Growth Equity Fund in 2018 Extended operations into Utilities to develop and aiming to raise up to $700 million of the Italian and Iberian operate utility scale investment in low carbon energy renewable energy sectors. solar projects in Egypt. infrastructure projects across India. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 47


 
Metrics part of the project. This is currently $40 per tonne of CO2 equivalent, We report direct and indirect greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions on a with a stress test at a carbon price of $80 per tonne. Until late January carbon dioxide equivalent (CO2e) basis. Direct emissions include CO2 2019 we used these specific prices in industrialized countries, but have and methane from the combustion of fuel and the operation of facilities, now expanded this to apply globally. and indirect emissions include those resulting from the purchase of Working with others electricity and steam we import into our operations. We work with peers, non-governmental organizations and academic There was a decrease in our direct GHG emissions in 2018. The primary institutions to address the climate challenge. reasons for this include actions taken by our businesses to reduce The Oil and Gas Climate Initiative (OGCI) – currently chaired by our emissions in areas such as flaring, methane and energy efficiency as group chief executive Bob Dudley – brings together 13 oil and gas well as operational changes, such as increased gas being captured and companies to increase the ambition, speed and scale of the initiatives exported to the liquefied natural gas facility in Angola. undertaken by its individual companies to help reduce manmade GHG a Greenhouse gas emissions (MteCO2e) emissions. OGCI announced a collective methane intensity target 2018 2017 2016 for member companies in 2018. The target aims to reduce the collective Operational controlb average methane intensity of the group’s aggregated upstream oil and gas operations to below 0.25% by 2025, compared with the baseline of Direct emissions 48.8 50.5 51.4 0.32% in 2017. See page 46 for information on BP’s methane intensity. Indirect emissions 5.4 6.1 6.2 BP equity sharec BP is working with OGCI Climate Investments to help progress the Direct emissions 46.5 49.4 50.1 UK’s first commercial full-chain carbon capture, use and storage project. The Clean Gas Project plans to capture CO from new efficient gas-fired Indirect emissions 5.7 6.8 6.2 2 power generation and transport it by pipeline to be stored in a formation a Our approach to reporting GHG emissions broadly follows the IPIECA/API/IOGP Petroleum under the southern North Sea. The infrastructure would also allow other Industry Guidelines for Reporting GHG Emissions. We calculate CO2 emissions based on the industries in Teesside to store CO2 captured from their processes. The fuel consumption and fuel properties for major sources. We report CO2 and methane. We do not include nitrous oxide, hydrofluorocarbons, perfluorocarbons and sulphur hexafluoride as project, which is currently undergoing a feasibility study, could be in they are not material to our operations and it is not practical to collect this data. operation by the mid-2020s. b Operational control data comprises 100% of emissions from activities that are operated by BP, going beyond the IPIECA guidelines by including emissions from certain other activities such as contracted drilling activities. c BP equity share data comprises 100% of emissions from subsidiaries and the percentage of emissions equivalent to our share of joint arrangements and associates , other than BP’s share of Rosneft. Managing our impacts The ratio of our total GHG emissions reported on an operational control We work hard to avoid, mitigate and manage our basis to gross production was 0.22teCO e/te production in 2018 (2017 2 environmental and social impacts over the life of 0.24teCO2e/te, 2016 0.24teCO2e/te). Gross production comprises upstream production, refining throughput and petrochemicals produced. our operations. Accrediting our lower carbon activities The way our businesses around the world understand and manage To reinforce our ambitions, we implemented our Advancing Low Carbon their environmental and social impacts is set out in our operating accreditation programme, which aims to inspire every part of BP to management system. This includes requirements on engaging with identify lower carbon opportunities. stakeholders who may be affected by our activities. To gain accreditation by BP, each activity must meet certain criteria, In planning our projects, we identify potential impacts from our activities including delivering what we call a better carbon outcome. This means in areas such as land rights, water use and protected areas. We use the either reducing GHG emissions, producing less carbon than competitor results of this analysis to identify actions and mitigation measures and or industry benchmarks, providing renewable energy, offsetting carbon implement these in project design, construction and operations. For produced, furthering research and technology to advance low carbon or example, as part of our exploration activities in São Tomé and Príncipe, enabling BP or others to meet their low carbon objectives. we are using underwater sound recorders and an autonomous vehicle to help understand the distribution and movement of marine mammals. Deloitte conducts independent assurance on the Advancing Low The outcomes of this will inform our approach to planning for potential Carbon activities, including assessing the application of BP’s process future activities. and criteria for accrediting activities, and GHG emissions offset and saved within the programme. Every year our major operating sites review their performance and set local improvement targets. These can include measures on flaring, A total of 52 activities met the criteria for accreditation or reaccreditation greenhouse gas emissions and the use of water. in 2019, up from 33 in 2018. These include emission reductions in our operations, carbon neutral products, more efficient ships, investments   See page 44 for information on our oil spill performance. in electrification and support for low carbon technologies. Water  See bp.com/advancinglowcarbon for details on the programme We review risks related to management of water in our portfolio and Deloitte’s assurance statement. each year, considering the local availability, quantity, quality and Calling for a price on carbon regulatory requirements. In our gas operations in Oman – an area BP believes that well-designed carbon pricing by governments provides where the availability of fresh water is extremely scarce – we withdraw the right incentives for everyone – energy producers and consumers brackish water under permit from a local underground aquifer that is only alike – to play their part in reducing emissions. It makes energy used for industrial purposes. We desalinate the water and use it for efficiency more attractive and makes lower carbon solutions, such drilling and hydraulic fracturing. We completed a modelling study in 2018 as renewables and carbon capture, use and storage, more cost to assess the sustainability of this water supply. The results of the study competitive. have been incorporated into a long-term water management plan to reduce water demand. We use a carbon price when evaluating our plans for certain large new projects and also those for which emissions costs would be a material Air quality We put measures in place to manage our air emissions, in line with regulations and industry guidelines designed to protect the health 48 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance of local communities and the environment. In our shipping business, we We disclose information on payments to governments for our upstream introduced three new liquefied natural gas carriers to our fleet in 2018. activities on a country-by-country and project basis under national The carriers are designed to use approximately 25% less fuel and emit reporting regulations such as those in effect in the UK. We also make less nitrogen oxides than our older ships. payments to governments in connection with other parts of our business – such as the transporting, trading, manufacturing and Hydraulic fracturing marketing of oil and gas. We aim to apply responsible practices to the design of our wells to mitigate potential risks associated with hydraulic fracturing. For example, We support transparency in the flow of revenue from oil and gas we install multiple layers of steel into each well and cement above and activities to governments. This helps citizens hold public authorities below any freshwater aquifers. We then test the integrity of each well to account for the way they use funds received through taxes and before we begin the fracturing process and again at completion. other agreements. Hydraulic fracturing creates very small earth tremors that are rarely felt We are a founding member of the Extractive Industries Transparency at the surface. Before we start work we assess the likelihood of our Initiative (EITI), which requires disclosure of payments made to and operations causing such activity. For example, we work to identify received by governments in relation to oil, gas and mining activity. natural faults in the rock. This analysis informs our development plans As part of the EITI, we work with governments, non-governmental for drilling and hydraulic fracturing activity, and we seek to mitigate this organizations and international agencies to improve the transparency risk through the design of our operations. of payments to governments. In 2018 we continued to support EITI implementation in a number of countries where we operate, including   See bp.com/environment for more information. Iraq and Trinidad & Tobago.  See bp.com/tax for our approach to tax and our payments to governments report. Value to society We aim to have a positive and enduring impact on the communities in which we operate. Human rights In supplying energy, we contribute to economies around the world We are committed to respecting the rights and by employing local staff, helping to develop national and local suppliers, dignity of all people when conducting our business. and through the funds we pay to governments from taxes and other agreements. We respect internationally recognized human rights as set out in the International Bill of Human Rights and the International Labour Additionally, our social investments support community efforts to Organization’s Declaration on Fundamental Principles and Rights at increase incomes and improve standards of living. We contributed Work. These include the rights of our workforce and those living in $114.2 million in social investment in 2018 (2017 $89.5 million, 2016 communities potentially affected by our activities. $61.1 million). In India we developed a training programme to help motorcycle mechanics working in small enterprises develop additional We set out our commitments in our human rights policy and our code skills in business management and customer service. Since it began in of conduct. Our operating management system contains guidance 2009, the programme has trained more than 200,000 mechanics. on respecting the rights of workers and community members. We aim to recruit our workforce from the community or country in We are incorporating the UN Guiding Principles on Business and which we operate. We also run programmes to build the skills of Human Rights, which set out how companies should prevent, address businesses and develop the local supply chain in a number of and remedy human rights impacts, into our business processes. Our locations. For example, in 2018 we launched an initiative with oil focus areas include the ethical recruitment and working conditions of and gas peers in Senegal to support local company efforts to achieve contracted workforces at our sites, responsible security, community international standards and improve their ability to bid for work with health and livelihoods, and mechanisms for workers and communities to companies like BP. raise their concerns. Nationals employed In 2018 our actions included: • Reviewing the risk of modern slavery in prioritized locations, including on-site assessments in some cases and addressing findings. • Working with a number of our peers to create an oil and gas industry framework for human rights supplier assessments with a particular Azerbaijan 91% focus on labour rights. Egypt 78% Trinidad Oman 77% • Developing clear expectations on labour rights and a systematic & Tobago 96% approach to modern slavery risk management to build into business Indonesia 96% systems and processes. Angola 87% • Continuing to develop capability on modern slavery and labour rights for our employees and selected contractors, as well as taking steps to raise worker awareness of their rights. • Assessing the practices of private security contractors and the way we  See bp.com/society for more information on how we generate value to society. work with public security forces in our operations in Georgia, in line with our continued implementation of the Voluntary Principles on Tax and transparency Security and Human Rights. We are committed to complying with tax laws in a responsible manner See bp.com/humanrights for more information about our approach to and having open and constructive relationships with tax authorities.   human rights. We paid $7.5 billion in income and production taxes to governments in 2018 (2017 $5.8 billion, 2016 $2.2 billion). BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 49


 
Anti-bribery and corruption BP operates in parts of the world where bribery and corruption present Ethical conduct a high risk. We have a responsibility to our employees, our shareholders and to the countries and communities in which we do business to be We are committed to conducting our business in an ethical and lawful in all our work. Our code of conduct explicitly prohibits ethical, transparent way, using our values and code engaging in bribery or corruption in any form. of conduct to guide us. Our group-wide anti-bribery and corruption policy and procedures include measures and guidance to assess risks, understand relevant Our values laws and report concerns. They apply to all BP-operated businesses. We provide training to employees appropriate to the nature or location of their role. A total of 10,957 employees completed anti-bribery and corruption training in 2018 (2017 12,500, 2016 13,000). We assess any exposure to bribery and corruption risk when working with suppliers and business partners. Where appropriate, we put in place a risk mitigation plan or we reject them if we conclude that risks are too high. We also conduct anti-bribery compliance audits on selected suppliers when contracts are in place. For example, our upstream business conducts audits for a number of suppliers in higher-risk regions to assess their conformance with our anti-bribery and corruption Our values represent the qualities and actions we wish to see in BP. contractual requirements. Potential areas for improvement are shared They inform the way we do business and the decisions we make. We with our suppliers and where necessary, this enables us to work with use these values as part of our recruitment, promotion and individual them to find ways to strengthen their procedures. We issued a total of performance management processes. 27 audit reports in 2018 (2017 36, 2016 25). We take corrective action with suppliers and business partners who fail to meet our expectations, See bp.com/values for more information.   which may include terminating contracts. The BP code of conduct Lobbying and political donations Our code of conduct is based on our values and sets clear expectations We prohibit the use of BP funds or resources to support any political for how we work at BP. It applies to all BP employees and members of candidate or party. the board. We recognize the rights of our employees to participate in the political Employees, contractors or other third parties who have a question process and these rights are governed by the applicable laws in the about our code of conduct or see something that they feel is unethical or countries in which we operate. For example, in the US we provide unsafe can discuss these with their managers, supporting teams, works administrative support for the BP employee political action committee councils (where relevant) or through OpenTalk, a confidential helpline (PAC), which is a non-partisan committee that encourages voluntary operated by an independent company. employee participation in the political process. All BP employee PAC A total of 1,712 concerns or enquiries were recorded in 2018 (2017 contributions are reviewed for compliance with federal and state law 1,612, 2016 1,701) through these channels. The most commonly raised and are publicly reported in accordance with US election laws. concerns were about fair treatment of people, workplace harassment We work with governments on a range of issues that are relevant and protecting BP’s assets. to our business, from regulatory compliance, to understanding our tax We take steps to identify and correct areas of non-conformance and liabilities, to collaborating on community initiatives. The way in which we take disciplinary action where appropriate. In 2018 our businesses interact with those governments depends on the legal and regulatory dismissed 50 employees for non-conformance with our code of conduct framework in each country. or unethical behaviour (2017 70, 2016 109). This excludes dismissals of We are members of multiple industry associations that offer staff employed at our retail service stations. opportunities to share good practices and collaborate on issues of importance to our sector. We aim for alignment between our policies   See bp.com/codeofconduct for more information. and those of trade associations, but understand that associations’ positions reflect a compromise of the assorted views of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill membership. The term of appointment of the ethics monitor, who was appointed   under the administrative agreement with the US Environmental Protection Agency, came to an end in March 2019. In his final report the ethics monitor confirmed that BP had successfully completed the recommendations he had made. 50 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
At the end of 2018 we had five female directors (2017 3, 2016 3) on our Strategic report – performance board. Our nomination committee remains mindful of diversity when Our people considering potential candidates. For more information on the composition of our board, see page 58. BP’s success depends on the wholehearted Workforce by gender contribution of a talented and diverse workforce. Members as at 31 December Male Female Female % Board directors 9 5 36 Executive team 11 2 15 Group leaders 286 89 24 Subsidiary directors 1,161 233 17 All employees 47,171 25,824 35 A total of 24% of our group leaders came from countries other than the UK and the US in 2018 (2017 24%, 2016 23%). Inclusion BP is committed to creating a positive and empowering workplace in which all employees feel valued for the work they do and the impact they make. Our goal is to create an environment of inclusion and acceptance, where everyone is treated equally and without BP employees discrimination. Number of employees at 31 Decembera 2018 2017 2016 To promote an inclusive culture we provide leadership training and Upstream 16,900 17,700 18,700 support employee-run advocacy groups in areas such as gender, Downstream 42,700 42,100 41,800 ethnicity, sexual orientation and disability. As well as bringing employees Other businesses and corporate 13,400 14,200 14,000 together, these groups support our recruitment programmes and Total 73,000 74,000 74,500 provide feedback on the potential impact of policy changes. Each group is sponsored by a senior executive. Service station staff 17,400 16,800 16,200 Agricultural, operational and We made progress in a number of important areas in 2018. For example, seasonal workers in Brazil 3,400 4,300 4,600 we worked with MyPlus, a disability consultancy, to increase our Total excluding service station understanding of the needs of disabled candidates in our application and staff and workers in Brazil 52,200 52,900 53,700 hiring processes. And we launched our gender transition guidelines to support employees who are transitioning, or helping someone who is. a Reported to the nearest 100. For more information see Financial statements – Note 35. We aim to ensure equal opportunity in recruitment, career development, Our industry relies on creative and scientific thinking to solve some of promotion, training and reward for all employees – regardless of the world’s biggest energy problems. We focus on attracting and ethnicity, national origin, religion, gender, age, sexual orientation, marital developing innovative and capable individuals, while also maintaining status, disability, or any other characteristic protected by applicable laws. safe and reliable operations. Where existing employees become disabled, our policy is to provide The group people committee helps facilitate the group chief executive’s continued employment, training and occupational assistance oversight of policies relating to employees. In 2018 the committee where needed. discussed remuneration policy, progress in our diversity and inclusion Employee engagement programme, modernizing and strengthening our attractiveness as an Managers hold regular team and one-to-one meetings with their staff, employer, our talent and learning programmes and long-term people complemented by formal processes through works councils in parts of priorities. Europe. We regularly communicate with employees on factors that Attraction and retention affect BP’s performance, and seek to maintain constructive relationships A total of 296 graduates joined BP in 2018 (2017 314, 2016 231). We with labour unions formally representing our employees. were named the UK’s highest-ranking recruiter in the oil and gas sector To better understand how employees feel about BP, we conduct an in The Times newspaper’s Top 100 Graduate Employer rankings in 2018. annual survey. The overall employee engagement score in 2018 was We invest in employee development – with an average spend of around 66%. Pride in working for BP was at the highest level $3,200 per person. This includes online and classroom-based courses in a decade at 76% in 2018. and resources, supported by a wide range of on-the-job learning and mentoring programmes. The area where our employees scored us as needing attention was in the efficiency of our processes and ways of working. We know we still Diversity have work to do to streamline our processes and drive the benefits of We are committed to making our workplaces reflect the communities digitization throughout BP. in which we are based. Share ownership The gender balance across BP as a whole is steadily improving, with We encourage employee share ownership and have a number of women representing 35% of BP’s total population (2017 34%, 2016 employee share plans in place. For example, we operate a ShareMatch 33%). We are working to improve these numbers further by, for plan in more than 50 countries, matching BP shares purchased by our example, developing mentoring, sponsorship and coaching programmes employees. We also operate a group-wide discretionary share plan, to help more women advance. But we still have work to do at the which allows employee participation at different levels globally and is executive and senior levels. linked to the company’s performance.  See bp.com/ukgenderpaygap for data and more information on our gender pay gap in the UK. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 See Glossary 51


 
Modernizing the whole group Smart glasses used across BPX Energy Using wearable technologies New technologies are helping We are using augmented reality (AR) to modernize our operations devices such as ‘smart glasses’ across BPX Energy. Technicians can use the and improve safety, performance glasses to transmit real-time video to experts and efficiency right across our anywhere in the business and they can then Digital vests business. And we are testing a return AR-enabled instruction back to the range of wearable technologies to technician – all while keeping their hands In Oman, where temperatures can reach 55°C, we are testing technologies such understand how they can support free. We are now using the mobile platform to troubleshoot equipment, conduct safety as biometric vests to protect our people our people in a variety of roles. verifications and deliver remote training. working in high temperatures. Working in extreme heat can trigger fatigue, This is helping increase productivity and dehydration and stress – and this can contributing to improvements in the safety affect safety and effective performance. and efficiency of our operations. The lightweight vest is designed to prevent this by monitoring location and core body temperature and transmitting data about heart and respiratory rates. It sends an alert if there is a potential concern or a real emergency. As technologies like these evolve, we will continue to trial them in our operations, so that we can roll out those that are the best fit. Temperatures in Oman can reach 55°C 52 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 53 e, treasury, trading l reporting risks. l isks and associated risk nanc f nancia cant r f f 75-86.   ial risk committee – for nanc rd. f olitical committee. wal committee – for strategic, commercial and investment committee. urce commitment meeting – for investment decision risks. utive team meeting – for strategic and commercial risks. p operations risk committee – for health, safety, security, p p ethics and compliance committee – for legal and regulatory p disclosure committee – for for – committee disclosure p risks. employee for – people committee p ty, ethics and environment assurance committee. environment and ethics ty, rt risks and their management the to appropriate levels blish a common understanding of risks on a like-for-like basis, rm prioritization of specific risk management activities and Exec Grou risks. integrity operations and environment Grou Reso Rene and cyber risks. Grou Grou Grou risks. ethics and compliance decision risks related new to lines of business.  BP boa Audit Safe Geop See BP governance framework on page 69, Board activity in 2018 on page See BP governance framework on page 69, Board 70 and committee reports on pages Executive committeesExecutive Board and its committees of the organization. Esta Repo Info taking account into potential impact and likelihood.   resource allocation. resource   • • • • • • • •   • • • • • help to processes business key with alignment activitiesmanagement in enable decisions key be to risk informed. As part of BP’s annual planning process, the executive team and board review the principal group’s risks and uncertainties. These may be updated during the year in response changes to in internal and circumstances.external risk profile Our The nature of our business operations is long term, resulting in many of our risks being enduring in nature. Nonetheless, risks can develop and evolve over time and their potential impact or likelihood may vary in response internal to and external events. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 processes management Risk We aim for a consistent basis of measuring risk to: • Risk oversight and governance Key risk oversight and governance committees include thefollowing: • BP’s group risk team analyses the risk group’s profile and maintains the provides team audit group Our system. management risk group independent assurance the to group chief executive and board as to whether the system group’s of internal control is adequately designed and operating effectively respond to appropriately the to risks that are significant BP. to Businesses and functions review signi Board Set policy and principal monitor risks Oversight and governance functions corporate Executive andExecutive Plan, manage manage Plan, performance assure and Business and and Business strategic risk management Business functions segments and segments the identified risks in appropriate ways. appropriate in risks identified the rstand the risk environment, identify the specificrisks and assess rt up the management chain and the to board on a periodic basis tor and seek assurance of the effectiveness of the management rmine how best deal to with these risks manage to overall Moni Repo Unde Dete potential exposure. Manage of these risks and intervene for improvement where necessary. on how significant risks are being managed, monitored, assured and the improvements that are being made. the potential exposure for BP. Facilities, and assets operations Day-to-day risk management Identify, manage and risks report Day-to-day risk management – management and staff at our facilities, assets and functions seek identify to and manage risk, promoting safe, compliant and reliable operations. BP requirements, which take into account applicable laws and regulations, underpin the practical plans developed help to reduce risk and deliver safe, compliant and reliable operations as well as greater efficiency and sustainable financial results. Business and strategic risk management – our businesses and functions integrate risk management business key into processes such planning, performance capital strategy, and management,as resource allocation, and project appraisal. We do this by using a standard framework for collating risk data, assessing risk management activities, making further improvements and in connection with planning new activities. Oversight and governance – throughout the year functional committees board relevant and the team, executive leadership, the provide oversight of how significant risks BP to areidentified, assessed and managed. They help ensure to that risks are governed by relevant appropriately. managed are and policies Our risk managementOur activities • • • • BP’s risk management system management risk BP’s BP’s risk management system and policy is designed be to a consistent and clear framework for managing and reporting risks from the group’s operations management to and the to board. The system seeks avoid to incidents and maximize business outcomes by allowing us to: • BP manages, monitors and reports on the principal risks and uncertainties that can impact our abilitydeliver to our strategy. These risks are described in the Risk factors on page 55. processes, structures, organizational systems, management Our standards, code of conduct and behaviours together form a system of internal control that governs how we conduct the business of BP and risks. associated manage How we manage How we risk


 
We identify high priority risks for particular oversight by the board and We seek to manage this risk through a range of measures, which its various committees in the coming year. Those identified for 2019 include cyber security standards, security protection tools, ongoing are listed in this section. These may be updated throughout the year detection and monitoring of threats and testing of cyber response and in response to changes in internal and external circumstances. The recovery procedures. We collaborate closely with governments, law oversight and management of other risks, for example technological enforcement agencies and industry peers to understand and respond to change or the transition to a lower carbon economy, is undertaken in new and emerging cyber threats. We build awareness with our staff, the normal course of business and in the executive team, the board share information on incidents with leadership for continuous learning and relevant committees. and conduct regular exercises including with the executive team to test response and recovery procedures. There can be no certainty that our risk management activities will mitigate or prevent these, or other risks, from occurring. Safety and operational risks Further details of the principal risks and uncertainties we face are set Process safety, personal safety and environmental risks out in Risk factors on page 55. The nature of the group’s operating activities exposes us to a wide range of significant health, safety and environmental risks such as incidents Risks for particular oversight by the board and its associated with releases of hydrocarbons when drilling wells, operating committees in 2019 facilities and transporting hydrocarbons. The risks for particular oversight by the board and its committees in Our operating management system helps us manage these risks and 2019 have been reviewed. These risks remain the same as for 2018. drive performance improvements. It sets out the rules and principles which govern key risk management activities such as inspection, Strategic and commercial risks maintenance, testing, business continuity and crisis response planning Financial liquidity and competency development. In addition, we conduct our drilling External market conditions can impact our financial performance. Supply activity through a global wells organization in order to promote a and demand and the prices achieved for our products can be affected by consistent approach for designing, constructing and managing wells. a wide range of factors including political developments, global economic conditions and the influence of OPEC. Security Hostile acts such as terrorism or piracy could harm our people and We seek to manage this risk through BP’s diversified portfolio, our disrupt our operations. We monitor for emerging threats and financial framework, liquidity stress testing, maintaining a significant vulnerabilities to manage our physical and information security. cash buffer, regular reviews of market conditions and our planning and investment processes. Our central security team provides guidance and support to our businesses through a network of regional security advisers who advise Geopolitical and conduct assurance activities with respect to the management of The diverse locations of our operations around the world expose us to a security risks affecting our people and operations. We continue to wide range of political developments and consequent changes to the monitor threats globally and maintain disaster recovery, crisis and economic and operating environment. Geopolitical risk is inherent to many business continuity management plans. regions in which we operate, and heightened political or social tensions or changes in key relationships could adversely affect the group. Compliance and control risks We seek to manage this risk through development and maintenance Ethical misconduct and legal or regulatory non-compliance of relationships with governments and stakeholders and by becoming Ethical misconduct or breaches of applicable laws or regulations could trusted partners in each country and region. In addition, we closely damage our reputation, adversely affect operational results and monitor events and implement risk mitigation plans where appropriate. shareholder value, and potentially affect our licence to operate. Our code of conduct and our values and behaviours, applicable to all employees, are central to managing this risk. Additionally, we have The impact of the UK’s exit from the EU various group requirements and training covering areas such as Following the referendum in 2016, we have been assessing the anti-bribery and corruption, anti-money laundering, competition/ potential impact of Brexit on BP. We have been preparing for anti-trust law and international trade regulations. We seek to keep different scenarios for the UK’s exit from the EU but do not believe abreast of new regulations and legislation and plan our response to any of these scenarios will pose a significant risk to our business. them. We offer an independent confidential helpline, OpenTalk, for The board’s geopolitical committee discussed this, most recently employees, contractors and other third parties. in January 2019. Trading non-compliance We continue to monitor developments in this area in line with our In the normal course of business, we are subject to risks around our risk management processes and procedures. trading activities which could arise from shortcomings or failures in our systems, risk management methodology, internal control processes or employee conduct. Cyber security The targeted and indiscriminate threats to the security of our digital We have specific operating standards and control processes to manage infrastructure continue to evolve rapidly and are increasingly prevalent these risks, including guidelines specific to trading, and seek to monitor across industries worldwide. The oil and gas industry is subject to compliance through our dedicated compliance teams. We also seek to evolving risks from a variety of cyber threat actors, including nation maintain a positive and collaborative relationship with regulators and the states, criminals, terrorists, hacktivists and insiders. A cyber security industry at large. breach could disrupt our business, injure people, harm the environment or our assets, or result in legal or regulatory breaches. 54 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Strategic report – performance 55 , ing costs ing, we could ctivities, could nanc fi nanc ial framework ial loss. Trade fi cant a fi ial, operational or nanc nanc ial performance. In the fi SeeGlossary fi nanc – breach of our digital l, including credit,l, ial framework could impact fi nanc fi – varying levels of control ial loss. nanc fi nancia fi nanc fi perational incident, legal proceedings or cant o ing or engagement in our trading activities on fi ial framework oroverwhelm our ability meet to e and control over the performance of such osts including the cost of remediation or nanc l capacity l and fi nanc fi uenc cant c fl fi or with contractors and sub-contractors may and we contractors where with or nancia fi – failure work to within our reputational consequences. reputational Climate change and the transition to a lower carbon economy – policy, legal, regulatory, technology and market change related the to issue of climate change could increase costs, reduce demand for our products, reduce revenue and limit certain growth opportunities. Changes in laws, regulations, policies, obligations, social attitudes and carbon lower a to transition the to relating preferences customer increasing including business, our on impact cost a have could economy Such strategy. our impact could and costs, litigation and compliance changes could lead constraints to on production and supply and access newto reserves. Technological improvements or innovations that customer and carbon economy, lower a to support transition the preferences or regulatory incentives related such to changes that alter fuel or power choices, such as towards low emission energy sources, could impact demand for oil and gas. Depending on the nature and speed of any such changes and our response, this could adversely affect exposure security or failure of our digital infrastructure including loss or misuse of sensitive information could damage our operations, increase costs and reputation. damage our The oil and gas industry is subject fast-evolving to risks from cyber threat hacktivists and terrorists, criminals, states, nation including actors, insiders. A breach or failure of our digital infrastructure – including control systems – due breaches to of our cyber defences, or those of third parties, misconduct negligence, reasons, could intentional other or seriously disrupt our operations. This could result in the loss or misuse of data or sensitive information, injury people, to disruption our to business, harm the to environment or our assets, legal or regulatory breaches and legal liability. Furthermore, the rapid detection of attempts gain to unauthorized access our to digital infrastructure, often through the use of sophisticated and co-ordinated means, is a challenge and any delay or failure detect to could compound these potential harms. These could result in signi Liquidity, Liquidity, have limited in the for responsible are contractors partners Our and operations. adequacy of the resources and capabilities they bring a project. to If these are found be to lacking, there may be Shouldsafety risks an incident for BP. occur in an operation that BP participates in, our partners and contractors may be unable or unwilling fullyto compensate us against costs we may incur on their behalf or on behalf of the arrangement. Where we do not have operational control of a venture, we may still be pursued by regulators or claimants in the event of an incident. cyber security and infrastructure Digital BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 our ability operate to and result in could impact our ability operate to and result in obligations. our An event such as a signi a geopolitical event in an area where wehave signi reduce our credit ratings. This could potentially increase and limit access to event of extended constraints on our ability obtain to Failure accurately to forecast or work within our and other receivables, including overdue receivables, may not be recovered and a substantial and unexpected cash call or funding request could disrupt our acceptable terms, which could put pressure on the liquidity. group’s Credit rating downgrades could also trigger a requirement for the company review to its funding arrangements with the BP pension trustees and may cause other impacts on be required reduce to capital expenditure or increase asset disposals in order provide to additional liquidity. See Liquidity and capital resources on page 277 and Financial statements – Note 29. contractors and arrangements Joint standards, the operations compliance partners, and our over of and liability legal sub-contractors in and contractors result could damage. reputational We conduct many of our activities through joint arrangements associates ial lity nanc nd tabi fi ows, fi fl and ability to ning a fi inability to access, to inability n and more onerous ations in demand. atio lity of our re fl uctu oducts, technological change, ital expenditure fl tabi fi e of OPEC can impact supply and t, cap ned pr fi fi ial performance is impacted by uenc ro ake, costake, in fl r for a prolonged period, we may have to ydrocarbon located, are basins nanc fi failure invest to in the best opportunities or scal t ows, p fi apital expenditure required. cant o fl our cant h cant fi fi ations can create currency exposures and impact ations, and the general macroeconomic outlook. macroeconomic general the and ations, ations against the US dollar. cant c fi f signi al performance.al al performance, results of operations, cash cash operations, of performance, results al uctu uctu cy or delivery, or operational challenges at any major fl uctu fl fl – exposure a range to of political developments and nanci nanci cien al performance.al ows. I fi fi fi fl ating prices oil, of gas and re nanci fi uctu iquidity, prospects, shareholder value and returns and reputation. and cash could also be adversely impacted. Events in or relating Russia, to including trade restrictions and other sanctions, could adversely impact our income and investment in or relating Russia. to Our ability pursue to business objectives and to recognize production and reserves relating these to investments Geopolitical performance. We face challenges in developing major projects, particularly in geographically and technically challenging areas. Poor investment choice, ef adversely could growth production or production underpins that project affect our consequent changes the to operating and regulatory environment in turn cause production decline, to limit our ability pursue to new opportunities, affect the recoverability of our assets or cause us incur to additional costs, particularly due the to long-term nature of many of our projects and signi Access, renewal and reserves progression – renew and progress upstream resources in a timely manner could adversely affect our long-term replacement of reserves. Delivering our group strategy depends on our ability continually to replenish a strong exploration pipeline of future opportunities access to and produce oil and natural gas. Competition for access investment to opportunities, political heightened economic and certain in risks signi where countries could cause business disruption. We operate and may seek new opportunities in countries and regions where political, economic and social transition may take place. Political instability, changes the to regulatory environment or taxation, property, of nationalization or expropriation sanctions, international civil strife, strikes, insurrections, acts of terrorism and acts of war may disrupt or curtail our operations or development activities. These may terms for access resources. to The pro Exchange rate underlying costs and revenues. Crude oil prices are generally set in US dollars, while products vary in currency. Many of our major project demand and prices for our products. Decreases in oil, gas or product prices could have an adverse effect on revenue, margins, pro a material adverse effect on the implementation of our strategy, our business, l fl rate exchange write down assets and re-assess the viability of certain projects, which may impact future cash Strategic and commercial risks Prices and markets – The risks discussed below, separatelyor in combination, could have Oil, gas and product prices are subject international to supply and demand and margins can be volatile. Political developments, increased supply from new oil and gas sources, technological change, global economic conditions and the in deliver major projects successfully could adversely affect our be subject to development costs are denominated in local currencies, which may maintain our long-term investment programme. Conversely, an increase an long-term our Conversely, programme. maintain investment in oil, gas and product prices may not improve margin performance as there could be increased petrochemicals activities can be volatile, with periodic over-supply or supply tightness in regional markets and unsuccessful exploration activity and increasing technical challenges challenges technical activity increasing and exploration unsuccessful and capital commitments may adversely affect our strategic progress. This, and our ability progress to upstream resources and sustain long-term reserves replacement, could impact our future production and Major project delivery – Risk factors Risk


 
the demand for our products, investor sentiment, our financial Security – hostile acts against our staff and activities could cause harm performance and our competitiveness. See Climate change on page 45. to people and disrupt our operations. Competition – inability to remain efficient, maintain a high quality Acts of terrorism, piracy, sabotage and similar activities directed against portfolio of assets, innovate and retain an appropriately skilled our operations and facilities, pipelines, transportation or digital workforce could negatively impact delivery of our strategy in a highly infrastructure could cause harm to people and severely disrupt competitive market. operations. Our activities could also be severely affected by conflict, civil strife or political unrest. Our strategic progress and performance could be impeded if we are unable to control our development and operating costs and margins, Product quality – supplying customers with off-specification products or to sustain, develop and operate a high quality portfolio of assets could damage our reputation, lead to regulatory action and legal liability, efficiently. We could be adversely affected if competitors offer superior and impact our financial performance. terms for access rights or licences, or if our innovation in areas such as Failure to meet product quality standards could cause harm to people exploration, production, refining, manufacturing, renewable energy or and the environment, damage our reputation, result in regulatory action new technologies lags the industry. Our performance could also be and legal liability, and impact financial performance. negatively impacted if we fail to protect our intellectual property. Our industry faces increasing challenge to recruit and retain diverse, Compliance and control risks skilled and experienced people in the fields of science, technology, engineering and mathematics. Successful recruitment, development Regulation – changes in the regulatory and legislative environment and retention of specialist staff is essential to our plans. could increase the cost of compliance, affect our provisions and limit our access to new growth opportunities. Crisis management and business continuity – failure to address an incident effectively could potentially disrupt our business. Governments that award exploration and production interests may impose specific drilling obligations, environmental, health and safety Our business activities could be disrupted if we do not respond, or are controls, controls over the development and decommissioning of a field perceived not to respond, in an appropriate manner to any major crisis and possibly, nationalization, expropriation, cancellation or non-renewal or if we are not able to restore or replace critical operational capacity. of contract rights. Royalties and taxes tend to be high compared Insurance – our insurance strategy could expose the group to material with those imposed on similar commercial activities, and in certain uninsured losses. jurisdictions there is a degree of uncertainty relating to tax law interpretation and changes. Governments may change their fiscal and BP generally purchases insurance only in situations where this is legally regulatory frameworks in response to public pressure on finances, and contractually required. Some risks are insured with third parties and resulting in increased amounts payable to them or their agencies. reinsured by group insurance companies. Uninsured losses could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, particularly if they arise Such factors could increase the cost of compliance, reduce our at a time when we are facing material costs as a result of a significant profitability in certain jurisdictions, limit our opportunities for new operational event which could put pressure on our liquidity and cash flows. access, require us to divest or write down certain assets or curtail or cease certain operations, or affect the adequacy of our provisions Safety and operational risks for pensions, tax, decommissioning, environmental and legal liabilities. Potential changes to pension or financial market regulation could also Process safety, personal safety, and environmental risks – impact funding requirements of the group. Following the Gulf of Mexico exposure to a wide range of health, safety, security and environmental oil spill, we may be subjected to a higher level of fines or penalties risks could cause harm to people, the environment and our assets and imposed in relation to any alleged breaches of laws or regulations, result in regulatory action, legal liability, business interruption, increased which could result in increased costs. costs, damage to our reputation and potentially denial of our licence Ethical misconduct and non-compliance – ethical misconduct or to operate. breaches of applicable laws by our businesses or our employees could Technical integrity failure, natural disasters, extreme weather or a be damaging to our reputation, and could result in litigation, regulatory change in its frequency or severity, human error and other adverse action and penalties. events or conditions could lead to loss of containment of hydrocarbons Incidents of ethical misconduct or non-compliance with applicable laws or other hazardous materials or constrained availability of resources and regulations, including anti-bribery and corruption and anti-fraud laws, used in our operating activities, as well as fires, explosions or other trade restrictions or other sanctions, could damage our reputation, result personal and process safety incidents, including when drilling wells, in litigation, regulatory action and penalties. operating facilities and those associated with transportation by road, sea or pipeline. Treasury and trading activities – ineffective oversight of treasury and trading activities could lead to business disruption, financial loss, There can be no certainty that our operating management system or regulatory intervention or damage to our reputation. other policies and procedures will adequately identify all process safety, personal safety and environmental risks or that all our operating activities We are subject to operational risk around our treasury and trading will be conducted in conformance with these systems. See Safety and activities in financial and commodity markets, some of which are security on page 43. regulated. Failure to process, manage and monitor a large number of complex transactions across many markets and currencies while Such events or conditions, including a marine incident, or inability to complying with all regulatory requirements could hinder profitable provide safe environments for our workforce and the public while at our trading opportunities. There is a risk that a single trader or a group facilities, premises or during transportation, could lead to injuries, loss of traders could act outside of our delegations and controls, leading of life or environmental damage. As a result we could face regulatory to regulatory intervention and resulting in financial loss, fines and action and legal liability, including penalties and remediation obligations, potentially damaging our reputation. See Financial statements – increased costs and potentially denial of our licence to operate. Note 29. Our activities are sometimes conducted in hazardous, remote or environmentally sensitive locations, where the consequences of Reporting – failure to accurately report our data could lead to regulatory such events or conditions could be greater than in other locations. action, legal liability and reputational damage. Drilling and production – challenging operational environments and External reporting of financial and non-financial data, including reserves other uncertainties could impact drilling and production activities. estimates, relies on the integrity of systems and people. Failure to report data accurately and in compliance with applicable standards could result Our activities require high levels of investment and are sometimes in regulatory action, legal liability and damage to our reputation. conducted in challenging environments such as those prone to natural disasters and extreme weather, which heightens the risks of technical integrity failure. The physical characteristics of an oil or natural gas field, and cost of drilling, completing or operating wells is often uncertain. We may be required to curtail, delay or cancel drilling operations or stop production because of a variety of factors, including unexpected drilling conditions, pressure or irregularities in geological formations, equipment failures or accidents, adverse weather conditions and compliance with The Strategic report was approved by the board and signed on its behalf governmental requirements. by Jens Bertelsen, company secretary on 29 March 2019. 56 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 57 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 he board isclosures porate Governance Code compliance Governance porate erformance and pay outcomes ation and governance committee governance and ation nnual bonus outcome xecutive director outcomes and interests and outcomes director xecutive neration committee neration nance framework ttee reports isits olitical committee intment and time commitment time and intment r workforce in 2018 committee ardship and executive director interests director executive and ardship -18 performance-18 share plan outcome ment with strategy with ment executive director remuneration policy for 2019 utional investors utional utive director remuneration policy and implementation for 2019 utive directors’ pay for 2018 utive management teams utive ing and induction and ing d and committee attendance committee and d d evaluation il investors ty, ethics and environment assurance committee environment and ethics ty, pendence rman’s committeerman’s ls and expertise and ls ersity utive team utive 2018 p 2018 a 2018 2016 Align Exec Wide Stew Non-e Other d Exec Non- Exec Gover Boar Role of t Skil Div Instit Reta AGM Audit Safe Remu Geop Chai Nomin Inde CorUK Appo Train Boar Site v International advisory board Commi report remuneration Directors’ Board of directors Exec Introduction from thechairman Board activity 2018 in Shareholder engagement 75 90 91 92 94 95 97 100 102 104 105 109 66 69 69 70 71 71 74 74 74 81 83 84 85 86 71 74 71 72 72 73 75 87 74 74 63 68 70 58 governance Corporate


 
 See BP’s board governance principles relating Board of directors to director independence on page 300. As at 29 March 2019 Helge Lund Bob Dudley Brian Gilvary Nils Andersen Alan Boeckmann Admiral Frank Dame Alison Pamela Daley Ian Davis Professor Dame Bowman Carnwath Ann Dowling Melody Meyer Brendan Nelson Paula Rosput Sir John Sawers Jens Bertelsen Reynolds Prior to Statoil, he was president and chief He has a degree in business economics from Helge Lund executive officer of Aker Kvaerner, an industrial the Norwegian School of Economics and Chairman conglomerate with operations in oil and gas, Business Administration in Bergen and a engineering and construction, pulp and paper Master of Business Administration from Tenure and shipbuilding. He has also held executive INSEAD business school in France. Appointed 26 July 2018 positions in Aker RGI, a Norwegian industrial Relevant skills and experience Board and committee activities holding company, and Hafslund Nycomed, an Helge Lund was appointed chair of the BP industrial group with business activities in Chair of the chairman’s committee and board following a detailed process involving all pharmaceuticals and energy. nomination and governance committee, members of the board. Helge has an regularly attends the safety, ethics and He has worked as a consultant with McKinsey impressive track record of leadership in the oil environment assurance, audit, remuneration & Company and has served as a political and gas industry. His open-minded and and geopolitical committees adviser for the parliamentary group of the forward-looking approach will be vital as the Conservative party in Norway. industry focuses on the transition to a lower Outside interests carbon world. He has deep industry • Chairman of Novo Nordisk AS Helge is chairman of the board of Novo Nordisk knowledge and global business experience – • Operating Advisor to Clayton Dubilier & Rice AS, a global healthcare company. Prior to not only in the oil and gas industry but also in • Member of the Board of Trustees of the joining BP, he was a non-executive director of pharmaceuticals, healthcare and construction. International Crisis Group the oil service group Schlumberger from 2016 to 2018, and Nokia from 2011 to 2014. Age 56 Nationality Norwegian He is an operating adviser to Clayton Dubilier & Career Rice, a US investment firm. He is a member of Helge Lund became a board director on the Board of Trustees of the International Crisis 26 July 2018 and chairman of the BP board Group and served as a member on the United on 1 January 2019. Nations Secretary-General’s Advisory Group on Sustainable Energy from 2011 to 2014. Helge served as chief executive of BG Group from 2015 to 2016, when the company merged with Shell. He joined BG Group from Statoil where he served as president and chief executive officer for 10 years from 2004. 58 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 59 Danish executive director of Unilever Plc and rman of Salling Group A/S rman of Færch Plast A/S rman of Akzo Nobel N.V. rman of WWF Denmark 60 Nationality Unilever NV Chai Chai Nils AndersenNils non-executiveIndependent director Non- Chai Chai the Gulf Mexico, of and leadingthe 2015 settlement negotiations US with the government and states resolve to the outstanding federal and state claims. Brian also played a leadrole in the negotiations around the exit of TNK-BP and investment into Rosneft and led the recent acquisition the of BHP onshore Lower 48 assets. Brian has also been at the centre of the workgroup’s on cyber securityrisk. addressing Brian Gilvary’s performance been has evaluated by the group chief executive and considered by the chairman’s committee. Tenure 2016 October 31 Appointed Board and committee activities Member of the safety, ethics and environment geopoliticalassurance, chairman’s and committees interests Outside • • • • • Age Career Nils Andersen was group chief executive of Møller-MærskA.P. from 2007 June to 2016. Prior this to he was executive vice president of Carlsberg A/S A/S Carlsberg and Breweries from 1999 2001, to becoming president and chief executive officer from 2001to 2007. Previous roles include non-executive director of Inditex S.A. and William Demant A/S. He has also served as managing director of Union Cervecera, chief and Hannen Brauerei executive officer of the drinks division of the Hero Group. Nils was elected as a member and chairman of the supervisory board of Akzo Nobel N.V. in April and 2018 was recently appointed as chairman of WWF Denmark. Nils received his graduate degree from the University of Aarhus. Relevant skills and experience Andersen experienceNils in extensive has having logistics, and goods, retail consumer integrated with corporations global led operations worldwide. He has substantial skill, knowledge and experience in marketing, brand shipping broad has He issues. reputation and energy industry upstream and experience which aligns with BP’s shipping business. His leadership earlier in his career focused leaner businesses, of transformation the on competitiveness, increasing and organizations transparency and increasing as well as communication has with stakeholders. Nils recently moved from the audit committee to assurance environment and ethics safety, the BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 British er Commission of Trilateral rary professor at Manchester University executive director of Air Liquide executive director of (Royal) Navy Board executive director of The Francis Crick t Britain Age Group Triathlete rman The of 100 Group 57 Nationality Institute Grea Brian Gilvary officer financial Chief Non- Non- Non- Chai Memb Hono transition to a lower carbon economy. Under carbon economy. lower a to transition his leadership, BP successfully acquired the lower 48 assets of BHP and in 2018 delivered six major projects as planned. been has performance Dudley’s Bob considered and evaluated by the chairman’s committee. Career Brian Gilvary was appointed chief financial officer on 1 January Therole 2012. includes tax,treasury, finance, for responsibility relations, investor acquisitions, and mergers services, information business global audit, technology and procurement. Healso has accountability for both integrated supply and responsible division shipping the and trading, for BP’s tanker fleet. Brian joined BP in 1986 after obtaining a PhD in mathematics from the University of Manchester. Following a broadrange of roles trading in and downstream upstream, in Europe and the US, he became downstream’s commercial director from 2002 2005. to From 2005 until 2009 he was chief executive of the BP’s function, trading and supply integrated commodity trading arm. In he 2010 was appointed deputy group chief financial officer function. finance the for responsibility with He was a director of TNK-BP over two periods, from 2003 2005 to and from until 2010 the sale of the business and BP’s acquisition of Rosneft equity in 2013. He served on the HM Treasury Financial Management Review Board from 2017. to 2014 Relevant skills and experience with career Brian Gilvary entire his spent has with broad experienceBP, of working across all facets of the group. This has provided him with deep insight BP’s into assets and businesses. Brian has been player a key as BP has implemented its strategy transform to a into ‘value over volume’ based business where trading creator is a key of value throughout the business.integrated In addition underpinning to his role as chief financial officer, his deep understanding of finance and trading has been vital in adjusting capital structures and operational costs while ensuring the group continues be to capable of opportunities. new meeting He played a major role in overseeing the financial consequences of the oil 2010 spill in • • • Age Tenure Appointed the to board 1 January 2012 interests Outside • • • • American British and r of the BritishAmerican the of r Business er of the UAE/UK CEO Forum er of the Emirates Foundation er of the World Economic Forum er of the Management Tsinghua er of the US Business Council er of the US Business Roundtable executive director of Rosneft r of the Oil and Gas Climate Initiative ow of the Royal Academy of Engineering 63 Nationality (WEF) Council Business International (OGCI) Memb Chai University Advisory Board, Beijing, China Membe AdvisoryInternational Board Memb Memb Memb Memb Board of Trustees Group chief executive Fell Non- Memb Bob Dudley Career Bob Dudley became group chief executiveon 2010. October 1 Amoco 1979, joined Bob Corporation in working in a variety of engineering and commercial posts. Between 1994 and 1997 he Russia. in development corporate on worked In 1997 he became general manager for strategy for Amoco and in 1999, following the merger between BP and Amoco, was appointed a similar to role in BP. Between 1999 and 2000 he was executive assistant the to group chief executive, president vice group becoming subsequently for BP’s renewables and alternative energy activities. In 2002 he became group vice president responsible for BP’s upstream businesses in Russia, the Caspianregion, Angola, Egypt. Algeria and From 2003 2008 to he was president and chief executive officer of TNK-BP. On hisreturn to BP in 2009, he was appointed the to BP board and oversaw the activities group’s in the Americas and Asia. During he 2010 served as the president and chief executive officer of BP’s Gulf Coast Restoration Organization in theUS. He wasappointed directora Rosneftof in March following 2013 BP’s acquisition of a stake in Rosneft. Since 2016, he has chaired the Oil and Gas Community of the World Economic Forum and is chair of the Oil and Gas Climate Initiative (OGCI). Relevant skills and experience Bob Dudley has spent his whole career in the oil and gas industry. As group chief executive, the board believes Bob has demonstrated has and vision and leadership outstanding transformed stronger BP a safer, into and simpler business. Over the past eight years, Bob has based this transformation on a consistent set of values and behaviours. BP is now more resilient and is able continue to delivering results in an uncertain economic environment. Bob continues lead to the development of the strategy, group’s as BP adapts the to challenges of the advancing • Age • • • • • • • • Tenure Appointed the to board 6 April 2009 interests Outside •


 
committee where he will shortly take the chair. His broad business experience and his Admiral Frank Bowman Dame Alison Carnwath knowledge of safe operations in our industry Independent non-executive director Independent non-executive director makes him very well qualified for that role. Tenure Tenure Appointed 8 November 2010 Appointed 21 May 2018 Alan Boeckmann Board and committee activities Board and committee activities Independent non-executive director Member of the safety, ethics and environment Member of the audit and chairman’s Tenure assurance, geopolitical and chairman’s committees Appointed 24 July 2014 committees Outside interests Board and committee activities Outside interests • Member of Supervisory Board and Audit Chair of the safety, ethics and environment • President of Strategic Decisions, LLC Committee chair of BASF SE assurance committee; member of the • Director of Morgan Stanley Mutual Funds • Director and Audit Committee chair of Zurich remuneration, nomination and governance • Director of Naval and Nuclear Technologies, Insurance Group and chairman’s committees LLP • Independent director of PACCAR Inc • Member of UK Panel on Takeovers and Outside interests Age 74 Nationality American Mergers • Non-executive director of Sempra Energy • Trustee of The Economist Group • Non-executive director of Archer Daniels Career Midland Frank Bowman served for more than Age 66 Nationality British 38 years in the US Navy, rising to the rank Age 70 Nationality American of Admiral. He commanded the nuclear Career submarine USS City of Corpus Christi and Dame Alison Carnwath qualified as a chartered Career the submarine tender USS Holland. After accountant before going on to hold a number Alan Boeckmann retired as non-executive promotion to flag officer, he served on the of senior financial advisory roles in London and chairman of Fluor Corporation in February joint staff as director of political-military affairs New York. 2012, ending a 35-year career with the and as the chief of naval personnel. He served company. Between 2002 and 2011 he held For more than 15 years, Dame Alison’s career, over eight years as director of the Naval the post of chairman and chief executive in her capacities as senior adviser, director and Nuclear Propulsion Program where he was officer, having previously been president chairman, has enabled her to demonstrate her responsible for the operations of more than and chief operating officer from 2001 to expertise on financial, strategic and good 100 reactors aboard the US Navy’s aircraft 2002. His tenure with the company included governance matters both in and outside of carriers and submarines. responsibility for global operations. As the board room. Her current roles include chairman and chief executive officer, he After his retirement as an Admiral in 2004, independent director of PACCAR Inc, director refocused the company on engineering, he was president and chief executive officer and audit committee chair of Zurich Insurance procurement, construction and maintenance of the Nuclear Energy Institute until 2008. Group and supervisory board member services. He served on the BP Independent Safety and audit committee chair BASF SE. Review Panel and was a member of the BP After graduating from the University of Previous roles of note include chairmanship America External Advisory Council. He holds Arizona with a degree in electrical engineering, of Land Securities Group plc as well as two masters degrees in engineering from he joined Fluor in 1974 as an engineer non-executive directorships of Barclays plc the Massachusetts Institute of Technology. and worked in a variety of domestic and and Man Group plc. He was appointed Honorary Knight international locations, including South Africa Dame Alison is a chartered accountant, holds Commander of the British Empire in 2005. and Venezuela. an undergraduate degree, has two honorary He was elected to the US National Academy degrees and in 2014 was appointed to the order Alan was previously a non-executive director of Engineering in 2009. of BHP Billiton and the Burlington Santa Fe of Dame Commander of the Most Excellent Frank is a member of the US CNA military Corporation, and has served on the boards Order of the British Empire for her services advisory board and has participated in studies of the American Petroleum Institute, the to business and diversity. of climate change and its impact on national National Petroleum Council, the Eisenhower Relevant skills and experience security, and on future global energy solutions Medical Center and the advisory board of Dame Alison has extensive financial and water scarcity. Additionally, he was Southern Methodist University’s Cox School experience both as an executive and non- co-chair of a National Academies study of Business. executive director. Dame Alison has chaired investigating the implications of climate significant boards and has deep experience He led the formation of the World Economic change for naval forces. Forum’s ‘Partnering Against Corruption’ of the workings of investors and the finance Relevant skills and experience initiative in 2004. industry in the City of London. She has Frank Bowman’s exemplary safety record in worked with global organizations and brings Relevant skills and experience running the US Navy’s nuclear submarine this broad range of skills to the BP board Alan Boeckmann has worked in a wide range program indicates his deep understanding and to the audit committee. of industries including engineering, of process safety and its implementation. construction, chemicals and the energy sector. Frank makes a substantial contribution to the He has been involved in delivering very large safety culture within BP. Combined with his projects particularly in the energy industry. In specific knowledge of BP’s safety goals his senior roles he directed the focus of global from his work on the BP Independent Safety corporations towards the advanced technology Review Panel and his special interest in needed to remain competitive in response to climate change, he brings an important the growth of the internet, e-commerce and perspective to the board and the safety, the globalization of the workforce. At the same ethics and environment assurance committee. time, he actively promoted fairness, He has led the oversight of BP’s compliance transparency, accountability and responsibility with the agreements with the US government in business dealings through the ‘Partnering stemming from the Deepwater Horizon Against Corruption’ initiative. oil spill. 60 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 61 Nationality American executive director of AbbVie Inc. ident of Melody Meyer Energy LLC or Advisor Cairn to India Limited tee of Trinity University ctor of the National Bureau of Asian ctor of National Oilwell Varco, Inc. 61 Research Melody Meyer Melody non-executiveIndependent director Pres Dire Trus Non- Seni Dire and the Royal Academy of Engineering and a foreign associate of the US National Academy of Engineering, the Chinese Academy of Engineering andthe French Academy of 18 from honorary has degrees She Sciences. universities, including the University of Oxford, Imperial College London and theKTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm. She was elected President of the Royal Academy of Engineering in September and 2014 in December was 2015 appointed the to Order of Merit. Relevant skills and experience Dame Ann is an internationally respected leader in engineering research and the practical application of new technology in industry. Her contribution in these fields has been widely recognized by universities around the world. Her academic backgroundprovides balance to the board andbrings different a perspective to assurance environment and ethics safety, the committee, particularly in developments as technology accelerate. Her work in this area is supplemented by her chairing the company’s technology advisory council. Dame Ann was chair of the remuneration committee from and 2015 stood down from that committee after the AGM. 2018 Dame Ann is a fellow the of Royal Society in Houston. Gulf Oil later merged with Chevron Melodywhere retirement her until remained • • Age Career Melody Meyer started her career with Gulf Oil in 2016. Melody with career Chevron, During her had Tenure Appointed May 2017 17 Board and committee activities Member of the safety, ethics and environment geopoliticalassurance, chairman’s and committees. interests Outside • • • leadershipkey roles in global exploration and projects international on working production, and operational assignments. In 2004 Melody became vice president for the Gulf of Mexico business unit, and in 2008 became president of the Chevron Energy Technology Company. MelodyFrom 2011 was president of Asia Pacific the for responsible Production, Exploration and financial and operating performance theof upstream assets in nine countries in Chevron’s Asia Pacificregion. Melody was executivethe Network and Women’s Chevron the of sponsor continues as a mentor and advocate for the advancement of women in the industry. She was recognized as a 2009 Trinity Distinguished • BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 vice-chancellor of professor and er of the Prime Minister’s Council for g LLC g Nationality British Nationality British executive directorJohnson of & executive director for All of Teach executive director of Smiths Group plc ident of the Royal Academy of 68 66 Non-executive director Majid of Al Futtaim Holdin Non- Inc. Johnson, Non- Science and Technology Technology and Science Mechanical Engineering at the University Cambridge of Memb Non- Professor Dame Ann Dowling non-executiveIndependent director Pres Engineering Deputy • • • Age Career Ian Davis is senior partner emeritus of McKinsey & Company. He was a partner at McKinsey for years31 until and 2010 served as chairman and managing director between 2003 and 2009. Ian has a MA in Politics, Philosophy and Economics from Balliol College, University of Oxford. Relevant skills and experience Ian Davis brings global financial and strategic experience the to board. He has worked with and organizations global advised and companies in a wide variety of sectors including oil and gas and the public sector. in the Gulf of Mexico and chaired the Gulf of Mexico committee from its formation in 2010 until it was stood down in 2016. He was previously a non-executive director in the Cabinet Office, giving him an important perspective on government affairs which is an asset both to the board and the geopolitical committee. In his role as the senior independent director, Ian is responsible for the annual evaluation of performance search led the and chairman’s the for a successor Carl-Henric to Svanberg as chairman, resulting in the appointment of Helge Lund. He isable draw to on knowledge of diverse issues and outcomes assist to the board and committees.its Ian led the board’s oversight of the response • Career Dame Ann Dowling is a deputy vice-chancellor at the University of Cambridge where she was appointed a professor of mechanical engineering in the department of engineering in 1993. She was head of the department of engineering at the university from 2009 2014. Her to research is in fluid mechanics, acoustics and combustion, and she has held visiting posts at MIT and at advisory technical BP’s chairs She Caltech. council. • Age Tenure Appointed 3 February 2012 Board and committee activities Member of the safety, ethics and environment committees chairman’s assurance and interests Outside • • Nationality American rman of Rolls-Royce Holdings plc ctor of BlackRock, Inc ctor of SecureWorks, Inc 66 Chai Ian Davis director independent Senior Dire Dire Independent non-executive Independent director Pamela Daley Pamela Tenure Appointed 2 April 2010 Board and committee activities geopolitical,Member remuneration, the of nomination and governance and chairman’s committees interests Outside • the General Electric Company. She joined GE in 1989 as tax counsel and held a number of senior executive roles in the company, serving most recently as senior vice president and senior advisor the to chairman from April to December 2013, when she retired from GE. Between 2004 and she 2013 was senior vice president of corporate business development at GE, where she was responsible for GE’s mergers, acquisitions activities divestiture and worldwide, and prior that, to from 1991 2004, to counsel senior served and vice president as transactions. for Pamela Daley has served as a director of BlackRock since and2014 of SecureWorks since 2016. She was a director of BG Group plc until 2016 from to its 2014 acquisition by Shell, a director from 2017 of Patheon to 2016 N.V. and its acquisition Thermountil by Fisher, was previously a partner at Morgan, Lewis & Bockius, a major US law firm, where she specialized in domestic and cross-border tax-oriented financings and commercial transactions. Pamela Daley is a qualified lawyer, she worked in highly regulated industries, holding senior roles on other boards including chair of the at committee nominating and governance SecureWorks and chair of the audit committee BlackRock.at Relevant skills and experience Pamela Daley has deep experience of global business through her executive role at GE. She has also served on a UK board in the oil and gas industry which gave her further insight into that Pamela sector. has joined the audit committee which to she brings deep financial experience expertise. and joined She has also committee, remuneration herthe where points investor and employee of understanding of view will provide important input. Career Pamela Daley spent most of her career with • Age Tenure Appointed 26 July 2018 Board and committee activities Member of the audit, remuneration and committeeschairman’s interests Outside •


 
Alumni, with the BioHouston Women in Science insight into the challenges faced by global Award, was the ASME Rhodes Petroleum businesses by regulatory frameworks. He Sir John Sawers Industry Leadership Award recipient and in 2018 recently joined the remuneration committee. Independent non-executive director as an Influential Woman in Energy. Tenure Relevant skills and experience Paula Rosput Reynolds Appointed 14 May 2015 Melody Meyer has spent her entire career in Independent non-executive director the oil and gas industry. The breadth, variety Board and committee activities and geographic scope of her experience is Tenure Chair of the geopolitical committee; member of distinctive. Her career has been marked by a Appointed 14 May 2015 the safety, ethics and environment assurance, focus on excellence, safety and performance Board and committee activities nomination and governance and chairman’s improvement. She has expertise in the Chair of the remuneration committee; member committees execution of major capital projects, creation of of the audit, nomination and governance and Outside interests businesses in new countries, strategic and chairman’s committees • Chairman and partner of Macro Advisory business planning, merger integration and safe Outside interests Partners LLP and reliable operations. • Non-executive director of BAE Systems plc • Visiting professor at King’s College London Melody brings a world-class operational • Non-executive director of TransCanada • Governor of the Ditchley Foundation perspective to the board, with a deep Corporation (until May 2019) • Trustee of the Bilderberg Association, UK understanding of the factors influencing safe, • Non-executive director of CBRE Group (until Age 63 Nationality British efficient and commercially high-performing May 2019) projects in a global organization. • Non-executive director of General Electric Career Company Sir John Sawers spent 36 years in public service Brendan Nelson Age 62 Nationality American in the UK, working on foreign policy, international security and intelligence. Independent non-executive director Career Sir John was chief of the Secret Intelligence Tenure Paula Rosput Reynolds is the former chairman, Service, MI6, from 2009 to 2014 – a period of Appointed 8 November 2010 president and chief executive officer of Safeco international upheaval and growing security Board and committee activities Corporation, a Fortune 500 property and threats, as well as closer public scrutiny of the Chair of the audit committee; member of the casualty insurance company that was acquired intelligence agencies. Prior to that, the bulk of his chairman’s, nomination and governance and by Liberty Mutual Insurance Group in 2008. She career was in diplomacy, representing the British remuneration committees also served as vice chair and chief restructuring government around the world and leading officer for American International Group (AIG) for negotiations at the UN, in the European Union Outside interests a period after the US government became the and in the G8. He was the UK ambassador to • Non-executive director and chairman of the financial sponsor from 2008 to 2009. the United Nations from 2007 to 2009, political group audit committee of The Royal Bank of director and main board member of the Foreign Scotland Group plc Previously Paula was an executive in the energy Office from 2003 to 2007, special representative • Member of the Financial Reporting Review industry. She was chairman, president and chief in Iraq during 2003, ambassador to Egypt from Panel executive officer of AGL Resources Inc., an operator of natural gas infrastructure in the US, 2001 to 2003 and foreign policy adviser to the Age 69 Nationality British now a subsidiary of Southern Company. Prior Prime Minister from 1999 to 2001. Earlier in his to this, she led a subsidiary of Duke Energy career, he was posted to Washington, South Career Corporation that was a merchant operator of Africa, Syria and Yemen. Brendan Nelson is a chartered accountant. electricity generation. She commenced her Sir John is now chairman of Macro Advisory He was made a partner of KPMG in 1984. He energy career at PG&E Corp. Partners, a firm that advises clients on the served as a member of the UK board of KPMG intersection of policy, politics and markets. from 2000 to 2006, subsequently being Paula was awarded the National Association of appointed vice chairman until his retirement in Corporate Directors (US) Lifetime Achievement Relevant skills and experience 2010. At KPMG International he held a number Award in 2014. Sir John’s deep experience of international of senior positions including global chairman, Relevant skills and experience political and commercial matters is an asset to banking and global chairman, financial services. Paula Rosput Reynolds has had a long career the board in navigating the geopolitical issues faced by a modern global company. Sir John He served for six years as a member of the leading global companies in the energy and brings a unique perspective and broad Financial Services Practitioner Panel and in 2013 financial sectors. Her financial background and experience which makes him ideal to lead the was the president of the Institute of Chartered deep experience of trading makes her ideally geopolitical committee. His knowledge and Accountants of Scotland. suited to serve on the audit committee. skills gained in government, diplomacy and Her experience with international and US Relevant skills and experience policy analysis and advice are invaluable to companies, including several restructuring Brendan Nelson has completed a wide variety both the board and the safety, ethics and processes and mergers, gives her insight into of audit, regulatory and due-diligence environment assurance committee. engagements over the course of his career. strategic and regulatory issues, which is an asset to the board. He played a significant role in the development Jens Bertelsen of the profession’s approach to the audit of Paula currently serves as the chair of the banks in the UK, with particular emphasis on remuneration committee of BAE Systems plc. Company secretary establishing auditing standards. He continues Her experience there and her wider business Tenure to contribute in his role as a member of the experience and understanding of the views of Appointed 1 January 2019 Financial Reporting Review Panel. investors are well suited to her being the chair Jens Bertelsen is a solicitor and formerly This wide experience makes him ideally suited of the BP remuneration committee. deputy secretary. to chair the audit committee and to act as its financial expert. He brings related input from his role as the chair of the audit committee of a major bank. His specialism in the financial services industry allows him to contribute 62 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 63 Bernard Looney Bernard British tee of the John Foundation Lyons ow of the UK Royal Academy of ow of the Institute of Materials, Minerals ow of the Institute of Directors 58 Nationality David Eyton Group head of technology Fell Engineering Fell and Mining Fell Trus Executive team tenure Appointed 1 September 2018 interests Outside • Career As group head of technology, David Eyton is accountable for technology strategy and its implementation This includes across BP. and capital investments corporate venture areas in development conducting and research of corporate renewal. In this role, David sits on the Oil & Gas Climate Initiative Climate Board. Investments David joined BP in 1982 from Cambridge University engineering degree. with an • • • Age Andy Hopwood Andy Strank Angela Dame BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Bob Fryar Schuster Helmut   The executive team represents theprincipal executive leadership of the BP group. Its members include BP’s executive directors (Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary whose biographies appear on pages 58-62) and the senior management listed on these pages. er of the Turkish-British Chamber of er of the Strategic Advisory Board of Nationality Turkish British and 59 Commerce & Industry Board of Directors the University of Surrey Tufan Erginbilgic Tufan Chief executive, Downstream Memb Memb Career ErginbilgicTufan was appointed chief executive, Downstream on 1 October 2014. Prior was this, to the chief Tufan operating officer of the fuels business, accountablefor BP’s fuels value chains worldwide, the global fuels businesses and the refining, sales and commercial fuels. optimization functions for joinedTufan Mobil in 1990 and BP in 1997 and has held a wide variety of roles in refining various European Turkey, in marketing and UK. the and countries He became head of the European fuels business in 2004 and took up leadership of BP’s lubricant business in 2006, before moving headto the group chief office. executive’s In 2009 he became chief operating officerfor the chains and value fuels eastern hemisphere businesses. lubricants Outside BP, SusanOutside is a member BP, of the Board andAmerican Institute Petroleum Executive Committee, the Greater Houston Partnership Executive Committee, the and Ford’s Theatre Board Executive Trustees of Committee. • Age Executive team tenure 2014 October 1 Appointed interests Outside • Dev Sanyal David Eyton Eric Nitcher Eric Tufan Erginbilgic Tufan 2019 American er of the American Petroleum Institute Partnership Houston Greater the of er er of the Ford’s Theatre Board of Nationality 58 Board and Executive Committee Executive and Board Committee Executive Memb Committee Executive Trustees Memb Memb Susan Dio Chairman and president of BP America Susan Dio Susan As at 29 March Executive team Lamar McKay • • Age Career Susan Dio is chairman and president of BP oversight and leadership America, providing Executive team tenure Appointed 1 September2018 interests Outside • BP’sto US businesses, which employ around 14,000 people. These businesses include oil refining, production, and exploration gas and pipeline trading, and supply petrochemicals, alternative and retail, shipping, operations, energy. Since joining the company in 1984, she has held operational key and executive positions in the US, UK, and Australia. Before assuming Susan served role, chief as current her executive officer of BP shipping, where she managed the fleet of BP-operated and chartered vessels that move more than 200 million tonnes of products across the globe year. each She also previously served as head of audit for unit business segment, downstream as BP’s leader of the Bulwer Island refinery, and as plant manager City of Texas chemicals.


 
Most recently, Andy was appointed chief where he led BP’s efforts to restructure the Bob Fryar operating officer, upstream strategy in April governance framework for TNK-BP. In 2009 Executive vice president, safety 2018. Lamar was appointed chairman and president and operational risk of BP America, serving as BP’s chief Bernard Looney representative in the US. In January 2013, he Executive team tenure became chief executive, upstream, Appointed 1 October 2010 Chief executive, Upstream responsible for exploration, development and Outside interests Executive team tenure production, serving in the role until April 2016. No external appointments Appointed 1 November 2010 Age 55 Nationality American Outside interests Eric Nitcher • Fellow of the Royal Academy of Engineering Group general counsel Career • Fellow of the Energy Institute Bob Fryar is responsible for strengthening Executive team tenure Age 48 Nationality Irish safety, operational risk management and the Appointed 1 January 2017 systematic management of operations across Career Outside interests the BP group. He is group head of safety and Bernard Looney is responsible for the No external appointments operational risk, with accountability for Upstream segment which consists of Age 56 Nationality American group-level disciplines including engineering, exploration, development and production. health, safety, security, remediation Career management and the environment. In this Bernard joined BP in 1991 as a drilling Eric Nitcher is responsible for legal matters capacity, he looks after the group-wide engineer, working in the North Sea, Vietnam across the BP group. operating management system and the Gulf of Mexico. In 2005 he became implementation and capability programmes. senior vice president for BP Alaska before Eric began his career in the late 1980s working becoming head of the group chief executive’s as a litigation and regulatory lawyer in Wichita, Bob has over 30 years’ experience in the office in 2007. Kansas. He joined Amoco in 1990 and over the oil and gas industry, having joined Amoco years has held a wide variety of roles, both Production Company in 1985. Between 2010 In 2009 he became the managing director within and outside the US. and 2013 Bob was executive vice president of of BP’s North Sea business in the UK and the production division, accountable for safe Norway. At the same time, Bernard became In 2000, Eric moved to London to work in the and compliant exploration and production a member of the Oil & Gas UK Board. He mergers and acquisitions legal team where operations and stewardship of resources became executive vice president, he played a key role in the formation of the across all regions. developments in October 2010, and in Russian joint venture TNK-BP. Eric returned to February 2013 became chief operating officer, Houston in 2007 where he served as special Prior to this, Bob was chief executive of BP production, serving in the role until April 2016. counsel and chief of staff to BP America’s Angola and also held several management chairman and president. positions in Trinidad, including chief operating officer for Atlantic LNG and vice president of Lamar McKay Most recently he played a leading role in operations. Bob has also served in a variety of Deputy group chief executive the settlement of the Deepwater Horizon US engineering and management positions in government claims and resolution of many of onshore US and the deepwater Gulf of Mexico. Executive team tenure the remaining private claims. Appointed 16 June 2008 Andy Hopwood Outside interests Dev Sanyal No external appointments Executive vice-president, chief operating Chief executive, alternative energy and officer, upstream strategy Age 60 Nationality American executive vice president, regions Executive team tenure Career Executive team tenure Appointed 1 November 2010 Lamar McKay is accountable for group Appointed 1 January 2012 Outside interests strategy and long-term planning, group Outside interests No external appointments economics, safety and operational risk, group • Independent non-executive director Age 61 Nationality British technology and the legal function. In addition of Man Group plc to supporting the group chief executive, he • Member of the Accenture Global Career also focuses on various corporate governance Energy Board Andy Hopwood is responsible for BP’s upstream activities including ethics and compliance. • Member of the Board of Advisors of strategy. Lamar started his career in 1980 with Amoco The Fletcher School of Law and Diplomacy, Tufts University Andy joined BP in 1980, spending his first 10 and held a range of technical and leadership • Member, International Advisory Board of the years in operations in the North Sea, Wytch Farm roles. Ministry of Petroleum and Natural Gas, and Indonesia. In 1989 Andy joined the corporate During 1998 to 2000, he worked on the Government of India planning team formulating BP’s upstream BP-Amoco merger and served as head of • Member of the Advisory Board of the Centre strategy and subsequent portfolio rationalization. strategy and planning for the exploration and for European Reform Andy held commercial leadership positions in production business. In 2000 he became Age 53 Nationality British and Indian Mexico and Venezuela before becoming the business unit leader for the central North Sea. upstream’s planning manager. In 2001 he became chief of staff for Career exploration and production, and subsequently Following the BP-Amoco merger, Andy spent Dev Sanyal is responsible for alternative for BP’s deputy group chief executive. Lamar time leading BP’s businesses in Azerbaijan, energy globally and for the group’s interests in became group vice president, Russia and Trinidad & Tobago and onshore North America. In the Europe and Asia regions. 2009 he joined the upstream executive team as Kazakhstan in 2003. He served as a member head of portfolio and technology and in 2010 was of the board of directors of TNK-BP between Dev joined BP in 1989 and has held a variety of appointed executive vice president, exploration February 2004 and May 2007. international roles in London, Athens, Istanbul, Vienna and Dubai. He was general manager, and production. In 2007 he was appointed executive vice former Soviet Union and Eastern Europe, prior president, BP America. In 2008 he became to being appointed chief executive, BP Eastern executive vice president, special projects 64 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 65 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Nationality British rary Fellow of the Energy Institute rary Professor of Earth Sciences, executive director plc of Severn Trent ow of the Royal Society ow of the Royal Academy of Engineering 66 Non- Fell Fell Hono Hono Dame Angela Strank Angela Dame BP chief scientist and head of downstreamtechnology, University Manchester of • • Executive team tenure Appointed 1 September 2018 interests Outside • • Age Career Dame Angela Strank is responsible for petrochemicals, BP’s across technology refining, fuels and lubricants businesses. As BP’s chief scientist sheis accountable for in advances from insights strategic developing capability in technology managing and science BP. Dame Angela joined BP in 1982 as a geologist in exploration and has held various technical across roles leadership commercial and chief including: downstream and upstream BP/ officer lubricants financial (Americas), business Nigeria, manager alliance Statoil Angola, technology manager development vice president, and head of the BP group chief office.executive’s In Dame 2010 Angela won the UK First AwardWomen’s in Science and Technology, and was in 2018 the first womanreceiveto the UK Energy Institute’s Cadman Award. DameIn 2017 Angela was awarded a Dame Commander of the Order of the British Empire in Her Majesty the Queen’s Birthday Honours List for services the to oil industry and women and engineering technology, science, in mathematics (STEM). Angela from honoraryDame holds degrees Royal Holloway University, London (DSc) and the University of Bradford. • Nationality British Austrian and executive director of Ivoclar 58 Non- Helmut SchusterHelmut Executive vice president, group human director resources Vivadent AG, Germany Mediterranean in1999. In November 2003 he was appointed chief executive, Air BP Internationaland in June 2006 was appointed head of the group chief office. executive’s In 2007, he assumed the role of group vice During this treasurer. group and president period he wasalso chairman of BP investment accountablemanagement was the and for aluminiumgroup’s interests. Until April 2016, Dev was executive vice president, strategy and regions. Executive team tenure Appointed 1 March 2011 interests Outside • Age Career became Schuster Helmut human group resources (HR) director In this in March 2011. role he is accountable for the BP human function. resources He completed his post graduate diploma in international relations and his PhD in economics at the University of Vienna and then began his career working for Henkel in a marketing capacity. Since joining BP in 1989 Helmut has held a number of leadership roles. He has worked in BP in theUS, UK and continental Europe and within most parts of power. and gas and trading marketing, refining, Before taking on his current role, his portfolio of responsibilitiesas vice president, HR included the refining and marketing segment of BP and corporate and functions. That role saw him leading the people agenda for roughly 60,000 people across the globe that included petrochemicals,businesses as such fuels value chains, lubricants and functional experts group. the across Outside of his role, Helmut is a non-executive director of Ivoclar Vivadent. Additionally, he is an alumni and advocate of AFS, which is an NGO that promotes intercultural learning.


 
Executive management teams Upstream 1. David Campbell 3. Murray Auchincloss 6. Nigel Jones 9. Tony Brock President, BP Russia Chief financial officer Associate general counsel Head of safety and operational risk 2. William Lin 4. Gordon Birrell 7. Andy Hopwood Chief operating officer, Chief operating officer, production, Chief operating officer, 10. James Dupree upstream regions transformation and carbon upstream strategy Chief operating officer, developments and technology 5. Kerry Dryburgh 8. Bernard Looney Head of human resources Chief executive 8 10 1 6 3 5 4 2 7 9 Other business and functions leaders 1. Steve Fortune 4. Geoff Morrell 7. Nick Wayth 10. Joan Wales Chief information officer, information Group head of communications Chief development officer, Head of safety and operational technology and services and external affairs alternative energy risk, other businesses and corporate 2. Craig Marshall 5. David Anderson 8. David Jardine 11. Jan Lyons Group head of investor relations Chief financial officer, Group head of audit Group head of tax alternative energy 3. Camille Drummond 9. David Bucknall Vice president of global 6. Trudi Charles Group controller and chief financial business services Associate general counsel, officer, other businesses and corporate integrated supply and trading and BP shipping 3 9 4 7 2 8 11 6 1 5 5 10 66 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 67 22 23 9 21. Spencer21. Dale Group chief economist Saxena Rahul 22. compliance and officer ethics Group Thomson Kate 23. treasurer Group 10 9. Andy Holmes Holmes Andy 9. Chief operating officer, fuels ASPAC and Air BP Strank Angela 10. Head of technology and scientist chief BP 21 20 8 and disciplinesthat support our executive team’s work. These include experts in fields such as renewable energy, finance, trading, technology and digital, and tax and treasury. Job titles correct as at 1 January 2019. Our diverse and talented leaders have a wide range of skills 18 19 7 17 18. Alan Haywood Chief executive officer, integrated trading and supply 19. Robert Lawson Global head of mergers acquisitionsand 20. Laura Folse Chief executive officer, energywind, alternative BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 6. Rita Griffin Chief operating officer, petrochemicals Michael7. Sosso Associate counsel, general shipping BP and downstream 8. Mike O’Sullivan Chief financial officer 6 5 16 4 15 3 strategic planning strategic Lindenhayn Mario 16. Chief executive officer, biofuels, energyalternative Knight Lucy 17. president, vice resources Human corporate activities business functions and 15. Dominic Emery Vice president, group 3. Tufan Erginbilgic Tufan 3. executive Chief Gardiner Evelyn 4. Head of human resources Sparkman Doug 5. Chief operating officer, fuels, Northfuels, America 14 2 13 1 12 Other business and functions leaders lubricants 2. Guy Moeyens Chief operating officer, fuels, Southern and AfricaEurope Downstream Mandhir Singh 1. Chief operating officer, 12. David Windle Head of solar and renewable products, energyalternative Howle Carol 13. Chief executive officer, BP shipping and chief operatingofficer, global oil, trading and supply integrated Pillai Ashok 14. Vice president, group reward


 
Introduction from the chairman engagement it has with both our people and with our wider community of stakeholders. As a board, we fully support this – it builds on the work we already do, and we will continue to evolve and enhance this engagement and provide more detail next year. Our oversight of the significant risks (such as operational, compliance and cyber security) facing BP continues. Both the audit committee and the safety, ethics and environmental assurance committee (SEEAC) continue to review these in depth and receive assurance from manage- ment as to how they are understood and mitigated to the level of risk acceptable to the board. In this regard, I want to once again pay tribute to the exceptional service over many years of Alan Boeckmann and Admiral Frank Bowman on the SEEAC and welcome Nils Andersen to the role of SEEAC chair. Brendan Nelson continues to chair the audit committee and brings enormous financial and regulatory experience and expertise to the role. I also want to thank Sir John Sawers for all his work chairing the geopolitical committee. John brings unique insight and experience to BP’s culture is well grounded with the right his role and the committee does important work overseeing significant values and behaviours embedded by the political and related risks in key geographies where BP operates. board and the senior leadership. The nomination and governance committee continues to review the skills that we need while always considering diversity and the need for independent thinking and challenge. The committee will also continue to review the size of the board to confirm that it is appropriate with a good mix of skills, experience and knowledge and the ability to maintain It is now nine months since I joined BP, initially as a non-executive appropriate oversight of the executive team and provide constructive director. In that time, my experience has confirmed the very positive challenge and support. impression of BP’s culture and values I arrived with. Based on my time spent in the business, the values of safety, respect, excellence, courage Executive remuneration remains a significant issue and we appreciated and one team are clearly embedded and genuinely lived. I see a culture the strong support that was given to our remuneration report at last that is grounded, responsible and humble – by which I mean one where year’s AGM. This was the second year in which our three-year policy, people have confidence in their capabilities and the strategy, but not developed following extensive engagement with shareholders, was in complacency or arrogance, and with a strong desire to learn and develop. effect. Paula Reynolds is working with the remuneration committee in I firmly believe that is the right combination for maintaining safe implementing that policy this year and to develop the new three-year operations, earning the trust of stakeholders and embracing the policy for which shareholder approval will be sought in 2020. Paula is challenges and opportunities the energy transition presents. A priority for currently in the process of reducing her directorship commitments my chairmanship is to see that the board continues to help sustain and with other companies during 2019 to ensure that she can retain her evolve this positive culture by having the right capability around the table strong focus on chairing the remuneration committee. and the right engagement with stakeholders outside the boardroom. You will see from Paula’s report on page 83 that the committee continues to exercise appropriate discretion in relation to executive Board capability remuneration. From 2019 we are linking BP’s progress towards one BP’s board has evolved considerably during Carl-Henric Svanberg’s of our emissions reduction targets to the remuneration of a significant tenure. Together we will look to continue its development and find number of our employees, including executive directors. the right balance of continuity and renewal. In my letter on page 6, I mentioned Dame Alison Carnwath and Pamela Daley joining the board Engaging with stakeholders in 2018, and that this year we are losing the distinguished services of Remuneration is just one issue where I believe dialogue is invaluable, Admiral Frank Bowman and Alan Boeckmann. and I will continue to encourage the board to meet with a range of Ian Davis is now in his 10th year as a director and continues as our senior stakeholders, including investors, partners, and our people, and gain independent director, having held this role since 2017. I have huge first-hand experience of BP’s businesses and operations around the respect and regard for Ian’s skills and experience and, to provide the world. Over the past year, board members visited BP operations in the continuity that I believe is critical I have asked him to extend his service US, UK and Oman and individual members also took opportunities to to at least the AGM in 2020. Ian continues to demonstrate constructive visit BP sites when travelling and pursuing their other interests and challenge and engagement both in the board and with executive business activities. Personally, I have already visited our operations in management. The board therefore retains complete confidence in Ian’s several countries including in the UK, the US, China, Oman and the independence and supports his re-election in this capacity. Netherlands. I look forward to making many more visits this year and sharing my observations and reflections in due course. Governance and remuneration processes Finally, I am grateful to Bob, the executive team, our employees and my We have spent considerable time evaluating the work of the board and colleagues on the board for all of their hard work, their commitment to its committees, for which we also brought in external expertise to BP and for the way that they have so warmly welcomed me into the facilitate our discussions. This was a very valuable exercise and resulted company. I am excited for our future. in a number of recommendations that I am considering with the board, and certain changes to our ways of working have already been made. Details of these changes will be included in a revised set of board governance principles to be published later this year. Looking outwards, there were changes to UK legislation and governance requirements during 2018 that have now come into effect. Helge Lund In particular, the board is required to understand more deeply the Chairman 68 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 69 utive gation ernance 64 4 6 4 21 6 2 6 1 6 6 6 Chairman’s Chairman’s committee Gov Dele Exec limitations process model Delegation ofDelegation through authority policy with monitoring Accountability Assurance through and monitoring reporting BP boardBP governance principles: • BP goal • • • Accountability    3 3 6 4 32 33 1 2 1 6 1 6 6 6 3 3 6 6 iance Nomination governance and committee (if More information putation surance   p ethics rnal market ty and ness arch compl rational rational risk ependent ependent ependent ependent for the board for the board See bp.com/governance governance principles. ormation equested) integrity auditor adviser (if relevant) Ind advice r Ind (asassurance needed) Safe ope Grou and Busi Exte re and rese Ind Ind Monitoring, inf • • • • • • and as and • Group audit Finance • • • 21 2 4 1 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 6 6 Geopolitical committee ttee  Group renewal renewal Group committee Audit Audit commi See page 75  7 7 4 4 3 3 6 6 Remuneration Remuneration committee CM)   (R ng mitments mitments mittee meeti Resource com Geopolitical com See page 84 31 2 1 44 4 3 7 7 7 7 Paula Reynolds missed a board meeting due to a pre-existing external commitment. John Sawers missed a board meeting due to other commitments. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Joint audit/Joint SEEAC Group ethics compliance and committee (GECC) Safety, ethics and environment assurance committee See page 81 266 2 4 1 6 4 4 1 6 2 3 76 6 4 5 66 4 4 3 6 4 4 3 4 SEEAC  ittee BP board Group people people Group comm (GPC) Audit Audit committee Owners/shareholders Group chief executive Executive management Executive  mittee ttee ttee Strategy/group risks/annual plan Strategy/group  B B A B A B A B A B A B A B A B ) Group chief executive’s delegations executive’s chief Group losure Chairman’s Chairman’s com See page 85 Group disc commi (GDC    499 4 5 7 4 9 9 59 3 54 9 29 9 4 9 4 2 9 8 9 9 8 9 8 9 9 8 99 9 8 7 6 1 1 4 4 9 9 9 9 A A Board ttee nancial fi ) C k k committee Remuneration See page 87 commi Group Group ris (GFR  C) governance Group operations risk committee (GOR See page 86 Nomination and committee Delegation Paul AndersonPaul Alan Boeckmann+ Frank Bowman Alison Carnwath Pamela Daley Ian Davis Ann Dowling Helge Lund+ Meyer Melody Brendan Nelson+ Paula Reynolds+ John Sawers+ Executive directors Bob Dudley Nils AndersenNils Non-executive directors Carl-Heneric Svanberg Brian Gilvary A = Total number of meetings the director was eligibleto attend. B = Total number of meetings the director did attend. + Committee chair. Nils Andersen missed a board meeting due to a pre-existing external commitment. personal circumstances. unforeseen to due board the of Alan meetings Boeckmann missed Pamela Daley missed a board meeting due to a pre-existing external commitment. Melody Meyer missed a board meeting due to other commitments. Board and committee and Board attendance BP governance framework The board operates within a system of governance that is set out in the BPboard governance principles. These principles define therole of the board, its processes and itsrelationship withexecutive management. This system is reflected in the governance of the subsidiaries. group’s


 
Board activity in 2018 Role of the board The board is responsible for the overall conduct of the group’s business. Directors have duties under both UK company law and BP’s Articles of Association. The primary tasks of the board in 2018 included: 1Active consideration and direction Monitoring of BP’s Ensuring that the principal risks and Board and executive of long-term strategy and approval performance against the uncertainties to BP are identified and that management of the annual plan strategy and plan systems of risk management and control succession are in place Strategy Performance and monitoring During the year the board It received regular reports on The board reviews financial • Quarterly and full-year results. provided input on the group’s the progress and implementation and operational performance • Shareholder distributions. strategy to senior management. of the strategy – through updates at each meeting. It receives The board reviews the quarterly This included a two-day strategy from management and by means regular updates on the group’s and full-year results, including session in September where it of a strategic performance performance for the year across the shareholder distribution examined developments in the scorecard which is discussed a range of metrics as well as the policy. The 2018 annual report wider environment and debated at each board meeting. latest view on expected full-year was assessed in terms of the strategic themes relating to delivery against external BP’s segments, key functions The board monitored the directors’ obligations and scorecard measures. Updates and the impact of the lower company’s performance against appropriate regulatory are also given on various carbon transition on the group’s the annual plan for 2018 and requirements. components of value delivery for business model. The board approved the forward framework discussed the transition to a for the annual plan for 2019. BP’s business. Regular reports The board monitors employee lower carbon world frequently presented to the board include: opinion via an annual ‘pulse’ The board reviewed the BP survey which includes during the year. • Chief executive’s report. Energy Outlook, updated measurement of how the BP • Group performance report. The board also held several in February 2018, which looks values are incorporated into long-term strategy sessions at long-term energy trends and • Group financial outlook. culture around our global covering upstream, downstream projections for world energy • Effectiveness of investment operations. and the future plans for the markets. review. integrated supply and trading function that supports them. Risk Succession The board, either directly The board reviewed the group The board, in conjunction with • Paul Anderson stood down or through its monitoring risk of cyber security in 2017 – the nomination and governance from the board at the 2018 committees, regularly reviews with the audit committee and and chairman’s committees, AGM. the processes whereby risks SEEAC assessing elements of reviews succession plans for • Alison Carnwath was elected are identified, evaluated and cyber security risk in their work executive and non-executive as a director at the 2018 AGM. managed. programme for the year. The directors on a regular basis. allocation of the group cyber The board needs to ensure • Helge Lund and Pamela Activities include: security risk to the board (with that potential candidates are Daley joined the board in • Assessing the effectiveness of additional monitoring by the audit identified and evaluated as July 2018 as non-executive the group’s system of internal and SEEA committees) remains current directors reach the director and chairman control and risk management unchanged for 2019. The group end of their recommended designate, and non-executive as part of the review of the risks allocated to the committees term of office, including in the director, respectively. BP Annual Report and Form for review over the year are event of a director leaving 20-F 2017. • Carl-Henric Svanberg stepped outlined in the reports of the unexpectedly. down as non-executive • Identification and subsequent committees on pages 75-86. The board employs executive director and chairman of the allocation of risks to the board Further information on BP’s search firms when it concludes board effective 31 December and monitoring committees system of risk management is that this is an effective way of 2018, succeeded by Helge (the audit, SEEA and outlined in How we manage risk finding suitable candidates. In Lund with effect from geopolitical committees) for on page 53. 2018 Egon Zehnder assisted 1 January 2019. 2018, and confirmation of the in the search for non-executive schedule for oversight. • Alan Boeckmann and directors. Egon Zehnder has no Frank Bowman will stand other connection with the down from the board at company or individual directors. the 2019 AGM. 70 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 71 3 5 8 1 1 9 6 1 2 8 4 4 Tenure (years) Non Non UK/US Evaluation Female Diversity Regulatory/ government affairs Brand/ marketing/ reputation annual re-electionannual shareholders. by While the chairman’s letter of appointment sets out the time commitment expected of him, those for NEDs do not set a fixed-time commitment, but instead set a general guide of between 30-40 days Theper year. time required of directors may fluctuate depending on demands of BP business and other events. They are expected to allocate sufficient timeto to BP perform their dutieseffectively and make themselves available for all regular and ad hoc meetings. The that, notwithstandingboard appointments, believes other NEDs’ the they have sufficient timeto fulfil their BP duties. Executive directors are permitted take to up one board appointment at an external listed company, subject the to agreement of the chairman. term limit on a director’s service, as BP proposes all directors for The board is satisfied that there is no compromiseto the independence and nothingof, give to rise conflicts to those of interestfor, directors who serve together as directors on the boards of other entities or who hold other external appointments. The nomination and governance committee keeps the other interests of the NEDs under review to ensure that the effectiveness of the board is not compromised. Ian Davis is proposed for re-election notwithstanding he will be in his consideration, careful Following non-executive a director. as year tenth the board believes that Ian continues provide to constructive challenge and robust scrutiny of matters that come before the board. Accordingly, the board is satisfied that Ian continuesto demonstrate the qualities of independence in carrying out his role as senior independent director. Appointment commitment time and The chairman and NEDs have letters of appointment. There is no BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 of new directors Training including Training site visits and induction Safety Financial expertise Engineering/ Engineering/ technology Diversity including skills, ethnicity experience, gender, tenure and Oil and gas/ extractives/ energy Background Succession planning to to planning Succession diversity future ensure balanceand Alan Boeckmann Frank Bowman Alison Carnwath Pamela Daley Ian Davis Ann Dowling Lund Helge Meyer Melody NelsonBrendan Paula Reynolds John Sawers Non-executive director AndersenNils Background and diversity in character and judgement and free from any business or other that with exercising interfere could materially that relationship judgement. It is the board’s view that all NEDs are independent. Diversity Diversity BP recognizes the importance of diversity, including gender, at the board and all levels of the group. We are committed increasing to diversity across our operations and have a wide range of activities supportto the development and promotion talented of individuals, regardless of gender and social and ethnic background. The board operates a policy that aims promote to diversity in its composition. Under this policy, director appointments are evaluated against the existing balance of skills, knowledge and experience on the board, with directors asked be to mindful of diversity, inclusiveness and meritocracy considerations board. nominations the when examining to Implementation of this policy is monitored through agreed metrics. During its annual evaluation, the board considered diversity as part of on our board Our of 14. nomination and governance committee actively considers diversity in seeking potential candidates for appointment to board.the The board looked at gender and wider diversity across the group as part of its annual review of HR, capability and talent management. BP continues take to action address to the broader issue of diversity within the group. Independence Non-executive directors (NEDs) are expected be to independent the review of its performance and effectiveness. At the end of 2018, there were fivefemale directors 3, 2016: 3)(2017: Skills and expertise and Skills In order carry to out its duties on behalf of shareholders, the board needs manage to its overall membership and continuously maintain its knowledge and expertise benefit to the business. It does this throughfour activity sets:


 
Fees received for an external appointment may be retained by the Board evaluation executive director and are reported in the directors’ remuneration report BP undertakes an annual review of the board, its committees and (see page 87). Neither the chairman nor the senior independent director individual directors. The chairman’s performance is evaluated by are employed as an executive of the group. the chairman’s committee and his evaluation is led by the senior independent director. The evaluation operates on a three-year cycle, Training and induction with one externally led evaluation followed by two subsequent years To help develop an understanding of BP’s business, the board continues of internal evaluations carried out using a questionnaire prepared by to build its knowledge through briefings and site visits. In 2018, the an external facilitator. board continued to receive training on ethics and compliance. Activity following prior year evaluation NEDs are expected to visit at least one business a year as part of their Actions arising from the 2017 evaluation and how these were learning programme. In 2018, the board as a whole visited operations addressed included: at the Khazzan gas field in Oman. Members of the SEEAC and other • Ongoing focus on capital allocation: the board continued to develop directors also visited the Cooper River petrochemicals plant in the US and deepen its understanding of the capital allocation process and and the Thunder Horse platform in the Gulf of Mexico. the way in which investment decisions were taken. Newly appointed NEDs follow a structured induction process. In 2018, • Longer term vision and strategy: the board held three ‘deep dive’ Helge Lund, Alison Carnwath and Pamela Daley all participated in the discussions to explore the group’s longer-term vision and strategy, induction programme, which includes one-to-one meetings with including challenges in BP’s core businesses as well as the transition management and the external auditors and other management who to a lower carbon economy. support the board and committees. Pamela Daley’s induction is set out below as an example. • Employee views on safety and culture: the board developed a greater understanding of employee views within the group, particularly through review of more detailed data from the annual Pulse Survey, by using the Technology Advisory Council (TAC) reports and through site visits, town halls and employee engagement forums. • International advisory board: the board reviewed the relationship Director induction programme between the board, the geopolitical committee and the international advisory board (IAB). Directors were invited to IAB dinners to hear the debate on broader issues. I deeply appreciate the 2018 evaluation quality of the BP induction The evaluation was undertaken through a questionnaire facilitated by programme and the BP an external consultant (Independent Audit) and individual interviews team’s dedication to between the consultant and the chairman and each director and other educating me. executives. The results of the evaluation and feedback from the interviews were collectively discussed by the board and will be incorporated into a revised version of the board governance principles that will be published later this year. Pamela Daley Non-executive director Pamela Daley, appointed in 2018, followed a tailored induction process. The programme of topics included: Board and governance Functional input • BP’s board governance • Communications and model, directors’ duties, corporate reporting interests and potential • Ethics and compliance conflicts. • External audit • Finance Business introduction • Human resources, including • Alternative energy capability and reward • BP’s business • Legal, including litigation • BP’s performance relative • Safety to competitors • Treasury • Downstream (refining, • Tax marketing and lubricants) • Integrated supply and Audit committee specific trading (IST) • Reporting and disclosure • Lower carbon transition • Business ‘deep dives’ • Strategy including IST risks and • Financial planning compliance and procurement • Upstream (exploration, • Cyber security and trading development, production, regulations. overview of our operations) 72 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 73 Workforce engagement Melody Meyer visited the Muscat office in March meet to with women from BP Oman, Houston, US Alongside the SEEAC visit in members July, of the board also spent time in the Houston office,following the damage caused by Hurricane They Harvey spent time in 2017. with BP’s US-based integrated supply and trading team and learned about the execution of business continuity planning following Harvey. They visited group key monitoring, across centres response and communication multiple businesses. as part of an empowering women in business supporting and helping advocated She event. women saying, all have “we a part play to in this, we can help ensure our female colleagues’ voices Melody are heard.” highlighted the need focus to on driving value, creating advantage from change, showing contribution. valuing and respect Melody also conducted a town hall at our Houston office in July and Paula Reynolds led a BP international woman’s network event at BP’s London head office in December. Cooper US River, In September membersof the SEEAC and other directors visited Cooper BP’s River, Southpetrochemicals in Carolina. plant Board members met with site leaders and discussed business emergency continuity planning, safety, risk and operating culture at the plant. They also heard about new technologies. sustainability-related BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 in the central processing facility control room. They met site staff over lunchand concluded their visit by meeting a local tribal leader who securing community in had been instrumental support Khazzan the for development. offices and accommodation, and spent time Manchester, UK Manchester, In May the board attended the ICAM, where they met with leading academics better to is research in understand investment how advancehelping fundamental understanding and use of materials across a variety of energy applications. industrial and Site visits Site Khazzan, Oman The board visited the Khazzan gas field in Oman, touring the facility and meeting with local staff. They experienced the scale of the field first hand following start-up of theproject. camp residential new They the visited also SEEAC and the audit committee chair visited Thunder Horse in Their July. trip included a half-day session with the Gulf of Mexico upstream leadership team followed by a day offshore. The regional president led the site visit and facilitated thorough discussion of challenges and risks the practices, working faced on site and management of those risks. The visit demonstrated the safety culture on board the rig. Thunder Horse, US NEDs visit at least one business every year help to deepen their operational understanding. In 2018, the board visited the Khazzan gas field in Oman and the International Centrefor Advanced Materials (ICAM), of which BP is a significant sponsor, at the University of Manchester. Members of the SEEAC and other directors visited upstream and downstream operations in the Gulf of Mexico and South Carolina respectively. The board met local management and were briefed at each visit and subsequently provided their feedback the to appropriate committee and the to board. A number of non-executives took the opportunity engage to directly with the local workforce as described below.


 
Shareholder engagement Institutional investors Retail investors The company operates an active investor relations programme. The BP held a further event for retail investors in conjunction with the UK board receives feedback on shareholder views through results of an Shareholders’ Association (UKSA) in 2018. The chairman and head of anonymous investor audit and reports from management and those investor relations gave presentations on BP’s annual results, strategy directors who meet with shareholders each year. In 2018 the chair of and the work of the board. Shareholders’ questions were focused on the remuneration committee undertook extensive engagement on BP’s activities and performance. the application of the remuneration policy prior to the AGM in May (see the remuneration committee report on page 83). Helge Lund also AGM held one-to-one meetings with 14 major institutional investors during Voting levels increased in 2018 to 67.3% (of issued share capital, the last quarter of the year prior to him becoming the chairman. including votes cast as withheld), compared to 50.8% in 2017 and Senior management regularly meets with institutional investors 64.3% in 2016. through road shows, group and one-to-one meetings, events for All resolutions were passed at the meeting. Each year the board socially responsible investors (SRIs) and oil and gas sector receives a report after the AGM giving a breakdown of the votes conferences throughout the year. and investor feedback on their voting decisions to inform them on In April, the chairman and all board committee chairs held an annual any issues arising. investor event. This meeting enabled BP’s largest shareholders to hear about the work of the board and its committees and for investors UK Corporate Governance Code compliance to share their views directly with NEDs. BP complied throughout 2018 with the provisions of the 2016 UK Corporate Governance Code except in the following aspects:   More information B.3.2 Lett ers of appointment do not set out fixed-time commitments See bp.com/investors for investor since the schedule of board and committee meetings is subject to and strategy presentations, including change according to the demands of business and other events. the group’s financial results and information on the work of the board Our letters of appointment set a general guide of a time and its committees. commitment of between 30-40 days per year. All directors are expected to demonstrate their commitment to the work of the board on an ongoing basis. This is reviewed by the nomination Shareholder engagement cycle 2018 and governance committee in recommending candidates for annual re-election. • Fourth quarter and full year 2017 results and D.2.2 The remuneration of the chairman is not set by the remuneration strategy update committee. Instead, the chairman’s remuneration is reviewed by • Investor roadshows with executive management the remuneration committee which makes a recommendation to – fourth quarter and full year 2017 results the board as a whole for final approval, within the limits set by • BP Energy Outlook presentation shareholders. This wider process enables all board members to discuss and approve the chairman’s remuneration, rather than Q1 • US SRI meetings on remuneration solely the members of the remuneration committee. • Investor meetings on remuneration, continuing BP remains cognizant of the new UK Corporate Governance Code and into Q2 will report accordingly in our 2019 Annual Report and Form 20-F. A copy • BP Annual Report 2017 launch of the UK Corporate Governance Code is available at frc.org.uk. • BP Sustainability Report 2017 launch • BP Technology Outlook launch • Chairman and board committee chairs meetings International advisory board • UKSA (retail shareholders’) meeting with the chairman BP’s international advisory board (IAB) advises the chairman, group chief Q2 • First quarter 2018 results presentation executive and the board on geopolitical and strategic issues relating to the company. This group meets once or twice a year and between • Annual general meeting meetings IAB members remain available to provide advice and counsel • Advancing the Energy Transition launch when needed. • BP Statistical Review of World Energy launch Membership of the IAB in 2018 comprised Lord Patten of Barnes, Josh Bolten, President Romano Prodi, Dr Ernesto Zedillo, John Key and Dr Javier Solana. The chairman, chief executive and Sir John Sawers • Second quarter 2018 results presentation attend meetings of the IAB. Issues discussed in 2018 included the Q3 • Investor roadshows with executive management global economy, developments in the Middle East, political events in following 2Q results Latin America and the political and economic outlook in the US. The IAB discussed the UK’s potential exit from the European Union at both of its meetings during 2018. • Third quarter 2018 results presentation Q4 • Upstream investor day in Oman 74 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 75 Member since November and 2010 chair since April 2011 Member since October resigned 2016; September2018 Member since May 2018 Member since October 2018 Member since May 2015 eeing the appointment, remuneration, independence appointment, the remuneration, eeing and ewing the systems in place enable to those who work for BP to ewing financial statements and other andfinancialother disclosures and financialewing statements ewing the effectiveness of the group audit function, BP’s igation of financial risks is appropriately addressed by the group group the by addressed appropriately is risks financial of igation raise concerns about possible improprieties in financial reporting or financial in improprieties possible about concerns raise other issues and for those matters be to investigated. Monitoring and obtaining assurance that the management or the obtaining assurance that and Monitoring mit chief executive and that the system of internal control is designed and implemented effectively in support of the limits imposed by the board (‘executive limitations’), as set out in the BP board principles. governance Revi requirements. listing and legal relevant with compliance monitoring Revi Overs performance of the external auditor and the integrity of the audit process as a whole, including the engagement of the external auditor supplyto non-audit services BP. to Revi internal financial controls and systems of internal control and risk management. Members NelsonBrendan Nils Andersen Alison Carnwath Pamela Daley Reynolds Paula Meetings and attendance and Meetings There were nine committee meetings in 2018, of which three were by teleconference. All directors attended every meeting during the period in which they were committee members, except for Nils Andersen, Alison Carnwath and Paula Reynolds who all missed a meeting each due pre-existing to external commitments. Regular attendees at the meetings include the chief financial officer,group controller, chief accounting officer, group head of audit, group general counsel and auditor. external Role of the committee The committee monitors the effectiveness of the financial group’s reporting, systems of internal control and risk managementand the processes. audit internal and external group’s the of integrity Key responsibilities • • • • • vice chairman of KPMG and president of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Scotland. Currently he is chairman of the group audit committee of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc and a member of Financialthe Reporting Panel. The Review board satisfied is is he that financial relevant committee audit and the member with recent experience as outlined in the UK Corporate Governance Code and competence in accounting and auditing as required by the FCA’s Corporate Governance Rules It considers in DTR7. that thecommittee as a whole has an appropriate and experienced blend of commercial, financial and auditexpertise to assess the issues it requiredis to address, as well as competence in the oil and gas The sector. board also determined that the audit committee meets the independence criteria provisions of Rule 10A-3 of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and that Brendan may be regarded as an audit committee financialexpert as defined16A in Item of Form 20-F. Brendan Nelson is chair of the audit committee. He was formerly BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Audit committee The committee continued theto monitor system ofgroup’s internal control, risk management functions and work of key as as well reviewing as and challenging appropriate the disclosures and key judgements made by management. BP’s financialreporting is balanced‘fair, and understandable’. In the 2018 committee focused on the effectiveness of a number of procurement, trading, and supply integrated including functions group tax, information technology and security, and shipping. We also received presentations regarding, and reviewed performance the Upstream of, segment and the lubricants business. These reviews were valuable in not only informing the committee of the work and future plans of those functions and businesses but also examining the risks key (and associated mitigations) faced by each of them. In addition, the committee carried out reviews the into group risks of financial liquidity, regulations. business with cyber compliance security and The transition Deloitte to from EY was completed in 2018. We met with both EY and Deloitte during as 2018 the transition occurred and oversaw and monitored Deloitte’s work as they settled their into role. We meet lead partner. regularly audit with the Nils Andersen retired from the committee in September as 2018 he joined the SEEAC. I would thank to like Nils for his service the to committee, and for the challenge and perspective he provided as a member. We were very pleased welcome to Dame Alison Carnwath Chairman’s introductionChairman’s As in previous years, the committee has continued review to the integrity of the financial group’s reporting by challenging and debating the judgements made by management, including the estimates which are made.We receive reports from management and the external and issues accounting significant highlighting quarter each auditor judgements and have used these informto our debate on whether to theto committee in May with 2018 Pamela Daley also joining in October 2018. Each of them bring excellent financial and otherrelevant skillsto committee.the Nelson Brendan Committee chair Committee reports


 
Activities during the year Financial disclosure and compliance functions, Financial liquidity: including the development of the anti-bribery risk associated with external The committee reviewed the considered whether the period and corruption elements of market conditions, supply and quarterly, half-year and annual covered by the company’s viability the programme, enhanced demand and prices achieved for financial statements with statement was appropriate. policies, tools and training and BP’s products which could impact management, focusing on the: The committee considered the strengthening of counter-party risk financial performance. measures, including due diligence. • Integrity of the group’s BP Annual Report and Form 20-F The committee reviewed the key The committee also reviewed key financial reporting process. 2017 and assessed whether the price assumptions used by the areas of BP’s legal function that • Clarity of disclosure. report was fair, balanced and group for investment appraisal and advise on compliance matters. • Compliance with relevant legal understandable and provided the judgements underlying those and financial reporting standards. the information necessary for Cyber security risk: including proposals, the cost of capital and its • Application of accounting shareholders to assess the inappropriate access to or misuse application as a discount rate to policies and judgements. group’s position and performance, of information and systems and evaluate long-term BP business business model and strategy. In As part of its review, the disruption of business activity. projects, liquidity (including credit making this assessment, the committee received quarterly rating, hedging, long-term committee examined disclosures The committee reviewed ongoing updates from management and commercial commitments and during the year, discussed the developments in the cyber the external auditor in relation to credit risk) and the effectiveness requirement with senior security landscape, including accounting judgements and and efficiency of the capital management, confirmed that events in the oil and gas industry estimates including those relating investment into major projects . representations to the external and within BP itself. The review to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, These assumptions also impacted auditors had been evidenced and focused on the improvements recoverability of asset carrying financial reporting (see page 79). reviewed reports relating to made in managing cyber risk, values and other matters. internal control over financial including the application of the BP’s principal risks are listed on The committee keeps under reporting. The committee made three lines of defence model and page 55. examining the indicators review the frequency of results a recommendation to the board, For 2019, the board has agreed associated with risk management reporting during the year. who in turn reviewed the report that the committee will continue and barrier performance. The committee reviewed the as a whole, confirmed the to monitor the same four group assessment and reporting of assessment and approved the risks as for 2018. longer-term viability, risk report’s publication. management and the system of Other disclosures reviewed internal control, including the included: Other reviews reporting and categorization of risk • Oil and gas reserves. across the group and the Other reviews undertaken in 2018 performance, risk management • Pensions and post-retirement examination of what might by the committee included: and controls, audit findings, key benefits assumptions. litigation and ethics and constitute a significant failing or • Lubricants: including strategy • Risk factors. compliance findings. weakness in the system of and strategic progress, financial • Legal liabilities. internal control. It also examined performance, risk management • Capability and succession in • Tax strategy. the group’s modelling for stress and controls, audit findings, key BP’s finance function, including • Going concern. testing different financial and litigation and ethics and the group’s finance • IFRS 16 (lease accounting). operational events, and compliance findings. modernization programme. • Upstream: including vision and • Assessment of financial metrics Risk reviews priorities, structure and for executive remuneration: portfolio, financial controls and consideration of financial The principal risks allocated to the integrated supply and trading the balance sheet, an overview performance for the group’s audit committee for monitoring in function’s risk management of tangible and intangible assets 2018 annual cash bonus 2018 included those associated programme, including and a review of the segment’s scorecard and performance with: compliance with regulatory finance organization. share plan, including developments and activities in adjustments to plan conditions Trading activities: including risks • Shipping: including an overview response to cyber threats. and NOIs. arising from shortcomings or failures of BP shipping’s role and in systems, risk management Compliance with applicable operating model, financial • Auditor transition: regular methodology, internal control laws and regulations: including performance, strategy, risk reports from the external processes or employees. ethical misconduct or breaches of management and controls and auditor regarding its transition applicable laws or regulations that the impact of IFRS 16 (lease into the role including detailed In reviewing this risk, the could damage BP’s reputation, accounting standard). updates on issues identified by committee focused on external adversely affect operational results the external auditor. market developments and how • Tax: including strategy and and/or shareholder value and BP’s trading function had strategic progress, key • Internal controls: assessments potentially affect BP’s licence responded – including new areas drivers of the group’s effective of management’s plans to to operate. of activity, such as emissions tax rate, the global indirect tax remediate the external auditors trading and impacts on the The committee reviewed the environment and the tax findings in relation to IT access control environment. group’s ethics and compliance modernization programme. risks. programme, including the work of The committee further • Procurement: including strategy the business integrity and ethics considered updates in the and strategic progress, financial 76 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 77 usions/outcomes ecember 2018. ignificant number of BEL claim aining uncertainties.aining e recognized during the year. f of Mexico licences and believes it is -tax charge billion of $1.2 in relation the to Concl settlements the in the degree year, of judgement necessary determine to the year-end provision had reduced significantly. the capitalize to continue to appropriate costs.       The group income statement includes a pre GulfMexico of oil spill. on information includes Disclosure rem The audit committee noted that following the s billion Exploration write-offs $1.1 totalling wer BP remains committed developing to the Gul billion $16.0 totalled Exploration intangibles at D 31 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Training The committee held a review on reserves and pensions. It received technical updates from the chief accounting officer on developments in financialreporting and accounting policy, in particularregarding the introduction of IFRS ‘Leases’ 16 accounting from the start 2019. of visit trading and supply Integrated In October, the committee held its meeting at BP’s integrated supply and trading (IST) business in London and conducted its annual tour of the business which covered oil and gas market fundamentals, finance and risk, IST’s strategy, and presentations on oil products LNGand trading. ommittee activityommittee eam intangibleeam including the assets, ision related business to economic loss losure of uncertainties the of losure to relating ual intangible asset certification process group’s quarterly due diligence process. diligence due quarterly group’s delines for compliance with oil and gas Audit c Audit       Received the output of management’s ann (BEL) and other claims related the to Gulf of continuing the including spill, oil Mexico effect of the Fifth Circuit opinion May 2017 on the matching of revenues with expenses claims. BEL when evaluating Held an in-depth review of BP’s policy and gui reserves regulation, disclosure including the reservesgroup’s governance framework controls. and Reviewed exploration write-offs as part of the Received briefings on the status of upstr used ensure to accounting criteria to intangible carry exploration to the continue balance are met. A review of the provisioning for and disc Particular focus was given updates to the to prov status of items on the intangibles assets ‘watch-list’, including certain Gulf of Mexico licences which expired and in 2013 2014. GulfMexico of oil spill was undertaken each quarter as part of the review of the stock announcement. exchange The the committee reviewed effectiveness internal of audit. The audit committee held also private meetings with the group ethics and compliance officer year. the during rnal controlrnal risk and management Inte Oil and natural gas accounting, including reserves BP uses technical and commercial judgements exploration, gas and oil for accounting when in and expenditure appraisal development and determining the estimated group’s oil and gas reserves. management’s based on Reserves estimates commodity have prices future for assumptions a direct impact on the assessment of the recoverability of asset carrying values reported in the financial statements. Judgement is required determine to whether it is appropriate continue to carry to intangible assets related exploration to costs on the sheet. balance Gulf of Mexico oil spill BP uses judgement in relation the to recognition of provisions relating the to Gulf of Mexico oil spill. The timing and amounts of the remaining cash flows subjectare to uncertainty and estimation is required to determine the amounts provided for. Key judgements and estimates Key in financialreporting The committee received quarterly reports on the findings of group audit in 2018. The committee met privately with the group head audit of and key members his of leadership team. Accounting judgements and estimates Areas of significant judgement considered by the committee in and 2018 how these were addressed included:


 
Key judgements and estimates Audit committee activity Conclusions/outcomes in financial reporting Recoverability of asset carrying values Determination as to whether and how much Reviewed the group’s oil and gas price The group’s long-term price assumptions for an asset, cash generating unit (CGU) or group assumptions. Brent oil, and Henry Hub gas were of CGUs containing goodwill is impaired unchanged from 2017. Reviewed the group’s discount rates for involves management judgement and impairment testing purposes. The group’s discount rates used for estimates on uncertain matters such as future impairment testing were also unchanged. commodity pricing, discount rates, production Upstream impairment charges, reversals profiles, reserves and the impact of inflation on and ‘watch-list’ items were reviewed as Impairments of $0.1 billion were recorded in operating expenses. part of the quarterly due diligence process. the year, net of impairment reversals. Investment in Rosneft Judgement is required in assessing the level of Reviewed the judgement on whether the BP has retained significant influence over control or influence over another entity in group continues to have significant Rosneft throughout 2018 as defined by which the group holds an interest. influence over Rosneft. IFRS. BP uses the equity method of accounting for Considered IFRS guidance on evidence its investment in Rosneft and BP’s share of participation in policy-making processes. Rosneft’s oil and natural gas reserves is Received reports from management which included in the group’s estimated net proved assessed the extent of significant influence, reserves of equity-accounted entities. including BP’s participation in decision The equity-accounting treatment of BP’s making. 19.75% interest in Rosneft continues to be dependent on the judgement that BP has significant influence over Rosneft. Derivative financial instruments For its level 3 derivative financial instruments, Received a briefing on the group’s trading BP has assets and liabilities of $3.6 billion and BP estimates their fair value using internal risks and reviewed the system of risk $3.1 billion respectively recognized on the models due to the absence of quoted market management and controls in place, balance sheet for level 3 derivative financial pricing or other observable, market- including those covering the valuation of instruments at 31 December 2018, mainly corroborated data. level 3 derivative financial instruments, relating to the activities of the integrated Judgement may also be required to determine using models where observable market supply and trading function (IST). pricing is not available. whether contracts to buy or sell commodities BP’s use of internal models to value certain meet the definition of a derivative. The committee annually reviews the control of these contracts has been disclosed in process and risks relating to the trading Note 30 in the financial statements. business. 78 See Glossary BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 79 usions/outcomes ptions remained largely unchanged remained ptions from eficits of $8.4 billion wererecognized on alance sheet obligation at the end of losed. e recognized on the balance sheet at Concl 2018 was2018 a nominal rate – based of 3% on long-dated bonds. government US    The method for determining the group’s assum The values these of 2017. assumptions and a sensitivity analysis of the impact of possible changes on the benefitexpense and obligation are provided in Note 24. DecemberAt31 2018, surpluses of $6.0 billion and d Decommissioning provisions of $13.6 billion wer The discount rate used by BP determine to the b The impact of this revised rate has been disc the balance sheet in relation pensions to and benefits. post-retirement other 31 December31 2018. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 The committee received updates during the year on the audit process, on assumptions group’s the challenged had auditor the how including issues.these Audit fees The audit committee reviews the fee structure, resourcing and terms of engagement for the external auditor annually; in addition it reviews the non-audit services that the auditor provides the to group on a quarterly basis. Fees paid the to external auditor for the year were $42 million $47 (2017 million), of which was for 5% non-audit assurance work (see Financial statements – Note 36). The audit committee is satisfied that this level of fee is appropriate in respect of the audit services provided and that an effective audit can be conducted for this fee. Non-audit or non-audit related assurance fees were $2 million $3 (2017 million). Non-audit or non-audit related services consisted of other assurance services. ommittee activityommittee ulating provisions, including the change the including provisions, ulating ironmental, asbestos and litigation and asbestos ironmental, ermine the projected benefitermine the obligation Audit c Audit    Reviewed the assumptions group’s used to det at the year end, including the discount rate, rate of inflation, salary growth and mortality levels. Received briefings on decommissioning, decommissioning, on briefings Received env Reviewedthe discount group’s rates for calc useto the nominal discount rate (i.e. taking account of expected inflation) from the second quarter of 2018. provisions, including requirements, the governance and controls for the development and approval of cost estimates and provisions in the financial statements. ts ts fi rrying value of certain exploration and appraisal assets where gement override of controls. sk of impairment in certain cash-generating units which are 3 of derivative financial instruments valuations within the financial derivative valuations within instruments of 3 unting for structured commodity transactions in the integrated ounting for pensions and other post- particularly sensitive changes to in the assumptions, key in particular assumptions. price gas long-term and the oil there could be potential indicators of impairment through licence expiry and/or partner withdrawal. Acco function. trading and supply Level integrated supply and trading function which involve using bespoke modelsvaluation and/or unobservable inputs. Mana The ri The ca retirement benefits involves making estimates estimates making benefitsinvolves retirement pension plan group’s the measuring when deficits. and surpluses estimates These require assumptions be to made about rates, discount including uncertain events, inflation andexpectancy. life Pensions and other post-retirement bene post-retirement other and Pensions Acc Key judgements and estimates Key in financialreporting Provisions BP’s most significant provisionsrelate to remediation environmental decommissioning, litigation.and The group holds provisions for the future decommissioning oil of and natural gas production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives. Most of these decommissioning events are many years in the future and the exact requirements that will have be to met when a removal event occurs are uncertain. Assumptions are made by BP in relation settlement to dates, technology, legal requirements and discount rates. The timing and amounts of future cash flows subjectare significantto uncertainty and estimation is required in determining the amounts of provisions be to recognized. Following a regular review of 30 from estimates, cost decommissioning June the 2018 present value of the decommissioning provision was determined by discounting the estimated cash flows expressed in expected future prices, i.e. taking accountexpected of inflation. Priorto 30 June 2018, the group estimated future cash flows in terms. real • • • • External audit Audit risk The external auditor set out its audit strategy for 2018, identifying significant audit risksto be addressed during the course of the audit. These included: •


 
Audit effectiveness Auditor appointment and independence The effectiveness, performance and integrity of the external audit The committee considers the reappointment of the external auditor process was evaluated through separate surveys completed by each year before making a recommendation to the board. The committee members and those BP personnel impacted by the audit, committee assesses the independence of the external auditor on an including chief financial officers, controllers, finance managers and ongoing basis and the external auditor is required to rotate the lead audit individuals responsible for accounting policy and internal controls over partner every five years and other senior audit staff every seven years. financial reporting. No partners or senior staff associated with the BP audit may transfer to the group. The survey sent to management comprised questions across five main criteria to measure the auditor’s performance: Non-audit services The audit committee is responsible for BP’s policy on non-audit • Robustness of the audit process. services and the approval of non-audit services. Audit objectivity and • Independence and objectivity. independence is safeguarded through the prohibition of non-audit tax • Quality of delivery. services and the limitation of audit-related work which falls within defined categories. BP’s policy on non-audit services states that the • Quality of people and service. auditor may not perform non-audit services that are prohibited by the • Value added advice. SEC, Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (PCAOB), UK Auditing Practices Board (APB) and the UK Financial Reporting The 2018 evaluation was the last of EY as the outgoing auditor. It also Council (FRC). included certain questions about the effectiveness of the transition to the incoming auditor, Deloitte. The results of the survey indicated that The audit committee approves the terms of all audit services as well as the external auditor’s performance had remained largely consistent in permitted audit-related and non-audit services in advance. The external key areas compared with the previous year. Areas with high scores and auditor is considered for permitted non-audit services only when its favourable comments included quality of accounting and auditing expertise and experience of the company is important. judgement and the working relationship with management. Areas for Approvals for individual engagements of pre-approved permitted improvement were identified but none impacted on the effectiveness services below certain thresholds are delegated to the group controller of the audit. The results of the questions regarding auditor transition or the chief financial officer. Any proposed service not included in the indicated that management were confident that Deloitte would be permitted services categories must be approved in advance either by effective in their role. The results of the survey were discussed with the audit committee chairman or the audit committee before Deloitte for consideration in their 2018 audit approach. engagement commences. The audit committee, chief financial officer The committee held private meetings with the external auditor during and group controller monitor overall compliance with BP’s policy on the year and the committee chair met separately with the external audit-related and non-audit services, including whether the necessary auditor and group head of audit at least quarterly. pre-approvals have been obtained. The categories of permitted and pre-approved services are outlined in Principal accountant’s fees and The effectiveness of the external auditor is evaluated by the audit services on page 301. The committee’s policies were updated in 2018 committee. The committee assessed the new auditor’s approach to to clarify the engagement of the incoming auditor, Deloitte, and the providing audit services as the team undertook its first audit. On the outgoing auditor (and auditor of Rosneft) EY. basis of such assessment, the committee concluded that the audit team was providing the required quality in relation to the provision of the services. The audit team had shown the necessary commitment and Committee evaluation ability to provide the services together with a demonstrable depth of The audit committee undertakes an annual evaluation of its performance knowledge, robustness, independence and objectivity as well as an and effectiveness. appreciation of complex issues. The team had posed constructive 2018 evaluation challenge to management where appropriate. For 2018, an external assessment was used to evaluate the work of the Audit transition committee as part of a wider review of the operation of the board as a Deloitte was appointed for the statutory audit, with effect from 2018 whole. The review concluded that it had performed effectively. following a tender process in 2016. The committee monitored the Areas of focus for 2019 include succession planning for membership of transition of BP’s statutory auditor from EY to Deloitte. This included: the committee, a site visit to global business services Kuala Lumpur and • Receiving reports from the audit transition team, including an integrated supply and trading Singapore and a further review of capital overview of operational activities and the termination of non-audit spending. services being provided by Deloitte to BP – which would be prohibited when Deloitte became the group’s statutory auditor. This included Deloitte stepping down as independent adviser to BP’s remuneration committee. • Requiring management to report to the committee on any services undertaken by the statutory auditor in line with the group’s policies relating to non-audit services. • Requiring confirmation of Deloitte’s compliance with BP’s independence and ethics and compliance rules. Deloitte confirmed its independence to the committee in October 2017. EY resigned on 29 March 2018 following completion of the 2017 audit. The committee also received reports from the external auditor’s transition team in April, May and July 2018 and an update to their plan in December 2018. 80 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 81 Member since September and 2014 chair since May 2016 Member since December 2018 Member since February 2010; resigned May 2018 Member since November 2010 Member since February 2012 Member since May 2017 Member since July 2015 Members Alan Boeckmann Nils Andersen AndersonPaul Frank Bowman Ann Dowling Meyer Melody John Sawers Role of the committee The role of the SEEAC is look to at the processes adopted by BP’s executive management identify to and mitigate significant non-financial process and personal of management the monitoring includes This risk. safety and receiving assurance that processes identify to and mitigate in effective and design their in appropriate are non-financial such risks implementation. their Meetings and attendance and Meetings There were six committee meetings in 2018. All directors attended every meeting for which they were eligible, apart from Alan Boeckmann who missed two meetings due unforeseen to personal circumstances. In addition the to committee members, all SEEAC meetings were attended by the group chief executive, the executive vice president for safety and operational risk (S&OR) and the head of group audit or his delegate. The external auditor attended some of the meetings and has access the to chair and secretary the to committee as required. The group general counsel and group ethics and compliance officer also attended some of the meetings. At the conclusion of each meeting the committee members the for sessions committee scheduled private withoutonly, the presence of executive management, discuss to any issues arising and the quality of the meeting. The group chief executive receives invitations join to the private meetings on an ad hoc basis and at least once a year the head of group audit and at least twice a year the group ethics and compliance officer are invitedto a private meeting with the committee. Key responsibilities segments business the reportsfrom specific receives committee The as well as cross-business information from the functions. These include, but are not limited the to, safety and operational risk function, group group and integrity business compliance, and ethics group audit, security. The SEEAC can access any other independent adviceand counsel it requires on an unrestricted basis. The SEEAC and audit committee worked together, through their chairs and secretaries, ensure to that agendas did not overlap or omit coverage risksof any key during the year. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 ronment envi   . BP Sustainability Report 2017 assurance committee (SEEAC) At everyAt site visit, we engage with the local leadership who help to embed a culture focused on operational risk mitigation. Safety, ethicsSafety, and The committee made two site visits in the year (see page 73). In July members of the committee visited the Thunder Horse platform in the Gulf of Mexico, and in September members visited Cooper River petrochemicals plant in South Carolina. The level of access the into operations on such visits gives the directors first hand and direct insight. This framework provides an opportunity for meaningful and open dialogue with the local site teams, allowing the committee to better fulfil its obligations. In May 2018, Paul Anderson retired from the board and the committee. In preparation for stepping my down from the BP board at the annual general meeting in May 2019, Nils Andersen, who was appointed the to committee in December 2018, will assume the role of the chair of SEEAC from April 2019. BoeckmannAlan Committee chair Act (MSA) statement in 2018, the committee again reviewed related work practices in BP and will continue review to progress in developing and embedding those practices. In it 2018 also reviewed the The committee’s focus continued be to on working with executive management drive to safe, ethical and reliable operations. It continued provide to constructive challenge as part of its review of the executives’ management of the highest priority non-financial group risks assigned SEEAC. to The risks under our remit remained the marine, same as for 2017: wells, pipelines, explosion or release at facilities, major security incidents and cyber security in the process control network. The committee receives reports on each of these risks and monitors their management and mitigation. Modern second Slavery company’s the of publication Following Chairman’s introductionChairman’s


 
Activities during the year Committee evaluation In 2018, the committee examined its performance and effectiveness System of internal control and risk management through an externally facilitated evaluation which included individual interviews. Discussion focused on the responsibilities of the committee, The review of operational risk and compliance officer and the group the balance of skills and experience among its members, the quality and performance forms a large part of auditor met in private with the timeliness of information the committee receives, the level of challenge the committee’s agenda. chairman and other members of between committee members and management and how well the the committee over the course of Group audit provided quarterly committee communicates its activities and findings to the board to both the year. During the year the reports on their assurance work inform and drive discussion. committee received separate and their annual review of the reports on the company’s The evaluation results continued to be positive. Committee members system of internal control and risk management of risks relating to: considered that they continued to possess the right mix of skills and management. background, had an appropriate level of support and received open and • Marine. The committee also received transparent briefings from management. The committee agreed to • Wells. regular reports from the group review its remit in 2019. • Pipelines. chief executive and vice president • Explosion or release Site visits remained an important element of the committee’s work, for S&OR on operational risk, at our facilities. acknowledged through the responses in the evaluation process. These including regular reports prepared • Major security incidents. gave members the opportunity to examine and witness risk on the group’s health, safety and • Cyber security (process management processes embedded in businesses and facilities, environmental performance and control networks). including the right management culture. Joint meetings between the operational integrity. These SEEAC and the audit committee were considered important in included meeting-by-meeting The committee reviewed these reviewing and gaining assurance around financial and operational risks measures of personal and process risks and their management and where there was overlap between the committees, particularly in safety, environmental and mitigation in depth with relevant relation to ethics and compliance (see below). regulatory compliance, security executive management. and cyber risk analysis, as well as quarterly reports from group audit. In addition, the group ethics and Site visits In July members of the visited the petrochemicals plant, committee, and other directors, Cooper River, in South Carolina. visited the Houston office and During the visit, directors were went offshore to Thunder Horse able to discuss business in the Gulf of Mexico. The continuity planning and Houston visit included time with emergency response which had various teams understanding the been in effect just prior to the effects of Hurricane Harvey, how visit as a result of Hurricane central office-based functions Florence. For all visits, committee support the offshore community members and other directors and other group monitoring received briefings on operations, teams. In preparation for the the status of conformance with offshore visit to Thunder Horse BP’s operating management the directors met with the Gulf of system, key business and Mexico leadership. Offshore, operational risks and risk there was a full tour of the asset management and mitigation. Joint meetings of the audit and safety, ethics and including control room, topsides Committee members reported environment assurance committees and drilling rig and plenty of back in detail about each visit to The audit committee and SEEAC hold joint meetings on a quarterly opportunity was provided to the committee and subsequently basis to simplify reporting of key issues that are within the remit converse with employees on the to the board. See page 73 for of both committees and to make more effective use of the rig. In September, committee further details. committees’ time. Each committee retains full discretion to require members, and other directors, a full presentation and discussion on any joint meeting topic at their respective meeting if deemed appropriate. The committees jointly met four times in 2018, with the chairmanship of the meetings Corporate reporting alternating between the chairman of the audit committee and chairman of the SEEAC. Topics discussed at the joint meetings The committee was responsible worked with the external auditor were the quarterly ethics and compliance reports (including for the overview of the BP with respect to their assurance significant investigations and allegations) and the 2019 forward Sustainability Report 2017. The of the report. programmes for the group audit and ethics and compliance committee reviewed content and functions. 82 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 83 Member since September and chair 2017 since May 2018 Member since May 2015 Member since January 2019 Member since July 2010 Member since July and chair 2012 since May resigned2015; May 2018 Member since May 2017 mine the terms of engagement, benefits of remuneration, and terms the mine tor the alignment of incentives and remuneration for all ive, and take account into as appropriate, regular updates on ge independent consultants or other advisers as the committee tain appropriate dialogue with shareholders on remuneration remuneration on shareholders with dialogue appropriate tain re terminationre terms and payments executive to directors and insightre from data sources on pay ratio, gender pay gap and hairman and the executive directorswhile considering policies ove theove principles of any equity plan that requires shareholder changesove the to design of remuneration for BP group leaders, are the annual remuneration report shareholders to show to how ew the relevant remuneration principles policies and remuneration for relevant the ew for employees below the board. the below employees for Ensu Appr Rece Ensu Main matters. Moni employees below the executive team with the expected values and behaviours. Enga may from time time to deem necessary, at the expense of the company. Recommend the to board the remuneration principlesand policy for the c Deter termination of employment for the chairman and the executive directors, executive team and the company secretary in accordance with the policy. Revi team. executive the below employees Prep the policy has been implemented. Appr approval. the executive team are fair. as proposed by the group chief executive. workforce views and engagement initiatives related remuneration. to considered as are outcomes workforce remuneration other appropriate. Members Reynolds Paula Alan Boeckmann Pamela Daley Ian Davis Ann Dowling NelsonBrendan • • • Role of the committee The role of the committee is determine to and recommend the to board the remuneration policy for the chairman and executive directors. In determining the policy, the committee takes account into various factors, including structuring the policy promote to the long-term success of thecompany and linkingreward business to performance. The committee recognizes the remuneration principles applicable all to level. board below employees Key responsibilities • • • • • • • • • BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Remuneration committee As the new committee I took chair, the opportunity in the autumn to engage with some of our institutional shareholders. In a changing governance landscape, it has been important ensure to our stakeholders continue be to heard. We have reviewed the responsibilities of the committee and have extended the scope include to oversight of remuneration below board level. We have continued operate to under the policy approved by shareholders Our focus will for 2019 of course in 2017. be the preparation new of a Policy for approval by shareholders at the 2020 AGM. Pamela Daley has joined the remuneration committee from 1 January 2019. We welcome Pamela the to committee and look contribution. valuable her to forward PricewaterhouseCoopers independent LLP our as continued has adviser following their PwC appointment has in other 2017. engagements with the company provide to certain services none of which are deemed material in this context. Paula Rosput Reynolds Chair’s introduction Committee chair


 
Meetings and attendance The chairman and the group chief executive attend meetings of the committee except for matters relating to their own remuneration. The group chief executive is consulted on the remuneration of the chief financial officer, the executive team and more broadly on remuneration across the wider employee population. Both the group chief executive and chief financial officer are consulted on matters relating to the group’s performance. The group human resources director attends meetings and other executives may attend where necessary. The committee consults other board committees on the group’s performance and on issues relating to the exercise of judgement or discretion. The committee met seven times during the year. All directors attended each meeting that they were eligible to attend, either in person or by telephone, except Alan Boeckmann who was not able to attend two Geopolitical committee meetings due to unforeseen personal circumstances. Activities during the year Chairman’s introduction In the period before the 2018 AGM, the committee focused on the outcomes for 2017. This involved reviewing directors’ salaries and the I am pleased to report on the work of the geopolitical committee in group’s performance outcome which in turn determined the annual 2018, which continued to develop and evolve during the year. During bonus and the performance share plan. 2018 I also joined discussions of the international advisory board. PwC has continued as independent adviser during 2018. The committee Paul Anderson stood down in May 2018. I want to thank Paul for his continued to monitor developments in potential regulation and legislation valuable contribution. We welcomed Nils Andersen to the committee and resulting implications. It also considered the company’s disclosure in August 2018 and his experience is invaluable given he was CEO of on the UK gender pay gap. major companies, such as Carlsberg and Mærsk, which had operations in many jurisdictions with significant political risk In each of its meetings, the committee focused on the overall quantum considerations. Other board members joined our meetings from time of executive director remuneration and its alignment to the broader to time. group of employees in BP. It has sought to reflect the views of shareholders and the broader societal context in its decisions. Sir John Sawers Committee chair Shareholder engagement There was engagement with shareholders and proxy voting agencies ahead of the 2018 AGM, carried out by the chair of the committee, the Role of the committee chairman and company secretary as required. The new committee chair The committee monitors the company’s identification and management continued engagement throughout the year, primarily with larger of geopolitical risk. shareholders and representative bodies, in light of evolving regulation and related remuneration issues. Key responsibilities Committee evaluation • Monitor the company’s identification and management of major and correlated geopolitical risk and consider reputational as well as An externally facilitated evaluation was undertaken to examine the financial consequences: committee’s performance in 2018. The evaluation concluded that the committee had worked well and had responded to the previous – Major geopolitical risks are those brought about by social, evaluation by increasing its remit to take on oversight of economic or political events that occur in countries where BP has remuneration below board level. material investments. Focus areas for 2019 include responding to regulation and – Correlated geopolitical risks are those brought about by social, governance reform and planning for the new remuneration policy economic or political events that occur in countries where BP may to be brought to shareholders for approval in 2020. The commitment or may not have a presence but that can lead to global political to stay focused on external developments and emerging ‘best instability. practice’ and improving remuneration reporting remained. See • Review BP’s activities in the context of political and economic page 87 for the Directors’ remuneration report. developments on a regional basis and advise the board on these elements in its consideration of BP’s strategy and the annual plan. 84 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 85 rmine any other matter that is appropriate be to considered by e on any matter referred it to by the chairman of any committees utive. ew theew structure and effectiveness of the business organization. theew systems for senior executive development and determine Chairman’s and nominationChairman’s and governance committees Evaluate the performance and the effectiveness of the group chief exec Revi Revi succession plans for the group chief executive, executive directors and other senior members of executive management. Dete non-executive directors. Opin non-executive directors. of solely comprised • Members the join Directors non-executive directors. all comprises The committee committee immediately on their appointment the to board. The group chief executive attends meetings of the committee when requested. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Chairman’s committeeChairman’s Role of the committee provide a forumTo for matters be to discussed by the non-executive directors. Key responsibilities • • • • Chairman’s introductionChairman’s The chairman’s and the nomination and governance committees were actively involved in the evolution of the board in 2018. In October, Carl-Henric Svanberg stood down as chairman of both committees and I pay tribute his to exceptional service since 2010. The board expanded the nomination committee’s remit in September help to 2018 fulfilrequirements provided in the new UK Corporate Governance Code and it was re-named the nomination and governance committee. It also continues focus to on board renewal and diversity as well as the talent in the senior levels of executive management and development of future leaders. Lund Helge Chair of the committees Member since September and 2015 chair since April 2016 Member since August2018 Member since September resigned 2015; May 2018 Member since September 2015 Member since September 2016 Member since May 2017 NilsAndersen AndersonPaul FrankBowman Ian Davis Meyer Melody Members John Sawers The committee reviewed its performance through feedback from the external evaluation of its work and of the work of the board as a whole. The evaluation concluded that the committee was working well and considering the right issues. The committee currently meets four times meetings. additional considering is and year a The committee and board felt that there should be greater integration between the work of the board, the committee and the international advisory board. This is being further considered during 2019. Committee evaluation The committee developed and broadened its work It over the year. discussed BP’s involvement in the countries key where it has existing investments or isconsidering investment in detail. These included the US, Russia, Mexico, Brazil, India and China. It considered broader policy issues such as the US domestic and foreign policy and the political and economic impact of a low oil price on countries. producing We reviewed the geopolitical background BP’s to global investments and the politics around climate change. Activities during the year The chairman and group chief executive regularly attend committee meetings. The executive vice president, regions and the vice president, government and political affairs attend meetings as required. The committee met four times during All the year. directors attended each meeting that they were eligible attend. to Meetings and attendance and Meetings


 
Meetings and attendance Nomination and governance committee The committee met six times in 2018. All directors attended all the Role of the committee meetings for which they were eligible, except that Nils Andersen was excused from two meetings due to a potential conflict of interest and The committee ensures an orderly succession of candidates for Alan Boeckmann missed two meetings due to unforeseen personal directors and the company secretary and oversees corporate circumstances. governance matters for the group. Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary joined meetings where the chairman’s Key responsibilities succession was discussed. Matters relating to the business of the nomination and governance committee were also discussed at some • Identify, evaluate and recommend candidates for appointment or meetings. reappointment as directors. • Review the outside directorships/commitments of the NEDs. Activities during the year • Review the mix of knowledge, skills experience and diversity of the • Evaluated the performance of the chairman and the group chief Board to ensure the orderly succession of directors. executive. • Identify, evaluate and recommend candidates for appointment as • Considered the composition of and the succession plans for the company secretary. executive team. • Review developments in law, regulation and best practice relating to • Discussed the strategy options for the company, including the corporate governance and make recommendations to the board on transition to a lower carbon future. appropriate actions to allow compliance. Committee evaluation Members The committee continues to work well. The balance of skills and experience amongst its non-executive director membership ensures it is Helge Lund Member since July 2018 and chair since best able to support and challenge the company as it implements its September 2018 strategy. Carl-Henric Member since September 2009 and chair Svanberg since January 2010; resigned as chair September 2018 and from committee December 2018 Alan Boeckmann Member since April 2016 Ian Davis Member since August 2010 Ann Dowling Member since May 2015 and resigned May 2018 Brendan Nelson Member since September 2018 Paula Reynolds Member since May 2018 John Sawers Member since April 2016 Meetings and attendance The committee met three times in 2018. During the second half of the year, matters relating to the appointment of new directors were considered jointly with the chairman’s committee. All directors attended each meeting that they were eligible to attend, except Paula Reynolds due to pre-existing external commitments. Activities during the year The committee continued to monitor the composition and skills of the board. The committee will continue to focus on ensuring that the board’s composition is strong and diverse. During the year, it was agreed that the committee would assume oversight of governance. Committee evaluation Following the board evaluation, it was agreed that the committee would also focus on governance requirements arising from the new UK Corporate Governance Code. 86 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 87 Results and progress 2018 in BP delivered another year of disciplined execution in 2018, alongside further progress against our five-year strategyto 2021. for growth. We delivered a further six major projects in 2018, bringing the over total 19 to the 2016-18 cycle. Strong operating performance across all all performance across operating Strong doubled than more has businesses our underlyingour to cost replacement profit billion,$12.7 with operating cash flow excluding Gulf of Mexico oilspill payments of $26.1 billion. BP distributed $8.1 billion in dividends in 2018, and continued the share buyback programme started offset to in 2017 the dilutive effects of the scrip shares. BP continues play to an active role in relation theto energy transition. We are carefully considering our mix of natural gas and oil, while investing in new technology and businesses that have the potential contribute to a lower to carbon world through our ‘reduce, improve, framework. create’ Our acquisitionChargemaster, of the UK’s (see company charging electric vehicle largest page 42), and further expansion of the solar company Lightsource BP (see page 47), are among the most promising investments advancing to commitment with our consistent a lowercarbon future. At the same time we continue sustain to our traditional reserves Our organic business. replacement ratio for the year was 100%, and our acquisition of BHP assets provides us with reserves opportunitiesand significantnew BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Chair of the remuneration committee Chair of the remuneration Targets are strongly aligned withTargets are strongly priorities,the company’s strategic and requirethey are ambitious achieve outcomes. material effort to Paula Rosput Reynolds Dear shareholder, Following shareholder extensive consultation led by board my colleague Professor Dame Ann Dowling, BP introduced our current remuneration Thus policy 2018 in 2017. was our second year using this policy. The committeeremuneration the believes structure remains fitfor purpose, the targets are strongly aligned with the company’s ambitious and are priorities, they strategic require material effort achieve to outcomes, and the rewards conferred date to align with progress. strategic and results financial our Please the to refer ‘Remuneration at a glance’ table for an overview. The policy delivers remuneration in three parts: a market-aligned foundation of base salary, benefits andretirement provision; annual reflect that our based measures on incentives assessed against targets require that strategy, progressive improvement year-on-year; and a materialopportunity earn to shares at the end of a three-year performance period, which is accompanied by a shareholding requirement ensureto our executive directors’ interests align with your own. Of course it is not enough relyto on a purely formulaic application of policy. Therefore the committee engages in a dialogue with Bob Dudley, Brian Gilvary and particularly colleagues, board onour those assurance environment and ethics safety, the committee (SEEAC) and the main board audit committee (MBAC) test to the reasonableness of the outcomes. This dialogue ensures we are well equipped apply to and explain discretion and judgement as needed. isclosures nnual bonus outcome xecutive director director xecutive xecutive director director xecutive tive director director tive tive directors’ pay directors’ tive r workforce in 2018 ardship and executive executive and ardship -18 performance share -18 ment with strategy with ment outcomes remuneration policy for 2019 Execu policy andremuneration 2019 for implementation Non-e Stew Non-e interests and outcomes Other d director interests for 2018 Wide 2018 a 2018 2016 outcome plan Align Execu 2018 performance2018 and pay        Contents 105 109 104 102 95 97 100 91 92 94 90   Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ report remuneration Directors’


 
Directors’ remuneration report Remuneration at a glance Key features Purpose and link to strategy Outcomes for 2018 Implementation in 2019 • Salary is reviewed annually and, if • Fixed remuneration reflecting • Bob Dudley’s salary unchanged • Bob Dudley’s salary appropriate, increased following the scale and complexity of our at $1,854,000. to remain at $1,854,000. the AGM. business, enabling us to attract • Brian Gilvary’s salary increased • Brian Gilvary’s salary increased and keep the highest calibre • Relates to market and our wider by 2% to £775,000. by 2% to £790,500. global talent. benefits workforce. Salary and • Benefits remain unchanged. • Benefits remain unchanged. • Bob is a member of both US • To recognize competitive • Bob’s defined benefit pension • Arrangements for Bob will pension (defined benefit) and practice in home country. did not increase in 2018. His continue unchanged. retirement savings (defined actual and notional company • Brian has offered to accelerate contribution) plans. contributions were more than the scheduled reductions in offset by investment losses • Brian is a member of a UK final his cash allowance. These will within his retirement savings salary defined benefit pension now reduce by 5% of salary at plans, hence he received no plan, and receives a cash each of 1 June 2019, 2020 and net benefit in 2018. allowance in lieu of further 2021, and a further 5% of service accrual. • Brian’s accrued defined benefit salary at 1 June 2023, taking pension increase was below his cash allowance to 15% inflation. He received a cash of salary. benefits allowance at 35% of salary, • These proposed changes Retirement Retirement which is included in the single reduce Brian’s cash figure table. supplement sooner than the transition for other members of the BP UK defined benefits plan. He will not receive any form of compensation related to the reductions. • 112.5% of salary at target, and • To incentivize delivery of our • Against our scorecard of safety • We will include an 225% at maximum. annual and strategic goals. and operational risk (20%), environmental target, weighted reliable operations (30%) and at 10%, in our performance • 50% of the bonus is paid in cash • The 50% deferral reinforces financial performance (50%), scorecard for 2019. and 50% is mandatorily deferred the long-term nature of our our performance score is 81% bonus Annual and held in BP shares for three business and the importance of target (40.5% of maximum). years. of sustainability. • Annual grant of performance • To link the largest part of • Against our balanced scorecard • Awards granted in 2017 at shares, representing the remuneration opportunity with of financial measures (67%), 500% (group chief executive) maximum outcome. the long-term performance of and strategic imperatives (33%), and 450% (chief financial the business. The outcome our 2016-18 performance score officer) of salary will vest in ––500% of salary for group chief varies with performance against is 90.5% of maximum. proportion to success against executive. measures linked directly to the measures of our 2017-19 • The committee has exercised ––450% of salary for chief financial returns and strategic scorecard. discretion to reduce the actual financial officer. priorities. vesting outcome to 80%. • Awards granted in 2019 will be • Shares only vest to the extent granted at 500% (group chief performance conditions are met. executive) and 450% (chief shares financial officer) of salary. Performance Performance • For awards granted in 2019, strategic priorities will be weighted at 30% (previously 20%) with return on average capital employed reducing to 20%. • Executive directors are required • To provide alignment between • Both executive directors • In 2019 we will engage with to maintain a shareholding the interests of executive materially exceed the share stakeholders to review and equivalent to at least five times directors and our shareholders. ownership requirements. revise, as appropriate, our post their salary. employment shareholding • The executive directors maintain policy for 2020 onwards. • Additionally, they are expected to their commitment to retain maintain shareholdings of at least shareholdings of at least two two and a half times salary for two and a half times salary for two requirement Shareholding years post employment. years post employment. 88 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 89   In this Directors’ remuneration report RC profit (loss), underlying RC profit,return on average capital employed, operating cash flowexcluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments are non-GAAP refining reliability, plant upstream and These measures measures. availability, major projects and underlying production and reserves replacement ratio are defined in the Glossary on page315. Paula Rosput Reynolds Chair of the remuneration committee 29 March 2019 Looking ahead to 2019 We recently announced our support for a shareholder resolution at the annual 2019 general meeting that would broaden our corporate reporting describe to how our strategy is consistent with the goals of the Paris Agreement.We welcome this resolution as an opportunity provideto further detail onour strategy and on our attractiveness as an investment proposition in the energy transition, and for continued investor engagement. We believe that all constituencies will be well served byour increasing the target financialrewards relating to how a greenhouse gas emissions reduction measure for our bonus 2019 scorecard. This means that of the outcome 10% will now reflect our progress in emissions reduction (consequently reducing slightly the relative weighting of other customary measures in our bonus plan). The 2019-21 performance share plan scorecard will continue focus to on relative total shareholder return, absolute returns on average capital employed over the three years, and a focused suite of strategic progress measures. better reflect To the importance of strategic progress, we navigate the low-carbon transition. this end, we have To introduced which includes BP’s role in the energy transition, we are increasing the weighting of this measure from 20% 30%, to while reducing the returns measure from 30% 20%. to Following our review of their total remuneration, we have decided to keep Bob’s salary unchanged, and propose increase to salary Brian’s fromby 2% the date of the AGM. We have also agreed accelerate to the reductions the to cash supplement Brian receives in lieu of further defined benefit pension service accrual, which will now startfrom 1 June 2019. More broadly, our committee activity has in 2019 included a review of the committee charter, approving remuneration decisions in respect of the executive team, deepening our understanding of wider workforce appropriate under the as measures adopting and other remuneration revised UK Corporate Governance Code, including an examination of the implications of pay and benefits differences across the workforce. We will be reviewing BP’s strategic progress in the context of share programmes approved under policy, the in particular 2017 progress related the to challenges a lower of carbon world. These evaluations will take time and thoughtful discussion and will lead the in to important business of engaging with our major shareholders and representative bodies ahead of our new policy approval in 2020. In that regard, we will be consulting widely on the ways in which we reflect the strategic imperatives of the company within a competitive global remuneration structure. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 set stretching targets for the annual 2018 bonus scorecard. Therefore, despite the strong business results we assessed for the year, 2018 performance as below of target plan, (40.5% at 81% of maximum). Following our discussions with SEEAC and MBAC, we found no reason adjustto this formulaic scorecard outcome. Half of the bonus for the executive directors will be delivered as shares and held for three years. was2018 the finalyear of the 2016-18 performance share award, the measures with financial strategic and policy, 2014 under our grant last Performance and remuneration outcomes 2018 in As we seek incentivize to year-on-year improvement, the committee Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ as shown in the table on page 93. BP again ranked first place relativeon TSR, delivered robust operating cash and flow, exceeded maximum expectations for major project delivery. These strong results across the range of measures led a formulaic to vesting outcome of 90.5% of maximum. execution, project and TSR, flow, including cash results, The foregoing were delivered alongside an almost 50% return shareholders to over the same three-year between period. directional alignment is Thus, there executives and shareholders. the formula However, from which the outcome was calculated originated in the plan 2014 which we substantially The committee revised in 2017. recognized that merely applying a dated formula might not best serve the interests of the to delivered clear value the despite stakeholders. Therefore, shareholders and the relatively muted annual bonus outcome, we concluded we should apply downward discretion on theexecutive directors’ long term award outcomes. We will vest the 2016-18 performance shares at 80% rather than at the 90.5% formulaic outcome. scorecard In exercising our judgement we have opted apply to the more challenging scales policy of our 2017 in measuring performance outcomes relating operating to cash flow, major project delivery and safety and operational risk. This adjustment brings the vintage 2016 EDIP outcome harmony into with the policy that was approved by shareholders This adjustment in 2017. reduced incentive 2018 pay by $1.45 million for Bob and £0.54 million for Brian. In addition, the committee has again acted on Bob’s request re-base to his 2016-18 award from its original 550% grant level the to 500% of salary grant level established policy. in the This 2017 adjustment reduces Bob’s vesting outcome million, by a further thus reducing $1.10 his incentive pay by $2.70 million overall. The single figurestotal of remuneration for Bob and Brian $14.67are million and £7.98 million respectively, as reported on page 95. This represents decrease a 3% for Bob, reflecting significant reductions in both his annual bonus and the investment return on his retirement savings, partly offset by an increase attributable share to price growth. For Brian, this represents increase,a 12% largely due vesting to of deferred awards from bonus, his 2015 and the increase attributable to share price growth. In our committee deliberations, we considered these outcomes and believe they are appropriate given the operational and financial performance of BP thisyear and the tremendousrecovery that BP has made over the past three years.


 
Directors’ remuneration report 2018 performance and pay outcomes 2018 A year of exceptional operational performance, with record plant reliability in the Upstream and refining throughput in Business the Downstream. Improvement across virtually all safety measures, growth in our retail business and delivery of six performance major projects. Profits have more than doubled, with an 11.2% return on capital, and strong foundations for continuing returns over the near and long term. Key strategic highlights • $12.7 billion underlying replacement cost profit. 1st $26.1bn $8.1bn • Transformation of our US onshore business. Among peers for total Operating cash flow Dividends paid, shareholder return for excluding Gulf of Mexico including scrip. • Six new major projects delivered. 2016-18. oil spill payments. Performance outcomes Robust results for the year fell short of our stretching targets, particularly on cash flow. On a three-year basis, 2018 concluded a remarkable period of delivery and preparation for the future. Annual bonus Performance shares 40.5% 0% 40.5% 90.5% -10.5% 80% Formulaic outcome Committee judgement, Final outcome Formulaic outcome Committee judgement Expected outcome after (% of maximum) no adjustment (% of maximum) (% of maximum) to reduce vesting committee discretiona (% of maximum) Performance measures Nil Maximum Performance measures Nil Maximum (% weighting) (% weighting) ������ ��������� Tier 1 process safety events (10%) ��� Relative TSR (33.3%) ��� Recordable injury frequency (10%) ��� Cumulative operating cash flow ( 33.3%) ��� ����������� ��������� ����������� ��� Reserves replacement ratioa (11.1%) ��� Downstream refining availability (15%) BP-operated upstream plant ��� Major project delivery (11.1%) ��� reliability (15%) Safety and operational risk ��������� – Tier 1 process safety events ��� (11.1%) Operating cash flow (excluding Gulf – Recordable injury frequency ��� of Mexico oil spill payments) (20%) ��� Underlying replacement cost profit (20%) ��� a The final outcome for part of this award is based on BP’s relative RRR ranking. This is forecast at second place but cannot be confirmed until after publication of our peers’ reports. This final Upstream unit production costs (10%) ��� outcome will be reported in our 2019 report. KPI   This symbol denotes remuneration measures that directly relate to the key performance indicators of our investor proposition – see page 16. Remuneration outcomes Reduced annual bonus and pension, partly offset by increases in performance share vesting, lead to a reduction for Bob. The increase for Brian reflects increases in the values of performance and deferred share vesting. ��� ������� ����� ����� ��������� Brian Gilvary, chief financial officer �ota� remunerat�on �ota� remunerat�on 2018 �1���� 2018 £8.0m 201� �1��1m 201� ���1m 201� �11��m 201� ���2m 201� �1���m 201� ���1m 201� �1���m 201� ����m Salary and benefits Retirement benefits Annual bonus Performance shares Discontinued plans (see page 96 for descriptions) Share ownership This is a key means by which the interests of executive directors are aligned with those of shareholders. Both directors have holdings in BP which significantly exceeded our shareholding policy requirement of five times salary. Bob Dudley, group chief executive 14.66 times salary, 3,718,074 sharesa, as at 15 March 2019 Brian Gilvary, chief financial officer 15.80 times salary, 2,248,905 shares, as at 15 March 2019 �o��cy re�u�rements ���� �ctua� aHeld as ADSs 90 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 91 y performancey cators on page 16. indi See ke See   out of 2.0 a KPI out of 2.0 a Formulaic score 0.81 0.10 0.81 0.11 0.03 0.18 0 0.33 0.07 $26.1bn 0.00 $12.7bn $7.15/bbl 0.40 0.198/200k hrs 0.21 94.9% 95.7% 0.21 16 events16 Outcome  Outcome 40.5% of maximum bonus $31.4bn 0.4 $13.0bn 0.4 $6.61/bbl 0.2 0.164/200k hrs 0.2 95.8% 0.3 97.3% 0.3 12 events 0.2 Maximum (2) Final scorecard outcome 2.0 of out 0.81 Financial performance 0.40 To avoid windfallTo outcomes in our financial measures, and drive genuine year-on-year improvement, we adjust our financial targetsreflectto any pricing impacts, i.e. the stronger oil price environment led of 2018 a to proportionalincrease in our profit and cash flow targets. This is the fourth occasion in the last seven years in which we have adjusted our and price positive out strip environments performance to measurement better reflect financial improvement in underlying terms. Unadjusted, the scores would all have been significantly higher, leadingto remuneration outcomes greater than we would have intended. Consequently, and despite another strong year of results and delivery for shareholders, our bonus of target, outcome or is for 81% 2018 40.5% of maximum, compared with 143% of target, of or 71.5% maximum, in 2017. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 16 events $28.9bn $28.9bn 0.2 $12.2bn 0.2 $7.01/bbl 0.1 0.200/200k hrs 0.1 95.3% 0.15 95.3% 0.15 0.1 Target (1) No adjustment MBAC discretion 19 events 0 $26.4bn 0 $11.4bn 0 $7.41/bbl 0 0.219/200k hrs 0 94.8% 0 93.3% 0 Threshold (0) Reliable operations 0.21 10% 20% 20% 10% 10% 15% 15% Weighting No adjustment SEEAC SEEAC discretion KPI   KPI   KPI KPI     KPI KPI     KPI (20% weight) Measures used for the 2017 remuneration policy.     ating cash flow flow cash ating Safety 0.21 REM cost profit costs frequency (Solomon Associates’(Solomon operational availability) (defined by API) (excluding Gulf of Mexico spilloil payments) Formulaic Formulaic scorecard outcome 2.0 of out 0.81 Financial performance weight) (50% Reliable operations weight) (30% Safety Underlying replacement replacement Underlying production unit Upstream Financial performance outcome Safety outcomeSafety BP-operated upstream reliability plant outcome operations Reliable Recordable injury Downstream refining availability Measures Tier 1 process safety events 2018 annual bonus annual 2018 Oper Formulaic score Annual bonus Due to rounding, the total does not agree exactly with the sum of its component parts. a Scorecard For the 2018 committee established a bonus scorecard of seven measures across three areas of focus: safetyand operational risk, operations financialreliable and performance.align measures These with our strategy and, in particular, reflect the annual plan. Six of the seven measures are identical scorecard. our to 2017 The seventh ‘BP-operatedmeasure, replaces ‘Upstream reliability’, plant upstream operating efficiency’ bringing unplanned from 2017, downtime into account which provides closer a comparison with the equivalent Downstream. the for measure In order build to the on the committee strong results set of 2017, notably stretching targets for each of these measures. For instance, our 2018 thresholdoutcomes for safety performance were set at the level our of outcomes,2017 meaning we had results exceed to 2017 achieve to even a minimum contribution the to bonus. 2018 Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ bonus annual outcome 2018


 
Directors’ remuneration report Shareholders will note that the most significant divergence from our Notwithstanding this outcome, we discussed and agreed Bob’s decision 2018 targets is in operating cash flow. Even though the 2018 outcome to adjust the group performance element of annual bonus for the wider of $26.1 billion is 8% higher than 2017, it fell marginally short of the workforce (employees below senior leadership level) and consequently threshold level of $26.4 billion on an adjusted basis. This meant a score these 32,600 employees received 2018 annual bonus based on an of zero on an element that contributes 20% of the overall bonus target. adjusted group performance score of 100%, rather than 81%, of target. We feel this is a reflection of the rigor in our policy and target-setting The annual bonus outcome is unrelated to the BP share price, and process, delivering a nil outcome even in a year which saw underlying therefore no part of the bonus is attributable to share price appreciation. profit more than double, and returns almost double. As shown below, half of the bonus is paid in cash after year end, and As in previous years, in order to confirm the final bonus score we have half is deferred into shares that will vest in three years, according to 2017 discussed the formulaic score with the chairs of the safety, ethics and policy terms. The full value of the 2018 bonus, including the deferred environment assurance committee (SEEAC) and the main board audit shares, is included in the 2018 single figure table. This differs from committee (MBAC). This year, neither of these committees raised reporting in respect of the 2014 policy, under which deferred shares issues for which we felt any need to adjust. On this basis, and in view are included in the single figure for the year in which they vest. of the demanding target levels we had set for 2018 performance, we believe that the formulaic score, and the annual bonuses that result, Deferred fairly reflect and reward 2018 performance for the executive directors Adjusted Paid into BP and senior leadership of BP. Accordingly we have made no discretionary Name outcome in cash shares adjustments to the formulaic scorecard outcome, which applies to the Bob Dudley $1,689,458 $844,729 $844,729 executive directors and BP’s senior leadership (approximately 4,400 Brian Gilvary £706,219a £353,109 £353,109 employees). a Due to rounding, the total does not agree exactly with the sum of its component parts. 2016-18 performance share plan outcome Vesting levels for the 2016-18 performance share awards we granted ratio over the period, which yields vesting at 80% of maximum for this in 2016 are determined under the terms of the 2014 policy, in line with element. We will confirm our final outcome for this measure once the performance measures and outcomes shown on the scorecard on competitor data is published in full later in the year. page 93. As before, we have assessed performance against the safety and Assessed against these scorecard measures, the group’s performance for operational risk measure by looking back at tier 1 process safety the three years from 2016 to 2018 is strong. Notably, we placed first on incidents and recordable injury frequency over the three-year period. relative total shareholder return (with 49.3%) which measures us against This is a detailed assessment looking at year-on-year performance our super-major peers, Chevron, ExxonMobil, Shell and Total. We also for which we sought input from the SEEAC. Based on continuing placed first in the 2015-17 performance cycle. Total shareholder return reductions in tier 1 events and in recordable injury frequency, and the represents the change in value of a shareholding over a three-year period, SEEAC overview, we assessed a score of 88% of maximum for this assuming that dividends are re-invested to purchase additional shares. element of the performance shares scorecard. BP’s standard practice is to calculate this change in value based on the While the scorecard provides a balanced view of longer-term results, average US market prices over the fourth quarter immediately before, as a committee we wish to take a broader view of performance in order and at the end of, the three-year performance cycle. Using a three- to ensure reward outcomes are proportional and appropriate. Our first month period average helps to counter the impact of share price concern is to ensure outcomes align with shareholders’ own experience volatility. of both returns, and of the company’s positioning to generate value into the future. In this regard we believe the scorecard has worked well. The choice of basis period for calculating share price growth can be a material factor in the ranking result. This generally explains why our Clearly there are also broader societal views to consider, together with peers who use relative TSR in their remuneration plans can arrive at a the general experience of the wider workforce as a key stakeholder different result. For example, in the three year scorecard period just group. These broader considerations create a compelling case for ended, BP and Shell showed different relative TSR rankings because restraint on quantum, even as they emphasize the need to align to unlike BP’s average of the calendar quarter approach, Shell’s standard performance. basis is to use a 90-day averaging period around the start and end of the Therefore while we believe that 2016-18 performance has been performance period. exemplary, and that the business is both operationally and strategically We have again made strong progress in major project delivery, well positioned for the future, the committee has nonetheless decided exceeding the top of the measurement scale (13) with 19 major to reduce vesting of the performance share award from the formulaic projects delivered over the three-year period, allowing maximum 90.5% to a discretionary 80% of maximum. In applying this judgement vesting for this element. and making this reduction the committee decided to apply the more challenging measurement scales of our 2017 policy. The committee Our $68 billion cumulative operating cash flow excluding the Gulf studied the impact of share price appreciation on pay outcomes and is of Mexico oil spill payments for the period exceeds the threshold satisfied that the gains arising are an appropriate and necessary design performance level of $61.2 billion, following adjustments for oil price feature of a long-term incentive. We believe there should be no routine in line with the 2014 policy. For the purposes of this report, we have adjustment, either for gains that in part reflect low grant prices, or for forecast a second place outcome for our relative reserves replacement shortfalls that reflect the opposite. 92 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 93 y performancey cators on page 16. c b indi See ke See   KPI 33.3% 27.3% 8.9% 11.1% 5.0% 90.5% 4.8% 29.8% 60.7% Outcome First $67.8bn Second 19 80% final vesting after committee discretion Formulaic vesting 90.5% First $73.2bn First 13 Maximum performance BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 The value of vested shares reflects the share price appreciation all three-year the shareholders experienced over period. 2016-18 For this award cycle, the original grant was calculated based on ordinary share and American depositary share (ADS) prices of £3.72 and $33.81 fourth-quarter 2018 the while respectively, £5.33 prices are average and $41.48. Consequently, share price appreciation accounts for $2.04 million of the value (18.5%) of Bob’s vested shares, and for £1.23 million (30.2%) of the value vested of Brian’s shares. The committee did not regard this as a direct reason exercise to discretion, although overall pay outcomes have been a partour of consideration of downward discretion. Third 9 Assessment of improvement over the three years Third $61.2bn Threshold performance £535,863 and re-basingand $2,698,677 due to discretion discretion to due Reduction in value value in Reduction a Strategic imperatives 29.8% shares vested Value of Committee review of stakeholder context and experience over three-year period of plan 33.3% 33.3% 11.1% 11.1% 11.1% Weighting £4,082,769 $11,043,179 KPI   KPI KPI Shares   vesting KPI   including KPI dividends   765,998   1,597,374 b KPI   Shares awarded 786,559 1,809,582 a Measures used for the 2014 remuneration policy. Formulaic Formulaic vesting 90.5% Financial 60.7% Total formulaicTotal vesting REM Financial Cumulative operating cash flow Major project delivery Safety and operational risk: – Process safety tier 1 events – Recordable injury frequency Relative reserves replacement ratio reserves replacement Relative Measures Relative total shareholder return 2016-18 performance2016-18 shares Strategic imperatives Performance shares Performance Due to rounding, the total does not agree exactly with the sum of its component parts. Due to rounding, the sum of the weightings does not agree with the actual total, which is 100%. This original award was based on 550% of salary, according to the terms of the 2014 policy. Bob Dudley’s award is granted in respect of American depositary shares (ADSs). The numbers in this table reflect calculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS equates to ordinarysix shares. Forecast position, to be confirmed after external data becomes available later in 2019. Scorecard a b c a b Name Bob Dudley Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ Brian Gilvary In addition, and in line with treatment last the committee year, has agreed Bob’s to request re-base to his original grant from 550% of salary 500% to salary, of recognizing the change from the policy 2014 to the 2017 policy. theto The 2017 impact these decisions have on pay outcomes for Bob and Brian are detailed below.


 
Directors’ remuneration report Alignment with strategy The strategy we set in 2017 commits us to a balance of short-term Our longer-term view is explicitly covered in the strategic progress goals and long-term ambitions, encompassing both conventional element for our performance shares, alongside measures that focus and emerging sources of energy. To help the board and executive on shareholder returns and return on average capital employed (ROACE) management assess delivery against this strategy, we track progress over each three-year cycle. These are the measures we established two against a number of key performance indicators (KPIs) – see page 16. years ago with our 2017 policy, and we will see the first cycle of results This strategy and these KPIs represent the foundation of our investor under that policy when we report the 2017-19 performance shares proposition. Importantly the majority of our KPIs translate directly into outcome in next year’s report. Looking ahead, the committee has the measures we use to assess our annual bonus and performance decided to increase the weighting of the strategic progress measure share awards. This helps us align the focus of our board and executive from 20% to 30% to better reflect its importance. This will apply for the management with the interests of our shareholders. To maintain this performance shares we grant in 2019 as part of the 2019-21 cycle. As a alignment over time, we will adjust our bonus and performance share result, we will reduce the weighting on ROACE from 30% to 20%. measures as and when BP’s strategy evolves or finds new areas To ensure we take a rounded view in our performance assessment, the of focus. performance share plan also features an underpin to bring absolute TSR, The annual bonus rewards activities that assure our success in the near safety and environmental factors into account. This underpin allows the term, with measures focused on safety, reliable operations, financial committee to embrace the energy transition in a way that enhances our performance and, from 2019, a new emissions reduction target. investor proposition and allows us to be competitive at a time when Ensuring our near-term health is a critical building block for the longer prices, policy, technology and customer preferences are volatile and term, providing the funds for us to invest, innovate, pursue new evolving, while managing the alignment between remuneration opportunities and enhance our productivity. For instance, the reliable outcomes and our strategic progress. operations measure in our annual plan has a strong and direct bearing on the financial measures for our three-year performance share Reducing our Improving Creating outcomes. Our new sustainable emissions reduction measure, with a emissions in our low carbon 10% weighting for 2019, connects bonus outcomes directly with the our operations products businesses progress we make under the reduce element of our ‘reduce, improve, create’ (RIC) framework for a low carbon transition. See our low carbon ambitions on page 46. BP set out an update of its strategy in 2017, which was reinforced in the results announcements in February 2018 and 2019. The foundations for strong performance are safe and reliable operations, a balanced portfolio, and a focus on returns. How we align Safer Fit for Focused on Growing our strategy and future returns sustainable free remuneration cash flow and measures distributions to Safe, reliable A distinctive Value based, shareholders over and efficient portfolio fit for a disciplined the long term execution changing world investment and cost focus Annual bonus Safety Environment Reliable operations Financial performance Performance shares Total shareholder return Return on average capital employed Strategic priorities Underpin: absolute TSR and safety/ environmental factors 94 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance c e 95 £38 2017 £611 £611 £186 £752 £263 £936 £7,115 £1,060 £3,595 (thousand) Brian Gilvary e b £0 2018 £67 £769 £269 £353 £353 £7,977 £1,876 £2,083 £4,083 c d – – 2017 $70 $746 $1,491 $1,491 $1,854 $1,349 $9,455 $15,108 (thousand) Bob Dudley Bob d b – – $0 2018 $79 $845 $845 $1,854 $2,042 $11,043 $14,666 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 a g Shares – deferred for three years Cash bonus Performance shares Deferred share awards from bonuses prior-year Salary retirement and Pension savings value – increase Benefits Cash in lieu of future accrual f 38 for ordinary shares and include accrued dividends on shares vested. Brian Gilvary has voluntarily agreed defer to performance assessment 01 for01 ordinary shares and $39.85 for ADSs. In May 2018, after the external data became available, the committee reviewed the relative ear after retirement, therefore the performance period is expected exceed to the minimum term of three years. As stated in the 2017 pensation (Savings) Plan (ECSP) account under Bob’s US retirement savings arrangements. In Bob 2018 incurred investment losses formance achieved under the rules of the plan and includes accrued dividends on shares vested. In accordance with UK regulations, the vesting iods. This additional line shows the value of those awards that is directly attributable share to price appreciation,being the number of shares directors’ remuneration report, Bob voluntarily deferred performance assessment and vesting of the deferred 2014 and matching awards until at least one year after retirement – see the Deferred shares table on page for further 101 details on these awards.    The values shown for performance shares and deferred share awards include the share price appreciation experienced over the three-year vesting per vesting, including accrued dividends, multiplied by the increase in share price from grant date vesting to date. Bob Dudley has voluntarily agreed defer to performance assessment and vesting of the awards related annual his to 2015 bonus until at least one y Represents the assumed vesting of shares following in 2019 the end of the relevant performance period, based on a preliminary assessment of per price of the assumed vesting is the average market price for the fourth quarter which of 2018 was £5.33 for ordinary shares and $41.48 for ADSs. The finalvesting will be confirmed by the committee in the second quarter ofand2019 provided in the directors’2019 remuneration report. by less than inflation, hence the net increase reportedis zero as perregulations. Full details are set out on page 96. For Brian Gilvary this represents the annual increase in accrued pension, net of inflation, multiplied by 20. In Brian’s salary2018 increased of $193,910 in this account, hence this aggregate value is negative and reported as per zero regulations. Full details are set out on page 96.   and vesting of the matching awards related annual his to 2015 bonus for a further two years – see the Deferred shares table on page for further 101 details on these awards. The amounts reported relate the annual to for 2014 2017 bonus and have been adjusted from the number provided in the directors’2017 remuneration report include to the accrual and vesting of accrued dividends. The amounts reported relate for 2018 the annual to 2015 bonus deferred over three years, which vested February on 19 at the 2019 market price of £5. For Bob Dudley this represents the aggregate value of the company match and investment gains on the accumulating unfunded BP Excess Com Remuneration is reported in the currency in which the individual is paid  In accordance with UK regulations, single in the 2017 figure table, the performance outcome values were based fourth-quarteron average prices reserves replacement ratio position, and this resulted in no adjustment the to finalvesting of 70%. On 22 198,306May 2018, ADSsfor Bob Dudley and 603,831 ordinary shares for Brian Gilvary vested at prices of $47.09 and £5.88 respectively. On July 31 an additional 2019 2,599 ADS and 7,795 ordinary shares vested, representing accrued dividends at prices of $45.09 and £5.73 for Bob and Brian respectively. The reported 2017 values for the total vesting have therefore thousand increased for by Bob $1,168 and by £614 thousand for Brian. of £5. Total remuneration Total Performance shares Discontinued plans Retirement benefits Retirement Annual bonus Value attributable to share price appreciation price share to attributable Value Due rounding, to the total does not agree exactly with the sum of its component parts. Salary and benefits g f e d c b a Single figure table – executive directors(audited) Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ Executive directors’ pay for 2018 for pay directors’ Executive


 
Directors’ remuneration report Overview of single figure outcomes Bob has requested that the committee delay the performance assessment and hence the vesting of his 2015 deferred and matching The single figures of total remuneration for Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary awards. This reflects his commitment to the long-term success of BP are $14.67 million and £7.98 million respectively. This is a 3% decrease and adds to his alignment with shareholders’ interests. These awards for Bob, and a 12% increase for Brian. In both cases 2018 remuneration will now vest, subject to an assessment against the original safety and includes material value from share price appreciation over the 2016 to environmental sustainability conditions, after his retirement. Similarly, 2018 period. Both individuals pay a majority of their taxes in the UK. After Brian has requested a two-year extension to the performance these tax and social security liabilities on this BP income, the net values assessment and vesting date of his 2015 matching award. of 2018 total remuneration are approximately $7.77 million for Bob, and approximately £4.23 million for Brian. For the 2015 deferred award for Brian, the committee considered operational and financial performance and reviewed safety and Salary and benefits environmental sustainability performance over the 2016-18 period, Bob Dudley’s salary remained at $1,854,000 throughout 2018. Brian seeking input from the SEEAC on safety and sustainability measures. Gilvary’s salary was increased by 2% to £775,000 with effect from The committee concluded that safety performance continues to show 21 May 2018. Both executive directors received car-related benefits, improvement, with safety embedded in the culture of the organization assistance with tax return preparation, security assistance, insurance and supporting strong operational and financial performance. The and medical benefits. In 2018 BP reimbursed Brian for holiday committee concluded that the deferred award should vest in full. curtailment costs incurred due to BP commitments. Part of this reimbursement is considered non-business related, hence is subject 2015 bonus – deferred and matching awards to tax and included as a benefit in the single figure table. Total shares vesting, 2018 annual bonus and 2016-18 performance shares Shares Vesting including Total value at Please refer to pages 91-93 for details of the performance measures, Name granted agreed dividends vesting targets, and outcomes, and the related reward outcomes Bob Dudleya for annual bonus and performance shares.   Deferred award 551,784 –a – – Discontinued plans: deferral of 2015 bonus – deferred and   Matching award 551,784 –a – – matching awards of shares Brian Gilvaryb In accordance with 2014 policy, Bob Dudley and Brian Gilvary deferred   Deferred award 318,042 100% 387,160 £2,082,921c two thirds of their 2015 annual bonus. As a result, they each received   Matching award 318,042 –b – – an equivalent value deferred award of BP shares, together with a a matching award of BP shares. Both the deferred and matching awards Vesting of deferred and matching awards deferred until at least one year after retirement, subject to conditions. were subject to a three-year performance period which ended on b Vesting of matching award deferred for two years, subject to conditions. 31 December 2018. c Based on a vesting share price of £5.38. Conclusions of the safety and sustainability assessment No systemic No major incidents Safety culture and values Strong safety performance issues identified embedded within the supports efficiency and financial global organization results across the group Retirement benefits This cash allowance is a feature of the UK pension arrangement, and Bob Dudley is a member of the US pension and retirement savings plans will transition down to 15% of salary by 1 June 2023 – see page 105 described on page 108. His normal retirement age is 60. In 2018 Bob’s for more detail. The committee continues to review the value of pension accrued defined benefit pension did not increase. In accordance with the benefits for individual directors and its alignment to the broader workforce. requirements of the UK regulations, the amount included in the single History of group chief executive remuneration figure table on page 95 is therefore zero. In 2018 Bob made contributions to the BP Employee Savings Plan (ESP) totalling $27,000 and BP made Total Annual bonus Performance Group chief remuneration % of shares vesting matching contributions to the ESP, and notional contributions to the BP Year executive thousanda maximum % of maximum Excess Compensation (Savings) Plan (ECSP), totalling $129,780. 2009 Tony Hayward £6,753 88.9b 17.5 However, investment losses of $193,910 in his unfunded ECSP account 2010c Tony Hayward £3,890 0 0 (aggregating the unfunded arrangements relating to his overall service Bob Dudley $8,057 0 0 with BP and TNK-BP), exceeded the sum of these contributions, hence the amount included in the single figure table is zero. 2011 Bob Dudley $8,439 66.7 16.7 2012 Bob Dudley $9,609 64.9 0 Brian Gilvary is a member of the UK pension arrangement described on 2013 Bob Dudley $15,086 88.0 45.5 page 108 in common with more than 3,800 UK employees employed 2014 Bob Dudley $16,390 73.3 63.8 prior to 2010 (or before 2014 in the North Sea). His normal retirement age is 60, although benefits accrued before 1 December 2006 may be 2015 Bob Dudley $19,376 100.0 74.3 paid from age 55 with BP’s consent. Brian’s 2018 salary increase was 2016 Bob Dudley $11,904 61.0 40.0 below inflation, and his accrued defined benefit pension increase was 2017 Bob Dudley $15,108 71.5 70.0 therefore likewise below inflation. In accordance with the requirements 2018 Bob Dudley $14,666 40.5 80.0 of the UK regulations, the amount included in the single figure table is a Total remuneration figures include pension. The total figure is also affected by share vesting therefore zero. outcomes and these amounts represent the actual outcome for the periods up to 2011 or the adjusted outcome in subsequent years where a preliminary assessment of the performance Brian has exceeded the lifetime allowance under UK pension legislation for EDIP was made. For 2018 the preliminary assessment has been reflected. and now receives a cash allowance of 35% of base salary in lieu of b 2009 annual bonus did not have an absolute maximum and so is shown as a percentage of the maximum established in 2010. further service accrual. This amount has been separately identified c 2010 figures show full-year total remuneration for both Tony Hayward and Bob Dudley, in the single figure table on page 95. although Bob Dudley did not become GCE until October 2010. 96 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 97 Performance shares for our executive directors performance group same the assessed using are leader performance group the for scorecard used weightings. the to adjustment some with shares, Annual bonus for executive directors is directly performance group same the measures to related without but workforce, wider the as outcomes and individual and performance area business element. the Other than the addition of security-related addition of the Other than benefits, our executive director benefit packages are broadly aligned with other employees who joined BP in the same country at the same time. The salaries of our executive directors and executive team form the basis of their total remuneration, and salaries these annually. review we The primary purpose of the review is stay to aligned ensure comparators, we although market relevant with any increases are kept within the budgets set for our wider workforce salary review. Comparison with executive director remuneration director executive Comparison with 4,000); and all BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Looking beyond much pay, the of workforce experience atBP is centred on a disciplined approach performance to management, for which employees set annual priorities related both to safety and value creation, balanced with behavioural objectives that give focus the to importance of good conduct. This deeply embedded programme has served to develop the management skills of team leaders and drives quality dialogue between employees and their managers. We agree with the executive view that team’s the time invested in managing performance both aligns individual effort corporate to goals and allows employees to understand the value of their own contribution. The benefit of this approach is largely qualitative, through direction and feedback, but the individual contribution is also measured and then rewarded as part of the annual bonus. For a more immediate impact, BP is also encouraging more ‘in the moment’ feedback through our new global recognition introducedprogramme in ‘energize!’, 2018. Energize! has been well received in all business areas and locations, with 77% of employees recognized at least once, at a frequency of around 1,500 recognition moments every day by year end. With strong emphasis on diversity and inclusion create to teams that reflect their communities, and with the enduringfoundation of BP’s values and behaviours build to respect, we believe BP employees work in a supportive, meritocratic and progressive environment. This positive environment is reflected in being the highest-ranked recruiterUK in the oil and gas sector in the Times newspaper’s 100 Graduate Top Employer 2018. rankings other professional employees (approximately 35,000 potential participants, of whom 20% will participate). Vesting is subject group to performance outcomes for the group only. population leader We operate a performance share plan with three-year vesting for employees from our professional entry level and above. Operation varies based on seniority in three broad (approximately 400); leaders senior (approximately leaders group tiers: Approximately half of our global workforce participate in an annual cash bonus plan that multiplies a target bonus amount by a performance factor in the range 2. 0 to The performance factor is an average of performance outcomes measured at a group, business area and individual level. This structure places equal emphasis on the team, broad their of success the contribution, personal employee’s an importance of and the results achieved by BP. where parts business distinct our those of for plans bonus different operate We and trading our as such different, markedly are market the models in remuneration businesses. marketing We offer market-aligned benefits packages reflecting normal practice in each country in which we operate. Where appropriate, and subject scale, to we offer significant elements of personal benefit choiceto our employees. Our salary is the basis for a competitive total reward package for all employees, and we conduct an annual salary review for all non-unionized employees. non-unionized employees. all for salary review annual an conduct we and As we determine salaries in this review, we take account of comparable pay rates at other relevant employers, the skills, knowledge and experience of each individual, relativitypeers to individual within BP, performance, and the overall budget we set for each country. In setting the budget each we year, assess how employee pay is currently positioned business and increases, further market any of forecasts rates, market to relative context related such to things as growth plans, workforce turnover and affordability. Policy features forthe wider workforce shares benefits Salary Performance Performance Annual bonus bonus Annual Pensions and and Pensions Summary of remuneration structure for employees below the board Element Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ Widerin workforce 2018 Workforce experience Delivery our of strategy, both near and long term, depends upon BP’s success in attracting and engaging a highly talented workforce, and on equipping our people with the skills for the future. While the board is currently considering ways engage to more deeply with the workforce, and about the workplace in its broadest sense, the remuneration committee continues receive to and review information on pay outcomes and processes for our wider workforce. We are building insight the into remuneration models used in different BP entities and stay informed on the pay structures and typical salary budgets for the core areas of the business. group’s For example, we have looked at data from the organization’s gender pay reporting, at progression of reward across the hierarchyjob of levels, and reviewed the reward structures and processes in BP’s trading business. Overall we observe a well-balanced and structured approach reward to (summarized in the table below), and the to ‘non-financial’reward engaged an productive and environment. to contribute that elements This context has informed our decision making on executive director pay and our views on incentive outcomes across the group. In our consideration the of annual bonus scorecard for 2018, for instance, while we felt the formulaic result delivered appropriate outcomes for BP’s senior leadership, we agreed with Bob’s decision apply to a more generous outcome the to wider workforce on the basis that, individually, they have limited influence over financial outcomes such as cash flow.


 
Directors’ remuneration report Group chief executive-to-employee pay ratio Percentage change comparisons: GCE remuneration versus professional workforce In 2016 and 2017 we disclosed the ratio between our group chief executive’s (GCE) total remuneration and the median (P50) Comparing remuneration of a comparator group of our UK and US professional 2018 to 2017 Salary Benefits Bonus workforce (representing 38% of our global professional workforce). % change in GCE We believe this representation offers a valuable data point, highlighting remuneration 0% 8.0% -43.4% relevant pay differentials within BP. On this basis, our 2018 GCE % change in comparator group to median pay ratio is 106:1. remuneration 4.4% 0% -7.8% GCE pay ratios The comparator group used here is the same as used in our voluntary P50 pay pay ratio disclosures since 2017, i.e. our professional and managerial ratio on total P50 total grade staff in the UK and US. This group is employed on readily Year Method remuneration P50 salary remuneration comparable terms to the group chief executive, and represents a 2017 BP voluntary 105:1 $112,100 $136,865 approximately one third of our total employee base. 2018 BP voluntary 106:1 $114,800 $138,101 Relative importance of spend on pay ($ million) a Re-based from original 92:1 to reflect final value at vesting of 2015-17 performance shares. ���tr��ut�on� to Remunerat�on pa�d to �ap�tal �n�e�tment With effect from year ending 31 December 2019, the UK government ��are�older� all emplo�ee� will require that we calculate the total remuneration of the three BP UK employees whose remuneration represents the 25th, 50th and 75th 1���01 percentile of our entire UK workforce. We are then required to disclose ������ the ratio of our group chief executive’s total remuneration against each of those three representative employees. ������ 10�20� ������ 8�210a ���� 201� ���� 201� ���� 201� a Distributions to shareholders comprise dividend payments of $8,080 million ($7,867 million in 2017) and share buybacks at a cost of $355 million ($343 million in 2017). See page 275 for details. 98 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 99 8% 12% 17% 37% 37% 38% 52% 58% Men Women BP ExplorationBP Limited OperatingCompany ExplorationBP activities upstream covers in the UK, principally North Sea operations. ExpressBP Shopping Limited BP Express Shopping is our largest UK employing business, concerned with retail operations concernedbusiness, retail with supporting our UK-wide network of forecourts. 92% 88% 83% 63% 63% 62% 48% 42% The illustration below, from our UK 2018 gender pay gap reporting, highlights the representation issue and how it relates the to gender pay gap for each entity. For instance, our larger gender pay gaps relate BP to Exploration and BP p.l.c. where we have the largest differential between female representation in the top and bottom pay quartiles. By contrast, we reported negative a pay gap in BP Chemicals, where male female to consistent. more is representation BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Lower Lower Upper Upper 7% 15% 18% 24% 31% 32% 37% 56% 29% 30% 40% 64% 60% 36% corporate in employees covers predominantly p.l.c. BP BP Oil represents our downstream our represents Oil BP lubricants businesses. and fuels BP p.l.c. 71% 70% integrated our including functions, and business businesses. BP Air and trading and supply BP Chemicals is our petrochemicals business our Chemicals is BP in the UK, principally our operations in Hull. 69% 68% 44% 85% 82% 76% BP Chemicals Limited 93% BP Oil UK Limited 63% Lower Lower Lower Proportion of females and males in each quartile band These charts show how men and women are represented in each pay band. An even distribution across the quartiles would tend minimize to the gender pay gap. Equal pay and UK gender pay gap reporting As well as looking at pay structures,the committee hasspent time understanding how effectively current pay policies and processes manage fairness and avoid bias in payoutcomes. noted We the February UK 2018 gender pay gapreporting for the five legal entities covered by the regulations, and the explanations provided in the reporting. BP’s accompanied that narrative anti-discrimination the Overall that committeeassured the feels Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ controls written pay into policies, and the quality of processes behind individual pay decision making, are effective in delivering an equal pay environment (like pay work) for like for the wider workforce. While the UK gender pay gap reporting showed pay gaps in favourmen of for four out of the five entities, we understand that these gapsresult largely from the relative under-representation of women in senior roles, and that the primary group’s focus should therefore be on improving female representation, rather than adjusting pay practices. Thereforewe have reviewed the various initiatives taken by management address to these representation concerns and will continue monitor to progress in issues. underlying the addressing Upper Upper Upper


 
Stewardship and executive director interests We believe that our executive directors should have a material interest Multiple of in the company, both during their tenure and after they leave BP. Our Value of salary achieved shareholding policy therefore requires executive directors to build a Director Appointment date current shareholding (policy requires 5x) personal shareholding of five times their salary within five years of their Bob Dudley October 2010 $27,185,318 14.66 x salary appointment. They are expected to maintain personal shareholdings of Brian Gilvary January 2012 £12,256,532 15.80 x salary at least two and a half times salary for two years post employment. The executive directors have interests in both performance shares and deferred bonus shares under the executive directors’ incentive plan Directors’ shareholdings (audited) (EDIP). The share interests are shown in aggregate and by plan in the The tables below detail the personal shareholdings of each executive tables below. These figures show the maximum possible vesting levels. director, and demonstrate that both significantly exceed the policy The actual number of shares/ADSs that vest will depend on the extent requirement as at 15 March 2019. These figures include all beneficial and to which performance conditions are satisfied. non-beneficial ownership of shares of BP (or calculated equivalents) that have been disclosed to the company and exclude the anticipated vesting Unvested Unvested Unvested of the 2016-18 performance shares. ordinary shares ordinary shares Changes from ordinary shares or equivalents or equivalents as 31 Dec 2018 to or equivalents at Director at 1 Jan 2018 31 Dec 2018 15 Mar 2019 15 Mar 2019 Ordinary Ordinary shares Ordinary shares shares or Changes from or equivalents Bob Dudleya 6,569,010b 6,825,606b 1,459,350 8,284,956 or equivalents equivalents at 31 Dec 2018 to total at Director at 1 Jan 2018 31 Dec 2018 15 Mar 2019 15 Mar 2019 Brian Gilvary 3,329,274 3,291,614 400,709 3,692,323 Bob Dudleya 3,065,520 3,718,284 -210b 3,718,074 a Held as ADSs. b This shareholding has been re-based to reflect the 500% of salary grant level of the 2017 Brian Gilvary 1,709,243 2,043,899 205,006 2,248,905 policy, in place of the original 550% per the 2014 policy. a Held as ADSs. b This reflects change in the equivalent value of BP ADRs under the BP Employee Savings Plan (‘ESP’), due to the BP ADR price movement. See page 108 for explanation of the ESP. Performance shares (audited) Share element interests Interests vested in 2018 and 2019 Date of award Potential maximum performance sharesa Number of of performance At 1 Jan Awarded At 31 Dec ordinary shares Face value of Performance period shares 2018 2018 2018 vested Vesting date the award, £ Bob Dudleyb 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 1,365,240 – – 1,205,430c 22 May 2018d – 2016-18 4 Mar 2016 1,645,074 – 1,645,074 e 1,597,374 f 2019f – 2017-19 g 19 May 2017 1,571,628h – 1,571,628 – – 7,418,084 2018-20i 22 May 2018 – 1,395,600 1,395,600 – – 8,206,128 Brian Gilvary 2015-17 11 Feb 2015 685,246 – – 611,626 c 22 May 2018d – 2016-18 4 Mar 2016 786,559 – 786,559 765,998f 2019f – 2017-19 g 19 May 2017 722,093 – 722,093 – – 3,408,279 2018-20i 22 May 2018 – 696,705 696,705 – – 4,096,625 a For awards under the 2015-17 and 2016-18 plans, performance conditions are measured one third on TSR relative to Chevron, ExxonMobil, Shell and Total (‘comparator companies’); one third on operating cash flow; and one third on a balanced scorecard of strategic imperatives. There is no identified overall minimum vesting threshold level but to comply with UK regulations a value of 44.4%, which is conditional on the TSR, operating cash flow, each of the strategic imperatives and strategic progress reaching the minimum threshold, has been calculated. For awards under the 2017-19 plan, performance conditions are measured 50% on TSR relative to Chevron, ExxonMobil, Shell and Total over three years; 30% on ROACE based on performance in 2019 and 20% on strategic progress assessed over the performance period. For awards under the 2018-20 plan, performance conditions are measured on the same basis as the 2017-19 plan, except ROACE which will be based on performance in the last two years of the performance period (i.e. 2019 and 2020). Each performance period ends on 31 December of the third year. b Bob Dudley received awards in the form of ADSs. The above numbers reflect calculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares. c Represents vestings of shares made at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan and includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. The market price of each share at the vesting date of 22 May 2018 was £5.88 and for ADSs was $47.09. These totals include the additional accrual of dividends which vested on 31 July 2018. d The 2015-17 award vested on 22 May 2018. Details can be found in the single figure table on page 95. e Bob Dudley has requested that the EDIP performance shares vesting in respect of the performance period 2016-18 is based on the 500% maximum annual award level which applies under the 2017 directors’ remuneration policy, rather than the 550% maximum annual award level which applies under the 2014 directors’ remuneration policy. The number reported here has been re-based to 500%. f For the assumed vestings in the second quarter of 2019 a price of £5.33 per ordinary share and $41.48 per ADS has been used. These are the average prices from the fourth quarter of 2018. g The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 19 May 2017 of £4.72. h In our 2017 report, the 31 December 2017 value for this award was incorrectly stated as 1,428,750. i The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 22 May 2018 of £5.88. 100 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance – – – – 101 787,529 749,447 655,861 655,861 696,870 696,870 344,890 344,890 the award, £ award, the 1,311,722 1,170,395 1,015,283 1,015,283 Face value of 1,330,268 2,030,565 28 Feb 2020 – – – – – – – – – – – – – – rcisable Expiry date imum vesting threshold level. Vesting date Vesting rst exe 19 Feb 2019 19 Feb 2019 20 Feb 2018 20 Feb 2018 fi 01 Sep 2019 07 Sep 2014 07 Sep 2021 Date from which j j h h ed min – – – – – – – – – – – – – – fi – vested Interests vested in 2018 and 2019 111,161 111,161 £5.27 Number of 193,580 193,580 ordinary shares Market price at date of exercise rs with a further one-year retention period. The face values 2018 ve yea 73,070 73,070 At 31Dec fi £3.72 £2.90 147,642 147,642 147,054 147,054 551,784 176,576 294,108 159,021 159,021 318,042 275,892 275,892 Option price –– – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – a 2018 c Awarded Awarded 2018 127,457 127,457 226,236 226,236 3,103 At 31 De – – Share element interests element Share 2018 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Post employment share ownership interests As we reported last maintain to year, their alignment with shareholders and in keeping with the long-term nature of our business, our executive directors will retain significant interests in BP post employment. These ongoing interests are centred on a) the personal commitment by each executive director maintain to actual holdings equivalent two to and a half times salary for two years post employment, and b) their anticipated interests in share awards under group plans which remain subject to vesting and/or holding periods at the time they leave BP. At 1 Jan 73,070 73,070 Potential maximum deferred shares maximum deferred Potential 88,288 88,288 147,642 147,642 147,054 147,054 551,784 176,576 294,108 159,021 159,021 318,042 275,892 275,892 Exercised 100,000 400,000 i – – – lculated equivalents in ordinary shares. One ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares. Granted ect ca fl 4 Mar 2016 4 Mar 2016 4 Mar 2016 4 Mar 2016 4 Mar 2016 4 Mar 2016 deferred shares deferred 11 Feb2015 11 11 Feb 2015 11 11 Feb2015 11 Feb2015 11 Feb2015 11 11 Feb2015 11 Date of awardDate of of 19 May19 2017 19 May19 2017 19 May19 2017 19 May19 2017 22 May2018 22 May 2018 k d d d d d d d i i 3,103 period 500,000 2017-19 2017-19 2015-17 2015-17 2015-17 2017-19 2017-19 2015-17 2015-17 2015-17 2016-18 2016-18 2016-18 2016-18 2016-18 2018-20 2018-20 2016-18 b Performance SAYE BP 2011 Vol Vol Vol Vol Type Option type At 1 Jan 2018 Mat Mat Mat Mat Mat Mat Comp Comp Comp Comp Comp Comp Comp Comp a f f c e g g year 2015 2016 2016 2014 2017 2017 2014 Bonus 2015 b 2011’ means 2011’ the BP plan. 2011 These options were granted to Brian Gilvary prior to his appointment as a director and are not subject to performance conditions. Represents vesting of shares at the end of the relevant performance period based on performance achieved under rules of the plan.Includes reinvested dividends on the shares vested. Brian Gilvary has voluntarily agreed to defer the performance assessment and vesting of these awardsperformance until the later of three period years post is expected award or one to exceed year post the minimum employment, term of three years. therefore the Bob Dudley has voluntarily agreed to defer the performance assessment and vesting of these awards untilexceed at least the minimum one year after term of three retirement, years. therefore the performance period is expected to The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares on 4 March 2016 of £3.68.The market price at closing of ordinary shares on May 19 2017 was £4.72 and for ADSs was $36.94. TheThe sterling market price value has at closing been used of ordinary to calculate the shares face on value. 22 May 2018 was £5.88 and for ADSs was $47.09. TheRepresents sterling value vestings has been of shares used to made calculate at the end the of the face relevant value. performance period based on performancevested. achieved The market under price rules of each of the plan share and used includes to determine reinvested the total value dividends at vesting on on the the shares vesting date of 20 Februarywhich 2018 vested was £4.75. on 22 May These 2018 and totals 31 July include 2018. the additional accrual of dividends Brian Gilvary has voluntarily agreed to defer the performance assessment and vesting of these matching awards for a total of Since 2010, vesting of the deferred shares has been subject to a safety and environmental sustainabilitydeterioration hurdle, and this will in safety continue. and environmental If the committee performance, assesses that there or there has have been been a material major incidents, eitherconclude of which reveal that underlying shares should vest weaknesses only in part, in safety or not and at all. environmental In reaching its management, conclusion, then the itcommittee may Bob will Dudley obtain received advice awards from the in the SEEAC. form of ADSs. There The is no above identi numbers re The face value has been calculated using the market price of ordinary shares February on 11 2015 of £4.46. have been calculated using the market prices of £4.46 per ordinary share February on 11 2015 and £3.68 per ordinary share on 4 March 2016. The market price of each shareused to determine the total value on the vesting date February of 19 2019 was £5.38. ‘BP The closing market price of an ordinary share on 31 December 2018 was £4.96. During 2018 the highest market price was £5.98 and the lowest market price was £4.60. Neither Bob Dudley or Brian Gilvary have any interest in BP preference shares, debentures or option plans (other than as listed above), and neither have interests in shares or loan stock of any subsidiary company. No directors or other executive team members (see page 63) own more of the ordinarythan 1% shares in issue. MarchAt 15 2019, our directors and other executive team members collectively held interests of 17,436,602 ordinary shares or their calculated equivalents, 5,978,567 restricted share units (with or without performance 11,977,279 equivalents, calculated their or conditions) shares or their calculated options over equivalents and 4,417,149 ordinary shares or their calculated equivalents, under BP group share schemes. option Brian Gilvary Brian a b In common with many of our UK employees, Brian Gilvary holds options under the BP group save as you earn (SAYE) schemes as shown below. These options are not subject performance to conditions. Share interests in share options plans (audited) i j k f g h b c d e a Bob Dudley Bob Deferred shares (audited) Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ Brian Gilvary Brian


 
Non-executive director outcomes and interests The board’s remuneration policy for the chairman and non-executive Non-executive directors fee structure directors (NEDs) was approved at the 2017 AGM and implemented The table below shows the fee structure for non-executive directors. during 2017. There has been no variance of the fees or allowances for the chairman and the NEDs since approval in 2017. Fees £ thousand a Chairman Senior independent director 120 Board member 90 The fee structure for the chairman, which has been in place since May Audit, geopolitical, remuneration and 2013, is £785,000 per year. The chairman is not eligible for committee SEEA committees chairmanship feesb 30 chairmanship and membership fees or intercontinental travel allowance. Committee membership feec 20 As chairman throughout 2018, Carl-Henric Svanberg had the use of a Intercontinental travel allowance 5 fully maintained office for company business, a car and driver, and a The senior independent director is eligible for committee chairmanship fees and security advice in London. He received a contribution to an office and intercontinental travel allowance plus any committee membership fees. secretarial support as appropriate to his needs in Sweden. The table b Committee chairmen do not receive an additional membership fee for the committee they chair. below shows the fees paid for the year ended 31 December 2018. c For members of the audit, geopolitical, SEEA and remuneration committees. 2018 remuneration (audited) 2018 remuneration (audited) £ thousand Fees Benefitsa Total £ thousand Fees Benefitsa Totalb 2018 2017 2018 2017 2018 2017 2018 2017 2018 2017 2018 2017 Carl-Henric Svanberg 785 785 24 35 809 820 Nils Andersen 132 115 11 17 144 132 a Benefits include travel and other expenses relating to attendance at board and other Paul Andersonc 69 155 6 27 76 182 meetings. Amounts disclosed have been grossed up using a tax rate of 45%, where relevant, as an estimation of tax due. Alan Boeckmann 155 165 10 11 165 176 Admiral Frank Bowman 160 155 14 15 174 170 The figures below include all the beneficial and non-beneficial interests Dame Alison Carnwathd 74 – 47 – 121 – of the chairman in shares of BP (or calculated equivalents) that have e been disclosed according to the disclosure guidance and transparency Pamela Daley 55 – 42 – 97 – rules in the Financial Conduct Authority handbook (‘the DTRs’) as at the Ian Davis 170 154 2 2 172 156 applicable dates. The chairman’s holdings as at 31 December 2018, as a Professor Dame Ann percentage of the shareholding policy, were 1,312%. Dowlingf 158 145 2 5 159 150 Helge Lunde 46 – 122g – 169 – Ordinary Melody Meyerh 160 86 26 23 186 109 Ordinary Ordinary Change from shares or shares or shares or 31 Dec 2018 equivalents Brendan Nelson 150 138 12 14 162 152 equivalents at equivalents at to total at Paula Rosput Reynolds 166 146i 33 8 200 154i Chairman 1 Jan 2018 31 Dec 2018 15 Mar 2019 15 Mar 2019 Sir John Sawers 150 145 1 5 151 150 Carl-Henric Svanberga 2,076,695 2,076,695 – – a Benefits include travel and other expenses relating to the attendance at board and other meetings. Amounts disclosed have been grossed up using a tax rate of 45%, where relevant, a Resigned on 31 December 2018. as an estimation of tax due. b Due to rounding, the totals may not agree exactly with the sum of its component parts. Helge Lund assumed the role of chairman with effect from 1 January c Resigned on 21 May 2018. d Appointed on 21 May 2018. 2019. His share interests are disclosed on page 103. e Appointed on 26 July 2018. f Fee includes £25 thousand for chairing and being a member of the BP technology advisory council. g Benefits include relocation expenses. h Appointed on 17 May 2017. i Amended from £140 thousand (fees) and £148 thousand (total) as originally disclosed in our 2017 report. 102 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance – 103 91% 67% 151% 417% 107% 107% 126% 135% 757% 273% 305% 446% achieved % of policy a – £81,914 £60,168 £60,168 £96,465 £274,113 $181,797 $181,797 £121,644 shareholding $128,627 $150,957 $327,358 £681,250 $535,214 Value of current £3,270,000 £3,270,000 c c c c c – 17,700 17,592 11,040 44,772 15,030 73,200 24,864 20,646 50,296 125,000 600,000 15 Mar 15 2019 equivalents at equivalents Ordinary shares or – 22,320 – – – – – – – – – – – – 15 Mar 15 2019 Changes from from Changes 31 Dec 2018 to c c c c c – BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 17,700 17,592 44,772 15,030 73,200 24,864 20,646 50,296 600,000 31 Dec 2018 Ordinary shares or equivalents at c c c c c – – – 14,198 11,040 11,040 47,500 44,772 22,320 22,320 24,864 20,646 30,000 58,200 125,000 125,000 1 Jan 2018 Ordinary shares or equivalents at threshold for such d b e f Resigned on 21 May 2018. Appointed on 21 May 2018. policy achieved based on annual equivalent fee for role of chairman. Based on share and ADS prices March at 15 2019 of £5.45 and $43.87. Appointed on 26 July 2018. Held as ADSs. Appointed 26 July 2018. Became chairman with effect from 1 January 2019. Percentage of Helge Lund Professor Dame Ann Dowling Paul AndersonPaul Alan Boeckmann Ian Davis Admiral Frank Bowman Payments for loss of office and payments to past directors (audited) We made no payments for loss of office during or respectin to of 2018 directors. former or current Sir Ian Prosser (who retired as a non-executive director of BP in April 2010) was appointed as a director and non-executive chairman of BP Pension Limited Trustees on 1 October 2010. During 2018, he received £100,000 for this role. Other than this, we made no payment any past to director of BP during (we 2018 have no minimis de a disclosures). NilsAndersen Non-executive directors’ interests (audited) The figures below indicate and include all the beneficial and Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ non-beneficial interestsof each non-executive director of the company in shares of BP (or calculated equivalents) that have been disclosed the to company under the DTRs as at the applicable dates. d e f b c Pamela Daley Brendan NelsonBrendan Dame Alison Carnwath Sir John Sawers Melody Meyer Melody Paula Rosput Reynolds Rosput Paula


 
Other disclosures Historical TSR performance Shareholder engagement F��� 100 �� Throughout 2018 we continued to discuss remuneration policy and approach with many of our largest shareholders, as well as investor �2�0 representative bodies. We plan to continue this dialogue in 2019, as we consider updates to our remuneration and minimum shareholdings policies for 2020. �200 The table below shows the votes on the report for the last three years. AGM directors’ remuneration report vote results �1�0 Year % vote ‘for’ % vote ‘against’ Votes withheld et��al �100 �old�n� �100 t� et��al 2018 96.42% 3.58% 42,741,541 �100 2017 97.05% 2.95% 63,453,383 2016 40.70% 59.30% 464,259,340 �alue o� ��po o� �alue ��0 The remuneration policy was approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM on 17 May 2017. The votes on the policy are shown below. 200� 2010 2011 2012 201� 201� 201� 201� 201� ���� 2017 AGM directors’ remuneration policy vote results Year % vote ‘for’ % vote ‘against’ Votes withheld This graph shows the growth in value of hypothetical £100 investments 2017 97.28% 2.72% 36,563,886 in BP p.l.c. ordinary shares, and in the FTSE 100 Index (of which BP is a constituent), over 10 years from 31 December 2008 to External appointments 31 December 2018. The board supports executive directors taking up appointments Independence and advice outside the company to broaden their knowledge and experience. Each executive director is permitted to retain any fee from their external The board considers all committee members to be independent appointments. Such external appointments are subject to agreement by with no personal financial interest, other than as shareholders, in the the chairman and reported to the board. Any external appointment must committee’s decisions. Further detail on the activities of the committee, not conflict with a director’s duties and commitments to BP. Details of advice received and shareholder engagement is set out in the appointments as non-executive directors of publicly listed companies remuneration committee report on page 83. during 2018 are shown below. During 2018 David Jackson, the then company secretary, and Appointee Additional position subsequently Hannah Ashdown, both of whom were employed by the Director company held at appointee company Total fees company and reported to the chairman of the board, acted as secretary Bob Dudley Rosnefta Director 0 to the remuneration committee. Brian Gilvary Air Liquide Non-executive director Euros 70,500 The committee also received advice on various matters relating to the a Bob Dudley holds this appointment as a result of the company’s shareholding in Rosneft. remuneration of executive directors’ and senior management from Helmut Schuster, executive vice president, group human resources, and Ashok Pillai, vice president, group reward. Committee membership Please refer to the committee report on page 83 for details of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (‘PwC’) continued to provide membership of the remuneration committee during 2018. independent advice to the committee in 2018, following its appointment as independent adviser to the committee in September 2017, following a competitive tender process. PwC is a member of the Remuneration Consulting Group and, as such, operates under the code of conduct in relation to executive remuneration consulting in the UK. The committee is satisfied that the advice received is objective and independent. Freshfields Bruckhaus Deringer LLP provided legal advice on specific compliance matters to the committee. PwC and Freshfields provide other advice in their respective areas to the group. During the year, PwC provided BP with services including subsidiary company secretarial support. Total fees or other charges (based on an hourly rate) for the provision of remuneration advice to the committee in 2018 (save in respect of legal advice) were £179,200 to PwC. 104 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 105 ial performance – 50%. performance – ial onment – 10% ty – 20% able operations – 20% 19, performance will be assessed against: mmittee holds discretionadjust to outcomes reflect to ition, the executive directors have voluntarily elected to rpin – the committee will then review broader fits will remain unchangedfor 2019. These include e changes reduce Brian’s cash supplement sooner supplement cash Brian’s reduce changes e ting from 1 June 2019, we agreed reduce to Brian’s cash Safe Envir Reli Financ impacting safety environmental or sustainability, by the committee. Bonus is subject malus to and clawback provisions or restatement misconduct, as such events following Malus miscalculation. and results, of misstatement may also be applied following a material failure decided as circumstances exceptional other or Performance shares are subject malus to and clawback misconduct, as such events following provisions and results, of misstatement or restatement miscalculation. applied be also following Malus may a material failure impacting safety or environmental as circumstances exceptional other or sustainability, decided by the committee. – – – – defer the vesting date of certain other share awards, with performanceassociated otherwise conditions, would which unrestricted. been have In add For 20 Unde TSR, and safety absolute including performance, environmental factors in order determine to the final outcome. vesting Bene car-relatedpreparation, benefits,return assistance tax with security medical and benefits. assistance, insurance Star supplement of by salary 5% each year reach to 20% of salary with effect from 1 June 2021, with a further reduction, 5% Thes to 15% of salary,15% to with effect from September 1 2023. The co than the transition for other members of the BP UK defined UK BP the members of other for transition the than benefits plan, and Brian will not receive anyform of normal His reductions. the to related compensation retirement age is 60, although benefits accrued before 1 December 2006 may be paid from age 55 with BP’s consent. performance considerations. broader • • • • • • • BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 lative oil to and gas majors – 50% weighting. E – averaged over the full period – 20% weighting. onus earned is paid in cash, 50% is deferred into ress against our strategic objectives – 30% es aligned to BP strategy and shareholders’ interests. interests. shareholders’ and strategy BP to aligned es d Brian are expected maintain to a holding of at least orecard measures for the bonus are set annually to ffect from the AGM, Brian Gilvary’s salary will increase ecard outcome of 1.0, reflecting target on each e 2019-21 cycle, vesting level will first be assessed on ompares an to average increase of over 3.5% our to UK surement scale on every measurea scorecard – n is a member of the BP UK defined benefits pension ROAC Prog TSR re weighting. rual under his defined his benefitarrangements. under rual pension ding of five times salary. ee-year holding period.ee-year holding – – – The table below shows how the remuneration policy approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM by shareholders at the 2017 policy approved shows how the remuneration The table below . go to bp.com/remuneration full remuneration policy, please in 2019. For the will be implemented Continuing requirement for executive directors maintain to a hol Bob an two and a half times salary for two years post employment. outcome of 2.0. scales measurement sets priorities. reflect committee The year-on-year require that (disclosed retrospectively) improvement. Three-year performance further by period, followed thr Measur For th areas: these in years three performance the over future years. His normal retirement age is 60. Maximum bonus requires performance at the top of the mea A scor maximum bonus. of half delivers scale, measurement 50% of b shares for three years. The sc Bob Dudley’s salary will remain at $1,854,000 for 2019. With e by £790,500. to 2% This c salaried staff, effective on our annual salary review date 1 April. Since September 2016, Bob has had no further service acc The 401(k) benefits have been partially cappedfor Bria plan and he receives a cash supplement in lieu of further participants other service as in terms same accrual the on the plan, currently 35% of salary.  • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Directly linked long-term to performance and represents the largest part of total remuneration. Reinforces alignment with shareholder interests, and stewardship of the enterprise. Salary and benefitsreflect the scale and complexity of the role, and competitive practice in the market. The bonus links variable pay safety, to environmental goals, reliable operations and financial performance for the year. 2019 CFO – 450% of salary reflects Vesting three-year performance GCE – 500% Share ownership Long-term shareholding obligation Performance shares Annual bonus Reflectshome country market Reflectsrole and home country market benefits Retirement Salary and benefits Up 225% to of salary annual with Aligned objectives Executive director remuneration policyremuneration director Executive Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ 2019 for and implementation


 
Salary and benefits Bob’s annual salary will remain at $1,854,000 for 2019. Brian’s salary Salary increases over the last five years will increase by 2% to £790,500 from the date of the 2019 AGM. For Bob Dudley Brian Gilvary reference, the April 2019 annual pay review of our salaried employees in the UK was subject to a budget in excess of 3.5%. 2019 Nil 2019 2.0% We expect to maintain benefits at the current level. 2018 ��l 2018 2�0� 201� ��l 201� ����� 201� ��l 201� ��l 201� ��l 201� ��l Salary with effect from AGM Increase Bob Dudley $1,854,000 Nil Brian Gilvary £790,500 2.0% Annual bonus For 2019 we have amended our bonus measures to include an changes in plan conditions (including oil and gas prices and refining environmental measure (10%) alongside safety (20%), reliable margins) when reviewing financial outcomes at year end, and retains operations (20%) and financial performance (50%). This approach discretion to review outcomes in the context of overall performance. will provide a balanced assessment of how the business has performed Awards will be subject to malus and clawback provisions as described over the course of the year and of our progress in addressing emissions in the 2017 policy. reduction. We are also changing downstream refining availability to BP-operated downstream refining availability to more closely align to our The maximum bonus opportunity remains 225% of salary, for a BP-operated upstream plant reliability measure. maximum bonus score of 2.0. In accordance with the 2017 policy, the bonus payable for performance which meets the annual plan The committee has set the 2019 targets after consultation on the safety (i.e. a bonus score of 1.0 out of a maximum of 2.0) is half of maximum, targets with the SEEAC and on the financial targets with the MBAC. 112.5% of salary. Although the detail of these targets is currently commercially sensitive, the committee will provide retrospective disclosure following the year For any bonus earned, 50% will be delivered in cash and 50% will be end, as with previous cycles. As before, the committee will consider deferred into shares that will vest after three years. Measures for 2019 annual bonus Element Safety Environment Financial performance Reliable operations 20% 10% 50% 20% Measures Weighting Measures Weighting Measures Weighting Measures Weighting include for 2019 include for 2019 include for 2019 include for 2019 Recordable injury 10% Sustainable emissions 10% Operating cash 20% BP-operated upstream 10% frequency  KPI reduction  KPI flow xcludinge Gulf of plant reliability  KPI Tier 1 and tier 2 process 10% Mexico oil spill payments KPI BP-operated 10% safety events  KPI Underlying 20% downstream refining replacement availability (Solomon cost profit  KPI Associates’ operational Upstream unit 10% availability)  KPI production costs  KPI 106 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 107 t-led downstream growth the in ower and renewables trading renewables and ower ing gas and advantaged oil in the uring and low carbon across multiple fronts Grow upstream Marke Vent Gas, p growth marketing and • Strategic progress 30% • • • KPI b BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Future growthFuture Measures for the strategic element are directly focused on deliveryof resilience portfolio the for positioning long-term strategy, company’s the and future growth. We will be following the implementation of our strategy through the four measures relating the to strategic priorities set out below. The committee has also sought input from the board specific the regarding measures. Detailsthe of strategic progress targets – which carry a 30% weighting in the vesting calculation – are commercially sensitive and are not included in this report. the committee However, intends provide to detailed retrospective disclosure after the end of the performance period so that shareholders will be able review to the basis of our assessment.The board regularly reviews progress on the strategic quarterly BP’s announcement and year priorities results the throughout progress. strategic group’s the on updates includes Broader performance assessment – the underpin Prior approving to vesting outcomes, the committee will also consider the broader performance of the business including absolute TSR (including factors performance, environmental with safety and together consideration issues of around greenhouse gases) over the three-year period. this to We refer as the underpin. The underpin will be applied after the formulaic outcome for the performance shares but before the finalvesting outcome has been determined. In looking at environmental factors, the committee will consider the improving emissions, reducing as such issues on progress group’s our products and creating low carbon businesses – see page 46. Return average capital on employed 20% 12.5% return on average12.5% capital employed 0% of element 8.5% return on average capital employed 100% of element KPI a 25% of element25% Third out five of 100% of element place First 50% Threshold vesting Maximum vesting Relative TSR versus oil majors Based on the average of performance over 2019, 2020 and 2021. There will be straight-line vesting for performance between the threshold and maximum vesting level. Adjustments may Element be required in certain circumstances (e.g. to reflect changes in accounting standards). Nil vesting for fourth and fifth place.Vesting of 80% for second place. Measures performance for 2019-21 shares a b Performance shares Performance Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ In line with policy, our the2017 performance share awards for our 2019-21 cycle will be granted at in the 2019 level of 500% of salary for Bob and 450% of salary for Brian. Performance will then be measured over three years, with any vested shares being subject a mandatory to holding period further of a three years. These awards are subject to malus and clawback provisions as set out in the policy. The measures for the 2019-21 cycle of performance shares focus on shareholder value, capital discipline and future growth. Shareholder value The TSR element is measured on a relative basis against the oil majors: Chevron, ExxonMobil, Shell We maintain and Total. our belief that the current comparator group remains appropriate as it is used for benchmarking across a range of activities in otherparts of the group. This measure carries a 50% weighting in the vesting calculation, with targets shown below. disciplineCapital ROACE is calculated by dividing the underlying replacement cost profit (after adding back net interest) by average capital employed excluding cash and goodwill (see Glossary on page for full definition). 315 ROACE is measured based on the actual price environmentfor each of the years in question; there will be no adjustments for changes plan to conditions. For the 2019-21 performance shares award, this assessment will be averaged over the full three-year period. This ROACE measure carries a 20% weighting in the vesting calculation, and targets are shown in the table below.


 
Retirement benefits Bob Dudley Bob is provided with pension benefits and retirement savings through a provided directly by the company rather than through the BPPS. The combination of tax-qualified and non-qualified benefit plans. His normal rules of this non-qualified arrangement are designed to mirror the design retirement age is 60. of the approved BPPS. The BP Supplemental Executive Retirement Benefit Plan (SERB) is a The BPPS is closed to new hires, but for existing participants the plan non-qualified defined benefit pension plan which provides a pension of continues to provide a pension of one sixtieth of final base salary for 1.3% of final average earnings for each year of service, less benefits each year of service, up to a maximum of two thirds of final base salary, paid under all other BP (US) tax-qualified and non-qualified pension and a dependant’s benefit of two thirds of the member’s pension. plans. In 2016 Bob reached the SERB service limit of 37 years of service On 1 April 2011, Brian elected to stop future service accrual and instead and therefore no longer builds up further service accrual under these receive a cash allowance. His accrued benefits in the approved and pension plans. However the accrued benefit remains linked to highest unapproved plans remain linked to his final base pay. average earnings within the final 10 years. The benefit payable under the The rules of the BPPS were amended in 2006 to introduce a normal SERB is unreduced at age 60 or older. retirement age of 65, but in common with other BPPS participants in The BP Employee Savings Plan (ESP) is a US tax-qualified defined service on 30 November 2006, Brian has a normal retirement age of 60. contribution plan to which both Bob and BP contribute. BP matches Subject to the consent of the committee, Brian may retire between age Bob’s salary contributions to a maximum of 7% of base salary, up 55 and 60 and be entitled to an immediate pension, with a reduction to the IRS limit. The BP Excess Compensation (Savings) Plan (ECSP) (currently 3%) for each year before normal retirement age in respect of is a non-qualified, unfunded, retirement savings plan to which BP the benefit that relates to service since 1 December 2006 and no notionally contributes 7% of base salary above the annual IRS limit. reduction in respect of the remainder of his benefit. In common with around 2,000 other participants, Bob does not Irrespective of this, on leaving in circumstances of total incapacity, an contribute to the ECSP. immediate unreduced pension would be payable from his leaving date. Under both savings plans, Bob is entitled to make investment elections, BPPS members can elect to stop accrual and instead receive a cash involving the actual investment holdings in the case of the ESP, allowance of 35% of salary until March 2021, then progressively and the notional investment holdings in the case of the ECSP. Benefits reducing to 15% of salary by March 2024 (or such earlier date that they payable under the ECSP are unfunded and will therefore be paid from would have accrued a maximum two-thirds pension under the BPPS corporate assets. Accordingly annual investment returns on the ECSP had they not opted out). As noted above, on 1 April 2011 Brian elected are recognized as income for the single figure table, in addition to the to stop future service accrual and receive this cash allowance. Currently notional contributions themselves. Conversely, annual investment over 650 employees have elected to stop future service accrual under losses are offset against the value of contributions and notional the final salary plan and instead receive the 35% cash allowance. Brian contributions by BP and therefore reduce the amount recognized as has offered to accelerate the schedule of this progressive reduction. income for the single figure table. Accordingly reductions to 30%, 25% and 20% will be made with effect Brian Gilvary from 1 June 2019, 2020 and 2021 respectively, and a final reduction to 15% with effect from 1 September 2023 being the date on which Brian Brian is provided with pension benefits and retirement savings through would have reached a maximum two-thirds pension under the BPPS a combination of tax-qualified and non-qualified benefit plans and a had he not opted out. cash allowance. His normal retirement age is 60, although benefits accrued before 1 December 2006 may be paid from age 55 with BP’s consent. Brian is a member of a UK final salary defined benefit pension plan, the BP Pension Scheme (BPPS), along with over 3,800 other UK employees. Pension benefits that have been accrued in the BPPS in excess of the individual lifetime tax allowance set by legislation are provided to Brian via a non-qualified, unfunded pension arrangement Shareholding requirements Both executive directors remain subject to the share ownership requirement of five-times salary, which they currently exceed. Based on the commitments each director has made to the committee, we expect that Bob and Brian will each maintain shareholdings of at least 250% of salary for two years post employment. 108 BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018


 
Corporate governance 109 . BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 Non-executive directors are provided with administrative support and reasonable travelling expenses. Professional fees are reimbursed in the form of cash, payable following the provision of advice and assistance. Non-executive directors are reimbursed for all reasonable travelling and subsistence expenses (including any relevant tax) incurred in carrying out their duties. The reimbursement of professional fees incurred by non-executive directors based outside the UK in connection with advice and assistance on UK tax compliance matters. The level and structure of non-executive directors’ remuneration is reviewed by the chairman, the GCE and the company secretary who make a recommendation the to board. Non-executive directors do not on vote their own remuneration. Remuneration for non-executive directors is reviewed annually. Non-executive directors receive an allowance reflect to the global nature of the company’s business. The intercontinental travel allowance is payable for the purpose of attending board or committee meetings or site visits. The allowance is paid in cash following each event of intercontinental travel. The chairman is provided with an office and full-time secretarial and administrative support in London and a contribution an to office and secretarial support in his home country as appropriate. A car and the use of a driver is provided in London, together with security assistance. All reasonable travelling and other expenses (including any relevant tax) incurred in carrying out his duties is reimbursed. Remuneration is in the form of cash fees, payable monthly. Remuneration practice is consistent with recognized best practice standards for non-executive directors’ remuneration and, as a UK-listed company, the level and structure of non-executive directors’ remuneration will primarily be compared against UK best practice. Additional fees may be payable reflect to additional boardresponsibilities, forexample, committee chairmanship and membership and for the role of senior independent director. Remuneration is in the form cash of fees, payable monthly. The level and structure of the chairman’s remuneration will practice. best UK against compared be primarily The quantum and structure of the non-executive chairman’s remuneration is reviewed annually by the remuneration committee, which makes a recommendation the to board. The chairman is provided with support and reasonable travelling expenses The table below shows the remuneration policy approved by shareholders at policy approved by shareholders shows the remuneration The table below . policy, please go to bp.com/remuneration For the full remuneration the 2017 AGM.  Operation and Operation opportunity Operation and Operation opportunity Operation and Operation opportunity Operation and Operation opportunity Operation and Operation opportunity Approach Approach Benefitsexpenses and Other fees and benefits allowance Intercontinental Non-executive directors Fees Approach Benefits and expenses Approach Approach Non-executive chairman Fees The maximum fees for non-executive directors are set in accordance with the Articles of Association. Directors’ remuneration report remuneration Directors’ policyNon-executive 2019 for remuneration director This directors’ remuneration report was approved by the board and signed on its behalf by Jens Bertelsen, company secretary on 29 March 2019.


 
Pages 110-111 have been removed as they do not form part of BP’s Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.


 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial
statements
 
 
 
Independent auditor’s
 
 
 
Group statement of
 
 
 
reports
 
 
changes in equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
Group statement of
 
 
 
 
 
 
comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.
Significant accounting
 
 
22.
Trade and other
 
 
 
 
 
policies
 
 
payables
 
 
 
2.
Significant event - Gulf
 
 
23.
Provisions
 
 
 
 
of Mexico oil spill
 
24.
Pensions and other post-
 
 
 
 
3.
Business combinations
 
 
 
retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
and other significant
 
 
25.
Cash and cash equivalents
 
 
 
 
transactions
 
26.
Finance debt
 
 
 
4.
Disposals and
 
 
27.
Capital disclosures and
 
 
 
 
 
impairment
 
 
analysis of changes in net
 
 
 
 
5.
Segmental analysis
 
 
debt
 
 
 
6.
Revenue from contracts
 
 
28.
Operating leases
 
 
 
 
with customers
 
29.
Financial instruments and
 
 
 
 
7.
Income statement
 
 
 
financial risk factors
 
 
 
 
analysis
 
30.
Derivative financial
 
 
 
 
8.
Exploration expenditure
 
 
instruments
 
 
 
9.
Taxation
 
31.
Called-up share capital
 
 
 
10.
Dividends
 
32.
Capital and reserves
 
 
 
11.
Earnings per share
 
33.
Contingent liabilities
 
 
 
12.
Property, plant and
 
 
34.
Remuneration of senior
 
 
 
 
 
equipment
 
 
management and non-
 
 
 
 
13.
Capital commitments
 
 
executive directors
 
 
 
14.
Goodwill
 
35.
Employee costs and
 
 
 
 
15.
Intangible assets
 
 
numbers
 
 
 
16.
Investments in joint
 
 
36.
Auditor’s remuneration
 
 
 
 
ventures
 
37.
Subsidiaries, joint
 
 
 
 
17.
Investments in
 
 
 
arrangements and
 
 
 
 
 
associates
 
 
associates
 
 
 
18.
Other investments
 
38.
Condensed consolidating
 
 
 
 
 
19.
Inventories
 
 
information on certain US
 
 
 
 
 
20.
Trade and other
 
 
 
subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
receivables
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
21.
Valuation and qualifying
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
accounts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited)
 
 
 
Oil and natural gas
 
 
 
Standardized measure of
 
 
 
 
exploration and production
 
 
 
discounted future net cash
 
 
 
 
activities
 
 
flows and changes therein
 
 
 
 
Movements in estimated net
 
 
 
relating to proved oil and
 
 
 
 
proved reserves
 
 
gas reserves
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Operational and statistical
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
113


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
























Pages 114-125 have been removed as they do not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.


























This page does not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.

114
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.

Opinion on the financial statements
We have audited the accompanying group balance sheet of BP p.l.c. and subsidiaries (the Company) as at 31 December 2018, the related group income statement, statements of comprehensive income and changes in equity, and group cash flow statement, for the year ended 31 December 2018, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the 'financial statements'). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of 31 December 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the year ended 31 December 2018, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union and IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2018, based on criteria established in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting and our report dated 29 March 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting.
Basis for opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's financial statements based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audit included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audit also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.



/s/ Deloitte LLP

London
United Kingdom
29 March 2019

The first accounting period we audited was the 12 months ended 31 December 2018. In 2017, we commenced our audit planning procedures.


126
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.

Opinion on internal control over financial reporting
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of BP p.l.c. and subsidiaries (the Company) as at 31 December 2018, based on the criteria established in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting (UK FRC Guidance). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2018, based on the criteria established in the UK FRC Guidance.
We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 31 December 2018, of the Company and our report dated 29 March 2019, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.
As described in Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting on page 301, management excluded from its assessment the internal control over financial reporting at Petrohawk Energy Corporation, which was acquired on 31 October 2018 and whose financial statements constitute 10.3% and 4.0% of net and total assets, respectively, 0.2% of total revenues and other income, and 0.05% of profit for the year of the consolidated financial statement amounts as at and for the year ended 31 December 2018. Accordingly, our audit did not include the internal control over financial reporting at Petrohawk Energy Corporation.
Basis for opinion
The Company's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Definition and limitations of internal control over financial reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


/s/ Deloitte LLP
London, United Kingdom
29 March 2019

Consent of independent registered public accounting firm
We consent to the incorporation by reference of our reports dated 29 March 2019, relating to the consolidated financial statements of BP p.l.c. (the 'company'), and the effectiveness of the company's internal control over financial reporting, appearing in the Annual Report on Form 20-F of the company for the year ended 31 December 2018, in the following Registration Statements:
Registration Statements on Form F-3 (File Nos. 333-226485, 333-226485-01 and 333-226485-02) of BP p.l.c., BP Capital Markets p.l.c. and BP Capital Markets America Inc.; and
Registration Statements on Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-67206, 333-79399, 333-103924, 333-123482, 333-123483, 333-131583, 333-131584, 333-132619, 333-146868, 333-146870, 333-146873, 333-173136, 333-177423, 333-179406, 333-186462, 333-186463, 333-199015, 333-200794, 333-200795, 333-207188, 333-207189, 333-210316, 333-210318) of BP p.l.c.


/s/ Deloitte LLP
London, United Kingdom
29 March 2019

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
127


Consolidated financial statements of the BP group
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the shareholders and board of directors of BP p.l.c.

Opinion on the financial statements
We have audited the accompanying group balance sheets of BP p.l.c. (the Company) as of 31 December 2017, and the related group income statement, group statement of comprehensive income, group statement of changes in equity and group cash flow statement for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2017, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the "group financial statements"). In our opinion, the group financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of BP p.l.c. at 31 December 2017 and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2017, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as adopted by the European Union and IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
Basis for opinion
These financial statements are the responsibility of BP p.l.c.'s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to BP p.l.c. in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.


/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
We served as the Company's auditor from 1909 to 2018.
London, United Kingdom
29 March 2018

Note that the report set out above is included for the purposes of BP p.l.c.’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for 2018 only and does not form part of BP p.l.c.’s Annual Report and Accounts for 2017.































128
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Group income statement
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2018

2017

2016

Sales and other operating revenues
 
5

298,756

240,208

183,008

Earnings from joint ventures – after interest and tax
 
16

897

1,177

966

Earnings from associates – after interest and tax
 
17

2,856

1,330

994

Interest and other income
 
7

773

657

506

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

456

1,210

1,132

Total revenues and other income
 
 
303,738

244,582

186,606

Purchases
 
19

229,878

179,716

132,219

Production and manufacturing expensesa
 
 
23,005

24,229

29,077

Production and similar taxes
 
5

1,536

1,775

683

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
5

15,457

15,584

14,505

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

860

1,216

(1,664
)
Exploration expense
 
8

1,445

2,080

1,721

Distribution and administration expenses
 
 
12,179

10,508

10,495

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
 
19,378

9,474

(430
)
Finance costsa
 
7

2,528

2,074

1,675

Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
24

127

220

190

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
 
16,723

7,180

(2,295
)
Taxationa
 
9

7,145

3,712

(2,467
)
Profit (loss) for the year
 
 
9,578

3,468

172

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
   BP shareholders
 
 
9,383

3,389

115

   Non-controlling interests
 
 
195

79

57

 
 
 
9,578

3,468

172

Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP shareholders
 
 
 
 
 
Per ordinary share (cents)
 
 
 
 
 
   Basic
 
11

46.98

17.20

0.61

   Diluted
 
11

46.67

17.10

0.60

Per ADS (dollars)
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
11

2.82

1.03

0.04

Diluted
 
11

2.80

1.03

0.04

a 
See Note 2 for information on the impact of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill on these income statement line items.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
129


Group statement of comprehensive incomea 
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
 $ million

 
 
Note

2018

2017

2016

Profit (loss) for the year
 
 
9,578

3,468

172

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 
 
(3,771
)
1,986

254

Exchange (gains) losses on translation of foreign operations reclassified to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 

(120
)
30

Available-for-sale investments
 
 

14

1

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 
30

(126
)
197

(639
)
Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement
 
30

120

116

196

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the balance sheet
 
30


112

81

Costs of hedging marked to market
 
30

(244
)


Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 
30

58



Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
16, 17

417

564

833

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 
9

4

(196
)
13

 
 
 
(3,542
)
2,673

769

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
24

2,317

3,646

(2,496
)
Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 
30

(37
)


Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 
9

(718
)
(1,303
)
739

 
 
 
1,562

2,343

(1,757
)
Other comprehensive income
 
 
(1,980
)
5,016

(988
)
Total comprehensive income
 
 
7,598

8,484

(816
)
Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
 
7,444

8,353

(846
)
Non-controlling interests
 
 
154

131

30

 
 
 
7,598

8,484

(816
)
a
See Note 32 for further information.


130
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Group statement of changes in equitya 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Share capital and capital reserves

Treasury shares

Foreign currency translation reserve

Fair value reserves

Profit and loss account

BP shareholders' equity

Non-controlling interests

Total equity

At 31 December 2017
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9, net of tax
 



(54
)
(126
)
(180
)

(180
)
At 1 January 2018
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(797
)
75,100

98,311

1,913

100,224

Profit (loss) for the year
 




9,383

9,383

195

9,578

Other comprehensive income
 


(3,746
)
(216
)
2,023

(1,939
)
(41
)
(1,980
)
Total comprehensive income
 


(3,746
)
(216
)
11,406

7,444

154

7,598

Dividendsb
 




(6,699
)
(6,699
)
(170
)
(6,869
)
Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 



26


26


26

Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 




(355
)
(355
)

(355
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 
230

1,191



(718
)
703


703

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




14

14


14

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 






207

207

At 31 December 2018
 
46,352

(15,767
)
(8,902
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2017
 
46,122

(18,443
)
(6,878
)
(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843

Profit (loss) for the year
 




3,389

3,389

79

3,468

Other comprehensive income
 


1,722

410

2,832

4,964

52

5,016

Total comprehensive income
 


1,722

410

6,221

8,353

131

8,484

Dividendsb
 




(6,153
)
(6,153
)
(141
)
(6,294
)
Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 




(343
)
(343
)

(343
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 

1,485



(798
)
687


687

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




215

215


215

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 




446

446

366

812

At 31 December 2017
 
46,122

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2016
 
43,902

(19,964
)
(7,267
)
(823
)
81,368

97,216

1,171

98,387

Profit (loss) for the year
 




115

115

57

172

Other comprehensive income
 


389

(330
)
(1,020
)
(961
)
(27
)
(988
)
Total comprehensive income
 


389

(330
)
(905
)
(846
)
30

(816
)
Dividendsb
 




(4,611
)
(4,611
)
(107
)
(4,718
)
Share-based payments, net of tax
 
2,220

1,521



(750
)
2,991


2,991

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 




106

106


106

Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 




430

430

463

893

At 31 December 2016
 
46,122

(18,443
)
(6,878
)
(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843

a See Note 32 for further information.
b See Note 10 for further information.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
131


Group balance sheet
At 31 December
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2018

2017

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
12

135,261

129,471

Goodwill
 
14

12,204

11,551

Intangible assets
 
15

17,284

18,355

Investments in joint ventures
 
16

8,647

7,994

Investments in associates
 
17

17,673

16,991

Other investments
 
18

1,341

1,245

Fixed assets
 
 
192,410

185,607

Loans
 
 
637

646

Trade and other receivables
 
20

1,834

1,434

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

5,145

4,110

Prepayments
 
 
1,179

1,112

Deferred tax assets
 
9

3,706

4,469

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 
24

5,955

4,169

 
 
 
210,866

201,547

Current assets
 
 
 
 
Loans
 
 
326

190

Inventories
 
19

17,988

19,011

Trade and other receivables
 
20

24,478

24,849

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

3,846

3,032

Prepayments
 
 
963

1,414

Current tax receivable
 
 
1,019

761

Other investments
 
18

222

125

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

22,468

25,586

 
 
 
71,310

74,968

Total assets
 
 
282,176

276,515

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
22

46,265

44,209

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

3,308

2,808

Accruals
 
 
4,626

4,960

Finance debt
 
26

9,373

7,739

Current tax payable
 
 
2,101

1,686

Provisions
 
23

2,564

3,324

 
 
 
68,237

64,726

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 
22

13,830

13,889

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

5,625

3,761

Accruals
 
 
575

505

Finance debt
 
26

56,426

55,491

Deferred tax liabilities
 
9

9,812

7,982

Provisions
 
23

17,732

20,620

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 
24

8,391

9,137

 
 
 
112,391

111,385

Total liabilities
 
 
180,628

176,111

Net assets
 
 
101,548

100,404

Equity
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
32

99,444

98,491

Non-controlling interests
 
32

2,104

1,913

Total equity
 
32

101,548

100,404


Helge Lund Chairman
R W Dudley Group chief executive
29 March 2019

132
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Group cash flow statement
For the year ended 31 December
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Note

2018

2017

2016

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
 
16,723

7,180

(2,295
)
Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 
8

1,085

1,603

1,274

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
5

15,457

15,584

14,505

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
4

404

6

(2,796
)
Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 
 
(3,753
)
(2,507
)
(1,960
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 
 
1,535

1,253

1,105

Interest receivable
 
 
(468
)
(304
)
(200
)
Interest received
 
 
348

375

267

Finance costs
 
7

2,528

2,074

1,675

Interest paid
 
 
(1,928
)
(1,572
)
(1,137
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
24

127

220

190

Share-based payments
 
 
690

661

779

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 
24

(386
)
(394
)
(467
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
 
986

2,106

4,487

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
 
672

(848
)
(3,681
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
 
(2,858
)
(4,848
)
(1,172
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
 
(2,577
)
2,344

1,655

Income taxes paid
 
 
(5,712
)
(4,002
)
(1,538
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
22,873

18,931

10,691

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
 
(16,707
)
(16,562
)
(16,701
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 
3

(6,986
)
(327
)
(1
)
Investment in joint ventures
 
 
(382
)
(50
)
(50
)
Investment in associates
 
 
(1,013
)
(901
)
(700
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
 
(25,088
)
(17,840
)
(17,452
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
4

940

2,936

1,372

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
4

1,911

478

1,259

Proceeds from loan repayments
 
 
666

349

68

Net cash used in investing activities
 
 
(21,571
)
(14,077
)
(14,753
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of shares
 
 
(355
)
(343
)

Proceeds from long-term financing
 
 
9,038

8,712

12,442

Repayments of long-term financing
 
 
(7,210
)
(6,276
)
(6,685
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 
 
1,317

(158
)
51

Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 
 

1,063

887

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
10

(6,699
)
(6,153
)
(4,611
)
Non-controlling interests
 
 
(170
)
(141
)
(107
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
 
(4,079
)
(3,296
)
1,977

Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 
 
(330
)
544

(820
)
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 
 
(3,107
)
2,102

(2,905
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of yeara
 
 
25,575

23,484

26,389

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 
 
22,468

25,586

23,484

a See Note 1 for further information.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
133


Notes on financial statements
1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions
Authorization of financial statements and statement of compliance with International Financial Reporting Standards
The consolidated financial statements of BP p.l.c and its subsidiaries (collectively referred to as BP or the group) for the year ended 31 December 2018 were approved and signed by the group chief executive and chairman on 29 March 2019 having been duly authorized to do so by the board of directors. BP p.l.c. is a public limited company incorporated and domiciled in England and Wales. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), IFRS as adopted by the European Union (EU) and in accordance with the provisions of the UK Companies Act 2006 as applicable to companies reporting under IFRS. IFRS as adopted by the EU differs in certain respects from IFRS as issued by the IASB. The differences have no impact on the group’s consolidated financial statements for the years presented. The significant accounting policies and accounting judgements, estimates and assumptions of the group are set out below.
Basis of preparation
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis and in accordance with IFRS and IFRS Interpretations Committee (IFRIC) interpretations issued and effective for the year ended 31 December 2018. The accounting policies that follow have been consistently applied to all years presented, except where otherwise indicated.
The consolidated financial statements are presented in US dollars and all values are rounded to the nearest million dollars ($ million), except where otherwise indicated.
Significant accounting policies: use of judgements, estimates and assumptions
Inherent in the application of many of the accounting policies used in preparing the consolidated financial statements is the need for BP management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses. Actual outcomes could differ from the estimates and assumptions used. The accounting judgements and estimates that have a significant impact on the results of the group are set out in boxed text below, and should be read in conjunction with the information provided in the Notes on financial statements. The areas requiring the most significant judgement and estimation in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are: accounting for the investment in Rosneft; oil and natural gas accounting, including the estimation of reserves; the recoverability of asset carrying values; derivative financial instruments; provisions and contingencies; and pensions and other post-retirement benefits. Where an estimate has a significant risk of resulting in a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year this is specifically noted within the boxed text. The group no longer considers the recoverability of trade receivables to represent one of its significant accounting judgements following the adoption of IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments´ and resulting recognition of expected credit losses, see Impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards for more information. The group does not consider income taxes to represent a significant estimate or judgement for 2018, see Income taxes for more information.
Basis of consolidation
The group financial statements consolidate the financial statements of BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries drawn up to 31 December each year. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date of their acquisition, being the date on which the group obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date that control ceases. The financial statements of subsidiaries are prepared for the same reporting year as the parent company, using consistent accounting policies. Intra-group balances and transactions, including unrealized profits arising from intra-group transactions, have been eliminated. Unrealized losses are eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Non-controlling interests represent the equity in subsidiaries that is not attributable, directly or indirectly, to BP shareholders.
Interests in other entities
Business combinations and goodwill
Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recognized at their fair values at the acquisition date.
Goodwill is initially measured as the excess of the aggregate of the consideration transferred, the amount recognized for any non-controlling interest and the acquisition-date fair values of any previously held interest in the acquiree over the fair value of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date. At the acquisition date, any goodwill acquired is allocated to each of the cash-generating units, or groups of cash-generating units, expected to benefit from the combination’s synergies. Following initial recognition, goodwill is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. Goodwill arising on business combinations prior to 1 January 2003 is stated at the previous carrying amount under UK generally accepted accounting practice, less subsequent impairments. See Note 14 for further information.
Goodwill may arise upon investments in joint ventures and associates, being the surplus of the cost of investment over the group’s share of the net fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities. Any such goodwill is recorded within the corresponding investment in joint ventures and associates.
Goodwill may also arise upon acquisition of interests in joint operations that meet the definition of a business. The amount of goodwill separately recognized is the excess of the consideration transferred over the group's share of the net fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities.
Interests in joint arrangements
The results, assets and liabilities of joint ventures are incorporated in these consolidated financial statements using the equity method of accounting as described below.
Certain of the group’s activities, particularly in the Upstream segment, are conducted through joint operations. BP recognizes, on a line-by-line basis in the consolidated financial statements, its share of the assets, liabilities and expenses of these joint operations incurred jointly with the other partners, along with the group’s income from the sale of its share of the output and any liabilities and expenses that the group has incurred in relation to the joint operation.
Interests in associates
The results, assets and liabilities of associates are incorporated in these consolidated financial statements using the equity method of accounting as described below.

134
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Significant judgement: investment in Rosneft
Judgement is required in assessing the level of control or influence over another entity in which the group holds an interest. For BP, the judgement that the group has significant influence over Rosneft Oil Company (Rosneft), a Russian oil and gas company is significant. As a consequence of this judgement, BP uses the equity method of accounting for its investment and BP's share of Rosneft's oil and natural gas reserves is included in the group's estimated net proved reserves of equity-accounted entities. If significant influence was not present, the investment would be accounted for as an investment in an equity instrument measured at fair value as described under 'Financial assets' below and no share of Rosneft's oil and natural gas reserves would be reported.
Significant influence is defined in IFRS as the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the investee but is not control or joint control of those policies. Significant influence is presumed when an entity owns 20% or more of the voting power of the investee. Significant influence is presumed not to be present when an entity owns less than 20% of the voting power of the investee.
BP owns 19.75% of the voting shares of Rosneft. The Russian federal government, through its investment company JSC Rosneftegaz, owned 50% plus one share of the voting shares of Rosneft at 31 December 2018. IFRS identifies several indicators that may provide evidence of significant influence, including representation on the board of directors of the investee and participation in policy-making processes. BP’s group chief executive, Bob Dudley, has been a member of the board of directors of Rosneft since 2013 and he is chairman of the Rosneft board’s Strategic Planning Committee. A second BP-nominated director, Guillermo Quintero, has been a member of the Rosneft board and its HR and Remuneration Committee since 2015. BP also holds the voting rights at general meetings of shareholders conferred by its 19.75% stake in Rosneft. BP's management consider, therefore, that the group has significant influence over Rosneft, as defined by IFRS.
The equity method of accounting
Under the equity method, an investment is carried on the balance sheet at cost plus post-acquisition changes in the group’s share of net assets of the entity, less distributions received and less any impairment in value of the investment. Loans advanced to equity-accounted entities that have the characteristics of equity financing are also included in the investment on the group balance sheet. The group income statement reflects the group’s share of the results after tax of the equity-accounted entity, adjusted to account for depreciation, amortization and any impairment of the equity-accounted entity’s assets based on their fair values at the date of acquisition. The group statement of comprehensive income includes the group’s share of the equity-accounted entity’s other comprehensive income. The group’s share of amounts recognized directly in equity by an equity-accounted entity is recognized directly in the group’s statement of changes in equity.
Financial statements of equity-accounted entities are prepared for the same reporting year as the group. Where material differences arise in the accounting policies used by the equity-accounted entity and those used by BP, adjustments are made to those financial statements to bring the accounting policies used into line with those of the group.
Unrealized gains on transactions between the group and its equity-accounted entities are eliminated to the extent of the group’s interest in the equity-accounted entity.
The group assesses investments in equity-accounted entities for impairment whenever there is objective evidence that the investment is impaired. If any such objective evidence of impairment exists, the carrying amount of the investment is compared with its recoverable amount, being the higher of its fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. If the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount, the investment is written down to its recoverable amount.
Segmental reporting
The group’s operating segments are established on the basis of those components of the group that are evaluated regularly by the group chief executive, BP’s chief operating decision maker, in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance.
The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as the group’s accounting policies described in this note, except that IFRS requires that the measure of profit or loss disclosed for each operating segment is the measure that is provided regularly to the chief operating decision maker. For BP, this measure of profit or loss is replacement cost profit before interest and tax which reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains and losses from profit. Replacement cost profit for the group is not a recognized measure under IFRS. For further information see Note 5.
Foreign currency translation
In individual subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates, transactions in foreign currencies are initially recorded in the functional currency of those entities at the spot exchange rate on the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated into the functional currency at the spot exchange rate on the balance sheet date. Any resulting exchange differences are included in the income statement, unless hedge accounting is applied. Non-monetary assets and liabilities, other than those measured at fair value, are not retranslated subsequent to initial recognition.
In the consolidated financial statements, the assets and liabilities of non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures, associates, and related goodwill, are translated into US dollars at the spot exchange rate on the balance sheet date. The results and cash flows of non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates are translated into US dollars using average rates of exchange. In the consolidated financial statements, exchange adjustments arising when the opening net assets and the profits for the year retained by non-US dollar functional currency subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates are translated into US dollars are recognized in a separate component of equity and reported in other comprehensive income. Exchange gains and losses arising on long-term intra-group foreign currency borrowings used to finance the group’s non-US dollar investments are also reported in other comprehensive income if the borrowings form part of the net investment in the subsidiary, joint venture or associate. On disposal or for certain partial disposals of a non-US dollar functional currency subsidiary, joint venture or associate, the related accumulated exchange gains and losses recognized in equity are reclassified from equity to the income statement.
Non-current assets held for sale
Non-current assets and disposal groups classified as held for sale are measured at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell.
Significant non-current assets and disposal groups are classified as held for sale if their carrying amounts will be recovered through a sale transaction rather than through continuing use. This condition is regarded as met only when the sale is highly probable and the asset or disposal group is available for immediate sale in its present condition subject only to terms that are usual and customary for sales of such assets. Management must be committed to the sale, which should be expected to qualify for recognition as a completed sale within one year from the date of classification as held for sale, and actions required to complete the plan of sale should indicate that it is unlikely that significant changes to the plan will be made or that the plan will be withdrawn.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
135


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets are not depreciated or amortized once classified as held for sale.
Intangible assets
Intangible assets, other than goodwill, include expenditure on the exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources, computer software, patents, licences and trademarks and are stated at the amount initially recognized, less accumulated amortization and accumulated impairment losses.
Intangible assets are carried initially at cost unless acquired as part of a business combination. Any such asset is measured at fair value at the date of the business combination and is recognized separately from goodwill if the asset is separable or arises from contractual or other legal rights.
Intangible assets with a finite life, other than capitalized exploration and appraisal costs as described below, are amortized on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives. For patents, licences and trademarks, expected useful life is the shorter of the duration of the legal agreement and economic useful life, and can range from three to fifteen years. Computer software costs generally have a useful life of three to five years.
The expected useful lives of assets and the amortization method are reviewed on an annual basis and, if necessary, changes in useful lives or the amortization method are accounted for prospectively.
Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure
Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure is accounted for using the principles of the successful efforts method of accounting as described below.
Licence and property acquisition costs
Exploration licence and leasehold property acquisition costs are capitalized within intangible assets and are reviewed at each reporting date to confirm that there is no indication that the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount. This review includes confirming that exploration drilling is still under way or planned or that it has been determined, or work is under way to determine, that the discovery is economically viable based on a range of technical and commercial considerations, and sufficient progress is being made on establishing development plans and timing. If no future activity is planned, the remaining balance of the licence and property acquisition costs is written off. Lower value licences are pooled and amortized on a straight-line basis over the estimated period of exploration. Upon recognition of proved reserves and internal approval for development, the relevant expenditure is transferred to property, plant and equipment.
Exploration and appraisal expenditure
Geological and geophysical exploration costs are recognized as an expense as incurred. Costs directly associated with an exploration well are initially capitalized as an intangible asset until the drilling of the well is complete and the results have been evaluated. These costs include employee remuneration, materials and fuel used, rig costs and payments made to contractors. If potentially commercial quantities of hydrocarbons are not found, the exploration well costs are written off. If hydrocarbons are found and, subject to further appraisal activity, are likely to be capable of commercial development, the costs continue to be carried as an asset. If it is determined that development will not occur then the costs are expensed.
Costs directly associated with appraisal activity undertaken to determine the size, characteristics and commercial potential of a reservoir following the initial discovery of hydrocarbons, including the costs of appraisal wells where hydrocarbons were not found, are initially capitalized as an intangible asset. When proved reserves of oil and natural gas are determined and development is approved by management, the relevant expenditure is transferred to property, plant and equipment.
The determination of whether potentially economic oil and natural gas reserves have been discovered by an exploration well is usually made within one year of well completion, but can take longer, depending on the complexity of the geological structure. Exploration wells that discover potentially economic quantities of oil and natural gas and are in areas where major capital expenditure (e.g. an offshore platform or a pipeline) would be required before production could begin, and where the economic viability of that major capital expenditure depends on the successful completion of further exploration or appraisal work in the area, remain capitalized on the balance sheet as long as such work is under way or firmly planned.
Development expenditure
Expenditure on the construction, installation and completion of infrastructure facilities such as platforms, pipelines and the drilling of development wells, including service and unsuccessful development or delineation wells, is capitalized within property, plant and equipment and is depreciated from the commencement of production as described below in the accounting policy for property, plant and equipment.
Significant judgement: oil and natural gas accounting
Judgement is required to determine whether it is appropriate to continue to carry costs associated with exploration wells and exploratory-type stratigraphic test wells on the balance sheet. This includes costs relating to exploration licences or leasehold property acquisitions. It is not unusual to have such costs remaining suspended on the balance sheet for several years while additional appraisal drilling and seismic work on the potential oil and natural gas field is performed or while the optimum development plans and timing are established. All such carried costs are subject to regular technical, commercial and management review on at least an annual basis to confirm the continued intent to develop, or otherwise extract value from, the discovery. Where this is no longer the case, the costs are immediately expensed.
One of the circumstances that indicate an entity should test such assets for impairment is that the period for which the entity has a right to explore in the specific area has expired or will expire in the near future, and is not expected to be renewed. BP has leases in the Gulf of Mexico making up a prospect, some with terms that were scheduled to expire at the end of 2013 and some with terms that were scheduled to expire at the end of 2014. A significant proportion of our capitalized exploration and appraisal costs in the Gulf of Mexico relate to this prospect. This prospect requires the development of subsea technology to ensure that the hydrocarbons can be extracted safely. BP is in negotiation with the US Bureau of Safety and Environmental Enforcement in relation to seeking extension of these leases so that the discovered hydrocarbons can be developed. BP remains committed to developing this prospect and expects that the leases will be renewed and, therefore, continues to carry the capitalized costs on its balance sheet. The carrying amount of capitalized costs is included in Note 8.

136
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment is stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses. The initial cost of an asset comprises its purchase price or construction cost, any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset into the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management, the initial estimate of any decommissioning obligation, if any, and, for assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use, directly attributable general or specific finance costs. The purchase price or construction cost is the aggregate amount paid and the fair value of any other consideration given to acquire the asset. The capitalized value of a finance lease is also included within property, plant and equipment.
Expenditure on major maintenance refits or repairs comprises the cost of replacement assets or parts of assets, inspection costs and overhaul costs. Where an asset or part of an asset that was separately depreciated is replaced and it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the group, the expenditure is capitalized and the carrying amount of the replaced asset is derecognized. Inspection costs associated with major maintenance programmes are capitalized and amortized over the period to the next inspection. Overhaul costs for major maintenance programmes, and all other maintenance costs are expensed as incurred.
Oil and natural gas properties, including related pipelines, are depreciated using a unit-of-production method. The cost of producing wells is amortized over proved developed reserves. Licence acquisition, common facilities and future decommissioning costs are amortized over total proved reserves. The unit-of-production rate for the depreciation of common facilities takes into account expenditures incurred to date, together with estimated future capital expenditure expected to be incurred relating to as yet undeveloped reserves expected to be processed through these common facilities. Information on the carrying amounts of the group’s oil and natural gas properties, together with the amounts recognized in the income statement as depreciation, depletion and amortization is contained in Note 12 and Note 5 respectively.
Estimates of oil and natural gas reserves determined by applying US Securities and Exchange Commission regulations including the determination of prices using 12-month historical data are used to calculate depreciation, depletion and amortization charges for the group’s oil and gas properties. The impact of changes in estimated proved reserves is dealt with prospectively by amortizing the remaining carrying value of the asset over the expected future production.
The estimation of oil and natural gas reserves and BP’s process to manage reserves bookings is described in Supplementary information on oil and natural gas on page 210, which is unaudited. Details on BP’s proved reserves and production compliance and governance processes are provided on page 286. The 2018 movements in proved reserves are reflected in the tables showing movements in oil and natural gas reserves by region in Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited) on page 210.
Other property, plant and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over its expected useful life. The typical useful lives of the group’s other property, plant and equipment are as follows:
Land improvements
15 to 25 years
Buildings
20 to 50 years
Refineries
20 to 30 years
Petrochemicals plants
20 to 30 years
Pipelines
10 to 50 years
Service stations
15 years
Office equipment
3 to 7 years
Fixtures and fittings
5 to 15 years
The expected useful lives and depreciation method of property, plant and equipment are reviewed on an annual basis and, if necessary, changes in useful lives or the depreciation method are accounted for prospectively.
An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the item) is included in the income statement in the period in which the item is derecognized.
Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, and goodwill
The group assesses assets or groups of assets, called cash-generating units (CGUs), for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or CGU may not be recoverable; for example, changes in the group’s business plans, changes in the group’s assumptions about commodity prices, low plant utilization, evidence of physical damage or, for oil and gas assets, significant downward revisions of estimated reserves or increases in estimated future development expenditure or decommissioning costs. If any such indication of impairment exists, the group makes an estimate of the asset’s or CGU’s recoverable amount. Individual assets are grouped into CGUs for impairment assessment purposes at the lowest level at which there are identifiable cash flows that are largely independent of the cash flows of other groups of assets. A CGU’s recoverable amount is the higher of its fair value less costs of disposal and its value in use. Where the carrying amount of a CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, the CGU is considered impaired and is written down to its recoverable amount.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
137


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
The business segment plans, which are approved on an annual basis by senior management, are the primary source of information for the determination of value in use. They contain forecasts for oil and natural gas production, refinery throughputs, sales volumes for various types of refined products (e.g. gasoline and lubricants), revenues, costs and capital expenditure. As an initial step in the preparation of these plans, various assumptions regarding market conditions, such as oil prices, natural gas prices, refining margins, refined product margins and cost inflation rates are set by senior management. These assumptions take account of existing prices, global supply-demand equilibrium for oil and natural gas, other macroeconomic factors and historical trends and variability. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are adjusted for the risks specific to the asset group that are not reflected in the discount rate and are discounted to their present value typically using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money.
Fair value less costs of disposal is the price that would be received to sell the asset in an orderly transaction between market participants and does not reflect the effects of factors that may be specific to the group and not applicable to entities in general.
An assessment is made at each reporting date as to whether there is any indication that previously recognized impairment losses may no longer exist or may have decreased. If such an indication exists, the recoverable amount is estimated. A previously recognized impairment loss is reversed only if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was recognized. If that is the case, the carrying amount of the asset is increased to the lower of its recoverable amount and the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation, had no impairment loss been recognized for the asset in prior years. Impairment reversals are recognized in profit or loss. After a reversal, the depreciation charge is adjusted in future periods to allocate the asset’s revised carrying amount, less any residual value, on a systematic basis over its remaining useful life.
Goodwill is reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate the recoverable amount of the group of CGUs to which the goodwill relates should be assessed. In assessing whether goodwill has been impaired, the carrying amount of the group of CGUs to which goodwill has been allocated is compared with its recoverable amount. Where the recoverable amount of the group of CGUs is less than the carrying amount (including goodwill), an impairment loss is recognized. An impairment loss recognized for goodwill is not reversed in a subsequent period.
Significant judgements and estimates: recoverability of asset carrying values
Determination as to whether, and by how much, an asset, CGU, or group of CGUs containing goodwill is impaired involves management estimates on highly uncertain matters such as the effects of inflation and deflation on operating expenses, discount rates, production profiles, reserves and resources, and future commodity prices, including the outlook for global or regional market supply-and-demand conditions for crude oil, natural gas and refined products. Judgement is required when determining the appropriate grouping of assets into a CGU or the appropriate grouping of CGUs for impairment testing purposes. For example, certain oil and gas properties with shared infrastructure may be grouped together to form a single CGU. Alternative groupings of assets or CGUs may result in a different outcome from impairment testing. See Note 14 for details on how these groupings have been determined in relation to the impairment testing of goodwill.
As disclosed above, the recoverable amount of an asset is the higher of its value in use and its fair value less costs of disposal. Fair value less costs of disposal may be determined based on expected sales proceeds or similar recent market transaction data or, where recent market transactions are not available for reference, using discounted cash flow techniques. Where discounted cash flow analyses are used to calculate fair value less costs of disposal, estimates are made about the assumptions market participants would use when pricing the asset, CGU or group of CGUs containing goodwill and the test is performed on a post-tax basis.
Details of impairment charges and reversals recognized in the income statement are provided in Note 4 and details on the carrying amounts of assets are shown in Note 12, Note 14 and Note 15.
The estimates for assumptions made in impairment tests in 2018 relating to discount rates, oil and gas properties and oil and gas prices are discussed below. Changes in the economic environment or other facts and circumstances may necessitate revisions to these assumptions and could result in a material change to the carrying values of the group's assets within the next financial year.
Discount rates
For discounted cash flow calculations, future cash flows are adjusted for risks specific to the cash-generating unit. Value-in-use calculations are typically discounted using a pre-tax discount rate based upon the cost of funding the group derived from an established model, adjusted to a pre-tax basis. Fair value less costs of disposal calculations use the post-tax discount rate.
The discount rates applied in impairment tests are reassessed each year. In 2018 the post-tax discount rate was 6% (2017 6%) and the pre-tax discount rate was 9% (2017 9%). Where the cash-generating unit is located in a country which is judged to be higher risk an additional 2% premium was added to the discount rate (2017 2%). The judgement of classifying a country as higher risk takes into account various economic and geopolitical factors.
Oil and natural gas properties
For oil and natural gas properties, expected future cash flows are estimated using management’s best estimate of future oil and natural gas prices and production and reserves volumes. The estimated future level of production in all impairment tests is based on assumptions about future commodity prices, production and development costs, field decline rates, current fiscal regimes and other factors.
The recoverability of intangible exploration and appraisal expenditure is covered under Oil and natural gas exploration, appraisal and development expenditure above.
Oil and gas prices
The long-term price assumptions used to determine recoverable amount based on value-in-use impairment tests from 2024 onwards are derived from $75 per barrel for Brent and $4/mmBtu for Henry Hub, both in 2015 prices, inflated for the remaining life of the asset (2017 $75 per barrel and $4/mmBtu, both in 2015 prices, from 2023 onwards).
The price assumptions used for the five-year period to 2023 have been set such that there is a gradual transition from current market prices to the long-term price assumptions as noted above, with the rate of increase reducing in the later years.

138
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Oil prices rebounded in 2018 in the face of cooperative production restraint from OPEC and some non-OPEC producers, but weakened late in the year as production restraint eased and US supply recorded record growth. BP's long-term assumption for oil prices is higher than recent market prices, reflecting the judgement that recent prices are not consistent with the market being able to produce sufficient oil to meet global demand sustainably in the longer term, especially given the financial requirements of key low-cost oil producing economies.
US gas prices remained relatively low for much of 2018, before increasing temporarily in the final quarter due to a combination of low storage and cold weather. Strong growth of low-cost supply helped to moderate prices through much of the year. BP's long-term price assumption for US gas is higher than recent market prices as US gas demand is expected to grow strongly, both domestic demand as well as exports of liquefied natural gas, absorbing the lowest cost resources from the sweet spots, and forcing producers to go to more expensive/drier gas, as well as requiring increased investment in infrastructure.
Oil and natural gas reserves
In addition to oil and gas prices, significant technical and commercial assessments are required to determine the group’s estimated oil and natural gas reserves. Reserves estimates are regularly reviewed and updated. Factors such as the availability of geological and engineering data, reservoir performance data, acquisition and divestment activity and drilling of new wells all impact on the determination of the group’s estimates of its oil and natural gas reserves. BP bases its proved reserves estimates on the requirement of reasonable certainty with rigorous technical and commercial assessments based on conventional industry practice and regulatory requirements.
Reserves assumptions for value-in-use and fair value tests reflect the reserves and resources that management currently intend to develop. The recoverable amount of oil and gas properties is determined using a combination of inputs including reserves, resources and production volumes. Risk factors may be applied to reserves and resources which do not meet the criteria to be treated as proved. 
The interdependency of these inputs, risk factors and the wide diversity of our oil and gas properties limits the practicability of estimating the probability or extent to which the overall recoverable amount is impacted by changes to one or more of the underlying assumptions. The recoverable amount of oil and gas properties is primarily sensitive to changes in the long-term oil and gas price assumptions. Management do not expect a change in these long-term price assumptions within the next financial year that would result in a material impairment charge. However, sensitivity analysis may be performed if a specific oil and gas property is identified to have low headroom above its carrying amount. In 2018, the group identified oil and gas properties with carrying amounts totalling $22,000 million where the headroom, as at the dates of the last impairment test performed on those assets, was less than or equal to 20% of the carrying value, including $1,345 million in relation to equity-accounted entities. A change in the discount rate, reserves, resources or the oil and gas price assumptions in the next financial year may result in the recoverable amount of one or more of these assets falling below the current carrying amount.
Goodwill
Irrespective of whether there is any indication of impairment, BP is required to test annually for impairment of goodwill acquired in business combinations. The group carries goodwill of approximately $12.2 billion on its balance sheet (2017 $11.6 billion), principally relating to the Atlantic Richfield, Burmah Castrol, Devon Energy and Reliance transactions. If there are low oil or natural gas prices for an extended period or the long-term price outlook weakens, the group may need to recognize goodwill impairment charges against its Upstream segment goodwill. Sensitivities relating to impairment testing of goodwill in the Upstream segment are provided in Note 14.
Inventories
Inventories, other than inventories held for short-term trading purposes, are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Cost is determined by the first-in first-out method and comprises direct purchase costs, cost of production, transportation and manufacturing expenses. Net realizable value is determined by reference to prices existing at the balance sheet date, adjusted where the sale of inventories after the reporting period gives evidence about their net realizable value at the end of the period.
Inventories held for short-term trading purposes are stated at fair value less costs to sell and any changes in fair value are recognized in the income statement.
Supplies are valued at the lower of cost on a weighted average basis and net realizable value.
Leases
Agreements under which payments are made to owners in return for the right to use a specific asset are accounted for as leases. Leases that transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are recognized as finance leases. All other leases are accounted for as operating leases.
Finance leases are capitalized at the commencement of the lease term at the fair value of the leased item or, if lower, at the present value of the minimum lease payments. Finance charges are allocated to each period so as to achieve a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability and are charged directly against income. Capitalized leased assets are depreciated over the shorter of the estimated useful life of the asset or the lease term. Operating lease payments are recognized as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term except where capitalized as exploration or appraisal expenditure. See significant accounting policy: Exploration and appraisal expenditure.
Financial assets
Financial assets are recognized initially at fair value, normally being the transaction price. In the case of financial assets not at fair value through profit or loss, directly attributable transaction costs are also included. The subsequent measurement of financial assets depends on their classification, as set out below. The group derecognizes financial assets when the contractual rights to the cash flows expire or the financial asset is transferred to a third party. This includes the derecognition of receivables for which discounting arrangements are entered into.
From 1 January 2018, the group classifies its financial asset debt instruments as measured at amortized cost, fair value through other comprehensive income or fair value through profit or loss. The classification depends on the business model for managing the financial assets and the contractual cash flow characteristics of the financial asset.
Financial assets measured at amortized cost
Financial assets are classified as measured at amortized cost when they are held in a business model the objective of which is to collect contractual cash flows and the contractual cash flows represent solely payments of principal and interest. Such assets are carried at amortized cost using the effective interest method if the time value of money is significant. Gains and losses are recognized in profit or loss when the assets are derecognized or impaired and when interest is recognized using the effective interest method. This category of financial assets includes trade and other receivables.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
139


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Financial assets measured at fair value through other comprehensive income
Financial assets are classified as measured at fair value through other comprehensive income when they are held in a business model the objective of which is both to collect contractual cash flows and sell the financial assets, and the contractual cash flows represent solely payments of principal and interest. The group does not have any financial assets classified in this category.
Financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss
Financial assets are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss when the asset does not meet the criteria to be measured at amortized cost or fair value through other comprehensive income. Such assets are carried on the balance sheet at fair value with gains or losses recognized in the income statement. Derivatives, other than those designated as effective hedging instruments, are included in this category.
Investments in equity instruments
Investments in equity instruments are subsequently measured at fair value through profit or loss unless an election is made on an instrument-by-instrument basis to recognise fair value gains and losses in other comprehensive income.
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge
These derivatives are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. The treatment of gains and losses arising from revaluation is described below in the accounting policy for derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Cash equivalents
Cash equivalents are short-term highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash, are subject to insignificant risk of changes in value and generally have a maturity of three months or less from the date of acquisition. Cash equivalents are classified as financial assets measured at amortized cost or fair value through profit or loss.
Impairment of financial assets measured at amortized cost
The group assesses on a forward looking basis the expected credit losses associated with financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost at each balance sheet date. Expected credit losses are measured based on the maximum contractual period over which the group is exposed to credit risk. Since this is typically less than 12 months there is no significant difference between the measurement of 12-month and lifetime expected credit losses for the group's in-scope financial assets. The measurement of expected credit losses is a function of the probability of default, loss given default and exposure at default. The expected credit loss is estimated as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of the future cash flows the group expects to receive discounted at the financial asset’s original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is adjusted, with the amount of the impairment gain or loss recognized in the income statement.
A financial asset or group of financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost is considered to be credit-impaired if there is reasonable and supportable evidence that one or more events that have a detrimental impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset (or group of financial assets) have occurred. Financial assets are written off where the group has no reasonable expectation of recovering amounts due.
Financial liabilities
The measurement of financial liabilities depends on their classification, as follows:
Financial liabilities measured at fair value through profit or loss
Financial liabilities that meet the definition of held for trading are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss. Such liabilities are carried on the balance sheet at fair value with gains or losses recognized in the income statement. Derivatives, other than those designated as effective hedging instruments, are included in this category.
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge
These derivatives are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. The treatment of gains and losses arising from revaluation is described below in the accounting policy for derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Financial liabilities measured at amortized cost
All other financial liabilities are initially recognized at fair value, net of directly attributable transaction costs. For interest-bearing loans and borrowings this is typically equivalent to the fair value of the proceeds received, net of issue costs associated with the borrowing.
After initial recognition, other financial liabilities are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method. Amortized cost is calculated by taking into account any issue costs and any discount or premium on settlement. Gains and losses arising on the repurchase, settlement or cancellation of liabilities are recognized in interest and other income and finance costs respectively.
This category of financial liabilities includes trade and other payables and finance debt.
Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities
The group uses derivative financial instruments to manage certain exposures to fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, interest rates and commodity prices, as well as for trading purposes. These derivative financial instruments are recognized initially at fair value on the date on which a derivative contract is entered into and subsequently remeasured at fair value. Derivatives are carried as assets when the fair value is positive and as liabilities when the fair value is negative.
Contracts to buy or sell a non-financial item (for example, oil, oil products, gas or power) that can be settled net in cash, with the exception of contracts that were entered into and continue to be held for the purpose of the receipt or delivery of a non-financial item in accordance with the group’s expected purchase, sale or usage requirements, are accounted for as financial instruments. Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair value of derivatives that are not designated as effective hedging instruments are recognized in the income statement.
If, at inception of a contract, the valuation cannot be supported by observable market data, any gain or loss determined by the valuation methodology is not recognized in the income statement but is deferred on the balance sheet and is commonly known as ‘day-one gain or loss’. This deferred gain or loss is recognized in the income statement over the life of the contract until substantially all the remaining contract term can be valued using observable market data at which point any remaining deferred gain or loss is recognized in the income statement. Changes in valuation subsequent to the initial valuation at inception of a contract are recognized immediately in the income statement.

140
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
For the purpose of hedge accounting, hedges are classified as:
Fair value hedges when hedging exposure to changes in the fair value of a recognized asset or liability.
Cash flow hedges when hedging exposure to variability in cash flows that is attributable to either a particular risk associated with a recognized asset or liability or a highly probable forecast transaction.
Hedge relationships are formally designated and documented at inception, together with the risk management objective and strategy for undertaking the hedge. The documentation includes identification of the hedging instrument, the hedged item or transaction, the nature of the risk being hedged, the existence at inception of an economic relationship and subsequent measurement of the hedging instrument's effectiveness in offsetting the exposure to changes in the hedged item’s fair value or cash flows attributable to the hedged risk, the hedge ratio and sources of hedge ineffectiveness. Hedges meeting the criteria for hedge accounting are accounted for as follows:
Fair value hedges
The change in fair value of a hedging derivative is recognized in profit or loss. The change in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is recorded as part of the carrying value of the hedged item and is also recognized in profit or loss, where it offsets. The group applies fair value hedge accounting when hedging interest rate risk and certain currency risks on fixed rate finance debt.
Fair value hedge accounting is discontinued only when the hedging relationship or a part thereof ceases to meet the qualifying criteria. This includes when the risk management objective changes or when the hedging instrument is sold, terminated or exercised. The accumulated adjustment to the carrying amount of a hedged item at such time is then amortized prospectively to profit or loss as finance interest expense over the hedged item's remaining period to maturity.
Cash flow hedges
The effective portion of the gain or loss on a cash flow hedging instrument is reported in other comprehensive income, while the ineffective portion is recognized in profit or loss. Amounts reported in other comprehensive income are reclassified to the income statement when the hedged transaction affects profit or loss.
Where the hedged item is a highly probably forecast transaction that results in the recognition of a non-financial asset or liability, such as a forecast foreign currency transaction for the purchase of property, plant and equipment, the amounts recognized within other comprehensive income are transferred to the initial carrying amount of the non-financial asset or liability. Where the hedged item is an equity investment, the amounts recognized in other comprehensive income remain in the separate component of equity until the hedged cash flows affect profit or loss. Where the hedged item is recognized directly in profit or loss, the amounts recognized in other comprehensive income are reclassified to production and manufacturing expenses.
Cash flow hedge accounting is discontinued only when the hedging relationship or a part thereof ceases to meet the qualifying criteria. This includes when the designated hedged forecast transaction or part thereof is no longer considered to be highly probable to occur, or when the hedging instrument is sold, terminated or exercised without replacement or rollover. When cash flow hedge accounting is discontinued amounts previously recognized within other comprehensive income remain in equity until the forecast transaction occurs and are reclassified to profit or loss or transferred to the initial carrying amount of a non-financial asset or liability as above. If the forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, amounts previously recognized within other comprehensive income will be immediately reclassified to profit or loss.
Costs of hedging
Time value of options and the foreign currency basis spread of cross-currency interest rate swaps are excluded from hedge designations and accounted for as costs of hedging. Changes in fair value of the time-value component of option contracts and the foreign currency basis spread of cross-currency interest rate swaps are recognized in other comprehensive income to the extent that they relate to the hedged item. For transaction-related hedged items, the amount recognized in other comprehensive income is reclassified to profit or loss when the hedged transaction affects profit or loss. For time-period related hedged items, the amount recognized in other comprehensive income is amortized to profit or loss on a straight line over the term of the hedging relationship.
Fair value measurement
Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. The group categorizes assets and liabilities measured at fair value into one of three levels depending on the ability to observe inputs employed in their measurement. Level 1 inputs are quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs are inputs that are observable, either directly or indirectly, other than quoted prices included within level 1 for the asset or liability. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability reflecting significant modifications to observable related market data or BP’s assumptions about pricing by market participants.
Significant judgement and estimate: derivative financial instruments
In some cases the fair values of derivatives are estimated using internal models due to the absence of quoted prices or other observable, market-corroborated data. This applies to the group’s longer-term derivative contracts. The majority of these contracts are valued using models with inputs that include price curves for each of the different products that are built up from available active market pricing data and modelled using the maximum available external pricing information. Additionally, where limited data exists for certain products, prices are determined using historical and long-term pricing relationships. Price volatility is also an input for options models. Changes in the key assumptions, in particular price curves, could have a material impact on the carrying amounts of derivative assets and liabilities in the next financial year. The impact on net assets and the Group income statement would be limited as a result of offsetting movements on derivative assets and liabilities. For more information see Note 30.
In some cases, judgement is required to determine whether contracts to buy or sell commodities meet the definition of a derivative. In particular longer -term contracts to buy and sell LNG are not considered to meet the definition as they are not considered capable of being net settled due to a lack of liquidity in the LNG market and so are accounted for on an accruals basis.
Offsetting of financial assets and liabilities
Financial assets and liabilities are presented gross in the balance sheet unless both of the following criteria are met: the group currently has a legally enforceable right to set off the recognized amounts; and the group intends to either settle on a net basis or realize the asset and settle the liability simultaneously. A right of set off is the group’s legal right to settle an amount payable to a creditor by applying against it an amount receivable from the same counterparty. The relevant legal jurisdiction and laws applicable to the relationships between the parties are considered when assessing whether a current legally enforceable right to set off exists.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
141


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Provisions and contingencies
Provisions are recognized when the group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation. Where appropriate, the future cash flow estimates are adjusted to reflect risks specific to the liability.
If the effect of the time value of money is material, provisions are determined by discounting the expected future cash flows at a pre-tax risk-free rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money. Where discounting is used, the increase in the provision due to the passage of time is recognized within finance costs. Provisions are discounted using a nominal discount rate of 3.0% (2017 2.5%).
Provisions are split between amounts expected to be settled within 12 months of the balance sheet date (current) and amounts expected to be settled later (non-current).
Contingent liabilities are possible obligations whose existence will only be confirmed by future events not wholly within the control of the group, or present obligations where it is not probable that an outflow of resources will be required or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Contingent liabilities are not recognized in the consolidated financial statements but are disclosed unless the possibility of an outflow of economic resources is considered remote.
Decommissioning
Liabilities for decommissioning costs are recognized when the group has an obligation to plug and abandon a well, dismantle and remove a facility or an item of plant and to restore the site on which it is located, and when a reliable estimate of that liability can be made. Where an obligation exists for a new facility or item of plant, such as oil and natural gas production or transportation facilities, this liability will be recognized on construction or installation. Similarly, where an obligation exists for a well, this liability is recognized when it is drilled. An obligation for decommissioning may also crystallize during the period of operation of a well, facility or item of plant through a change in legislation or through a decision to terminate operations; an obligation may also arise in cases where an asset has been sold but the subsequent owner is no longer able to fulfil its decommissioning obligations, for example due to bankruptcy. The amount recognized is the present value of the estimated future expenditure determined in accordance with local conditions and requirements. The provision for the costs of decommissioning wells, production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives is estimated using existing technology, at future prices, depending on the expected timing of the activity, and discounted using the nominal discount rate. The weighted average period over which these costs are generally expected to be incurred is estimated to be approximately 18 years.
An amount equivalent to the decommissioning provision is recognized as part of the corresponding intangible asset (in the case of an exploration or appraisal well) or property, plant and equipment. The decommissioning portion of the property, plant and equipment is subsequently depreciated at the same rate as the rest of the asset. Other than the unwinding of discount on the provision, any change in the present value of the estimated expenditure is reflected as an adjustment to the provision and the corresponding asset where that asset is generating or is expected to generate future economic benefits.
Environmental expenditures and liabilities
Environmental expenditures that are required in order for the group to obtain future economic benefits from its assets are capitalized as part of those assets. Expenditures that relate to an existing condition caused by past operations that do not contribute to future earnings are expensed.
Liabilities for environmental costs are recognized when a clean-up is probable and the associated costs can be reliably estimated. Generally, the timing of recognition of these provisions coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites.
The amount recognized is the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the obligation. Provisions for environmental liabilities have been estimated using existing technology, at future prices and discounted using a nominal discount rate. The weighted-average period over which these costs are generally expected to be incurred is estimated to be approximately six years.
Significant judgements and estimates: provisions
The group holds provisions for the future decommissioning of oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines at the end of their economic lives. The largest decommissioning obligations facing BP relate to the plugging and abandonment of wells and the removal and disposal of oil and natural gas platforms and pipelines around the world. Most of these decommissioning events are many years in the future and the precise requirements that will have to be met when the removal event occurs are uncertain. Decommissioning technologies and costs are constantly changing, as are political, environmental, safety and public expectations. The timing and amounts of future cash flows are subject to significant uncertainty and estimation is required in determining the amounts of provisions to be recognized. Any changes in the expected future costs are reflected in both the provision and the asset.
If oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines are sold to third parties, judgement is required to assess whether the new owner will be unable to meet their decommissioning obligations, whether BP would then be responsible for decommissioning, and if so the extent of that responsibility.
Decommissioning provisions associated with downstream and petrochemicals facilities are generally not recognized, as the potential obligations cannot be measured, given their indeterminate settlement dates. The group performs periodic reviews of its downstream and petrochemicals long-lived assets for any changes in facts and circumstances that might require the recognition of a decommissioning provision.
The provision for environmental liabilities is estimated based on current legal and constructive requirements, technology, price levels and expected plans for remediation. Actual costs and cash outflows can differ from current estimates because of changes in laws and regulations, public expectations, prices, discovery and analysis of site conditions and changes in clean-up technology.
The timing and amount of future expenditures relating to decommissioning and environmental liabilities are reviewed annually, together with the interest rate used in discounting the cash flows. The interest rate used to determine the balance sheet obligations at the end of 2018 was a nominal rate of 3.0% (2017 a real rate of 0.5% and a nominal rate of 2.5%), which was based on long-dated US government bonds.

142
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Further information about the group’s provisions is provided in Note 21. Changes in assumptions in relation to the group's provisions could result in a material change in their carrying amounts within the next financial year. A 0.5% change in the nominal discount rate could have an impact of approximately $1.3 billion on the value of the group’s provisions, excluding those relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. The impact on the group income statement would not be significant as the majority of the group’s provisions relate to decommissioning costs.
As described in Note 33, the group is subject to claims and actions for which no provisions have been recognized. The facts and circumstances relating to particular cases are evaluated regularly in determining whether a provision relating to a specific litigation should be recognized or revised. Accordingly, significant management judgement relating to provisions and contingent liabilities is required, since the outcome of litigation is difficult to predict.
Change in significant estimate - decommissioning provision
Decommissioning provision cost estimates are reviewed regularly and such a review was undertaken in the second quarter of 2018. The timing and amount of estimated future expenditures were re-assessed and discounted to determine the present value. From 30 June 2018 the present value of the decommissioning provision is determined by discounting the estimated cash flows expressed in expected future prices, i.e. taking account of expected inflation, at a nominal discount rate of 2.5% as at 30 June 2018. Prior to 30 June 2018, the group estimated future cash flows in real terms i.e. at current prices and discounted them using a real discount rate of 0.5% as at 31 December 2017.
The impact of the review was a reduction in the provision of $1.5 billion as at 30 June 2018, with a similar reduction in the carrying amount of property, plant and equipment. There was no significant impact on the income statement for the first half of 2018. The impact on the income statement for the second half of 2018 was a decrease in depreciation, depletion and amortization of approximately $80 million and an increase in finance costs of approximately $80 million.
The nominal discount rate applied to provisions was revised at 31 December 2018 to 3.0%. The impact of this increase was a further $1.3- billion reduction in the decommissioning provision, with a similar reduction in the carrying amount of property, plant and equipment.
Employee benefits
Wages, salaries, bonuses, social security contributions, paid annual leave and sick leave are accrued in the period in which the associated services are rendered by employees of the group. Deferred bonus arrangements that have a vesting date more than 12 months after the balance sheet date are valued on an actuarial basis using the projected unit credit method and amortized on a straight-line basis over the service period until the award vests. The accounting policies for share-based payments and for pensions and other post-retirement benefits are described below.
Share-based payments
Equity-settled transactions
The cost of equity-settled transactions with employees is measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments on the date on which they are granted and is recognized as an expense over the vesting period, which ends on the date on which the employees become fully entitled to the award. A corresponding credit is recognized within equity. Fair value is determined by using an appropriate, widely used, valuation model. In valuing equity-settled transactions, no account is taken of any vesting conditions, other than conditions linked to the price of the shares of the company (market conditions). Non-vesting conditions, such as the condition that employees contribute to a savings-related plan, are taken into account in the grant-date fair value, and failure to meet a non-vesting condition, where this is within the control of the employee is treated as a cancellation and any remaining unrecognized cost is expensed.
For other equity-settled share-based payment transactions, the goods or services received and the corresponding increase in equity are measured at the fair value of the goods or services received unless their fair value cannot be reliably estimated. If the fair value of the goods and services received cannot be reliably estimated, the transaction is measured by reference to the fair value of the equity instruments granted.
Cash-settled transactions
The cost of cash-settled transactions is recognized as an expense over the vesting period, measured by reference to the fair value of the corresponding liability which is recognized on the balance sheet. The liability is remeasured at fair value at each balance sheet date until settlement, with changes in fair value recognized in the income statement.
Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
The cost of providing benefits under the group’s defined benefit plans is determined separately for each plan using the projected unit credit method, which attributes entitlement to benefits to the current period to determine current service cost and to the current and prior periods to determine the present value of the defined benefit obligation. Past service costs, resulting from either a plan amendment or a curtailment (a reduction in future obligations as a result of a material reduction in the plan membership), are recognized immediately when the company becomes committed to a change.
Net interest expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits, which is recognized in the income statement, represents the net change in present value of plan obligations and the value of plan assets resulting from the passage of time, and is determined by applying the discount rate to the present value of the benefit obligation at the start of the year, and to the fair value of plan assets at the start of the year, taking into account expected changes in the obligation or plan assets during the year.
Remeasurements of the defined benefit liability and asset, comprising actuarial gains and losses, and the return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest described above) are recognized within other comprehensive income in the period in which they occur and are not subsequently reclassified to profit and loss.
The defined benefit pension plan surplus or deficit recognized on the balance sheet for each plan comprises the difference between the present value of the defined benefit obligation (using a discount rate based on high quality corporate bonds) and the fair value of plan assets out of which the obligations are to be settled directly. Fair value is based on market price information and, in the case of quoted securities, is the published bid price. Defined benefit pension plan surpluses are only recognized to the extent they are recoverable, either by way of a refund from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the plan.
Contributions to defined contribution plans are recognized in the income statement in the period in which they become payable.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
143


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Significant estimate: pensions and other post-retirement benefits
Accounting for defined benefit pensions and other post-retirement benefits involves making significant estimates when measuring the group's pension plan surpluses and deficits. These estimates require assumptions to be made about many uncertainties.
Pensions and other post-retirement benefit assumptions are reviewed by management at the end of each year. These assumptions are used to determine the projected benefit obligation at the year end and hence the surpluses and deficits recorded on the group's balance sheet, and pension and other post-retirement benefit expense for the following year.
The assumptions that are the most significant to the amounts reported are the discount rate, inflation rate, salary growth and mortality levels. Assumptions about these variables are based on the environment in each country. The assumptions used vary from year to year, with resultant effects on future net income and net assets. Changes to some of these assumptions, in particular the discount rate and inflation rate, could result in material changes to the carrying amounts of the group's pension and other post-retirement benefit obligations within the next financial year, in particular for the UK, US and Eurozone plans. Any differences between these assumptions and the actual outcome will also affect future net income and net assets.
The values ascribed to these assumptions and a sensitivity analysis of the impact of changes in the assumptions on the benefit expense and obligation used are provided in Note 24.
Income taxes
Income tax expense represents the sum of current tax and deferred tax.
Income tax is recognized in the income statement, except to the extent that it relates to items recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, in which case the related tax is recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity.
Current tax is based on the taxable profit for the period. Taxable profit differs from net profit as reported in the income statement because it is determined in accordance with the rules established by the applicable taxation authorities. It therefore excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other periods as well as items that are never taxable or deductible. The group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.
Deferred tax is provided, using the liability method, on temporary differences at the balance sheet date between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial reporting purposes. Deferred tax liabilities are recognized for all taxable temporary differences except:
Where the deferred tax liability arises on the initial recognition of goodwill.
Where the deferred tax liability arises on the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and, at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit or loss.
In respect of taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and associates and interests in joint arrangements, where the group is able to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences, carry-forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences and the carry-forward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses can be utilized, except where the deferred tax asset relating to the deductible temporary difference arises from the initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction that is not a business combination and, at the time of the transaction, affects neither accounting profit nor taxable profit or loss. In respect of deductible temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and associates and interests in joint arrangements, deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that the temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future and taxable profit will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilized.
The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable or increased to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow all or part of the deferred tax asset to be utilized.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the asset is realized or the liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not discounted.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset only when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when the deferred tax assets and liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority on either the same taxable entity or different taxable entities where there is an intention to settle the current tax assets and liabilities on a net basis or to realize the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously.
Where tax treatments are uncertain, if it is considered probable that a taxation authority will accept the group's proposed tax treatment, income taxes are recognized consistent with the group's income tax filings. If it is not considered probable, the uncertainty is reflected using either the most likely amount or an expected value, depending on which method better predicts the resolution of the uncertainty.
The computation of the group’s income tax expense and liability involves the interpretation of applicable tax laws and regulations in many jurisdictions throughout the world. The resolution of tax positions taken by the group, through negotiations with relevant tax authorities or through litigation, can take several years to complete and in some cases it is difficult to predict the ultimate outcome. Therefore, judgement is required to determine whether provisions for income taxes are required and, if so, estimation is required of the amounts that could be payable.
In addition, the group has carry-forward tax losses and tax credits in certain taxing jurisdictions that are available to offset against future taxable profit. However, deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses or tax credits can be utilized. Management judgement is exercised in assessing whether this is the case and estimates are required to be made of the amount of future taxable profits that will be available.
Management do not assess there to be a significant risk of a material change to the group’s tax provisioning or recognition of deferred tax assets within the next financial year, however the tax position remains inherently uncertain and therefore subject to change. To the extent that actual outcomes differ from management’s estimates, income tax charges or credits, and changes in current and deferred tax assets or liabilities, may arise in future periods. For more information see Note 9 and Note 33.


144
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Judgement is also required when determining whether a particular tax is an income tax or another type of tax (for example a production tax). Accounting for deferred tax is applied to income taxes as described above, but is not applied to other types of taxes; rather such taxes are recognized in the income statement in accordance with the applicable accounting policy such as Provisions and contingencies. No new significant judgements were made in 2018 in this regard.
Customs duties and sales taxes
Customs duties and sales taxes that are passed on or charged to customers are excluded from revenues and expenses. Assets and liabilities are recognized net of the amount of customs duties or sales tax except:
Customs duties or sales taxes incurred on the purchase of goods and services which are not recoverable from the taxation authority are recognized as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset.
Receivables and payables are stated with the amount of customs duty or sales tax included.
The net amount of sales tax recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is included within receivables or payables in the balance sheet.
Own equity instruments – treasury shares
The group’s holdings in its own equity instruments are shown as deductions from shareholders’ equity at cost. Treasury shares represent BP shares repurchased and available for specific and limited purposes. For accounting purposes, shares held in Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) to meet the future requirements of the employee share-based payment plans are treated in the same manner as treasury shares and are, therefore, included in the consolidated financial statements as treasury shares. Consideration, if any, received for the sale of such shares is also recognized in equity. No gain or loss is recognized in the income statement on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of equity shares. Shares repurchased under the share buy-back programme which are immediately cancelled are not shown as treasury shares, but are shown as a deduction from the profit and loss account reserve in the group statement of changes in equity.
Revenue and other income
Revenue from contracts with customers is recognized when or as the group satisfies a performance obligation by transferring control of a promised good or service to a customer. The transfer of control of oil, natural gas, natural gas liquids, LNG, petroleum and chemical products, and other items usually coincides with title passing to the customer and the customer taking physical possession. The group principally satisfies its performance obligations at a point in time; the amounts of revenue recognized relating to performance obligations satisfied over time are not significant.
When, or as, a performance obligation is satisfied, the group recognizes as revenue the amount of the transaction price that is allocated to that performance obligation. The transaction price is the amount of consideration to which the group expects to be entitled. The transaction price is allocated to the performance obligations in the contract based on standalone selling prices of the goods or services promised.
Contracts for the sale of commodities are typically priced by reference to quoted prices. Revenue from term commodity contracts is recognized based on the contractual pricing provisions for each delivery. Certain of these contracts have pricing terms based on prices at a point in time after delivery has been made. Revenue from such contracts is initially recognized based on relevant prices at the time of delivery and subsequently adjusted as appropriate.
Physical exchanges with counterparties in the same line of business in order to facilitate sales to customers are reported net, as are sales and purchases made with a common counterparty, as part of an arrangement similar to a physical exchange.
Where the group acts as agent on behalf of a third party to procure or market energy commodities, any associated fee income is recognized but no purchase or sale is recorded.
Where forward sale and purchase contracts for oil, natural gas or power have been determined to be for short-term trading purposes, the associated sales and purchases are reported net within sales and other operating revenues whether or not physical delivery has occurred.
Interest income is recognized as the interest accrues (using the effective interest rate, that is, the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash receipts through the expected life of the financial instrument to the net carrying amount of the financial asset).
Dividend income from investments is recognized when the shareholders’ right to receive the payment is established.
Finance costs
Finance costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets, which are assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use, are added to the cost of those assets until such time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use. All other finance costs are recognized in the income statement in the period in which they are incurred.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
145


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Impact of new International Financial Reporting Standards
BP adopted two new accounting standards issued by the IASB with effect from 1 January 2018, IFRS 9 ‘Financial instruments’ and IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from contracts with customers’. There are no other new or amended standards or interpretations adopted during the year that have a significant impact on the consolidated financial statements.
IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’
IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ was issued in July 2014 and replaced IAS 39 ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement.’ BP adopted IFRS 9 and the related consequential amendments to other IFRSs in the financial reporting period commencing 1 January 2018. The group has applied the new standard in accordance with the transition provisions of IFRS 9. Comparatives have not been restated and adjustments on transition have been reported in opening retained earnings at 1 January 2018.
The group’s revised accounting policies in relation to financial instruments are provided above.
The overall impact on transition to IFRS 9, including the impact upon the group's share of equity-accounted entities, was a reduction of $180 million in net assets, net of tax. This adjustment mainly related to an increase in the loss allowance for financial assets in the scope of IFRS 9's impairment requirements. As comparatives have not been restated the closing balance at 31 December 2017 for certain line items in the balance sheet differ from the opening balance at 1 January 2018 (as summarized below). Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of 2018 in the Group cash flow statement are the 1 January 2018 amounts included in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
31 December 2017

1 January 2018

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9

Non-current
 
 
 
 
Investments in equity-accounted entities
 
24,985

24,903

(82
)
Loans, trade and other receivables
 
2,080

2,069

(11
)
Deferred tax liabilities
 
(7,982
)
(7,946
)
36

Current
 
 
 
 
Loans, trade and other receivables
 
25,039

24,927

(112
)
Cash and cash equivalents
 
25,586

25,575

(11
)
 
 
 
 
 
Net assets
 
100,404

100,224

(180
)
 
 
 
 
 
Reserves
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale investments
 
17


(17
)
Costs of hedging
 

(37
)
(37
)
Profit and loss account
 
75,226

75,100

(126
)
 
 
75,243

75,063

(180
)

Classification and measurement
IFRS 9 provides a single classification and measurement approach for financial assets that reflects the business model in which they are managed and their cash flow characteristics. For financial liabilities the existing classification and measurement requirements of IAS 39 are largely retained.
The table below illustrates the classification and carrying amounts of financial assets under IFRS 9 and IAS 39 at the date of initial application, 1 January 2018. There were no differences in classification or carrying amounts for financial liabilities and no differences in the measurement of liabilities for financial guarantee contracts.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 1 January 2018
 
Classification under IAS 39
Classification under IFRS 9
Carrying amount under IAS 39

Measurement category adjustment on transition

Measurement attribute adjustment on transition

Carrying amount under IFRS 9

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments – equity shares
 
Available-for-sale financial assets
Fair value through profit or loss
433



433

 – other
 
Available-for-sale financial assets
Fair value through profit or loss
275



275

 – other
 
At fair value through profit or loss
Fair value through profit or loss
662



662

Loans
 
Loans and receivables
Amortized cost
836

(100
)

736

Loans
 
Loans and receivables
Fair value through profit or loss

100

(8
)
92

Trade and other receivables
 
Loans and receivables
Amortized cost
24,361


(115
)
24,246

Derivative financial instruments
 
At fair value through profit or loss
Fair value through profit or loss
6,454



6,454

Derivative financial instruments
 
Derivative hedging instruments
Derivative hedging instruments
688



688

Cash and cash equivalents
 
Loans and receivables
Amortized cost
21,916


(11
)
21,905

Cash and cash equivalents
 
Available-for-sale financial assets
Amortized cost
2,270

(2,058
)

212

Cash and cash equivalents
 
Available-for-sale financial assets
Fair value through profit or loss

2,058


2,058

Cash and cash equivalents
 
Held-to-maturity investments
Amortized cost
1,400



1,400

 
 
 
 
59,295


(134
)
59,161


146
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Other investments existing on transition that were classified as available-for-sale financial assets under IAS 39 are classified as mandatorily measured at fair value through profit or loss (FVTPL) under IFRS 9. The contractual terms of these assets do not give rise to cash flows that are solely payments of principal and interest. Fair value gains and losses will be recognized in profit or loss rather than in other comprehensive income as was the case under IAS 39. An adjustment to the 2018 opening balance sheet was made to transfer $17 million of fair value gains net of related tax from the available-for-sale investments reserve to the profit and loss account reserve.
Certain loans that were classified as loans and receivables under IAS 39 have been classified as mandatorily measured at FVTPL under IFRS 9 as a result of the business model in which they are held. The adjustment of $8m to the carrying amount of these assets on transition reflects the difference between amortized cost measurement under IAS 39 and fair value measurement under IFRS 9.
Cash and cash equivalents that were classified as available-for-sale and held-to-maturity financial assets under IAS 39 have been classified as either measured at amortized cost or measured at FVTPL under IFRS 9. Cash and cash equivalents measured at FVTPL comprise money market funds that do not give rise to cash flows that are solely payments of principal and interest. For cash and cash equivalents that have been reclassified to measured at amortized cost, the carrying amount of those assets at the end of the reporting period approximate their fair value. The fair value gain or loss that would have been recognized in other comprehensive income in the reporting period if those financial assets had not been reclassified to amortized cost is immaterial.
Adjustments to the carrying amount of financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost under IFRS 9 relate entirely to the additional loss allowance required by the new standard's expected credit loss model.
There were no financial assets or financial liabilities which the group had previously designated as at FVTPL under IAS 39 that were required to be reclassified, or which the group has elected to reclassify upon the application of IFRS 9. The group did not elect to designate at FVTPL any financial assets or financial liabilities at the date of initial application of IFRS 9.
Under IFRS 9 the group has elected to apply hedge accounting prospectively to certain of its commodity price risk management activities for which hedge accounting was not possible under IAS 39. Certain derivatives that were previously classified as at FVTPL have therefore been reclassified to derivative hedging instruments at 1 January 2018. As the hedging instruments are exchange traded derivatives, the value transferred on transition was nil.
Impairment
The financial asset impairment requirements of IFRS 9 introduce a forward-looking expected credit loss model that results in earlier recognition of credit losses than the incurred loss model of IAS 39. The adjustment to the 2018 opening balance sheet relating to expected credit loss reduced both the carrying amounts of financial assets and the profit and loss account reserve.
The table below reconciles the ending impairment allowances in accordance with IAS 39 and the provisions in accordance with IAS 37 to the opening loss allowances determined in accordance with IFRS 9.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 1 January 2018
 
Classification under IAS 39
Classification under IFRS 9
IAS 39 loss allowance

Measurement category effect on transition

Measurement attribute adjustment on transition

IFRS 9 loss allowance

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments – equity shares
 
Available-for-sale financial assets
Fair value through profit or loss
91

(91
)


Trade and other receivables
 
Loans and receivables
Amortized cost
335


115

450

Cash and cash equivalents
 
Loans and receivables
Amortized cost


11

11

Total loss allowance on financial assets
 
 
 
426

(91
)
126

461

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans that form part of the net investment in equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
37


6

43

Total loss allowance
 
 
 
463

(91
)
132

504

Impairment allowances on available-for-sale assets represent amounts provided against investments in equity instruments that were held at cost under IAS 39. Under IFRS 9 these assets are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss and therefore no loss allowance exists on these assets under IFRS 9.
The increase in the loss allowances for financial assets classified as measured at amortized cost under IFRS 9 and loans that form part of the net investment in equity-accounted entities represent the additional loss allowance required by the new standard's expected credit loss model.
Hedge accounting
Under IFRS 9 all existing hedging relationships qualified as continuing hedging relationships and the group has applied hedge accounting prospectively to certain of its commodity price risk management activities for which hedge accounting was not possible under IAS 39.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
147


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
IFRS 9 also introduces a new way of treating fair value movements on the time value and foreign currency basis spreads of certain hedging instruments. Whereas under IAS 39 these movements were recognized in profit or loss, the group is either required, or has elected to initially recognize these movements within equity to the extent that they relate to the hedged item. An adjustment to the 2018 opening balance sheet was made to transfer $37 million of losses net of related tax from the profit and loss account reserve to the costs of hedging reserve for relevant hedging instruments existing on transition.
Under IAS 39 the effective portion of the gain or loss on a cash flow hedging instrument is reported in other comprehensive income and is reclassified to the balance sheet as part of the initial carrying amount of the corresponding non-financial asset or liability. Under IFRS 9 the effective portion of the gain or loss continues to be reported in the statement of other comprehensive income but the transfer to the balance sheet is shown in the statement of changes in equity.
IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’
IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ was issued in May 2014 and replaced IAS 18 ‘Revenue’ and certain other standards and interpretations. IFRS 15 provides a single model for accounting for revenue arising from contracts with customers, focusing on the identification and satisfaction of performance obligations. BP adopted IFRS 15 from 1 January 2018 and applied the ‘modified retrospective’ transition approach to implementation.
The group’s revised accounting policy in relation to revenue is provided above. A disaggregation of revenue from contracts with customers is provided in note 5.
The group identified certain minor changes in accounting relating to its revenue from contracts with customers but the new standard had no material effect on the group’s net assets as at 1 January 2018 and so no transition adjustment is presented.
The most significant change identified is the accounting for revenues relating to oil and natural gas properties in which the group has an interest with joint operation partners. From 1 January 2018, BP ceased using the entitlement method of accounting under which revenue was recognized in relation to the group's entitlement to the production from oil and gas properties based on its working interest, irrespective of whether the production was taken and sold to customers. In its 2018 consolidated financial statements the group has recognized revenue when sales are made to customers; production costs have been accrued or deferred to reflect differences between volumes taken and sold to customers and the group's ownership interest in total production volumes. Compared to the group’s previous accounting policy this may result in timing differences in respect of revenues and profits recognized in each period, but there will be no change in the total revenues and profits over the duration of the joint operation. The impact on the consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2018 was not material.
In addition, BP has made determinations about presentation and disclosure relating to its revenue from contracts with customers as follows:
Derivative contracts resulting in physical delivery to a customer
Certain contracts entered into by the group that result in physical delivery to a counterparty of products such as crude oil, natural gas and refined products are required by IFRS to be accounted for as financial instruments. These contracts are within the scope of IFRS 9 rather than IFRS 15. The group’s counterparties in these transactions, however, may meet the IFRS 15 definition of a customer. Revenue recognized relating to such contracts when physical delivery occurs is, therefore, presented together with revenue from contracts with customers in the group’s consolidated financial statements. Changes in the fair value of derivative assets and liabilities prior to physical delivery are excluded from revenue from contracts with customers and are presented as other operating revenues. Additionally, where forward sales and purchase contracts for oil, natural gas or power have been determined to be for short-term trading purposes, the associated sales and purchases continue to be reported net within other operating revenues consistent with the group’s practice prior to implementation of IFRS 15.
Contracts with post-delivery pricing terms
Contracts entered into by the group for the sale of oil, natural gas (including LNG), NGLs and refined products are typically priced by reference to quoted prices. In line with market practice, certain of these contracts are based on average prices over a period that is partially or entirely after delivery. Revenue relating to such contracts is recognized initially based on relevant prices at the time of delivery and subsequently adjusted as prices are finalized, consistent with the group’s practice prior to implementation of IFRS 15. Whilst these post-delivery adjustments are changes in the value of receivables within the scope of IFRS 9, not IFRS 15, the distinction between revenue recognized at the time of delivery and revenue recognized as a result of post-delivery changes in quoted commodity prices relating to the same transaction is not considered to be significant. All revenue from these contracts, both that recognized at the time of delivery and that from post-delivery price adjustments, is disclosed as revenue from contracts with customers.
Disclosure of the amount of the transaction price allocated to unsatisfied performance obligations
The disclosures required by IFRS 15 include the amount of the contract transaction price allocated to performance obligations that are unsatisfied at the balance sheet date. Many of BP’s commodity sales are made under term contracts in which sales are made based on quoted prices at or near the time of delivery, meaning the consideration for future deliveries is entirely variable. In these arrangements, each delivery is considered to be a separate performance obligation and the transaction price is the amount of revenue expected to be earned from all sales that are contracted to be made in future periods, which can be up to 20 years from the balance sheet date.
BP does not consider the disclosure of the amount of the transaction price allocated to contracted future deliveries of commodities within the scope of IFRS 15 to be relevant information. This disclosure has not, therefore, been provided in these consolidated financial statements. The consideration in many such contracts is entirely variable so would be subject to the requirement of IFRS 15 relating to constraining estimates of variable consideration. Applying the constraint for the purposes of this disclosure requirement would provide an indication only of contracted revenues based on estimated future minimum market prices. Such commodities are regularly sold in liquid markets on a spot basis, using similar pricing bases to sales made under term contracts, meaning that disclosure of contracted sales would have little predictive value. Furthermore, as described above, a significant proportion of the group’s commodity sales contracts are within the scope of IFRS 9, not IFRS 15. Derivative assets or liabilities representing the difference between contracted price and forward price are recognized on the group balance sheet for these contracts.
Contract assets and liabilities
The group does not have material contract asset or contract liability balances and so these amounts are included within amounts presented for trade receivables and other payables.

148
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Not yet adopted
The IASB has issued IFRS 16 'Leases' which will become effective from financial reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019 and has been adopted by the EU. The group has not adopted IFRS 16 in these consolidated financial statements and will adopt it from 1 January 2019. There are no other standards and interpretations in issue but not yet adopted that the directors anticipate will have a material effect on the reported income or net assets of the group.
IFRS 16 ‘Leases’
IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ provides a new model for lessee accounting in which the majority of leases will be accounted for by the recognition on the balance sheet of a right-of-use asset and a lease liability. The subsequent amortization of the right-of-use asset and the interest expense related to the lease liability will be recognized in profit or loss over the lease term. IFRS 16 replaces IAS 17 ‘Leases’ and IFRIC 4 ‘Determining whether an arrangement contains a lease’ and will be effective for financial reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019.
BP will adopt IFRS 16 in the financial reporting period commencing 1 January 2019 and has elected to apply the modified retrospective transition approach in which the cumulative effect of initial application is recognized in opening retained earnings at the date of initial application with no restatement of comparative periods’ financial information.
IFRS 16 introduces a revised definition of a lease. As permitted by the standard, BP has elected not to reassess the existing population of leases under the new definition and will only apply the new definition for the assessment of contracts entered into after the transition date. On transition the standard permits, on a lease-by-lease basis, the right-of-use asset to be measured either at an amount equal to the lease liability (as adjusted for prepaid or accrued lease payments), or on an historical basis as if the standard had always applied. BP has elected to use the historical asset measurement for its more material leases and to use the asset equals liability approach for the remainder of the population. In addition, BP has also elected the option to adjust the carrying amounts of the right-of-use assets as at 1 January 2019 for onerous lease provisions that had been recognized on the group balance sheet as at 31 December 2018, rather than the alternative of performing impairment tests on transition.
The group’s evaluation of the effect of adoption of the standard is substantially complete and a material effect on the group’s balance sheet is expected, as set out further below. The presentation and timing of recognition of charges in the income statement will also change as the operating lease expense currently reported under IAS 17, typically on a straight-line basis, will be replaced by depreciation of the right-of-use asset and interest on the lease liability. In the cash flow statement operating lease payments are currently presented within cash flows from operating activities but under IFRS 16 payments will be presented as financing cash flows, representing repayments of debt, and as operating cash flows, representing payments of interest. Variable lease payments that do not depend on an index or rate are not included in the lease liability and will continue to be presented as operating cash flows.
Information on the group’s leases classified as operating leases under IAS 17, which are not recognized on the balance sheet as at 31 December 2018, is presented in Note 28. The following table provides a reconciliation of the operating lease commitments disclosed in Note 28 to the total lease liability expected to be recognized on the group balance sheet in accordance with IFRS 16 as at 1 January 2019, with explanations below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Operating lease commitments at 31 December 2018
 
11,979

 
 
 
Leases not yet commenced
 
(1,372
)
Leases below materiality threshold
 
(86
)
Short-term leases
 
(91
)
Effect of discounting
 
(1,512
)
Impact on leases in joint operations
 
836

Variable lease payments
 
(58
)
Redetermination of lease term
 
(252
)
Other
 
(22
)
Total additional lease liabilities expected to be recognized on adoption of IFRS 16
 
9,422

Finance lease obligations at 31 December 2018
 
667

Adjustment for finance leases in joint operations
 
(189
)
Total expected lease liabilities at 1 January 2019
 
9,900

Leases not yet commenced: The operating lease commitments disclosed in Note 28 include amounts relating to leases entered into by the group that had not yet commenced as at 31 December 2018. In accordance with IFRS 16 assets and liabilities will not be recognized on the group balance sheet in relation to these leases until the dates of commencement of the leases. Such commitments will continue to be disclosed in future under IFRS 16.
Short-term leases and leases below materiality threshold: As part of the transition to IFRS 16, BP has elected not to recognize assets and liabilities relating to short-term leases i.e. leases with a term of less than 12 months and has also applied a materiality threshold for the recognition of assets and liabilities related to leases. The disclosed operating lease commitments as at 31 December 2018 in Note 28 includes amounts related to such leases.
Effect of discounting: The amount of the lease liability recognized in accordance with IFRS 16 will be on a discounted basis whereas the operating lease commitments information in Note 28 is presented on an undiscounted basis. The discount rates used on transition are incremental borrowing rates as appropriate for each lease based on factors such as the lessee legal entity, lease term and currency. The weighted average discount rate to be used on transition is expected to be around 3.5%, with a weighted average remaining lease term of around 9 years. For new leases commencing after 1 January 2019 the discount rate used will be the interest rate implicit in the lease, if this is readily determinable, or the incremental borrowing rate if the implicit rate cannot be readily determined.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
149


1. Significant accounting policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions – continued
Impact on leases in joint operations: The operating lease commitments for leases within joint operations are included on the basis of BP’s net working interest for the information provided in Note 28, irrespective of whether BP is the operator and whether the lease has been co-signed by the joint operators or not. However, for transition to IFRS 16, the facts and circumstances of each lease in a joint operation have been assessed to determine the group’s rights and obligations and to recognize assets and liabilities on the group balance sheet accordingly. This relates mainly to leases of drilling rigs within joint operations in the Upstream segment. Where all parties to a joint operation jointly have the right to control the use of the identified asset and all parties have a legal obligation to make lease payments to the lessor, the group’s share of the right-of-use asset and its share of the lease liability will be recognized on the group balance sheet. This may arise in cases where the lease is signed by all parties to the joint operation. However, in cases where BP is the only party with the legal obligation to make lease payments to the lessor, the full lease liability will be recognized on the group balance sheet. This may be the case if for example BP, as operator of the joint operation, is the sole signatory to the lease. If, however, the underlying asset is jointly controlled by all parties to the joint operation BP will recognize its net share of the right-of-use asset on the group balance sheet along with a receivable representing the amounts to be recovered from the other parties. If BP is not legally obliged to make lease payments to the lessor but jointly controls the asset, the net share of the right-of-use asset will be recognized on the group balance sheet along with a payable representing amounts to be paid to the other parties.
Variable lease payments: Where there are lease payments that vary depending on an index or rate, the measurement of the operating lease commitments in Note 28 is based on the variable factor as at inception of the lease and is not updated to reflect subsequent changes in the variable factor. Such subsequent changes in the lease payments are currently treated as contingent rentals and charged to profit or loss as and when paid. Under IFRS 16 the lease liability will be adjusted whenever the lease payments are changed in response to changes in the variable factor, and for transition the liability is measured on the basis of the prevailing variable factor on 1 January 2019.
Redetermination of lease term: Under the transition provisions of IFRS 16, the remaining terms of certain leases have been redetermined with the benefit of hindsight, on the basis that BP is now reasonably certain to exercise its option to terminate those leases before the full term.
Under IAS 17 finance leases are recognized on the group balance sheet and will continue to be recognized in accordance with IFRS 16. The amounts recognized on the group balance sheet as at 1 January 2019 in relation to the right-of-use assets and liabilities for existing finance leases within joint operations will be on a net or gross basis as appropriate as described above.
In addition to the lease liability, which will be presented within finance debt, other line items on the group balance sheet expected to be adjusted on transition to IFRS 16 include property, plant and equipment, prepayments, receivables, accruals, payables, provisions and deferred tax balances, as set out below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
31 December 2018

1 January 2019

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 16

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
135,261

143,950

8,689

Trade and other receivables
 
1,834

2,159

325

Prepayments
 
1,179

849

(330
)
Deferred tax assets
 
3,706

3,736

30

Current assets
 
 
 
 
Trade and other receivables
 
24,478

24,673

195

Prepayments
 
963

872

(91
)
Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
46,265

46,209

(56
)
Accruals
 
4,626

4,578

(48
)
Finance debt and leases
 
9,373

11,525

2,152

Provisions
 
2,564

2,547

(17
)
Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 
13,830

14,013

183

Accruals
 
575

548

(27
)
Finance debt and leases
 
56,426

63,507

7,081

Deferred tax liabilities
 
9,812

9,767

(45
)
Provisions
 
17,732

17,657

(75
)
 
 
 
 
 
Net assets
 
101,548

101,218

(330
)
 
 
 
 
 
Equity
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders' equity
 
99,444

99,115

(329
)
Non-controlling interests
 
2,104

2,103

(1
)
 
 
101,548

101,218

(330
)

The total expected adjustments to the group's lease liabilities at 1 January 2019 may be reconciled as follows:
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Total additional lease liabilities expected to be recognized on adoption of IFRS 16
 
9,422

Less: adjustment for finance leases in joint operations
 
(189
)
Total expected adjustment to lease liabilities
 
9,233

Of which – current
 
2,152

– non-current
 
7,081



150
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


2. Significant event – Gulf of Mexico oil spill
As a consequence of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill in April 2010, BP continues to incur costs and has also recognized liabilities for certain future costs.
The impacts of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill on the income statement, balance sheet and cash flow statement of the group are included within the relevant line items in those statements and are shown in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Income statement
 
 
 
 
Production and manufacturing expenses
 
714

2,687

6,640

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
(714
)
(2,687
)
(6,640
)
Finance costs
 
479

493

494

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
(1,193
)
(3,180
)
(7,134
)
Less: Taxation
 
174

(2,222
)
3,105

Profit (loss) for the period
 
(1,019
)
(5,402
)
(4,029
)
Balance sheet
 
 
 
 
Current assets
 
 
 
 
     Trade and other receivables
 
214

252

 
Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
     Trade and other payables
 
(2,279
)
(2,089
)
 
     Provisions
 
(333
)
(1,439
)
 
Net current assets (liabilities)
 
(2,398
)
(3,276
)
 
Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
     Deferred tax
 
1,563

2,067

 
Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
     Other payables
 
(11,922
)
(12,253
)
 
     Provisions
 
(12
)
(1,141
)
 
     Deferred tax
 
3,999

3,634

 
Net non-current assets (liabilities)
 
(6,372
)
(7,693
)
 
Net assets (liabilities)
 
(8,770
)
(10,969
)
 
Cash flow statement
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
(1,193
)
(3,180
)
(7,134
)
Net charge for interest and other finance expense, less net interest paid
 
479

493

494

Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
240

2,542

4,353

(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
(485
)
(1,738
)
(3,210
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(2,572
)
(3,453
)
(1,608
)
Pre-tax cash flows
 
(3,531
)
(5,336
)
(7,105
)
Income statement
The group income statement for 2018 includes a pre-tax charge of $1,193 million (2017 pre-tax charge of $3,180 million, 2016 pre-tax charge of $7,134 million) in relation to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. The charge within production and manufacturing expenses in 2018 of $714 million (2017 $2,687 million, 2016 $6,640 million) relates mainly to business economic loss (BEL) and other claims associated with the Deepwater Horizon Court Supervised Settlement Program (DHCSSP). Finance costs of $479 million (2017 $493 million, 2016 $494 million) reflect the unwinding of the discount on payables and, for 2016, provisions.
The cumulative amount charged to the income statement to date comprises spill response costs arising in the aftermath of the incident, amounts charged for the 2012 agreement with the US government to resolve all federal criminal claims arising from the incident, amounts charged for the 2016 consent decree and settlement agreement with the United States and the five Gulf coast states including amounts payable for natural resource damages, state claims and Clean Water Act penalties, operating costs, amounts charged upon initial recognition of the trust obligation, other litigation, claims, environmental and legal costs and estimated obligations for future costs, net of settlements agreed with the co-owners of the Macondo well and other third parties.
The cumulative pre-tax income statement charge since the incident amounts to $67.0 billion and is analysed in the table below.
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Cumulative since
the incident

Environmental costs
 



8,526

Spill response costs
 



14,304

Litigation and claims costs
 
629

2,647

6,596

42,410

Clean Water Act penalties
 



4,061

Other costs
 
85

40

44

1,394

Settlements credited to the income statement
 



(5,681
)
(Profit) loss before interest and taxation
 
714

2,687

6,640

65,014

Finance costs
 
479

493

494

1,944

(Profit) loss before taxation
 
1,193

3,180

7,134

66,958


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
151


2. Significant event – Gulf of Mexico oil spill – continued
Provisions and contingent liabilities
Provisions
Movements during the year in the remaining provision, which relates to litigation and claims, are presented in the table below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

 
 
Litigation and claims

At 1 January
 
2,580

Increase in provision
 
629

Reclassified to other payables
 
(2,045
)
Utilization
 
(819
)
At 31 December
 
345

Of which – current
 
333

 – non-current
 
12


Litigation and claims – PSC settlement
The Economic and Property Damages Settlement Agreement (EPD Settlement Agreement) with the Plaintiffs' Steering Committee (PSC) provides for a court-supervised settlement programme, the DHCSSP, which commenced operation on 4 June 2012. A separate claims administrator was appointed to pay medical claims and to implement other aspects of the Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement. For further information on the PSC settlements, see Legal proceedings on page 296.
The litigation and claims provision reflects the latest estimate for the remaining costs associated with the PSC settlement. These costs relate predominantly to BEL claims and associated administration costs. The amounts ultimately payable may differ from the amount provided and the timing of payments is uncertain.
The DHCSSP’s determination of BEL claims was substantially completed by the end of 2017 and remaining claims continued to be processed throughout 2018 with only a very small number of claims remaining to be determined by the end of 2018. However certain BEL claims determined by the DHCSSP have been and continue to be appealed by BP and/or the claimants.
During 2018 settlement agreements were reached with claimants for a significant proportion of the provision existing at the beginning of the year. Amounts payable under these settlement agreements have been reclassified from provisions to other payables. The remaining amount provided for includes the latest estimate of the amounts that are expected ultimately to be paid to resolve outstanding BEL claims. Claims under appeal will ultimately only be resolved once the full judicial appeals process has been concluded, including appeals to the Federal District Court and Fifth Circuit, as may be the case, or when settlements are reached with individual claimants. Depending upon the ultimate resolution of these claims, the amounts payable may differ from those currently provided.
Payments to resolve outstanding claims under the PSC settlement are expected to be made over a number of years. The timing of payments, however, is uncertain, and, in particular, will be impacted by how long it takes to resolve claims that have been appealed and may be appealed in the future.
Contingent liabilities
For information on legal proceedings relating to the Deepwater Horizon oil spill, see Legal proceedings on pages 296-298. Any further outstanding Deepwater Horizon related claims are not expected to have a material impact on the group's financial performance.
Other payables
Other payables include amounts payable under the 2016 consent decree and settlement agreement with the United States and five Gulf coast states, including amounts payable for natural resource damages, state claims and Clean Water Act penalties. On a discounted basis the amounts included in other payables for these elements of the agreements are $5,485 million payable over 14 years, $2,897 million payable over 15 years and $4,010 million payable over 14 years respectively at 31 December 2018. For full details of these agreements, see BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
In addition, other payables at 31 December 2018 also includes amounts payable for settled economic loss and property damage claims which are payable over a period of up to nine years.
Cash flow statement
The impact on net cash provided by operating activities on a pre-tax basis amounted to an outflow of $3,531 million (2017 outflow of $5,336 million, 2016 outflow of $7,105 million). On a post-tax basis, the amounts were an outflow of $3,218 million (2017 outflow of $5,167 million and 2016 outflow of $6,892 million).
Cash outflows in 2018, 2017 and 2016 include payments made under the 2012 agreement with the US government to resolve all federal criminal claims arising from the incident and the 2016 consent decree and settlement agreement with the United States and the five Gulf coast states.


152
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


3. Business combinations and other significant transactions
Business combinations
BP undertook a number of business combinations in 2018. For the full year, total consideration paid in cash amounted to $7,100 million, offset by cash acquired of $114 million.
On 31 October 2018, BP acquired from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. 100% of the issued share capital of Petrohawk Energy Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of BHP that holds a portfolio of unconventional onshore US oil and gas assets.
The acquisition brings BP extensive oil and gas production and resources in the liquids-rich regions of the Permian and Eagle Ford basins in Texas and in the Haynesville gas basin in Texas and Louisiana.
The total consideration for the transaction, after customary closing adjustments and the effect of discounting deferred payments, is $10,302 million, which will all be paid in cash. As at 31 December 2018, $6,788 million of the consideration had been paid. The remaining discounted amount of $3,514 million is included within other payables on the group balance sheet and will be paid in four instalments, with the final instalment being paid in April 2019.
The transaction has been accounted for as a business combination using the acquisition method. The provisional fair values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired, as at the date of acquisition, are shown in the table below. No goodwill has been recognized on the acquisition.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

Assets
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
10,845

Intangible assets
 
21

Inventories
 
27

Trade and other receivables
 
493

Cash
 
104

Liabilities
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
(659
)
Provisions
 
(323
)
Non-controlling interest
 
(206
)
Total consideration
 
10,302

The acquisition-date fair values of the assets and liabilities acquired are provisional. As we gain further understanding of the acquired properties and development options, these fair values may be adjusted.
An analysis of the cash flows relating to the acquisition included within the cash flow statement for 2018 is provided below.
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

Transaction costs of the acquisition (included in cash flows from operating activities)
 
62

Interest on deferred payments (included in cash flows from operating activities)
 
21

Cash consideration paid, net of cash acquired (included in cash flows from investing activities)
 
6,684

Total net cash outflow for the acquisition
 
6,767

From the date of acquisition to 31 December 2018, the acquired activities generated revenues of $472 million and profit before tax of $49 million. If the business combination had taken place on 1 January 2018, it is estimated that the acquired activities would have generated revenues of $2,798 million and profit before tax of $431 million.
In addition to the BHP transaction described above, BP undertook a number of other individually insignificant business combinations in 2018.
Other significant transactions
On 18 December 2018, BP purchased an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field in the North Sea, as part of the agreements with ConocoPhillips in which ConocoPhillips simultaneously purchased BP's entire 39.2% interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope of Alaska. The purchase gives BP a 45.1% interest in Clair in total. Gross payments made and received of $1,739 million and $1,490 million are included in Capital expenditure and Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash acquired, respectively, in the group cash flow statement. Goodwill of $804 million, resulting from the recognition of a deferred tax liability as part of the transaction accounting, has been recognized on the purchase of the interest in the Clair field.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
153


4. Disposals and impairment
The following amounts were recognized in the income statement in respect of disposals and impairments.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
437

526

557

Downstream
 
15

674

561

Other businesses and corporate
 
4

10

14

 
 
456

1,210

1,132

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
707

127

169

Downstream
 
59

88

89

Other businesses and corporate
 
11


3

 
 
777

215

261

Impairment losses
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
400

1,138

1,022

Downstream
 
12

69

84

Other businesses and corporate
 
254

32

11

 
 
666

1,239

1,117

Impairment reversals
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
(580
)
(176
)
(3,025
)
Downstream
 
(2
)
(62
)
(17
)
Other businesses and corporate
 
(1
)


 
 
(583
)
(238
)
(3,042
)
Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
860

1,216

(1,664
)
Disposals
Disposal proceeds and principal gains and losses on disposals by segment are described below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
940

2,936

1,372

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
1,911

478

1,259

 
 
2,851

3,414

2,631

By business
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
2,145

1,183

839

Downstream
 
120

2,078

1,646

Other businesses and corporate
 
586

153

146

 
 
2,851

3,414

2,631

At 31 December 2018, deferred consideration relating to disposals amounted to $35 million receivable within one year (2017 $259 million and 2016 $255 million) and $304 million receivable after one year (2017 $268 million and 2016 $271 million). In addition, contingent consideration receivable relating to disposals amounted to $893 million at 31 December 2018 (2017 $237 million and 2016 $131 million). These amounts of contingent consideration are reported within Other investments on the group balance sheet - see Note 18 for further information.
Upstream
In 2018, gains principally resulted from the disposal of interests in the Bruce, Keith and Rhum fields in the UK North Sea, from the disposal of certain properties in the US, and from adjustments to disposals in prior periods. Losses included $335 million resulting from the disposal of our interest in the Magnus field and associated assets in the UK North Sea, $221 million from the disposal of our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area in the US (see Note 3 for further information), and adjustments to disposals in prior periods.
In 2017, gains principally resulted from the disposal of a portion of our interest in the Perdido offshore hub in the US, and further gains associated with disposals in the UK.
In 2016, gains principally resulted from the contribution of BP’s Norwegian upstream business into Aker BP ASA and from the sale of certain properties in the UK.
Downstream
In 2017, gains principally resulted from the disposal of our interest in the SECCO joint venture and the disposal of certain midstream assets in Europe.
In 2016, gains principally resulted from the disposal of certain US and non-US midstream assets in our fuels business and the dissolution of our German refining joint operation with Rosneft.
Other businesses and corporate
In 2018 proceeds from disposals were principally in respect of life insurance policies in the US and wind farms within our US wind business.
  


154
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


4. Disposals and impairment – continued
Summarized financial information relating to the sale of businesses is shown in the table below. The principal transaction categorized as a business disposal in 2018 was the disposal of our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area in the US - see Note 3 for further information. The principal transaction categorized as a business disposal in 2017 was the disposal of our interest in the Forties Pipeline System in the North Sea. The principal transactions categorized as business disposals in 2016 were the contribution of BP’s Norwegian upstream business into Aker BP ASA and the dissolution of the group’s German refining joint operation with Rosneft.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Non-current assets
 
3,274

735

4,794

Current assets
 
173

57

1,202

Non-current liabilities
 
(250
)
(173
)
(2,558
)
Current liabilities
 
(97
)
(86
)
(532
)
Total carrying amount of net assets disposed
 
3,100

533

2,906

Recycling of foreign exchange on disposal
 


25

Costs on disposala
 
3

3

229

 
 
3,103

536

3,160

Gains (losses) on sale of businessesb
 
(221
)
44

593

Total consideration
 
2,882

580

3,753

Non-cash considerationc
 
(282
)
(216
)
(2,698
)
Consideration received (receivable)
 
(689
)
114

204

Proceeds from the sale of businesses, net of cash disposedd
 
1,911

478

1,259

a 2016 includes amounts relating to the remeasurement to fair value of certain assets as a result of the dissolution of our German refining joint operation with Rosneft.
b 2016 gains on sale of businesses include deferred amounts not recognized in the income statement.
c 2016 non-cash consideration principally relates to the contribution of BP’s Norwegian upstream business into Aker BP ASA in exchange for 30% interest in Aker BP ASA and the dissolution of the group’s German refining joint operation with Rosneft.
d Proceeds are stated net of cash and cash equivalents disposed of $15 million (2017 $25 million and 2016 $676 million).
Impairments
Impairment losses and impairment reversals in each segment are described below. For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to impairments see Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangibles and goodwill within Note 1. See also Note 12, Note 15 and Note 21 for further information on impairments by asset category.
Upstream
Impairment losses and reversals related primarily to producing and midstream assets.
The 2018 impairment losses of $400 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant charges arising in Australia and the US. Impairment losses arose primarily as a result of changes to project activity, asset obsolescence and the decision to dispose of certain assets. The 2018 impairment reversals of $580 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant reversals arising in the North Sea and Angola following a change to decommissioning cost estimates.
The 2017 impairment losses of $1,138 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant charges arising in BPX Energy (previously known as the US Lower 48 business) and the North Sea. Impairment losses within Upstream arose primarily as a result of changes in reserves estimates and the decision to dispose of certain assets, including the Forties Pipeline System business.
The 2017 impairment reversals of $176 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant reversals arising in the North Sea.
The 2016 impairment losses of $1,022 million related to a number of different assets, with the most significant charges arising in the North Sea. Impairment losses within Upstream arose primarily as a result of revised cost estimates and decisions to dispose of certain assets.
The 2016 impairment reversals of $3,025 million primarily related to the North Sea and Angola. The largest impairment reversals related to the Andrew area cash-generating unit (CGU) in the North Sea and the PSVM and Greater Plutonio CGUs in Angola but none of these were individually significant. In addition an impairment reversal was recorded in relation to the Block KG D6 CGU in India; and exploration costs were also written back during the period (see Note 8). The impairment reversals arose following a reduction in the discount rate applied, changes to future price assumptions, and also increased confidence in the progress of the KG D6 projects in India.
Downstream
Impairment losses totalling $12 million, $69 million, and $84 million were recognized in 2018, 2017 and 2016 respectively.
Other businesses and corporate
Impairment losses totalling $254 million, $32 million, and $11 million were recognized in 2018, 2017 and 2016 respectively. The amount for 2018 is in respect of assets within our US wind business in advance of their disposal in December 2018.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
155


5. Segmental analysis
The group’s organizational structure reflects the various activities in which BP is engaged. At 31 December 2018, BP had three reportable segments: Upstream, Downstream and Rosneft.
Upstream’s activities include oil and natural gas exploration, field development and production; midstream transportation, storage and processing; and the marketing and trading of natural gas, including liquefied natural gas (LNG), together with power and natural gas liquids (NGLs).
Downstream’s activities include the refining, manufacturing, marketing, transportation, and supply and trading of crude oil, petroleum, petrochemicals products and related services to wholesale and retail customers.
BP’s interest in Rosneft is accounted for using the equity method and is reported as a separate operating segment, reflecting the way in which the investment is managed.
Other businesses and corporate comprises the biofuels and wind businesses, the group’s shipping and treasury functions, and corporate activities worldwide.
The accounting policies of the operating segments are the same as the group’s accounting policies described in Note 1. However, IFRS requires that the measure of profit or loss disclosed for each operating segment is the measure that is provided regularly to the chief operating decision maker for the purposes of performance assessment and resource allocation. For BP, this measure of profit or loss is replacement cost profit or loss before interest and tax which reflects the replacement cost of supplies by excluding from profit or loss inventory holding gains and lossesa. Replacement cost profit or loss for the group is not a recognized measure under IFRS.
Sales between segments are made at prices that approximate market prices, taking into account the volumes involved. Segment revenues and segment results include transactions between business segments. These transactions and any unrealized profits and losses are eliminated on consolidation, unless unrealized losses provide evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Sales to external customers by region are based on the location of the group subsidiary which made the sale. The UK region includes the UK-based international activities of Downstream.
All surpluses and deficits recognized on the group balance sheet in respect of pension and other post-retirement benefit plans are allocated to Other businesses and corporate. However, the periodic expense relating to these plans is allocated to the operating segments based upon the business in which the employees work.
Certain financial information is provided separately for the US as this is an individually material country for BP, and for the UK as this is BP’s country of domicile.
 







































a 
Inventory holding gains and losses represent the difference between the cost of sales calculated using the replacement cost of inventory and the cost of sales calculated on the first-in first-out (FIFO) method after adjusting for any changes in provisions where the net realizable value of the inventory is lower than its cost. Under the FIFO method, which we use for IFRS reporting, the cost of inventory charged to the income statement is based on its historical cost of purchase or manufacture, rather than its replacement cost. In volatile energy markets, this can have a significant distorting effect on reported income. The amounts disclosed represent the difference between the charge to the income statement for inventory on a FIFO basis (after adjusting for any related movements in net realizable value provisions) and the charge that would have arisen based on the replacement cost of inventory. For this purpose, the replacement cost of inventory is calculated using data from each operation’s production and manufacturing system, either on a monthly basis, or separately for each transaction where the system allows this approach. The amounts disclosed are not separately reflected in the financial statements as a gain or loss. No adjustment is made in respect of the cost of inventories held as part of a trading position and certain other temporary inventory positions.

156
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other
 businesses
and
corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
56,399

270,689


1,678

(30,010
)
298,756

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(28,565
)
(574
)

(871
)
30,010


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
27,834

270,115


807


298,756

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
951

589

2,283

(70
)

3,753

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
14,328

6,940

2,221

(3,521
)
211

20,179

Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
(6
)
(862
)
67



(801
)
Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
14,322

6,078

2,288

(3,521
)
211

19,378

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,528
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(127
)
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
16,723

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,211

900


59


5,170

Non-US
 
8,907

1,177


203


10,287

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
355

834


1,557


2,746

Segment assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investments in joint ventures and associates
 
12,785

2,772

10,074

689


26,320

Additions to non-current assetsb
 
11,533

2,862


245


14,640

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 156.
b 
Includes additions to property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; and investments in associates.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other businesses and corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
45,440

219,853


1,469

(26,554
)
240,208

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(24,179
)
(1,800
)

(575
)
26,554


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
21,261

218,053


894


240,208

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
930

674

922

(19
)

2,507

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
5,221

7,221

836

(4,445
)
(212
)
8,621

Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
8

758

87



853

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
5,229

7,979

923

(4,445
)
(212
)
9,474

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,074
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(220
)
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,180

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,631

875


65


5,571

Non-US
 
8,637

1,141


235


10,013

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
220

304


2,902


3,426

Segment assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investments in joint ventures and associates
 
12,093

2,349

10,059

484


24,985

Additions to non-current assetsb
 
14,500

2,677


275


17,452

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 156.
b 
Includes additions to property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; and investments in associates.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
157


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

By business
 
Upstream

Downstream

Rosneft

Other businesses and corporate

Consolidation adjustment and eliminations

Total
group

Segment revenues
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
33,188

167,683


1,667

(19,530
)
183,008

Less: sales and other operating revenues between segments
 
(17,581
)
(1,291
)

(658
)
19,530


Third party sales and other operating revenues
 
15,607

166,392


1,009


183,008

Earnings from joint ventures and associates – after interest and tax
 
723

608

647

(18
)

1,960

Segment results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
574

5,162

590

(8,157
)
(196
)
(2,027
)
Inventory holding gains (losses)a
 
60

1,484

53



1,597

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
634

6,646

643

(8,157
)
(196
)
(430
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Finance costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,675
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
 
 
 
 
 
(190
)
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,295
)
Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,396

856


71


5,323

Non-US
 
7,835

1,094


253


9,182

Charges for provisions, net of write-back of unused provisions, including change in discount rate
 
352

758


6,719


7,829

a 
See explanation of inventory holding gains and losses on page 156.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
98,066

200,690

298,756

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
369

1,167

1,536

Results
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
3,041

17,138

20,179

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Non-current assetsb c
 
68,188

124,060

192,248

a 
Non-US region includes UK $65,630 million
b 
Non-US region includes UK $19,426 million
c 
Includes property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; investments in associates; and non-current prepayments.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2017

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
83,269

156,939

240,208

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
52

1,723

1,775

Results
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
(266
)
8,887

8,621

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
Non-current assetsb c
 
61,828

123,646

185,474

a 
Non-US region includes UK $48,837 million.
b 
Non-US region includes UK $18,004 million.
c 
Includes property, plant and equipment; goodwill; intangible assets; investments in joint ventures; investments in associates; and non-current prepayments.


158
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


5. Segmental analysis – continued
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2016

By geographical area
 
US

Non-US

Total

Revenues
 
 
 
 
Third party sales and other operating revenuesa
 
65,132

117,876

183,008

Other income statement items
 
 
 
 
Production and similar taxes
 
155

528

683

Results
 
 
 
 
Replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
(8,311
)
6,284

(2,027
)
a 
Non-US region includes UK $37,119 million.

6. Revenue from contracts with customers
The amounts shown in the table below are included in Sales and other operating revenues in the group income statement. An analysis of total sales and other operating revenues by segment and region is provided in Note 5.
Revenue from contracts with customers, by product
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Crude oil
 
65,276

49,670

32,284

Oil products
 
195,466

159,821

126,465

Natural gas, LNG and NGLs
 
21,745

16,196

11,337

Non-oil products and other revenues from contracts with customers
 
13,768

12,538

11,487

Revenues from contracts with customers
 
296,255

238,225

181,573

The group’s sales to customers of crude oil and oil products were substantially all made by the Downstream segment. The group’s sales to customers of natural gas, LNG and NGLs were made by the Upstream segment. A significant majority of the group’s sales of non-oil products and other revenues from contracts with customers were made by the Downstream segment.

7. Income statement analysis
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Interest and other income
 
 
 
 
Interest income from
 
 
 
 
Financial assets measured at amortized cost
 
421

288

183

Financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss
 
39



Other income
 
313

369

323

 
 
773

657

506

Currency exchange losses charged to the income statementa
 
368

83

698

Expenditure on research and development
 
429

391

400

Finance costs
 
 
 
 
Interest payable on liabilities measured at amortized cost
 
2,198

1,718

1,221

Capitalized at 3.56% (2017 2.25% and 2016 1.81%)b
 
(419
)
(297
)
(244
)
Unwinding of discount on provisions
 
210

150

310

Unwinding of discount on other payables measured at amortized cost
 
539

503

388

 
 
2,528

2,074

1,675

a 
Excludes exchange gains and losses arising on financial instruments measured at fair value through profit or loss.
b 
Tax relief on capitalized interest is approximately $55 million (2017 $64 million and 2016 $56 million).



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
159


8. Exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources
The following financial information represents the amounts included within the group totals relating to activity associated with the exploration for and evaluation of oil and natural gas resources. All such activity is recorded within the Upstream segment.
For information on significant judgements made in relation to oil and natural gas accounting see Intangible assets in Note 1.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Exploration and evaluation costs
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written offa
 
1,085

1,603

1,274

Other exploration costs
 
360

477

447

Exploration expense for the year
 
1,445

2,080

1,721

Impairment losses
 
137


62

Intangible assets – exploration and appraisal expenditureb
 
15,989

17,026

16,960

Liabilities
 
60

82

102

Net assets
 
15,929

16,944

16,858

Cash used in operating activities
 
360

477

447

Cash used in investing activities
 
1,119

1,901

2,920

a 2018 includes $447 million in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico principally relating to licence expiries. 2017 included a write-off in Angola of $574 million in relation to licence relinquishment, and Egypt of $208 million following a determination that no commercial hydrocarbons had been found. 2017 also included a $145-million write-off in relation to the value ascribed to certain licences in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico as part of the accounting for the acquisition of upstream assets from Devon Energy in 2011. 2016 included a $601-million write-off in Brazil relating to the BM-C-34 licence and various write-offs in the Gulf of Mexico totalling $611 million and India totalling $216 million, partially offset by a write-back of $319 million in India relating to block KG D6 as a result of increased confidence in the progress of the projects. An impairment reversal of $234 million was also recorded in 2016 in relation to KG D6 in India. For further information see Upstream – Exploration on page 25.
b 2018 includes $2.3 billion relating to licences in the Gulf of Mexico that have expired and approximately $1.6 billion relating to certain licences elsewhere that are due to expire in the next financial year. BP remains committed to developing these prospects. See Note 1 for further information.

The carrying amount, by location, of exploration and appraisal expenditure capitalized as intangible assets at 31 December 2018 is shown in the table below.
Carrying amount
 
Location
$1 - 2 billion
 
Angola; India; Egypt; Middle East
$2 - 3 billion
 
US - Gulf of Mexico; Canada; Brazil

9. Taxation
Tax on profit
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Current tax
 
 
 
 
Charge for the year
 
6,217

4,208

1,762

Adjustment in respect of prior yearsa
 
(221
)
58

(123
)
 
 
5,996

4,266

1,639

Deferred taxb
 
 
 
 
Origination and reversal of temporary differences in the current year
 
907

(503
)
(3,709
)
Adjustment in respect of prior years
 
242

(51
)
(397
)
 
 
1,149

(554
)
(4,106
)
Tax charge (credit) on profit or loss
 
7,145

3,712

(2,467
)
a 
The adjustments in respect of prior years reflect the reassessment of the current tax balances for prior years in light of changes in facts and circumstances during the year.
b 
Origination and reversal of temporary differences in the current year include the impact of tax rate changes on deferred tax balances. 2018 includes a credit of $121 million (2017 $859 million charge) in respect of the reduction in the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018. The adjustments in respect of prior years reflect the reassessment of deferred tax balances for prior periods in light of all other changes in facts and circumstances during the year.
In 2018, the total tax charge recognized within other comprehensive income was $714 million (2017 $1,499 million charge and 2016 $752 million credit), primarily comprising the deferred tax impact of the remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset. See Note 32 for further information.
The total tax charge recognized directly in equity was $17 million (2017 $263 million charge and 2016 $5 million credit).
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to taxation see Income taxes in Note 1.
Reconciliation of the effective tax rate
The following table provides a reconciliation of the group weighted average statutory corporate income tax rate to the effective tax rate of the group on profit or loss before taxation.
For 2016, the items presented in the reconciliation are affected as a result of the overall tax credit for the year and the loss before taxation. In order to provide a more meaningful analysis of the effective tax rate, the table also presents separate reconciliations for the group excluding the impacts of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill and impairment losses and reversals, and for the impacts of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill and impairment losses and reversals in isolation.

160
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


9. Taxation – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016 excluding impacts of Gulf of Mexico oil spill and impairments

2016 impacts of Gulf of Mexico oil spill and impairments

2016

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
16,723

7,180

2,914

(5,209
)
(2,295
)
Tax charge (credit) on profit or loss
 
7,145

3,712

(117
)
(2,350
)
(2,467
)
Effective tax rate
 
43%
52%
(4)%
45%
107%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
% of profit or loss before taxation
 
Tax rate computed at the weighted average statutory ratea
 
43

44

18

33

52

Increase (decrease) resulting from
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax reported in equity-accounted entities
 
(5
)
(7
)
(15
)

19

Adjustments in respect of prior years
 


5

13

23

Deferred tax not recognized
 
2

9

26

3

(27
)
Tax incentives for investment
 
(2
)
(6
)
(9
)

11

Gulf of Mexico oil spill non-deductible costs
 

1


(2
)
(4
)
Disposal impactsb
 

(1
)
(24
)

30

Foreign exchange
 
3

(4
)
1


(2
)
Items not deductible for tax purposes
 
1

5

8


(11
)
Impact of US tax reformc
 
(1
)
12




Decrease in rate of UK supplementary charged
 


(15
)

19

Other
 
2

(1
)
1

(2
)
(3
)
Effective tax rate
 
43

52

(4
)
45

107

a 
Calculated based on the statutory corporate income tax rate applicable in the countries in which the group operates, weighted by the profits and losses before tax in the respective countries.
b 
In 2016 this related primarily to the tax impact on the contribution of BP’s Norwegian upstream business into Aker BP ASA.
c 
Relates to the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018.
d 
Relates to the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the UK supplementary charge rate applicable to profits arising in the North Sea from 20% to 10% in 2016.
Deferred tax
 
 
 
$ million

Analysis of movements during the year in the net deferred tax liability
 
2018

2017

At 31 December
 
3,513

2,497

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9a
 
(36
)

At 1 January
 
3,477

2,497

Exchange adjustments
 
(68
)
12

Charge (credit) for the year in the income statement
 
1,149

(554
)
Charge for the year in other comprehensive income
 
734

1,503

Charge for the year in equity
 
17

1

Acquisitions and other additionsb
 
797

54

At 31 December
 
6,106

3,513

a 2018 reflects the deferred tax impact of adjustments recorded by the group on adoption of IFRS 9. See Note 1 for further information.
b 2018 relates primarily to the purchase of an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field. See Note 3 - Other significant transactions for further information.



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
161


9. Taxation – continued
The following table provides an analysis of deferred tax in the income statement and the balance sheet by category of temporary difference:
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Income statementa
 
 
Balance sheeta

 
 
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

Deferred tax liability
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation
 
(1,297
)
(3,971
)
81

22,565

23,045

Pension plan surpluses
 
65

(12
)
(12
)
1,956

1,319

Derivative financial instruments
 
(36
)
(27
)
(230
)

623

Other taxable temporary differences
 
(57
)
(64
)
(122
)
1,224

1,317

 
 
(1,325
)
(4,074
)
(283
)
25,745

26,304

Deferred tax asset
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 
(6
)
340

98

(1,319
)
(1,386
)
Decommissioning, environmental and other provisions
 
1,505

3,503

591

(7,126
)
(8,618
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
(25
)
(50
)
(6
)
(144
)
(672
)
Tax creditsb
 
123

1,476

(5,177
)
(3,626
)
(3,750
)
Loss carry forward
 
559

(964
)
249

(5,900
)
(6,493
)
Other deductible temporary differences
 
318

(785
)
422

(1,524
)
(1,872
)
 
 
2,474

3,520

(3,823
)
(19,639
)
(22,791
)
Net deferred tax charge (credit) and net deferred tax liability
 
1,149

(554
)
(4,106
)
6,106

3,513

Of which – deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
 
9,812

7,982

 – deferred tax assets
 
 
 
 
3,706

4,469

a The 2017 and 2018 income statement and balance sheet are impacted by the reduction in US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018.
b 
The 2016 income statement reflected the impact of a loss carry-back claim in the US, displacing foreign tax credits utilized in prior periods which are now carried forward.

The recognition of deferred tax assets of $2,758 million (2017 $3,503 million), in entities which have suffered a loss in either the current or preceding period, is supported by forecasts which indicate that sufficient future taxable profits will be available to utilize such assets. For 2018, $1,563 million relates to the US (2017 $2,067 million) and $1,108 million relates to India (2017 $1,336 million).
A summary of temporary differences, unused tax credits and unused tax losses for which deferred tax has not been recognized is shown in the table below.
 
 
 
$ billion

At 31 December
 
2018

2017

Unused US state tax lossesa
 
6.6

6.8

Unused tax losses – other jurisdictionsb
 
4.3

4.5

Unused tax credits
 
22.5

20.1

of which – arising in the UKc
 
18.7

16.3

              – arising in the USd
 
3.8

3.8

Deductible temporary differencese
 
37.3

31.4

Taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
1.5

1.6

a 
For 2018 these losses expire in the period 2019-2038 with applicable tax rates ranging from 3% to 12%.
b 
The majority of the unused tax losses have no fixed expiry date.
c 
The UK unused tax credits arise predominantly in overseas branches of UK entities based in jurisdictions with higher statutory corporate income tax rates than the UK. No deferred tax asset has been recognized on these tax credits as they are unlikely to have value in the future; UK taxes on these overseas branches are largely mitigated by double tax relief in respect of overseas tax. These tax credits have no fixed expiry date.
d 
For 2018 the US unused tax credits expire in the period 2019-2028.
e 
The majority comprises fixed asset temporary differences in the UK. Substantially all of the temporary differences have no expiry date.
 
 
 
 
$ million

Impact of previously unrecognized deferred tax or write-down of deferred tax assets on tax charge
 
2018

2017

2016

Current tax benefit relating to the utilization of previously unrecognized deferred tax assets
 
83

22

40

Deferred tax benefit arising from the reversal of a previous write-down of deferred tax assets
 


269

Deferred tax benefit relating to the recognition of previously unrecognized deferred tax assets
 
112

436

394

Deferred tax expense arising from the write-down of a previously recognized deferred tax asset
 
169

78

55



162
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


10. Dividends
The quarterly dividend paid on 29 March 2019 in respect of the fourth quarter 2018 was 10.25 cents per ordinary share ($0.615 per American Depositary Share (ADS)). The corresponding amount in sterling was announced on 18 March 2019. A scrip dividend alternative is available, allowing shareholders to elect to receive their dividend in the form of new ordinary shares and ADS holders in the form of new ADSs.
 
 
Pence per share
 
Cents per share
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Dividends announced and paid in cash
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

1

1

Ordinary shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
March
 
7.1691

8.1587

7.0125

10.00

10.00

10.00

1,828

1,303

1,099

June
 
7.4435

7.7563

6.9167

10.00

10.00

10.00

1,727

1,546

1,168

September
 
7.9296

7.6213

7.5578

10.25

10.00

10.00

1,409

1,676

1,161

December
 
8.0251

7.4435

7.9313

10.25

10.00

10.00

1,734

1,627

1,182

 
 
30.5673

30.9798

29.4183

40.50

40.00

40.00

6,699

6,153

4,611

Dividend announced, paid in March 2019
 
 
 
 
10.25

 
 
1,435

 
 
The details of the scrip dividends issued are shown in the table below.
 
 
2018

2017

2016

Number of shares issued (thousand)
 
195,305

289,789

548,005

Value of shares issued ($ million)
 
1,381

1,714

2,858

The financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2018 do not reflect the dividend announced on 5 February 2019 and paid in March 2019; this will be treated as an appropriation of profit in the year ending 31 December 2019.

11. Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
Cents per share

Per ordinary share
 
2018

2017

2016

Basic earnings per share
 
46.98

17.20

0.61

Diluted earnings per share
 
46.67

17.10

0.60

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dollars per share
 
Per American Depositary Share (ADS)
 
2018

2017

2016

Basic earnings per share
 
2.82

1.03

0.04

Diluted earnings per share
 
2.80

1.03

0.04

Basic earnings per ordinary share amounts are calculated by dividing the profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP ordinary shareholders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.
The average number of shares outstanding includes certain shares that will be issuable in the future under employee share-based payment plans and excludes treasury shares, which includes shares held by the Employee Share Ownership Plan trusts (ESOPs).
For the diluted earnings per share calculation, the weighted average number of shares outstanding during the year is adjusted for the average number of shares that are potentially issuable in connection with employee share-based payment plans. If the inclusion of potentially issuable shares would decrease loss per share, the potentially issuable shares are excluded from the weighted average number of shares outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Profit (loss) attributable to BP shareholders
 
9,383

3,389

115

Less: dividend requirements on preference shares
 
1

1

1

Profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP ordinary shareholders
 
9,382

3,388

114

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shares thousand

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares
 
19,970,215

19,692,613

18,744,800

Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares issuable under employee share-based payment plans
 
132,278

123,829

110,519

Weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share
 
20,102,493

19,816,442

18,855,319

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shares thousand

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares – ADS equivalent
 
3,328,369

3,282,102

3,124,133

Potential dilutive effect of ordinary shares (ADS equivalent) issuable under employee share-based payment plans
 
22,046

20,638

18,420

Weighted average number of ordinary shares (ADS equivalent) outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per share
 
3,350,415

3,302,740

3,142,553


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
163


11. Earnings per share – continued
The number of ordinary shares outstanding at 31 December 2018, excluding treasury shares, and including certain shares that will be issuable in the future under employee share-based payment plans was 20,101,658,664. Between 31 December 2018 and 11 March 2019, the latest practicable date before the completion of these financial statements, there was a net increase of 143,038,241 in the number of ordinary shares outstanding primarily as a result of share issues in relation to employee share-based payment plans.
Employee share-based payment plans
The group operates share and share option plans for directors and certain employees to obtain ordinary shares and ADSs in the company. Information on these plans for directors is shown in the Directors remuneration report on pages 87-109.
The following table shows the number of shares potentially issuable under equity-settled employee share option plans, including the number of options outstanding, the number of options exercisable at the end of each year, and the corresponding weighted average exercise prices. The dilutive effect of these plans at 31 December is also shown.
Share options
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Number of optionsab
thousand

Weighted average
 exercise price $

Number of optionsab
thousand

Weighted average
 exercise price $

Outstanding
 
19,437

4.28

22,399

4.34

Exercisable
 
481

4.69

1,112

4.46

Dilutive effect
 
6,123

n/a

5,145

n/a

a 
Numbers of options shown are ordinary share equivalents (one ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares).
b 
At 31 December 2018 the quoted market price of one BP ordinary share was £4.96 (2017 £5.23).
In addition, the group operates a number of equity-settled employee share plans under which share units are granted to the group’s senior leaders and certain other employees. These plans typically have a three-year performance or restricted period during which the units accrue net notional dividends which are treated as having been reinvested. Leaving employment will normally preclude the conversion of units into shares, but special arrangements apply for participants that leave for qualifying reasons. The number of shares that are expected to vest each year under employee share plans are shown in the table below. The dilutive effect of the employee share plans at 31 December is also shown.
Share plans
 
2018

2017

 
 
Number of sharesa

Number of sharesa

Vesting
 
thousand

thousand

Within one year
 
108,934

101,550

1 to 2 years
 
106,337

108,373

2 to 3 years
 
71,407

85,878

3 to 4 years
 
588

413

Over 4 years
 
799

166

 
 
288,065

296,380

Dilutive effect
 
127,165

126,122

a 
Numbers of shares shown are ordinary share equivalents (one ADS is equivalent to six ordinary shares).
There has been a net decrease of 56,796,490 in the number of potential ordinary shares relating to employee share-based payment plans between 31 December 2018 and 11 March 2019.


164
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


12. Property, plant and equipment
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Land and land improvements

Buildings

Oil and gas propertiesa

Plant, machinery and equipment

Fittings, fixtures and office equipment

Transportationb

Oil depots, storage tanks and service stations

Total

Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2018
 
3,474

1,573

226,054

46,662

2,853

10,774

8,748

300,138

Exchange adjustments
 
(168
)
(58
)

(892
)
(73
)
(43
)
(501
)
(1,735
)
Additions
 
233

40

9,712

2,323

204

(112
)
736

13,136

Acquisitions
 
163

4

10,882

9

1

2

36

11,097

Remeasurements
 


17





17

Transfers from intangible assets
 


901





901

Deletions
 
(140
)
(45
)
(14,699
)
(1,810
)
(238
)
(128
)
(146
)
(17,206
)
At 31 December 2018
 
3,562

1,514

232,867

46,292

2,747

10,493

8,873

306,348

Depreciation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2018
 
683

818

133,326

20,996

2,136

7,523

5,185

170,667

Exchange adjustments
 
(25
)
(24
)

(460
)
(52
)
(27
)
(279
)
(867
)
Charge for the year
 
92

52

12,342

1,820

189

252

384

15,131

Impairment losses
 
2


86

253


178

2

521

Impairment reversals
 


(564
)
(1
)

(17
)

(582
)
Deletions
 
(126
)
(139
)
(11,333
)
(1,733
)
(232
)
(75
)
(145
)
(13,783
)
At 31 December 2018
 
626

707

133,857

20,875

2,041

7,834

5,147

171,087

Net book amount at 31
 December 2018
 
2,936

807

99,010

25,417

706

2,659

3,726

135,261

Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2017
 
3,066

2,235

215,564

43,725

2,670

14,000

7,623

288,883

Exchange adjustments
 
264

42


1,251

91

28

772

2,448

Additions
 
264

94

12,366

1,890

240

347

575

15,776

Acquisitions
 



41


228

1

270

Transfers from intangible assets
 


451





451

Deletions
 
(120
)
(798
)
(2,327
)
(245
)
(148
)
(3,829
)
(223
)
(7,690
)
At 31 December 2017
 
3,474

1,573

226,054

46,662

2,853

10,774

8,748

300,138

Depreciation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January 2017
 
584

1,062

122,428

18,686

2,022

9,823

4,521

159,126

Exchange adjustments
 
33

27


647

67

19

466

1,259

Charge for the year
 
90

94

12,385

1,764

185

381

350

15,249

Impairment losses
 
3

35

624

35


479

17

1,193

Impairment reversals
 


(135
)


(72
)

(207
)
Deletions
 
(27
)
(400
)
(1,976
)
(136
)
(138
)
(3,107
)
(169
)
(5,953
)
At 31 December 2017
 
683

818

133,326

20,996

2,136

7,523

5,185

170,667

Net book amount at 31
 December 2017
 
2,791

755

92,728

25,666

717

3,251

3,563

129,471

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets held under finance leases at net book amount included above
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 

2

12

207


295

6

522

At 31 December 2017
 

2

16

238


233

7

496

Assets under construction included above
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22,522

At 31 December 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
23,789

a For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to the estimation of oil and natural reserves see Property, plant and equipment within Note 1.
b 
Includes adjustments to decommissioning provisions see Note 1 for further information.

13. Capital commitments
Authorized future capital expenditure for property, plant and equipment by group companies for which contracts had been signed at 31 December 2018 amounted to $8,319 million (2017 $11,340 million). BP has capital commitments amounting to $1,227 million (2017 $1,451 million) in relation to associates. BP’s share of capital commitments of joint ventures amounted to $619 million (2017 $483 million).


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
165


14. Goodwill and impairment review of goodwill
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

Cost
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
12,163

11,805

Exchange adjustments
 
(210
)
336

Acquisitions and other additionsa
 
1,046

83

Deletions
 
(184
)
(61
)
At 31 December
 
12,815

12,163

Impairment losses
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
612

611

Exchange adjustments
 

1

Deletions
 
(1
)

At 31 December
 
611

612

Net book amount at 31 December
 
12,204

11,551

Net book amount at 1 January
 
11,551

11,194

a 2018 principally relates to the purchase of an additional 16.5% share in the Clair field in the North Sea. See Note 3 - Other significant transactions for further information.
Impairment review of goodwill
 
 
 
$ million

Goodwill at 31 December
 
2018

2017

Upstream
 
8,346

7,728

Downstream
 
3,802

3,758

Other businesses and corporate
 
56

65

 
 
12,204

11,551

Goodwill acquired through business combinations has been allocated to groups of cash-generating units that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the acquisition. For Upstream, goodwill is allocated to all oil and gas assets in aggregate at the segment level. For Downstream, goodwill has been allocated to Lubricants and Other.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to impairments see Impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets and goodwill in Note 1.
Upstream
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

Goodwill
 
8,346

7,728

Excess of recoverable amount over carrying amount
 
53,391

27,705

The table above shows the carrying amount of goodwill for the segment and the excess of the recoverable amount, based upon a post-tax value-in-use calculation, over the carrying amount (headroom) at the date of the test. The increase in headroom principally arises from acquisitions, new activity and changes in US tax. In the prior year, the recoverable amount was estimated using a fair value less costs of disposal calculation and was based on cash flows estimated for the impairment test performed in 2016 as permitted by IAS 36.
The value in use is based on the cash flows expected to be generated by the projected oil or natural gas production profiles up to the expected dates of cessation of production of each producing field, based on current estimates of reserves and resources, appropriately risked. Midstream and supply and trading activities and equity-accounted entities are generally not included in the impairment review of goodwill, because they are not part of the grouping of cash-generating units to which the goodwill relates and which is used to monitor the goodwill for internal management purposes. Where such activities form part of a wider Upstream cash-generating unit, they are reflected in the test. As the production profile and related cash flows can be estimated from BP’s past experience, management believes that the cash flows generated over the estimated life of field is the appropriate basis upon which to assess goodwill and individual assets for impairment. The estimated date of cessation of production depends on the interaction of a number of variables, such as the recoverable quantities of hydrocarbons, the production profile of the hydrocarbons, the cost of the development of the infrastructure necessary to recover the hydrocarbons, production costs, the contractual duration of the production concession and the selling price of the hydrocarbons produced. As each producing field has specific reservoir characteristics and economic circumstances, the cash flows of the fields are computed using appropriate individual economic models and key assumptions agreed by BP management. Capital expenditure, operating costs and expected hydrocarbon production profiles are derived from the business segment plan adjusted for assumptions reflecting the price environment at the time that the test was performed. Estimated production volumes and cash flows up to the date of cessation of production on a field-by-field basis are consistent with this. The production profiles used are consistent with the reserve and resource volumes approved as part of BP’s centrally controlled process for the estimation of proved and probable reserves and total resources.
The most recent review for impairment was carried out in the fourth quarter. The key assumptions used in the value-in-use calculation are oil and natural gas prices, production volumes and the discount rate. Oil and gas price assumptions for the first five years are based on management’s best estimate of prices over those five years, with the long-term price applied from year 6 onwards. Price assumptions and discount rate assumptions used were as disclosed in Note 1. The value-in-use calculation has been prepared solely for the purposes of determining whether the goodwill balance was impaired. Estimated future cash flows were prepared on the basis of certain assumptions prevailing at the time of the test. The actual outcomes may differ from the assumptions made. For example, reserves and resources estimates and production forecasts are subject to revision as further technical information becomes available and economic conditions change, and future commodity prices may differ from the forecasts used in the calculations.
Sensitivities to different variables have been estimated using certain simplifying assumptions. For example, lower oil and gas price sensitivities do not reflect the specific impacts for each contractual arrangement and will not capture fully any favourable impacts that may arise from cost deflation. Therefore a detailed calculation at any given price or production profile may produce a different result.



166
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


14. Goodwill and impairment review of goodwill – continued
It is estimated that if the oil price assumption for all future years was approximately $14 per barrel lower in each year, this would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment. It is estimated that no reasonable fall in the gas price assumption would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment.
Estimated production volumes are based on detailed data for each field and take into account development plans agreed by management as part of the long-term planning process. The average production for the purposes of goodwill impairment testing over the next 15 years is 829mmboe per year (2017 889mmboe per year). It is estimated that if production volumes were to be reduced by approximately 13% for this period, this would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment.
It is estimated that if the post-tax discount rate was approximately 11% for the entire portfolio, an increase of 5% for all countries not considered ‘higher risk’ and 3% for countries considered 'higher risk', this would cause the recoverable amount to be equal to the carrying amount of goodwill and related net non-current assets of the segment.
Downstream
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
Lubricants

Other

Total

Lubricants

Other

Total

Goodwill
 
2,692

1,110

3,802

2,849

909

3,758

Cash flows for each cash-generating unit are derived from the business segment plans, which cover a period of up to five years. To determine the value in use for each of the cash-generating units, cash flows for a period of 10 years are discounted and aggregated with a terminal value.
Lubricants
As permitted by IAS 36, the detailed calculations of Lubricants’ recoverable amount performed in the most recent detailed calculation in 2013 were used as the basis for the tests in 2014-2017 as the criteria of IAS 36 were considered satisfied: the headroom was substantial in 2013; there have been no significant changes in the assets and liabilities; and the likelihood that the recoverable amount would be less than the carrying amount is remote. IAS 36 does not specify for how many years such an approach is appropriate and management determined that a re-performance of the test was appropriate in 2018 given the passage of time since 2013. There was no significant change in the outcome of this test compared to that in 2013.
The key assumptions to which the calculation of value in use for the Lubricants unit is most sensitive are operating unit margins, sales volumes, and discount rate. Operating margin and sales volumes assumptions used in the detailed impairment review of goodwill calculation are consistent with the assumptions used in the Lubricants unit’s business plan and values assigned to these key assumptions reflect past experience. No reasonably possible change in any of these key assumptions would cause the unit’s carrying amount to exceed its recoverable amount. Cash flows beyond the plan period are extrapolated using a nominal 2.8% growth rate (2013 3%).

15. Intangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
Exploration and appraisal expenditurea

Other intangibles

Total

Exploration and appraisal expenditurea

Other intangibles

Total

Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
17,886

4,488

22,374

18,524

4,035

22,559

Exchange adjustments
 

(128
)
(128
)

197

197

Acquisitions
 

25

25


41

41

Additions
 
1,095

318

1,413

2,128

310

2,438

Transfers to property, plant and equipment
 
(901
)

(901
)
(451
)

(451
)
Deletions
 
(1,027
)
(199
)
(1,226
)
(2,315
)
(95
)
(2,410
)
At 31 December
 
17,053

4,504

21,557

17,886

4,488

22,374

Amortization
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
860

3,159

4,019

1,564

2,812

4,376

Exchange adjustments
 

(77
)
(77
)

107

107

Charge for the year
 
1,085

326

1,411

1,603

335

1,938

Impairment losses
 
137


137




Deletions
 
(1,018
)
(199
)
(1,217
)
(2,307
)
(95
)
(2,402
)
At 31 December
 
1,064

3,209

4,273

860

3,159

4,019

Net book amount at 31 December
 
15,989

1,295

17,284

17,026

1,329

18,355

Net book amount at 1 January
 
17,026

1,329

18,355

16,960

1,223

18,183

a For further information see Intangible assets within Note 1 and Note 8.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
167


16. Investments in joint ventures
The following table provides aggregated summarized financial information relating to the group’s share of joint ventures.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Sales and other operating revenues
 
13,258

11,380

10,081

Profit before interest and taxation
 
1,396

1,394

1,612

Finance costs
 
85

100

156

Profit before taxation
 
1,311

1,294

1,456

Taxation
 
414

117

490

Profit for the year
 
897

1,177

966

Other comprehensive income
 
6

8

5

Total comprehensive income
 
903

1,185

971

Non-current assets
 
10,399

10,139

 
Current assets
 
2,935

2,419

 
Total assets
 
13,334

12,558

 
Current liabilities
 
1,715

1,687

 
Non-current liabilities
 
3,017

2,927

 
Total liabilities
 
4,732

4,614

 
Net assets
 
8,602

7,944

 
Group investment in joint ventures
 
 
 
 
Group share of net assets (as above)
 
8,602

7,944

 
Loans made by group companies to joint ventures
 
45

50

 
 
 
8,647

7,994

 

Transactions between the group and its joint ventures are summarized below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Sales to joint ventures
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Product
 
Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas
 
4,603

251

3,578

352

3,327

291

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Purchases from joint ventures
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Product
 
Purchases

Amount payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas, refinery operating costs, plant processing fees
 
1,336

300

1,257

176

943

120

The terms of the outstanding balances receivable from joint ventures are typically 30 to 45 days. The balances are unsecured and will be settled in cash. There are no significant provisions for doubtful debts relating to these balances and no significant expense recognized in the income statement in respect of bad or doubtful debts. Dividends receivable are not included in the table above.

17. Investments in associates
The following table provides aggregated summarized financial information for the group’s associates as it relates to the amounts recognized in the group income statement and on the group balance sheet.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
Income statement
 
 
Balance sheet

 
 
 
Earnings from associates
 - after interest and tax
 
 
Investments in associates

 
 
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

Rosneft
 
2,283

922

647

10,074

10,059

Other associates
 
573

408

347

7,599

6,932

 
 
2,856

1,330

994

17,673

16,991

The associate that is material to the group at both 31 December 2018 and 2017 is Rosneft.
BP owns 19.75% of the voting shares of Rosneft which are listed on the MICEX stock exchange in Moscow and its global depository receipts are listed on the London Stock Exchange. The Russian federal government, through its investment company JSC Rosneftegaz, owned 50.0% plus one share of the voting shares of Rosneft at 31 December 2018.
BP classifies its investment in Rosneft as an associate because, in management’s judgement, BP has significant influence over Rosneft; see Interests in other entities within Note 1 for further information. The group’s investment in Rosneft is a foreign operation whose functional currency is the Russian rouble. The increase in the group's equity-accounted investment balance for Rosneft at 31 December 2018 compared with 31 December 2017 principally relates to earnings from Rosneft offset by dividends distribution and foreign exchange effects which have been recognized in other comprehensive income.

168
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


17. Investments in associates – continued
The value of BP’s 19.75% shareholding in Rosneft based on the quoted market share price of $6.18 per share (2017 $4.99 per share) was $12,934 million at 31 December 2018 (2017 $10,444 million).
The following table provides summarized financial information relating to Rosneft. This information is presented on a 100% basis and reflects adjustments made by BP to Rosneft’s own results in applying the equity method of accounting. BP adjusts Rosneft’s results for the accounting required under IFRS relating to BP’s purchase of its interest in Rosneft and the amortization of the deferred gain relating to the disposal of BP’s interest in TNK-BP. These adjustments have increased the reported profit for 2018, as shown in the table below, compared with the amounts reported in Rosneft's IFRS financial statements. In particular, in 2018 these adjustments resulted in BP reporting a lower amount relating to impairment charges of downstream goodwill than the equivalent amounts reported by Rosneft.

 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
Gross amount

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Sales and other operating revenues
 
131,322

103,028

74,380

Profit before interest and taxation
 
18,886

9,949

7,094

Finance costs
 
2,785

2,228

1,747

Profit before taxation
 
16,101

7,721

5,347

Taxation
 
2,957

1,742

1,797

Non-controlling interests
 
1,585

1,311

273

Profit for the year
 
11,559

4,668

3,277

Other comprehensive income
 
2,086

2,810

4,203

Total comprehensive income
 
13,645

7,478

7,480

Non-current assets
 
137,038

158,719

 
Current assets
 
43,438

39,737

 
Total assets
 
180,476

198,456

 
Current liabilities
 
41,311

66,506

 
Non-current liabilities
 
78,754

70,704

 
Total liabilities
 
120,065

137,210

 
Net assets
 
60,411

61,246

 
Less: non-controlling interests
 
9,403

10,314

 
 
 
51,008

50,932

 
The group received dividends, net of withholding tax, of $620 million from Rosneft in 2018 (2017 $314 million and 2016 $332 million).
Summarized financial information for the group’s share of associates is shown below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP share

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
2016

 
 
Rosnefta

Other

Total

Rosnefta

Other

Total

Rosnefta

Other

Total

Sales and other operating revenues
 
25,936

9,134

35,070

20,348

7,600

27,948

14,690

5,377

20,067

Profit before interest and taxation
 
3,730

1,150

4,880

1,965

626

2,591

1,401

525

1,926

Finance costs
 
550

78

628

440

54

494

345

22

367

Profit before taxation
 
3,180

1,072

4,252

1,525

572

2,097

1,056

503

1,559

Taxation
 
584

499

1,083

344

164

508

355

156

511

Non-controlling interests
 
313


313

259


259

54


54

Profit for the year
 
2,283

573

2,856

922

408

1,330

647

347

994

Other comprehensive income
 
412

(1
)
411

555

1

556

830

(2
)
828

Total comprehensive income
 
2,695

572

3,267

1,477

409

1,886

1,477

345

1,822

Non-current assets
 
27,065

10,787

37,852

31,347

9,261

40,608

 
 
 
Current assets
 
8,579

2,398

10,977

7,848

2,645

10,493

 
 
 
Total assets
 
35,644

13,185

48,829

39,195

11,906

51,101

 
 
 
Current liabilities
 
8,159

2,232

10,391

13,135

2,501

15,636

 
 
 
Non-current liabilities
 
15,554

3,817

19,371

13,964

3,308

17,272

 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
23,713

6,049

29,762

27,099

5,809

32,908

 
 
 
Net assets
 
11,931

7,136

19,067

12,096

6,097

18,193

 
 
 
Less: non-controlling interests
 
1,857


1,857

2,037


2,037

 
 
 
 
 
10,074

7,136

17,210

10,059

6,097

16,156

 
 
 
Group investment in associates
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Group share of net assets (as above)
 
10,074

7,136

17,210

10,059

6,097

16,156

 
 
 
Loans made by group companies to associates
 

463

463


835

835

 
 
 
 
 
10,074

7,599

17,673

10,059

6,932

16,991

 
 
 
a 
From 1 October 2014, Rosneft adopted hedge accounting in relation to a portion of highly probable future export revenue denominated in US dollars over a five-year period. Foreign exchange gains and losses arising on the retranslation of borrowings denominated in currencies other than the Russian rouble and designated as hedging instruments are recognized initially in other comprehensive income, and are reclassified to the income statement as the hedged revenue is recognized.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
169


17. Investments in associates – continued
Transactions between the group and its associates are summarized below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Sales to associates
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Product
 
Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

Sales

Amount receivable at
31 December

LNG, crude oil and oil products, natural gas
 
2,064

393

1,612

216

3,643

765

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Purchases from associates
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Product
 
Purchases

Amount payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Purchases

Amount
payable at
31 December

Crude oil and oil products, natural gas, transportation tariff
 
14,112

2,069

11,613

1,681

8,873

2,000

In addition to the transactions shown in the table above, in 2018 BP acquired a 49% stake in LLC Kharampurneftegaz, a Rosneft subsidiary, which will develop subsoil resources within the Kharampurskoe and Festivalnoye licence areas in Yamalo-Nenets Autonomous Okrug in northern Russia. BP’s interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz is accounted for as an associate.
The terms of the outstanding balances receivable from associates are typically 30 to 45 days. The balances are unsecured and will be settled in cash. There are no significant provisions for doubtful debts relating to these balances and no significant expense recognized in the income statement in respect of bad or doubtful debts. Dividends receivable are not included in the table above.
The majority of the sales to and purchases from associates relate to crude oil and oil products transactions with Rosneft.
BP has commitments amounting to $11,303 million (2017 $13,932 million), primarily in relation to contracts with its associates for the purchase of transportation capacity. For information on capital commitments in relation to associates see Note 13.

18. Other investments
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Equity investmentsa
 
1

482

15

418

Other
 
221

859

110

827

 
 
222

1,341

125

1,245

a 
The majority of equity investments are unlisted.
Other investments includes $893 million relating to contingent consideration amounts arising on disposals (2017 $237 million) which are financial assets classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss. The fair value is determined using an estimate of discounted future cash flows that are expected to be received and is considered a level 3 valuation under the fair value hierarchy. Future cash flows are estimated based on inputs including oil and natural gas prices, production volumes and operating costs related to the disposed operations. The discount rate used is based on a risk-free rate adjusted for asset-specific risks.

19. Inventories
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

Crude oil
 
4,878

5,692

Natural gas
 
322

119

Refined petroleum and petrochemical products
 
10,419

10,694

 
 
15,619

16,505

Trading inventories
 
282

295

 
 
15,901

16,800

Supplies
 
2,087

2,211

 
 
17,988

19,011

Cost of inventories expensed in the income statement
 
229,878

179,716

The inventory valuation at 31 December 2018 is stated net of a provision of $1,009 million (2017 $474 million) to write down inventories to their net realizable value, of which $604 million (2017 $62 million) relates to hydrocarbon inventories. The net charge to the income statement in the year in respect of inventory net realizable value provisions was $552 million (2017 $27 million credit), of which $553 million (2017 $31 million credit) related to hydrocarbon inventories.
Trading inventories are valued using quoted benchmark prices adjusted as appropriate for location and quality differentials. They are predominantly categorized within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.


170
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


20. Trade and other receivables
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Trade receivables
 
19,414

7

18,912

4

Amounts receivable from joint ventures and associates
 
642

2

566

2

Other receivables
 
3,275

740

4,206

671

 
 
23,331

749

23,684

677

Non-financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Gulf of Mexico oil spill trust fund reimbursement asset
 
214


252


Sales taxes and production taxes
 
790

482

746

276

Other receivables
 
143

603

167

481

 
 
1,147

1,085

1,165

757

 
 
24,478

1,834

24,849

1,434

In both 2018 and 2017 the group entered into non-recourse arrangements to discount certain receivables in support of supply and trading activities and the management of credit risk.
Trade and other receivables are predominantly non-interest bearing. See Note 29 for further information.

21. Valuation and qualifying accounts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
 
Not credit-impaired

Credit impaired

Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

Trade and other receivables

Fixed asset
investments

At 1 January – IAS 39
 

335

335

314

392

335

447

435

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9
 
115


115

(85
)




At 1 January – IFRS 9
 
115

335

450

229

392

335

447

435

Charged to costs and expenses
 
(26
)
56

30

10

68

47

120

55

Charged to other accountsa
 

(12
)
(12
)
(1
)
13

3

(7
)
(2
)
Deductions
 

(52
)
(52
)
(3
)
(138
)
(71
)
(168
)
(153
)
At 31 December
 
89

327

416

235

335

314

392

335

a Principally exchange adjustments.
Valuation and qualifying accounts relating to trade and other receivables comprise expected credit loss allowances in 2018 and impairment provisions recognized on an incurred loss basis in comparative periods. The adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9 relates to the additional loss allowance required by the new standard's expected credit loss model. There were no significant changes to the gross carrying amounts of trade and other receivables during the year that affected the estimation of the loss allowance at 31 December 2018.
Valuation and qualifying accounts relating to fixed asset investments comprise impairment provisions for investments in equity-accounted entities in 2018. This includes expected credit loss allowances of $44 million (1 January 2018 $43 million) relating to loans that form part of the net investment in equity-accounted entities. The adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9 primarily relates to amounts provided against investments in equity instruments that were held at cost less impairment losses under IAS 39 but that are classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss under IFRS 9.
In addition to the amounts presented above, expected loss allowances on cash and cash equivalents classified as measured at amortized cost totalled $11 million (1 January 2018 $11 million). For further information on the group's credit risk management policies and how the group recognizes and measures expected losses see Note 29.
Valuation and qualifying accounts are deducted in the balance sheet from the assets to which they apply.
For further information on the adjustments on adoption of IFRS 9 see Note 1.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
171


22. Trade and other payables
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Current

Non-current

Current

Non-current

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Trade payables
 
26,252


26,983


Amounts payable to joint ventures and associates
 
2,369


1,857


Payables for capital expenditure and acquisitionsa
 
7,325

1,345

3,810

1,269

Payables related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spillb
 
2,279

11,922

2,089

12,253

Other payables
 
4,980

318

5,733

60

 
 
43,205

13,585

40,472

13,582

Non-financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Sales taxes, customs duties, production taxes and social security
 
2,272

35

2,586

50

Other payables
 
788

210

1,151

257

 
 
3,060

245

3,737

307

 
 
46,265

13,830

44,209

13,889

a 
Includes $3,514 million deferred consideration relating to the acquisition of Petrohawk Energy Corporation from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. See Note 3 for further information.
b See Note 2 for further information.
Materially all of BP's trade payables have payment terms in the range of 30 to 60 days and give rise to operating cash flows. The active management of supplier payment terms within this range enables BP to optimize and reduce volatility in cash flow.
Trade and other payables, other than those relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, are predominantly interest free. See Note 29 (c) for further information.

23. Provisions
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Decommissioning

Environmental

Litigation and claims

Other

Total

At 1 January 2018
 
16,100

1,516

3,334

2,994

23,944

Exchange adjustments
 
(135
)
(9
)
(3
)
(84
)
(231
)
Acquisitions
 
295

12

24

5

336

Increase (decrease) in existing provisions
 
137

428

1,492

1,303

3,360

Write-back of unused provisions
 
(2
)
(115
)
(21
)
(255
)
(393
)
Unwinding of discount
 
162

22

9

17

210

Change in discount ratea
 
(2,377
)
(38
)
(31
)
(17
)
(2,463
)
Utilization
 
(9
)
(245
)
(1,034
)
(528
)
(1,816
)
Reclassified to other payables
 
(270
)
(4
)
(2,051
)
(37
)
(2,362
)
Deletions
 
(288
)

(1
)

(289
)
At 31 December 2018
 
13,613

1,567

1,718

3,398

20,296

Of which – current
 
257

300

798

1,209

2,564

– non-current
 
13,356

1,267

920

2,189

17,732

Of which – Gulf of Mexico oil spillb
 


345


345

a 
Includes the impact of changing from a real to nominal discount rate. See Note 1 for further information.
b 
Further information on the financial impacts of the Gulf of Mexico oil spill is provided in Note 2.
The decommissioning provision comprises the future cost of decommissioning oil and natural gas wells, facilities and related pipelines. The environmental provision includes provisions for costs related to the control, abatement, clean-up or elimination of environmental pollution relating to soil, groundwater, surface water and sediment contamination. The litigation and claims category includes provisions for matters related to, for example, commercial disputes, product liability, and allegations of exposures of third parties to toxic substances. Included within the other category at 31 December 2018 are provisions for deferred employee compensation of $338 million (2017 $391 million).
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to provisions, see Provisions and contingencies within Note 1.

24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
Most group companies have pension plans, the forms and benefits of which vary with conditions and practices in the countries concerned. Pension benefits may be provided through defined contribution plans (money purchase schemes) or defined benefit plans (final salary and other types of schemes with committed pension benefit payments). For defined contribution plans, retirement benefits are determined by the value of funds arising from contributions paid in respect of each employee. For defined benefit plans, retirement benefits are based on such factors as an employee’s pensionable salary and length of service. Defined benefit plans may be funded or unfunded. The assets of funded plans are generally held in separately administered trusts.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to accounting for these plans see Pensions and other post-retirement benefits in Note 1.
The primary pension arrangement in the UK is a funded final salary pension plan under which retired employees draw the majority of their benefit as an annuity. This pension plan is governed by a corporate trustee whose board is composed of four member-nominated directors, four company-nominated directors, an independent director and an independent chairman nominated by the company. The trustee board is required by law to act in the best interests of the plan participants and is responsible for setting certain policies, such as investment policies of the plan. The UK plan is closed to new joiners but remains open to ongoing accrual for current members. New joiners in the UK are eligible for membership of a defined contribution plan.

172
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
In the US, all pension benefits now accrue under a cash balance formula. Benefits previously accrued under final salary formulas are legally protected. Retiring US employees typically take their pension benefit in the form of a lump sum payment upon retirement. The plan is funded and its assets are overseen by a fiduciary Investment Committee composed of six BP employees appointed by the president of BP Corporation North America Inc. (the appointing officer). The Investment Committee is required by law to act in the best interests of the plan participants and is responsible for setting certain policies, such as the investment policies of the plan. US employees are also eligible to participate in a defined contribution (401k) plan in which employee contributions are matched with company contributions. In the US, group companies also provide post-retirement healthcare to retired employees and their dependants (and, in certain cases, life insurance coverage); the entitlement to these benefits is usually based on the employee remaining in service until a specified age and completion of a minimum period of service.
In the Eurozone, there are defined benefit pension plans in Germany, France, the Netherlands and other countries. In Germany and France, the majority of the pensions are unfunded, in line with market practice. In Germany, the group’s largest Eurozone plan, employees receive a pension and also have a choice to supplement their core pension through salary sacrifice. For employees who joined since 2002 the core pension benefit is a career average plan with retirement benefits based on such factors as an employee’s pensionable salary and length of service. The returns on the notional contributions made by both the company and employees are based on the interest rate which is set out in German tax law. Retired German employees take their pension benefit typically in the form of an annuity. The German plans are governed by legal agreements between BP and the works council or between BP and the trade union.
The level of contributions to funded defined benefit plans is the amount needed to provide adequate funds to meet pension obligations as they fall due. During 2018 the aggregate level of contributions was $610 million (2017 $637 million and 2016 $651 million). The aggregate level of contributions in 2019 is expected to be approximately $700 million, and includes contributions in all countries that we expect to be required to make contributions by law or under contractual agreements, as well as an allowance for discretionary funding.
For the primary UK plan there is a funding agreement between the group and the trustee. On an annual basis the latest funding position is reviewed and a schedule of contributions is agreed covering the next five years. Contractually committed funding amounted to $1,275 million at 31 December 2018, all of which relates to future service. This amount is included in the group’s committed cash flows relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefit plans as set out in the table of contractual obligations on page 278.
The surplus relating to the primary UK pension plan is recognized on the balance sheet on the basis that the company is entitled to a refund of any remaining assets once all members have left the plan.
Pension contributions in the US are determined by legislation and are supplemented by discretionary contributions. No contributions were made into the primary US pension plan in 2018 and no statutory funding requirement is expected in the next 12 months.
The surplus relating to the primary US fund is recognized on the balance sheet on the basis that economic benefit can be gained from the surplus through a reduction in future contributions.
There was no minimum funding requirement for the US plan, and no significant minimum funding requirements in other countries at 31 December 2018.
The obligation and cost of providing pensions and other post-retirement benefits is assessed annually using the projected unit credit method. The date of the most recent actuarial review was 31 December 2018. The UK plans are subject to a formal actuarial valuation every three years; valuations are required more frequently in many other countries. The most recent formal actuarial valuation of the UK pension plans was as at 31 December 2017. A valuation of the US plan and largest Eurozone plans are carried out annually.
The material financial assumptions used to estimate the benefit obligations of the various plans are set out below. The assumptions are reviewed by management at the end of each year, and are used to evaluate the accrued benefit obligation at 31 December and pension expense for the following year.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
%
Financial assumptions used to determine benefit obligation
 
 
 
UK
 
 
US
 
 
Eurozone
 
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Discount rate for plan liabilities
 
2.9
2.5
2.7
4.1
3.5
3.9
2.0
1.9
1.7
Rate of increase in salaries
 
3.8
4.1
4.6
3.9
4.1
4.2
3.1
3.0
3.0
Rate of increase for pensions in payment
 
3.0
2.9
3.0
1.5
1.4
1.5
Rate of increase in deferred pensions
 
3.0
2.9
3.0
0.5
0.6
0.5
Inflation for plan liabilities
 
3.1
3.1
3.2
1.5
1.7
1.8
1.7
1.6
1.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
%
Financial assumptions used to determine benefit expense
 
 
 
UK
 
 
US
 
 
Eurozone
 
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Discount rate for plan service cost
 
2.6
2.7
4.0
3.6
4.1
4.2
2.4
2.1
2.7
Discount rate for plan other finance expense
 
2.5
2.7
3.9
3.5
3.9
4.0
1.9
1.7
2.4
Inflation for plan service cost
 
3.1
3.2
3.1
1.7
1.8
1.5
1.6
1.6
1.8
The discount rate assumptions are based on third-party AA corporate bond indices and for our largest plans in the UK, US and the Eurozone we use yields that reflect the maturity profile of the expected benefit payments. The inflation rate assumptions for our UK and US plans are based on the difference between the yields on index-linked and fixed-interest long-term government bonds. In other countries, including the Eurozone, we use this approach, or advice from the local actuary depending on the information available. The inflation assumptions are used to determine the rate of increase for pensions in payment and the rate of increase in deferred pensions where there is such an increase.
The assumptions for the rate of increase in salaries are based on the inflation assumption plus an allowance for expected long-term real salary growth. These include an allowance for promotion-related salary growth, of up to 0.8% depending on country.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
173


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
In addition to the financial assumptions, we regularly review the demographic and mortality assumptions. The mortality assumptions reflect best practice in the countries in which we provide pensions, and have been chosen with regard to applicable published tables adjusted where appropriate to reflect the experience of the group and an extrapolation of past longevity improvements into the future. BP’s most substantial pension liabilities are in the UK, the US and the Eurozone where our mortality assumptions are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Years

Mortality assumptions
 
 
 
UK

 
 
US

 
 
Eurozone

 
 
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Life expectancy at age 60 for a male currently aged 60
 
27.4

27.4

28.0

25.1

25.1

25.7

25.6

25.1

25.0

Life expectancy at age 60 for a male currently aged 40
 
28.9

29.0

30.0

26.9

26.8

27.5

28.1

27.6

27.6

Life expectancy at age 60 for a female currently aged 60
 
28.8

28.8

29.5

28.5

28.4

29.3

29.0

29.0

28.9

Life expectancy at age 60 for a female currently aged 40
 
30.6

30.5

31.9

30.1

30.0

31.0

31.2

31.4

31.3

Pension plan assets are generally held in trusts, the primary objective of which is to accumulate assets sufficient to meet the obligations of the plans. The assets of the trusts are invested in a manner consistent with fiduciary obligations and principles that reflect current practices in portfolio management.
A significant proportion of the assets are held in equities, which are expected to generate a higher level of return over the long term, with an acceptable level of risk. In order to provide reasonable assurance that no single security or type of security has an unwarranted impact on the total portfolio, the investment portfolios are highly diversified.
The trustee’s long-term investment objective for the primary UK plan as it matures is to invest in assets whose value changes in the same way as the plan liabilities, in order to reduce the level of funding risk. To move towards this objective, the UK plan uses a liability driven investment (LDI) approach for part of the portfolio, investing primarily in government bonds to achieve this matching effect for the most significant plan liability assumptions of interest rate and inflation rate. This is partly funded by short-term sale and repurchase agreements, whereby the plan borrows money using existing bonds as security and which will be bought back at a specified price at an agreed future date. The funds raised are used to invest in further bonds to increase the proportion of assets which match the plan liabilities. The borrowings are shown separately in the analysis of pension plan assets in the table below.
For the primary UK pension plan there is an agreement with the trustee to increase the proportion of assets with liability matching characteristics over time primarily by reducing the proportion of plan assets held as equities and increasing the proportion held as bonds. There is a similar agreement in place for the primary US plan. During 2018, the UK and the US plans switched 12.5% and 10% of plan assets respectively from equities to bonds.
The current asset allocation policy for the major plans at 31 December 2018 was as follows:
 
 
UK
US
Asset category
 
%
%
Total equity (including private equity)
 
30
40
Bonds/cash (including LDI)
 
63
60
Property/real estate
 
7
The amounts invested under the LDI programme by the primary UK pension plan as at 31 December 2018 were $4,197 million (2017 $2,588 million) of government-issued nominal bonds and $17,491 million (2017 $16,177 million) of index-linked bonds.
Some of the group’s pension plans in the Eurozone and other countries use derivative financial instruments as part of their asset mix to manage the level of risk. The fair value of these instruments are included in other assets in the table below. The UK and US plans do not use derivative financial instruments.
The group’s main pension plans do not invest directly in either securities or property/real estate of the company or of any subsidiary.
The fair values of the various categories of assets held by the defined benefit plans at 31 December are presented in the table below, including the effects of derivative financial instruments. Movements in the fair value of plan assets during the year are shown in detail in the table on page 176.

174
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
UKa

USb

Eurozone

Other

Total

Fair value of pension plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
5,191

1,238

413

306

7,148

   – emerging markets
 
950

63

65

56

1,134

Private equityc
 
2,792

1,495


4

4,291

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
4,263

2,072

895

533

7,763

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
17,491


102


17,593

Corporate bondsd
 
4,606

2,184

506

243

7,539

Propertye
 
2,311

6

57

25

2,399

Cash
 
376

73

42

83

574

Other
 
116

64

32

40

252

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(6,011
)



(6,011
)
 
 
32,085

7,195

2,112

1,290

42,682

At 31 December 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
9,548

2,158

537

376

12,619

   – emerging markets
 
2,220

220

83

53

2,576

Private equityc
 
2,679

1,461



4,140

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
2,663

1,777

941

545

5,926

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
16,177


2


16,179

Corporate bondsd
 
4,682

2,024

546

272

7,524

Propertye
 
2,211

6

71

30

2,318

Cash
 
390

80

21

98

589

Other
 
104

53

23

45

225

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(5,583
)



(5,583
)
 
 
35,091

7,779

2,224

1,419

46,513

At 31 December 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
Listed equities – developed markets
 
11,494

2,283

436

363

14,576

   – emerging markets
 
2,549

220

54

46

2,869

Private equityc
 
2,754

1,442

1


4,197

Government issued nominal bondsd
 
489

1,438

821

448

3,196

Government issued index-linked bondsd
 
9,384


4


9,388

Corporate bondsd
 
4,042

1,732

427

259

6,460

Propertye
 
1,970

6

45

28

2,049

Cash
 
547

105

17

83

752

Other
 
(68
)
90

74

83

179

Debt (repurchase agreements) used to fund liability driven investments
 
(2,981
)



(2,981
)
 
 
30,180

7,316

1,879

1,310

40,685

a 
Bonds held by the UK pension plans are denominated in sterling. Property held by the UK pension plans is in the United Kingdom.
b 
Bonds held by the US pension plans are denominated in US dollars.
c Private equity is valued at fair value based on the most recent third-party net asset valuation.
d Bonds held by pension plans are valued using quoted prices in active markets. Where quoted prices are not available, quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets are used.
e Properties are valued based on an analysis of recent market transactions supported by market knowledge derived from third-party valuers.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
175


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
295

299

84

43

721

Past service costb
 
15


9

4

28

Settlementb
 


17


17

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
310

299

110

47

766

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
38

178

5

40

261

Total operating charge
 
348

477

115

87

1,027

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(868
)
(262
)
(44
)
(45
)
(1,219
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
774

369

136

67

1,346

Other finance (income) expense
 
(94
)
107

92

22

127

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
(722
)
(256
)
(69
)
(36
)
(1,083
)
Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
1,770

945

14

65

2,794

Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
123

(9
)
(42
)
7

79

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
520

41

(43
)
9

527

Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
1,691

721

(140
)
45

2,317

Movements in benefit obligation during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at 1 January
 
31,513

10,820

7,275

1,873

51,481

Exchange adjustments
 
(1,589
)

(303
)
(113
)
(2,005
)
Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
310

299

110

47

766

Interest cost
 
774

369

136

67

1,346

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
21


2

7

30

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,780
)
(597
)
(84
)
(83
)
(2,544
)
Benefit payments (unfunded plans)d
 
(6
)
(218
)
(301
)
(17
)
(542
)
Disposals
 



(14
)
(14
)
Remeasurements
 
(2,413
)
(977
)
71

(81
)
(3,400
)
Benefit obligation at 31 Decembera e
 
26,830

9,696

6,906

1,686

45,118

Movements in fair value of plan assets during the year
 





Fair value of plan assets at 1 January
 
35,091

7,779

2,224

1,419

46,513

Exchange adjustments
 
(1,883
)

(93
)
(73
)
(2,049
)
Interest income on plan assetsa f
 
868

262

44

45

1,219

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
21


2

7

30

Contributions by employers (funded plans)
 
490

7

88

25

610

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,780
)
(597
)
(84
)
(83
)
(2,544
)
Disposals
 



(14
)
(14
)
Remeasurementsf
 
(722
)
(256
)
(69
)
(36
)
(1,083
)
Fair value of plan assets at 31 Decemberg
 
32,085

7,195

2,112

1,290

42,682

Surplus (deficit) at 31 December
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
Represented by
 





Asset recognized
 
5,473

418

29

35

5,955

Liability recognized
 
(218
)
(2,919
)
(4,823
)
(431
)
(8,391
)
 
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
The surplus (deficit) may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 





Funded
 
5,473

396

(152
)
(97
)
5,620

Unfunded
 
(218
)
(2,897
)
(4,642
)
(299
)
(8,056
)
 
 
5,255

(2,501
)
(4,794
)
(396
)
(2,436
)
The defined benefit obligation may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 





Funded
 
(26,612
)
(6,799
)
(2,264
)
(1,387
)
(37,062
)
Unfunded
 
(218
)
(2,897
)
(4,642
)
(299
)
(8,056
)
 
 
(26,830
)
(9,696
)
(6,906
)
(1,686
)
(45,118
)
a 
The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b 
Past service costs and settlements have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent charges for special termination benefits representing the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements mostly in the UK and Eurozone.
c 
Most of the contributions made by plan participants into UK pension plans were made under salary sacrifice.
d 
The benefit payments amount shown above comprises $3,046 million benefits and $2 million settlements, plus $38 million of plan expenses incurred in the administration of the benefit.
e 
The benefit obligation for the US is made up of $7,290 million for pension liabilities and $2,406 million for other post-retirement benefit liabilities (which are unfunded and are primarily retiree medical liabilities). The benefit obligation for the Eurozone includes $4,328 million for pension liabilities in Germany which is largely unfunded.
f 
The actual return on plan assets is made up of the sum of the interest income on plan assets and the remeasurement of plan assets as disclosed above.
g 
The fair value of plan assets includes borrowings related to the LDI programme as described on page 174.

176
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
357

292

85

46

780

Past service costb
 
12


5

(1
)
16

Settlementb
 


13


13

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
369

292

103

45

809

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
31

191

7

38

267

Total operating charge
 
400

483

110

83

1,076

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(845
)
(266
)
(37
)
(48
)
(1,196
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
831

393

121

71

1,416

Other finance (income) expense
 
(14
)
127

84

23

220

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
2,396

826

30

43

3,295

Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
(236
)
(514
)
336

(47
)
(461
)
Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
734

72


(23
)
783

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
91

(40
)
(36
)
14

29

Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
2,985

344

330

(13
)
3,646

Movements in benefit obligation during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at 1 January
 
29,908

10,533

6,820

1,715

48,976

Exchange adjustments
 
2,886


915

89

3,890

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
369

292

103

45

809

Interest cost
 
831

393

121

71

1,416

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
16


2

6

24

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,903
)
(641
)
(75
)
(89
)
(2,708
)
Benefit payments (unfunded plans)d
 
(5
)
(239
)
(302
)
(20
)
(566
)
Acquisitions
 

1



1

Disposals
 

(1
)
(9
)

(10
)
Remeasurements
 
(589
)
482

(300
)
56

(351
)
Benefit obligation at 31 Decembera e
 
31,513

10,820

7,275

1,873

51,481

Movements in fair value of plan assets during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at 1 January
 
30,180

7,316

1,879

1,310

40,685

Exchange adjustments
 
3,048


264

72

3,384

Interest income on plan assetsa f
 
845

266

37

48

1,196

Contributions by plan participantsc
 
16


2

6

24

Contributions by employers (funded plans)
 
509

12

87

29

637

Benefit payments (funded plans)d
 
(1,903
)
(641
)
(75
)
(89
)
(2,708
)
Remeasurementsf
 
2,396

826

30

43

3,295

Fair value of plan assets at 31 Decemberg
 
35,091

7,779

2,224

1,419

46,513

Surplus (deficit) at 31 December
 
3,578

(3,041
)
(5,051
)
(454
)
(4,968
)
Represented by
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset recognized
 
3,838

260

43

28

4,169

Liability recognized
 
(260
)
(3,301
)
(5,094
)
(482
)
(9,137
)
 
 
3,578

(3,041
)
(5,051
)
(454
)
(4,968
)
The surplus (deficit) may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 
 
 
 
 
 
Funded
 
3,838

238

(106
)
(101
)
3,869

Unfunded
 
(260
)
(3,279
)
(4,945
)
(353
)
(8,837
)
 
 
3,578

(3,041
)
(5,051
)
(454
)
(4,968
)
The defined benefit obligation may be analysed between funded and unfunded plans as follows
 
 
 
 
 
 
Funded
 
(31,253
)
(7,541
)
(2,330
)
(1,520
)
(42,644
)
Unfunded
 
(260
)
(3,279
)
(4,945
)
(353
)
(8,837
)
 
 
(31,513
)
(10,820
)
(7,275
)
(1,873
)
(51,481
)
a 
The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b 
Past service costs and settlements have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent charges for special termination benefits representing the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements mostly in the UK and Eurozone.
c 
Most of the contributions made by plan participants into UK pension plans were made under salary sacrifice.
d 
The benefit payments amount shown above comprises $3,235 million benefits and $2 million settlements, plus $37 million of plan expenses incurred in the administration of the benefit.
e 
The benefit obligation for the US is made up of $8,085 million for pension liabilities and $2,735 million for other post-retirement benefit liabilities (which are unfunded and are primarily retiree medical liabilities). The benefit obligation for the Eurozone includes $4,586 million for pension liabilities in Germany which is largely unfunded.
f 
The actual return on plan assets is made up of the sum of the interest income on plan assets and the remeasurement of plan assets as disclosed above.
g 
The fair value of plan assets includes borrowings related to the LDI programme as described on page 174.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
177


24. Pensions and other post-retirement benefits – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

Analysis of the amount charged to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current service costa
 
333

310

76

71

790

Past service costb
 
17

(24
)
7

1

1

Settlement
 


9

(1
)
8

Operating charge relating to defined benefit plans
 
350

286

92

71

799

Payments to defined contribution plans
 
30

194

7

33

264

Total operating charge
 
380

480

99

104

1,063

Interest income on plan assetsa
 
(1,086
)
(287
)
(47
)
(51
)
(1,471
)
Interest on plan liabilities
 
1,005

417

159

80

1,661

Other finance (income) expense
 
(81
)
130

112

29

190

Analysis of the amount recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actual asset return less interest income on plan assets
 
4,422

330

53

8

4,813

Change in financial assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
(6,932
)
(239
)
(622
)
4

(7,789
)
Change in demographic assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities
 
430

9

12

(5
)
446

Experience gains and losses arising on the plan liabilities
 
55

(62
)
26

15

34

Remeasurements recognized in other comprehensive income
 
(2,025
)
38

(531
)
22

(2,496
)
a The costs of managing plan investments are offset against the investment return, the costs of administering pension plan benefits are generally included in current service cost and the costs of administering other post-retirement benefit plans are included in the benefit obligation.
b Past service costs have arisen from restructuring programmes and represent a combination of credits as a result of the curtailment in the pension arrangements of a number of employees mostly in the US and charges for special termination benefits representing the increased liability arising as a result of early retirements mostly in the UK and Eurozone. The UK also includes $12 million of cost resulting from benefit harmonization within the primary plan.

Sensitivity analysis
The discount rate, inflation, salary growth and the mortality assumptions all have a significant effect on the amounts reported. A one-percentage point change, in isolation, in certain assumptions as at 31 December 2018 for the group’s plans would have had the effects shown in the table below. The effects shown for the expense in 2019 comprise the total of current service cost and net finance income or expense.
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
One percentage point
 
 
 
Increase

Decrease

Discount ratea
 
 
 
Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit expense in 2019
 
(337
)
295

Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit obligation at 31 December 2018
 
(6,179
)
8,153

Inflation rateb
 
 
 
Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit expense in 2019
 
227

(187
)
Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit obligation at 31 December 2018
 
4,919

(4,225
)
Salary growth
 
 
 
Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit expense in 2019
 
64

(55
)
Effect on pension and other post-retirement benefit obligation at 31 December 2018
 
653

(595
)
a 
The amounts presented reflect that the discount rate is used to determine the asset interest income as well as the interest cost on the obligation.
b 
The amounts presented reflect the total impact of an inflation rate change on the assumptions for rate of increase in salaries, pensions in payment and deferred pensions.
One additional year of longevity in the mortality assumptions would increase the 2019 pension and other post-retirement benefit expense by $52 million and the pension and other post-retirement benefit obligation at 31 December 2018 by $1,432 million.
Estimated future benefit payments and the weighted average duration of defined benefit obligations
The expected benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, but exclude plan expenses, up until 2028 and the weighted average duration of the defined benefit obligations at 31 December 2018 are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Estimated future benefit payments
 
UK

US

Eurozone

Other

Total

2019
 
1,030

787

350

101

2,268

2020
 
1,036

755

339

97

2,227

2021
 
1,056

806

331

97

2,290

2022
 
1,088

749

326

100

2,263

2023
 
1,120

741

317

98

2,276

2024-2028
 
5,777

3,476

1,501

498

11,252

 
 
 
 
 
 
Years

Weighted average duration
 
17.8

9.5

14.2

13.0

 

178
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


25. Cash and cash equivalents
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

Cash
 
6,148

4,592

Term bank deposits
 
13,105

17,324

Cash equivalents (excluding term bank deposits)
 
3,215

3,670

 
 
22,468

25,586

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash in hand; current balances with banks and similar institutions; term deposits of three months or less with banks and similar institutions; money market funds and commercial paper. The carrying amounts of cash and term bank deposits approximate their fair values. Substantially all of the other cash equivalents are categorized within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy.
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 2018 includes $1,350 million (2017 $1,488 million) that is restricted. The restricted cash balances include amounts required to cover initial margin on trading exchanges and certain cash balances which are subject to exchange controls.
The group holds $4,693 million (2017 $3,638 million) of cash and cash equivalents outside the UK and it is not expected that any significant tax will arise on repatriation.

26. Finance debt
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
Current

Non-current

Total

Current

Non-current

Total

Borrowings
 
9,329

55,803

65,132

7,701

54,873

62,574

Net obligations under finance leases
 
44

623

667

38

618

656

 
 
9,373

56,426

65,799

7,739

55,491

63,230

The main elements of current borrowings are the current portion of long-term borrowings that is due to be repaid in the next 12 months of $7,175 million (2017 $6,849 million) and issued commercial paper of $2,040 million (2017 $744 million). Finance debt does not include accrued interest, which is reported within other payables.
The following table shows the weighted average interest rates achieved through a combination of borrowings and derivative financial instruments entered into to manage interest rate and currency exposures.
 
 
 
Fixed rate debt
 
Floating rate debt
 
Total

 
 
Weighted
average
interest
rate
%
Weighted
average
time for
which rate
is fixed
Years
Amount
$ million

Weighted
average
interest
rate
%
Amount
$ million

Amount
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

US dollar
 
4
4
17,593

4
47,465

65,058

Other currencies
 
7
18
657

8
84

741

 
 
 
 
18,250

 
47,549

65,799

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

US dollar
 
4
4
18,090

3
44,212

62,302

Other currencies
 
6
16
895

3
33

928

 
 
 
 
18,985

 
44,245

63,230

Fair values
The estimated fair value of finance debt is shown in the table below together with the carrying amount as reflected in the balance sheet.
Long-term borrowings in the table below include the portion of debt that matures in the 12 months from 31 December 2018, whereas in the group balance sheet the amount is reported within current finance debt.
The carrying amount of the group’s short-term borrowings, comprising mainly of commercial paper, approximates their fair value. The fair values of the majority of the group’s long-term borrowings are determined using quoted prices in active markets, and so fall within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Where quoted prices are not available, quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets are used and such measurements are therefore categorized in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. The fair value of the group’s finance lease obligations is estimated using discounted cash flow analysis based on the group’s current incremental borrowing rates for similar types and maturities of borrowing and are consequently categorized in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Fair value

Carrying
amount

Fair value

Carrying
amount

Short-term borrowings
 
2,153

2,153

852

852

Long-term borrowings
 
63,106

62,979

63,182

61,722

Net obligations under finance leases
 
1,087

667

1,131

656

Total finance debt
 
66,346

65,799

65,165

63,230



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
179


27. Capital disclosures and analysis of changes in net debt
The group defines capital as total equity. We maintain our financial framework to support the pursuit of value growth for shareholders, while ensuring a secure financial base.
The group monitors capital on the basis of the net debt ratio, that is, the ratio of net debt to net debt plus equity. Net debt is calculated as gross finance debt, as shown in the balance sheet, plus the fair value of associated derivative financial instruments that are used to hedge foreign exchange and interest rate risks relating to finance debt, for which hedge accounting is applied, less cash and cash equivalents. Net debt and net debt ratio are non-GAAP measures. BP believes these measures provide useful information to investors. Net debt enables investors to see the economic effect of gross debt, related hedges and cash and cash equivalents in total. The net debt ratio enables investors to see how significant net debt is relative to equity from shareholders. The derivatives are reported on the balance sheet within the headings ‘Derivative financial instruments’. All components of equity are included in the denominator of the calculation.
We aim to manage the net debt ratio within a 20-30% band and maintain a significant liquidity buffer. At 31 December 2018, the net debt ratio was 30.3% (2017 27.4%).
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December
 
2018

2017

Gross debt
 
65,799

63,230

Less: fair value asset (liability) of hedges related to finance debta
 
(813
)
(175
)
 
 
66,612

63,405

Less: cash and cash equivalents
 
22,468

25,586

Net debt
 
44,144

37,819

Equity
 
101,548

100,404

Net debt ratio
 
30.3
%
27.4
%
a 
Derivative financial instruments entered into for the purpose of managing interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk associated with net debt with a fair value liability position of $827 million (2017 liability of $634 million, 2016 liability of $1,962 million) are not included in the calculation of net debt shown above as hedge accounting was not applied for these instruments. The movement in the year is attributable to a net cash flow of $nil (2017 net cash outflow $242 million) and fair value losses of $193 million (2017 fair value gains of $1,086 million).
An analysis of changes in net debt is provided below.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
 
2017

Movement in net debt
 
Finance
debt

Hedge-
accounted
derivatives

Cash and
cash
equivalents

Net debt

Finance
debt

Hedge-
accounted
derivatives

Cash and
cash
equivalents

Net debt

At 1 January
 
(63,230
)
(175
)
25,586

(37,819
)
(58,300
)
(697
)
23,484

(35,513
)
Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9
 


(11
)
(11
)




Exchange adjustments
 
259


(330
)
(71
)
(1,324
)

544

(780
)
Net financing cash flow
 
(3,505
)
360

(2,777
)
(5,922
)
(2,236
)
(284
)
1,558

(962
)
Fair value gains (losses)
 
856

(998
)

(142
)
(1,314
)
1,282


(32
)
Other movements
 
(179
)


(179
)
(56
)
(476
)

(532
)
At 31 December
 
(65,799
)
(813
)
22,468

(44,144
)
(63,230
)
(175
)
25,586

(37,819
)
a The adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9 reflects the creation of a credit loss allowance for cash and cash equivalents as a result of the new standard`s expected credit loss impairment model.

28. Operating leases
The cost recognized in relation to minimum lease payments for the year was $3,514 million (2017 $4,423 million and 2016 $5,113 million).
The future minimum lease payments at 31 December 2018, before deducting related rental income from operating sub-leases of $120 million (2017 $188 million), are shown in the table below. This does not include future contingent rentals. Where the lease rentals are dependent on a variable factor, the future minimum lease payments are based on the factor as at inception of the lease.
 
 
 
$ million

Future minimum lease payments
 
2018

2017

Payable within
 
 
 
1 year
 
2,511

2,969

2 to 5 years
 
5,359

6,387

Thereafter
 
4,109

4,614

 
 
11,979

13,970

In the case of an operating lease entered into by BP as the operator of a joint operation, the amounts included in the totals disclosed represent the net operating lease expense and net future minimum lease payments. These net amounts are after deducting amounts reimbursed, or to be reimbursed, by joint operators, whether the joint operators have co-signed the lease or not. Where BP is not the operator of a joint operation, BP’s share of the lease expense and future minimum lease payments is included in the amounts shown, whether BP has co-signed the lease or not.
Typical durations of operating leases are up to ten years for leases of plant and machinery, up to fifteen years for leases of ships and commercial vehicles and up to forty years for leases of land and buildings.
The most significant items of plant and machinery hired under operating leases are drilling rigs used in the Upstream segment. At 31 December 2018, the future minimum lease payments relating to these amounted to $1,378 million (2017 $2,088 million).

180
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


28. Operating leases – continued
The group has entered into a number of structured operating leases for ships and in some cases the lease rental payments vary with market interest rates. The variable portion of the lease payments above or below the amount based on the market interest rate prevailing at inception of the lease is treated as contingent rental expense. The group also routinely enters into bareboat charters, time-charters and voyage-charters for ships on standard industry terms. The future minimum lease payments relating to operating leases for international oil and gas ships managed by the BP Shipping function amounted to $3,032 million (2017 $3,172 million). Commercial vehicles hired under operating leases are primarily railcars.
Retail service station sites and office accommodation are the main items in the land and buildings category. At 31 December 2018, the future minimum lease payments relating to land and buildings amounted to $1,914 million (2017 $2,167 million).
The terms and conditions of these operating leases do not impose any significant financial restrictions on the group. Some of the leases of rigs, ships and buildings allow for renewals at BP’s option, and some of the group’s operating leases contain escalation clauses.
BP will adopt IFRS 16 'Leases' in the financial reporting period commencing 1 January 2019. See Note 1 for further details.

29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors
The accounting classification of each category of financial instruments and their carrying amounts are set out below. Current year amounts are presented based on the classification, measurement and impairment requirements of IFRS 9. Comparatives are presented based on the classification, measurement and impairment requirements of IAS 39.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2018
 
Note

 
Measured at amortized cost

Mandatorily measured at fair value through profit or loss

Derivative hedging instruments

Total carrying
amount

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
 
18

 

1,563


1,563

Loans
 
 
 
839

124


963

Trade and other receivables
 
20

 
24,080



24,080

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

8,564

427

8,991

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

 
20,366

2,102


22,468

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
22

 
(56,790
)


(56,790
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 

(7,685
)
(1,248
)
(8,933
)
Accruals
 
 
 
(5,201
)


(5,201
)
Finance debt
 
26

 
(65,799
)


(65,799
)
 
 
 
 
(82,505
)
4,668

(821
)
(78,658
)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2017
 
Note
 
Loans and receivables

Available-for-sale financial assets

Held-to-maturity investments

At fair value through profit or loss

Derivative hedging instruments

Financial liabilities measured at amortized cost

Total carrying
amount

Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments – equity shares
 
18

 

433





433

 – other
 
18

 

275


662



937

Loans
 
 
 
836






836

Trade and other receivables
 
20

 
24,361






24,361

Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 



6,454

688


7,142

Cash and cash equivalents
 
25

 
21,916

2,270

1,400




25,586

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
22

 





(54,054
)
(54,054
)
Derivative financial instruments
 
30

 



(5,705
)
(864
)

(6,569
)
Accruals
 
 
 






(5,465
)
(5,465
)
Finance debt
 
26

 





(63,230
)
(63,230
)
 
 
 
 
47,113

2,978

1,400

1,411

(176
)
(122,749
)
(70,023
)
The fair value of finance debt is shown in Note 26. For all other financial instruments, the carrying amount is either the fair value, or approximates the fair value.
Information on gains and losses on derivative financial assets and financial liabilities classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss is provided in the derivative gains and losses section of Note 30. Fair value gains and losses related to other assets and liabilities classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss totalled a net loss of $78 million. Dividend income of $8 million from investments in equity instruments classified as measured at fair value through profit or loss is presented within other income - see Note 7.
Interest income and expenses arising on financial instruments are disclosed in Note 7.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
181


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
Financial risk factors
The group is exposed to a number of different financial risks arising from natural business exposures as well as its use of financial instruments including market risks relating to commodity prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates; credit risk; and liquidity risk.
The group financial risk committee (GFRC) advises the group chief financial officer (CFO) who oversees the management of these risks. The GFRC is chaired by the CFO and consists of a group of senior managers including the group treasurer and the heads of the group finance, tax and the integrated supply and trading functions. The purpose of the committee is to advise on financial risks and the appropriate financial risk governance framework for the group. The committee provides assurance to the CFO and the group chief executive (GCE), and via the GCE to the board, that the group’s financial risk-taking activity is governed by appropriate policies and procedures and that financial risks are identified, measured and managed in accordance with group policies and group risk appetite.
The group’s trading activities in the oil, natural gas, LNG and power markets are managed within the integrated supply and trading function. Treasury holds foreign exchange and interest-rate products in the financial markets to hedge group exposures related to debt issuance; the compliance, control, and risk management processes for these activities are managed within the treasury function. All other foreign exchange and interest rate activities within financial markets are performed within the integrated supply and trading function and are also underpinned by the compliance, control and risk management infrastructure common to the activities of BP’s integrated supply and trading function. All derivative activity is carried out by specialist teams that have the appropriate skills, experience and supervision. These teams are subject to close financial and management control.
The integrated supply and trading function maintains formal governance processes that provide oversight of market risk, credit risk and operational risk associated with trading activity. A policy and risk committee approves value-at-risk delegations, reviews incidents and validates risk-related policies, methodologies and procedures. A commitments committee approves the trading of new products, instruments and strategies and material commitments.
In addition, the integrated supply and trading function undertakes derivative activity for risk management purposes under a control framework as described more fully below.
(a) Market risk
Market risk is the risk or uncertainty arising from possible market price movements and their impact on the future performance of a business. The primary commodity price risks that the group is exposed to include oil, natural gas and power prices that could adversely affect the value of the group’s financial assets, liabilities or expected future cash flows. The group enters into derivatives in a well-established entrepreneurial trading operation. In addition, the group has developed a control framework aimed at managing the volatility inherent in certain of its natural business exposures. In accordance with the control framework the group enters into various transactions using derivatives for risk management purposes.
The major components of market risk are commodity price risk, foreign currency exchange risk and interest rate risk, each of which is discussed below.
(i) Commodity price risk
The group’s integrated supply and trading function uses conventional financial and commodity instruments and physical cargoes and pipeline positions available in the related commodity markets. Oil and natural gas swaps, options and futures are used to mitigate price risk. Power trading is undertaken using a combination of over-the-counter forward contracts and other derivative contracts, including options and futures. This activity is on both a standalone basis and in conjunction with gas derivatives in relation to gas-generated power margin. In addition, NGLs are traded around certain US inventory locations using over-the-counter forward contracts in conjunction with over-the-counter swaps, options and physical inventories.
The group measures market risk exposure arising from its trading positions in liquid periods using value-at-risk techniques. These techniques make a statistical assessment of the market risk arising from possible future changes in market prices over a one-day holding period. The value-at-risk measure is supplemented by stress testing. Trading activity occurring in liquid periods is subject to value-at-risk limits for each trading activity and for this trading activity in total. The board has delegated a limit of $100 million value at risk in support of this trading activity. Alternative measures are used to monitor exposures which are outside liquid periods and which cannot be actively risk-managed.
(ii) Foreign currency exchange risk
Since BP has global operations, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates can have a significant effect on the group’s reported results and future expenditure commitments. The effects of most exchange rate fluctuations are absorbed in business operating results through changing cost competitiveness, lags in market adjustment to movements in rates and translation differences accounted for on specific transactions. For this reason, the total effect of exchange rate fluctuations is not identifiable separately in the group’s reported results. The main underlying economic currency of the group’s cash flows is the US dollar. This is because BP’s major product, oil, is priced internationally in US dollars. BP’s foreign currency exchange management policy is to limit economic and material transactional exposures arising from currency movements against the US dollar. The group co-ordinates the handling of foreign currency exchange risks centrally, by netting off naturally-occurring opposite exposures wherever possible and then managing any material residual foreign currency exchange risks.
Most of the group’s borrowings are in US dollars or are hedged with respect to the US dollar. At 31 December 2018, the total foreign currency borrowings not swapped into US dollars amounted to $741 million (2017 $928 million).
The group manages the net residual foreign currency exposures by constantly reviewing the foreign currency economic value at risk and aims to manage such risk to keep the 12-month foreign currency value at risk below $400 million. At no point over the past three years did the value at risk exceed the maximum risk limit. A continuous assessment is made in respect to the group’s foreign currency exposures to capture hedging requirements.
During the year, hedge accounting was applied to foreign currency exposure to highly probable forecast capital expenditure commitments. The group fixes the US dollar cost of non-US dollar supplies by using currency forwards for the highly probable forecast capital expenditure; the exposures are in sterling, euro, Australian dollar, Norwegian krone and Korean won. At 31 December 2018 the most significant open contracts in place were for $434 million sterling (2017 $437 million sterling).
Where the group enters into foreign currency exchange contracts for entrepreneurial trading purposes the activity is controlled using trading value-at-risk techniques as explained in (i) commodity price risk above.    

182
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
(iii) Interest rate risk
BP is also exposed to interest rate risk from the possibility that changes in interest rates will affect future cash flows or the fair values of its financial instruments, principally finance debt. While the group issues debt in a variety of currencies based on market opportunities, it uses derivatives to swap the debt to a floating rate exposure, mainly to US dollar floating, but in certain defined circumstances maintains a US dollar fixed rate exposure for a proportion of debt. The proportion of floating rate debt net of interest rate swaps at 31 December 2018 was 72% of total finance debt outstanding (2017 70%). The weighted average interest rate on finance debt at 31 December 2018 was 4% (2017 3%) and the weighted average maturity of fixed rate debt was five years (2017 five years).
The group’s earnings are sensitive to changes in interest rates on the floating rate element of the group’s finance debt. If the interest rates applicable to floating rate instruments were to have changed by one percentage point on 1 January 2019, it is estimated that the group’s finance costs for 2019 would change by approximately $475 million (2017 $442 million).
(b) Credit risk
Credit risk is the risk that a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument will fail to perform or fail to pay amounts due causing financial loss to the group and arises from cash and cash equivalents, derivative financial instruments and deposits with financial institutions and principally from credit exposures to customers relating to outstanding receivables. Credit exposure also exists in relation to guarantees issued by group companies under which the outstanding exposure incremental to that recognized on the balance sheet at 31 December 2018 was $696 million (2017 $656 million) in respect of liabilities of joint ventures and associates and $432 million (2017 $382 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties.
The group has a credit policy, approved by the CFO that is designed to ensure that consistent processes are in place throughout the group to measure and control credit risk. Credit risk is considered as part of the risk-reward balance of doing business. On entering into any business contract the extent to which the arrangement exposes the group to credit risk is considered. Key requirements of the policy include segregation of credit approval authorities from any sales, marketing or trading teams authorized to incur credit risk; the establishment of credit systems and processes to ensure that all counterparty exposure is rated and that all counterparty exposure and limits can be monitored and reported; and the timely identification and reporting of any non-approved credit exposures and credit losses. While each segment is responsible for its own credit risk management and reporting consistent with group policy, the treasury function holds group-wide credit risk authority and oversight responsibility for exposure to banks and financial institutions.
For the purposes of financial reporting the group calculates expected loss allowances based on the maximum contractual period over which the group is exposed to credit risk. Since this is typically less than 12 months for the group's in-scope financial assets there is no significant difference between the measurement of 12-month and lifetime expected credit losses. The group has no significant financial guarantee liabilities measured on an expected loss basis. Financial assets are considered to be credit-impaired when there is reasonable and supportable evidence that one or more events that have a detrimental impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset have occurred. This includes observable data concerning significant financial difficulty of the counterparty; a breach of contract; concession being granted to the counterparty for economic or contractual reasons relating to the counterparty’s financial difficulty, that would not otherwise be considered; it becoming probable that the counterparty will enter bankruptcy or other financial re-organization or an active market for the financial asset disappearing because of financial difficulties. The group also applies a rebuttable presumption that an asset is credit-impaired when contractual payments are more than 30 days past due. Where the group has no reasonable expectation of recovering a financial asset in its entirety or a portion thereof for example where all legal avenues for collection of amounts due have been exhausted, the financial asset (or relevant portion) is written off.
The measurement of expected credit losses is a function of the probability of default, loss given default (i.e. the magnitude of the loss after recovery if there is a default) and the exposure at default (i.e. the asset's carrying amount). The group allocates a credit risk rating to exposures based on data that is determined to be predictive of the risk of loss, including but not limited to external ratings. Probabilities of default derived from historical, current and future-looking market data are assigned by credit risk rating with a loss given default based on historical experience and relevant market and academic research applied by exposure type. Experienced credit judgement is applied to ensure probabilities of default are reflective of the credit risk associated with the group's exposures. Credit enhancements that would reduce the group's credit losses in the event of default are reflected in the calculation when they are considered integral to the related asset.
The maximum credit exposure associated with financial assets is equal to the carrying amount. The group does not aim to remove credit risk entirely but expects to experience a certain level of credit losses. As at 31 December 2018, the group had in place credit enhancements designed to mitigate approximately $7.3 billion of credit risk, of which $6.7 billion relates to assets in the scope of IFRS 9's impairment requirements. Credit enhancements include standby and documentary letters of credit, bank guarantees, insurance and liens which are typically taken out with financial institutions who have investment grade credit ratings, or are liens over assets held by the counterparty of the related receivables. Reports are regularly prepared and presented to the GFRC that cover the group’s overall credit exposure and expected loss trends, exposure by segment, and overall quality of the portfolio.
Management information used to monitor credit risk, which reflects the impact of credit enhancements, indicates that the risk profile of financial assets which are subject to review for impairment under IFRS 9 is as set out below.
 
 
%

As at 31 December
 
2018

AAA to AA-
 
22
%
A+ to A-
 
41
%
BBB+ to BBB-
 
16
%
BB+ to BB-
 
8
%
B+ to B-
 
11
%
CCC+ and below
 
2
%
For the comparative period an analysis of the ageing of trade and other receivables reported under IAS 39 is provided.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
183


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
 
 
$ million

Trade and other receivables at 31 December
 
2017

Neither impaired nor past due
 
22,858

Impaired (net of provision)
 
53

Not impaired and past due in the following periods
 

within 30 days
 
637

31 to 60 days
 
130

61 to 90 days
 
114

over 90 days
 
569

 
 
24,361

Movements in the impairment provision for trade and other receivables are shown in Note 21.
Financial instruments subject to offsetting, enforceable master netting arrangements and similar agreements
The following table shows the amounts recognized for financial assets and liabilities which are subject to offsetting arrangements on a gross basis, and the amounts offset in the balance sheet.
Amounts which cannot be offset under IFRS, but which could be settled net under the terms of master netting agreements if certain conditions arise, and collateral received or pledged, are also presented in the table to show the total net exposure of the group.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Gross
amounts of
recognized
financial
assets
(liabilities)

Amounts
set off

Net amounts
presented on
the balance
sheet

Related amounts not set off
in the balance sheet
 
Net amount

At 31 December 2018
 
Master
netting
arrangements

Cash
collateral
(received)
pledged

Derivative assets
 
11,502

(2,511
)
8,991

(2,079
)
(299
)
6,613

Derivative liabilities
 
(11,337
)
2,511

(8,826
)
2,079


(6,747
)
Trade and other receivables
 
11,296

(5,390
)
5,906

(1,020
)
(169
)
4,717

Trade and other payables
 
(10,797
)
5,390

(5,407
)
1,020


(4,387
)
At 31 December 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
8,522

(1,380
)
7,142

(1,554
)
(321
)
5,267

Derivative liabilities
 
(7,818
)
1,380

(6,438
)
1,554


(4,884
)
Trade and other receivables
 
11,648

(5,311
)
6,337

(2,156
)
(114
)
4,067

Trade and other payables
 
(12,543
)
5,311

(7,232
)
2,156


(5,076
)
(c) Liquidity risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that suitable sources of funding for the group’s business activities may not be available. The group’s liquidity is managed centrally with operating units forecasting their cash and currency requirements to the central treasury function. Unless restricted by local regulations, generally subsidiaries pool their cash surpluses to the treasury function, which will then arrange to fund other subsidiaries’ requirements, or invest any net surplus in the market or arrange for necessary external borrowings, while managing the group’s overall net currency positions.
BP utilizes various arrangements in order to manage its working capital including discounting of receivables and, in the supply and trading business, the active management of supplier payment terms, inventory and collateral. In line with normal industry practice some supplier arrangements utilize letter of credit (LC) facilities. In certain of those arrangements BP’s payments are made to the provider of the LC rather than the supplier.
Standard & Poor’s Ratings long-term credit rating for BP is A- (stable outlook) and Moody’s Investors Service rating is A1 (stable outlook).
During 2018, $9 billion of long-term taxable bonds were issued with terms ranging from four to ten years. Commercial paper is issued at competitive rates to meet short-term borrowing requirements as and when needed.
As a further liquidity measure, the group continues to maintain suitable levels of cash and cash equivalents, amounting to $22.5 billion at 31 December 2018 (2017 $25.6 billion), primarily invested with highly rated banks or money market funds and readily accessible at immediate and short notice. At 31 December 2018, the group had substantial amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities available, consisting of $7,625 million of standby facilities, all of which is available to draw and repay up to the first half of 2022. These facilities are with 25 international banks, and borrowings under them would be at pre-agreed rates.
The group has committed LC facilities totalling $12,175 million with a number of banks, allowing LCs to be issued for a maximum 24-month duration. There were also uncommitted secured LC facilities in place at 31 December 2018 for $4,190 million, which are secured against inventories or receivables when utilized. The facilities only terminate by either party giving a stipulated termination notice to the other.
The amounts shown for finance debt in the table below include future minimum lease payments with respect to finance leases. The table also shows the timing of cash outflows relating to trade and other payables and accruals.

184
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


29. Financial instruments and financial risk factors – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
 
2017

 
 
Trade and
other
payablesa

Accruals

Finance
debt

Interest on finance debt

Trade and
other
payablesa

Accruals

Finance
debt

Interest on finance debt

Within one year
 
43,230

4,626

9,301

2,404

40,472

4,960

7,626

1,757

1 to 2 years
 
2,232

146

6,788

1,955

1,693

135

7,331

1,537

2 to 3 years
 
1,662

95

6,805

1,700

1,413

83

7,068

1,321

3 to 4 years
 
1,484

64

8,057

1,422

1,378

70

6,766

1,114

4 to 5 years
 
1,406

89

7,058

1,138

1,368

54

7,986

894

5 to 10 years
 
6,058

113

25,356

2,390

6,181

115

24,162

1,951

Over 10 years
 
5,001

68

1,243

320

6,125

48

2,089

390

 
 
61,073

5,201

64,608

11,329

58,630

5,465

63,028

8,964

a 2018 includes $18,360 million (2017 $18,918 million) in relation to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill.
The group manages liquidity risk associated with derivative contracts, other than derivative hedging instruments, based on the expected maturities of both derivative assets and liabilities as indicated in Note 30. Management does not currently anticipate any cash flows that could be of a significantly different amount or could occur earlier than the expected maturity analysis provided.
The table below shows the timing of cash outflows for derivative financial instruments entered into for the purpose of managing interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk associated with finance debt, whether or not hedge accounting is applied, based upon contractual payment dates. The amounts reflect the gross settlement amount where the pay leg of a derivative will be settled separately from the receive leg, as in the case of cross-currency swaps hedging non-US dollar finance debt. The swaps are with high investment-grade counterparties and therefore the settlement-day risk exposure is considered to be negligible. Not shown in the table are the gross settlement amounts (inflows) for the receive leg of derivatives that are settled separately from the pay leg, which amount to $22,453 million at 31 December 2018 (2017 $21,484 million) to be received on the same day as the related cash outflows. For further information on our derivative financial instruments, see Note 30.
 
 
 
$ million

Cash outflows for derivative financial instruments at 31 December
 
2018

2017

Within one year
 
1,700

1,505

1 to 2 years
 
1,678

1,700

2 to 3 years
 
2,384

1,678

3 to 4 years
 
2,838

2,384

4 to 5 years
 
2,906

2,838

5 to 10 years
 
11,475

11,238

Over 10 years
 
724

724

 
 
23,705

22,067


30. Derivative financial instruments
In the normal course of business the group enters into derivative financial instruments (derivatives) to manage its normal business exposures in relation to commodity prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates, including management of the balance between floating rate and fixed rate debt, consistent with risk management policies and objectives. An outline of the group’s financial risks and the objectives and policies pursued in relation to those risks is set out in Note 29. Additionally, the group has a well-established entrepreneurial trading operation that is undertaken in conjunction with these activities using a similar range of contracts.
For information on significant estimates and judgements made in relation to the valuation of derivatives see Derivative financial instruments within Note 1.
The fair values of derivative financial instruments at 31 December are set out below.
Exchange traded derivatives are valued using closing prices provided by the exchange as at the balance sheet date. These derivatives are categorized within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Exchange traded derivatives are typically considered settled through the (normally daily) payment or receipt of variation margin.
Over-the-counter (OTC) financial swaps and physical commodity sale and purchase contracts are generally valued using readily available information in the public markets and quotations provided by brokers and price index developers. These quotes are corroborated with market data and are categorized within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
In certain less liquid markets, or for longer-term contracts, forward prices are not as readily available. In these circumstances, OTC financial swaps and physical commodity sale and purchase contracts are valued using internally developed methodologies that consider historical relationships between various commodities, and that result in management’s best estimate of fair value. These contracts are categorized within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
Financial OTC and physical commodity options are valued using industry standard models that consider various assumptions, including quoted forward prices for commodities, time value, volatility factors, and contractual prices for the underlying instruments, as well as other relevant economic factors. The degree to which these inputs are observable in the forward markets determines whether the option is categorized within level 2 or level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
185


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
 
Fair value
asset

Fair value
liability

Fair value
asset

Fair value
liability

Derivatives held for trading
 
 
 
 
 
Currency derivatives
 
69

(898
)
237

(756
)
Oil price derivatives
 
2,361

(1,849
)
1,637

(1,281
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
4,787

(3,888
)
3,580

(2,844
)
Power price derivatives
 
1,240

(943
)
885

(693
)
Other derivatives
 
107


115


 
 
8,564

(7,578
)
6,454

(5,574
)
Embedded derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity price contracts
 



(16
)
Other embedded derivatives
 

(107
)

(115
)
 
 

(107
)

(131
)
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Currency forwards, futures and cylinders
 
5

(14
)
35

(35
)
Gas price futures
 
2




 
 
7

(14
)
35

(35
)
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Currency forwards, futures and swaps
 
158

(789
)
460

(523
)
Interest rate swaps
 
262

(445
)
193

(306
)
 
 
420

(1,234
)
653

(829
)
 
 
8,991

(8,933
)
7,142

(6,569
)
Of which – current
 
3,846

(3,308
)
3,032

(2,808
)
– non-current
 
5,145

(5,625
)
4,110

(3,761
)
Derivatives held for trading
The group maintains active trading positions in a variety of derivatives. The contracts may be entered into for risk management purposes, to satisfy supply requirements or for entrepreneurial trading. Certain contracts are classified as held for trading, regardless of their original business objective, and are recognized at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in the income statement. Trading activities are undertaken by using a range of contract types in combination to create incremental gains by arbitraging prices between markets, locations and time periods. The net of these exposures is monitored using market value-at-risk techniques as described in Note 29.
The following tables show further information on the fair value of derivatives and other financial instruments held for trading purposes.
Derivative assets held for trading have the following fair values and maturities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
48

12

9




69

Oil price derivatives
 
1,916

363

53

25

4


2,361

Natural gas price derivatives
 
1,333

708

542

452

352

1,400

4,787

Power price derivatives
 
540

276

158

79

55

132

1,240

Other derivatives
 




107


107

 
 
3,837

1,359

762

556

518

1,532

8,564

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
186

31

8

5

3

4

237

Oil price derivatives
 
1,280

177

99

66

14

1

1,637

Natural gas price derivatives
 
1,122

609

428

328

288

805

3,580

Power price derivatives
 
420

188

81

60

38

98

885

Other derivatives
 





115

115

 
 
3,008

1,005

616

459

343

1,023

6,454



186
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Derivative liabilities held for trading have the following fair values and maturities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
(299
)
(71
)
(256
)
(171
)
(3
)
(98
)
(898
)
Oil price derivatives
 
(1,560
)
(232
)
(43
)
(12
)
(2
)

(1,849
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
(1,030
)
(557
)
(391
)
(338
)
(285
)
(1,287
)
(3,888
)
Power price derivatives
 
(401
)
(213
)
(95
)
(54
)
(47
)
(133
)
(943
)
 
 
(3,290
)
(1,073
)
(785
)
(575
)
(337
)
(1,518
)
(7,578
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Currency derivatives
 
(92
)
(232
)
(66
)
(188
)
(99
)
(79
)
(756
)
Oil price derivatives
 
(1,120
)
(118
)
(33
)
(4
)
(6
)

(1,281
)
Natural gas price derivatives
 
(973
)
(410
)
(334
)
(224
)
(194
)
(709
)
(2,844
)
Power price derivatives
 
(337
)
(134
)
(63
)
(39
)
(29
)
(91
)
(693
)
 
 
(2,522
)
(894
)
(496
)
(455
)
(328
)
(879
)
(5,574
)
The following table shows the fair value of derivative assets and derivative liabilities held for trading, analysed by maturity period and by methodology of fair value estimation. This information is presented on a gross basis, that is, before netting by counterparty.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Fair value of derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
111

14

3




128

Level 2
 
5,000

1,362

504

262

120

72

7,320

Level 3
 
491

385

353

331

427

1,640

3,627

 
 
5,602

1,761

860

593

547

1,712

11,075

Less: netting by counterparty
 
(1,765
)
(402
)
(98
)
(37
)
(29
)
(180
)
(2,511
)
 
 
3,837

1,359

762

556

518

1,532

8,564

Fair value of derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 1
 
(156
)
(11
)
(2
)
(2
)


(171
)
Level 2
 
(4,562
)
(1,161
)
(576
)
(308
)
(67
)
(163
)
(6,837
)
Level 3
 
(337
)
(303
)
(305
)
(302
)
(299
)
(1,535
)
(3,081
)
 
 
(5,055
)
(1,475
)
(883
)
(612
)
(366
)
(1,698
)
(10,089
)
Less: netting by counterparty
 
1,765

402

98

37

29

180

2,511

 
 
(3,290
)
(1,073
)
(785
)
(575
)
(337
)
(1,518
)
(7,578
)
Net fair value
 
547

286

(23
)
(19
)
181

14

986

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Less than
1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

Over
5 years

Total

Fair value of derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 2
 
3,663

1,003

438

244

140

135

5,623

Level 3
 
386

258

231

226

211

899

2,211

 
 
4,049

1,261

669

470

351

1,034

7,834

Less: netting by counterparty
 
(1,041
)
(256
)
(53
)
(11
)
(8
)
(11
)
(1,380
)
 
 
3,008

1,005

616

459

343

1,023

6,454

Fair value of derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Level 2
 
(3,338
)
(953
)
(358
)
(289
)
(163
)
(166
)
(5,267
)
Level 3
 
(225
)
(197
)
(191
)
(177
)
(173
)
(724
)
(1,687
)
 
 
(3,563
)
(1,150
)
(549
)
(466
)
(336
)
(890
)
(6,954
)
Less: netting by counterparty
 
1,041

256

53

11

8

11

1,380

 
 
(2,522
)
(894
)
(496
)
(455
)
(328
)
(879
)
(5,574
)
Net fair value
 
486

111

120

4

15

144

880


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
187


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Level 3 derivatives
The following table shows the changes during the year in the net fair value of derivatives held for trading purposes within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Oil
price

Natural gas
price

Power
price

Other

Total

Fair value contracts at 1 January 2018
 
67

65

(226
)
115

21

Gains (losses) recognized in the income statement
 
58

(26
)
209

(8
)
233

Settlements
 
(107
)
(32
)
(97
)

(236
)
Transfers out of level 3
 
5

(20
)
(34
)

(49
)
Net fair value of contracts at 31 December 2018
 
23

(13
)
(148
)
107

(31
)
Deferred day-one gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
577

Derivative asset (liability)
 
 
 
 
 
546

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Oil
price

Natural gas
price

Power
price

Other

Total

Fair value contracts at 1 January 2017
 
68

145

(147
)
231

297

Gains (losses) recognized in the income statement
 
76

161

61

15

313

Settlements
 
(68
)
(35
)
(113
)
(131
)
(347
)
Transfers out of level 3
 
(9
)
(206
)
(27
)

(242
)
Net fair value of contracts at 31 December 2017
 
67

65

(226
)
115

21

Deferred day-one gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
503

Derivative asset (liability)
 
 
 
 
 
524

The amount recognized in the income statement for the year relating to level 3 held-for-trading derivatives still held at 31 December 2018 was a $123-million gain (2017 $234-million gain related to derivatives still held at 31 December 2017).
Derivative gains and losses
The group enters into derivative contracts including futures, options, swaps and certain forward sales and forward purchases contracts, relating to both currency and commodity trading activities. Gains or losses arise on contracts entered into for risk management purposes, optimization activity and entrepreneurial trading. They also arise on certain contracts that are for normal procurement or sales activity for the group but that are required to be fair valued under accounting standards. These gains and losses are included within sales and other operating revenues in the income statement. Also included within this line item are gains and losses on inventory held for trading purposes. The total amount relating to all these items (excluding gains and losses on realized physical derivative contracts that have been reflected gross in the income statement within sales and purchases) was a net gain of $2,504 million (2017 $1,983 million net gain and 2016 $1,435 million net gain). This number does not include gains and losses on realized physical derivative contracts that have been reflected gross in the income statement within sales and purchases or the change in value of transportation and storage contracts which are not recognized under IFRS, but does include the associated financially settled contracts. The net amounts for actual gains and losses relating to these derivative contracts and all related items therefore differ significantly from the amounts disclosed above.
The group also enters into derivative contracts including futures, options, swaps and certain forward sales and forward purchase contracts primarily relating to foreign currency risk management activities. Gains and losses on these contracts are included within production and manufacturing expenses in the income statement. The change in the unrealized value of these contracts was a net loss of $351 million (2017 $1,420 million net gain and 2016 $154 million net loss), however the gains and losses in each year are largely offset by opposing net foreign exchange differences on retranslation of the associated non-US dollar debt. The net amounts for actual gains and losses relating to these derivative contracts and all related items therefore differ significantly from the amounts disclosed above.
Cash flow hedges
(i) Foreign currency risk of highly probable forecast capital expenditure
At 31 December 2018, the group held currency forwards designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships of highly probable forecast non-US dollar capital expenditure. Note 29 outlines the group’s approach to foreign currency exchange risk management. When the highly probable forecast capital expenditure designated as a hedged item occurs, a non-financial asset is recognized and is presented within the fixed asset section of the balance sheet.
The group claims hedge accounting only for the spot value of the currency exposure in line with the strategy to fix the volatility in the spot exchange rate element. The fair value on the instrument attributable to forward points is taken immediately to the income statement.
The group applies hedge accounting where there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship is determined at inception and prospectively by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item. The group enters into hedging derivatives that match the currency and notional of the hedged items on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio is determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional designated on the forecast transaction. The group determines the extent to which it hedges highly probable forecast capital expenditures on a project by project basis.
The group has identified the following sources of ineffectiveness, which are not expected to be material:
counterparty's credit risk, the group mitigates counterparty credit risk by entering into derivative transactions with high credit quality counterparties; and
differences in settlement timing between the derivative and hedged items. The latter impacts the discount factor used in the calculation of the hedge ineffectiveness. The group mitigates differences in timing between the derivatives and hedged items by applying a rolling strategy and by hedging currency pairs from stable economies (i.e. sterling/US dollar, Euro/US dollar, Norwegian krone/US dollar, Korean won/US dollar). The group's cash flow hedge designations are highly effective as the sources of ineffectiveness identified are expected to result in minimal hedge ineffectiveness.
The group has not designated any net positions as hedged items in cash flow hedges of foreign currency risk.

188
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
(ii) Commodity price risk of highly probable forecast sales
At 31 December 2018, the group held Henry Hub NYMEX futures designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships of certain highly probable forecast future sales.
The group is exposed to the variability in the gas price, but only applies hedge accounting to the risk of Henry Hub price movements for a percentage of future gas sales from its BPX Energy business (previously known as US Lower 48 business). Hedge accounting may be applied to such sales for up to the following two calendar years.
The group applies hedge accounting in relation to these highly probable future sales where there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship is determined at inception and prospectively by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item. The group enters into hedging derivatives that match the notional amounts of the hedged items on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio is determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional amount designated on the forecast transaction.
The hedge is expected to be highly effective due to the price index of the hedging instruments matching the price index of the hedged item and the derivative assets or liabilities recognized in respect of exchange-traded instruments reflect the impact of daily margin payments and receipts.
The group has not designated any net positions as hedged items in cash flow hedges of commodity price risk.
The table below summarizes the change in the fair value of hedging instruments and the hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness in the period.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to calculate ineffectiveness

Change in fair value of hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness

Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in profit or (loss)

At 31 December 2018
 
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
(5
)
5


Commodity price risk
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast sales
 
(126
)
126



The table below summarizes the carrying amount and nominal amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships at 31 December 2018.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying amount of hedging instrument
 
Nominal amounts of hedging instruments
 
 
 
Assets

Liabilities

At 31 December 2018
 
$ million

$ million

$ million

mmBtu

Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange risk
 
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure
 
5

(14
)
386



Commodity price risk
 
 
 
 
 
Highly probable forecast sales
 
2


 
145

All hedging instruments are presented within derivative financial instruments on the group balance sheet.
Of the nominal amount of hedging instruments relating to highly probable forecast capital expenditure $304 million matures in 2019 and $82 million matures in 2020. All of the hedging instruments relating to highly probable forecast sales mature in 2019.
The table below summarizes the weighted average exchange rates and the weighted average sales price in relation to the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedge relationships at 31 December 2018.
 
 
Weighted average price/rate
 
At 31 December 2018
 
Forecast capital expenditure

Forecast sales

Sterling/US dollar
 
1.34



Euro/US dollar
 
1.14



Australian dollar/US dollar
 
0.72



Norwegian krone/US dollar
 
8.67



Korean won/US dollar
 
1,107.90



Henry Hub $/mmBtu
 
 
2.86






 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
189


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
Fair value hedges
At 31 December 2018, the group held interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swap contracts as fair value hedges of the interest rate risk and foreign currency risk arising from group fixed rate debt issuances. The interest rate swaps are used to convert US dollar denominated fixed rate borrowings into floating rate debt. The cross-currency interest rate swaps are used to convert sterling, euro, Swiss franc, Australian dollar, Canadian dollar and Norwegian krone denominated fixed rate borrowings into US dollar floating rate debt. The group manages all risks derived from debt issuance, such as credit risk, however, the group applies hedge accounting only to certain components of interest rate and foreign currency risk in order to minimize hedge ineffectiveness. Note 29 outlines the group’s approach to interest rate and foreign currency exchange risk management.
The interest rate and foreign currency exposures are identified and hedged on an instrument-by-instrument basis. For interest rate exposures, the group designates as a fair value hedge the benchmark interest rate component only. This is an observable and reliably measurable component of interest rate risk. For foreign currency exposures, the group excludes from the designation the foreign currency basis spread component implicit in the cross-currency interest rate swaps. This is separately calculated at hedge designation, is recognized in other comprehensive income over the life of the hedge and amortized to the income statement on a straight-line basis, in accordance with the group’s policy on costs of hedging.
The group applies hedge accounting where there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument. The existence of an economic relationship is determined initially by comparing the critical terms of the hedging instrument and those of the hedged item and it is prospectively assessed using linear regression analysis. The group issues fixed rate debt and enters into interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps with critical terms that match those of the debt and on a 1:1 hedge ratio basis. The hedge ratio is determined by comparing the notional amount of the derivative with the notional amount of the debt. The hedge relationship is designated for the full term and notional value of the debt. Both the hedging instrument and the hedged item are expected to be held to maturity.
The group has identified the following sources of ineffectiveness, which are not expected to be material:
derivative counterparty’s credit risk which is not offset by the hedged item. This risk is mitigated by entering into derivative transactions only with high credit quality counterparties; and
sensitivity to interest rate between the hedged item and the derivatives. This is driven by differences in payment frequencies between the instrument and the bond.
The table below summarizes the change in the fair value of hedging instruments and the hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness in the period.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to calculate ineffectiveness

Change in fair value of hedged item used to calculate ineffectiveness

Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in profit or (loss)

At 31 December 2018
 
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
(70
)
69

(1
)
Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
812

(809
)
3


The table below summarizes the carrying amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December 2018.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Carrying amount of hedging instrument
 
Nominal amounts of hedging instruments

At 31 December 2018
 
Assets

Liabilities

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
262

(445
)
24,513

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 
158

(789
)
16,580

All hedging instruments are presented within derivative financial instruments on the group balance sheet. Ineffectiveness arising on fair value hedges is included within the production and manufacturing expenses section of the income statement.
The table below summarizes the profile by tenor of the nominal amount of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December 2018. The weighted average floating interest rate of these interest rate swaps and cross-currency interest rate swaps was 3.04% and 4.07% respectively.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

At 31 December 2018
 
Less than 1 year

1-2 years

2-3 years

3-4 years

4-5 years

5-10 years

Over 10 years

Total

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 
2,694

2,324

2,597

4,923

1,700

10,275


24,513

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 

1,245

1,167

707

2,921

10,254

286

16,580






190
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


30. Derivative financial instruments – continued
The table below summarizes the carrying amount, and the accumulated fair value adjustments included within the carrying amount, of the hedged items designated in fair value hedge relationships at 31 December 2018.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Carrying amount of hedged item
 
Accumulated fair value adjustment included in the carrying amount of hedged items
 
At 31 December 2018
 
Assets

Liabilities

Assets

Liabilities

Discontinued hedges

Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate risk on finance debt
 

(24,747
)
175


(360
)
Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt
 

(16,883
)

(62
)

The hedged item for all fair value hedges is presented within finance debt on the group balance sheet.
Movement in reserves related to hedge accounting
The table below provides a reconciliation of the cash flow hedge and costs of hedging reserves on a pre-tax basis by risk category. The signage convention of this table is consistent with that presented in Note 32.
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Cash flow hedge reserve
 
Costs of hedging reserve

 
 
 
Highly probable forecast capital expenditure

Highly probable forecast sales

Purchase of equitya

Interest rate and foreign currency risk on finance debt

Total

At 31 December 2017
 
(10
)

(651
)

(661
)
Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9
 



(37
)
(37
)
At 1 January 2018
 
(10
)

(651
)
(37
)
(698
)
Recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flow hedges marked to market
 
(37
)
(126
)


(163
)
Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement - hedged item affected profit or loss
 

120



120

Costs of hedging marked to market
 



(244
)
(244
)
Costs of hedging reclassified to the income statement
 



58

58

 
 
(37
)
(6
)

(186
)
(229
)
Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet
 
26




26

At 31 December 2018
 
(21
)
(6
)
(651
)
(223
)
(901
)
a See Note 32 for further information on the cash flow hedge reserve relating to the purchase of equity
Substantially all of the cash flow hedge reserve balances and all of the amounts reclassified into profit or loss during the year relate to continuing hedge relationships. Amounts deferred in the cash flow hedge reserve that have been reclassified to profit or loss are presented in sales and other operating revenues in the income statement.
Costs of hedging relates to the foreign currency basis spreads of hedging instruments used to hedge the group's interest rate and foreign currency risk on debt which is a time-period related item.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
191


31. Called-up share capital
The allotted, called up and fully paid share capital at 31 December was as follows:
 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Issued
 
Shares
thousand

$ million

Shares
thousand

$ million

Shares
thousand

$ million

8% cumulative first preference shares of £1 eacha
 
7,233

12

7,233

12

7,233

12

9% cumulative second preference shares of £1 eacha
 
5,473

9

5,473

9

5,473

9

 
 
 
21

 
21

 
21

Ordinary shares of 25 cents each
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
21,288,193

5,322

21,049,696

5,263

20,108,771

5,028

Issue of new shares for the scrip dividend programme
 
195,305

49

289,789

72

548,005

137

Issue of new shares for employee share-based payment plans
 
92,168

23





Issue of new shares – otherb
 




392,920

98

Repurchase of ordinary share capital
 
(50,202
)
(13
)
(51,292
)
(13
)


At 31 December
 
21,525,464

5,381

21,288,193

5,322

21,049,696

5,263

 
 
 
5,402

 
5,343

 
5,284

a The nominal amount of 8% cumulative first preference shares and 9% cumulative second preference shares that can be in issue at any time shall not exceed £10,000,000 for each class of preference shares.
b 
2016 relates to the issue of new ordinary shares in consideration for a 10% interest in the Abu Dhabi onshore oil concession. See Note 32 for further information.

Voting on substantive resolutions tabled at a general meeting is on a poll. On a poll, shareholders present in person or by proxy have two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of the first and second preference shares held and one vote for every ordinary share held. On a show-of-hands vote on other resolutions (procedural matters) at a general meeting, shareholders present in person or by proxy have one vote each.
In the event of the winding up of the company, preference shareholders would be entitled to a sum equal to the capital paid up on the preference shares, plus an amount in respect of accrued and unpaid dividends and a premium equal to the higher of (i) 10% of the capital paid up on the preference shares and (ii) the excess of the average market price of such shares on the London Stock Exchange during the previous six months over par value.
During 2018 the company repurchased 50 million ordinary shares for a total consideration of $355 million, including transaction costs of $2 million, as part of the share repurchase programme announced on 31 October 2017. All shares purchased were for cancellation. The repurchased shares represented 0.2% of ordinary share capital.
Treasury sharesa 
 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
 
Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

Shares
thousand

Nominal value
$ million

At 1 January
 
1,482,072

370

1,614,657

403

1,756,327

439

Purchases for settlement of employee share plans
 
757


4,423

1

9,631

2

Issue of new shares for employee share-based payment plans
 
92,168

23





Shares re-issued for employee share-based payment plans
 
(148,732
)
(37
)
(137,008
)
(34
)
(151,301
)
(38
)
At 31 December
 
1,426,265

356

1,482,072

370

1,614,657

403

Of which – shares held in treasury by BP
 
1,264,732

316

1,472,343

368

1,576,411

394

– shares held in ESOP trusts
 
161,518

40

9,705

2

21,432

5

– shares held by BP’s US share plan administratorb
 
15


24


16,814

4

a 
See Note 32 for definition of treasury shares.
b 
Held in the form of ADSs to meet the requirements of employee share-based payment plans in the US.

For each year presented, the balance at 1 January represents the maximum number of shares held in treasury by BP during the year, representing 6.9% (2017 7.5% and 2016 8.6%) of the called-up ordinary share capital of the company.
During 2018, the movement in shares held in treasury by BP represented less than 1.0% (2017 less than 0.5% and 2016 less than 0.8%) of the ordinary share capital of the company.

192
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 



























THIS PAGE HAS BEEN LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
193


32. Capital and reserves
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share
capital

Share
premium
account

Capital
redemption
reserve

Merger
reserve

Total share capital
and capital
reserves

At 31 December 2017
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

Adjustment on adoption of IFRS 9, net of tax
 





At 1 January 2018
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges and costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
49

(49
)



Cash flow hedges transferred to the balance sheet, net of tax
 





Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 
(13
)

13



Share-based payments, net of taxb
 
23

207



230

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 





At 31 December 2018
 
5,402

12,305

1,439

27,206

46,352

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share
capital

Share
premium
account

Capital
redemption
reserve

Merger
reserve

Total share capital
and capital
reserves

At 1 January 2017
 
5,284

12,219

1,413

27,206

46,122

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 





Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
72

(72
)



Repurchases of ordinary share capital
 
(13
)

13



Share-based payments, net of taxb
 





Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of taxc
 





At 31 December 2017
 
5,343

12,147

1,426

27,206

46,122

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share
capital

Share
premium
account

Capital
redemption
reserve

Merger
reserve

Total share capital
and capital
reserves

At 1 January 2016
 
5,049

10,234

1,413

27,206

43,902

Profit (loss) for the year
 





Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)a
 





Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 





Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 





Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of taxa
 





Other
 





Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 





Total comprehensive income
 





Dividends
 
137

(137
)



Share-based payments, net of taxb d
 
98

2,122



2,220

Share of equity-accounted entities’ changes in equity, net of tax
 





Transactions involving non-controlling interests, net of tax
 





At 31 December 2016
 
5,284

12,219

1,413

27,206

46,122

a Principally foreign exchange effects relating to the Russian rouble.
b Movements in treasury shares relate to employee share-based payment plans.

194
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


32. Capital and reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

Treasury
shares

Foreign
currency
translation
reserve

Available-
for-sale
investments

Cash flow
hedges

Costs of hedging

Total
fair value
reserves

Profit and
loss
account

BP
shareholders’
equity

Non-
controlling
interests

Total equity

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
17

(760
)

(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404



(17
)

(37
)
(54
)
(126
)
(180
)

(180
)
(16,958
)
(5,156
)

(760
)
(37
)
(797
)
75,100

98,311

1,913

100,224







9,383

9,383

195

9,578

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

(3,746
)





(3,746
)
(41
)
(3,787
)



(6
)
(173
)
(179
)

(179
)

(179
)






417

417


417







7

7


7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






1,599

1,599


1,599




(37
)

(37
)

(37
)

(37
)

(3,746
)

(43
)
(173
)
(216
)
11,406

7,444

154

7,598







(6,699
)
(6,699
)
(170
)
(6,869
)



26


26


26


26







(355
)
(355
)

(355
)
1,191






(718
)
703


703







14

14


14









207

207

(15,767
)
(8,902
)

(777
)
(210
)
(987
)
78,748

99,444

2,104

101,548

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Treasury
shares

Foreign
currency
translation
reserve

Available-
for-sale
investments

Cash flow
hedges

Costs of hedging

Total
fair value
reserves

Profit and
loss
account

BP
shareholders’
equity

Non-
controlling
interests

Total equity

(18,443
)
(6,878
)
3

(1,156
)

(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843







3,389

3,389

79

3,468

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

1,722





(3
)
1,719

52

1,771



14



14


14


14




396


396


396


396







564

564


564







(72
)
(72
)

(72
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






2,343

2,343


2,343


1,722

14

396


410

6,221

8,353

131

8,484







(6,153
)
(6,153
)
(141
)
(6,294
)






(343
)
(343
)

(343
)
1,485






(798
)
687


687







215

215


215







446

446

366

812

(16,958
)
(5,156
)
17

(760
)

(743
)
75,226

98,491

1,913

100,404

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Treasury
shares

Foreign
currency
translation
reserve

Available-
for-sale
investments

Cash flow
hedges

Costs of hedging

Total
fair value
reserves

Profit and
loss
account

BP
shareholders’
equity

Non-
controlling
interests

Total equity

(19,964
)
(7,267
)
2

(825
)

(823
)
81,368

97,216

1,171

98,387







115

115

57

172






















389






389

(27
)
362



1



1


1


1




(331
)

(331
)

(331
)

(331
)






833

833


833







(96
)
(96
)

(96
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 






(1,757
)
(1,757
)

(1,757
)

389

1

(331
)

(330
)
(905
)
(846
)
30

(816
)






(4,611
)
(4,611
)
(107
)
(4,718
)
1,521






(750
)
2,991


2,991







106

106


106







430

430

463

893

(18,443
)
(6,878
)
3

(1,156
)

(1,153
)
75,638

95,286

1,557

96,843

c Principally relates to the initial public offering of common units in BP Midstream Partners LP for which net proceeds of $811 million were received.
d Includes ordinary shares issued to the government of Abu Dhabi in consideration for a 10% interest in the Abu Dhabi onshore oil concession. The share-based payment transaction was valued at the fair value of the interest in the assets, with reference to a market transaction for an identical interest.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
195


32. Capital and reserves – continued
Share capital
The balance on the share capital account represents the aggregate nominal value of all ordinary and preference shares in issue, including treasury shares.
Share premium account
The balance on the share premium account represents the amounts received in excess of the nominal value of the ordinary and preference shares.
Capital redemption reserve
The balance on the capital redemption reserve represents the aggregate nominal value of all the ordinary shares repurchased and cancelled.
Merger reserve
The balance on the merger reserve represents the fair value of the consideration given in excess of the nominal value of the ordinary shares issued in an acquisition made by the issue of shares.
Treasury shares
Treasury shares represent BP shares repurchased and available for specific and limited purposes. For accounting purposes shares held in Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) and BP’s US share plan administrator to meet the future requirements of the employee share-based payment plans are treated in the same manner as treasury shares and are, therefore, included in the financial statements as treasury shares. The ESOPs are funded by the group and have waived their rights to dividends in respect of such shares held for future awards. Until such time as the shares held by the ESOPs vest unconditionally to employees, the amount paid for those shares is shown as a reduction in shareholders’ equity. Assets and liabilities of the ESOPs are recognized as assets and liabilities of the group.
Foreign currency translation reserve
The foreign currency translation reserve records exchange differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations. Upon disposal of foreign operations, the related accumulated exchange differences are reclassified to the income statement.
Available-for-sale investments
This reserve recorded the changes in fair value of investments classified as available-for-sale under IAS 39 except for impairment losses, foreign exchange gains or losses, or changes arising from revised estimates of future cash flows. On adoption of IFRS 9 the balance in this reserve was transferred to the profit and loss account reserve. Under the new standard the group recognizes fair value gains and losses on these investments in profit or loss.
Cash flow hedges
This reserve records the portion of the gain or loss on a hedging instrument in a cash flow hedge that is determined to be an effective hedge. It includes $651 million relating to the acquisition of an 18.5% interest in Rosneft in 2013 which will only be reclassified to the income statement if the investment in Rosneft is either sold or impaired. For further information on the accounting for cash flow hedges see Note 1 - Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Costs of hedging
This reserve records the change in fair value of the foreign currency basis spread of financial instruments to which cost of hedge accounting has been applied. The accumulated amount relates to time-period related hedged items and is amortized to profit or loss over the term of the hedging relationship.
Prior to the group’s adoption of IFRS 9 changes in the fair value of such foreign currency basis spreads were recognized in profit or loss. On adoption of the new standard a transfer from the profit and loss account reserve to the costs of hedging reserve was made in order to reflect the opening reserves position for relevant hedging instruments existing on transition. For further information on the accounting for costs of hedging see Note 1 - Derivative financial instruments and hedging activities.
Profit and loss account
The balance held on this reserve is the accumulated retained profits of the group.

196
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


32. Capital and reserves – continued
The pre-tax amounts of each component of other comprehensive income, and the related amounts of tax, are shown in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
(3,771
)
(16
)
(3,787
)
Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
(6
)

(6
)
Costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 
(186
)
13

(173
)
Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
417


417

Other
 

7

7

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
2,317

(718
)
1,599

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 
(37
)

(37
)
Other comprehensive income
 
(1,266
)
(714
)
(1,980
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
1,866

(95
)
1,771

Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 
14


14

Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
425

(29
)
396

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
564


564

Other
 

(72
)
(72
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
3,646

(1,303
)
2,343

Other comprehensive income
 
6,515

(1,499
)
5,016

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Pre-tax

Tax

Net of tax

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences (including reclassifications)
 
284

78

362

Available-for-sale investments (including reclassifications)
 
1


1

Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 
(362
)
31

(331
)
Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 
833


833

Other
 

(96
)
(96
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 
(2,496
)
739

(1,757
)
Other comprehensive income
 
(1,740
)
752

(988
)

33. Contingent liabilities
Contingent liabilities related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
See Note 2 for information on contingent liabilities related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill.
Contingent liabilities not related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
There were contingent liabilities at 31 December 2018 in respect of guarantees and indemnities entered into as part of the ordinary course of the group’s business. No material losses are likely to arise from such contingent liabilities. Further information on financial guarantees is included in Note 29.
In the normal course of the group’s business, legal and regulatory proceedings are pending or may be brought against BP group entities arising out of current and past operations, including matters related to commercial disputes, product liability, antitrust, commodities trading, premises-liability claims, consumer protection, general health, safety and environmental claims and allegations of exposures of third parties to toxic substances, such as lead pigment in paint, asbestos and other chemicals. BP believes that the impact of these legal and regulatory proceedings on the group‘s results of operations, liquidity or financial position will not be material.
The group files tax returns in many jurisdictions throughout the world. Various tax authorities are currently examining the group’s tax returns. Tax returns contain matters that could be subject to differing interpretations of applicable tax laws and regulations including the tax deductibility of certain intercompany charges. The resolution of tax positions through negotiations with relevant tax authorities, or through litigation, can take several years to complete and the amounts could be significant and could be material to the group’s results of operations, financial position or liquidity. While it is difficult to predict the ultimate outcome in some cases, the group does not anticipate that there will be any material impact upon the group‘s results of operations, financial position or liquidity.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
197


33. Contingent liabilities – continued
The group is subject to numerous national and local health, safety and environmental laws and regulations concerning its products, operations and other activities. These laws and regulations may require the group to take future action to remediate the effects on the environment of prior disposal or release of chemicals or petroleum substances by the group or other parties. Such contingencies may exist for various sites including refineries, chemical plants, oil fields, commodities extraction sites, service stations, terminals and waste disposal sites. In addition, the group may have obligations relating to prior asset sales or closed facilities. The ultimate requirement for remediation and its cost are inherently difficult to estimate. However, the estimated cost of known environmental obligations has been provided in these accounts in accordance with the group‘s accounting policies. While the amounts of future costs that are not provided for could be significant and could be material to the group‘s results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, it is not possible to estimate the amounts involved. BP does not expect these costs to have a material impact on the group’s results of operations, financial position or liquidity.
If oil and natural gas production facilities and pipelines are sold to third parties and the subsequent owner is unable to meet their decommissioning obligations it is possible that, in certain circumstances, BP could be partially or wholly responsible for decommissioning. While the amounts associated with decommissioning provisions reverting to the group could be significant and could be material, BP is not currently aware of any such cases that have a greater than remote chance of reverting to the group. Furthermore, as described in Provisions and contingencies within Note 1, decommissioning provisions associated with downstream and petrochemical facilities are not generally recognized as the potential obligations cannot be measured given their indeterminate settlement dates.
See also Legal proceedings on pages 296-298.

34. Remuneration of senior management and non-executive directors
Remuneration of directors
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Total for all directors
 
 
 
 
Emoluments
 
8

9

10

Amounts received under incentive schemesa
 
16

9

14

Total
 
24

18

24

a Excludes amounts relating to past directors.
Emoluments
These amounts comprise fees paid to the non-executive chairman and the non-executive directors and, for executive directors, salary and benefits earned during the relevant financial year, plus cash bonuses awarded for the year.
Pension contributions
During 2018 one executive director participated in a UK final salary pension plan in respect of service prior to 1 April 2011. During 2018, one executive director participated in retirement savings plans established for US employees and in a US defined benefit pension plan in respect of service prior to 1 September 2016.
Further information
Full details of individual directors’ remuneration are given in the Directors’ remuneration report on page 87. See also Related-party transactions on page 300.
Remuneration of directors and senior management
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Total for all senior management and non-executive directors
 
 
 
 
Short-term employee benefits
 
25

29

28

Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
2

2

3

Share-based payments
 
32

29

39

Total
 
59

60

70

Senior management comprises members of the executive team, see pages 63-65 for further information.
Short-term employee benefits
These amounts comprise fees and benefits paid to the non-executive chairman and non-executive directors, as well as salary, benefits and cash bonuses for senior management. Deferred annual bonus awards, to be settled in shares, are included in share-based payments. Short term employee benefits includes compensation for loss of office of $nil in 2018 (2017 $nil and 2016 $2.2 million).
Pensions and other post-retirement benefits
The amounts represent the estimated cost to the group of providing pensions and other post-retirement benefits to senior management in respect of the current year of service measured in accordance with IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’.
Share-based payments
This is the cost to the group of senior management’s participation in share-based payment plans, as measured by the fair value of options and shares granted, accounted for in accordance with IFRS 2 ‘Share-based Payments’.


198
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


35. Employee costs and numbers
 
 
 
 
$ million

Employee costs
 
2018

2017

2016

Wages and salariesa
 
7,931

7,572

8,456

Social security costs
 
743

711

760

Share-based paymentsb
 
669

624

764

Pension and other post-retirement benefit costs
 
1,154

1,296

1,253

 
 
10,497

10,203

11,233


 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
2017

 
 
2016

Average number of employeesc
 
US

Non-US

Total

US

Non-US

Total

US

Non-US

Total

Upstream
 
5,900

11,500

17,400

6,200

12,200

18,400

6,700

13,500

20,200

Downstreamd e
 
6,000

36,300

42,300

6,100

35,900

42,000

6,600

36,600

43,200

Other businesses and corporatee f
 
1,900

12,100

14,000

1,900

12,400

14,300

1,900

12,100

14,000

 
 
13,800

59,900

73,700

14,200

60,500

74,700

15,200

62,200

77,400

a Includes termination costs of $493 million (2017 $189 million and 2016 $545 million).
b The group provides certain employees with shares and share options as part of their remuneration packages. The majority of these share-based payment arrangements are equity-settled.
c Reported to the nearest 100.
d Includes 17,100 (2017 16,500 and 2016 15,800) service station staff.
e Around 800 centralized function employees were reallocated from Upstream and Downstream to Other businesses and corporate during 2016.
f Includes 4,000 (2017 4,700 and 2016 4,900) agricultural, operational and seasonal workers in Brazil.

36. Auditor’s remuneration
 
 
 
 
$ million

Fees
 
2018

2017

2016

The audit of the company annual accountsa
 
25

26

25

The audit of accounts of subsidiaries of the company
 
10

11

12

Total audit
 
35

37

37

Audit-related assurance servicesb
 
4

7

7

Total audit and audit-related assurance services
 
39

44

44

Taxation compliance services
 


1

Non-audit and other assurance services
 
2

3

1

Total non-audit or non-audit-related assurance services
 
2

3

2

Services relating to BP pension plans
 
1


1

 
 
42

47

47

a Fees in respect of the audit of the accounts of BP p.l.c. including the group’s consolidated financial statements.
b Includes interim reviews and audit of internal control over financial reporting and non-statutory audit services.

With effect from 2018, following a competitive tender process, Deloitte LLP (Deloitte) was appointed as auditor of the Company, replacing Ernst & Young LLP (EY). In the table above, auditor’s remuneration for services provided during the year ended 31 December 2018 thus relates to Deloitte and for the years ended 31 December 2017 and 31 December 2016 to EY.
In addition to the amounts shown in the table above, in 2018 $0.75 million of additional fees were paid to EY in respect of their audit for 2017. Auditors’ remuneration is included in the income statement within distribution and administration expenses.
The tax services relate to income tax and indirect tax compliance, employee tax services and tax advisory services.
The audit committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for the engagement of Deloitte to render audit and certain assurance and other services. The audit fees payable to Deloitte were considered as part of the audit tender process in 2016 and challenged by the audit committee through comparison with the audit pricing proposals of the other bidding firms, before being approved. Deloitte performed further assurance services that were not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements and were pre-approved by the Committee. Deloitte is engaged for these services when its expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit-related or assurance nature.
Under SEC regulations, the remuneration of the auditor of $42 million (2017 $47 million and 2016 $47 million) is required to be presented as follows: audit $35 million (2017 $37 million and 2016 $37 million); other audit-related $4 million (2017 $7 million and 2016 $7 million); tax $nil (2017 $nil and 2016 $1 million); and all other fees $3 million (2017 $3 million and 2016 $2 million).


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
199


37. Subsidiaries, joint arrangements and associates
The more important subsidiaries and associates of the group at 31 December 2018 and the group percentage of ordinary share capital (to nearest whole number) are set out below. There are no individually significant incorporated joint arrangements. The group's share of the assets and liabilities of the more important unincorporated joint arrangements are held by subsidiaries listed in the table below. Those subsidiaries held directly by the parent company are marked with an asterisk (*), the percentage owned being that of the group unless otherwise indicated. A complete list of undertakings of the group is included in Note 14 in the parent company financial statements of BP p.l.c. which are filed with the Registrar of Companies in the UK, along with the group’s annual report.
Subsidiaries
 
%
Country of
incorporation
 
Principal activities
International
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Corporate Holdings
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
 BP Exploration Operating Company
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
*BP Global Investments
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
*BP International
 
100
England & Wales
 
Integrated oil operations
 BP Oil International
 
100
England & Wales
 
Integrated oil operations
*Burmah Castrol
 
100
Scotland
 
Lubricants
Angola
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Angola)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Azerbaijan
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Caspian Sea)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
 BP Exploration (Azerbaijan)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Canada
 
 
 
 
 
*BP Holdings Canada
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
Egypt
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Delta)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Germany
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Europa SE
 
100
Germany
 
Refining and marketing
India
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Exploration (Alpha)
 
100
England & Wales
 
Exploration and production
Trinidad & Tobago
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Trinidad and Tobago
 
70
US
 
Exploration and production
UK
 
 
 
 
 
 BP Capital Markets
 
100
England & Wales
 
Finance
US
 
 
 
 
 
*BP Holdings North America
 
100
England & Wales
 
Investment holding
 Atlantic Richfield Company
 
100
US
 
Exploration and production, refining and marketing
 BP America
 
100
US
 
 BP America Production Company
 
100
US
 
 BP Company North America
 
100
US
 
 BP Corporation North America
 
100
US
 
 BP Exploration (Alaska)
 
100
US
 
 BP Products North America
 
100
US
 
 Standard Oil Company
 
100
US
 
 BP Capital Markets America
 
100
US
 
Finance
 
 
 
 
 
 
Associates
 
%
Country of
incorporation
 
Principal activities
Russia
 
 
 
 
 
 Rosneft Oil Company
 
19.75
Russia
 
Integrated oil operations


200
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries
BP p.l.c. fully and unconditionally guarantees the payment obligations of its 100%-owned subsidiary BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. under the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust. The following financial information for BP p.l.c., BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and all other subsidiaries on a condensed consolidating basis is intended to provide investors with meaningful and comparable financial information about BP p.l.c. and its subsidiary issuers of registered securities and is provided pursuant to Rule 3-10 of Regulation S-X in lieu of the separate financial statements of each subsidiary issuer of public debt securities. Non-current assets for BP p.l.c. includes investments in subsidiaries recorded under the equity method for the purposes of the condensed consolidating financial information. Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries is the group’s share of profit related to such investments. The eliminations and reclassifications column includes the necessary amounts to eliminate the intercompany balances and transactions between BP p.l.c., BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. and other subsidiaries. The financial information presented in the following tables for BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. incorporates subsidiaries of BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. using the equity method of accounting and excludes the BP group’s midstream operations in Alaska that are reported through different legal entities and that are included within the ‘other subsidiaries’ column in these tables. BP p.l.c. also fully and unconditionally guarantees securities issued by BP Capital Markets p.l.c. and BP Capital Markets America Inc. These companies are 100%-owned finance subsidiaries of BP p.l.c.
Income statement
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
4,315


298,620

(4,179
)
298,756

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


897


897

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


2,856


2,856

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

10,942


(10,942
)

Interest and other income
 
42

373

2,081

(1,723
)
773

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


456


456

Total revenues and other income
 
4,357

11,315

304,910

(16,844
)
303,738

Purchases
 
1,507


232,550

(4,179
)
229,878

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
1,015


21,990


23,005

Production and similar taxes
 
282


1,254


1,536

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
377


15,080


15,457

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
66


794


860

Exploration expense
 


1,445


1,445

Distribution and administration expenses
 
22

642

11,673

(158
)
12,179

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
1,088

10,673

20,124

(12,507
)
19,378

Finance costs
 
8

1,326

2,759

(1,565
)
2,528

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(95
)
222


127

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
1,080

9,442

17,143

(10,942
)
16,723

Taxation
 
164

59

6,922


7,145

Profit (loss) for the year
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578

Attributable to
 





BP shareholders
 
916

9,383

10,026

(10,942
)
9,383

Non-controlling interests
 


195


195

 
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578


















 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
201


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Statement of comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
916

9,383

10,221

(10,942
)
9,578

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

(296
)
(3,475
)

(3,771
)
Cash flow hedges (including reclassifications)
 


(6
)

(6
)
Costs of hedging (including reclassifications)
 


(186
)

(186
)
Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


417


417

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


4


4

 
 

(296
)
(3,246
)

(3,542
)
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

1,689

628


2,317

Cash flow hedges that will subsequently be transferred to the balance sheet
 


(37
)

(37
)
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

(511
)
(207
)

(718
)
 
 

1,178

384


1,562

Other comprehensive income
 

882

(2,862
)

(1,980
)
Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

(2,821
)

2,821


Total comprehensive income
 
916

7,444

7,359

(8,121
)
7,598

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
  BP shareholders
 
916

7,444

7,205

(8,121
)
7,444

  Non-controlling interests
 


154


154

 
 
916

7,444

7,359

(8,121
)
7,598

Income statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
3,264


240,177

(3,233
)
240,208

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


1,177


1,177

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


1,330


1,330

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

4,436


(4,436
)

Interest and other income
 
11

369

1,470

(1,193
)
657

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
71

9

1,139

(9
)
1,210

Total revenues and other income
 
3,346

4,814

245,293

(8,871
)
244,582

Purchases
 
1,010


181,939

(3,233
)
179,716

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
1,156


23,073


24,229

Production and similar taxesa
 
(18
)

1,793


1,775

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
735


14,849


15,584

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


1,216


1,216

Exploration expense
 


2,080


2,080

Distribution and administration expenses
 
19

616

10,022

(149
)
10,508

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
444

4,198

10,321

(5,489
)
9,474

Finance costs
 
6

826

2,286

(1,044
)
2,074

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(15
)
235


220

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
438

3,387

7,800

(4,445
)
7,180

Taxation
 
(392
)
(11
)
4,115


3,712

Profit (loss) for the year
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
830

3,398

3,606

(4,445
)
3,389

Non-controlling interests
 


79


79

 
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

a Includes revised non-cash provision adjustments; actual cash payments for Production and similar taxes remain in line with prior year.

202
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Statement of comprehensive income continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
830

3,398

3,685

(4,445
)
3,468

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

166

1,820


1,986

Exchange (gains) losses on translation of foreign operations transferred to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


(120
)

(120
)
Available-for-sale investments marked to market
 


14


14

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 


197


197

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement
 


116


116

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the balance sheet
 


112


112

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


564


564

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


(196
)

(196
)
 
 

166

2,507


2,673

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 










Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

2,984

662


3,646

Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

(1,169
)
(134
)

(1,303
)
 
 

1,815

528


2,343

Other comprehensive income
 

1,981

3,035


5,016

Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

2,983


(2,983
)

Total comprehensive income
 
830

8,362

6,720

(7,428
)
8,484

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
830

8,362

6,589

(7,428
)
8,353

Non-controlling interests
 


131


131

 
 
830

8,362

6,720

(7,428
)
8,484

Income statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Sales and other operating revenues
 
2,740


182,999

(2,731
)
183,008

Earnings from joint ventures - after interest and tax
 


966


966

Earnings from associates - after interest and tax
 


994


994

Equity-accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

862


(862
)

Interest and other income
 
94

343

899

(830
)
506

Gains on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


1,132


1,132

Total revenues and other income
 
2,834

1,205

186,990

(4,423
)
186,606

Purchases
 
888


134,062

(2,731
)
132,219

Production and manufacturing expenses
 
1,171


27,906


29,077

Production and similar taxes
 
102


581


683

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
673


13,832


14,505

Impairment and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(147
)

(1,517
)

(1,664
)
Exploration expense
 


1,721


1,721

Distribution and administration expenses
 

808

9,797

(110
)
10,495

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
147

397

608

(1,582
)
(430
)
Finance costs
 
103

311

1,981

(720
)
1,675

Net finance (income) expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(82
)
272


190

Profit (loss) before taxation
 
44

168

(1,645
)
(862
)
(2,295
)
Taxation
 
(41
)
53

(2,479
)

(2,467
)
Profit (loss) for the year
 
85

115

834

(862
)
172

Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
85

115

777

(862
)
115

Non-controlling interests
 


57


57

 
 
85

115

834

(862
)
172


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
203


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Statement of comprehensive income continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Profit (loss) for the year
 
85

115

834

(862
)
172

Other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation differences
 

(236
)
490


254

Exchange (gains) losses on translation of foreign operations transferred to gain or loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 


30


30

Available-for-sale investments marked to market
 


1


1

Cash flow hedges marked to market
 


(639
)

(639
)
Cash flow hedges reclassified to the income statement
 


196


196

Cash flow hedges reclassified to the balance sheet
 


81


81

Share of items relating to equity-accounted entities, net of tax
 


833


833

Income tax relating to items that may be reclassified
 


13


13

 
 

(236
)
1,005


769

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
Remeasurements of the net pension and other post-retirement benefit liability or asset
 

(2,019
)
(477
)

(2,496
)
Income tax relating to items that will not be reclassified
 

750

(11
)

739

 
 

(1,269
)
(488
)

(1,757
)
Other comprehensive income
 

(1,505
)
517


(988
)
Equity-accounted other comprehensive income of subsidiaries
 

544


(544
)

Total comprehensive income
 
85

(846
)
1,351

(1,406
)
(816
)
Attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
85

(846
)
1,321

(1,406
)
(846
)
Non-controlling interests
 


30


30

 
 
85

(846
)
1,351

(1,406
)
(816
)

204
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Balance sheet
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
4,445


130,816


135,261

Goodwill
 


12,204


12,204

Intangible assets
 
598


16,686


17,284

Investments in joint ventures
 


8,647


8,647

Investments in associates
 

2

17,671


17,673

Other investments
 


1,341


1,341

Subsidiaries - equity-accounted basis
 

166,311


(166,311
)

Fixed assets
 
5,043

166,313

187,365

(166,311
)
192,410

Loans
 


32,402

(31,765
)
637

Trade and other receivables
 

2,600

1,834

(2,600
)
1,834

Derivative financial instruments
 


5,145


5,145

Prepayments
 


1,179


1,179

Deferred tax assets
 


3,706


3,706

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 

5,473

482


5,955

 
 
5,043

174,386

232,113

(200,676
)
210,866

Current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 


326


326

Inventories
 
302


17,686


17,988

Trade and other receivables
 
2,536

151

38,931

(17,140
)
24,478

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,846


3,846

Prepayments
 
7


956


963

Current tax receivable
 


1,019


1,019

Other investments
 


222


222

Cash and cash equivalents
 

13

22,455


22,468

 
 
2,845

164

85,441

(17,140
)
71,310

Total assets
 
7,888

174,550

317,554

(217,816
)
282,176

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payables
 
413

14,634

48,358

(17,140
)
46,265

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,308


3,308

Accruals
 
89

31

4,506


4,626

Finance debt
 


9,373


9,373

Current tax payable
 
310


1,791


2,101

Provisions
 
1


2,563


2,564

 
 
813

14,665

69,899

(17,140
)
68,237

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other payables
 

31,800

16,395

(34,365
)
13,830

Derivative financial instruments
 


5,625


5,625

Accruals
 


575


575

Finance debt
 


56,426


56,426

Deferred tax liabilities
 
586

1,907

7,319


9,812

Provisions
 
670


17,062


17,732

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 

184

8,207


8,391

 
 
1,256

33,891

111,609

(34,365
)
112,391

Total liabilities
 
2,069

48,556

181,508

(51,505
)
180,628

Net assets
 
5,819

125,994

136,046

(166,311
)
101,548

Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
5,819

125,994

133,942

(166,311
)
99,444

Non-controlling interests
 


2,104


2,104

 
 
5,819

125,994

136,046

(166,311
)
101,548


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
205


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Balance sheet continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Non-current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
 
6,973


122,498


129,471

Goodwill
 


11,551


11,551

Intangible assets
 
585


17,770


18,355

Investments in joint ventures
 


7,994


7,994

Investments in associates
 

2

16,989


16,991

Other investments
 


1,245


1,245

Subsidiaries - equity-accounted basis
 

161,840


(161,840
)

Fixed assets
 
7,558

161,842

178,047

(161,840
)
185,607

Loans
 
1


32,401

(31,756
)
646

Trade and other receivables
 

2,623

1,434

(2,623
)
1,434

Derivative financial instruments
 


4,110


4,110

Prepayments
 


1,112


1,112

Deferred tax assets
 


4,469


4,469

Defined benefit pension plan surpluses
 

3,838

331


4,169

 
 
7,559

168,303

221,904

(196,219
)
201,547

Current assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 


190


190

Inventories
 
274


18,737


19,011

Trade and other receivables
 
2,206

293

34,991

(12,641
)
24,849

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,032


3,032

Prepayments
 
2


1,412


1,414

Current tax receivable
 


761


761

Other investments
 


125


125

Cash and cash equivalents
 

10

25,576


25,586

 
 
2,482

303

84,824

(12,641
)
74,968

Total assets
 
10,041

168,606

306,728

(208,860
)
276,515

Current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trade and other payablesa
 
673

10,143

46,034

(12,641
)
44,209

Derivative financial instruments
 


2,808


2,808

Accruals
 
115

60

4,785


4,960

Finance debt
 


7,739


7,739

Current tax payable
 


1,686


1,686

Provisions
 
1


3,323


3,324

 
 
789

10,203

66,375

(12,641
)
64,726

Non-current liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other payablesa
 

31,804

16,464

(34,379
)
13,889

Derivative financial instruments
 


3,761


3,761

Accruals
 


505


505

Finance debt
 


55,491


55,491

Deferred tax liabilities
 
838

1,337

5,807


7,982

Provisions
 
1,222


19,398


20,620

Defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan deficits
 

221

8,916


9,137

 
 
2,060

33,362

110,342

(34,379
)
111,385

Total liabilities
 
2,849

43,565

176,717

(47,020
)
176,111

Net assets
 
7,192

125,041

130,011

(161,840
)
100,404

Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders’ equity
 
7,192

125,041

128,098

(161,840
)
98,491

Non-controlling interests
 


1,913


1,913

 
 
7,192

125,041

130,011

(161,840
)
100,404

a 
For BP plc, an amount of $2,300 million has been reclassified from non-current other payables to current trade and other payables, with consequential amendments to the eliminations and reclassifications column.

206
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
1,080

9,442

17,143

(10,942
)
16,723

Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


1,085


1,085

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
377


15,080


15,457

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
66


338


404

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(3,753
)

(3,753
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,535


1,535

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(10,942
)

10,942


Dividends received from subsidiaries
 

3,490


(3,490
)

Interest receivable
 
(42
)
(215
)
(1,776
)
1,565

(468
)
Interest received
 
42

215

1,656

(1,565
)
348

Finance costs
 
8

1,326

2,759

(1,565
)
2,528

Interest paid
 
(8
)
(1,326
)
(2,159
)
1,565

(1,928
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(95
)
222


127

Share-based payments
 

671

19


690

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(183
)
(203
)

(386
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
33


953


986

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(62
)

734


672

(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
(72
)
165

(951
)
(2,000
)
(2,858
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(491
)
4,509

(6,595
)

(2,577
)
Income taxes paid
 
(133
)

(5,579
)

(5,712
)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
 
798

7,057

20,508

(5,490
)
22,873

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(273
)

(16,434
)

(16,707
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(6,986
)

(6,986
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(382
)

(382
)
Investment in associates
 


(1,013
)

(1,013
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(273
)

(24,815
)

(25,088
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 


940


940

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 
1,475


436


1,911

Proceeds from loan repayments
 


666


666

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
1,202


(22,773
)

(21,571
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of shares
 

(355
)


(355
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


9,038


9,038

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(7,210
)

(7,210
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


1,317


1,317

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 
(2,000
)
(6,699
)
(3,490
)
5,490

(6,699
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(170
)

(170
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 
(2,000
)
(7,054
)
(515
)
5,490

(4,079
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


(330
)

(330
)
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

3

(3,110
)

(3,107
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 

10

25,565


25,575

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 

13

22,455


22,468


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
207


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
438

3,387

7,800

(4,445
)
7,180

Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


1,603


1,603

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
735


14,849


15,584

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(71
)
(9
)
77

9

6

Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(2,507
)

(2,507
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,253


1,253

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(4,436
)

4,436


Dividends received from subsidiaries
 

3,183


(3,183
)

Interest receivable
 
(11
)
(220
)
(1,117
)
1,044

(304
)
Interest received
 
11

220

1,188

(1,044
)
375

Finance costs
 
6

826

2,286

(1,044
)
2,074

Interest paid
 
(6
)
(826
)
(1,784
)
1,044

(1,572
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(15
)
235


220

Share-based payments
 

595

66


661

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(145
)
(249
)

(394
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
(128
)

2,234


2,106

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(25
)

(823
)

(848
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
108

522

(5,478
)

(4,848
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(830
)
3,374

(200
)

2,344

Income taxes paid
 


(4,002
)

(4,002
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
227

6,456

15,431

(3,183
)
18,931

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(321
)

(16,241
)

(16,562
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(327
)

(327
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(50
)

(50
)
Investment in associates
 


(901
)

(901
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(321
)

(17,519
)

(17,840
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 
94


2,842


2,936

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 


478


478

Proceeds from loan repayments
 


349


349

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
(227
)

(13,850
)

(14,077
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net issue (repurchase) of shares
 

(343
)


(343
)
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


8,712


8,712

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(6,276
)

(6,276
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


(158
)

(158
)
Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 


1,063


1,063

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 

(6,153
)
(3,183
)
3,183

(6,153
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(141
)

(141
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 

(6,496
)
17

3,183

(3,296
)
Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


544


544

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

(40
)
2,142


2,102

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 

50

23,434


23,484

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 

10

25,576


25,586


208
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


38. Condensed consolidating information on certain US subsidiaries – continued
Cash flow statement continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Issuer

Guarantor

 
 
 
 
 
BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc.

BP p.l.c.

Other subsidiaries

Eliminations and reclassifications

BP group

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) before taxation
 
44

168

(1,645
)
(862
)
(2,295
)
Adjustments to reconcile profit (loss) before taxation to net cash provided by operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploration expenditure written off
 


1,274


1,274

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
673


13,832


14,505

Impairment and (gain) loss on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(148
)

(2,648
)

(2,796
)
Earnings from joint ventures and associates
 


(1,960
)

(1,960
)
Dividends received from joint ventures and associates
 


1,105


1,105

Equity accounted income of subsidiaries - after interest and tax
 

(862
)

862


Dividends received from (paid to) subsidiaries
 
(7,000
)
372


6,628


Interest receivable
 
(94
)
(233
)
(593
)
720

(200
)
Interest received
 
94

233

660

(720
)
267

Finance costs
 
103

311

1,981

(720
)
1,675

Interest paid
 
(103
)
(311
)
(1,443
)
720

(1,137
)
Net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 

(82
)
272


190

Share-based payments
 

780

(1
)

779

Net operating charge for pensions and other post-retirement benefits, less contributions and benefit payments for unfunded plans
 

(192
)
(275
)

(467
)
Net charge for provisions, less payments
 
77


4,410


4,487

(Increase) decrease in inventories
 
(3
)

(3,678
)

(3,681
)
(Increase) decrease in other current and non-current assets
 
6,985

(156
)
(1,001
)
(7,000
)
(1,172
)
Increase (decrease) in other current and non-current liabilities
 
(33
)
4,634

(2,946
)

1,655

Income taxes paid
 
104

(1
)
(1,641
)

(1,538
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
 
699

4,661

5,703

(372
)
10,691

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expenditure on property, plant and equipment, intangible and other assets
 
(699
)

(16,002
)

(16,701
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 


(1
)

(1
)
Investment in joint ventures
 


(50
)

(50
)
Investment in associates
 


(700
)

(700
)
Total cash capital expenditure
 
(699
)

(16,753
)

(17,452
)
Proceeds from disposals of fixed assets
 


1,372


1,372

Proceeds from disposals of businesses, net of cash disposed
 


1,259


1,259

Proceeds from loan repayments
 


68


68

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
 
(699
)

(14,054
)

(14,753
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from long-term financing
 


12,442


12,442

Repayments of long-term financing
 


(6,685
)

(6,685
)
Net increase (decrease) in short-term debt
 


51


51

Net increase (decrease) in non-controlling interests
 


887


887

Dividends paid
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP shareholders
 

(4,611
)
(372
)
372

(4,611
)
Non-controlling interests
 


(107
)

(107
)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
 

(4,611
)
6,216

372

1,977

Currency translation differences relating to cash and cash equivalents
 


(820
)

(820
)
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
 

50

(2,955
)

(2,905
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
 


26,389


26,389

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
 

50

23,434


23,484




 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
209


Supplementary information on oil and natural gas (unaudited)
The regional analysis presented below is on a continent basis, with separate disclosure for countries that contain 15% or more of the total proved reserves (for subsidiaries plus equity-accounted entities), in accordance with SEC and FASB requirements.
Oil and gas reserves – certain definitions
Unless the context indicates otherwise, the following terms have the meanings shown below:
Proved oil and gas reserves
Proved oil and gas reserves are those quantities of oil and gas, which, by analysis of geoscience and engineering data, can be estimated with reasonable certainty to be economically producible – from a given date forward, from known reservoirs, and under existing economic conditions, operating methods, and government regulations – prior to the time at which contracts providing the right to operate expire, unless evidence indicates that renewal is reasonably certain, regardless of whether deterministic or probabilistic methods are used for the estimation. The project to extract the hydrocarbons must have commenced or the operator must be reasonably certain that it will commence the project within a reasonable time.
(i)
The area of the reservoir considered as proved includes:
(A) The area identified by drilling and limited by fluid contacts, if any; and
(B) Adjacent undrilled portions of the reservoir that can, with reasonable certainty, be judged to be continuous with it and to contain economically producible oil or gas on the basis of available geoscience and engineering data.
(ii)
In the absence of data on fluid contacts, proved quantities in a reservoir are limited by the lowest known hydrocarbons (LKH) as seen in a well penetration unless geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establishes a lower contact with reasonable certainty.
(iii)
Where direct observation from well penetrations has defined a highest known oil (HKO) elevation and the potential exists for an associated gas cap, proved oil reserves may be assigned in the structurally higher portions of the reservoir only if geoscience, engineering, or performance data and reliable technology establish the higher contact with reasonable certainty.
(iv)
Reserves which can be produced economically through application of improved recovery techniques (including, but not limited to, fluid injection) are included in the proved classification when:
(A) Successful testing by a pilot project in an area of the reservoir with properties no more favourable than in the reservoir as a whole, the operation of an installed programme in the reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or other evidence using reliable technology establishes the reasonable certainty of the engineering analysis on which the project or programme was based; and
(B) The project has been approved for development by all necessary parties and entities, including governmental entities.
(v)
Existing economic conditions include prices and costs at which economic producibility from a reservoir is to be determined. The price shall be the average price during the 12-month period prior to the ending date of the period covered by the report, determined as an unweighted arithmetic average of the first-day-of-the-month price for each month within such period, unless prices are defined by contractual arrangements, excluding escalations based upon future conditions.
Undeveloped oil and gas reserves
Undeveloped oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that are expected to be recovered from new wells on undrilled acreage, or from existing wells where a relatively major expenditure is required for recompletion.
(i)
Reserves on undrilled acreage shall be limited to those directly offsetting development spacing areas that are reasonably certain of production when drilled, unless evidence using reliable technology exists that establishes reasonable certainty of economic producibility at greater distances.
(ii)
Undrilled locations can be classified as having undeveloped reserves only if a development plan has been adopted indicating that they are scheduled to be drilled within five years, unless the specific circumstances, justify a longer time.
(iii)
Under no circumstances shall estimates for undeveloped reserves be attributable to any acreage for which an application of fluid injection or other improved recovery technique is contemplated, unless such techniques have been proved effective by actual projects in the same reservoir or an analogous reservoir, or by other evidence using reliable technology establishing reasonable certainty.
Developed oil and gas reserves
Developed oil and gas reserves are reserves of any category that can be expected to be recovered:
(i)
Through existing wells with existing equipment and operating methods or in which the cost of the required equipment is relatively minor compared to the cost of a new well; and
(ii)
Through installed extraction equipment and infrastructure operational at the time of the reserves estimate if the extraction is by means not involving a well.
For details on BP’s proved reserves and production compliance and governance processes, see pages 285-290.


210
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe
US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
29,730


89,069

3,385

14,269

51,980


38,315

6,119

232,867

Unproved properties
 
451


3,602

2,667

2,742

3,870


3,153

568

17,053

 
 
30,181


92,671

6,052

17,011

55,850


41,468

6,687

249,920

Accumulated depreciation
 
16,809


47,051

420

8,517

38,324


20,173

3,626

134,920

Net capitalized costs
 
13,372


45,620

5,632

8,494

17,526


21,295

3,061

115,000

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of properties
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 
1,933


10,650



(1
)

36


12,618

Unproved
 


35


100

50


(5
)

180

 
 
1,933


10,685


100

49


31


12,798

Exploration and appraisal costsc
 
238


216

139

245

283

5

148

24

1,298

Development
 
817


3,429

46

591

2,340


2,458

236

9,917

Total costs
 
2,988


14,330

185

936

2,672

5

2,637

260

24,013

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
619


1,306

105

2,074

3,228


1,430

1,410

10,172

Sales between businesses
 
2,255


11,656

1

195

3,928


7,793

665

26,493

 
 
2,874


12,962

106

2,269

7,156


9,223

2,075

36,665

Exploration expenditure
 
105


509

146

252

405

5

20

3

1,445

Production costs
 
646


2,729

120

430

1,066


951

138

6,080

Production taxes
 
(269
)

369


357



1,010

69

1,536

Other costs (income)e
 
(331
)
(2
)
2,379

43

165

133

42

94

223

2,746

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,199


3,921

101

1,023

3,635


2,165

298

12,342

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(226
)

203

10


(141
)

21

136

3

 
 
1,124

(2
)
10,110

420

2,227

5,098

47

4,261

867

24,152

Profit (loss) before taxationf
 
1,750

2

2,852

(314
)
42

2,058

(47
)
4,962

1,208

12,513

Allocable taxesg
 
446


454

(95
)
314

1,184

13

3,509

508

6,333

Results of operations
 
1,304

2

2,398

(219
)
(272
)
874

(60
)
1,453

700

6,180

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
 
 
 
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
1,750

2

2,852

(314
)
42

2,058

(47
)
4,962

1,208

12,513

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesh
 
(20
)
265

188

(111
)
135

(58
)
5

463

6

873

Equity-accounted entitiesi j
 
(2
)
130

28


209

207

2,346

245


3,163

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
1,728

397

3,068

(425
)
386

2,207

2,304

5,670

1,214

16,549

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
d Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
e Includes property taxes, other government take and the fair value gain on embedded derivatives of $17 million. The UK region includes a $384-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
f Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $208 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
g US region includes the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US Federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21% enacted in December 2017.
h Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
i The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and tax.
j From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation.



 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
211


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

3,439



9,643


24,052

3,646


40,780

Unproved properties
 

657



86


828

26


1,597

 
 

4,096



9,729


24,880

3,672


42,377

Accumulated depreciation
 

670



4,665


6,749

3,672


15,756

Net capitalized costs
 

3,426



5,064


18,131



26,621

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 






425



425

Unproved
 

137





148



285

 
 

137





573



710

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

67



25


207



299

Development
 

251



575


3,255

212


4,293

Total costs
 

455



600


4,035

212


5,302

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

1,114



1,792



353


3,259

Sales between businesses
 






15,901



15,901

 
 

1,114



1,792


15,901

353


19,160

Exploration expenditure
 

89



7


112



208

Production costs
 

207



438


1,487

39


2,171

Production taxes
 




361


7,634

94


8,089

Other costs (income)
 

21



127


638



786

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

290



416


1,627

212


2,545

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 

6





47

1


54

 
 

613



1,349


11,545

346


13,853

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

501



443


4,356

7


5,307

Allocable taxes
 

350



279


849



1,478

Results of operationsg
 

151



164


3,507

7


3,829

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

151



164


3,507

7


3,829

Midstream and other activities after taxh
 
(2
)
(21
)
28


45

207

(1,161
)
238


(666
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 
(2
)
130

28


209

207

2,346

245


3,163

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft and Pan American Energy Group are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of transportation costs and sales taxes.
g From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation.
h Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.

212
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
34,208


83,449

3,518

13,581

49,795


35,519

5,984

226,054

Unproved properties
 
481


3,957

2,561

2,905

4,013


3,407

562

17,886

 
 
34,689


87,406

6,079

16,486

53,808


38,926

6,546

243,940

Accumulated depreciation
 
21,793


48,462

367

7,495

34,870


18,007

3,192

134,186

Net capitalized costs
 
12,896


38,944

5,712

8,991

18,938


20,919

3,354

109,754

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of properties
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 


22



564


1,187


1,773

Unproved
 
13


13


330

374


228


958

 
 
13


35


330

938


1,415


2,731

Exploration and appraisal costsc
 
336


102

52

264

682

11

190

18

1,655

Development
 
995


2,776

58

911

2,972


2,760

223

10,695

Total costs
 
1,344


2,913

110

1,505

4,592

11

4,365

241

15,081

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
204


724

171

1,134

2,211


1,276

967

6,687

Sales between businesses
 
1,745


9,117

2

327

4,022


6,394

487

22,094

 
 
1,949


9,841

173

1,461

6,233


7,670

1,454

28,781

Exploration expenditure
 
331


282

39

83

1,346

11

(29
)
17

2,080

Production costs
 
629


2,256

116

573

979


904

157

5,614

Production taxes
 
(37
)

52


86



1,618

56

1,775

Other costs (income)e
 
(272
)
2

1,655

34

71

280

39

311

349

2,469

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,190


4,258

96

742

3,586


2,147

366

12,385

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
133

(12
)
87

(1
)
(31
)


(10
)
13

179

 
 
1,974

(10
)
8,590

284

1,524

6,191

50

4,941

958

24,502

Profit (loss) before taxationf
 
(25
)
10

1,251

(111
)
(63
)
42

(50
)
2,729

496

4,279

Allocable taxesg
 
(104
)

(1,811
)
(28
)
155

788

(19
)
1,505

146

632

Results of operations
 
79

10

3,062

(83
)
(218
)
(746
)
(31
)
1,224

350

3,647

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
 
 
 
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
(25
)
10

1,251

(111
)
(63
)
42

(50
)
2,729

496

4,279

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesh
 
(185
)
97

(176
)
(111
)
140

(80
)
3

315

11

14

Equity-accounted entitiesi j
 

71

25


381

205

837

245


1,764

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
(210
)
178

1,100

(222
)
458

167

790

3,289

507

6,057

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline, the Forties Pipeline System and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. The Forties Pipeline System was divested on 31 October 2017. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
d Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
e Includes property taxes, other government take and the fair value gain on embedded derivatives of $32 million. The UK region includes a $343-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
f Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $120 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
g US region includes the deferred tax impact of the reduction in the US Federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21% enacted in December 2017.
h Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
i The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and tax.
j From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation. Of BP's initial 60% interest in PAE, 10% was classified as held for sale on 9 September 2017. For September, only 9 days of income was reported for the full 60%. After this equity accounting continued for the 50% not classified as held for sale. BP accounted for 50% of the enlarged entity from 16 December 2017.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
213


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

3,187



9,096


24,686

3,434


40,403

Unproved properties
 

481



68


907

26


1,482

 
 

3,668



9,164


25,593

3,460


41,885

Accumulated depreciation
 

400



4,249


6,207

3,460


14,316

Net capitalized costs
 

3,268



4,915


19,386



27,569

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 

323





653



976

Unproved
 

152



20


416



588

 
 

475



20


1,069



1,564

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

49



43


194



286

Development
 

199



576


3,361

446


4,582

Total costs
 

723



639


4,624

446


6,432

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

773



1,750



988


3,511

Sales between businesses
 






11,537



11,537

 
 

773



1,750


11,537

988


15,048

Exploration expenditure
 

68





59



127

Production costs
 

157



592


1,424

117


2,290

Production taxes
 




336


5,712

426


6,474

Other costs (income)
 

67



11


409

(5
)

482

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

328



458


1,539

446


2,771

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 

6



27


54



87

 
 

626



1,424


9,197

984


12,231

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

147



326


2,340

4


2,817

Allocable taxes
 

54



(18
)

457



493

Results of operationsg
 

93



344


1,883

4


2,324

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

93



344


1,883

4


2,324

Midstream and other activities after taxh
 

(22
)
25


37

205

(1,046
)
241


(560
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 

71

25


381

205

837

245


1,764

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft and Pan American Energy Group are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of transportation costs and sales taxes.
g From 16 December 2017, BP entered into a new 50:50 joint venture Pan American Energy Group (PAEG). Prior to this, Pan American Energy (PAE) was owned 60% by BP and 40% by Bridas Corporation. Of BP's initial 60% interest in PAE, 10% was classified as held for sale on 9 September 2017. For September, only 9 days of income was reported for the full 60%. After this equity accounting continued for the 50% not classified as held for sale. BP accounted for 50% of the enlarged entity from 16 December 2017.
h Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.



214
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 
34,171


81,633

3,622

12,624

46,892


30,870

5,752

215,564

Unproved properties
 
483


4,712

2,377

2,450

3,808


4,132

562

18,524

 
 
34,654


86,345

5,999

15,074

50,700


35,002

6,314

234,088

Accumulated depreciation
 
21,745


44,988

272

6,764

31,456


15,942

2,826

123,993

Net capitalized costs
 
12,909


41,357

5,727

8,310

19,244


19,060

3,488

110,095

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decembera b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 
215


314





703

207

1,439

Unproved
 


38

10

10

181


1,728


1,967

 
 
215


352

10

10

181


2,431

207

3,406

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 
165

5

391

70

123

297

10

252

89

1,402

Development
 
1,284

3

2,372

28

1,519

2,957


2,788

194

11,145

Total costs
 
1,664

8

3,115

108

1,652

3,435

10

5,471

490

15,953

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decembera
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuese
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 
244

26

640

74

747

1,215


97

1,042

4,085

Sales between businesses
 
1,387

421

6,204

2

103

3,391


3,908

309

15,725

 
 
1,631

447

6,844

76

850

4,606


4,005

1,351

19,810

Exploration expenditure
 
133

3

693

61

672

87

10

(27
)
89

1,721

Production costs
 
619

208

2,524

114

476

1,220


691

154

6,006

Production taxes
 
(351
)

155


38



800

41

683

Other costs (income)f
 
(215
)
37

1,687

25

115

597

34

115

153

2,548

Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 
1,002

209

3,940

66

591

2,937


2,179

289

11,213

Net impairments and (gains) losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(809
)
(345
)
(627
)
(5
)
(77
)
(765
)

(182
)
63

(2,747
)
 
 
379

112

8,372

261

1,815

4,076

44

3,576

789

19,424

Profit (loss) before taxationg
 
1,252

335

(1,528
)
(185
)
(965
)
530

(44
)
429

562

386

Allocable taxesh
 
(286
)
(287
)
(402
)
(40
)
(194
)
670

(10
)
(74
)
288

(335
)
Results of operations
 
1,538

622

(1,126
)
(145
)
(771
)
(140
)
(34
)
503

274

721

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
Exploration and production activities – subsidiaries (as above)
 
1,252

335

(1,528
)
(185
)
(965
)
530

(44
)
429

562

386

Midstream and other activities – subsidiariesi
 
(417
)
54

(14
)
(137
)
187

(142
)
(2
)
(81
)
13

(539
)
Equity-accounted entitiesj k
 

(1
)
20


447

(12
)
597

266


1,317

Total replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
835

388

(1,522
)
(322
)
(331
)
376

551

614

575

1,164

a These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of subsidiaries, which includes our share of oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of joint operations. They do not include any costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations are excluded. In addition, our midstream activities of marketing and trading of natural gas, power and NGLs in the US, Canada, UK, Asia and Europe are excluded. The most significant midstream pipeline interests include the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System, the Forties Pipeline System, the South Caucasus Pipeline and the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan pipeline. Major LNG activities are located in Trinidad, Indonesia, Australia and Angola.
b Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
c Rest of Asia amounts include BP’s participating interest in the Abu Dhabi ADCO concession.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e Presented net of transportation costs, purchases and sales taxes.
f Includes property taxes, other government take and the fair value gain on embedded derivatives of $32 million. The UK region includes a $454-million gain which is offset by corresponding charges primarily in the US region, relating to the group self-insurance programme.
g Excludes the unwinding of the discount on provisions and payables amounting to $152 million which is included in finance costs in the group income statement.
h UK region includes the deferred tax impact of the enactment of legislation to reduce the UK supplementary charge tax rate applicable to profits arising in the North Sea from 20% to 10%.
i Midstream and other activities excludes inventory holding gains and losses.
j The profits of equity-accounted entities are included after interest and tax.
k Includes the results of BP’s 30% interest in Aker BP ASA from 1 October 2016.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
215


Oil and natural gas exploration and production activities – continued
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capitalized costs at 31 Decemberb c
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross capitalized costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved properties
 

2,702



10,211


19,558

3,009


35,480

Unproved properties
 

296



6


383

26


711

 
 

2,998



10,217


19,941

3,035


36,191

Accumulated depreciation
 

48



4,615


4,401

3,035


12,099

Net capitalized costs
 

2,950



5,602


15,540



24,092

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Costs incurred for the year ended 31 Decemberb d e
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of propertiesc
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proved
 






1,576



1,576

Unproved
 






69



69

 
 






1,645



1,645

Exploration and appraisal costsd
 

18



7


118

1


144

Development
 

54



559


2,070

371


3,054

Total costs
 

72



566


3,833

372


4,843

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Results of operations for the year ended 31 Decemberb
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenuesf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Third parties
 

162



1,865



876


2,903

Sales between businesses
 






8,088

16


8,104

 
 

162



1,865


8,088

892


11,007

Exploration expenditure
 

13





50



63

Production costs
 

36



559


1,085

145


1,825

Production taxes
 




335


3,393

352


4,080

Other costs (income)
 

(13
)


(429
)

345

3


(94
)
Depreciation, depletion and amortization
 

48



499


1,082

386


2,015

Net impairments and losses on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 




164


59



223

 
 

84



1,128


6,014

886


8,112

Profit (loss) before taxation
 

78



737


2,074

6


2,895

Allocable taxes
 

75



319


435

3


832

Results of operationsg
 

3



418


1,639

3


2,063

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Upstream and Rosneft segments replacement cost profit (loss) before interest and tax from equity-accounted entities
Exploration and production activities – equity-accounted entities after tax (as above)
 

3



418


1,639

3


2,063

Midstream and other activities after taxh
 

(4
)
20


29

(12
)
(1,042
)
263


(746
)
Total replacement cost profit (loss) after interest and tax
 

(1
)
20


447

(12
)
597

266


1,317

a Amounts reported for Russia in this table include BP’s share of Rosneft’s worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia. The amounts reported include the corresponding amounts for their equity-accounted entities. Amounts also include certain adjustments, mainly related to purchase price allocations for 2016 acquisitions.
b These tables contain information relating to oil and natural gas exploration and production activities of equity-accounted entities. Amounts relating to the management and ownership of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, LNG liquefaction and transportation operations as well as downstream activities of Rosneft are excluded.
c Costs of decommissioning are included in capitalized costs at 31 December but are excluded from costs incurred for the year.
d Includes exploration and appraisal drilling expenditures, which are capitalized within intangible assets, and geological and geophysical exploration costs, which are charged to income as incurred.
e The amounts shown reflect BP’s share of equity-accounted entities’ costs incurred, and not the costs incurred by BP in acquiring an interest in equity-accounted entities.
f Presented net of transportation costs and sales taxes.
g Includes the results of BP’s 30% interest in Aker BP ASA from 1 October 2016.
h Includes interest and adjustment for non-controlling interests. Excludes inventory holding gains and losses.



216
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245


932

54

10

281


1,040

31

2,592

Undeveloped
 
164


492

195

6

28


642

11

1,537

 
 
409


1,423

248

16

309


1,682

42

4,129

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
22


116

(6
)
1

11


40

(2
)
183

Improved recovery
 


51



1




52

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
93


412







504

Discoveries and extensions
 
15


17



13




46

Productiond
 
(37
)

(137
)
(9
)
(3
)
(75
)

(114
)
(6
)
(381
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(37
)

(118
)






(155
)
 
 
57


341

(15
)
(2
)
(50
)

(74
)
(8
)
249

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223


962

43

8

223


1,126

30

2,615

Undeveloped
 
243


802

190

5

36


482

5

1,763

 
 
466


1,764

234

14

259


1,608

34

4,378

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

56



285

1

3,124

6


3,473

Undeveloped
 

89



263


2,251



2,603

 
 

145



548

1

5,374

6


6,076

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



7


150



168

Improved recovery
 

13








13

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






89



89

Discoveries and extensions
 



19

21


326



366

Production
 

(13
)


(25
)

(335
)
(6
)

(379
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

12


19

4

(1
)
229

(6
)

257

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

57



293

1

3,190



3,541

Undeveloped
 

100


19

259


2,414



2,792

 
 

157


19

552

1

5,604



6,333

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245

56

932

54

295

282

3,124

1,047

31

6,064

Undeveloped
 
164

89

492

195

269

28

2,251

642

11

4,140

 
 
409

145

1,423

249

564

310

5,374

1,688

42

10,205

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
223

57

962

43

302

224

3,190

1,126

30

6,156

Undeveloped
 
243

100

802

209

264

36

2,414

482

5

4,555

 
 
466

157

1,764

253

566

260

5,604

1,608

34

10,711

a Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 4 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 344 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.28% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 24 mmbbl held through BP's interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
g Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,539 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and Canada, 58 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,481 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
217


Movements in estimated net proved reserves - continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11


177


2

21



5

216

Undeveloped
 
3


69


28




1

102

 
 
14


246


30

21



6

318

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
1


20



(3
)



17

Improved recovery
 


16



2




18

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 


253







253

Discoveries and extensions
 
3


1



3




7

Productionc
 
(2
)

(25
)

(3
)
(3
)


(1
)
(34
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(3
)








(3
)
 
 


265


(3
)
(2
)


(1
)
258

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8


266


2

14



5

295

Undeveloped
 
6


246


25

4




280

 
 
14


511


27

18



5

576

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




10

82



97

Undeveloped
 

4





49



53

 
 

8




10

131



149

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 





(1
)
25



23

Improved recovery
 










Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 

(1
)



(1
)
(2
)


(4
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

(1
)



(3
)
23



19

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




7

103



114

Undeveloped
 

3





51



54

 
 

7




7

154



169

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11

4

177


2

31

82


5

313

Undeveloped
 
3

4

69


28


49


1

154

 
 
14

8

246


30

31

131


6

467

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
8

4

266


2

22

103


5

409

Undeveloped
 
6

3

246


25

4

51



335

 
 
14

7

511


27

26

154


5

744

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 8 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 12 million barrels of NGLs in respect of the 7.82% non-controlling interest in Rosneft.
f Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 154 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 154 million barrels in Russia.

218
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves - continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256


1,108

54

12

301


1,040

36

2,808

Undeveloped
 
167


561

195

34

28


642

12

1,639

 
 
424


1,669

248

46

329


1,682

48

4,447

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
23


136

(6
)
1

8


40

(2
)
200

Improved recovery
 


67



3




70

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
93


665







758

Discoveries and extensions
 
18


18



16




52

Productiond
 
(39
)

(162
)
(9
)
(6
)
(79
)

(114
)
(7
)
(415
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(40
)

(118
)






(158
)
 
 
56


606

(15
)
(5
)
(52
)

(74
)
(9
)
507

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231


1,228

43

10

237


1,126

35

2,910

Undeveloped
 
249


1,048

190

30

40


482

5

2,044

 
 
480


2,276

234

41

277


1,608

39

4,954

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



285

11

3,206

6


3,569

Undeveloped
 

93



263


2,300



2,656

 
 

153



548

12

5,505

6


6,225

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



7

(2
)
175



191

Improved recovery
 

13








13

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






89



89

Discoveries and extensions
 



19

21


326



366

Production
 

(13
)


(25
)
(2
)
(337
)
(6
)

(383
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

11


19

4

(3
)
253

(6
)

277

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



293

8

3,293



3,655

Undeveloped
 

104


19

259


2,465



2,846

 
 

164


19

552

8

5,758



6,502

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256

60

1,108

54

297

313

3,206

1,047

36

6,377

Undeveloped
 
167

93

561

195

297

28

2,300

642

12

4,295

 
 
424

153

1,669

249

594

341

5,505

1,688

48

10,672

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
231

60

1,228

44

303

245

3,293

1,126

35

6,565

Undeveloped
 
249

104

1,048

209

289

40

2,465

482

5

4,890

 
 
480

164

2,276

253

593

285

5,758

1,608

39

11,456

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
e Also includes 12 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 356 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 24 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,693 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Canada, 58 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and 5,635 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
219


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523


5,238

(1
)
2,862

1,159


2,755

2,730

15,266

Undeveloped
 
320


3,086


3,330

1,510


4,245

1,505

13,997

 
 
843


8,323

(1
)
6,193

2,670


7,000

4,235

29,263

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
84


10

3

(195
)
(444
)

140

(123
)
(524
)
Improved recovery
 


1,315







1,315

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
40


2,655







2,695

Discoveries and extensions
 
60


11


31

578




680

Productionc
 
(66
)

(751
)
(3
)
(788
)
(423
)

(324
)
(303
)
(2,658
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(178
)

(237
)






(416
)
 
 
(61
)

3,003

1

(951
)
(290
)

(184
)
(426
)
1,092

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439


6,270


2,168

1,313


3,599

2,630

16,420

Undeveloped
 
343


5,056


3,073

1,067


3,218

1,179

13,936

 
 
782


11,326


5,241

2,380


6,817

3,809

30,355

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

112



1,274

476

6,077

17


7,955

Undeveloped
 

69



450

146

7,173

3


7,841

 
 

180



1,724

622

13,250

20


15,796

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



(50
)
(39
)
805

2


719

Improved recovery
 




1





1

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






2,413



2,413

Discoveries and extensions
 



4

122


512



638

Productionc
 

(22
)


(145
)
(48
)
(464
)
(6
)

(685
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

(19
)

3

(71
)
(87
)
3,267

(5
)

3,087

At 31 Decemberf g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

107



1,207

391

7,798

12


9,515

Undeveloped
 

55


4

446

143

8,719

4


9,369

 
 

161


4

1,653

534

16,517

15


18,884

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523

112

5,238


4,136

1,635

6,077

2,771

2,730

23,221

Undeveloped
 
320

69

3,086


3,781

1,656

7,173

4,249

1,505

21,838

 
 
843

180

8,323


7,917

3,291

13,250

7,020

4,235

45,060

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
439

107

6,270


3,375

1,704

7,798

3,610

2,630

25,934

Undeveloped
 
343

55

5,056

4

3,519

1,210

8,719

3,221

1,179

23,305

 
 
782

161

11,326

4

6,894

2,914

16,517

6,832

3,809

49,239

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Includes 181 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 139 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 42 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 1,573 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 1,211 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 8.60% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 480 billion cubic feet held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
g Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 14,325 billion cubic feet, comprising 0 billion cubic feet in Canada, 26 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 15 billion cubic feet in Vietnam, 200 billion cubic feet in Egypt and 14,084 billion cubic feet in Russia.

220
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalentc
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347


2,011

54

505

501


1,515

507

5,440

Undeveloped
 
222


1,093

195

608

288


1,374

272

4,052

 
 
569


3,104

248

1,114

790


2,889

779

9,492

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
38


138

(5
)
(33
)
(69
)

64

(23
)
110

Improved recovery
 


294



3




297

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
100


1,123







1,222

Discoveries and extensions
 
29


20


5

116




169

Productione f
 
(50
)

(292
)
(9
)
(142
)
(152
)

(170
)
(59
)
(874
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(70
)

(159
)






(229
)
 
 
46


1,124

(15
)
(169
)
(102
)

(106
)
(82
)
696

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307


2,309

43

384

464


1,746

488

5,741

Undeveloped
 
308


1,919

190

560

224


1,037

208

4,447

 
 
615


4,228

234

944

687


2,783

696

10,188

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

80



505

93

4,254

9


4,941

Undeveloped
 

105



341

25

3,536

1


4,008

 
 

184



846

119

7,790

10


8,949

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

11



(1
)
(8
)
313



315

Improved recovery
 

13








14

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 






505



505

Discoveries and extensions
 



20

42


414



476

Productione
 

(17
)


(50
)
(10
)
(417
)
(7
)

(501
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

8


19

(9
)
(18
)
816

(7
)

809

At 31 Decemberi j
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

79



501

76

4,638

2


5,296

Undeveloped
 

113


20

336

25

3,968

1


4,462

 
 

192


20

837

101

8,605

3


9,757

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347

80

2,011

54

1,010

595

4,254

1,524

507

10,381

Undeveloped
 
222

105

1,093

195

949

314

3,536

1,374

272

8,060

 
 
569

184

3,104

249

1,959

908

7,790

2,899

779

18,441

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
307

79

2,309

44

885

539

4,638

1,749

488

11,037

Undeveloped
 
308

113

1,919

210

896

249

3,968

1,037

208

8,908

 
 
615

192

4,228

253

1,781

788

8,605

2,786

696

19,945

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f Includes 31 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 24 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 7 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
g Includes 283 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
h Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
i Includes 565 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 107 mmboe held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
j Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 8,163 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Canada, 62 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 3 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam, 35 million barrels of oil equivalent in Egypt and 8,063 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
221


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
 North
America
 South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155


826

42

9

317


1,107

32

2,487

Undeveloped
 
274


497

209

11

42


245

14

1,291

 
 
429


1,322

251

20

358


1,352

46

3,778

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
15


208

5

1

35


407

2

673

Improved recovery
 


12



2




14

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
3


1



1




5

Discoveries and extensions
 


12





42


53

Productiond
 
(29
)

(131
)
(7
)
(5
)
(88
)

(119
)
(6
)
(384
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(9
)








(9
)
 
 
(20
)

101

(2
)
(4
)
(50
)

330

(4
)
351

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245


932

54

10

281


1,040

31

2,592

Undeveloped
 
164


492

195

6

28


642

11

1,537

 
 
409


1,423

248

16

309


1,682

42

4,129

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

45



321

1

3,162

43


3,573

Undeveloped
 

69



325


2,134

1


2,529

 
 

114



646

1

5,296

44


6,101

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



1


102

(1
)

104

Improved recovery
 

11



4





16

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

34





37



71

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



22


264



288

Production
 

(11
)


(28
)

(325
)
(36
)

(401
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(5
)


(98
)




(103
)
 
 

31



(98
)

78

(37
)

(25
)
At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

56



285

1

3,124

6


3,473

Undeveloped
 

89



263


2,251



2,603

 
 

145



548

1

5,374

6


6,076

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155

45

826

42

330

318

3,162

1,150

32

6,060

Undeveloped
 
274

69

497

209

336

42

2,134

246

14

3,819

 
 
429

114

1,322

251

666

360

5,296

1,395

46

9,879

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
245

56

932

54

295

282

3,124

1,047

31

6,064

Undeveloped
 
164

89

492

195

269

28

2,251

642

11

4,140

 
 
409

145

1,423

249

564

310

5,374

1,688

42

10,205

a Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Includes 5 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 337 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.31% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmbbl held through BP’s equity-accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
g Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,402 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and Canada, 59 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,342 million barrels in Russia.


222
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13


226


5

13



9

266

Undeveloped
 
3


73


28

1



2

107

 
 
16


299


33

14



11

373

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
2


(44
)


11



(4
)
(36
)
Improved recovery
 


15







15

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 










Discoveries and extensions
 


1







1

Productionc
 
(3
)

(24
)

(3
)
(4
)


(1
)
(35
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(1
)








(1
)
 
 
(2
)

(52
)

(3
)
7



(5
)
(55
)
At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11


177


2

21



5

216

Undeveloped
 
3


69


28




1

102

 
 
14


246


30

21



6

318

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

3




11

50



65

Undeveloped
 

2





15



17

 
 

5




11

65



81

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 





1

68



69

Improved recovery
 

1








1

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

2








2

Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 

(1
)



(1
)
(2
)


(4
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

3




(1
)
66



68

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

4




10

82



97

Undeveloped
 

4





49



53

 
 

8




10

131



149

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13

3

226


5

24

50


9

331

Undeveloped
 
3

2

73


28

1

15


2

123

 
 
16

5

299


33

25

65


11

454

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
11

4

177


2

31

82


5

313

Undeveloped
 
3

4

69


28


49


1

154

 
 
14

8

246


30

31

131


6

467

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 9 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 131 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 131 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
223


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168


1,051

42

14

330


1,107

42

2,753

Undeveloped
 
277


569

209

39

43


245

16

1,398

 
 
445


1,621

251

53

372


1,352

57

4,151

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
17


164

5

1

45


407

(2
)
637

Improved recovery
 


27



2




29

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
3


1



1




5

Discoveries and extensions
 


12





42


54

Productiond
 
(32
)

(155
)
(7
)
(8
)
(92
)

(119
)
(7
)
(419
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(10
)








(10
)
 
 
(22
)

49

(2
)
(7
)
(43
)

330

(9
)
296

At 31 Decembere
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256


1,108

54

12

301


1,040

36

2,808

Undeveloped
 
167


561

195

34

28


642

12

1,639

 
 
424


1,669

248

46

329


1,682

48

4,447

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

48



321

12

3,213

43


3,637

Undeveloped
 

71



325


2,148

1


2,545

 
 

119



646

12

5,361

44


6,183

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

2



1

1

170

(1
)

174

Improved recovery
 

13



4





17

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

36





37



72

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



22


264



288

Production
 

(12
)


(28
)
(2
)
(327
)
(36
)

(405
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(6
)


(98
)




(104
)
 
 

34



(98
)
(1
)
144

(37
)

43

At 31 Decemberg h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

60



285

11

3,206

6


3,569

Undeveloped
 

93



263


2,300



2,656

 
 

153



548

12

5,505

6


6,225

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168

48

1,051

42

335

342

3,213

1,150

42

6,390

Undeveloped
 
277

71

569

209

364

43

2,148

246

16

3,943

 
 
445

119

1,621

251

699

385

5,361

1,395

57

10,333

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
256

60

1,108

54

297

313

3,206

1,047

36

6,377

Undeveloped
 
167

93

561

195

297

28

2,300

642

12

4,295

 
 
424

153

1,669

249

594

341

5,505

1,688

48

10,672

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
e Also includes 14 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 338 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
i Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,533 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Canada, 59 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and 5,473 million barrels in Russia.

224
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia

Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499


5,447


1,784

767


1,890

3,012

13,398

Undeveloped
 
350


2,567


4,970

2,191


3,769

1,643

15,490

 
 
848


8,014


6,755

2,958


5,659

4,654

28,888

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
50


(38
)
3

(677
)
(450
)

258

(129
)
(983
)
Improved recovery
 


1,002



1


6


1,009

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
25





527




552

Discoveries and extensions
 


10


829

14


1,229


2,082

Productionc
 
(77
)

(664
)
(3
)
(714
)
(380
)

(152
)
(291
)
(2,281
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(4
)








(4
)
 
 
(5
)

309


(562
)
(288
)

1,342

(420
)
376

At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523


5,238

(1
)
2,862

1,159


2,755

2,730

15,266

Undeveloped
 
320


3,086


3,330

1,510


4,245

1,505

13,997

 
 
843


8,323

(1
)
6,193

2,670


7,000

4,235

29,263

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

89



1,546

412

5,544

26


7,617

Undeveloped
 

21



534


6,304

4


6,863

 
 

110


1

2,080

412

11,847

30


14,480

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

19



47

5

1,556

(2
)

1,625

Improved recovery
 

37



55





92

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

39




237

10



286

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



67


324



392

Productionc
 

(19
)


(178
)
(32
)
(488
)
(8
)

(726
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(6
)


(347
)




(353
)
 
 

70



(356
)
210

1,403

(10
)

1,316

At 31 Decemberf g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

112



1,274

476

6,077

17


7,955

Undeveloped
 

69



450

146

7,173

3


7,841

 
 

180



1,724

622

13,250

20


15,796

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499

89

5,447


3,330

1,179

5,544

1,916

3,012

21,015

Undeveloped
 
350

21

2,567


5,505

2,191

6,304

3,772

1,643

22,353

 
 
848

110

8,014


8,835

3,370

11,847

5,688

4,654

43,368

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
523

112

5,238


4,136

1,635

6,077

2,771

2,730

23,221

Undeveloped
 
320

69

3,086


3,781

1,656

7,173

4,249

1,505

21,838

 
 
843

180

8,323


7,917

3,291

13,250

7,020

4,235

45,060

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c Includes 180 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 131 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 49 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
d Includes 1,860 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f Includes 306 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 2.30% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 2 billion cubic feet held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
g Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 13,522 billion cubic feet, comprising 0 billion cubic feet in Canada, 28 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 19 billion cubic feet in Vietnam, 237 billion cubic feet in Egypt and 13,237 billion cubic feet in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
225


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalent c
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254


1,990

42

321

462


1,433

561

5,063

Undeveloped
 
338


1,012

209

896

420


895

299

4,068

 
 
592


3,002

251

1,217

882


2,327

860

9,131

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
25


157

5

(116
)
(32
)

451

(24
)
467

Improved recovery
 


200



2


1


203

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
8


1



92




100

Discoveries and extensions
 


14


143

3


254


413

Productione f
 
(45
)

(270
)
(8
)
(131
)
(157
)

(145
)
(57
)
(812
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 
(11
)








(11
)
 
 
(23
)

102

(2
)
(104
)
(93
)

562

(81
)
361

At 31 Decemberg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347


2,011

54

505

501


1,515

507

5,440

Undeveloped
 
222


1,093

195

608

288


1,374

272

4,052

 
 
569


3,104

248

1,114

790


2,889

779

9,492

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)h
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

63



588

83

4,168

47


4,951

Undeveloped
 

75



417


3,235

1


3,729

 
 

138



1,005

83

7,404

49


8,679

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 

5



9

2

439

(1
)

454

Improved recovery
 

19



14





33

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

42




41

38



122

Discoveries and extensions
 

1



34


320



355

Productione
 

(15
)


(58
)
(7
)
(411
)
(38
)

(530
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(7
)


(158
)




(165
)
 
 

46



(159
)
35

386

(39
)

269

At 31 Decemberi j
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

80



505

93

4,254

9


4,941

Undeveloped
 

105



341

25

3,536

1


4,008

 
 

184



846

119

7,790

10


8,949

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254

63

1,990

42

909

545

4,168

1,480

561

10,014

Undeveloped
 
338

75

1,012

209

1,313

420

3,235

896

299

7,797

 
 
592

138

3,002

251

2,222

966

7,404

2,376

860

17,810

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
347

80

2,011

54

1,010

595

4,254

1,524

507

10,381

Undeveloped
 
222

105

1,093

195

949

314

3,536

1,374

272

8,060

 
 
569

184

3,104

249

1,959

908

7,790

2,899

779

18,441

a Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 2 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f Includes 31 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 23 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 8 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
g Includes 335 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
h Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
i Includes 391 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 7 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
j Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 7,864 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Canada, 64 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 3 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam, 41 million barrels of oil equivalent in Egypt and 7,755 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

226
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Crude oila b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asiad

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
141

86

890

46

8

340


598

35

2,146

Undeveloped
 
298

19

577

205

18

89


192

16

1,414

 
 
440

106

1,467

252

26

429


790

51

3,560

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimatesd
 
13


(30
)

(2
)
22


543

2

548

Improved recovery
 


1



3


70


74

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
3


3





25

1

32

Discoveries and extensions
 
2



4






6

Productione
 
(29
)
(9
)
(119
)
(5
)
(4
)
(96
)

(75
)
(6
)
(341
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(97
)
(1
)




(1
)
(2
)
(102
)
 
 
(11
)
(106
)
(145
)
(1
)
(6
)
(71
)

562

(5
)
218

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155


826

42

9

317


1,107

32

2,487

Undeveloped
 
274


497

209

11

42


245

14

1,291

 
 
429


1,322

251

20

358


1,352

46

3,778

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 




311

2

2,844

68


3,225

Undeveloped
 




311


1,981



2,292

 
 




622

2

4,825

68


5,517

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 




(2
)

33

13


45

Improved recovery
 




1


4



5

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

116



36


456



609

Discoveries and extensions
 




16


285



301

Production
 

(3
)


(28
)

(305
)
(37
)

(373
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(2
)
(1
)

(2
)
 
 

114



24


471

(25
)

584

At 31 Decemberh
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

45



321

1

3,162

43


3,573

Undeveloped
 

69



325


2,134

1


2,529

 
 

114



646

1

5,296

44


6,101

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
141

86

890

47

319

342

2,844

666

35

5,371

Undeveloped
 
298

19

577

205

329

89

1,981

192

16

3,707

 
 
440

106

1,467

252

648

431

4,825

858

51

9,078

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
155

45

826

42

330

318

3,162

1,150

32

6,060

Undeveloped
 
274

69

497

209

336

42

2,134

246

14

3,819

 
 
429

114

1,322

251

666

360

5,296

1,395

46

9,879

a 
Crude oil includes condensate and bitumen. Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels upon which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d Rest of Asia includes additions from Abu Dhabi ADCO concession.
e Includes 6 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
f Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g Includes 347 million barrels of crude oil in respect of the 6.58% non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmbbl held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
h Total proved crude oil reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,330 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and Canada, 62 million barrels in Venezuela and 5,268 million barrels in Russia.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
227


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Natural gas liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
5

11

269


7

5



9

308

Undeveloped
 
4

1

70


28

10



2

115

 
 
10

12

339


35

15



12

422

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
7


(24
)


1




(14
)
Improved recovery
 


3







3

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
1


4







6

Discoveries and extensions
 










Productionc
 
(2
)
(1
)
(24
)

(2
)
(2
)


(1
)
(34
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(10
)







(10
)
 
 
7

(12
)
(40
)

(2
)
(1
)


(1
)
(49
)
At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13


226


5

13



9

266

Undeveloped
 
3


73


28

1



2

107

 
 
16


299


33

14



11

373

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 





13

32



45

Undeveloped
 






15



15

 
 





13

47



60

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 





(2
)
18



16

Improved recovery
 










Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

5








5

Discoveries and extensions
 










Production
 










Sales of reserves-in-place
 










 
 

5




(2
)
18



21

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

3




11

50



65

Undeveloped
 

2





15



17

 
 

5




11

65



81

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
5

11

269


7

18

32


9

352

Undeveloped
 
4

1

70


28

10

15


2

130

 
 
10

12

339


35

28

47


12

482

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
13

3

226


5

24

50


9

331

Undeveloped
 
3

2

73


28

1

15


2

123

 
 
16

5

299


33

25

65


11

454

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
d 
Includes 10 million barrels of NGL in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f 
Total proved NGL reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 65 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Venezuela, Vietnam and Canada, and 65 million barrels in Russia.

228
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels
 
Total liquidsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USc

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
147

98

1,159

46

15

346


598

45

2,453

Undeveloped
 
303

20

647

205

46

99


192

18

1,529

 
 
449

117

1,806

252

61

444


790

63

3,982

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimatesd
 
20


(54
)

(2
)
23


543

3

533

Improved recovery
 


5



3


70


78

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
5


7





25

1

38

Discoveries and extensions
 
2



4






6

Productione
 
(31
)
(10
)
(143
)
(5
)
(6
)
(98
)

(75
)
(7
)
(375
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(108
)
(1
)




(1
)
(2
)
(112
)
 
 
(4
)
(117
)
(185
)
(1
)
(8
)
(72
)

562

(5
)
168

At 31 Decemberf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168


1,051

42

14

330


1,107

42

2,753

Undeveloped
 
277


569

209

39

43


245

16

1,398

 
 
445


1,621

251

53

372


1,352

57

4,151

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 




311

14

2,876

68


3,270

Undeveloped
 




312


1,996



2,307

 
 




622

14

4,872

68


5,577

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 




(2
)
(2
)
51

13


61

Improved recovery
 




1


4



5

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

122



36


456



614

Discoveries and extensions
 




16


285



301

Production
 

(3
)


(28
)

(305
)
(37
)

(374
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(2
)
(1
)

(2
)
 
 

119



24

(2
)
489

(25
)

605

At 31 Decemberh i
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

48



321

12

3,213

43


3,637

Undeveloped
 

71



325


2,148

1


2,545

 
 

119



646

12

5,361

44


6,183

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
147

98

1,159

47

326

360

2,876

666

45

5,723

Undeveloped
 
302

20

647

205

357

99

1,996

192

18

3,836

 
 
449

117

1,806

252

684

459

4,872

858

63

9,560

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
168

48

1,051

42

335

342

3,213

1,150

42

6,390

Undeveloped
 
277

71

569

209

364

43

2,148

246

16

3,943

 
 
445

119

1,621

251

699

385

5,361

1,395

57

10,333

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
d 
Rest of Asia includes additions from Abu Dhabi ADCO concession.
e 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
f 
Also includes 16 million barrels in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
g 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h 
Includes 347 million barrels in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
i 
Total proved liquid reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 5,395 million barrels, comprising less than 1 million barrels in Canada, 62 million barrels in Venezuela, less than 1 million barrels in Vietnam and 5,333 million barrels in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
229


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
billion cubic feet
 
Natural gasa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
348

274

6,257


2,071

847


1,803

3,408

15,009

Undeveloped
 
343

14

2,105


5,989

2,305


3,455

1,343

15,553

 
 
691

288

8,363


8,060

3,152


5,257

4,751

30,563

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 
133


(231
)
3

(1,042
)
(19
)

548

396

(211
)
Improved recovery
 


469


42

1


22


534

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
95


91






252

438

Discoveries and extensions
 


1


355

43




399

Productionc
 
(71
)
(33
)
(676
)
(4
)
(624
)
(219
)

(152
)
(306
)
(2,085
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(256
)
(2
)

(37
)


(17
)
(439
)
(750
)
 
 
158

(288
)
(348
)

(1,306
)
(194
)

401

(97
)
(1,675
)
At 31 Decemberd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499


5,447


1,784

767


1,890

3,012

13,398

Undeveloped
 
350


2,567


4,970

2,191


3,769

1,643

15,490

 
 
848


8,014


6,755

2,958


5,659

4,654

28,888

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)e
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 



1

1,463

386

4,962

44


6,856

Undeveloped
 




598


6,176

4


6,778

 
 



1

2,061

386

11,139

48


13,634

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 




62

34

736

5


836

Improved recovery
 




1


10



11

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

115



19


81



216

Discoveries and extensions
 




128


343



471

Productionc
 

(4
)


(190
)
(8
)
(461
)
(15
)

(680
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(1
)
(8
)

(8
)
 
 

110



20

26

709

(18
)

846

At 31 Decemberf g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

89



1,546

412

5,544

26


7,617

Undeveloped
 

21



534


6,304

4


6,863

 
 

110


1

2,080

412

11,847

30


14,480

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
348

274

6,257

1

3,534

1,233

4,962

1,847

3,408

21,865

Undeveloped
 
343

14

2,105


6,587

2,305

6,176

3,459

1,343

22,331

 
 
691

288

8,363

1

10,121

3,538

11,139

5,305

4,751

44,197

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
499

89

5,447


3,330

1,179

5,544

1,916

3,012

21,015

Undeveloped
 
350

21

2,567


5,505

2,191

6,304

3,772

1,643

22,353

 
 
848

110

8,014


8,835

3,370

11,847

5,688

4,654

43,368

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Includes 176 billion cubic feet of natural gas consumed in operations, 145 billion cubic feet in subsidiaries, 31 billion cubic feet in equity-accounted entities.
d 
Includes 2,026 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
e 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
f 
Includes 300 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 2.53% non-controlling interest in Rosneft including 1 billion cubic feet held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
g 
Total proved gas reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 11,900 billion cubic feet, comprising 1 billion cubic feet in Canada, 33 billion cubic feet in Venezuela, 23 billion cubic feet in Vietnam and 11,843 billion cubic feet in Russia.

230
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Movements in estimated net proved reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
million barrels of oil equivalentc
 
Total hydrocarbonsa b
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

USd

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
207

145

2,238

46

373

492


909

632

5,041

Undeveloped
 
362

22

1,010

205

1,078

496


788

250

4,211

 
 
568

167

3,248

252

1,451

988


1,696

882

9,252

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimatese
 
43


(94
)
1

(181
)
20


637

71

497

Improved recovery
 


86


7

3


74


170

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 
21


23





25

44

113

Discoveries and extensions
 
2



4

61

8




75

Productionf g
 
(43
)
(16
)
(260
)
(5
)
(114
)
(136
)

(101
)
(60
)
(735
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 

(152
)
(1
)

(7
)


(4
)
(78
)
(241
)
 
 
23

(167
)
(245
)
(1
)
(233
)
(105
)

631

(22
)
(121
)
At 31 Decemberh
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254


1,990

42

321

462


1,433

561

5,063

Undeveloped
 
338


1,012

209

896

420


895

299

4,068

 
 
592


3,002

251

1,217

882


2,327

860

9,131

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)i
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 




563

81

3,732

76


4,452

Undeveloped
 




415


3,061

1


3,476

 
 




978

81

6,792

77


7,928

Changes attributable to
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revisions of previous estimates
 




9

4

178

14


205

Improved recovery
 




1


6



7

Purchases of reserves-in-place
 

142



39


470



652

Discoveries and extensions
 




38


344



382

Productiong
 

(3
)


(61
)
(2
)
(385
)
(40
)

(491
)
Sales of reserves-in-place
 






(2
)
(2
)

(4
)
 
 

138



27

2

611

(28
)

751

At 31 Decemberj k
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 

63



588

83

4,168

47


4,951

Undeveloped
 

75



417


3,235

1


3,729

 
 

138



1,005

83

7,404

49


8,679

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
At 1 January
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
207

145

2,238

47

936

573

3,732

984

632

9,493

Undeveloped
 
362

22

1,010

205

1,493

496

3,061

788

250

7,687

 
 
568

167

3,248

252

2,429

1,069

6,792

1,773

882

17,180

At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Developed
 
254

63

1,990

42

909

545

4,168

1,480

561

10,014

Undeveloped
 
338

75

1,012

209

1,313

420

3,235

896

299

7,797

 
 
592

138

3,002

251

2,222

966

7,404

2,376

860

17,810

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
5.8 billion cubic feet of natural gas = 1 million barrels of oil equivalent.
d 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 9 million barrels of oil equivalent upon which a net profits royalty will be payable, over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e 
Rest of Asia includes additions from Abu Dhabi ADCO concession.
f 
Excludes NGLs from processing plants in which an interest is held of less than 1 thousand barrels per day for subsidiaries and 3 thousand barrels per day for equity-accounted entities.
g 
Includes 30 million barrels of oil equivalent of natural gas consumed in operations, 25 million barrels of oil equivalent in subsidiaries, 5 million barrels of oil equivalent in equity-accounted entities.
h 
Includes 366 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
i 
Volumes of equity-accounted entities include volumes of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
j 
Includes 402 million barrels of oil equivalent in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft, including 6 mmboe held through BP’s equity accounted interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha.
k 
Total proved reserves held as part of our equity interest in Rosneft is 7,447 million barrels of oil equivalent, comprising less than 1 million barrels of oil equivalent in Canada, 68 million barrels of oil equivalent in Venezuela, 4 million barrels of oil equivalent in Vietnam and 7,375 million barrels of oil equivalent in Russia.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
231


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves
The following tables set out the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows, and changes therein, relating to crude oil and natural gas production from the group’s estimated proved reserves. This information is prepared in compliance with FASB Oil and Gas Disclosures requirements.
Future net cash flows have been prepared on the basis of certain assumptions which may or may not be realized. These include the timing of future production, the estimation of crude oil and natural gas reserves and the application of average crude oil and natural gas prices and exchange rates from the previous 12 months. Furthermore, both proved reserves estimates and production forecasts are subject to revision as further technical information becomes available and economic conditions change. BP cautions against relying on the information presented because of the highly arbitrary nature of the assumptions on which it is based and its lack of comparability with the historical cost information presented in the financial statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
39,700


160,000

4,100

17,500

30,400


147,500

30,000

429,200

Future production costb
 
15,000


57,600

3,400

7,200

8,500


55,800

7,600

155,100

Future development costb
 
2,100


17,800

1,100

2,800

2,600


16,400

2,500

45,300

Future taxationc
 
8,900


16,600


3,200

5,300


51,100

6,900

92,000

Future net cash flows
 
13,700


68,000

(400
)
4,300

14,000


24,200

13,000

136,800

10% annual discountd
 
5,000


29,900

(200
)
700

3,300


9,400

5,800

53,900

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse f
 
8,700


38,100

(200
)
3,600

10,700


14,800

7,200

82,900

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

12,800



38,500


356,800



408,100

Future production costb
 

4,200



16,100


232,100



252,400

Future development costb
 

800



3,600


19,300



23,700

Future taxationc
 

5,900



4,400


24,000



34,300

Future net cash flows
 

1,900



14,400


81,400



97,700

10% annual discountd
 

600



8,500


48,100



57,200

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsh i
 

1,300



5,900


33,300



40,500

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows
 
8,700

1,300

38,100

(200
)
9,500

10,700

33,300

14,800

7,200

123,400

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and
equity-accounted
entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(18,800
)
(8,000
)
(26,800
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
8,500

4,300

12,800

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
5,800

3,500

9,300

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
41,000

15,800

56,800

Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
(2,100
)
2,100


Net change in taxation
 
(17,000
)
(7,600
)
(24,600
)
Future development costs
 
1,000

(3,500
)
(2,500
)
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
7,600

400

8,000

Addition of 10% annual discount
 
5,200

3,100

8,300

Total change in the standardized measure during the yearj
 
31,200

10,100

41,300

a 
The marker prices used were Brent $71.43/bbl, Henry Hub $3.10/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
In certain situations, revenues and costs are included in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows valuation and excluded from the determination of proved reserves and vice versa. This can result in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows being negative.
f 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $1,100 million.
g 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $2,500 million in Russia.
i 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
i 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft changes to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.

232
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves – continued 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
26,300


99,200

7,100

15,200

27,000


118,800

26,200

319,800

Future production costb
 
13,800


46,700

4,100

7,100

8,600


52,600

8,400

141,300

Future development costb
 
1,700


12,100

1,100

2,400

3,400


18,200

3,200

42,100

Future taxationc
 
4,200


6,500


1,700

3,800


33,200

4,800

54,200

Future net cash flows
 
6,600


33,900

1,900

4,000

11,200


14,800

9,800

82,200

10% annual discountd
 
2,100


13,100

1,100

500

3,400


5,500

4,800

30,500

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse
 
4,500


20,800

800

3,500

7,800


9,300

5,000

51,700

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)f
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

9,000



32,900


205,100

400


247,400

Future production costb
 

4,100



15,500


114,900

300


134,800

Future development costb
 

800



3,400


17,600

100


21,900

Future taxationc
 

3,100



3,100


12,400



18,600

Future net cash flows
 

1,000



10,900


60,200



72,100

10% annual discountd
 

400



6,400


34,900



41,700

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsg h
 

600



4,500


25,300



30,400

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows
 
4,500

600

20,800

800

8,000

7,800

25,300

9,300

5,000

82,100

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(12,800
)
(5,500
)
(18,300
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
9,800

4,200

14,000

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
2,300

1,300

3,600

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
33,100

7,300

40,400

Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
2,800

1,000

3,800

Net change in taxation
 
(12,500
)
(1,500
)
(14,000
)
Future development costs
 
3,000

(4,600
)
(1,600
)
Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
800

(600
)
200

Addition of 10% annual discount
 
2,300

2,600

4,900

Total change in the standardized measure during the yeari
 
28,800

4,200

33,000

a 
The marker prices used were Brent $54.36/bbl, Henry Hub $2.96/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $1,100 million.
f 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
g 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $1,963 million in Russia.
h 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
i 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft changes to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
233


Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows and changes therein relating to proved oil and gas reserves – continued
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia 
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 
21,600


72,400

4,500

11,700

23,600


78,100

24,000

235,900

Future production costb
 
13,900


43,100

3,500

6,600

10,000


42,600

9,400

129,100

Future development costb
 
3,000


14,300

1,100

3,700

5,100


15,400

3,500

46,100

Future taxationc
 
1,700


500


100

2,000


17,800

3,400

25,500

Future net cash flows
 
3,000


14,500

(100
)
1,300

6,500


2,300

7,700

35,200

10% annual discountd e
 
900


4,900


200

2,800


(600
)
4,100

12,300

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowse f
 
2,100


9,600

(100
)
1,100

3,700


2,900

3,600

22,900

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)g
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Future cash inflowsa
 

5,400



34,400


159,900

1,900


201,600

Future production costb
 

3,000



16,500


84,300

1,200


105,000

Future development costb
 

700



3,800


13,200

700


18,400

Future taxationc
 

1,300



3,600


10,100



15,000

Future net cash flows
 

400



10,500


52,300



63,200

10% annual discountd
 

200



6,100


30,700



37,000

Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flowsh i
 

200



4,400


21,600



26,200

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows
 
2,100

200

9,600

(100
)
5,500

3,700

21,600

2,900

3,600

49,100

The following are the principal sources of change in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows:
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
Subsidiaries

Equity-accounted
entities (BP share)

Total subsidiaries and
equity-accounted
entities

Sales and transfers of oil and gas produced, net of production costs
 
(15,200
)
(5,400
)
(20,600
)
Development costs for the current year as estimated in previous year
 
13,100

3,500

16,600

Extensions, discoveries and improved recovery, less related costs
 
700

900

1,600

Net changes in prices and production cost
 
(25,500
)
(5,900
)
(31,400
)
Revisions of previous reserves estimates
 
12,200

1,200

13,400

Net change in taxation
 
(2,500
)
900

(1,600
)
Future development costs
 
4,900

(2,500
)
2,400

Net change in purchase and sales of reserves-in-place
 
1,800

2,900

4,700

Addition of 10% annual discount
 
3,000

2,800

5,800

Total change in the standardized measure during the yearj
 
(7,500
)
(1,600
)
(9,100
)
a 
The marker prices used were Brent $42.82/bbl, Henry Hub $2.46/mmBtu.
b 
Production costs, which include production taxes, and development costs relating to future production of proved reserves are based on the continuation of existing economic conditions. Future decommissioning costs are included.
c 
Taxation is computed with reference to appropriate year-end statutory corporate income tax rates.
d 
Future net cash flows from oil and natural gas production are discounted at 10% regardless of the group assessment of the risk associated with its producing activities.
e 
In certain situations, revenues and costs are included in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows valuation and excluded from the determination of proved reserves and vice versa. This can result in the standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows being negative. Depending on the timing of those cash flows the effect of discounting may be to increase the discounted future net cash flows.
f 
Non-controlling interests in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC amounted to $300 million.
g 
The standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted entities includes standardized measure of discounted future net cash flows of equity-accounted investments of those entities.
h 
Non-controlling interests in Rosneft amounted to $1,608 million in Russia.
i 
No equity-accounted future cash flows in Africa because proved reserves are received as a result of contractual arrangements, with no associated costs.
j 
Total change in the standardized measure during the year includes the effect of exchange rate movements. Exchange rate effects arising from the translation of our share of Rosneft to US dollars are included within ‘Net changes in prices and production cost’.


234
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Operational and statistical information
The following tables present operational and statistical information related to production, drilling, productive wells and acreage. Figures include amounts attributable to assets held for sale.
Crude oil and natural gas production
The following table shows crude oil, natural gas liquids and natural gas production for the years ended 31 December 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Production for the yeara b 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiac

Rest of
Asiad

 
 
Subsidiariese
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilf
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2018
 
101


385

24

7

204


313

17

1,051

2017
 
80


370

20

12

241


325

17

1,064

2016
 
79

24

335

13

10

263


204

16

943

Natural gas liquids
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2018
 
5


60


9

11



2

88

2017
 
6


56


10

10



2

85

2016
 
6

4

56


8

5



3

82

Natural gasg
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
2018
 
152


1,900

7

2,136

1,061


826

819

6,900

2017
 
182


1,659

9

1,936

949


371

783

5,889

2016
 
170

82

1,656

10

1,689

513


363

820

5,302

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilf
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2018
 

34



55

1

933

16


1,040

2017
 

31



63

1

905

99


1,099

2016
 

7



65


840

102


1,015

Natural gas liquids
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
2018
 

2




6

4



12

2017
 

2




6

4



12

2016
 




1

4

4



8

Natural gasg
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
2018
 

59



335

80

1,286



1,760

2017
 

53



418

77

1,308



1,855

2016
 

12



449

18

1,279

15


1,773

a 
Production excludes royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Amounts reported for Russia include BP’s share of Rosneft worldwide activities, including insignificant amounts outside Russia.
d 
Production volume recognition methodology for our Technical Service Contract arrangement in Iraq was simplified in 2016 to exclude the impact of oil price movements on lifting imbalances. A minor adjustment has been made to comparative periods.
e 
All of the oil and liquid production from Canada is bitumen.
f 
Crude oil includes condensate.
g 
Natural gas production excludes gas consumed in operations.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
235


Operational and statistical information – continued
Productive oil and gas wells and acreage
The following tables show the number of gross and net productive oil and natural gas wells and total gross and net developed and undeveloped oil and natural gas acreage in which the group and its equity-accounted entities had interests as at 31 December 2018. A ‘gross’ well or acre is one in which a whole or fractional working interest is owned, while the number of ‘net’ wells or acres is the sum of the whole or fractional working interests in gross wells or acres. Productive wells are producing wells and wells capable of production. Developed acreage is the acreage within the boundary of a field, on which development wells have been drilled, which could produce the reserves; while undeveloped acres are those on which wells have not been drilled or completed to a point that would permit the production of commercial quantities, whether or not such acres contain proved reserves.
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totalb

 
 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russiaa

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Number of productive wells at 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Oil wellsc
– gross
 
116

74

2,677

169

5,356

695

66,147

1,979

12

77,225

 
– net
 
69

22

1,097

45

2,437

466

13,151

445

2

17,734

Gas wellsd
– gross
 
34

1

20,565

244

1,069

209

512

102

78

22,814

 
– net
 
5


10,602

121

379

89

114

45

16

11,371

Oil and natural gas acreage at 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
thousands of acres
 
Developed
– gross
 
81

57

6,263

147

1,336

868

6,751

1,290

173

16,966

 
– net
 
46

17

3,683

64

355

345

1,297

272

41

6,120

Undevelopede
– gross
 
3,067

180

5,012

17,110

19,890

52,698

431,130

8,586

4,022

541,695

 
– net
 
1,861

54

3,700

8,750

6,469

36,504

86,045

2,357

1,889

147,629

a 
Based on information received from Rosneft as at 31 December 2018.
b 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.
c 
Includes approximately 7,381 gross (1,447 net) multiple completion wells (more than one formation producing into the same well bore).
d 
Includes approximately 2,768 gross (1,407 net) multiple completion wells. If one of the multiple completions in a well is an oil completion, the well is classified as an oil well.
e 
Undeveloped acreage includes leases and concessions.
Net oil and gas wells completed or abandoned
The following table shows the number of net productive and dry exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells completed or abandoned in the years indicated by the group and its equity-accounted entities. Productive wells include wells in which hydrocarbons were encountered and the drilling or completion of which, in the case of exploratory wells, has been suspended pending further drilling or evaluation. A dry well is one found to be incapable of producing hydrocarbons in sufficient quantities to justify completion.
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totala

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
0.3


1.7


2.0


15.0

5.0


24.0

Dry
 



0.5

2.0

2.4




4.9

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
1.4

0.6

142.7

5.0

103.9

14.4

137.3

53.5

1.3

460.1

Dry
 


6.8


3.6



2.6


13.0

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
2.8

0.1

1.5

1.2

3.2

2.6

9.4

1.4


22.2

Dry
 
2.4





2.9


1.0


6.3

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
2.5

0.5

124.0

8.0

103.7

16.5

282.7

43.6

1.1

582.6

Dry
 


0.5


1.6

2.1


0.8


5.0

2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
0.3

0.4

0.5


0.6

2.1

3.4

1.6


8.9

Dry
 
1.0

0.3

4.7



1.5


0.3


7.8

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Productive
 
3.4

1.4

145.6


99.8

20.2

88.5

55.2

0.5

414.6

Dry
 
0.8




0.6

2.0


1.0


4.4

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.

236
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Operational and statistical information – continued
Drilling and production activities in progress
The following table shows the number of exploratory and development oil and natural gas wells in the process of being drilled by the group and its equity-accounted entities as of 31 December 2018. Suspended development wells and long-term suspended exploratory wells are also included in the table.
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Totala

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
At 31 December 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exploratory
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 

0.9

5.0


3.0

3.0


3.0


14.9

Net
 

0.3

2.9


0.8

1.3


3.0


8.3

Development
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross
 
9.0

4.6

147.0

5.0

11.0

18.0


108.0


302.6

Net
 
2.9

1.4

80.5

2.5

5.0

9.2


19.0


120.5

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not exactly agree with the sum of their component parts.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
237


























Pages 238-271 have been removed as they do not form part of BP's Annual Report on Form 20-F as filed with the SEC.




























238
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 



























THIS PAGE HAS BEEN LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

















272
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


 
 
 
Additional
disclosures
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Principal accountant’s fees and services
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
273


Selected financial information
This information has been extracted or derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of the BP group. Note 1 to the financial statements includes details on the basis of preparation of these financial statements. The selected information should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements and related notes. The audited consolidated financial statements and related notes as of 31 December 2018 and 2017 and for the three years ended 31 December 2018 are presented on page 126.
 
 
$ million except per share amounts
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

2015

2014

Income statement data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and other operating revenues
 
298,756

240,208

183,008

222,894

353,568

Profit (loss) before interest and taxation
 
19,378

9,474

(430
)
(7,918
)
6,412

Finance costs and net finance expense relating to pensions and other post-retirement benefits
 
(2,655
)
(2,294
)
(1,865
)
(1,653
)
(1,462
)
Taxation
 
(7,145
)
(3,712
)
2,467

3,171

(947
)
Non-controlling interests
 
(195
)
(79
)
(57
)
(82
)
(223
)
Profit (loss) for the yeara
 
9,383

3,389

115

(6,482
)
3,780

Inventory holding (gains) losses«, before tax
 
801

(853
)
(1,597
)
1,889

6,210

Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses
 
(198
)
225

483

(569
)
(1,917
)
RC profit (loss)«for the year
 
9,986

2,761

(999
)
(5,162
)
8,073

Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items« and fair value accounting effects«, before taxb
 
3,380

3,730

6,746

15,067

8,234

Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(643
)
(325
)
(3,162
)
(4,000
)
(4,171
)
Underlying RC profit«for the year
 
12,723

6,166

2,585

5,905

12,136

Earnings per sharec – cents
 
 
 
 
 
 
Profit (loss) for the yeara per ordinary share
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
46.98

17.20

0.61

(35.39
)
20.55

Diluted
 
46.67

17.10

0.60

(35.39
)
20.42

RC profit (loss) for the year per ordinary share«
 
50.00

14.02

(5.33
)
(28.18
)
43.90

Underlying RC profit for the year per ordinary share«
 
63.70

31.31

13.79

32.22

66.00

Dividends paid per share – cents
 
40.50

40.00

40.00

40.00

39.00

– pence
 
30.568

30.979

29.418

26.383

23.850

Capital expenditure«d
 
 
 
 
 
 
Organic capital expenditure«
 
15,140

16,501

16,675

N/A

N/A

Inorganic capital expenditure«
 
9,948

1,339

777

N/A

N/A

 
 
25,088

17,840

17,452

20,202

23,192

Balance sheet data (at 31 December)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
282,176

276,515

263,316

261,832

284,305

Net assets
 
101,548

100,404

96,843

98,387

112,642

Share capital
 
5,402

5,343

5,284

5,049

5,023

BP shareholders’ equity
 
99,444

98,491

95,286

97,216

111,441

Finance debt due after more than one year
 
56,426

55,491

51,666

46,224

45,977

Net debt to net debt plus equity«
 
30.3%
27.4%
26.8%
21.6%
16.7%
Ordinary share datae
 
Share million
 
Basic weighted average number of shares
 
19,970

19,693

18,745

18,324

18,385

Diluted weighted average number of shares
 
20,102

19,816

18,855

18,324

18,497

a 
Profit attributable to BP shareholders.
b 
See pages 276 and 320 for further analysis of these items.
c 
A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.
d 
From 2017 onwards BP reports organic, inorganic and total capital expenditure on a cash basis which were previously reported on an accruals basis. This aligns with BP's financial framework and is consistent with other financial metrics used when comparing sources and uses of cash. An analysis of capital expenditure on a cash basis for 2015 and 2014 is not available.
e 
The number of ordinary shares shown has been used to calculate the per share amounts.















274
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Additional information
Capital expenditure
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Capital expenditure
 
 
 
 
Organic capital expenditure
 
15,140

16,501

16,675

Inorganic capital expenditurea
 
9,948

1,339

777

 
 
25,088

17,840

17,452

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Organic capital expenditure by segment
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
3,482

2,999

3,415

Non-US
 
8,545

10,764

10,929

 
 
12,027

13,763

14,344

Downstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
877

809

774

Non-US
 
1,904

1,590

1,328

 
 
2,781

2,399

2,102

Other businesses and corporate
 






US
 
54

64

32

Non-US
 
278

275

197

 
 
332

339

229

 
 
15,140

16,501

16,675

Organic capital expenditure by geographical area
 
 
 
 
US
 
4,413

3,872

4,221

Non-US
 
10,727

12,629

12,454

 
 
15,140

16,501

16,675

a On 31 October 2018, BP acquired from BHP Billiton Petroleum (North America) Inc. 100% of the issued share capital of Petrohawk Energy Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of BHP that holds a portfolio of unconventional onshore US oil and gas assets. As at 31 December 2018, $6,788 million of the consideration had been paid. 2018 includes $1,739 million relating to the purchase of an additional 16.5% interest in the Clair field west of Shetland in the North Sea, as part of the agreements with ConocoPhillips in which ConocoPhillips simultaneously purchased BP's entire 39.2% interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope of Alaska. 2018 also includes amounts relating to the 25-year extension to our ACG production-sharing agreement« in Azerbaijan. 2017 includes amounts paid to acquire interests in Mauritania and Senegal and in the Zohr gas field in Egypt.
 


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
275


Non-operating items
Non-operating items are charges and credits included in the financial statements that BP discloses separately because it considers such disclosures to be meaningful and relevant to investors. They are items that management considers not to be part of underlying business operations and are disclosed in order to enable investors to understand better and evaluate the group’s reported financial performance. An analysis of non-operating items is shown in the table below.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Upstream
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa b
 
(90
)
(563
)
2,391

Environmental and other provisions
 
(35
)
1

(8
)
Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
(131
)
(24
)
(373
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 
17

33

32

Otherb d
 
56

(118
)
(289
)
 
 
(183
)
(671
)
1,753

Downstream
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa e
 
(54
)
579

405

Environmental and other provisions
 
(83
)
(19
)
(73
)
Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
(405
)
(171
)
(300
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Other
 
(174
)

(56
)
 
 
(716
)
389

(24
)
Rosneft
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assets
 
(95
)

62

Environmental and other provisions
 



Restructuring, integration and rationalization costs
 



Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Other
 


(39
)
 
 
(95
)

23

Other businesses and corporate
 
 
 
 
Impairment and gain (loss) on sale of businesses and fixed assetsa
 
(260
)
(22
)

Environmental and other provisionsf
 
(640
)
(156
)
(134
)
Restructuring, integration and rationalization costsc
 
(190
)
(72
)
(90
)
Fair value gain (loss) on embedded derivatives
 



Gulf of Mexico oil spill responseg
 
(714
)
(2,687
)
(6,640
)
Other
 
(159
)
90

(55
)
 
 
(1,963
)
(2,847
)
(6,919
)
Total before interest and taxation
 
(2,957
)
(3,129
)
(5,167
)
Finance costsg
 
(479
)
(493
)
(494
)
Total before taxation
 
(3,436
)
(3,622
)
(5,661
)
Taxation credit (charge) on non-operating itemsh
 
510

1,172

2,833

Taxation - impact of US tax reformi
 
121

(859
)

Total after taxation
 
(2,805
)
(3,309
)
(2,828
)
a 
See Financial statements – Note 4 for further information.
b 
2018 includes an impairment reversal for assets in the North Sea and Angola. 2017 includes an impairment charge relating to BPX Energy (previously known as the US Lower 48 business), partially offset by gains associated with asset divestments. In addition, 2017 includes an impairment charge arising following the announcement of the agreement to sell the Forties Pipeline System business to INEOS. 2016 includes a $319-million exploration write-back relating to Block KG D6 in India. In addition, an impairment reversal of $234 million was also recorded in relation to this block.
c 
Restructuring charges are classified as non-operating items where they relate to an announced major group restructuring. A major group restructuring is a restructuring programme affecting more than one of the group’s operating segments that is expected to result in charges of more than $1 billion over a defined period. Following the Gulf of Mexico oil spill in 2010 and since the fall in oil prices in late 2014, major group restructuring programmes were initiated.The group's restructuring programme, originally announced in 2014, has now been completed.
d 
2018 and 2017 include exploration write-offs of $124 million and $145 million respectively in relation to the value ascribed to certain licences in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico as part of the accounting for the acquisition of upstream assets from Devon Energy in 2011. 2017 also includes BP’s share of an impairment reversal recognized by the Angola LNG equity-accounted entity, partially offset by other items. 2016 includes the write-off of $334 million in relation to the value ascribed to the licence in Brazil as part of the accounting for the acquisition of upstream assets from Devon Energy in 2011.
e 
2017 primarily reflects the disposal of our shareholding in the SECCO joint venture.
f 
2018 primarily reflects charges due to the annual update of environmental provisions, including asbestos-related provisions for past operations, together with updates of non-Gulf of Mexico oil spill related legal provisions.
g 
See Financial statements – Note 2 for further details regarding costs relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill.
h 
2017 includes the tax effect of the increase in the provision in the fourth quarter for business economic loss and other claims associated with the Deepwater Horizon Court Supervised Settlement Program (DHCSSP) at the new US tax rate.
i 
In 2017 the US tax reform reduced the US federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, effective from 1 January 2018. The impact disclosed has been calculated as the change in deferred tax balances at 31 December 2017, excluding the increase in the provision in the fourth quarter for business economic loss and other claims associated with the DHCSSP, which arises following the reduction in the tax rate. 2018 reflects a further impact following a clarification of the tax reform. The impact of the US tax reform has been treated as a non-operating item because it is not considered to be part of underlying business operations, has a material impact upon the reported result and is substantially impacted by Gulf of Mexico oil spill charges, which are also treated as non-operating items. Separate disclosure is considered meaningful and relevant to investors.


276
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Liquidity and capital resources
Financial framework
BP’s financial framework sets a number of parameters in support of growing shareholder value, distributions and returns, while maintaining a strong balance sheet. BP’s objective over time is to grow sustainable free cash flow« through a combination of operating cash flow« growth and capital discipline, in service of growing shareholder distributions over the long term.
We maintain our progressive dividend policy and the commitment to the share buyback programme and expect the impact of the scrip dilution since the third quarter of 2017 to be fully offset by the end of 2019. The shape of the buyback programme will reflect ongoing consideration of factors including changes in the environment, the underlying performance of the business, the outlook for the group financial framework, and other market factors which may vary quarter to quarter.
We expect operating cash flow excluding amounts relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill to continue to cover organic capital expenditure« of $15-17 billion and the full dividend« (including scrip) at around $50 per barrel. Looking further out, this balancing point is expected to steadily reduce to $35-40 per barrel by 2021, with organic capital expenditure in a range of $15-17 billion per year. In a constant price environment, surplus organic free cash flow« is expected to grow and be used to ensure the right balance between deleveraging the balance sheet, growing distributions and disciplined investment, depending on the context and outlook at the time.
Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments were just over $3 billion in 2018, are expected to step down to around $2 billion in 2019 and around $1 billion per annum thereafter. Over the next two years we plan to complete more than $10 billion of divestments and we expect divestment proceeds« subsequently to revert to the historical norm of around $2-3 billion per annum.
We continue to target a gearing« band on a pre-IFRS 16 basis of 20-30%, while maintaining strong liquidity and debt market access. Payments for the acquisition of BHP’s onshore US assets using available cash moved gearing to 30.3% at the end of 2018. Gearing is expected to move towards the middle of the band in 2020 in line with the generation of free cash flow and receipt of disposal proceeds.
In 2018, the return on average capital employed« was 11.2%a at an average of $71 per barrel. At $55 per barrel real, return on average capital employed is targeted to improve to over 10% by 2021, as we continue to grow our underlying business.
a Nearest equivalent GAAP measures: Numerator – Profit attributable to BP shareholders $9.4 billion; Denominator – Average capital employed $165.5 billion.
Dividends and other distributions to shareholders
The dividend is determined in US dollars, the economic currency of BP, and the dividend level is regularly reviewed by the board. The quarterly dividend was increased to 10.25 cents per share from the third quarter of 2018 (2017 10 cents per share).
The total dividend distributed to BP shareholders in 2018 was $8.1 billion (2017 $7.9 billion). Shareholders have the option to receive a scrip dividend in place of receiving cash. In 2018 the total dividend paid in cash was $6.7 billion (2017 $6.2 billion).
Details of share repurchases to satisfy the requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans are set out on page 312. The share buyback programme to offset the dilutive impact of the scrip dividend purchased 50 million ordinary shares in 2018 at a cost of $355 million, including fees and stamp duty.
Financing the group’s activities
The group’s principal commodities, oil and gas, are priced internationally in US dollars. Group policy has generally been to minimize economic exposure to currency movements by financing
 
operations with US dollar debt. Where debt is issued in other currencies, including euros, it is generally swapped back to US dollars using derivative contracts, or else hedged by maintaining offsetting cash positions in the same currency. Cash balances of the group are mainly held in US dollars or swapped to US dollars and holdings are well diversified to reduce concentration risk. The group is not, therefore, exposed to significant currency risk regarding its cash or borrowings. Also see Risk factors on page 55 for further information on risks associated with prices and markets and Financial statements – Note 29.
The group’s gross debt at 31 December 2018 amounted to $65.8 billion (2017 $63.2 billion). Of the total gross debt, $9.4 billion is classified as short term at the end of 2018 (2017 $7.7 billion). See Financial statements – Note 26 for more information on the short-term balance. Net debt« was $44.1 billion at the end of 2018, an increase of $6.3 billion from the 2017 year-end position of $37.8 billion.
The ratio of gross debt to gross debt plus equity at 31 December 2018 was 39.3% (2017 38.6%). The ratio of net debt to net debt plus equity« was 30.3% at the end of 2018 (2017 27.4%). See Financial statements – Note 27 for gross debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis, and for further information on net debt.
Cash and cash equivalents of $22.5 billion at 31 December 2018 (2017 $25.6 billion) are included in net debt. We manage our cash position to ensure the group has adequate cover to respond to potential short-term market illiquidity, and expect to maintain a robust cash position.
The group also has undrawn committed bank facilities of $7.6 billion (see Financial statements – Note 29 for more information).
We believe that the group has sufficient working capital for foreseeable requirements, taking into account the amounts of undrawn borrowing facilities and levels of cash and cash equivalents, and its ongoing ability to generate cash.
BP utilizes various arrangements in order to manage its working capital including discounting of receivables and, in the supply and trading business, the active management of supplier payment terms, inventory and collateral.
Standard & Poor’s Ratings’ long-term credit rating for BP is A- (stable outlook) and the Moody’s Investors Service rating is A1 (stable outlook).
The group’s sources of funding, its access to capital markets and maintaining a strong cash position are described in Financial statements – Note 25 and Note 29. On 14 December 2018, BP completed the exchange of $10.5 billion of notes previously issued by BP Capital Markets p.l.c for new notes issued by BP Capital Markets America Inc. in order to optimize the BP group’s capital structure and align revenue generation to indebtedness. Further information on the management of liquidity risk and credit risk, and the maturity profile and fixed/floating rate characteristics of the group’s debt are also provided in Financial statements – Note 26 and Note 29.
Off-balance sheet arrangements
At 31 December 2018, the group’s share of third-party finance debt of equity-accounted entities was $16.1 billion (2017 $18.0 billion). These amounts are not reflected in the group’s debt on the balance sheet. The group has issued third-party guarantees under which amounts outstanding, incremental to amounts recognized on the balance sheet, at 31 December 2018 were $696 million (2017 $656 million) in respect of liabilities of joint ventures«and associates«and $432 million (2017 $382 million) in respect of liabilities of other third parties. Of these amounts, $684 million (2017 $645 million) of the joint ventures and associates guarantees relate to borrowings and for other third-party guarantees, $423 million (2017 $350 million) relate to guarantees of borrowings. Details of operating lease commitments, which are not recognized on the balance sheet, are shown in the table below and provided in Financial statements – Note 28.

The information above contains forward-looking statements, which by their nature involve risk and uncertainty because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that will or may occur in the future and are outside the control of BP. You are urged to read the Cautionary statement on page 303 and Risk factors on page 55, which describe the risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
277


Contractual obligations
The following table summarizes the group’s capital expenditure commitments for property, plant and equipment at 31 December 2018 and the proportion of that expenditure for which contracts have been placed.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Payments due by period
 
Capital expenditure
 
Total

2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

2024 and thereafter

Committed
 
26,378

12,749

5,689

3,456

1,653

1,001

1,830

of which is contracted
 
8,319

5,646

1,742

528

157

53

193

Capital expenditure is considered to be committed when the project has received the appropriate level of internal management approval. For joint operations«, the net BP share is included in the amounts above.
In addition, at 31 December 2018, the group had committed to capital expenditure relating to investments in equity-accounted entities amounting to $1,411 million. Contracts were in place for $1,170 million of this total.
The following table summarizes the group’s principal contractual obligations at 31 December 2018, distinguishing between those for which a liability is recognized on the balance sheet and those for which no liability is recognized. Further information on borrowings is given in Financial statements – Note 26 and more information on operating leases is given in Financial statements – Note 28.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Payments due by period
 
Expected payments by period under contractual obligations
 
Total

2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

2024 and thereafter

Balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Borrowingsa
 
74,587

11,607

8,646

8,410

9,385

8,110

28,429

Finance lease future minimum lease paymentsb
 
1,350

98

97

95

94

86

880

Decommissioning liabilitiesc
 
23,807

290

169

107

339

96

22,806

Environmental liabilitiesc
 
1,663

300

303

219

173

136

532

Gulf of Mexico oil spill liabilitiesd
 
18,360

2,302

1,569

1,343

1,267

1,219

10,660

Pensions and other post-retirement benefitse
 
19,114

1,237

1,211

1,149

1,084

1,067

13,366

 
 
138,881

15,834

11,995

11,323

12,342

10,714

76,673

Off-balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Operating lease future minimum lease paymentsf
 
11,979

2,511

1,875

1,446

1,124

914

4,109

Unconditional purchase obligationsg
 
144,660

69,676

16,422

11,479

8,326

6,715

32,042

 
 
156,639

72,187

18,297

12,925

9,450

7,629

36,151

Total
 
295,520

88,021

30,292

24,248

21,792

18,343

112,824

a 
Expected payments include interest totalling $10,646 million ($2,350 million in 2019, $1,904 million in 2020, $1,653 million in 2021, $1,379 million in 2022, $1,101 million in 2023 and $2,259 million thereafter).
b 
Expected payments include interest totalling $683 million ($54 million in 2019, $51 million in 2020, $47 million in 2021, $43 million in 2022, $37 million in 2023 and $451 million thereafter).
c 
The amounts presented are undiscounted.
d 
The amounts presented are undiscounted. Gulf of Mexico oil spill liabilities are included in the group balance sheet, on a discounted basis, within other payables. See Financial statements – Note 2 for further information.
e 
Represents the expected future contributions to funded pension plans and payments by the group for unfunded pension plans and the expected future payments for other post-retirement benefits.
f 
The future minimum lease payments are before deducting related rental income from operating sub-leases. In the case of an operating lease entered into solely by BP as the operator of a joint operation, the amounts shown in the table represent the net future minimum lease payments, after deducting amounts reimbursed, or to be reimbursed, by joint operation partners. Where BP is not the operator of a joint operation, BP’s share of the future minimum lease payments are included in the amounts shown, whether BP has co-signed the lease or not. Where operating lease costs are incurred in relation to the hire of equipment used in connection with a capital project, some or all of the cost may be capitalized as part of the capital cost of the project.
g 
Represents any agreement to purchase goods or services that is enforceable and legally binding and that specifies all significant terms (such as fixed or minimum purchase volumes, timing of purchase and pricing provisions). Agreements that do not specify all significant terms, or that are not enforceable, are excluded. The amounts shown include arrangements to secure long-term access to supplies of crude oil, natural gas, feedstocks and pipeline systems. In addition, the amounts shown for 2019 include purchase commitments existing at 31 December 2018 entered into principally to meet the group’s short-term manufacturing and marketing requirements. The price risk associated with these crude oil, natural gas and power contracts is discussed in Financial statements – Note 29.

The following table summarizes the nature of the group’s unconditional purchase obligations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Payments due by period
 
Unconditional purchase obligations
 
Total

2019

2020

2021

2022

2023

2024 and thereafter

Crude oil and oil products
 
62,801

43,265

6,395

4,679

2,769

2,356

3,337

Natural gas
 
27,642

14,916

4,922

2,880

2,325

1,555

1,044

Chemicals and other refinery feedstocks
 
6,715

4,857

923

298

291

118

228

Power
 
5,573

3,296

1,087

494

158

113

425

Utilities
 
1,037

163

138

80

64

64

528

Transportation
 
21,682

1,740

1,480

1,580

1,412

1,412

14,058

Use of facilities and services
 
19,210

1,439

1,477

1,468

1,307

1,097

12,422

Total
 
144,660

69,676

16,422

11,479

8,326

6,715

32,042


278
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Upstream analysis by region
Our upstream operations are set out below by geographical area, with associated significant events for 2018. BP’s percentage working interest in oil and gas assets is shown in brackets. Working interest is the cost-bearing ownership share of an oil or gas lease. Consequently, the percentages disclosed for certain agreements do not necessarily reflect the percentage interests in proved reserves and production.
In addition to exploration, development and production activities, our upstream business also includes midstream and liquefied natural gas (LNG) supply activities. Midstream activities involve the ownership and management of crude oil and natural gas pipelines, processing facilities and export terminals, LNG processing facilities and transportation, and our natural gas liquids (NGLs) processing business.
Our LNG supply activities are located in Abu Dhabi, Angola, Australia, Indonesia and Trinidad. We market around 3.5 million tonnes per annum of our LNG production to IST, which uses contractual rights to access import terminal capacity in the liquid markets of Italy (Rovigo), the Netherlands (Gate), Spain (Bilbao), the UK (the Isle of Grain) and the US (Cove Point), with the remainder marketed directly to customers. LNG is supplied to customers in markets including Argentina, China, the Dominican Republic, India, Japan, Kuwait, South Korea, Taiwan and Thailand.
Europe
BP is active in the North Sea and the Norwegian Sea. In 2018 BP’s production came from three key areas: the Shetland area comprising the Clair, Foinaven, Magnus and Schiehallion fields; the central area comprising the Andrew area, Bruce, ETAP, Keith, Kinnoull and Rhum fields; and Norway, through our equity accounted 30% interest in Aker BP.
In July we announced that we had entered into an agreement with ConocoPhillips to increase our holding in the Clair field (prior to the increase BP 29% and operator) by 16.5%, while selling our non-operated interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope of Alaska as well as our holding in the Kuparuk Transportation Company. Clair is the largest oilfield on the UK Continental Shelf. The transaction completed in December.
In September we received approval from the Oil and Gas Authority (OGA) to proceed with the Vorlich development (BP 66% and operator). Located 240 kilometres east of Aberdeen, in the central North Sea, Vorlich will consist of two wells tied back to the existing Ithaca Energy-operated FPF-1 floating production facility. The development is part of a programme of North Sea subsea tie-back developments that seek to access new production from fields located near to established producing infrastructure. The field is expected to come onstream in 2020.
In October EnQuest notified BP that it would exercise its option to acquire the remaining 75% of BP’s stake in the Magnus field and associated infrastructure. The disposal completed at the end of November. EnQuest acquired the initial 25% of BP’s interest in the Magnus field and associated infrastructure in December 2017.
Also in October we received approval from OGA to proceed with the Alligin development (BP 50% and operator). Located 140 kilometres west of Shetland, Alligin is part of the Greater Schiehallion area. We announced our intention to develop it in April. The development will consist of two wells tied back to the existing Schiehallion and Loyal subsea infrastructure, and is expected to come onstream in 2020.
Development progressed at the Total-operated Culzean field (BP 32%) during the year. The field will be developed with three fixed platforms and a floating storage unit. At the end of 2018, construction activities were complete and the hook-up and commissioning activities were underway, with first production expected in 2019.
In November 2017 we announced that we had agreed to sell a package of our interests in the North Sea comprising the Bruce (BP 37%), Keith (BP 35%) and Rhum (BP 50%) fields, three bridge-linked platforms and associated subsea infrastructure to Serica
 
Energy plc. We operated the assets through the year until the sale and transfer of ownership completed at the end of November 2018.
In November as part of the sale of Rhum to Serica Energy plc the US Office of Foreign Assets Control issued a joint licence to BP and Serica permitting certain US persons and US owned and controlled companies to support Rhum activities in compliance with US primary sanctions and a letter of comfort permitting all non-US persons to support Rhum activities in compliance with US secondary sanctions. The Rhum field is now owned by Serica (50%) and the Iranian Oil Company (U.K.) Limited (IOC, 50%) under a joint operating agreement. The shares in IOC are now held in trust. See International Trade Sanctions on page 298.
In November we announced the start-up of production at Clair Ridge – the second phase of development at the Clair field. Two new, bridge-linked platforms and oil and gas export pipelines have been constructed as part of the project. The new facilities, which required capital investment in excess of $6 billion, are designed for around 40 years of production.
North America
Our upstream activities in North America are located in five areas: deepwater Gulf of Mexico, the Lower 48 states, Alaska, Canada and Mexico.
BP has around 240 lease blocks in the deepwater Gulf of Mexico and operates four production hubs.
In October we announced the start-up of the Northwest Expansion project at our Thunder Horse platform, under budget and ahead of schedule. The project, which achieved first oil just 16 months after being sanctioned, adds a new subsea manifold and two wells tied into existing flowlines two miles to the north of the platform. The new project is expected to boost production at Thunder Horse and is the third major field expansion there in recent years.
We participated in lease sales 250 and 251 during the year, and were awarded 44 leases in total.
In December BP received approval from the Bureau of Safety Environmental Enforcement of the assignment of Chevron’s interest in the Tiber and Guadalupe leases. BP now has a 100% working interest in these leases.
Exploration write-offs totalling $447 million were recognized in 2018, driven primarily by lease relinquishment ($131 million of this was recognized as a non-operating item).
In February 2019 we announced the start-up of the Constellation project (BP 66.67%), operated by Anadarko.
See also Financial statements – Note 1 for further information on exploration leases.
The US Lower 48 onshore new combined business, following acquisition of BHP's unconventional assets (see below), has significant operated and non-operated activities across Colorado, Louisiana, New Mexico, Oklahoma, Texas and Wyoming producing natural gas, oil, NGLs and condensate. It had a 2.4 billion boe proved reserve base as at 31 December 2018, predominantly in unconventional reservoirs (tight gas«, shale gas and coalbed methane, and newly acquired shale oil). This resource spans 3.5 million net developed acres and has approximately 12,000 operated gross wells, with daily net production around 500mboe/d.
Since the beginning of 2015, our US Lower 48 onshore business has operated as a separate business while remaining part of our Upstream segment. With its own governance, systems and processes, it was established to increase competitive performance through swift decision making and innovation, while maintaining BP’s commitment to safe, reliable and compliant operations. In October 2018 we announced that we had changed the name of our Lower 48 business to BPX Energy.
In October we completed the acquisition of BHP’s US unconventional assets in a landmark deal that will significantly upgrade our US onshore oil and gas portfolio and help drive long-term growth. The acquisition, which was announced in July, adds oil and gas production of 190mboe/d in the liquids-rich regions of

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
279


the Permian and Eagle Ford basins in Texas and in the Haynesville natural gas basin in East Texas and Louisiana.  
As part of the BHP acquisition announcement, BPX Energy expects to divest some existing assets to shift the organization’s core focus towards the newly-acquired BHP assets. The divestment includes core positions in San Juan, Wamsutter, Anadarko, Arkoma, legacy East Texas and Southwest Oklahoma basins, as well as diversified non-operated royalty and working interests across the US Lower 48.
BP’s onshore US crude oil and product pipelines and related transportation assets are included in the Downstream segment.
In Alaska, BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. (BPXA) operated nine North Slope oilfields in the Greater Prudhoe Bay area at the end of the year. For the past four years BP has slowed decline at Prudhoe Bay through wellwork and improved operating field efficiencies, with production being largely maintained. Infrastructure renewal activities in 2018 included compressor replacements, fire and gas system upgrades, safety system upgrades, pipeline renewal, and facility piping upgrade projects. BP owns significant interests in three producing fields operated by others, as well as a non-operating interest in the Liberty development project and owned significant interests in an additional five producing fields operated by others prior to the sale of our interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area (see below).
In July we announced the sale of our non-operated 39.2% interest in the Greater Kuparuk Area on the North Slope comprising five fields, as well as our holding in the Kuparuk Transportation Company to ConocoPhillips. The transaction received all regulatory approvals and closed in December, with a retroactive effective date of 1 July 2018.
In May 2018 BP signed a Gas Sales Precedent Agreement with the Alaska Gas Development Corporation detailing key terms for potential future gas sales to the State. In addition, in September an amendment to the Point Thomson development plan was agreed with the State to better align field milestones to those of the Alaska LNG project.
BP Pipelines (Alaska) Inc. (BPPA) owns a 49% interest in the Trans-Alaska Pipeline System (TAPS). TAPS transports crude oil from Prudhoe Bay on the Alaska North Slope to the port of Valdez in southcentral Alaska. In April 2012 Unocal (1.37%) gave notice to the other TAPS owners of their intention to withdraw as an owner of TAPS. The remaining owners and Unocal have not yet reached agreement regarding the terms for the transfer of Unocal’s interest in TAPS.
In 2017 the parties involved in TAPS tariff matters at the Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC) and the Regulatory Commission of Alaska (RCA) reached an agreement to settle all pending legal challenges involving TAPS interstate rates at FERC for the years 2009-15 and establish a mechanism for calculating interstate rate ceilings for TAPS for the period from 2016 through 2021, as well as subsequent years unless otherwise terminated. The agreement resolved all challenges involving TAPS intrastate rates from 2008 to 2019 and established intrastate rate ceilings for the future through to 30 June 2019. RCA approval was granted in January and FERC approval in February and all associated settlement amounts and tariff refunds were paid.
In September BP Alaska removed one of its four Alaska grade crude oil tankers from service (the vessel Frontier). Historically, BP Alaska has utilized four tankers to carry crude oil shipments from Alaska. With the reduction in volume over time, as well as new efficiencies identified in the shipping programme, Frontier has been removed from service and its carrying value impaired accordingly.
In Canada BP is focused on oil sands development as well as pursuing offshore exploration opportunities. We utilize in-situ steam-assisted gravity drainage (SAGD) technology in our oil sands developments, which uses the injection of steam into the reservoir to warm the bitumen so that it can flow to the surface through producing wells. We hold interests in three oil sands lease areas through the Sunrise Oil Sands and Terre de Grace partnerships and the Pike Oil Sands joint operation«. In addition, we have significant
 
offshore exploration licences in Nova Scotia, Newfoundland and Labrador and the Canadian Beaufort Sea.
The government of Canada continued with its plans to introduce legislation to allow it to suspend any oil and gas activities in the Beaufort Sea.
In Mexico, we have interests in two exploration joint operations« in the Salina Basin with Equinor and Total, Block 1 (BP 33% and operator) and Block 3 (BP 33%), and in one exploration joint operation in the Sureste Basin with Total and Hokchi, a subsidiary of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG), Block 34 (BP 42.5% and operator). Both Salina Basin operations received exploration plan approval in March from Comisión Nacional de Hidrocarburos (CNH), the Mexican regulator. Seismic interpretation and well pre-spud activities are taking place in 2018 and 2019 with the tentative plan to commence drilling in the first half of 2020. The Sureste Basin operation submitted an exploration plan for approval to CNH at the end of December.
South America
BP has upstream activities in Brazil and Trinidad & Tobago and through PAEG, in Argentina and Bolivia.
In Brazil BP has interests in 25 exploration concessions across five basins.
In the North Campos basin, BP was nominated as operator following Anadarko's withdrawal from both the BM-C-30 and BM-C-32 blocks. Regulatory consent is being sought for both Anadarko's exit and the operatorship transfer. The consortium decided not to perform the previously planned extended well test during the year. Instead it elected to finalize the appraisal plans and request a postponement of up to five years to decide whether the projects are commercially feasible. During this period, the consortium will assess alternative development concepts. Approval of this request by the Brazilian National Petroleum Agency (ANP) is still pending.
BP continues to progress the preparatory activities for drilling exploration wells in the Foz do Amazonas Basin, with a BP-operated well scheduled to start drilling in 2021. An extension request to August 2020 was approved by the ANP regarding the BP-operated Block FZA-M-59. BP is monitoring developments on its other non-operated interests in the Foz de Amazonas basin (BP 30%) to establish an expected drilling activity schedule.
In the South Campos basin, BP's request for a contract suspension in Block BM-C-35 is under review by the ANP.
BP won Blocks C-M-755 and C-M-793 at the 15th bid round in March in a consortium with Equinor (BP 60%).
In June BP won the licence for the Dois Irmãos block located in the Campos basin, offshore Brazil, as a result of the fourth Pre-Salt Production Sharing Contract Bid Round (Petrobras operator 45%, BP 30%, and Equinor 25%).
BP accessed new acreage in the Santos basin, offshore Brazil in September by winning the licence for the Pau Brasil block (BP 50% and operator). This represents BP’s first operated production sharing acreage in the Santos basin.
In October drilling commenced at the Peroba block (BP 40%). Well results are expected in the first quarter of 2019.
In Argentina and Bolivia BP conducts activity through PAEG, a joint venture that is owned by BP (50%) and Bridas Corporation (50%). PAEG also has activities in Mexico.
In Trinidad & Tobago BP holds exploration and production licences and production-sharing agreements«(PSAs) covering 1.8 million acres offshore of the east and north-east coast. Facilities include 14 offshore platforms and two onshore processing facilities. Production comprises gas and associated liquids.
BP also has a shareholding in the Atlantic LNG liquefaction plant. BP’s shareholding averages 39% across four LNG trains« with a combined capacity of 15 million tonnes per annum. We sell gas to train 1, 2 and 3 and process gas in train 4. All LNG from train 1 and most of the LNG from trains 2 and 3 is sold to third parties under

280
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


long-term contracts. BP’s LNG entitlement from trains 2, 3 and 4 is marketed to the US, Europe, Asia and South America.
In December, the Cassia compression project was sanctioned. This project involves the installation of a new compression platform (Cassia C), bridge-linked to the Cassia B processing platform and providing lowered wellhead pressures to fields served by the Cassia hub. The expected project start-up date is 2021.
Negotiations of three historical upstream commercial issues were completed with the government of the Republic of Trinidad & Tobago at the end of 2018. This resulted in a payment of $144 million representing final settlement.
The Atlantic LNG Train 1 gas supply contract is currently being negotiated for the period April 2019 to September 2024. 
Discussions are ongoing with partners in the Manakin project on the Unit Operating Agreement (UOA), Field Development Plan and subsurface arrangements following declaration of commerciality in January 2018. The UOA is expected to be agreed in 2019. Manakin, discovered in 1998, is a cross-border field with Venezuela.
In October the Bongos exploration well in the deepwater Block 14 (BP 30%) was announced as a discovery. Assessment of the well results is currently in progress.
The Angelin project, sanctioned in June 2017, involves the construction of a new platform, BP’s 15th offshore production facility, 60 kilometres off the south-east coast of Trinidad in water depths of approximately 65 metres. The development includes four wells, with gas from Angelin flowing to the Cassia B hub for processing via a new pipeline to the Serrette platform. During 2018 the jacket and topsides were installed and subsea skid and pipeline installation was also completed. The first well was completed in January 2019 and the project commenced production in February 2019.
Africa
BP’s upstream activities in Africa are located in Algeria, Angola, Côte d'Ivoire, Egypt, Libya, Madagascar, Mauritania, São Tomé & Príncipe and Senegal.
In Algeria BP, Sonatrach and Equinor are partners in the In Salah (BP 33.15%) and In Amenas (BP 45.89%) projects that supply gas to the domestic and European markets.
In December 2017 BP and Equinor signed an extension agreement for the In Amenas production sharing contract with Sonatrach, the Algerian state-owned energy company. The agreement was formally ratified in April 2018.
In Angola, BP owns an interest in five major deepwater offshore licences and is operator in two of these, Blocks 18 and 31, that are producing. We also have an equity interest in the Angola LNG plant (BP 13.6%).
During the year a final investment decision (FID) on Block 17 was made by the operator, Total, to proceed with the Zinia 2 deep offshore development project (BP 16.67%).
In December, BP announced it had taken the FID to progress the Platina project in Block 18. The agreement also extends the production licence for the Greater Plutonio operation in Block 18 to 2032, and provides for Sonangol to take an 8% equity interest in the block, all subject to government approval.
The Block 25/11 production sharing agreement expired in January 2019. The remaining intangible asset of $42 million associated with the licence acquisition cost was written off at the start of 2018 as no further drilling activity was planned.
In Côte d’Ivoire, BP has interests in five offshore oil blocks with Kosmos Energy (KE) under agreements with the government of Côte d'Ivoire and the state oil company Société Nationale d'Operations Pétrolières de la Côte d'Ivoire (PETROCI) (BP 45%, KE 45% and operator, PETROCI approximately 10%). New 3D seismic data was acquired during the year and analysis of it is ongoing.
In Egypt, BP and its partners currently produce 10% of Egypt’s liquids« production and over 50% of its gas production.
 
The Atoll field in the North Damietta concession came fully onstream at the start of 2018.
In 2018 exploration write-offs of $236 million were recognized, the most significant being $169 million in connection with withdrawal from the Rahamat lease.
Following concept sanction in 2017, BP continued progressing the Baltim South West field. Two wells are planned in 2019 followed by further development wells in 2020. A new nine-slot platform will be installed and tied back to existing infrastructure (Abu Madi) through a new offshore and onshore pipeline.
In December BP announced it had acquired a 25% interest in the Nour North Sinai offshore concession area from Eni. The concession is in the East Nile Delta Basin. Eni, the operator, is currently carrying out drilling of the first exploration well and will remain the operator with a 40% stake in the concession. BP will hold a 25% interest, Mubadala Petroleum 20% and Tharwa Petroleum Company 15%.
In February 2019 BP announced the start-up of gas production from the Giza and Fayoum fields in the West Nile Delta development (BP 82.75%). This development comprises five fields across the North Alexandria and West Mediterranean deepwater offshore blocks and is being developed as three separate projects to enable BP and its partners to accelerate gas production commitments to Egypt. The first of these three projects (Taurus and Libra) started production in 2017, Giza and Fayoum is the second, and the third project (Raven) is expected to be onstream in 2019.
In Libya, BP partners with the Libyan Investment Authority (LIA) in an exploration and production-sharing agreement (EPSA) to explore acreage in the onshore Ghadames and offshore Sirt basins (BP 85%). BP wrote off all balances associated with the Libya EPSA in 2015.
In October we announced that we had signed an agreement with the Libyan National Oil Corporation and Eni with a view to working together to resume exploration activities in Libya. The parties have agreed to work towards Eni acquiring a 42.5% interest in the BP-operated EPSA in Libya. On completion, Eni would also become operator of the EPSA. The companies are working to finalize and complete all agreements with a target of resuming exploration activities in 2019.
In Mauritania and Senegal, BP has a 62% participating interest in the C-6, C-8, C-12 and C-13 exploration blocks in Mauritania and a 60% participating interest in the Cayar Profond and St Louis Profond exploration blocks in Senegal. Together these blocks cover approximately 33,000 square kilometres. BP also has a 15% interest in the C-18 exploration block, operated by Total.
In February KE announced that the Requin Tigre-1 well in the Saint Louis Profond Block, offshore Senegal, was fully tested but did not encounter hydrocarbons.
In December BP and partners announced that the FID for Phase 1 of the cross-border Greater Tortue Ahmeyim development had been agreed. The decision was made following agreement between the Mauritanian and Senegalese governments and partners BP, KE and National Oil Companies, Petrosen and SMHPM. The project will produce gas from an ultra-deepwater subsea system and mid-water floating production, storage and offloading (FPSO) vessel. The gas will then be transferred to a floating liquefied natural gas (FLNG) facility at a near-shore hub located on the Mauritania and Senegal maritime border. The FLNG facility is designed to provide approximately 2.5 million tonnes of LNG per annum on average. The project, the first major gas project to reach FID in the basin, is planned to provide LNG for global export as well as making gas available for domestic use in both Mauritania and Senegal. First gas for the project is expected in 2022.
In Madagascar, BP signed four production-sharing contracts (PSC) in 2018 for exploration licences situated offshore northwest Madagascar, under agreements with the government of Madagascar represented by Office des Mines Nationales et des Industries Stratégiques (OMNIS) (BP 100%).

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
281


In São Tomé & Príncipe, BP and KE were awarded two offshore blocks in March 2018, under production-sharing agreements with the government of São Tomé & Príncipe represented by Agência Nacional do Petróleo de São Tomé e Príncipe (ANP-STP) (BP 50% (operator), KE 35% ANP-STP 15%). During the year work began on environmental baseline surveys, with completion anticipated in the second half of 2019.
Asia
BP has activities in Abu Dhabi, Azerbaijan, China, India, Iraq, Kuwait, Oman and Russia.
In China we have a 30% equity stake in the Guangdong LNG regasification terminal and trunkline project with a total storage capacity of 640,000 cubic metres. The project is supplied under a long-term contract with Australia’s North West Shelf venture (BP 16.67%).
BP has two PSCs for shale gas exploration, development and production in the Neijiang-Dazu block and Rong Chang Bei block in the Sichuan basin. The two blocks, both in the exploration phase, cover a total area of approximately 2,500 square kilometres. China National Petroleum Corporation (CNPC) is the operator. In 2018, drilling activity continued to progress in the two blocks in the Sichuan basin.
In Azerbaijan, BP operates two PSAs, Azeri-Chirag-Gunashli (ACG) (BP 30.37%) and Shah Deniz (BP 28.83%) and also holds a number of other exploration leases.
In 2012 certain EU and US regulations concerning restrictive measures against Iran were issued, which impact the Shah Deniz joint venture in which Naftiran Intertrade Co Ltd (NICO), a subsidiary of the National Iranian Oil Company, holds a 10% interest. The EU sanctions and certain US secondary sanctions in respect of Iran were lifted or suspended as part of the Joint Comprehensive Plan of Action. However, in November the US secondary sanctions were reinstated. For further information see International trade sanctions on page 298.
In April we announced that we had signed a new PSA with the State Oil Company of Azerbaijan Republic (SOCAR) for the joint exploration and development of Block D230 in the North Absheron basin. The block lies 135 kilometres north-east of Baku in the Caspian Sea, covering an area of 3,200 square kilometres. Under the PSA, which is for 25 years, BP will be the operator during the exploration phase and hold a 50% interest, with SOCAR holding the remaining 50%. The signing of the PSA follows the memorandum of understanding for exploration of Block D230, which was agreed in May 2016.
In July we announced the start-up of the landmark Shah Deniz Stage 2 gas development in Azerbaijan, including its first commercial gas delivery to Turkey. The BP-operated $28 billion project is the first subsea development in the Caspian Sea and the largest subsea infrastructure operated by BP worldwide. It is also the starting point for the Southern Gas Corridor series of pipelines that will deliver natural gas from the Caspian Sea direct to European markets for the first time.
BP holds a 30.1% interest in and operates the Baku-Tbilisi-Ceyhan oil pipeline. The 1,768-kilometre pipeline transports oil from the BP-operated ACG oilfield and gas condensate from the Shah Deniz gas field in the Caspian Sea, along with other third-party oil, to the eastern Mediterranean port of Ceyhan. The pipeline has a capacity of 1mmboe/d, with an average throughput in 2018 of 697mboe/d.
BP is technical operator of, and currently holds a 28.83% interest in, the 693 kilometre South Caucasus Pipeline. The pipeline takes gas from Azerbaijan through Georgia to the Turkish border and has a capacity of 143mboe/d, with average throughput in 2018 of 142mboe/d. BP (as operator of Azerbaijan International Operating Company) also operates the Western Route Export Pipeline that transports ACG oil to Supsa on the Black Sea coast of Georgia, with an average throughput of 76mboe/d in 2018.
BP also holds a 12% interest in the Trans Anatolian Natural Gas Pipeline. In the first phase, which commenced in June, gas from Shah Deniz is transported from Georgia to Eskishehir in Turkey. The
 
capacity of the pipeline during the first phase is 106mboe/d and the average throughput in 2018 was 30mboe/d. The second phase will take gas from Eskishehir to the connection with the Trans Adriatic Pipeline (TAP) in Greece. BP has a 20% interest in TAP, that will take gas through Greece and Albania into Italy. In December TAP entered into project financing arrangements with multiple lenders. BP's share of the funds received as a result of financing is $594 million.
In Oman BP operates the Khazzan field in Block 61 (BP 60%).
In April BP announced that, together with its partner the Oman Oil Company Exploration & Production (OOCEP), it had approved the development of Ghazeer, the second phase of the Khazzan gas field in Oman. The Ghazeer project is expected to increase production by 50% and will involve construction of a third gas processing train to handle this. The project is currently on track to deliver first gas as planned in 2021.
In January 2019 BP announced that together with Eni, they had signed a heads of agreement (HoA) with the Ministry of Oil and Gas of the Sultanate of Oman to work jointly towards a significant new exploration opportunity in Oman. Under the HoA, the two companies will work with the government of Oman towards the award of a new EPSA for Block 77 in central Oman. BP and Eni have entered discussions with the Ministry to finalise details of the EPSA. Block 77, with a total area of almost 3,100 square kilometres, is located in central Oman, 30 kilometres east of the BP-operated Block 61.
In Abu Dhabi, BP holds a 10% interest in the ADNOC onshore concession. We also have a 10% equity shareholding in ADNOC LNG and a 10% shareholding in the shipping company NGSCO. ADNOC LNG supplied approximately 5.4 million tonnes of LNG (729bcfe regasified) in 2018. Our interest in the ADNOC onshore concession expires at the end of 2054.
In March 2019 ADNOC and ADNOC LNG agreed to extend the gas supply agreement to 2040. The new agreement will take effect from 1 April 2019, and replaces an existing agreement expiring on 31 March 2019.
Our interest in the ADNOC offshore concession expired in March 2018. The concession, together with all related rights and obligations, has reverted back to the government of the Emirate of Abu Dhabi.
In 2016 BP signed an enhanced technical service agreement for south and east Kuwait conventional oilfields, which includes the Burgan field, with Kuwait Oil Company. Target performance for the 2017-18 plan was delivered and implementation of the 2018-19 plan is underway.
In India we have a participating interest in two oil and gas PSAs (KG D6 30% and NEC25 33.33%) both operated by Reliance Industries Limited (RIL). We also have a stake in a 50:50 joint venture (India Gas Solutions Private Limited) with RIL for the sourcing and marketing of gas in India.
In April BP and RIL sanctioned the Satellite Cluster project in Block KG D6. This is the second of three projects in the Block KG D6 integrated development. The first of the projects, development of the R-Series deep-water gas fields, was sanctioned in June 2017 and is currently under development. The Satellite Cluster is a dry gas development and comprises four discoveries with a five-well subsea development in Block KG D6, off the east coast of India. It is expected to come on stream in 2021.
In Iraq BP holds a 47.6% working interest and is the lead contractor in the Rumaila technical service contract in southern Iraq. The technical services contract runs to December 2034. Rumaila is one of the world’s largest oil fields, comprising five producing reservoirs.
In January 2018 BP entered into a letter of intent to work on the Kirkuk field which extends until 2019.
In Russia in addition to its 19.75% equity interest in Rosneft, BP holds a 20% interest in Taas-Yuryakh Neftegazodobycha (Taas) together with Rosneft (50.1%) and a consortium comprising Oil India Limited, Indian Oil Corporation Limited and Bharat PetroResources Limited (29.9%). Taas is developing the Srednebotuobinskoye oil and gas condensate field in East Siberia (see Rosneft on page 34 for further details). Also with Rosneft, we hold a 49% interest in Yermak

282
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Neftegaz LLC, which conducts exploration in the West Siberian and Yenisei-Khatanga basins. Yermak Neftegaz LLC currently holds seven exploration and production licences. The venture has carried out further appraisal work on the Baikalovskoye field, an existing Rosneft discovery in the Yenisei-Khatanga area of mutual interest.
In the second quarter, the Taas-Yuryakh expansion project completed commissioning of the main project facilities for the Srednebotuobinskoye oil and gas condensate.
Also in the second quarter BP acquired a 49% stake in LLC Kharampurneftegaz to develop subsoil resources jointly with Rosneft within the Kharampurskoe and Festivalnoye licence areas in Yamalo-Nenets.
In September Rosneft and BP also agreed to jointly explore two additional oil and gas licence areas located in Sakha (Yakutia). The licences are expected to be held by a Yermak subsidiary. Completion of the deal, subject to external approvals, is expected in 2019.
Australasia
BP has activities in Australia and Eastern Indonesia.
In Australia BP is one of seven participants in the North West Shelf (NWS) venture, which has been producing LNG, pipeline gas, condensate, LPG and oil since the 1980s. Six partners (including BP) hold an equal 16.67% interest in the gas infrastructure and an equal 15.78% interest in the gas and condensate reserves, with a seventh partner owning the remaining 5.32%. BP also has a 16.67% interest in some of the NWS oil reserves and related infrastructure. The NWS venture is currently the largest single source supplier to the domestic market in Western Australia and one of the largest LNG export projects in the region, with five LNG trains in operation. BP’s net share of the capacity of NWS LNG trains 1-5 is 2.7 million tonnes of LNG per year.
 
BP is also one of five participants in the Browse LNG venture (operated by Woodside) and holds a 17.33% interest.
The Browse project participants finalized evaluating a range of development options for the project and have selected to develop Browse by connecting it via a 900 kilometre pipeline to the NWS venture's Karratha gas plant. A final investment decision is expected in 2021. This decision has resulted in the write-off of $136 million in relation to previous project development costs for Browse.
In October we announced the start-up of production at our Western Flank B project (BP 16.67%), ahead of schedule.
During the year, the Ocean Great White rig contract was cancelled and a commercial arrangement entered into with the lessor whereby BP will utilize different rigs on projects in the future.
In Papua Barat, Eastern Indonesia, BP operates the Tangguh LNG plant (BP 40.22%). The asset currently comprises 16 producing wells, two offshore platforms, two pipelines and an LNG plant with two production trains. It has a total capacity of 7.6 million tonnes of LNG per annum. Tangguh supplies LNG to customers in Indonesia, Mexico, China, South Korea, and Japan through a combination of long, medium and short-term contracts.
The Tangguh expansion project is progressing on schedule with the installation of two offshore platforms completed and the construction of the onshore LNG production train and supporting facilities currently ongoing. Drilling on the first of 13 new production wells commenced in early 2019, and first production is expected in 2020. The project will add 3.8 million tonnes per annum (mtpa) of production capacity to the existing facility, bringing total plant capacity to 11.4mtpa.
In November approval from the government of Indonesia to relinquish BP’s 32% interest in the Chevron-operated West Papua I was received.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
283


Downstream plant capacity
The following tablea summarizes BP group’s interests in refineries and average daily crude distillation capacities as at 31 December 2018.
 
 
 
 
Crude distillation capacitiesb
 
Fuels value chain
Country
Refinery
 
Group interestc
(%)

BP share
thousand barrels
per day

US
 
 
 
 
 
US North West
US
Cherry Point
 
100

236

US East of Rockies
 
Whiting
 
100

430

 
 
Toledo
 
50

80

 
 
 
 
 
746

Europe
 
 
 
 
 
Rhine
Germany
Bayernoild
 
10

22

 
 
Gelsenkirchen
 
100

265

 
 
Lingen
 
100

95

 
Netherlands
Rotterdam
 
100

377

Iberia
Spain
Castellón
 
100

110

 
 
 
 
 
869

Rest of world
 
 
 
 
 
Australia
Australia
Kwinana
 
100

152

New Zealand
New Zealand
Whangareid e
 
10.1

33

Southern Africa
South Africa
Durband
 
50

90

 
 
 
 
 
275

Total BP share of capacity at 31 December 2018
 
 
1,890

a This does not include BP’s interest in Pan American Energy Group, which is reported through the Upstream segment.
b Crude distillation capacity is gross rated capacity, which is defined as the highest average sustained unit rate for a consecutive 30-day period.
c BP share of equity, which is not necessarily the same as BP share of processing entitlements.
d Indicates refineries not operated by BP.
e Reflects BP share of processing entitlement, which is not the same as BP share of equity.
Petrochemicals production capacitya 
The following table summarizes BP group’s share of petrochemicals production capacities as at 31 December 2018.
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP share of capacity
thousand tonnes per annumb
 
 
 
 
 
 
Product

Geographical area
Site
Group interestc
(%)

 
PTA

PX

Acetic
acid

Olefins and
derivatives

Others

US
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cooper River
100

 
1,400





 
Texas Cityd
100

 

900

600


100

 
 
 
 
1,400

900

600


100

Europe
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UK
Hull
100

 


500


200

Belgium
Geel
100

 
1,400

700




Germany
Gelsenkirchene
100

 



3,300


 
Mülheime
100

 




200

 
 
 
 
1,400

700

500

3,300

400

Rest of world
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trinidad & Tobago
Point Lisas
36.9

 




700

China
Chongqing
51

 


200


100

 
Nanjing
50

 


300



 
Zhuhaif
91.9

 
2,500





Indonesia
Merak
100

 
500





South Korea
Ulsang
34-51

 


300


100

Malaysia
Kertih
70

 


400



Taiwan
Mai Liao
50

 


200



 
Taichung
61.4

 
500





 
 
 
 
3,500


1,400


900

 
 
 
 
6,300

1,600

2,500

3,300

1,400

Total BP share of capacity at 31 December 2018
 
 
 


15,100

a 
Petrochemicals production capacity is the proven maximum sustainable daily rate (MSDR) multiplied by the number of days in the respective period, where MSDR is the highest average daily rate ever achieved over a sustained period.
b 
Capacities are shown to the nearest hundred thousand tonnes per annum.
c 
Includes BP share of non-operated equity-accounted entities, as indicated.
d 
For acetic acid, group interest is quoted at 100%, reflecting the capacity entitlement which is marketed by BP.
e 
Due to the integrated nature of these plants with our Gelsenkirchen refinery, the income and expenditure of these plants is managed and reported through the fuels business.
f 
BP Zhuhai Chemical Company Ltd is a subsidiary«of BP, the capacity of which is shown above at 100%.
g 
Group interest varies by product.

284
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Oil and gas disclosures for the group
Resource progression
BP manages its hydrocarbon resources in three major categories: prospect inventory, contingent resources and reserves. When a discovery is made, volumes usually transfer from the prospect inventory to the contingent resources category. The contingent resources move through various sub-categories as their technical and commercial maturity increases through appraisal activity.
At the point of final investment decision, most proved reserves will be categorized as proved undeveloped (PUD). Volumes will subsequently be recategorized from PUD to proved developed (PD) as a consequence of development activity. When part of a well’s proved reserves depends on a later phase of activity, only that portion of proved reserves associated with existing, available facilities and infrastructure moves to PD. The first PD bookings will typically occur at the point of first oil or gas production. Major development projects typically take one to five years from the time of initial booking of PUD to the start of production. Changes to proved reserves bookings may be made due to analysis of new or existing data concerning production, reservoir performance, commercial factors and additional reservoir development activity.
Volumes can also be added or removed from our portfolio through acquisition or divestment of properties and projects. When we dispose of an interest in a property or project, the volumes associated with our adopted plan of development for which we have a final investment decision will be removed from our proved reserves upon completion of the transaction. When we acquire an interest in a property or project, the volumes associated with the existing development and any committed projects will be added to our proved reserves if BP has made a final investment decision and they satisfy the SEC’s criteria for attribution of proved status. Following the acquisition, additional volumes may be progressed to proved reserves from non-proved reserves or contingent resources.
Non-proved reserves and contingent resources in a field will only be recategorized as proved reserves when all the criteria for attribution of proved status have been met and the volumes are included in the business plan and scheduled for development, typically within five years. BP will only book proved reserves where development is scheduled to commence after more than five years, if these proved reserves satisfy the SEC’s criteria for attribution of proved status and BP management has reasonable certainty that these proved reserves will be produced.
At the end of 2018 BP had material volumes of proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years in Russia, Trinidad, the North Sea, Egypt, Canada and the Gulf of Mexico. These are part of ongoing infrastructure-led development activities for which BP has a historical track record of completing comparable projects in these countries. We have no proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years in our onshore US developments.
In each case the volumes are being progressed as part of an adopted development plan where there are physical limits to the development timing such as infrastructure limitations, contractual limits including gas delivery commitments, late life compression and the complex nature of working in remote locations, or where there are significant commitments on delivery to the relevant authority.
Over the past five years, BP has annually progressed a weighted average 19% (18% for 2017 five-year average) of our group proved undeveloped reserves (including the impact of disposals and price acceleration effects in PSAs) to proved developed reserves. This equates to a turnover time of about five and a half years. We expect the turnover time to remain near this level and anticipate the volume of proved undeveloped reserves held for more than five years to remain about the same.
Proved reserves as estimated at the end of 2018 meet BP’s criteria for project sanctioning and SEC tests for proved reserves. We have not halted or changed our commitment to proceed with any material project to which proved undeveloped reserves have been attributed.
 
In 2018 we progressed 1,306mmboe of proved undeveloped reserves (745mmboe for our subsidiaries« alone) to proved developed reserves through ongoing investment in our subsidiaries’ and equity-accounted entities’ upstream development activities. Total development expenditure, excluding midstream activities, was $14,210 million in 2018 ($9,917 million for subsidiaries and $4,293 million for equity-accounted entities). The major areas with progressed volumes in 2018 were Russia, US, Azerbaijan, UAE and Egypt. Revisions of previous estimates for proved undeveloped reserves are due to changes relating to field performance, well results or changes in commercial conditions including price impacts. There were material net positive revisions to our proved undeveloped resources in Russia as a result of development drilling results and material net negative revisions in the US Lower 48 due to changes in our development plan to incorporate activity associated with the purchase of new assets. The following tables describe the changes to our proved undeveloped reserves position through the year for our subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities and for our subsidiaries alone.
Subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
volumes in mmboea

Proved undeveloped reserves at 1 January 2018
8,060

Revisions of previous estimates
20

Improved recovery
311

Discoveries and extensions
646

Purchases
1,174

Sales
(12
)
Total in year proved undeveloped reserves changes
2,139

Proved developed reserves reclassified as undeveloped
15

Progressed to proved developed reserves by development activities (e.g. drilling/completion)
(1,306
)
Proved undeveloped reserves at 31 December 2018
8,908

 
 
Subsidiaries only
volumes in mmboea

Proved undeveloped reserves at 1 January 2018
4,052

Revisions of previous estimates
(272
)
Improved recovery
297

Discoveries and extensions
169

Purchases
945

Sales
(12
)
Total in year proved undeveloped reserves changes
1,128

Proved developed reserves reclassified as undeveloped
12

Progressed to proved developed reserves by development activities (e.g. drilling/completion)
(745
)
Proved undeveloped reserves at 31 December 2018
4,447

a 
Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

BP bases its proved reserves estimates on the requirement of reasonable certainty with rigorous technical and commercial assessments based on conventional industry practice and regulatory requirements. BP only applies technologies that have been field tested and have been demonstrated to provide reasonably certain results with consistency and repeatability in the formation being evaluated or in an analogous formation. BP applies high-resolution seismic data for the identification of reservoir extent and fluid contacts only where there is an overwhelming track record of success in its local application. In certain cases BP uses numerical simulation as part of a holistic assessment of recovery factor for its fields, where these simulations have been field tested and have been demonstrated to provide reasonably certain results with consistency and repeatability in the formation being evaluated or in an analogous formation. In certain deepwater fields BP has booked proved reserves before production flow tests are conducted, in part because of the significant safety, cost and environmental implications of conducting these tests. The industry has made substantial technological improvements in understanding, measuring and delineating reservoir properties without the need for flow tests. To determine reasonable certainty of commercial recovery, BP employs a general method of

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
285


reserves assessment that relies on the integration of three types of data:
well data used to assess the local characteristics and conditions of reservoirs and fluids
field scale seismic data to allow the interpolation and extrapolation of these characteristics outside the immediate area of the local well control
data from relevant analogous fields.
Well data includes appraisal wells or sidetrack holes, full logging suites, core data and fluid samples. BP considers the integration of this data in certain cases to be superior to a flow test in providing understanding of overall reservoir performance. The collection of data from logs, cores, wireline formation testers, pressures and fluid samples calibrated to each other and to the seismic data can allow reservoir properties to be determined over a greater volume than the localized volume of investigation associated with a short-term flow test. There is a strong track record of proved reserves recorded using these methods, validated by actual production levels.
Governance
BP’s centrally controlled process for proved reserves estimation approval forms part of a holistic and integrated system of internal control. It consists of the following elements:
Accountabilities of certain officers of the group to ensure that there is review and approval of proved reserves bookings independent of the operating business and that there are effective controls in the approval process and verification that the proved reserves estimates and the related financial impacts are reported in a timely manner.
Capital allocation processes, whereby delegated authority is exercised to commit to capital projects that are consistent with the delivery of the group’s business plan. A formal review process exists to ensure that both technical and commercial criteria are met prior to the commitment of capital to projects.
Group audit, whose role is to consider whether the group’s system of internal control is adequately designed and operating effectively to respond appropriately to the risks that are significant to BP.
Approval hierarchy, whereby proved reserves changes above certain threshold volumes require immediate review and all proved reserves require annual central authorization and have scheduled periodic reviews. The frequency of periodic review ensures that 100% of the BP proved reserves base undergoes central review every three years.
BP’s vice president of segment reserves is the petroleum engineer primarily responsible for overseeing the preparation of the reserves estimate. He has more than 35 years of diversified industry experience, with 13 years spent managing the governance and compliance of BP’s reserves estimation. He is a past member of the Society of Petroleum Engineers Oil and Gas Reserves Committee and of the American Association of Petroleum Geologists Committee on Resource Evaluation and is the current chair of the bureau of the United Nations Economic Commission for Europe Expert Group on Resource Classification.
No specific portion of compensation bonuses for senior management is directly related to proved reserves targets. Additions to proved reserves is one of several indicators by which the performance of the Upstream segment is assessed by the remuneration committee for the purposes of determining compensation bonuses for the executive directors. Other indicators include a number of financial and operational measures.
BP’s variable pay programme for the other senior managers in the Upstream segment is based on individual performance contracts. Individual performance contracts are based on agreed items from the business performance plan, one of which, if chosen, could relate to proved reserves.
 
Compliance
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) do not provide specific guidance on reserves disclosures. BP estimates proved reserves in accordance with SEC Rule 4-10 (a) of Regulation S-X and relevant Compliance and Disclosure Interpretations (C&DI) and Staff Accounting Bulletins as issued by the SEC staff.
By their nature, there is always some risk involved in the ultimate development and production of proved reserves including, but not limited to: final regulatory approval; the installation of new or additional infrastructure, as well as changes in oil and gas prices; changes in operating and development costs; and the continued availability of additional development capital. All the group’s proved reserves held in subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities are estimated by the group’s petroleum engineers or by independent petroleum engineering consulting firms and then assured by the group’s petroleum engineers.
DeGolyer & MacNaughton (D&M), an independent petroleum engineering consulting firm, has estimated the net proved crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGLs) and natural gas reserves, as of 31 December 2018, of certain properties owned by Rosneft as part of our equity-accounted proved reserves. The properties evaluated by D&M account for 100% of Rosneft’s net proved reserves as of 31 December 2018. The net proved reserves estimates prepared by D&M were prepared in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rule 4-10(a)(1)-(32) of Regulation S-X. All reserves estimates involve some degree of uncertainty. BP has filed D&M’s independent report on its reserves estimates as an exhibit to this Annual Report on Form 20-F filed with the SEC.
Netherland, Sewell & Associates (NSAI), an independent petroleum engineering consulting firm, has estimated the net proved crude oil, condensate, natural gas liquids (NGLs) and natural gas reserves, as of 31 December 2018, of certain properties owned by BP in the US Lower 48. The properties evaluated by NSAI account for 100% of BP’s net proved reserves in the US Lower 48 as of 31 December 2018. The net proved reserves estimates prepared by NSAI were prepared in accordance with the reserves definitions of Rule 4-10(a)(1)-(32) of Regulation S-X. All reserves estimates involve some degree of uncertainty. BP has filed NSAI’s independent report on its reserves estimates as an exhibit to this Annual Report on Form 20-F filed with the SEC.
Our proved reserves are associated with both concessions (tax and royalty arrangements) and agreements where the group is exposed to the upstream risks and rewards of ownership, but where our entitlement to the hydrocarbons« is calculated using a more complex formula, such as with PSAs. In a concession, the consortium of which we are a part is entitled to the proved reserves that can be produced over the licence period, which may be the life of the field. In a PSA, we are entitled to recover volumes that equate to costs incurred to develop and produce the proved reserves and an agreed share of the remaining volumes or the economic equivalent. As part of our entitlement is driven by the monetary amount of costs to be recovered, price fluctuations will have an impact on both production volumes and reserves.
We disclose our share of proved reserves held in equity-accounted entities (joint ventures« and associates«), although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.
BP’s estimated net proved reserves and proved reserves replacement
89% of our total proved reserves of subsidiaries at 31 December 2018 were held through joint operations«(88% in 2017), and 31% of the proved reserves were held through such joint operations where we were not the operator (34% in 2017).

286
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Estimated net proved reserves of crude oil at 31 December 2018a b c 
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

UK
223

243

466

Rest of Europe



USd
962

802

1,764

Rest of North Americae
43

190

234

South Americaf
8

5

14

Africa
223

36

259

Rest of Asia
1,126

482

1,608

Australasia
30

5

34

Subsidiaries
2,615

1,763

4,378

Equity-accounted entities
3,541

2,792

6,333

Total
6,156

4,555

10,711

Estimated net proved reserves of natural gas liquids at 31 December 2018a b 
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

UK
8

6

14

Rest of Europe



US
266

246

511

Rest of North America



South America
2

25

27

Africa
14

4

18

Rest of Asia



Australasia
5


5

Subsidiaries
295

280

576

Equity-accounted entities
114

54

169

Total
409

335

744

Estimated net proved reserves of liquids«
 
 
million barrels
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

Subsidiariesf
2,910

2,044

4,954

Equity-accounted entitiesg
3,655

2,846

6,502

Total
6,565

4,890

11,456

Estimated net proved reserves of natural gas at 31 December 2018a b 
 
billion cubic feet
 
 
Developed

Undeveloped

Total

UK
439

343

782

Rest of Europe



US
6,270

5,056

11,326

Rest of North America



South Americah
2,168

3,073

5,241

Africa
1,313

1,067

2,380

Rest of Asia
3,599

3,218

6,817

Australasia
2,630

1,179

3,809

Subsidiaries
16,420

13,936

30,355

Equity-accounted entitiesi
9,515

9,369

18,884

Total
25,934

23,305

49,239

Estimated net proved reserves on an oil equivalent basis
 
million barrels of oil equivalent
 
 
Developed
Undeveloped

Total

Subsidiaries
5,741

4,447

10,188

Equity-accounted entities
5,296

4,462

9,757

Total
11,037

8,908

19,945

a 
Proved reserves exclude royalties due to others, whether payable in cash or in kind, where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently, and include non-controlling interests in consolidated operations. We disclose our share of reserves held in joint ventures and associates that are accounted for by the equity method although we do not control these entities or the assets held by such entities.
b 
The 2018 marker prices used were Brent« $71.43/bbl (2017 $54.36/bbl and 2016 $42.82/bbl) and Henry Hub« $3.10/mmBtu (2017 $2.96/mmBtu and 2016 $2.46/mmBtu).
c 
Includes condensate.
 
d 
Proved reserves in the Prudhoe Bay field in Alaska include an estimated 16 million barrels on which a net profits royalty will be payable over the life of the field under the terms of the BP Prudhoe Bay Royalty Trust.
e 
All of the reserves in Canada are bitumen.
f 
Includes 12 million barrels of liquids in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
g 
Includes 356 million barrels of liquids in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 24 million barrels held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.
h 
Includes 1,573 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the 30% non-controlling interest in BP Trinidad and Tobago LLC.
i 
Includes 1,211 billion cubic feet of natural gas in respect of the non-controlling interest in Rosneft held assets in Russia including 480 billion cubic feet held through BP’s interests in Russia other than Rosneft.

Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.
Proved reserves replacement
Total hydrocarbon proved reserves at 31 December 2018, on an oil equivalent basis including equity-accounted entities, increased by 8% (increase of 7% for subsidiaries and increase of 9% for equity-accounted entities) compared with 31 December 2017. Natural gas represented about 43% (51% for subsidiaries and 33% for equity-accounted entities) of these reserves. The change includes a net increase from acquisitions and disposals of 1,498mmboe (increase of 993mmboe within our subsidiaries and increase of 505mmboe within our equity-accounted entities). Acquisition activity in our subsidiaries occurred in the US and UK, and divestment activity in our subsidiaries in the US and UK. In our equity-accounted entities acquisitions occurred in our Russian joint ventures other than Rosneft. There were no divestments in our equity-accounted entities.
The proved reserves replacement ratio« is the extent to which production is replaced by proved reserves additions. This ratio is expressed in oil equivalent terms and includes changes resulting from revisions to previous estimates, improved recovery, and extensions and discoveries. For 2018, the proved reserves replacement ratio excluding acquisitions and disposals was 100% (143% in 2017 and 109% in 2016) for subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities, 66% for subsidiaries alone and 161% for equity-accounted entities alone. There were increases (131mmboe) of reserves due to extension of the date of cessation of production across the group due to higher oil and gas prices, but these were more than offset by decreases (140mmboe) in PSAs, principally in Azerbaijan, Indonesia and Iraq resulting from decreased cost recovery volumes due to higher oil and gas prices.
In 2018 net additions to the group’s proved reserves (excluding production and sales and purchases of reserves-in-place) amounted to 1,381mmboe (576mmboe for subsidiaries and 805mmboe for equity-accounted entities), through revisions to previous estimates, improved recovery from, and extensions to, existing fields and discoveries of new fields. The subsidiary additions were through improved recovery from, and extensions to, existing fields and discoveries of new fields where they represented a mixture of proved developed and proved undeveloped reserves. Volumes added in 2018 principally resulted from the application of conventional technologies and extensions of the cessation of production as a result of higher prices. The principal proved reserves additions in our subsidiaries by region were in UAE, Oman and the US. We had material reductions in our proved reserves in Iraq principally due to higher oil and gas prices. The principal reserves additions in our equity-accounted entities were in PAE and Rosneft.
14% of our proved reserves are associated with PSAs. The countries in which we operated under PSAs in 2018 were Algeria, Angola, Azerbaijan, Egypt, India, Indonesia and Oman. In addition, the technical service contract (TSC) governing our investment in the Rumaila field in Iraq functions as a PSA.
The group holds no licences due to expire within the next three years that would have a significant impact on BP’s reserves or production.
For further information on our reserves see page 217.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
287


BP’s net production by country – crude oila and natural gas liquids
 
 
 
 
 
thousand barrels per day
 
 
 
 
 
 
BP net share of productionb
 
 
 
 
Crude oil

 
 
 
Natural gas
liquids

 
2018

2017

2016

 
2018

2017

2016

Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UKc d
101

80

79

 
5

6

6

Norwayc


24

 


4

Total Rest of Europe


24

 


4

Total Europe
101

80

102

 
5

6

10

Alaskac
106

109

107

 



Lower 48 onshorec
18

10

12

 
37

34

36

Gulf of Mexico deepwater
261

251

216

 
23

21

20

Total US
385

370

335

 
60

56

56

Canadae
24

20

13

 



Total Rest of North America
24

20

13

 



Total North America
408

390

347

 
60

56

56

Trinidad & Tobagoc
7

12

10

 
9

10

8

Total South America
7

12

10

 
9

10

8

Angola
147

192

219

 



Egyptc
49

40

39

 



Algeria
9

9

5

 
11

10

5

Total Africa
204

241

263

 
11

10

5

Abu Dhabic
169

158


 



Azerbaijan
72

90

105

 



Western Indonesiac


2

 



Iraq
54

73

96

 



India

1

1

 



Oman
17

2


 



Total Rest of Asia
313

325

204

 



Total Asia
313

325

204

 



Australiac
16

15

15

 
2

2

3

Eastern Indonesiac
2

1

2

 



Total Australasia
17

17

16

 
2

2

3

Total subsidiaries
1,051

1,064

943

 
88

85

82

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
 
 

Rosneft (Russia, Canada, Venezuela, Vietnam)
919

900

836

 
4

4

4

Abu Dhabi
16

99

101

 



Argentinac
52

60

62

 


1

Boliviac
3

3

4

 



Egypt



 
3

2

3

Norwayc
34

31

7

 
2

2


Russiac
14

5

4

 



Angola
1

1


 
3

4

1

Other


1

 



Total equity-accounted entities
1,040

1,099

1,015

 
12

12

8

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entitiesf
2,091

2,163

1,958

 
100

97

90

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
a 
Includes condensate.
b 
Production excludes royalties due to others whether payable in cash or in kind where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
c 
In 2018, BP acquired various interests in the Permian Basin, Eagle Ford and Haynesville Shales in Lower 48 onshore as a result of the acquisition of BHP’s US unconventional assets, increased its interest in the Clair asset in the UK North Sea, and acquired an interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz in Russia, and in certain US offshore assets. It also disposed of its interests in the Greater Kuparuk Area in Alaska, the Magnus field in the UK North Sea, and in certain other assets in the UK North Sea and US onshore assets. In 2017, BP renewed its onshore concession of the United Arab Emirates that grants BP 10% interest in ADCO onshore concession. It also decreased its interest in Magnus field in North Sea and completed the formation of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG) (BP 50%, Bridas Corporation 50%), which is a combination of Pan American Energy and Axion Energy with an effective decrease in interest. In 2016, BP increased its interests in Tangguh in Indonesia and the Culzean asset in the UK North Sea, and in certain US onshore assets. It disposed of its interests in the Valhall, Skarv and Ula assets in the Norwegian North Sea and in return received an interest in Aker BP ASA, which operates in Norway. It also disposed of its interests in the Jansz-Io asset in Australia, and the Sanga Sanga conventional concession in Indonesia. It also decreased its interests in certain Trinidad and US onshore assets.
d 
Volumes relate to six BP-operated fields within ETAP. BP has no interests in the remaining three ETAP fields, which are operated by Shell.
e 
All of the production from Canada in Subsidiaries is bitumen.
f 
Includes 3 net mboe/d of NGLs from processing plants in which BP has an interest (2017 3mboe/d and 2016 3mboe/d).

Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

288
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


BP’s net production by country – natural gas
 
 
million cubic feet per day
 
 
 
BP net share of productiona
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

Subsidiaries
UKb
 
152

182

170

Norwayb
 


82

Total Rest of Europe
 


82

Total Europe
 
152

182

252

Lower 48 onshoreb
 
1,705

1,467

1,476

Gulf of Mexico deepwater
 
190

186

173

Alaska
 
5

5

6

Total US
 
1,900

1,659

1,656

Canada
 
7

9

10

Total Rest of North America
 
7

9

10

Total North America
 
1,907

1,667

1,666

Trinidad & Tobagob
 
2,136

1,936

1,689

Total South America
 
2,136

1,936

1,689

Egyptb
 
878

745

305

Algeria
 
183

205

208

Total Africa
 
1,061

949

513

Azerbaijan
 
256

232

245

Western Indonesiab
 


35

India
 
32

60

84

Oman
 
538

79


Total Rest of Asia
 
826

371

363

Total Asia
 
826

371

363

Australiab
 
437

426

451

Eastern Indonesiab
 
382

357

369

Total Australasia
 
819

783

820

Total subsidiariesc
 
6,900

5,889

5,302

Equity-accounted entities (BP share)
 
 
 
 
Rosneft (Russia, Canada, Egypt, Venezuela, Vietnam)
 
1,286

1,308

1,279

Argentina
 
264

329

354

Bolivia
 
71

89

95

Norwayb
 
59

53

12

Angola
 
80

77

18

Western Indonesia
 


15

Total equity-accounted entitiesc
 
1,760

1,855

1,773

Total subsidiaries and equity-accounted entities
 
8,659

7,744

7,075

a Production excludes royalties due to others whether payable in cash or in kind where the royalty owner has a direct interest in the underlying production and the option and ability to make lifting and sales arrangements independently.
b In 2018, BP acquired various interests in the Permian Basin, Eagle Ford and Haynesville Shales in Lower 48 onshore as a result of the acquisition of BHP’s US unconventional assets, increased its interest in the Clair asset in the UK North Sea, and acquired an interest in LLC Kharampurneftegaz in Russia, and in certain US offshore assets. It also disposed of its interests in the Greater Kuparuk Area in Alaska, the Magnus field in the UK North Sea, and in certain other assets in the UK North Sea and US onshore assets. In 2017, BP decreased its interest in Magnus field in North Sea and completed the formation of Pan American Energy Group (PAEG) (BP 50%, Bridas Corporation 50%), which is a combination of Pan American Energy and Axion Energy with an effective decrease in interest.In 2016, BP increased its interests in Tangguh in Indonesia and the Culzean asset in the UK North Sea, and in certain US onshore assets. It disposed of its interests in the Valhall, Skarv and Ula assets in the Norwegian North Sea and in return received an interest in Aker BP ASA, which operates in Norway. It also disposed of its interests in the Jansz-Io asset in Australia, and the Sanga Sanga concession in Indonesia. It also decreased its interests in certain Trinidad and US onshore assets.
c Natural gas production volumes exclude gas consumed in operations within the lease boundaries of the producing field, but the related reserves are included in the group’s reserves.

Because of rounding, some totals may not agree exactly with the sum of their component parts.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
289


The following tables provide additional data and disclosures in relation to our oil and gas operations.
Average sales price per unit of production (realizations«)a 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ per unit of production
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America

Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total
group
average

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
Americab

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
71.28


67.11

33.57

69.17

68.81


70.80

67.54

67.81

Natural gas liquids
 
31.63


25.81


35.74

39.14


92.47

52.14

29.42

Gas
 
7.71


2.43


3.08

4.82


3.85

7.97

3.92

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
53.67


49.98

36.80

55.44

53.61


52.88

53.26

51.71

Natural gas liquids
 
32.77


22.42


26.79

36.48



39.39

26.00

Gas
 
5.09


2.36


2.25

3.82


3.44

6.14

3.19

2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 
42.80

40.16

39.65

26.11

45.64

40.83


39.29

41.52

39.99

Natural gas liquids
 
25.70

20.16

14.71


21.40

21.30



32.70

17.31

Gas
 
4.50

4.19

1.90


1.72

3.89


3.39

5.71

2.84

Equity-accounted entitiesd
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

70.24



62.35


62.46

39.49


62.24

Natural gas liquidse
 






N/A




Gas
 

7.93



4.36


1.70



2.50

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

55.08



49.97


45.66

15.61


42.33

Natural gas liquidse
 






N/A




Gas
 

5.78



4.49


1.63



2.47

2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Crude oilc
 

50.71



48.88


36.36

12.92


34.04

Natural gas liquidse
 




34.51


N/A



34.51

Gas
 

5.16



4.21


1.39

6.11


2.20


Average production cost per unit of productionf 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ per unit of production
 
 
 
Europe
North
America
South
America
Africa
Asia
Australasia
Total
group
average

 
 
UK

Rest of
Europe

US

Rest of
North
America

 
 
Russia

Rest of
Asia

 
Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
13.76


9.63

13.10

3.08

7.31


5.72

2.35

7.15

2017
 
14.58


8.68

15.02

4.41

6.47


6.37

2.79

7.11

2016
 
14.80

13.72

10.20

21.79

4.21

9.34


7.08

2.62

8.46

Equity-accounted entities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 

12.15



10.61


3.09

5.92


4.16

2017
 

10.33



11.92


3.19

3.27


4.32

2016
 

10.41



10.66


2.46

3.67


3.57

a Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Realizations include transfers between businesses, except in the case of Russia.
b All of the production from Canada in Subsidiaries is bitumen.
c Includes condensate.
d In certain countries it is common for equity-accounted entities’ agreements to include pricing clauses that require selling a significant portion of the entitled production to local governments or markets at discounted prices.
e Natural gas liquids for Russia are included in crude oil.
f Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Amounts do not include ad valorem and severance taxes.


290
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Environmental expenditure
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Operating expenditure
 
501

441

487

Capital expenditure
 
449

487

564

Clean-ups
 
31

22

27

Additions to environmental remediation provision
 
428

249

262

Increase (decrease) in decommissioning provision
 
137

(228
)
(804
)
Operating and capital expenditure on the prevention, control, treatment or elimination of air and water emissions and solid waste is often not incurred as a separately identifiable transaction. Instead, it forms part of a larger transaction that includes, for example, normal operations and maintenance expenditure. The figures for environmental operating and capital expenditure in the table are therefore estimates, based on the definitions and guidelines of the American Petroleum Institute.
Environmental operating expenditure of $501 million in 2018 (2017 $441 million) showed an overall increase of 14% the largest element of which was due to higher expenditures associated with sustaining and increasing production volumes in the Gulf of Mexico region.
Environmental capital expenditure in 2018 was lower overall than in 2017 largely due to lower spend resulting from the divestiture of the North Sea Forties Pipeline System and lower expenditure on Arundel, Clair and Schiehallion fields.
Clean-up costs were $31 million in 2018 (2017 $22 million) representing increases in oil spill clean-up costs and other associated remediation and disposal costs as well as costs related to the replacement of underground storage tanks in the US.
In addition to operating and capital expenditure, we also establish provisions for future environmental remediation work. Expenditure against such provisions normally occurs in subsequent periods and is not included in environmental operating expenditure reported for such periods.
Provisions for environmental remediation are made when a clean-up is probable and the amount of the obligation can be reliably estimated. Generally, this coincides with the commitment to a formal plan of action or, if earlier, on divestment or on closure of inactive sites.
The extent and cost of future environmental restoration, remediation and abatement programmes are inherently difficult to estimate. They often depend on the extent of contamination, and the associated impact and timing of the corrective actions required, technological feasibility and BP’s share of liability. Though the costs of future programmes could be significant and may be material to the results of operations in the period in which they are recognized, it is not expected that such costs will be material to the group’s overall results of operations or financial position.
Additions to our environmental remediation provision increased in 2018 largely due to the scope reassessments of the remediation plans of a number of our sites in the US and Canada. The charge for environmental remediation provisions in 2018 included $8 million in respect of provisions for new sites (2017 $8 million and 2016 $7 million).
In addition, we make provisions on installation of our oil and gas producing assets and related pipelines to meet the cost of eventual decommissioning. On installation of an oil or natural gas production facility, a provision is established that represents the discounted value of the expected future cost of decommissioning the asset.
In 2018, the net decrease in the decommissioning provision, similar to the decrease in 2017, was a result of detailed reviews of expected future costs, partially offset by increases to the asset base.
We undertake periodic reviews of existing provisions. These reviews take account of revised cost assumptions, changes in decommissioning requirements and any technological developments.
 
Provisions for environmental remediation and decommissioning are usually established on a discounted basis, as required by IAS 37 ‘Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets’.
Further details of decommissioning and environmental provisions appear in Financial statements – Note 23.
Environmental expenditure relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
For full details of all environmental activities in relation to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill, see Financial statements – Note 2.
Regulation of the group’s business
BP’s activities, including its oil and gas exploration and production, pipelines and transportation, refining and marketing, petrochemicals production, trading, biofuels, wind, solar and shipping activities, are subject to a broad range of EU, US, international, regional, and local legislation and regulations, including legislation that implements international conventions and protocols. These cover virtually all aspects of BP’s activities and include matters such as licence acquisition, production rates, royalties, environmental, health and safety protection, fuel specifications and transportation, trading, pricing, anti-trust, export, taxes, and foreign exchange.
Upstream contractual and regulatory framework
The terms and conditions of the leases, licences and contracts under which our oil and gas interests are held vary from country to country. These leases, licences and contracts are generally granted by or entered into with a government entity or state-owned or controlled company and are sometimes entered into with private property owners. Arrangements with governmental or state entities usually take the form of licences or production-sharing agreements«(PSAs), although arrangements with US government entities are usually by lease. Arrangements with private property owners are also usually in the form of leases.
Licences (or concessions) give the holder the right to explore for, develop and produce a commercial discovery. Under a licence, the holder bears the risk of exploration, development and production activities and provides the financing for these operations. In principle, the licence holder is entitled to all production, minus any royalties that are payable in kind. A licence holder is generally required to pay production taxes or royalties, which may be in cash or in kind. Less typically, BP may explore for, develop and produce hydrocarbons« under a service agreement with the host entity in exchange for reimbursement of costs and/or a fee paid in cash rather than production.
PSAs entered into with a government entity or state-owned or controlled company generally require BP (alone or with other contracting companies) to provide all the financing and bear the risk of exploration and production activities in exchange for a share of the production remaining after royalties, if any.
In certain countries, separate licences are required for exploration and production activities, and in some cases production licences are limited to only a portion of the area covered by the original exploration licence. Both exploration and production licences are generally for a specified period of time. In the US, leases from the US government typically remain in effect for a specified term, but may be extended beyond that term as long as there is production in paying quantities. The term of BP’s licences and the extent to which these licences may be renewed vary from country to country.
BP frequently conducts its exploration and production activities in joint arrangements« or co-ownership arrangements with other international oil companies, state-owned or controlled companies and/or private companies. These joint arrangements may be incorporated or unincorporated arrangements, while the co-ownerships are typically unincorporated. Whether incorporated or unincorporated, relevant agreements set out each party’s level of participation or ownership interest in the joint arrangement or co-ownership. Conventionally, all costs, benefits, rights, obligations, liabilities and risks incurred in carrying out joint arrangement or co-ownership operations under a lease or licence are shared among the joint arrangement or co-owning parties according to these agreed ownership interests. Ownership of joint arrangement or co-owned

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
291


property and hydrocarbons to which the joint arrangement or co-ownership is entitled is also shared in these proportions. To the extent that any liabilities arise, whether to governments or third parties, or as between the joint arrangement parties or co-owners themselves, each joint arrangement party or co-owner will generally be liable to meet these in proportion to its ownership interest. In many upstream operations, a party (known as the operator) will be appointed (pursuant to a joint operating agreement) to carry out day-to-day operations on behalf of the joint arrangement or co-ownership. The operator is typically one of the joint arrangement parties or a co-owner and will carry out its duties either through its own staff, or by contracting out various elements to third-party contractors or service providers. BP acts as operator on behalf of joint arrangements and co-ownerships in a number of countries where it has exploration and production activities.
Frequently, work (including drilling and related activities) will be contracted out to third-party service providers who have the relevant expertise and equipment not available within the joint arrangement or the co-owning operator’s organization. The relevant contract will specify the work to be done and the remuneration to be paid and will typically set out how major risks will be allocated between the joint arrangement or co-ownership and the service provider. Generally, the joint arrangement or co-owner and the contractor would respectively allocate responsibility for and provide reciprocal indemnities to each other for harm caused to and by their respective staff and property. Depending on the service to be provided, an oil and gas industry service contract may also contain provisions allocating risks and liabilities associated with pollution and environmental damage, damage to a well or hydrocarbon reservoirs and for claims from third parties or other losses. The allocation of those risks vary among contracts and are determined through negotiation between the parties.
In general, BP incurs income tax on income generated from production activities (whether under a licence or PSA). In addition, depending on the area, BP’s production activities may be subject to a range of other taxes, levies and assessments, including special petroleum taxes and revenue taxes. The taxes imposed on oil and gas production profits and activities may be substantially higher than those imposed on other activities, for example in Abu Dhabi, Angola, Egypt, Norway, the UK, the US, Russia and Trinidad & Tobago.
Greenhouse gas regulation
In December 2015, nearly 200 nations at the United Nations climate change conference in Paris (COP21) agreed the Paris Agreement, for implementation post-2020. The agreement came into force on 4 November 2016. This agreement applies to both developing and developed countries, although in some instances allowances or flexibilities are provided for developing countries. The Paris Agreement aims to hold the increase in the global average temperature to well below 2°C above pre-industrial levels and to pursue efforts to limit the temperature increase to 1.5°C above pre-industrial levels. There is no quantitative long-term emissions goal. However, countries aim to reach global peaking of greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions as soon as possible and to undertake rapid reductions thereafter, so as to achieve a balance between human caused emissions by sources and removals by sinks of GHGs in the second half of this century. The Paris Agreement commits all parties to submit Nationally Determined Contributions (NDCs) (i.e. pledges or plans of climate action) and pursue domestic measures aimed at achieving the objectives of their NDCs. Developed country NDCs should include absolute emission reduction targets, and developing countries are encouraged to move towards absolute emission reduction targets over time. The Paris Agreement places binding commitments on countries to report on their emissions and progress made on their NDCs and to undergo international review of collective progress. It also requires countries to submit revised NDCs every five years, which are expected to be more ambitious with each revision. Global assessments of progress will occur every five years, starting in 2023. In the decision adopting the Paris Agreement, an earlier commitment by developed countries to mobilize $100 billion a year by 2020 was extended through 2025, with a further goal with a floor of $100 billion to be set before 2025. On 1 June 2017, the US announced that it will withdraw from the Paris Agreement. This includes suspending the implementation of the US’s NDC and funding for the
 
Green Climate Fund. The process for withdrawal can be completed no earlier than 4 November 2020.
At the United Nations climate change conference in Poland (COP24) in December 2018, the ‘Paris Rulebook’ was agreed. This rulebook describes how the elements of the Paris Agreement will be implemented when it comes into force in 2020. COP24 failed to agree on rules for implementing Article 6, which could enable international carbon trading to assist in meeting NDCs. Discussions on Article 6 have now been deferred to COP25 which will take place in Chile in 2019.
More stringent national and regional measures relating to the transition to a lower carbon economy can be expected in the future. These measures could increase BP’s production costs for certain products, increase compliance and litigation costs, increase demand for competing energy alternatives or products with lower-carbon intensity, and affect the sales and specifications of many of BP’s products. Further, such measures could lead to constraints on production and supply and access to new reserves, particularly due to the long term nature of many of BP’s projects. Current and announced measures and developments potentially affecting BP’s businesses include the following:
United States
In the US, the Obama administration adopted its Climate Action Plan in 2013 and used its existing statutory authority to implement that plan, including the Clean Air Act (CAA) and the Mineral Leasing Act (MLA). BP's operations are affected by regulation in a number of ways under the CAA, for example:
Stricter GHG regulations, stricter limits on sulphur in fuels, emissions regulations in the refinery sector and a revised lower ambient air quality standard for ozone, finalized by the EPA in October 2015, are affecting our US operations.
EPA regulations aimed at methane emissions are in place for new and modified sources. As discussed below, the Bureau of Land Management (BLM) has issued a new waste prevention rule which rescinded the prior rule regarding methane regulation on federal lands.
States may also have separate, stricter air emission laws in addition to the CAA. Despite the US withdrawal from the Paris Agreement, a number of US states, cities and private organizations remain committed to meeting Paris Agreement goals. A number of states also belong to or are considering joining carbon trading markets (e.g. California).
As noted below, some of these regulations may be suspended, revised or rescinded resulting in regulatory uncertainty and complex compliance challenges for our affected businesses
On 28 March 2017, the Trump administration issued Executive Order (EO) 13783 rescinding major elements of the Climate Action Plan, and instructing the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) to review and then commence the process of suspending, revising or rescinding certain regulations, including the Clean Power Plan (CPP) which was an important element of the Obama administration’s Climate Action Plan, and the EPA new source methane rule.
On 21 August 2018, the EPA introduced the Affordable Clean Energy (ACE) Rule, which is intended to address GHG emissions from certain stationary sources, and which is intended to replace the CPP. The CPP regulations are currently stayed pending resolution of existing legal challenges; the EPA may decline to defend certain of these legal challenges. When the ACE Rule is finalized, it is likely to face legal challenges as well. The outcome with respect to these rules may affect electricity generation practices and prices, reliability of electricity supply, and regulatory requirements affecting other GHG emission sources in other sectors and have potential impacts on combined heat and power installations.
In June 2016, the EPA finalized rules aimed at limiting methane emissions from new and modified sources in the oil and natural gas sector in the US by 40-45% from 2012 levels by 2025. In January 2017 the BLM's methane rule, aimed at limiting methane emissions from oil and gas operations on federal lands also came into effect. EO 13783 instructed the Department of Interior (DOI) to

292
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


review and possibly suspend, revise or rescind the BLM methane rule. In September 2018, BLM finalized a new waste prevention rule, which removed many of the provisions of the former BLM methane rule. The EPA rule and the new waste prevention rule are being challenged by states and NGOs. The final outcome of the rule revisions and legal challenges with respect to these EPA and BLM rules is uncertain.
The Energy Policy Act of 2005 and the Energy Independence and Security Act of 2007 impose a renewable fuel mandate (the federal Renewable Fuel Standard) as well as state initiatives that impose low GHG emissions thresholds for transportation fuels (currently adopted in California, through the California Low Carbon Fuel Standard, and in Oregon). In October 2018, President Trump directed the EPA to conduct rulemaking to extend to E15 gasoline the volatility allowance currently given to E10 gasoline under the CAA. Current law allows E15 gasoline to be sold year-round, but this rule will make it easier for E15 to meet the more stringent summer volatility standards. This rulemaking will also address “market reforms” of the RFS credit-trading programme, which is the open market for renewables credit trading. EPA has indicated it hopes to have the rulemaking finalized by the summer 2019 driving season.
Under the GHG mandatory reporting rule (GHGMRR), annual reports on GHG emissions must be filed with the EPA. In addition to direct emissions from affected facilities, producers and importers/exporters of petroleum products, certain natural gas liquids and GHG products are required to report product volumes and notional GHG emissions as if these products were fully combusted.
A number of states, municipalities and regional organizations have responded to current and proposed federal changes in environmental regulation and a number of additional state and regional initiatives in the US will affect our operations. The California cap and trade programme started in January 2012 and expanded to cover emissions from transportation fuels in 2015. The State of Washington adopted a carbon cap rule that was to become effective 2017, but the rule has been suspended pending review before the state’s supreme court.
European Union
EU leaders in 2007 endorsed a set of measures to reduce GHG emissions and encourage renewables in the 2010 to 2020 period. These include an overall GHG reduction target of 20% by 2020. To meet this, a set of regulatory measures were adopted which include: a collective national reduction target for emissions not covered by the EU Emissions Trading System (EU ETS) Directive; binding national renewable energy targets of 20% renewable energy used in renewable energy sources in the EU, including at least a 10% share of renewable energy in the transport sector under the Renewable Energy Directive; a legal framework to promote carbon capture and storage (CCS); and a revised EU ETS Phase 3.
In October 2014 EU leaders adopted the climate and energy framework setting key targets for the year 2030 including at least 40% cuts in GHG emissions (from 1990 levels). The GHG reduction target is to be achieved by a 43% reduction of emissions from sectors covered by the EU ETS, and a 30% GHG reduction by Member States for all other GHG emissions. Measures to achieve the 2030 targets include a significant revision of the EU ETS for Phase 4 agreed in 2017, which addresses the surplus allowances in the system and the amount of free allocation for sectors prone to international competition. In mid-2018 a 32% share of renewable energy and a 32.5% increase in energy efficiency was agreed which must be met by EU Member States by 2030. The package also sets a renewable energy target of 14% for the transportation sector.
On 28 November 2018 the European Commission presented its long-term Energy and Climate Strategy that sets a “vision” towards a net-zero GHG emissions economy by the mid-twenty first century.
The Medium Combustion Plants Directive (MCPD) applies to air emissions of sulphur dioxide (SO2), nitrogen oxides (NOx) and
 
particulates from the combustion of fuels in plants with a rated thermal input between one and 50MW. It also includes requirements to monitor emissions of carbon monoxide (CO) from such plant. Its requirements are being phased in - the emission limit values set in the Directive applied from 20 December 2018 for new plants and by 2025 or 2030 for existing plants, depending on their size.
The National Emission Ceiling Directive 2016 entered into force on 31 December 2016, replacing earlier legislation. It introduces stricter emissions limits from 2020 and 2030, with new indicative national targets applying from 2025. EU member states had to implement the Directive by 1 July 2018. NECD has been implemented in the UK by the National Emission Ceiling Regulations 2018. Each EU Member State is also required to produce a National Air Pollution Control Programme by 31 March 2019 setting out the measures it will take to ensure compliance with the 2020 and 2030 reduction commitments.
The EU Fuel Quality Directive affects our production and marketing of transport fuels. Revisions adopted in 2009 mandate reductions in the life cycle GHG emissions per unit of energy and tighter environmental fuel quality standards for petrol and diesel.
Other
Canada’s highest emitting province, Alberta, has regulations targeting large final emitters (sites with over 100,000 tonnes of carbon dioxide equivalent per annum) with compliance obligations being based on facility performance relative to product specific benchmarks. Compliance is possible by improving emissions intensity, the purchase of offsets or the payment of C$30/tonne to the Climate Change and Emissions Management Fund. In addition, there is an economy-wide price of carbon policy that covers emissions not in the scope of the existing regulations for large final emitters (C$30/tonne in 2019; then escalating in line with Federal backstop pricing). Additional requirements are in place relating to electricity generation sources and limits on overall oil sands emissions. The Canadian federal government has announced climate change regulations, effective from January 2019, including a national backstop carbon price starting at C$20/tonne in 2019 and escalating to C$50/tonne by 2022 (or equivalent system for provinces with cap-and-trade systems), with implementation of the price and associated large emitters pricing system (modelled on the Alberta output-based-allocation system), use of any funds generated, and outcome reporting being managed by each province. Newfoundland & Labrador and Nova Scotia are implementing regulations that meet equivalency requirements of the Federal regulations via economy wide carbon taxes on fuels and large emitter programs (intensity based for Newfoundland & Labrador and cap and trade for Nova Scotia).
China is operating emission trading pilot programmes in five cities and three provinces. One of BP's subsidiaries and one of BP’s joint venture« companies in China are participating in these schemes. A plan to establish a nationwide carbon emissions trading market (initially covering the power sector only) was promulgated in December 2017 by the National Development and Reform Commission, which will not supersede the above eight pilot programmes immediately but allow those pilot schemes to be incorporated into the national scheme gradually. In 2018, the Climate Change Bureau was transferred to the newly formed Ministry for Ecology & Environment as part of the overall ministerial restructuring. The Climate Change Bureau remains in charge of the nationwide Emission Trading Scheme with no changes to the 2017 implementation plan.
In July 2016, China carried out pilot programmes on compensation for and trading of energy quotas in four provinces which may be further expanded in or after 2020. In January 2017, a nationwide pilot scheme on the issuance and voluntary purchase and trading of renewable energy green power certificates was launched, and draft regulation issued in 2018. The scheme is expected to undergo further testing in 2019 before becoming mandatory. Generators will be able to obtain certificates, which then can be sold to the two national grid companies. No secondary trading is foreseen initially.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
293


China has also adopted more stringent vehicle tailpipe emission standards and vehicle efficiency standards to address air pollution and GHG emissions. These standards will have an impact on transportation fuel product mix and overall demand. In addition, China has also introduced a mandate for sales of new energy vehicles (NEVs) commencing in 2020. This will accelerate NEV penetration into the light vehicle sector and impact light fuel demand.
For information on the steps that BP is taking in relation to climate change issues and for details of BP’s GHG reporting, see Sustainability – Climate change on page 45.
Other environmental regulation
Current and proposed fuel and product specifications, emission controls (including control of vehicle emissions), climate change programmes and regulation of unconventional oil and gas extraction under a number of environmental laws may have a significant effect on the production, sale and profitability of many of BP’s products.
There are also environmental laws that require BP to remediate and restore areas affected by the release of hazardous substances or hydrocarbons associated with our operations or properties. These laws may apply to sites that BP currently owns or operates, sites that it previously owned or operated, or sites used for the disposal of its and other parties’ waste. See Financial Statements – Note 23 for information on provisions for environmental restoration and remediation.
A number of pending or anticipated governmental proceedings against certain BP group companies under environmental laws could result in monetary or other sanctions. Group companies are also subject to environmental claims for personal injury and property damage alleging the release of, or exposure to, hazardous substances. The costs associated with future environmental remediation obligations, governmental proceedings and claims could be significant and may be material to the results of operations in the period in which they are recognized. We cannot accurately predict the effects of future developments, such as stricter environmental laws or enforcement policies, or future events at our facilities, on the group, and there can be no assurance that material liabilities and costs will not be incurred in the future. For a discussion of the group’s environmental expenditure, see page 291.
A significant proportion of our fixed assets are located in the US and the EU. US and EU environmental, health and safety regulations significantly affect BP’s operations. Significant legislation and regulation in the US and the EU affecting our businesses and profitability includes the following:
United States
Since taking office in January 2017, the Trump administration has issued a number of Executive Orders (EO) intended to reform the federal permitting and rulemaking processes to reduce regulatory burdens placed on manufacturing generally and the energy industry specifically. These EOs immediately rescind certain policies and procedures and order the commencement of a broad process to identify other actions that may be taken to further reduce these regulatory requirements. It is not clear how much or how quickly these regulatory requirements will be reduced given statutory and rulemaking constraints and the likely legal challenges to some of these initiatives which can result in regulatory uncertainty and compliance challenges for our operations.
The National Environmental Policy Act (NEPA) requires that the federal government gives proper consideration to the environment prior to undertaking any major federal action that significantly affects the environment, which includes the issuance of federal permits. The environmental reviews required by NEPA can delay projects. State law analogues to NEPA could also limit or delay our projects. On 15 August 2017 the Trump administration issued EO 13807 which directs federal agencies to take certain actions to streamline the NEPA process although the effect of EO 13807 on our operations remains uncertain. In 2018 the Trump Administration started the rulemaking process to reform the NEPA regulations consistent with EO 13807.
 
The CAA regulates air emissions, permitting, fuel specifications and other aspects of our production, distribution and marketing activities.
The Energy Policy Act of 2005 and the Energy Independence and Security Act of 2007 affect our US fuel markets by, among other things, imposing the limitations discussed above under ‘Greenhouse gas regulation’. EPA regulations impose light, medium and heavy duty vehicle emissions standards for GHGs (both fuel economy and tailpipe standards) as well as for nonroad engines and vehicles and permitting requirements for certain large GHG stationary emission sources. California also imposes Low Emission Vehicle (LEV) and Zero Emission Vehicle (ZEV) standards on vehicle manufacturers and a number of other states impose different stricter GHG emission limits on vehicles. These regulations may impact fuel demand and product mix in California and those states adopting LEV and ZEV standards and may impact BP’s product mix and demand for particular products.
In August 2018 the US Department of Transportation and EPA issued a joint proposed rulemaking to establish new or revised fuel economy and tailpipe carbon dioxide emissions standards for passenger cars and light trucks covering model years (MY) 2021 through 2026. The Trump administration’s proposed option would lock in the 2020 standards until 2026. This would be a rollback from the Obama Administration’s rules. The agencies have said they intend to finalize this rulemaking in Spring 2019. The proposal would also eliminate the waiver allowing California and other states to set their own LEV and ZEV standards. California and other states have announced their intention to litigate if such a rule is finalized.
The Clean Water Act regulates wastewater and other effluent discharges from BP’s facilities, and BP is required to obtain discharge permits, install control equipment and implement operational controls and preventative measures.
The Resource Conservation and Recovery Act regulates the generation, storage, transportation and disposal of wastes associated with our operations and can require corrective action at locations where such wastes have been disposed of or released.
The Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (CERCLA) can, in certain circumstances, impose the entire cost of investigation and remediation on a party who owned or operated a site contaminated with a hazardous substance, or who arranged for disposal of a hazardous substance at a site. BP has incurred, or is likely to incur, liability under CERCLA or similar state laws, including costs attributed to insolvent or unidentified parties.
BP is also subject to claims for remediation costs under other federal and state laws, and to claims for natural resource damages under CERCLA, the Oil Pollution Act of 1990 (OPA 90) (discussed below) and other federal and state laws. CERCLA also requires notification of releases of hazardous substances to national, state and local government agencies, as applicable. In addition, the Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act requires reporting on the storage, use and releases of designated quantities of certain listed hazardous substances to federal, state and local government agencies, as applicable.
The Toxic Substances Control Act (TSCA) regulates BP’s manufacture, import, export, sale and use of chemical substances and products. In June 2016, the US enacted legislation to modernize and reform TSCA. The EPA has promulgated rules, processes and guidance to implement the reforms. Key components of the reform legislation include: (1) a reset of the TSCA chemical inventory, (2) new chemical management prioritization efforts expanding risk assessment and risk management practices, (3) new confidentiality provisions, and (4) new authority for the EPA to impose a fee structure. In 2017, the EPA finalized details regarding the process and requirements for execution of the TSCA inventory reset.
The Occupational Safety and Health Act imposes workplace safety and health requirements on BP operations along with significant process safety management obligations, requiring continuous evaluation and improvement of operational practices to enhance

294
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


safety and reduce workplace emissions at gas processing, refining and other regulated facilities. On 17 January 2017, the US Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) published an instruction guidance document for implementing and conducting a “National Emphasis Program” for process safety management (PSM) in covered facilities. Over the next several years OSHA will pursue inspections through the National Emphasis Program to ensure compliance with PSM requirements in both refineries and chemical plants.
The US Department of Transportation (DOT) regulates the transport of BP’s petroleum products such as crude oil, gasoline, petrochemicals and other hydrocarbon liquids.
The Maritime Transportation Security Act and the DOT Hazardous Materials (HAZMAT) regulations impose security compliance regulations on certain BP facilities.
OPA 90 imposes operational requirements, liability standards and other obligations governing the transportation of petroleum products in US waters and is implemented through regulations issued by the EPA, the US Coast Guard, the DOT, the OSHA, the Bureau of Safety and Environmental Enforcement and various states. Alaska and the West Coast states currently have the most demanding state requirements.
The Outer Continental Shelf Land Act, the MLA and other statutes give the Department of Interior (DOI) and the BLM authority to regulate operations and air emissions, including equipment and testing, on offshore and onshore operations on federal lands subject to DOI authority.
The Endangered Species Act and Marine Mammal Protection Act protect certain species from adverse human impacts. The species and their habitat may be protected thereby restricting operations or development at certain times and in certain places. With an increasing number of species being protected, we have experienced increasing restrictions on our activities.
European Union
The Industrial Emissions Directive (IED) 2010 provides the framework for granting permits for major industrial sites. It lays down rules on integrated prevention and control of air, water and soil pollution arising from industrial activities. As part of the IED framework, additional emission limit values are informed by sector specific and cross-sector Best Available Technology (BAT) Conclusions, such as the BAT Conclusions for the refining sector, for large combustion plants as well as common waste water and waste gas treatment and management systems in the chemical sector. These may result in requirements for BP to further reduce its emissions, particularly its air and water emissions.
The EU regulation on ozone depleting substances 2009 (ODS Regulation) requires companies to reduce the use of ozone depleting substances (ODSs) and phase out use of certain ODSs. BP continues to replace ODSs in refrigerants and/or equipment in the EU and elsewhere, in accordance with the Montreal Protocol and related legislation. The Kigali Amendment to the Montreal Protocol (which aims to reduce hydrofluorocarbons) came into force on 1 January 2019. In addition, the EU regulation on fluorinated GHGs with high global warming potential (the F-gas Regulations) require a phase-out of certain hydrofluorocarbons, based on global warming potential.
European regulations also establish passenger car performance standards for CO2 tailpipe emissions (European Regulation (EC) No 443/2009). By 2021, the European passenger fleet emissions target for new vehicles will be 95 grams of CO2 per kilometre. This target will be achieved by manufacturing fuel efficient vehicles and vehicles using alternative, low carbon fuels such as hydrogen and electricity. In addition, vehicle emission test cycles and vehicle type approval procedures are being updated to improve accuracy of emission and efficiency measurements. European vehicle CO2 emission regulations also impact the fuel efficiency of vans. By 2020, the EU fleet of newly registered vans must meet a target of 147 grams of CO2 per kilometre, which is 19% below the 2012 fleet average.
 
In October 2018 the European Council released an updated proposal on setting CO2 reduction targets, from a 2021 baseline, of 15% by 2025 and 35% by 2030 for passenger cars, and 15% by 2025 and 30% by 2030 for passenger vans and heavy duty vehicles.
The EU Registration, Evaluation Authorization and Restriction of Chemicals (REACH) Regulation 2006 requires registration of chemical substances manufactured in or imported into the EU, together with the submission of relevant hazard and risk data. REACH affects our manufacturing or trading/import operations in the EU. Since coming into force in 2007, REACH implementation has followed a phase-in schedule defined by the EU, the final phase of which was completed 31 May 2018. BP maintains compliance by checking whether imports are covered by the registrations of non-EU suppliers’ representatives, preparing and submitting registration dossiers to cover new manufactured and imported substances, and updating previously submitted registrations as required. Some substances registered previously, including substances supplied to us by third parties for our use, are now subject to evaluation and review for potential authorization or restriction procedures, and possible banning, by the European Chemicals Agency and EU member state authorities. In addition, BP’s facilities and operations in several EU countries have undergone REACH compliance inspections by the competent authority for the respective EU member state. An amendment to the Annex of the Regulation on classification, labelling and packaging of substances and mixture (CLP Regulation) requires harmonized notification of information on hazardous materials (certain lubricant and fuel formations) to EU member state poison centres. The uniform notification rules will apply as of January 2020 for consumer products, from 2021 for professional and 2024 for industrial uses.
Outside the EU, Turkey has published REACH-like regulations, known as KKDIK, as well as related implementation schedules and substance registrations. BP is compiling and preparing the requisite information to meet the pre-registration requirements for the KKDIK.
The EU Offshore Safety Directive was adopted in 2013. Its purpose is to introduce a harmonized regime aimed at reducing the potential environmental, health and safety impacts of the offshore oil and gas industry throughout EU waters. The Directive has been implemented in the UK primarily through the Offshore Installations (Offshore Safety Directive) (Safety Case etc.) Regulations 2015.
The Water Framework Directive (WFD) published in 2000 aims to protect the quantity and quality of ground and surface waters of the EU member states. The ongoing implementation of the WFD and the related Environmental Quality Standards Directive 2008 as well as the planned review of the WFD in 2019 is likely to require additional compliance efforts and increased costs for managing freshwater withdrawals and discharges from BP’s EU operations.
The “Best Available Techniques Guidance Document on upstream hydrocarbon exploration and production” seeks to document best practice in the upstream sector. The guidance defines Best Available Techniques and best risk management approaches across the upstream lifecycle, from exploration and appraisal through to decommissioning, and largely draws on experience and good practice from existing standards as well as existing regulatory regimes from Member States. While the document is non-binding, the European Commission are encouraging regulatory authorities to utilize this guidance when issuing permits. The guidance is in the final stages of review and is expected to be published in 2019.
Regulations governing the discharge of treated water have also been developed in countries outside of the US and EU. This includes regulations in Trinidad and Angola. In Trinidad, BP is upgrading its water treatment facilities to meet consent levels agreed with the regulators to apply water discharge rules arising from the Certificate of Environmental Clearance (CEC) Regulations 2001 and associated Water Pollution Rules 2007. In Angola, BP has upgraded produced water treatment systems to meet revised oil in water limits for produced water discharge under Executive Decree ED 97-14.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
295


The Abidjan Convention has been now been ratified by more than 15 African nations, including Angola. The Convention, along with the Additional Protocol published in 2012, sets environmental quality standards for the discharge of chemicals to the marine environment. BP currently operates produced water treatment to meet these quality standards in Angola and is designing systems to meet the standard for our future gas operations in Mauritania and Senegal.
Environmental maritime regulations
BP’s shipping operations are subject to extensive national and international regulations governing liability, operations, training, spill prevention and insurance. These include:
Liability and spill prevention and planning requirements governing, among others, tankers, barges, and offshore facilities are imposed by OPA in US waters. OPA also mandates a levy on imported and domestically produced oil to fund oil spill responses. Some states, including Alaska, Washington, Oregon and California, impose additional liability for oil spills. Outside US territorial waters, BP Shipping tankers are subject to international liability, spill response and preparedness regulations under the UN’s International Maritime Organization (IMO), including the International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage, the International Convention for the Prevention of Pollution from Ships (MARPOL), the International Convention on Oil Pollution, Preparedness, Response and Co-operation, and the International Convention on Civil Liability for Bunker Oil Pollution Damage. In April 2010, the Hazardous and Noxious Substance (HNS) Protocol 2010 was adopted to address issues that have inhibited ratification of the International Convention on Liability and Compensation for Damage in Connection with the Carriage of Hazardous and Noxious Substances by Sea 1996. As at 31 December 2018, as the required minimum number of contracting states had not been achieved, the HNS Convention had not entered into force.
A global sulphur cap of 0.5% will apply to marine fuel from January 2020 under MARPOL. In order to comply, ships will either need to consume low sulphur marine fuels, operate on other low sulphur fuels such as LNG or implement approved abatement technology to enable them to meet the low sulphur emissions requirements while continuing to use higher sulphur fuel. This new global cap will not alter the lower limits that apply in the sulphur oxides Emissions Control Areas established by the IMO. Measures to support consistent global implementation are expected to be finalized in 2019.
Under the International Convention for the Control and Management of Ships’ Ballast Water and Sediments 2004, which entered into force in September 2017, ships in international traffic are required to manage their ballast water and sediments to a certain standard, according to a ship-specific ballast water management plan.
The Convention for the Protection of the Marine Environment of the North-East Atlantic (OSPAR), entered into force in March 1998, is an international convention which aims to protect the marine environment of the North-East Atlantic. OSPAR has 16 contracting parties, including the UK Government. Work carried out in accordance with OSPAR is managed by the OSPAR Commission, which is made up of government representatives of the 15 contracting parties and the EU. OSPAR Recommendation 2001/1 relates to the management of produced water from offshore installations in the North Sea. The 2001 recommendation set a target of a 15% reduction in the total quantity of oil in produced water discharged by 2006 compared to 2000 levels and a performance standard for dispersed oil in produced water discharged into the sea of 30 mg/l. More recently, guidelines for the implementation of a risk-based approach to the management of produced water discharges from offshore installations were adopted (OSPAR Recommendation 2012/5). This approach supports a key goal of the 2001 recommendations, that by 2020 Contracting Parties should achieve a reduction of oil in produced water discharged into the sea to a level which will adequately ensure that each of those discharges will present no harm to the marine environment.
 
The EU shipping monitoring, reporting and verification (MRV) regulation entered into force in July 2015 and is aimed at gathering data on CO2 emissions based on ships’ fuel consumption. It is considered the first step of a staged approach for the inclusion of maritime transport emissions in the EU’s GHG reduction commitment. In parallel, through amendments to MARPOL Annex VI, the IMO Data Collection System (DCS) for collecting and analysing fuel consumption data came into effect in March 2018.
To meet its financial responsibility requirements, BP Shipping maintains marine pollution liability insurance in respect of its operated ships to a maximum limit of $1 billion for each occurrence through mutual insurance associations (P&I Clubs), although there can be no assurance that a spill will necessarily be adequately covered by insurance or that liabilities will not exceed insurance recoveries.
Legal proceedings
Proceedings relating to the Deepwater Horizon oil spill
Introduction
BP Exploration & Production Inc. (BPXP) was lease operator of Mississippi Canyon, Block 252 in the Gulf of Mexico (Macondo), where the semi-submersible rig Deepwater Horizon was deployed at the time of the 20 April 2010 explosion and fire and resulting oil spill (the Incident). Lawsuits and claims arising from the Incident were brought principally in US federal and state courts.
Many of the lawsuits in federal court relating to the Incident were consolidated by the Federal Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation into two multi-district litigation proceedings, one in federal district court in Houston for the securities, derivative and Employee Retirement Income Security Act (ERISA) cases (MDL 2185) and another in federal district court in New Orleans for the remaining cases (MDL 2179). A Plaintiffs’ Steering Committee (PSC) was established to act on behalf of individual and business plaintiffs in MDL 2179. All federal and state governmental claims in relation to the Incident have now been settled or dismissed and the 2014 administrative agreement with the US Environmental Protection Agency and BP’s obligations thereunder ended in March 2019. The remaining proceedings arising from the Incident are discussed below.
PSC settlements
PSC settlements – Economic and Property Damages Settlement Agreement
In 2012 the Economic and Property Damages Settlement was entered into with the PSC to resolve certain economic and property damage claims. It also resolved property damage in certain areas along the Gulf Coast, as well as claims for additional payments under certain Master Vessel Charter Agreements entered into in the course of the Vessels of Opportunity Program implemented as part of the response to the Incident.
The economic and property damages claims process, which is under court supervision through the settlement claims process established by the Economic and Property Damages Settlement, continued during 2018. Only a very small number of business economic loss claims remain to be determined, although certain business economic loss claims continue to be appealed by BP and/or the claimants.
For more information about BP’s current estimate of the total cost of the Economic and Property Damages Settlement, see Financial statements – Note 2.
PSC settlements – Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement
In 2012 the Medical Benefits Class Action Settlement (Medical Settlement) was entered into with the PSC. It involves payments to qualifying class members based on a matrix for certain Specified Physical Conditions (SPCs), as well as a 21-year Periodic Medical Consultation Program (PMCP) for qualifying class members, and also includes provisions regarding class members pursuing claims for later-manifested physical conditions (LMPCs).

296
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


The deadline for submitting SPC and PMCP claims was 12 February 2015. The Medical Claims Administrator has reported the total number of claims submitted is 37,226. As of 25 January 2019, 27,607 claims (comprising 22,833 SPC and 4,774 PMCP only) have been approved for compensation totalling approximately $67 million; 9,615 claims have been denied; and 4 claims are pending determination.
In order to seek compensation from BP for an LMPC, class members must file a notice with the Medical Claims Administrator within 4 years after either (i) the date of first diagnosis of the LMPC or (ii) the effective date of the MSA (12 February 2014), whichever is later. As of 22 February 2019, there are 2,159 pending lawsuits brought by class members claiming LMPCs.
Other civil complaints – economic loss
PSC settlement - Opt out and Excluded claims
In 2016, the vast majority of economic loss and property damage claims from individuals and businesses that either opted out of the 2012 PSC settlement and/or were excluded from that settlement were either resolved or dismissed. Although several groups of plaintiffs whose claims were dismissed by the district court for noncompliance with the district court’s prior orders filed appeals in the Fifth Circuit, only a small number of those individual and business plaintiffs now have pending appeals.
BP-Branded Fuel Dealers
On 23 March 2017, two plaintiffs filed an appeal to the Fifth Circuit from the district court’s October 2012 ruling dismissing their claims on the grounds that alleged losses by dealers of BP-branded fuel allegedly caused by the reputation impact of the spill on the BP brand are not compensable under OPA 90. On 3 July 2018, the Fifth Circuit affirmed the district court’s ruling dismissing their claims.
General Maritime Law Claims
On 19 July 2017 the district court held that maritime claims by 215 plaintiffs would be subject to further proceedings in MDL 2179 under OPA 90 and under general maritime law. The court dismissed with prejudice all other claims for economic loss brought by private plaintiffs under general maritime law. Five groups of plaintiffs filed appeals in the Fifth Circuit from the dismissal of their claims, and two of those appeals remain pending.
MDL 2179 - Other Economic Loss and Property Damage Claims
On 11 January 2018, the district court issued an order requiring all remaining plaintiffs in MDL 2179 with economic loss or property damage claims to file by 11 April 2018 a verified sworn statement regarding the actual damages each such plaintiff seeks in its pending litigation and an explanation of how those alleged damages were causally related to the Incident. On 10 July 2018 the district court issued an order on those plaintiffs’ compliance with the January 2018 order and on 29 November 2018 ruled on several motions for reconsideration of its July 2018 compliance order. In those two orders, the district court identified fewer than 200 plaintiffs with economic loss or property damage claims that it deemed to have complied with its January 2018 order, and it dismissed the remaining economic loss or property damage claims with prejudice.
Other civil complaints – personal injury
The vast majority of post-explosion clean-up, medical monitoring and personal injury claims from individuals that either opted out of the 2012 PSC settlement and/or were excluded from that settlement have been dismissed.
On 9 April 2018 the district court in MDL 2179 issued an order requiring the 981 plaintiffs whose claims for post-explosion clean-up, medical monitoring and personal injury claims occurring after the Incident remain pending in MDL 2179 to file a sworn statement providing detailed information regarding their claims. On 20 September 2018, the district court issued an order requiring more than 150 plaintiffs whose responses to the 9 April 2018 order BP deemed to be materially deficient to show cause in writing by 11 October 2018 why their claims should not be
 
dismissed with prejudice for their failure to comply with the court’s order. The district court has not yet ruled on the show cause submissions.
Individual securities litigation
Following court approval of the settlement of a securities class action brought on behalf of a class of post-explosion American depository share (ADS) holders in 2017, there remained individual cases filed in state and federal courts by pension funds, investment funds and advisers. These were against BP entities and several current and former officers and directors seeking damages for alleged losses those funds suffered because of their purchases and/or holdings of BP ordinary shares and, in certain cases, ADSs. The funds assert claims under English law and, for plaintiffs purchasing ADSs, federal securities law. All of the cases, with the exception of one case that has been stayed, were transferred to MDL 2185. As at 31 December 2018, 28 actions on behalf of 113 plaintiffs remained pending in MDL 2185.
Canadian class actions
Following various legal proceedings, on 26 February 2016, a plaintiff seeking to assert claims under Canadian law against BP on behalf of a class of Canadian residents who allegedly suffered losses because of their purchase of BP ordinary shares and ADSs filed a motion in the Court of Appeal for Ontario to lift a stay on the action. The plaintiff’s motion was granted on 29 July 2016. On 1 September 2017 the court granted in part and denied in part BP’s motion for summary judgment, limiting the case to three alleged misstatements and narrowing the class period. On 3 April 2018, the Court of Appeal for Ontario affirmed that decision.
Non-US government lawsuits
On 5 April 2011, the Mexican State of Yucatan submitted a claim to the Gulf Coast Claims Facility (GCCF) alleging potential damage to its natural resources and environment, and seeking to recover the cost of assessing the alleged damage. This was followed by a suit against BP which was transferred to MDL 2179. On 5 April 2017, BP moved to dismiss the State of Yucatan’s claims, and the court granted BP's motion to dismiss on 6 March 2018.
On 19 April 2013, the Mexican federal government filed a civil action against BP and others in MDL 2179. The complaint sought a determination that each defendant was liable under OPA 90 for damages that included the costs of responding to the spill, natural resource damages allegedly recoverable by Mexico as an OPA 90 trustee and the net loss of taxes, royalties, fees or net profits. The claims in this civil action were resolved by agreement effective 15 February 2018 and dismissed on 28 March 2018.
On 18 October 2012, before a Mexican Federal District Court located in Mexico City, a class action complaint was filed against BP America Production Company (BPAPC) and other BP subsidiaries. The plaintiffs, who allegedly are fishermen, are seeking, among other things, compensatory damages for the class members who allegedly suffered economic losses, as well as an order requiring BP to remediate environmental damage resulting from the Incident, to provide funding for the preservation of the environment and to conduct environmental impact studies in the Gulf of Mexico for the next 10 years. On 15 May 2018, BP was formally served with the post-class certification complaint. On 27 June 2018, BP answered the complaint by seeking dismissal on various grounds including that no oil reached Mexican waters or land and there was no economic or environmental harm in Mexico.
On 3 December 2015 and 29 March 2016, Acciones Colectivas de Sinaloa (ACS) filed two class actions (which have since been consolidated) in a Mexican Federal District Court on behalf of several Mexican states against BPXP, BPAPC, and other purported BP subsidiaries. In these class actions, plaintiffs seek an order requiring the BP defendants to repair the damage to the Gulf of Mexico, to pay penalties, and to compensate plaintiffs for damage to property, to health and for economic loss. BPXP was formally served with the action on 8 December 2017. BPXP opposed class certification and sought dismissal on 1 February 2018, principally on the basis that that no oil reached Mexican waters or land and there was no economic or environmental harm in Mexico. BPAPC was formally served with the

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
297


action in October 2018 and filed an opposition to class certification and requested dismissal on 28 December 2018.
Other legal proceedings
FERC and CFTC matters
Following an investigation by the US Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC) and the US Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC) of several BP entities, the Administrative Law Judge of the FERC ruled on 13 August 2015 that BP manipulated the market by selling next-day, fixed price natural gas at Houston Ship Channel in 2008 in order to suppress the Gas Daily index and benefit its financial position. On 11 July 2016 the FERC issued an Order affirming the initial decision and directing BP to pay a civil penalty of $20.16 million and to disgorge $207,169 in unjust profits. On 10 August 2016, BP filed a request for rehearing with the FERC. BP strongly disagrees with the FERC’s decision and will ultimately appeal to the US Court of Appeals if necessary.
OSHA matters
On 8 March 2010, the US Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) issued 65 citations to BP Products North America Inc. (BP Products) and BP-Husky Refining LLC (BP-Husky) for alleged violations of the Process Safety Management (PSM) standard at the Toledo refinery, with penalties of approximately $3 million. These citations resulted from an inspection conducted pursuant to OSHA’s Petroleum Refinery Process Safety Management National Emphasis Program. Both BP Products and BP-Husky contested the citations. The outcome of a pre-trial settlement of a number of the citations and a trial of the remainder was a reduction in the total penalty in respect of the citations from the original amount of approximately $3 million to $80,000. The OSH Review Commission granted OSHA’s petition for review and briefing was completed in the first half of 2014. On 27 September 2018, the OSH Review Commission issued its decision, which reduced the citations to two remaining, and reduced the penalty to $7,000. OSHA has decided not to appeal this decision.
Prudhoe Bay leak
In March and August 2006, oil leaked from oil transit pipelines operated by BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. (BPXA) at the Prudhoe Bay unit on the North Slope of Alaska. On 12 May 2008, a BP p.l.c. shareholder filed a consolidated complaint alleging violations of federal securities law on behalf of a putative class of BP p.l.c. shareholders, based on alleged misrepresentations concerning the integrity of the Prudhoe Bay pipeline before its shutdown on 6 August 2006. On 7 December 2015, the complaint was dismissed with prejudice. On 5 January 2016, plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal of that decision to the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals. On July 31, 2018 the Ninth Circuit granted the parties’ motion to dismiss the appeal voluntarily ending the litigation.
Lead paint matters
Since 1987, Atlantic Richfield Company (Atlantic Richfield), a subsidiary of BP, has been named as a co-defendant in numerous lawsuits brought in the US alleging injury to persons and property caused by lead pigment in paint. The majority of the lawsuits have been abandoned or dismissed against Atlantic Richfield. Atlantic Richfield is named in these lawsuits as alleged successor to International Smelting and Refining and another company that manufactured lead pigment during the period 1920-1946. The plaintiffs include individuals and governmental entities. Several of the lawsuits purport to be class actions. The lawsuits seek various remedies including compensation to lead-poisoned children, cost to find and remove lead paint from buildings, medical monitoring and screening programmes, public warning and education of lead hazards, reimbursement of government healthcare costs and special education for lead-poisoned citizens and punitive damages. No lawsuit against Atlantic Richfield has been settled nor has Atlantic Richfield been subject to a final adverse judgment in any proceeding. The amounts claimed and, if such suits were successful, the costs of implementing the remedies sought in the various cases could be
 
substantial. While it is not possible to predict the outcome of these legal actions, Atlantic Richfield believes that it has valid defences. It intends to defend such actions vigorously and believes that the incurrence of liability is remote. Consequently, BP believes that the impact of these lawsuits on the group’s results, financial position or liquidity will not be material.
Scharfstein v. BP West Coast Products, LLC
A class action lawsuit was filed against BP West Coast Products, LLC (BPWCP) in Oregon State Court under the Oregon Unlawful Trade Practices Act on behalf of customers who used a debit card at ARCO gasoline stations in Oregon during the period 1 January 2011 to 30 August 2013, alleging that ARCO sites in Oregon failed to provide sufficient notice of the 35 cents per transaction debit card fee. In January 2014, the jury rendered a verdict against BPWCP and awarded statutory damages of $200 per class member. On 25 August 2015, the trial court determined the size of the class to be slightly in excess of two million members. On 31 May 2016 the trial court entered a judgment against BPWCP for the amount of $417.3 million. On 31 May 2018 the Oregon Court of Appeals affirmed the trial court’s ruling. BP filed a Petition for Review to the Oregon Supreme Court which was denied on 8 November 2018. In March 2019, BP and the Plaintiffs agreed to a settlement of the class action lawsuit, subject to final court approval. BP intends to file a petition for a writ of certiorari to the US Supreme Court in order to preserve BP’s appeal rights pending final court approval of the settlement. BP’s provisions for litigation and claims includes a provision for this lawsuit.
International trade sanctions
During the period covered by this report, non-US subsidiaries«, or other non-US entities of BP, conducted limited activities in, or with persons from, certain countries identified by the US Department of State as State Sponsors of Terrorism or otherwise subject to US and EU sanctions (Sanctioned Countries). Sanctions restrictions continue to be insignificant to the group’s financial condition and results of operations. BP monitors its activities with Sanctioned Countries, persons from Sanctioned Countries and individuals and companies subject to US and EU sanctions and seeks to comply with applicable sanctions laws and regulations.
In May 2018, the US government announced its planned withdrawal from the Joint Comprehensive Plan of Action (JCPOA) under which the US and the EU had implemented temporary, limited and reversible relief of certain sanctions related to Iran. The US government tasked OFAC with implementing the full re-imposition of both primary and secondary sanctions in respect of Iran by the end of a wind-down period. As a result of the JCPOA, BP had considered and developed possible business opportunities in relation to Iran, engaged in discussions with Iranian government officials and other Iranian nationals and attended conferences. BP will continue to monitor and assess business opportunities in Iran which are compliant with EU and US laws applicable to BP including potentially attending meetings in connection with this purpose.
On 30 November 2018, BP completed the sale of certain of its assets in the North Sea, including its ownership stake, and the transfer of its role as operator, in the North Sea Rhum field (Rhum) joint arrangement to Serica Energy plc (Serica). Prior to that date, Rhum was owned under a 50:50 unincorporated joint arrangement between BP and Iranian Oil Company (U.K.) Limited (IOC).
BP has a 28.8% interest in and operates the Azerbaijan Shah Deniz field (Shah Deniz) and a related gas pipeline entity, South Caucasus Pipeline Company Limited (SCPC), and has a 23% non-operated interest in a related gas marketing entity, Azerbaijan Gas Supply Company Limited (AGSC). Naftiran Intertrade Co. Limited and NICO SPV Limited (collectively, NICO) have a 10% non-operating interest in each of Shah Deniz and SCPC and an 8% non-operating interest in AGSC. Shah Deniz, SCPC and AGSC continue in operation as they were excluded from the main operative provisions of the EU regulations as well as from the application of the US sanctions, and fall within the exception for certain natural gas projects under Section 603 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 (ITRA).
On 3 December 2018 BP entered into an agreement with, among others, SOCAR and NICO pursuant to which SOCAR shall pay to BP

298
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Exploration Shah Deniz Limited (BPXSD), as the Shah Deniz Operator, an amount in respect of compensation for NICO’s waiver of its right to lift its share of Shah Deniz condensate. Such amounts shall be used to cover cash calls to NICO in respect of operating costs due from NICO to BPXSD. On 30 November 2018, OFAC issued a new licence in relation to these arrangements.
BP holds an interest in a non-BP operated Indian joint venture« that sold produced crude oil to an Indian entity in which NICO holds a minority, non-controlling stake.
Both the US and the EU have enacted strong sanctions against Syria, including a prohibition on the purchase of Syrian-origin crude and a US prohibition on the provision of services to Syria by US persons. The EU sanctions against Syria include a prohibition on supplying certain equipment used in the production, refining or liquefaction of petroleum resources, as well as restrictions on dealing with the Central Bank of Syria and numerous other Syrian financial institutions.
Following the imposition in 2011 of further US and EU sanctions against Syria, BP terminated all sales of crude oil and petroleum products into Syria, though BP continues to supply aviation fuel to non-governmental Syrian resellers outside of Syria.
BP sells lubricants in Cuba through a 50:50 joint arrangement and trades in small quantities of lubricants.
During 2014 the US and the EU imposed sanctions on certain Russian activities, individuals and entities, including Rosneft. Certain sectoral sanctions also apply to entities in which entities on the relevant sectoral sanctions list own a certain percentage interest, being either 33% or 50% depending on certain criteria. In August 2017, Russia related sanctions were passed in the US which target among other things: (i) Russian energy export pipelines; (ii) privatisation of state owned assets in Russia; and (iii) certain international offshore Arctic, deepwater and/or shale exploration and production oil projects. We are not aware of any material adverse effect on our current income and investment in Russia or elsewhere as a consequence of those sanctions.
BP maintains bank accounts and has registered and paid required fees to maintain registrations of patents and trademarks in certain Sanctioned Countries.
BP has equity interests in non-operated joint arrangements« with air fuel sellers, resellers, and fuel delivery services around the world. From time to time, the joint arrangement operator or other partners may sell or deliver fuel to airlines from Sanctioned Countries or flights to Sanctioned Countries, without BP's involvement.
BP has no control over the activities non-controlled associates may undertake in Sanctioned Countries or with persons from Sanctioned Countries.
Disclosure pursuant to Section 219 of ITRA
To our knowledge, none of BP’s activities, transactions or dealings are required to be disclosed pursuant to ITRA Section 219, with the following possible exceptions:
Prior to 30 November 2018, Rhum, located in the UK sector of the North Sea, was operated by BP Exploration Operating Company Limited (BPEOC), a non-US subsidiary of BP, and Rhum was owned under a 50:50 unincorporated joint arrangement between BPEOC and Iranian Oil Company (U.K.) Limited (IOC) which was initially established in 1974. During 2018, BP recorded gross revenues of $177.3 million related to its interests in Rhum. BP had a net profit of $87.7 million for the year ended 31 December 2018.
BP has sought to carry out its role as operator of the Rhum joint arrangement in compliance with US sanctions and has obtained a series of specific OFAC licences relating to the ongoing operation of the Rhum field.
In November 2017, BPEOC entered into an agreement with IOC for the sale and purchase of an IOC entitlement to Forties blend crude oil. The parties agreed to set off the purchase price - £29.89 million ($39.88 million equivalent) - against IOC’s share of operating costs incurred or to be incurred by BPEOC as operator of the Rhum field under the Rhum joint operating agreement. 604,976 net barrels of Forties blend crude oil was loaded at a North Sea terminal in January 2018 and delivered to BP’s Rotterdam refinery. Upon
 
delivery at BP’s Rotterdam refinery, the Forties blend crude oil was comingled with other products for refining, and therefore BP is unable to ascertain an amount of gross revenue or gross profit attributable to it.
During 2018, BPEOC received £223,693 ($298,456 equivalent) (net of tariffs) from BPEOC Forties Pipeline System in respect of monies owed to IOC in relation to the purchase of IOC’s share of Onshore Raw Gas at the Kinneil terminal of the Forties Pipeline System. BP and IOC agreed to set off the £223,693 ($298,456 equivalent) against IOC’s share of operating costs incurred or to be incurred by BPEOC as operator of the Rhum field under the Rhum joint operating agreement.
During 2018, BPEOC received £2.79 million ($3.73 million equivalent) (net of tariffs) from a non-US third party in respect of the sale to such non-US third party of certain NGLs redelivered from the St Fergus terminal. These NGLs had been acquired by BPEOC from IOC at the St. Fergus terminal. BP and IOC agreed to set off the £2.79 million ($3.73 million equivalent) against IOC’s share of operating costs incurred by BPEOC as operator of the Rhum field under the Rhum joint operating agreement.
As noted above, on 30 November 2018, BP completed the sale of its ownership stake in the Rhum joint arrangement and transferred its role as operator to Serica. Prior to the sale, on 5 October 2018, Serica and BP received a conditional licence from OFAC relating to the ongoing operation of the Rhum field. The licence was valid until 31 October 2019 and was conditional upon arrangements being put in place before 5 November 2018 relating to the interests in Rhum held by IOC. An updated licence from OFAC on substantially the same terms and a letter of comfort permitting all non-US persons to support Rhum activities in compliance with US secondary sanctions were issued on 2 November 2018. On the same date the conditions in such OFAC licence in respect of the interest in Rhum held by IOC were met in full. These conditions were satisfied through arrangements which provide that all benefits accruing from and relating to IOC’s interest in Rhum will be held in escrow, by a trust and management company (Rhum Management Company) set up for this purpose, for such period as US sanctions apply. The arrangements are designed to ensure that neither IOC nor any direct or indirect parent company of IOC (including any member of the Government of Iran) will derive any economic benefit from Rhum, or exercise any decision-making powers in respect of Rhum, during that period. From satisfaction of the OFAC licence conditions on 2 November 2018, BP dealt with the Rhum Management Company in respect of Rhum joint venture matters.
In December 2018, BP made a cash transfer of £2.69 million ($3.59 million equivalent) to Rhum Management Company. This transfer represented the net amount of IOC funds in the Rhum joint venture account which had not, to that date, been set off against IOC’s share of operating costs incurred by BPEOC as operator of the Rhum field under the Rhum joint operating agreement.
BP does not expect to enter into any further similar arrangements with IOC or any member of the Government of Iran in relation to the Rhum field. BP will continue to purchase from Serica’s liftings from Rhum or provide services to Serica as the operator of Rhum.
On 17 July 2018 BP Iran Limited terminated its lease of an office in Tehran. The office had been used for administrative activities. In 2018, taxes, including rental tax payments associated with the Tehran office, with an aggregate US dollar equivalent value of approximately $11,000, were paid from a BP trust account held with Tadvin Co. to Iranian public entities. No gross revenues or net profits were attributable to these activities.
During 2018, certain BP employees visited Iran for the purpose of meetings with Iranian government officials and other Iranian nationals and attending conferences. Payments were made to Iranian public entities for visas and taxes in relation to such visits with an aggregate US dollar equivalent value of approximately $3,000. In addition, certain BP employees met with Iranian government officials and other Iranian nationals outside of Iran. No gross revenues or net profits were attributable to these activities, save where otherwise disclosed. BP will continue to monitor and assess business opportunities in Iran which are compliant with EU

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
299


and US laws applicable to BP including potentially attending meetings in connection with this purpose.
Material contracts
On 4 April 2016 the district court approved the Consent Decree among BP Exploration & Production Inc., BP Corporation North America Inc., BP p.l.c., the United States and the states of Alabama, Florida, Louisiana, Mississippi and Texas (the Gulf states) which fully and finally resolved any and all natural resource damages (NRD) claims of the United States, the Gulf states, and their respective natural resource trustees and all Clean Water Act (CWA) penalty claims, and certain other claims of the United States and the Gulf states.
Concurrently, the definitive Settlement Agreement that BP entered into with the Gulf states (Settlement Agreement) with respect to State claims for economic, property and other losses became effective.
BP has filed the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement as exhibits to its Annual Report on Form 20-F 2018 filed with the SEC. For further details of the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement, see Legal proceedings in BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
Property, plant and equipment
BP has freehold and leasehold interests in real estate and other tangible assets in numerous countries, but no individual property is significant to the group as a whole. For more on the significant subsidiaries of the group at 31 December 2018 and the group percentage of ordinary share capital see Financial statements – Note 37. For information on significant joint ventures« and associates« of the group see Financial statements – Notes 16 and 17.
Related-party transactions
Transactions between the group and its significant joint ventures and associates are summarized in Financial statements – Note 16 and Note 17. In the ordinary course of its business, the group enters into transactions with various organizations with which some of its directors or executive officers are associated. Except as described in this report, the group did not have any material transactions or transactions of an unusual nature with, and did not make loans to, related parties in the period commencing 1 January 2018 to 15 March 2019.
Corporate governance practices
In the US, BP ADSs are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE). The significant differences between BP’s corporate governance practices as a UK company and those required by NYSE listing standards for US companies are listed as follows:
Independence
BP has adopted a robust set of board governance principles, which reflect the UK Corporate Governance Code approach to corporate governance. As such, the way in which BP makes determinations of directors’ independence differs from the NYSE rules.
BP’s board governance principles require that all non-executive directors be determined by the board to be ‘independent in character and judgement and free from any business or other relationship which could materially interfere with the exercise of their judgement’. The BP board has determined that, in its judgement, all of the non-executive directors are independent. In doing so, however, the board did not explicitly take into consideration the independence requirements outlined in the NYSE’s listing standards.
Committees
BP has a number of board committees that are broadly comparable in purpose and composition to those required by NYSE rules for domestic US companies. For instance, BP has a chairman’s (rather than executive) committee and remuneration (rather than compensation) committee. BP also has an audit committee, which NYSE rules require for both US companies and foreign private issuers. These committees are composed solely of non-executive
 
directors whom the board has determined to be independent, in the manner described above.
The BP board governance principles prescribe the composition, main tasks and requirements of each of the committees (see the board committee reports on pages 75-86). BP has not, therefore, adopted separate charters for each committee.
Under US securities law and the listing standards of the NYSE, BP is required to have an audit committee that satisfies the requirements of Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act and Section 303A.06 of the NYSE Listed Company Manual. BP’s audit committee complies with these requirements. The BP audit committee does not have direct responsibility for the appointment, reappointment or removal of the independent auditors. Instead, it follows the UK Companies Act 2006 by making recommendations to the board on these matters for it to put forward for shareholder approval at the AGM.
One of the NYSE’s additional requirements for the audit committee states that at least one member of the audit committee is to have ‘accounting or related financial management expertise’. The board determined that Brendan Nelson possesses such expertise and also possesses the financial and audit committee experiences set forth in both the UK Corporate Governance Code and SEC rules (see Audit committee report on page 75). Mr Nelson is the audit committee financial expert as defined in Item 16A of Form 20-F.
Shareholder approval of equity compensation plans
The NYSE rules for US companies require that shareholders must be given the opportunity to vote on all equity-compensation plans and material revisions to those plans. BP complies with UK requirements that are similar to the NYSE rules. The board, however, does not explicitly take into consideration the NYSE’s detailed definition of what are considered ‘material revisions’.
Code of ethics
The NYSE rules require that US companies adopt and disclose a code of business conduct and ethics for directors, officers and employees. BP has adopted a code of conduct, which applies to all employees and members of the board, and has board governance principles that address the conduct of directors. In addition BP has adopted a code of ethics for senior financial officers as required by the SEC. BP considers that these codes and policies address the matters specified in the NYSE rules for US companies.
Code of ethics
The company has adopted a code of ethics for its group chief executive, chief financial officer, group controller, group head of audit and chief accounting officer as required by the provisions of Section 406 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the rules issued by the SEC. There have been no waivers from the code of ethics relating to any officers.
BP also has a code of conduct, which is applicable to all employees, officers and members of the board. This was updated (and published) in July 2014.
Controls and procedures
Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures
The company maintains ‘disclosure controls and procedures’, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e), that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports the company files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the company’s group chief executive and chief financial officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
In designing and evaluating our disclosure controls and procedures, our management, including the group chief executive and chief financial officer, recognize that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the disclosure controls

300
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


and procedures are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud within the company, if any, have been detected. Further, in the design and evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures our management necessarily was required to apply its judgement in evaluating the costs and benefits of possible control and procedure design options. Also, we have investments in unconsolidated entities. As we do not control these entities, our disclosure controls and procedures with respect to such entities are necessarily substantially more limited than those we maintain with respect to our consolidated subsidiaries. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. The company’s disclosure controls and procedures have been designed to meet, and management believes that they meet, reasonable assurance standards.
The company’s management, with the participation of the company’s group chief executive and chief financial officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(b) as of the end of the period covered by this annual report. Based on that evaluation, the group chief executive and chief financial officer have concluded that the company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective at a reasonable assurance level.
Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting
Management of BP is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. BP’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the principal executive and financial officers to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of BP’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with IFRS.
As of the end of the 2018 fiscal year, management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the criteria in the UK Financial Reporting Council’s Guidance on Risk Management, Internal Control and Related Financial and Business Reporting relating to internal control over financial reporting. Based on this assessment, management has determined that BP’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2018 was effective.
Management’s assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting excluded Petrohawk Energy Corporation, which was acquired on 31 October 2018. Petrohawk financial statements constitute 10.3% and 4.0% of net and total assets respectively, 0.2% of revenues, and 0.05% of net income of the consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended 31 December 2018. This exclusion is in accordance with the general guidance issued by the SEC that an assessment of a recent business combination may be omitted from management’s report on internal control over financial reporting in the first year of consolidation.
The company’s internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect transactions and dispositions of assets; provide reasonable assurances that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with IFRS and that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and the directors of BP; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of BP’s assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements. BP’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2018 has been audited by Deloitte, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing on page 127 of BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018.
Changes in internal control over financial reporting
There were no changes in the group’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the Form 20-F
 
that have materially affected or are reasonably likely to materially affect our internal control over financial reporting.
Principal accountant's fees and services
The audit committee has established policies and procedures for the engagement of the independent registered public accounting firm, Deloitte LLP, to render audit and certain assurance services. The policies provide for pre-approval by the audit committee of specifically defined audit, audit-related, non-audit and other services that are not prohibited by regulatory or other professional requirements. Deloitte is engaged for these services when its expertise and experience of BP are important. Most of this work is of an audit nature. The policy has been updated such that non-audit tax services provided by the audit firm from 2017 onwards are prohibited.
Under the policy, pre-approval is given for specific services within the following categories: advice on accounting, auditing and financial reporting matters; internal accounting and risk management control reviews (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation); non-statutory audit; project assurance and advice on business and accounting process improvement (excluding any services relating to information systems design and implementation relating to BP’s financial statements or accounting records); due diligence in connection with acquisitions, disposals and joint arrangements« (excluding valuation or involvement in prospective financial information); provision of, or access to, Deloitte publications, workshops, seminars and other training materials; provision of reports from data gathered on non-financial policies and information; provision of the independent third party audit in accordance with US Generally Accepted Government Auditing Standards, over the company’s Conflict Minerals Report – where such a report is required under the SEC rule ‘Conflict Minerals’, issued in accordance with Section 1502 of the Dodd Frank Act; and assistance with understanding non-financial regulatory requirements. BP operates a two-tier system for audit and non-audit services. For audit related services, the audit committee has a pre-approved aggregate level, within which specific work may be approved by management. Non-audit services are pre-approved for management to authorize per individual engagement, but above a defined level must be approved by the chairman of the audit committee or the full committee. In response to the revised regulatory guidelines of the UK Financial Reporting Council, the audit committee reviewed and updated its policies with effect from 1 January 2017 and in 2018 further updated its policies to clarify the engagement of the incoming auditor, Deloitte, and the outgoing auditor (and auditor of Rosneft) Ernst & Young to ensure independence. The defined maximum level for pre-approval has been reduced in line with FRC guidance on ‘non-trivial’ engagements. The audit committee has delegated to the chairman of the audit committee authority to approve permitted services provided that the chairman reports any decisions to the committee at its next scheduled meeting. Any proposed service not included in the approved service list must be approved in advance by the audit committee chairman and reported to the committee, or approved by the full audit committee in advance of commencement of the engagement.
The audit committee evaluates the performance of the auditor each year. The audit fees payable to Deloitte are reviewed by the committee in the context of other global companies for cost effectiveness. The committee keeps under review the scope and results of audit work and the independence and objectivity of the auditor. External regulation and BP policy requires the auditor to rotate its lead audit partner every five years. See Financial statements – Note 36 and Audit committee report on page 79 for details of fees for services provided by the auditor.
Directors’ report information
This section of BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 forms part of, and includes certain disclosures which are required by law to be included in, the Directors’ report.
Indemnity provisions

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
301


In accordance with BP’s Articles of Association, on appointment each director is granted an indemnity from the company in respect of liabilities incurred as a result of their office, to the extent permitted by law. These indemnities were in force throughout the financial year and at the date of this report. In respect of those liabilities for which directors may not be indemnified, the company maintained a directors’ and officers’ liability insurance policy throughout 2018. During the year, a review of the terms and scope of the policy was undertaken. The policy was renewed during 2018 and continued into 2019. Although their defence costs may be met, neither the company’s indemnity nor insurance provides cover in the event that the director is proved to have acted fraudulently or dishonestly. Certain subsidiaries are trustees of the group’s pension schemes. Each director of these subsidiaries«is granted an indemnity from the company in respect of liabilities incurred as a result of such a subsidiary’s activities as a trustee of the pension scheme, to the extent permitted by law. These indemnities were in force throughout the financial year and at the date of this report.
Financial risk management objectives and policies
The disclosures in relation to financial risk management objectives and policies, including the policy for hedging, are included in How we manage risk on page 53, Liquidity and capital resources on page 277 and Financial statements – Notes 29 and 30.
Exposure to price risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and cash flow risk
The disclosures in relation to exposure to price risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and cash flow risk are included in Financial statements – Note 29.
Important events since the end of the financial year
Disclosures of the particulars of the important events affecting BP which have occurred since the end of the financial year are included in the Strategic report as well as in other places in the Directors’ report.
Likely future developments in the business
An indication of the likely future developments in the business of the company is included in the Strategic report.
Research and development
An indication of the activities of the company in the field of research and development is included in Innovation in BP on page 40.
Branches
As a global group our interests and activities are held or operated through subsidiaries, branches, joint arrangements« or associates« established in – and subject to the laws and regulations of – many different jurisdictions.
Employees
The disclosures concerning policies in relation to the employment of disabled persons and employee involvement are included in Sustainability – Our people on page 51.
Employee share schemes
Certain shares held as a result of participation in some employee share plans carry voting rights. Voting rights in respect of such shares are exercisable via a nominee. Dividend waivers are in place in respect of unallocated shares held in employee share plan trusts.
Change of control provisions
On 5 October 2015, the United States lodged with the district court in MDL 2179 a proposed Consent Decree between the United States, the Gulf states, BP Exploration & Production Inc., BP Corporation North America Inc. and BP p.l.c., to fully and finally resolve any and all natural resource damages claims of the United States, the Gulf states and their respective natural resource trustees and all Clean Water Act penalty claims, and certain other claims of the United States and the Gulf states. Concurrently, BP entered into a definitive Settlement Agreement with the five Gulf states (Settlement Agreement) with respect to state claims for economic, property and other losses. On 4 April 2016, the district court approved the Consent Decree, at which time the Consent Decree and Settlement Agreement became
 
effective. The federal government and the Gulf states may jointly elect to accelerate the payments under the Consent Decree in the event of a change of control or insolvency of BP p.l.c., and the Gulf states individually have similar acceleration rights under the Settlement Agreement. For further details of the Consent Decree and the Settlement Agreement, see Legal proceedings in BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2015.
Greenhouse gas emissions
The disclosures in relation to greenhouse gas emissions are included in Sustainability – Climate change on page 45.
Disclosures required under Listing Rule 9.8.4R
The information required to be disclosed by Listing Rule 9.8.4R can be located as set out below:
Information required
Page

(1) Amount of interest capitalized
159

(2) – (11)
Not applicable

(12), (13) Dividend waivers
302

(14)
Not applicable



302
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Cautionary statement
In order to utilize the ‘safe harbor’ provisions of the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (the ‘PSLRA’) and the general doctrine of cautionary statements, BP is providing the following cautionary statement. This document contains certain forecasts, projections and forward-looking statements - that is, statements related to future, not past, events and circumstances - with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and businesses of BP and certain of the plans and objectives of BP with respect to these items. These statements may generally, but not always, be identified by the use of words such as ‘will’, ‘expects’, ‘is expected to’, ‘aims’, ‘should’, ‘may’, ‘objective’, ‘is likely to’, ‘intends’, ‘believes’, ‘anticipates’, ‘plans’, ‘we see’ or similar expressions. In particular, among other statements, (i) certain statements in the Chairman’s letter (pages 6-7), the Group chief executive’s letter (page 8), the Strategic report (inside cover and pages 1-56), Additional disclosures (pages 273-304) and Shareholder information (pages 305-314), including but not limited to statements under the headings ‘The changing energy mix’, ‘How we run our business’, ‘Our strategy’ and ‘Global energy markets’ and including but not limited to statements regarding plans and prospects relating to near- and long-term growth, organic capital expenditure, organic growth, the strength of BP’s balance sheet, maintaining a robust cash position, working capital, operating cash flow and margins, capital discipline, growth in sustainable free cash flow and shareholder distributions and future dividend and optional scrip dividend payments; plans and expectations regarding share buybacks, including to offset the impact of dilution from the scrip programme since the third quarter 2017 by the end of 2019; expectations regarding world energy demand, including the growth in relative demand for renewables, oil and gas, and the proportional growth of renewables; expectations with respect to the world energy mix, production, consumption and emissions to 2040; plans and expectations regarding BP’s portfolio, including having a distinctive portfolio, BP’s active management of the portfolio and the flexibility of the portfolio; plans and expectations with respect to disciplined investment; plans and expectations with respect to the Upstream, including growing advantaged oil and gas, being competitive in every basin and producing resilient and competitive barrels; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s transformation agenda; plans and expectations to deliver 2021 financial targets; expectations with respect to reserves bookings from new discoveries; plans and expectations regarding BP’s quality of execution, including to get more from a unit of capital compared to peers; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s refining and petrochemicals portfolio; plans and expectations with respect to creating distinctive retail offers in the Downstream; plans and expectations with regard to new technologies, including their efficiency and impact on production; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s investments in Chargemaster, StoreDot and FreeWire, including for BP to become the leading fuel provider for both conventional and electric vehicles and supporting electric vehicle adoption; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s investment in solar energy and biofuels, including to invest $200 million in Lightsource BP over a three-year period; plans and expectations with respect to the commercial optimization programme; plans and expectations to run safe and reliable operations; plans and expectations regarding BP’s acquisition of onshore-US oil and gas assets from BHP, including expectations regarding the funding and timing of further purchase price payments, future performance and operations and related divestments; plans and expectations to reduce emissions in operations and the low carbon future, including to target zero net growth in operational emissions to 2025 and the Advancing Low Carbon accreditation programme; plans and expectations with respect to evaluating the creation of a joint venture with SOCAR; plans and expectations regarding BP’s low carbon businesses, including in Brazil and India; plans and expectations with respect to Fulcrum BioEnergy’s commercial operations; plans to grow third-party technology licensing income; plans and expectations regarding charges in Other businesses and corporate in 2019 and proceeds from divestments and disposals, including to have more than $10 billion of divestments over the next two years; expectations regarding the determination of business economic loss claims in respect of the 2012 PSC settlement and expectations with respect to the timing and amount of future payments relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill
 
including 2012 PSC settlement payments; plans and expectations regarding sales commitments of BP and its equity-accounted entities; expectations regarding underlying production and capital investment; plans and expectations with respect to gearing including to target gearing within a 20-30% band; expectations regarding oil prices; expectations regarding the return on average capital employed; expectations with respect to the cash break even point; plans and expectations regarding the US onshore, including to increase the liquid hydrocarbon proportion and to upgrade and reposition BPX Energy; plans with regard to BP’s exploration budget; plans and expectations regarding the resiliency of downstream businesses; expectations regarding the effective tax rate in 2019; plans to produce 900,000boe/d from new major projects by 2021 and expectations regarding operating cash margins of this production; plans to start up five major projects in 2019; plans and expectations with respect to expected project start-ups between 2019 and 2021; plans and expectations regarding investment, development, and production levels and the timing thereof with respect to projects and partnerships in Australia, Azerbaijan, Brazil, China, Egypt, India, Indonesia, Libya, Mexico, Mauritania, Russia, São Tomé and Príncipe, Senegal, Turkey, Trinidad & Tobago, Oman, the UK North Sea, the Gulf of Mexico, and the continental United States; expectations regarding the Trans Anatolian Natural Gas Pipeline; plans and expectations regarding social investment; plans and expectations regarding relationships with governments, customers, partners, suppliers and communities; plans and expectations regarding the dual energy challenge and the energy transition, including BP’s progressive and pragmatic approach and planned investments; plans and expectations regarding shareholder resolutions; plans and expectations with respect to BP’s public reporting of ambitions, plans and progress; plans and expectations regarding innovation in BP, including the development of BPme, Wolfspar, a land seismic recording system, APEX, Plant Operations Advisor and wind energy storage systems; plans and expectations regarding plant reliability and base decline, including for base decline to remain between 3-5%; plans and expectations regarding the Tangguh gas facility; expectations regarding discounts for North American heavy crude oil, refining margins and refining turnarounds; plans to undertake joint exploration and development with Rosneft, including to explore oil and gas licence areas in Sakha (Yakutia); expectations regarding pensions and other post-retirement benefits; expectations regarding payments under contractual obligations; plans and expectations regarding additions to BP’s fleet of oil tankers and LNG tankers; expectations regarding the actions of contractors and partners and their terms of service; BP’s aim to maintain a diverse workforce, create an inclusive environment and ensure equal opportunity; policies and goals related to risk management plans; plans regarding activities, dealings and transactions relating to Iran; plans and projections regarding oil and gas reserves, including the turnover time of proved undeveloped reserves to proved developed reserves; expectations regarding the costs of environmental restoration programmes; expectations regarding the renewal of leases; expectations regarding the future value of assets; expectations regarding future regulations and policy, their impact on BP’s business and plans regarding compliance with such regulations; and expectations regarding legal and trial proceedings, court decisions, potential investigations and civil actions by regulators, government entities and/or other entities or parties, and the timing of such proceedings and BP’s intentions in respect thereof; and (ii) certain statements in Corporate governance (pages 57-86) and the Directors’ remuneration report (pages 87-109) with regard to the anticipated future composition of the board of directors and the effects thereof; the board’s goals and areas of focus, including changes to KPIs and those goals stemming from the board’s annual evaluation; plans and expectations regarding directors’ share ownership and remuneration; plans regarding the governance and remuneration processes; and goals, activities and areas of focus of board committees, are all forward looking in nature.
By their nature, forward-looking statements involve risk and uncertainty because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that will or may occur in the future and are outside the control of BP. Actual results may differ materially from those expressed in such statements, depending on a variety of factors, including: the specific factors identified in the discussions accompanying such forward looking statements; the receipt of

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
303


relevant third party and/or regulatory approvals; the timing and level of maintenance and/or turnaround activity; the timing and volume of refinery additions and outages; the timing of bringing new projects onstream; the timing, quantum and nature of certain acquisitions and divestments; future levels of industry product supply, demand and pricing, including supply growth in North America; OPEC quota restrictions; production-sharing agreements effects; operational and safety problems; potential lapses in product quality; economic and financial market conditions generally or in various countries and regions; political stability and economic growth in relevant areas of the world; changes in laws and governmental regulations and policies, including related to climate change; changes in social attitudes and customer preferences; regulatory or legal actions including the types of enforcement action pursued and the nature of remedies sought or imposed; the actions of prosecutors, regulatory authorities and courts; delays in the processes for resolving claims; amounts ultimately determined to be payable and the timing of payments relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill; exchange rate fluctuations; development and use of new technology; recruitment and retention of a skilled workforce; the success or otherwise of partnering; the actions of competitors, trading partners, contractors, subcontractors, creditors, rating agencies and others; our access to future credit resources; business disruption and crisis management; the impact on our reputation of ethical misconduct and non-compliance with regulatory obligations; trading losses; major uninsured losses; decisions by Rosneft’s management and board of directors; the actions of contractors; natural disasters and adverse weather conditions; changes in public expectations and other changes to business conditions; wars and acts of terrorism; cyberattacks or sabotage; and other factors discussed elsewhere in this report including under Risk factors (pages 55-56). In addition to factors set forth elsewhere in this report, those set out above are important factors, although not exhaustive, that may cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements.
Statements regarding competitive position
Statements referring to BP’s competitive position are based on the company’s belief and, in some cases, rely on a range of sources, including investment analysts’ reports, independent market studies and BP’s internal assessments of market share based on publicly available information about the financial results and performance of market participants.


304
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


 
 
 
Shareholder
information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
305


Share prices and listings
Markets and market prices
The primary market for BP’s ordinary shares is the London Stock Exchange (LSE) (trading symbol 'BP'). BP’s ordinary shares are a constituent element of the Financial Times Stock Exchange 100 Index.
Trading of BP’s shares on the LSE is primarily through the use of the Stock Exchange Electronic Trading Service (SETS), introduced in 1997 for the largest companies in terms of market capitalization whose primary listing is the LSE. Under SETS, buy and sell orders at specific prices may be sent electronically to the exchange by any firm that is a member of the LSE, on behalf of a client or on behalf of itself acting as a principal. The orders are then anonymously displayed in the order book. When there is a match on a buy and a sell order, the trade is executed and automatically reported to the LSE. Trading is continuous from 8.00am to 4.30pm UK time but, in the event of a 20% movement in the share price either way, the LSE may impose a temporary halt in the trading of that company’s shares in the order book to allow the market to re-establish equilibrium. Dealings in ordinary shares may also take place between an investor and a market maker, via a member firm, outside the electronic order book.
In the US, BP’s securities are traded on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the form of ADSs (trading symbol 'BP'), for which JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. is the depositary (the Depositary) and transfer agent. The Depositary’s principal office is 383 Madison Avenue, Floor 11, New York, NY, 10179, US. Each ADS represents six ordinary shares. ADSs are listed on the NYSE. ADSs are evidenced by American depositary receipts (ADRs), which may be issued in either certificated or book entry form.
BP's securities are also traded in the form of a global depositary certificate representing BP ordinary shares on the Frankfurt, Hamburg and Dusseldorf Stock Exchanges.
On 11 March 2019, 922,206,611 ADSs (equivalent to approximately 5,533,239,666 ordinary shares or some 27.31% of the total issued share capital, excluding shares held in treasury) were outstanding and were held by approximately 81,329 ADS holders. Of these, about 80,393 had registered addresses in the US at that date. One of the registered holders of ADSs represents some 1,207,639 underlying holders.
On 11 March 2019 there were approximately 235,594 ordinary shareholders. Of these shareholders, around 1,540 had registered addresses in the US and held a total of some 4,112,535 ordinary shares.
Since a number of the ordinary shares and ADSs were held by brokers and other nominees, the number of holders in the US may not be representative of the number of beneficial holders or their respective country of residence.
Dividends
BP’s current policy is to pay interim dividends on a quarterly basis on its ordinary shares.
Its policy is also to announce dividends for ordinary shares in US dollars and state an equivalent sterling dividend. Dividends on BP ordinary shares will be paid in sterling and on BP ADSs in US dollars. The rate of exchange used to determine the sterling amount equivalent is the average of the market exchange rates in London over the four business days prior to the sterling equivalent announcement date. The directors may choose to declare dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the company’s intention to change its current policy of announcing dividends on ordinary shares in US dollars.
Information regarding dividends announced and paid by the company on ordinary shares and preference shares is provided in Financial statements – Note 10.
A Scrip Dividend Programme (Scrip Programme) was approved by shareholders in 2010 and was renewed for a further three years at the 2018 AGM. It enables BP ordinary shareholders and ADS holders to elect to receive dividends by way of new fully paid BP ordinary shares (or ADSs in the case of ADS holders) instead of cash. The operation of the Scrip Programme is always subject to the directors’ decision to
 
make the Scrip Programme offer available in respect of any particular dividend. Should the directors decide not to offer the Scrip Programme in respect of any particular dividend, cash will be paid automatically instead.
Future dividends will be dependent on future earnings, the financial condition of the group, the Risk factors set out on page 55 and other matters that may affect the business of the group set out in Our strategy on page 10 and in Liquidity and capital resources on page 277.
The following table shows dividends announced and paid by the company per ADS for the past five years.
Dividends per ADSa
March

June

September

December

Total

2013
UK pence
36.01

35.01

34.58

34.80

140.40

 
US cents
54

54

54

57

219

2014
UK pence
34.24

34.84

35.76

38.26

143.10

 
US cents
57

58.5

58.5

60

234

2015
UK pence
40.00

39.18

39.29

39.81

158.28

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2016
UK pence
42.08

41.50

45.35

47.59

176.52

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2017
UK pence
48.95

46.54

45.73

44.66

185.88

 
US cents
60

60

60

60

240

2018
UK pence
43.01

44.66

47.58

48.15

183.40

US cents
60

60

61.50

61.50

243

a 
Dividends announced and paid by the company on ordinary and preference shares are provided in Financial statements – Note 10.

There are currently no UK foreign exchange controls or restrictions on remittances of dividends on the ordinary shares or on the conduct of the company’s operations, other than restrictions applicable to certain countries and persons subject to EU economic sanctions or those sanctions adopted by the UK government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations.
Shareholder taxation information
This section describes the material US federal income tax and UK taxation consequences of owning ordinary shares or ADSs to a US holder who holds the ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets for tax purposes. It does not apply, however, inter alia to members of special classes of holders some of which may be subject to other rules, including: tax-exempt entities, life insurance companies, dealers in securities, traders in securities that elect a mark-to-market method of accounting for securities holdings, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, holders that, directly or indirectly, hold 10% or more of the company’s voting stock, holders that hold the shares or ADSs as part of a straddle or a hedging or conversion transaction, holders that purchase or sell the shares or ADSs as part of a wash sale for US federal income tax purposes, or holders whose functional currency is not the US dollar. In addition, if a partnership holds the shares or ADSs, the US federal income tax treatment of a partner will generally depend on the status of the partner and the tax treatment of the partnership and may not be described fully below.
A US holder is any beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs that is for US federal income tax purposes (1) a citizen or resident of the US, (2) a US domestic corporation, (3) an estate whose income is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its source, or (4) a trust if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the trust’s administration and one or more US persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust.
This section is based on the tax laws of the United States, including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, its legislative history, existing and proposed US Treasury regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions, and the taxation laws of the UK, all as currently in effect, as well as the income tax convention between the US and the UK that entered into force on 31 March 2003 (the ‘Treaty’). These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis. This section further assumes that each obligation under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms.

306
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


For purposes of the Treaty and the estate and gift tax Convention (the ‘Estate Tax Convention’) and for US federal income tax and UK taxation purposes, a holder of ADRs evidencing ADSs will be treated as the owner of the company’s ordinary shares represented by those ADRs. Exchanges of ordinary shares for ADRs and ADRs for ordinary shares generally will not be subject to US federal income tax or to UK taxation other than stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax, as described below.
Investors should consult their own tax adviser regarding the US federal, state and local, UK and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of ordinary shares and ADSs in their particular circumstances, and in particular whether they are eligible for the benefits of the Treaty in respect of their investment in the shares or ADSs.
Taxation of dividends
UK taxation
Under current UK taxation law, no withholding tax will be deducted from dividends paid by the company, including dividends paid to US holders. A shareholder that is a company resident for tax purposes in the UK or trading in the UK through a permanent establishment generally will not be taxable in the UK on a dividend it receives from the company. A shareholder who is an individual resident for tax purposes in the UK is subject to UK tax but until 5 April 2016, was entitled to a tax credit on cash dividends paid on ordinary shares or ADSs of the company equal to one-ninth of the cash dividend.
From 6 April 2016 the dividend tax credit was replaced by a new tax-free dividend allowance and dividends paid by the company on or after 6 April 2016 do not carry a UK tax credit. The dividend allowance was £5,000 but this has been reduced to £2,000 as of 6 April 2018.
The dividend allowance of £2,000 means there is no UK tax due on the first £2,000 of dividends received. Dividends above this level are subject to tax at 7.5% for basic tax payers, 32.5% for higher rate tax payers and 38.1% for additional rate tax payers.
Although the first £2,000 of dividend income is not subject to UK income tax, it does not reduce the total income for tax purposes. Dividends within the dividend allowance still count towards basic or higher rate bands, and may therefore affect the rate of tax paid on dividends received in excess of the £2,000 allowance. For instance, if an individual has an annual gross salary of £50,000 and also receives a dividend of £12,000 they will be subject to the following scenario. The individual's personal allowance and the basic rate tax band will be used up by the gross salary. The remaining part of the salary and the whole of the dividend will be subject to tax at the higher rate, although the dividend allowance will reduce the amount of dividend subject to tax. The dividend of £12,000 will be reduced by the dividend allowance of £2,000 leaving taxable dividend income of £10,000. The dividend will be taxed at 32.5% so that the total tax payable on the dividends is £3,250.
How the shareholder pays the tax arising on the dividend income depends on the amount of dividend income and salary they receive in the tax year. If less than £2,000 they will not need to report anything or pay any tax. If between £2,000 and £10,000, the shareholder can pay what they owe by: contacting the helpline; asking HMRC to change their tax code – the tax will be taken from their wages or pension or through completion of the ‘Dividends’ section of their tax return, where one is being filed. If over £10,000 they will be required to file a self-assessment tax return and should complete the ‘Dividends’ section with details of the amounts received.
US federal income taxation
A US holder is subject to US federal income taxation on the gross amount of any dividend paid by the company out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes). Dividends paid to a non-corporate US holder that constitute qualified dividend income will be taxable to the holder at a preferential rate, provided that the holder has a holding period in the ordinary shares or ADSs of more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and meets other holding period requirements. Dividends paid by the company with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs will generally be qualified dividend income.
 
For US federal income tax purposes, a dividend must be included in income when the US holder, in the case of ordinary shares, or the Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction generally allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations. US ADS holders should consult their own tax adviser regarding the US tax treatment of the dividend fee in respect of dividends. Dividends will be income from sources outside the US and generally will be ‘passive category income’ or, in the case of certain US holders, ‘general category income’, each of which is treated separately for purposes of computing a US holder’s foreign tax credit limitation.
As noted above in UK taxation, a US holder will not be subject to UK withholding tax. Accordingly, the receipt of a dividend will not entitle the US holder to a foreign tax credit.
The amount of the dividend distribution on the ordinary shares that is paid in pounds sterling will be the US dollar value of the pounds sterling payments made, determined at the spot pounds sterling/US dollar rate on the date the dividend distribution is includible in income, regardless of whether the payment is, in fact, converted into US dollars. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency exchange fluctuations during the period from the date the pounds sterling dividend payment is includible in income to the date the payment is converted into US dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss and will not be eligible for the preferential tax rate on qualified dividend income. The gain or loss generally will be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.
Distributions in excess of the company’s earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a return of capital to the extent of the US holder’s basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain, subject to taxation as described in Taxation of capital gains – US federal income taxation section below.
In addition, the taxation of dividends may be subject to the rules for passive foreign investment companies (PFIC), described below under ‘Taxation of capital gains – US federal income taxation’. Distributions made by a PFIC do not constitute qualified dividend income and are not eligible for the preferential tax rate applicable to such income.
Taxation of capital gains
UK taxation
A US holder may be liable for both UK and US tax in respect of a gain on the disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs if the US holder is (1) resident for tax purposes in the United Kingdom at the date of disposal, (2) if he or she has left the UK for a period not exceeding five complete tax years between the year of departure from and the year of return to the UK and acquired the shares before leaving the UK and was resident in the UK in the previous four out of seven tax years before the year of departure, (3) a US domestic corporation resident in the UK by reason of its business being managed or controlled in the UK or (4) a citizen of the US that carries on a trade or profession or vocation in the UK through a branch or agency or a corporation that carries on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK, through a permanent establishment, and that has used, held, or acquired the ordinary shares or ADSs for the purposes of such trade, profession or vocation of such branch, agency or permanent establishment. However, such persons may be entitled to a tax credit against their US federal income tax liability for the amount of UK capital gains tax or UK corporation tax on chargeable gains (as the case may be) that is paid in respect of such gain.
Under the Treaty, capital gains on dispositions of ordinary shares or ADSs generally will be subject to tax only in the jurisdiction of residence of the relevant holder as determined under both the laws of the UK and the US and as required by the terms of the Treaty.
Under the Treaty, individuals who are residents of either the UK or the US and who have been residents of the other jurisdiction (the US or the UK, as the case may be) at any time during the six years immediately preceding the relevant disposal of ordinary shares or ADSs may be subject to tax with respect to capital gains arising from a disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs of the company not only in the jurisdiction of which the holder is resident at the time of the disposition but also in the other jurisdiction.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
307


For gains on or after 23 June 2010, the UK Capital Gains Tax rate will be dependent on the level of an individual’s taxable income. Where total taxable income and gains after all allowable deductions are less than the upper limit of the basic rate income tax band of £34,500 (for 2018/19), the rate of Capital Gains Tax will be 10%. For gains (and any parts of gains) above that limit the rate will be 20%.
From 6 April 2008, entitlement to the annual exemption is based on an individual’s circumstances (taking into account Domicile status, remittance basis of taxation and number of years in the UK). For individuals who are entitled to the exemption for 2018/19, this has been set at £11,700. Corporation tax on chargeable gains is levied at 19 per cent for companies from 1 April 2017.
US federal income taxation
A US holder who sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognize a capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the US dollar value of the amount realized on the disposition and the US holder’s tax basis, determined in US dollars, in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Any such capital gain or loss generally will be long-term gain or loss, subject to tax at a preferential rate for a non-corporate US holder, if the US holder’s holding period for such ordinary shares or ADSs exceeds one year.
Gain or loss from the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs will generally be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.
We do not believe that ordinary shares or ADSs will be treated as stock of a passive foreign investment company (PFIC) for US federal income tax purposes, but this conclusion is a factual determination that is made annually and thus is subject to change. If we are treated as a PFIC, unless a US holder elects to be taxed annually on a mark-to-market basis with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs, any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs would in general not be treated as capital gain. Instead, a US holder would be treated as if he or she had realized such gain rateably over the holding period for ordinary shares or ADSs and would be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for each such year to which the gain was allocated, in addition to which an interest charge in respect of the tax attributable to each such year would apply. Certain ‘excess distributions’ would be similarly treated if we were treated as a PFIC.
Additional tax considerations
Scrip Programme
The company has an optional Scrip Programme, wherein holders of BP ordinary shares or ADSs may elect to receive any dividends in the form of new fully paid ordinary shares or ADSs of the company instead of cash. Please consult your tax adviser for the consequences to you.
UK inheritance tax
The Estate Tax Convention applies to inheritance tax. ADSs held by an individual who is domiciled for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention in the US and is not for the purposes of the Estate Tax Convention a national of the UK will not be subject to UK inheritance tax on the individual’s death or on transfer during the individual’s lifetime unless, among other things, the ADSs are part of the business property of a permanent establishment situated in the UK used for the performance of independent personal services. In the exceptional case where ADSs are subject to both inheritance tax and US federal gift or estate tax, the Estate Tax Convention generally provides for tax payable in the US to be credited against tax payable in the UK or for tax paid in the UK to be credited against tax payable in the US, based on priority rules set forth in the Estate Tax Convention.
UK stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax
The statements below relate to what is understood to be the current practice of HM Revenue & Customs in the UK under existing law.
Provided that any instrument of transfer is not executed in the UK and remains at all times outside the UK and the transfer does not relate to any matter or thing done or to be done in the UK, no UK stamp duty is payable on the acquisition or transfer of ADSs. Neither will an
 
agreement to transfer ADSs in the form of ADRs give rise to a liability to stamp duty reserve tax.
Purchases of ordinary shares, as opposed to ADSs, through the CREST system of paperless share transfers will be subject to stamp duty reserve tax at 0.5%. The charge will arise as soon as there is an agreement for the transfer of the shares (or, in the case of a conditional agreement, when the condition is fulfilled). The stamp duty reserve tax will apply to agreements to transfer ordinary shares even if the agreement is made outside the UK between two non-residents. Purchases of ordinary shares outside the CREST system are subject either to stamp duty at a rate of £5 per £1,000 (or part, unless the stamp duty is less than £5, when no stamp duty is charged), or stamp duty reserve tax at 0.5%. Stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax are generally the liability of the purchaser.
A subsequent transfer of ordinary shares to the Depositary’s nominee will give rise to further stamp duty at the rate of £1.50 per £100 (or part) or stamp duty reserve tax at the rate of 1.5% of the value of the ordinary shares at the time of the transfer. For ADR holders electing to receive ADSs instead of cash, after the 2012 first quarter dividend payment, HM Revenue & Customs no longer seeks to impose 1.5% stamp duty reserve tax on issues of UK shares and securities to non-EU clearance services and depositary receipt systems.
US Medicare Tax
A US holder that is an individual or estate, or a trust that does not fall into a special class of trusts that is exempt from such tax, is subject to a 3.8% tax on the lesser of (1) the US holder’s ‘net investment income’ (or ‘undistributed net investment income’ in the case of an estate or trust) for the relevant taxable year and (2) the excess of the US holder’s modified adjusted gross income for the taxable year over a certain threshold (which in the case of individuals is between $125,000 and $250,000, depending on the individual’s circumstances). A holder’s net investment income generally includes its dividend income and its net gains from the disposition of shares or ADSs, unless such dividend income or net gains are derived in the ordinary course of the conduct of a trade or business (other than a trade or business that consists of certain passive or trading activities). If you are a US holder that is an individual, estate or trust, you are urged to consult your tax advisers regarding the applicability of the Medicare tax to your income and gains in respect of your investment in the shares or ADSs.
Major shareholders
The disclosure of certain major and significant shareholdings in the share capital of the company is governed by the Companies Act 2006, the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules (DTR) and the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
Register of members holding BP ordinary shares as at 31 December 2018
Range of holdings
Number of ordinary
shareholders

Percentage of total
ordinary shareholders
Percentage of total
ordinary share capital
excluding shares
held in treasury
1-200
53,495

22.63
0.01
201-1,000
79,856

33.77
0.22
1,001-10,000
90,654

38.34
1.41
10,001-100,000
10,801

4.57
1.11
100,001-1,000,000
948

0.40
1.77
Over 1,000,000a
689

0.29
95.48
Totals
236,443

100.00
100.00
a 
Includes JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. holding 27.32% of the total ordinary issued share capital (excluding shares held in treasury) as the approved depositary for ADSs, a breakdown of which is shown in the table below.

308
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Register of holders of American depositary shares (ADSs) as at 31 December 2018a 
Range of holdings
Number of
ADS holders

Percentage of
 total ADS holders
Percentage of 
total ADSs
1-200
48,763

59.44
0.28
201-1,000
21,504

26.21
1.11
1,001-10,000
11,266

13.73
3.17
10,001-100,000
501

0.61
0.91
100,001-1,000,000
7

0.01
0.13
Over 1,000,000b
1

0.00
94.40
Totals
82,042

100.00
100.00
a 
One ADS represents six 25 cent ordinary shares.
b 
One holder of ADSs represents 1,169,280 underlying shareholders.
As at 31 December 2018 there were also 1,286 preference shareholders. Preference shareholders represented 0.42% and ordinary shareholders represented 99.58% of the total issued nominal share capital of the company (excluding shares held in treasury) as at that date.
As at 31 December 2018, we had been notified pursuant to DTR5 that BlackRock, Inc. held 6.84% of the voting rights attached to the issued share capital of the company.
Between 1 January 2019 and 11 March 2019, we received notification of the following interests pursuant to DTR5. On 12 February 2019, BlackRock, Inc. notified BP that it held 7.29% of the voting rights attached to the issued share capital of the company. On 19 February 2019, BlackRock, Inc. notified BP that it held 7.28% of the voting rights attached to the issued share capital of the company.
We are also aware that, as at 11 March 2019, BlackRock, Inc. held 6.61% and The Vanguard Group, Inc. held 3.45% of the ordinary issued share capital of the company.
Under the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 BP is aware of the following interests as at 11 March 2019:
Holder
Holding of
ordinary shares

Percentage of ordinary share capital excluding shares held in treasury
JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., depositary for ADSs, through its nominee Guaranty Nominees Limited
5,533,239,667

27.31
BlackRock, Inc.
1,339,183,607

6.61
The company’s major shareholders do not have different voting rights.
The company has also been notified of the following interests in preference shares as at 11 March 2019:
Holder
Holding of 8%
cumulative first
preference shares

Percentage
of class
The National Farmers Union Mutual Insurance Society Limited
945,000

13.10
Hargreaves Lansdown Asset Management Limited
628,471

8.70
Canaccord Genuity Group Inc.
587,885

8.10
Prudential plc

528,150

7.30
Holder
Holding of 9%
cumulative second
preference shares

Percentage
of class

The National Farmers Union Mutual Insurance Society Limited
987,000

18.00

Prudential plc
644,450

11.80

 
 
 
Safra Group
320,000

5.80

Hargreaves Lansdown Asset Management Limited
317,789

5.80

Canaccord Genuity Group Inc.
283,135

5.20

As at 11 March 2019, the total preference shares in issue comprised only 0.42% of the company’s total issued nominal share capital (excluding shares held in treasury), the rest being ordinary shares.
 
Annual general meeting
The 2019 AGM will be held on Tuesday 21 May 2019 at 11.00am. A separate notice convening the meeting is distributed to shareholders, which includes an explanation of the items of business to be considered at the meeting.
All resolutions for which notice has been given will be decided on a poll. Deloitte LLP have expressed their willingness to continue in office as auditors and a resolution for their reappointment is included in the Notice of BP Annual General Meeting 2019.
Memorandum and Articles of Association
The following summarizes certain provisions of the company’s Memorandum and Articles of Association and applicable English law. This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the UK Companies Act 2006 (the Act) and the company’s Memorandum and Articles of Association. The Memorandum and Articles of Association are available online at bp.com/usefuldocs.
The company’s Articles of Association may be amended by a special resolution at a general meeting of the shareholders. At the annual general meeting (AGM) held on 17 April 2008 shareholders voted to adopt new Articles of Association, largely to take account of changes in UK company law brought about by the Act. Further amendments to the Articles of Association were approved by shareholders at the AGM held on 15 April 2010 and shareholders voted to adopt new Articles of Association at the AGM held on 16 April 2015. At the AGM held on 21 May 2018 shareholders voted to adopt new Articles of Association to reflect developments in market practice and to provide clarification and additional flexibility where necessary or appropriate.
Objects and purposes
BP is a public company limited by shares, incorporated under the name BP p.l.c. and is registered in England and Wales with the registered number 102498. The provisions regulating the operations of the company, known as its ‘objects’, were historically stated in a company’s memorandum. The Act abolished the need to have object provisions and so at the AGM held on 15 April 2010 shareholders approved the removal of its objects clause together with all other provisions of its Memorandum that, by virtue of the Act, are treated as forming part of the company’s Articles of Association.
Directors and secretary
The business and affairs of BP shall be managed by the directors. The company’s Articles of Association provide that directors may be appointed by the existing directors or by the shareholders in a general meeting. Any person appointed by the directors will hold office only until the next general meeting, notice of which is first given after their appointment and will then be eligible for re-election by the shareholders. A director may be removed by BP as provided for by applicable law and shall vacate office in certain circumstances as set out in the Articles of Association. In addition the company may, by special resolution, remove a director before the expiration of his/her period of office and, subject to the Articles of Association, may by ordinary resolution appoint another person to be a director instead. There is no requirement for a director to retire on reaching any age.
The Articles of Association place a general prohibition on a director voting in respect of any contract or arrangement in which the director has a material interest other than by virtue of such director’s interest in shares in the company. However, in the absence of some other material interest not indicated below, a director is entitled to vote and to be counted in a quorum for the purpose of any vote relating to a resolution concerning the following matters:
The giving of security or indemnity with respect to any money lent or obligation taken by the director at the request or benefit of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings.
Any proposal in which the director is interested, concerning the underwriting of company securities or debentures or the giving of any security to a third party for a debt or obligation of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
309


Any proposal concerning any other company in which the director is interested, directly or indirectly (whether as an officer or shareholder or otherwise) provided that the director and persons connected with such director are not the holder or holders of 1% or more of the voting interest in the shares of such company.
Any proposal concerning the purchase or maintenance of any insurance policy under which the director may benefit.
Any proposal concerning the giving to the director of any other indemnity which is on substantially the same terms as indemnities given or to be given to all of the other directors or to the funding by the company of his expenditure on defending proceedings or the doing by the company of anything to enable the director to avoid incurring such expenditure where all other directors have been given or are to be given substantially the same arrangements.
Any proposal concerning an arrangement for the benefit of the employees and directors or former employees and former directors of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings, including but without being limited to a retirement benefits scheme and an employees’ share scheme, which does not accord to any director any privilege or advantage not generally accorded to the employees or former employees to whom the arrangement relates.
The Act requires a director of a company who is in any way interested in a contract or proposed contract with the company to declare the nature of the director’s interest at a meeting of the directors of the company. The definition of ‘interest’ includes the interests of spouses, children, companies and trusts. The Act also requires that a director must avoid a situation where a director has, or could have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the company’s interests. The Act allows directors of public companies to authorize such conflicts where appropriate, if a company’s Articles of Association so permit. BP’s Articles of Association permit the authorization of such conflicts. The directors may exercise all the powers of the company to borrow money, except that the amount remaining undischarged of all moneys borrowed by the company shall not, without approval of the shareholders, exceed two times the amount paid up on the share capital plus the aggregate of the amount of the capital and revenue reserves of the company. Variation of the borrowing power of the board may only be affected by amending the Articles of Association.
Remuneration of non-executive directors shall be determined in the aggregate by resolution of the shareholders. Remuneration of executive directors is determined by the remuneration committee. This committee is made up of non-executive directors only. There is no requirement of share ownership for a director’s qualification.
The Articles of Association provide entitlement to the directors’ pensions and death and disability benefits to the directors’ relations and dependants respectively.
The circumstances in which a director’s office will automatically terminate include: when a director ceases to hold an executive office of the company and the directors resolve that he should cease to be a director; if a medical practitioner provides an opinion that a director has become incapable of acting as a director and may remain so incapable for a further three months and the directors resolve that he should cease to be a director; and if all of the other directors vote in favour of a resolution stating that the person should cease to be a director.
The company secretary has express powers to delegate any of the powers or discretions conferred on him or her.
 
Dividend rights; other rights to share in company profits; capital calls
If recommended by the directors of BP, shareholders of BP may, by resolution, declare dividends but no such dividend may be declared in excess of the amount recommended by the directors. The directors may also pay interim dividends without obtaining shareholder approval. No dividend may be paid other than out of profits available for distribution, as determined under IFRS and the Act. Dividends on ordinary shares are payable only after payment of dividends on BP preference shares. Any dividend unclaimed after a period of 10 years from the date of declaration of such dividend shall be forfeited and reverts to BP. If the company exercises its right to forfeit shares and sells shares belonging to an untraced shareholder then any entitlement to claim dividends or other monies unclaimed in respect of those shares will be for a period of twelve months after the sale. The company may take such steps as the directors decide are appropriate in the circumstances to trace the member entitled and the sale may be made at such time and on such terms as the directors may decide.
The directors have the power to declare and pay dividends in any currency provided that a sterling equivalent is announced. It is not the company’s intention to change its current policy of paying dividends in US dollars. At the company’s AGM held on 15 April 2010, shareholders approved the introduction of a Scrip Dividend Programme (Scrip Programme) and to include provisions in the Articles of Association to enable the company to operate the Scrip Programme. The Scrip Programme was renewed at the company’s AGM held on 21 May 2018 for a further three years. The Scrip Programme enables ordinary shareholders and BP ADS holders to elect to receive new fully paid ordinary shares (or BP ADSs in the case of BP ADS holders) instead of cash. The operation of the Scrip Programme is always subject to the directors’ decision to make the scrip offer available in respect of any particular dividend. Should the directors decide not to offer the scrip in respect of any particular dividend, cash will automatically be paid instead. The directors may determine in relation to any scrip dividend plan or programme how the costs of the programme will be met, the minimum number of ordinary shares required in order to be able to participate in the programme and any arrangements to deal with legal and practical difficulties in any particular territory.
Apart from shareholders’ rights to share in BP’s profits by dividend (if any is declared or announced), the Articles of Association provide that the directors may set aside:
A special reserve fund out of the balance of profits each year to make up any deficit of cumulative dividend on the BP preference shares.
A general reserve out of the balance of profits each year, which shall be applicable for any purpose to which the profits of the company may properly be applied. This may include capitalization of such sum, pursuant to an ordinary shareholders’ resolution, and distribution to shareholders as if it were distributed by way of a dividend on the ordinary shares or in paying up in full unissued ordinary shares for allotment and distribution as bonus shares.
Any such sums so deposited may be distributed in accordance with the manner of distribution of dividends as described above.
Holders of shares are not subject to calls on capital by the company, provided that the amounts required to be paid on issue have been paid off. All shares are fully paid.
Share transfers and share certificates
The directors may permit transfers to be effected other than by an instrument in writing and that share certificates will not be required to be issued by the company if they are not required by law.
The company may charge an administrative fee in the event that a shareholder wishes to replace two or more certificates representing shares with a single certificate or wishes to surrender a single certificate and replace it with two or more certificates. All certificates are sent at the member’s risk.

310
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Voting rights
The Articles of Association of the company provide that voting on resolutions at a shareholders’ meeting will be decided on a poll other than resolutions of a procedural nature, which may be decided on a show of hands. If voting is on a poll, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every ordinary share held and two votes for every £5 in nominal amount of BP preference shares held. If voting is on a show of hands, each shareholder who is present at the meeting in person or whose duly appointed proxy is present in person will have one vote, regardless of the number of shares held, unless a poll is requested.
Shareholders do not have cumulative voting rights.
For the purposes of determining which persons are entitled to attend or vote at a shareholders’ meeting and how many votes such persons may cast, the company may specify in the notice of the meeting a time, not more than 48 hours before the time of the meeting, by which a person who holds shares in registered form must be entered on the company’s register of members in order to have the right to attend or vote at the meeting or to appoint a proxy to do so.
Holders on record of ordinary shares may appoint a proxy, including a beneficial owner of those shares, to attend, speak and vote on their behalf at any shareholders’ meeting, provided that a duly completed proxy form is received not less than 48 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time of the meeting or adjourned meeting or, where the poll is to be taken after the date of the meeting, not less than 24 hours (or such shorter time as the directors may determine) before the time of the poll.
Record holders of BP ADSs are also entitled to attend, speak and vote at any shareholders’ meeting of BP by the appointment by the approved depositary, JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A., of them as proxies in respect of the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. Each such proxy may also appoint a proxy. Alternatively, holders of BP ADSs are entitled to vote by supplying their voting instructions to the depositary, who will vote the ordinary shares represented by their ADSs in accordance with their instructions.
Proxies may be delivered electronically.
Corporations who are members of the company may appoint one or more persons to act as their representative or representatives at any shareholders’ meeting provided that the company may require a corporate representative to produce a certified copy of the resolution appointing them before they are permitted to exercise their powers.
Matters are transacted at shareholders’ meetings by the proposing and passing of resolutions, of which there are two types: ordinary or special.
An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes of those persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. A special resolution requires the affirmative vote of not less than three quarters of the persons voting at a meeting at which there is a quorum. Any AGM requires 21 clear days’ notice. The notice period for any other general meeting is 14 clear days subject to the company obtaining annual shareholder approval, failing which, a 21 clear day notice period will apply.
Liquidation rights; redemption provisions
In the event of a liquidation of BP, after payment of all liabilities and applicable deductions under UK laws and subject to the payment of secured creditors, the holders of BP preference shares would be entitled to the sum of (1) the capital paid up on such shares plus, (2) accrued and unpaid dividends and (3) a premium equal to the higher of (a) 10% of the capital paid up on the BP preference shares and (b) the excess of the average market price over par value of such shares on the LSE during the previous six months. The remaining assets (if any) would be divided pro rata among the holders of ordinary shares.
 
Without prejudice to any special rights previously conferred on the holders of any class of shares, BP may issue any share with such preferred, deferred or other special rights, or subject to such restrictions as the shareholders by resolution determine (or, in the absence of any such resolutions, by determination of the directors), and may issue shares that are to be or may be redeemed.
Variation of rights
The rights attached to any class of shares may be varied with the consent in writing of holders of 75% of the shares of that class or on the adoption of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. At every such separate meeting, all of the provisions of the Articles of Association relating to proceedings at a general meeting apply, except that the quorum with respect to a meeting to change the rights attached to the preference shares is 10% or more of the shares of that class, and the quorum to change the rights attached to the ordinary shares is one third or more of the shares of that class.
Shareholders’ meetings and notices
Shareholders must provide BP with a postal or electronic address in the UK to be entitled to receive notice of shareholders’ meetings. Holders of BP ADSs are entitled to receive notices under the terms of the deposit agreement relating to BP ADSs. The substance and timing of notices are described above under the heading Voting rights.
Under the Act, the AGM of shareholders must be held once every year, within each six month period beginning with the day following the company’s accounting reference date. All general meetings shall be held at a time and place determined by the directors. If any shareholders’ meeting is adjourned for lack of quorum, notice of the time and place of the adjourned meeting may be given in any lawful manner, including electronically. Powers exist for action to be taken either before or at the meeting by authorized officers to ensure its orderly conduct and safety of those attending.
The directors have power to convene a general meeting which is a hybrid meeting, that is to provide facilities for shareholders to attend a meeting which is being held at a physical place by electronic means as well (but not to convene a purely electronic meeting).
The provisions of the Articles of Association in relation to satellite meetings permit facilities being provided by electronic means to allow those persons at each place to participate in the meeting.
Limitations on voting and shareholding
There are no limitations, either under the laws of the UK or under the company’s Articles of Association, restricting the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote BP ordinary or preference shares in the company other than limitations that would generally apply to all of the shareholders and limitations applicable to certain countries and persons subject to EU economic sanctions or those sanctions adopted by the UK government which implement resolutions of the Security Council of the United Nations.
Disclosure of interests in shares
The Act permits a public company to give notice to any person whom the company believes to be or, at any time during the three years prior to the issue of the notice, to have been interested in its voting shares requiring them to disclose certain information with respect to those interests. Failure to supply the information required may lead to disenfranchisement of the relevant shares and a prohibition on their transfer and receipt of dividends and other payments in respect of those shares and any new shares in the company issued in respect of those shares. In this context the term ‘interest’ is widely defined and will generally include an interest of any kind whatsoever in voting shares, including any interest of a holder of BP ADSs.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
311


Called-up share capital
Details of the allotted, called-up and fully-paid share capital at 31 December 2018 are set out in Financial statements – Note 31. In accordance with institutional investor guidelines, the company deems it appropriate to grant authority to the directors to allot shares and other securities and to disapply pre-emption rights by way of shareholders resolutions at each AGM in place of authority granted by virtue of the company's Articles of Association. At the AGM on 21 May 2018, authorization was given to the directors to allot shares in the company and to grant rights to subscribe for, or to convert any
 
security into, shares in the company up to an aggregate nominal amount as set out in the Notice of Meeting 2018. These authorities were given for the period until the next AGM in 2019 or 21 August 2019, whichever is the earlier. These authorities are renewed annually at the AGM.
Company records and service of notice
In relation to notices not covered by the Act, the reference to notice by advertisement in a national newspaper also includes advertisements via other means such as a public announcement.
Purchases of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers
In November 2017 BP began a share repurchase or buyback programme (the programme). The sole purpose of the programme is to reduce the issued share capital of the company to offset the ongoing dilutive effect of scrip dividends over time, as announced by the company on 31 October 2017. Authorization for the programme was renewed at the company’s 2018 AGM covering the period until the date of the company's 2019 AGM. The maximum number of ordinary shares to be purchased will not exceed 1.99 billion ordinary shares, which is the maximum number of ordinary shares permitted to be purchased by the company pursuant to the authority granted by shareholders at the company's 2018 AGM . The shares purchased will be cancelled.
The following table provides details of ordinary share purchases made (1) under the programme and (2) by the Employee Share Ownership Plans (ESOPs) and other purchases of ordinary shares and ADSs made to satisfy the requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans.
 
 
Total number of shares purchaseda

Average price
paid per share
$

Number of shares
purchased
by ESOPs or for
certain employee
share-based plans
b

Number of shares purchased as part of the buyback programmec

Maximun approximate dollar value of shares yet to be purchased under the programme
$ million
2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
January
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
February 6 – February 28
 
12,574,000

6.69

24,000

12,550,000

N/A
March 8 – March 21
 
5,500,000

6.62

Nil

5,500,000

N/A
April
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
May 1 – May 11
 
7,765,798

7.50

463,650

7,302,148

N/A
June 6 – June 27
 
3,230,500

7.66

Nil

3,230,500

N/A
July
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
August 3 – August 30
 
6,788,050

7.24

Nil

6,788,050

N/A
September 4 – September 21
 
12,497,354

7.22

Nil

12,497,354

N/A
October
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
November 1 – November 28
 
2,603,190

6.84

269,000

2,334,190

N/A
December
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
January
 
Nil

 
 
 
N/A
February 5 – February 21
 
2,753,983

7.10

120,000

2,633,983

N/A
March 11
 
717,995

7.14

Nil

717,995

N/A
a 
All share purchases were of ordinary shares of 25 cents each and/or ADSs (each representing six ordinary shares) and were on/open market transactions.
b 
Transactions represent the purchase of ordinary shares by ESOPs and other purchases of ordinary shares and ADSs made to satisfy requirements of certain employee share-based payment plans.
c 
The company announced its intent to commence the programme on 31 October 2017 and announced further details and commencement of the programme on 15 November 2017. At the AGM on 21 May 2018, authorization was given to the company to repurchase up to 1.99 billion ordinary shares, for the period ending on the date of the AGM in 2019 or 21 August 2019, whichever is the earlier. This authorization is renewed annually at the AGM. The total number of ordinary shares repurchased during 2018 under the programme was 50,202,242 at a cost of $355 million (including fees and stamp duty) representing 0.25% of BP’s issued share capital excluding shares held in treasury on 31 December 2018. All ordinary shares repurchased in 2018 under the programme were cancelled in order to reduce BP’s issued share capital.

312
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Fees and charges payable by ADS holders
The Depositary collects fees for delivery and surrender of ADSs directly from investors depositing shares or surrendering ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal or from intermediaries acting for them. The Depositary collects fees for making distributions to investors by deducting those fees from the amounts distributed or by selling a portion of the distributable property to pay the fees.
The charges of the Depositary payable by investors are as follows:
Type of service
Depositary actions
Fee
Depositing or substituting the underlying shares
Issuance of ADSs against the deposit of shares, including deposits and issuances in respect of:
Share distributions, stock splits, rights, merger.
Exchange of securities or other transactions or event or other distribution affecting the ADSs or deposited securities.
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the new ADSs delivered.
Selling or exercising rights
Distribution or sale of securities, the fee being an amount equal to the fee for the execution and delivery of ADSs that would have been charged as a result of the deposit of such securities.
$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or portion thereof).
Withdrawing an underlying share
Acceptance of ADSs surrendered for withdrawal of deposited securities.
$5.00 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof) evidenced by the ADSs surrendered.
Expenses of the Depositary
Expenses incurred on behalf of holders in connection with:
Stock transfer or other taxes and governmental charges.
Delivery by cable, telex, electronic and facsimile transmission.
Transfer or registration fees, if applicable, for the registration of transfers of underlying shares.
Expenses of the Depositary in connection with the conversion of foreign currency into US dollars (which are paid out of such foreign currency).
Expenses payable are subject to agreement between the company and the Depositary by billing holders or by deducting charges from one or more cash dividends or other cash distributions.
Dividend fees
ADS holders who receive a cash dividend are charged a fee which BP uses to offset the costs associated with administering the ADS programme.
The Deposit Agreement provides that a fee of $0.05 or less per ADS can be charged. The current fee is $0.02 per BP ADS per calendar year (equivalent to $0.005 per BP ADS per quarter per cash distribution).
Global Invest Direct (GID) Plan
New investors and existing ADS holders can buy or sell BP ADSs by enrolling in BP’s GID Plan, sponsored and administered by the Depositary.
Cost per transaction is $2.00 for recurring, $2.00 for one-time automatic investments, and $5.00 for investment made by check, plus $0.12 commission per share.
Fees and payments made by the Depositary to the issuer
The Depositary has agreed to reimburse certain company expenses related to the company’s ADS programme and incurred by the company in connection with the ADS programme arising during the year ended 31 December 2018. The Depositary reimbursed to the company, or paid amounts on the company’s behalf to third parties, or waived its fees and expenses, of $16,582,418.54 for the year ended 31 December 2018.
The table below sets out the types of expenses that the Depositary has agreed to reimburse and the fees it has agreed to waive for standard costs associated with the administration of the ADS programme relating to the year ended 31 December 2018.
Category of expense reimbursed,
waived or paid directly to third parties
Amount reimbursed, waived or paid directly to third parties for the year ended 31 December 2018
$

Fees for delivery and surrender of BP ADSs
647,683.39

Dividend feesa
15,934,735.15

Total
16,582,418.54

a 
Dividend fees are charged to ADS holders who receive a cash distribution, which BP uses to offset the costs associated with administering the ADS programme.
Under certain circumstances, including removal of the Depositary or termination of the ADR programme by the company, the company is required to repay the Depositary certain amounts reimbursed and/or expenses paid to or on behalf of the company during the 12-month period prior to notice of removal or termination.

 
Documents on display
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 is available online at bp.com/annualreport. To obtain a hard copy of BP’s complete audited financial statements, free of charge, UK based shareholders should contact BP Distribution Services by calling +44 (0) 870 241 3269 or by emailing bpdistributionservices@bp.com. If based in the US or Canada shareholders should contact Issuer Direct by calling +1 888 301 2505 or by emailing bpreports@issuerdirect.com.
The company is subject to the information requirements of the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934 applicable to foreign private issuers. In accordance with these requirements, the company files its Annual Report and Form 20-F and other related documents with the SEC. The SEC maintains an internet site at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports and other information regarding issuers, including BP, that file electronically with the SEC. BP's SEC filings are also available at bp.com/sec. BP discloses in this report (see Corporate governance practices (Form 20-F Item 16G) on page 300) significant ways (if any) in which its corporate governance practices differ from those mandated for US companies under NYSE listing standards.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
313


Shareholding administration
If you have any queries about the administration of shareholdings, such as change of address, change of ownership, dividend payments, the Scrip Programme or to change the way you receive your company documents (such as the BP Annual Report and Form 20-F and Notice of BP Annual General Meeting) please contact the BP Registrar or the BP ADS Depositary.
Ordinary and preference shareholders
The BP Registrar, Link Asset Services
The Registry, 34 Beckenham Road, Beckenham, Kent BR3 4TU, UK
Freephone in UK 0800 701107
From outside the UK +44 (0)371 277 1014
Fax +44 (0)1484 601512
ADS holders
The BP ADS Depositary, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
PO Box 64504, St Paul, MN 55164-0504, US
Toll-free in US and Canada +1 877 638 5672
From outside the US and Canada +1 651 306 4383
2019 shareholder calendara
30 April 2019
First quarter results announced
10 May 2019
Record date (to be eligible for the first quarter interim dividend)
21 May 2019
Annual general meeting
21 Jun 2019
First quarter interim dividend payment for 2019
5 Jul 2019
8% and 9% preference shares record date
30 Jul 2019
Second quarter results announced
31 Jul 2019
8% and 9% preference shares dividend payment
9 Aug 2019
Record date (to be eligible for the second quarter interim dividend)
20 Sep 2019
Second quarter interim dividend payment for 2019
29 Oct 2019
Third quarter results announced
8 Nov 2019
Record date (to be eligible for the third quarter interim dividend)
20 Dec 2019
Third quarter interim dividend payment for 2019
a 
All future dates are provisional and may be subject to change. For the full calendar see bp.com/financialcalendar.

 
Exhibits
The following documents are filed in the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) EDGAR system, as part of this Annual Report on Form 20-F, and can be viewed on the SEC’s website.
 
Memorandum and Articles of Association of BP p.l.c.*******†
 
The BP Executive Directors’ Incentive Plan******†
 
Amended Director’s Secondment Agreement for
R W Dudley*****†
 
Amended Director’s Service Contract and Secondment Agreement for R W Dudley**†
 
Director’s Service Contract for Dr B Gilvary***†
 
The BP Share Award Plan 2015*******†
 
Subsidiaries (included as Note 37 to the Financial Statements)
 
Code of Ethics*†
 
Rule 13a – 14(a) Certifications†
 
Rule 13a – 14(b) Certifications#†
 
Consent of DeGolyer and MacNaughton†
 
Report of DeGolyer and MacNaughton†
 
Consent of Netherland, Sewell & Associates†
 
Report of Netherland, Sewell & Associates†
 
Consent Decree*******†
 
Gulf states Settlement Agreement*******†
 
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
 
Consent of Deloitte LLP (included on page 127)
Exhibit 101
 
Interactive data files
*
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009.
**
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2010.
***
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2011.
*****
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2013.
******
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2014.
*******
 
Incorporated by reference to the company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2015.
#
 
Furnished only.
 
Included only in the annual report filed in the Securities and Exchange Commission EDGAR system.
The total amount of long-term securities of BP p.l.c. and its subsidiaries under any one instrument does not exceed 10% of their total assets on a consolidated basis.
The company agrees to furnish copies of any or all such instruments to the SEC on request.


314
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Glossary
Abbreviations
ADR
American depositary receipt.
ADS
American depositary share. 1 ADS = 6 ordinary shares.
Barrel (bbl)
159 litres, 42 US gallons.
bcf/d
Billion cubic feet per day.
bcfe
Billion cubic feet equivalent.
b/d
Barrels per day.
boe/d
Barrels of oil equivalent per day.
GAAP
Generally accepted accounting practice.
Gas
Natural gas.
GHG
Greenhouse gas.
GWh
Gigawatt hour.
HSSE
Health, safety, security and environment.
IFRS
International Financial Reporting Standards.
KPIs
Key performance indicators.
LNG
Liquefied natural gas.
LPG
Liquefied petroleum gas.
mb/d
Thousand barrels per day.
mboe/d
Thousand barrels of oil equivalent per day.
mmb/d or Mb/d
Million barrels per day.
mmboe/d
Million barrels of oil equivalent per day.
mmBtu
Million British thermal units.
mmcf/d
Million cubic feet per day.
mmte or Mte
Million tonnes.
MteCO2 
Million tonnes of CO2 equivalent.
MW
Megawatt.
NGLs
Natural gas liquids.
PSA
Production-sharing agreement.
 
PTA
Purified terephthalic acid.
RC
Replacement cost.
SEC
The United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
Definitions
Unless the context indicates otherwise, the definitions for the following glossary terms are given below.
Non-GAAP measures are sometimes referred to as alternative performance measures.
Adjusted effective tax rate (ETR)
Non-GAAP measure. The adjusted ETR is calculated by dividing taxation on an underlying replacement cost (RC) basis excluding the impact of reductions in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge (in 2016 and 2015) by underlying RC profit or loss before tax. Taxation on an underlying RC basis is taxation on a RC basis for the period adjusted for taxation on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects. Information on underlying RC profit or loss is provided below. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the adjusted ETR because this measure may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, period on period. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is the ETR on profit or loss for the period. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for adjusted ETR to ETR on profit or loss for the period, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to present a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include the taxation on inventory holding gains and losses, non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Associate
An entity over which the group has significant influence and that is neither a subsidiary nor a joint arrangement of the group. Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the investee but is not control or joint control over those policies.
Brent
A trading classification for North Sea crude oil that serves as a major benchmark price for purchases of oil worldwide.
Capital expenditure
Total cash capital expenditure as stated in the group cash flow statement.
Consolidation adjustment – UPII
Unrealized profit in inventory arising on inter-segment transactions.
Commodity trading contracts
BP’s Upstream and Downstream segments both participate in regional and global commodity trading markets in order to manage, transact and hedge the crude oil, refined products and natural gas that the group either produces or consumes in its manufacturing operations. These physical trading activities, together with associated incremental trading opportunities, are discussed in Upstream on page 22 and in Downstream on page 28. The range of contracts the group enters into in its commodity trading operations is described below. Using these contracts, in combination with rights to access storage and transportation capacity, allows the group to access advantageous pricing differences between locations, time periods and arbitrage between markets.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
315


Exchange-traded commodity derivatives
Contracts that are typically in the form of futures and options traded on a recognized exchange, such as Nymex and ICE. Such contracts are traded in standard specifications for the main marker crude oils, such as Brent and West Texas Intermediate; the main product grades, such as gasoline and gasoil; and for natural gas and power. Gains and losses, otherwise referred to as variation margin, are generally settled on a daily basis with the relevant exchange. These contracts are used for the trading and risk management of crude oil, refined products, and natural gas and power. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on exchange-traded commodity derivatives are included in sales and other operating revenues for accounting purposes.
Over-the-counter contracts
Contracts that are typically in the form of forwards, swaps and options. Some of these contracts are traded bilaterally between counterparties or through brokers, others may be cleared by a central clearing counterparty. These contracts can be used both for trading and risk management activities. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on over-the-counter (OTC) contracts are included in sales and other operating revenues for accounting purposes. Many grades of crude oil bought and sold use standard contracts including US domestic light sweet crude oil, commonly referred to as West Texas Intermediate, and a standard North Sea crude blend – Brent, Forties, Oseberg and Ekofisk (BFOE). Forward contracts are used in connection with the purchase of crude oil supplies for refineries, products for marketing and sales of the group’s oil production and refined products. The contracts typically contain standard delivery and settlement terms. These transactions call for physical delivery of oil with consequent operational and price risk. However, various means exist and are used from time to time, to settle obligations under the contracts in cash rather than through physical delivery. Because the physically settled transactions are delivered by cargo, the BFOE contract additionally specifies a standard volume and tolerance.
Gas and power OTC markets are highly developed in North America and the UK, where commodities can be bought and sold for delivery in future periods. These contracts are negotiated between two parties to purchase and sell gas and power at a specified price, with delivery and settlement at a future date. Typically, the contracts specify delivery terms for the underlying commodity. Some of these transactions are not settled physically as they can be achieved by transacting offsetting sale or purchase contracts for the same location and delivery period that are offset during the scheduling of delivery or dispatch. The contracts contain standard terms such as delivery point, pricing mechanism, settlement terms and specification of the commodity. Typically, volume, price and term (e.g. daily, monthly and balance of month) are the main variable contract terms.
Swaps are often contractual obligations to exchange cash flows between two parties. A typical swap transaction usually references a floating price and a fixed price with the net difference of the cash flows being settled. Options give the holder the right, but not the obligation, to buy or sell crude, oil products, natural gas or power at a specified price on or before a specific future date. Amounts under these derivative financial instruments are settled at expiry. Typically, netting agreements are used to limit credit exposure and support liquidity.
Spot and term contracts
Spot contracts are contracts to purchase or sell a commodity at the market price prevailing on or around the delivery date when title to the inventory is taken. Term contracts are contracts to purchase or sell a commodity at regular intervals over an agreed term. Though spot and term contracts may have a standard form, there is no offsetting mechanism in place. These transactions result in physical delivery with operational and price risk. Spot and term contracts typically relate to purchases of crude for a refinery, products for marketing, or third-party natural gas, or sales of the group’s oil production, oil products or gas production to third parties. For accounting purposes, spot and term sales are included in sales and other operating revenues when title passes. Similarly, spot and term purchases are included in purchases for accounting purposes.


 
Divestment proceeds
Disposal proceeds as per the group cash flow statement.
Dividend yield
Sum of the four quarterly dividends announced in respect of the year as a percentage of the year-end share price on the respective exchange.
Effective tax rate (ETR) on replacement cost (RC) profit or loss
Non-GAAP measure. The ETR on RC profit or loss is calculated by dividing taxation on a RC basis by RC profit or loss before tax. Information on RC profit or loss is provided below. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the ETR on RC profit or loss because this measure excludes the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories and allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is the ETR on profit or loss for the period. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.
Fair value accounting effects
Non-GAAP adjustments to IFRS profit or loss. We use derivative instruments to manage the economic exposure relating to inventories above normal operating requirements of crude oil, natural gas and petroleum products. Under IFRS, these inventories are recorded at historical cost. The related derivative instruments, however, are required to be recorded at fair value with gains and losses recognized in the income statement. This is because hedge accounting is either not permitted or not followed, principally due to the impracticality of effectiveness-testing requirements. Therefore, measurement differences in relation to recognition of gains and losses occur. Gains and losses on these inventories are not recognized until the commodity is sold in a subsequent accounting period. Gains and losses on the related derivative commodity contracts are recognized in the income statement, from the time the derivative commodity contract is entered into, on a fair value basis using forward prices consistent with the contract maturity.
BP enters into physical commodity contracts to meet certain business requirements, such as the purchase of crude for a refinery or the sale of BP’s gas production. Under IFRS these physical contracts are treated as derivatives and are required to be fair valued when they are managed as part of a larger portfolio of similar transactions. Gains and losses arising are recognized in the income statement from the time the derivative commodity contract is entered into.
IFRS require that inventory held for trading is recorded at its fair value using period-end spot prices, whereas any related derivative commodity instruments are required to be recorded at values based on forward prices consistent with the contract maturity. Depending on market conditions, these forward prices can be either higher or lower than spot prices, resulting in measurement differences.
BP enters into contracts for pipelines and other transportation, storage capacity, oil and gas processing and liquefied natural gas (LNG) that, under IFRS, are recorded on an accruals basis. These contracts are risk-managed using a variety of derivative instruments that are fair valued under IFRS. This results in measurement differences in relation to recognition of gains and losses.
The way that BP manages the economic exposures described above, and measures performance internally, differs from the way these activities are measured under IFRS. BP calculates this difference for consolidated entities by comparing the IFRS result with management’s internal measure of performance. Under management’s internal measure of performance the inventory, transportation and capacity contracts in question are valued based on fair value using relevant forward prices prevailing at the end of the period. The fair values of derivative instruments used to risk manage certain oil, gas and other contracts, are deferred to match with the underlying exposure and the commodity contracts for business requirements are accounted for on an accruals basis. We believe that disclosing management’s estimate of this difference provides useful information for investors because it enables investors to see the economic effect of these activities as a whole. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.


316
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


In addition, from 2018 fair value accounting effects include changes in the fair value of the near-term portions of LNG contracts that fall within BP’s risk management framework. LNG contracts are not considered derivatives, because there is insufficient market liquidity, and they are therefore accrual accounted under IFRS. However, oil and natural gas derivative financial instruments (used to risk manage the near-term portions of the LNG contracts) are fair valued under IFRS. The fair value accounting effect reduces timing differences between recognition of the derivative financial instruments used to risk manage the LNG contracts and the recognition of the LNG contracts themselves, which therefore gives a better representation of performance in each period. Comparative information has not been restated on the basis that the effect was not material.
Free cash flow
Operating cash flow less net cash used in investing activities, as presented in the group cash flow statement.
Full dividend
Full dividend is cash dividend plus cash equivalent value of scrip dividend.
Gearing
See Net debt and net debt ratio definition.
Gross debt ratio
Gross debt ratio is defined as the ratio of gross debt to the total of gross debt plus shareholders' equity.
Henry Hub
A distribution hub on the natural gas pipeline system in Erath, Louisiana, that lends its name to the pricing point for natural gas futures contracts traded on the New York Mercantile Exchange and the over-the-counter swaps traded on Intercontinental Exchange.
Hydrocarbons
Liquids and natural gas. Natural gas is converted to oil equivalent at 5.8 billion cubic feet = 1 million barrels.
Inorganic capital expenditure
A subset of capital expenditure and is a non-GAAP measure. Inorganic capital expenditure comprises consideration in business combinations and certain other significant investments made by the group. It is reported on a cash basis. BP believes that this measure provides useful information as it allows investors to understand how BP’s management invests funds in projects which expand the group’s activities through acquisition. An analysis of organic capital expenditure by segment and region, and a reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 275.
Inventory holding gains and losses
The difference between the cost of sales calculated using the replacement cost of inventory and the cost of sales calculated on the first-in first-out (FIFO) method after adjusting for any changes in provisions where the net realizable value of the inventory is lower than its cost. Under the FIFO method, which we use for IFRS reporting, the cost of inventory charged to the income statement is based on its historical cost of purchase or manufacture, rather than its replacement cost. In volatile energy markets, this can have a significant distorting effect on reported income. The amounts disclosed represent the difference between the charge to the income statement for inventory on a FIFO basis (after adjusting for any related movements in net realizable value provisions) and the charge that would have arisen based on the replacement cost of inventory. For this purpose, the replacement cost of inventory is calculated using data from each operation’s production and manufacturing system, either on a monthly basis, or separately for each transaction where the system allows this approach. The amounts disclosed are not separately reflected in the financial statements as a gain or loss. No adjustment is made in respect of the cost of inventories held as part of a trading position and certain other temporary inventory positions. See Replacement cost (RC) profit or loss definition below.



 
Joint arrangement
An arrangement in which two or more parties have joint control.
Joint control
Contractually agreed sharing of control over an arrangement, which exists only when decisions about the relevant activities require the unanimous consent of the parties sharing control.
Joint operation
A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the arrangement have rights to the assets, and obligations for the liabilities, relating to the arrangement.
Joint venture
A joint arrangement whereby the parties that have joint control of the arrangement have rights to the net assets of the arrangement.
Liquids
Comprises crude oil, condensate and natural gas liquids. For the Upstream segment, it also includes bitumen.
LNG train
An LNG train is a processing facility used to liquefy and purify natural gas in the formation of LNG.
Major projects
Have a BP net investment of at least $250 million, or are considered to be of strategic importance to BP or of a high degree of complexity.
Net debt and net debt ratio (gearing)
Non-GAAP measures. Net debt is calculated as gross finance debt, as shown in the balance sheet, plus the fair value of associated derivative financial instruments that are used to hedge foreign currency exchange and interest rate risks relating to finance debt, for which hedge accounting is applied, less cash and cash equivalents. The net debt ratio is defined as the ratio of net debt to the total of net debt plus total shareholders’ equity. All components of equity are included in the denominator of the calculation. BP believes these measures provide useful information to investors. Net debt enables investors to see the economic effect of gross debt, related hedges and cash and cash equivalents in total. The net debt ratio enables investors to see how significant net debt is relative to equity from shareholders. The derivatives are reported on the balance sheet within the headings ‘Derivative financial instruments’. See Financial statements – Note 27 for information on gross debt, which is the nearest equivalent measure to net debt on an IFRS basis.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for net debt ratio to gross debt ratio, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to present a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include fair value asset (liability) of hedges related to finance debt and cash and cash equivalents, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Net generating capacity
The sum of the rated capacities of the assets/turbines that have entered into commercial operation, including BP’s share of equity-accounted entities. The gross data is the equivalent capacity on a gross-joint venture basis, which includes 100% of the capacity of equity-accounted entities where BP has partial ownership.
Non-operating items
Charges and credits are included in the financial statements that BP discloses separately because it considers such disclosures to be meaningful and relevant to investors. They are items that management considers not to be part of underlying business operations and are disclosed in order to enable investors better to understand and evaluate the group’s reported financial performance. Non-operating items within equity-accounted earnings are reported net of incremental income tax reported by the equity-accounted entity. An analysis of non-operating items by segment and type is shown on page 276.




 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
317


Operating cash flow
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities as stated in the group cash flow statement. When used in the context of a segment rather than the group, the terms refer to the segment’s share thereof.
Operating cash flow excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments
Non-GAAP measure. It is calculated by excluding post-tax operating cash flows relating to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill as reported in Financial statements – Note 2 from net cash provided by operating activities as reported in the group cash flow statement. BP believes net cash provided by operating activities excluding amounts related to the Gulf of Mexico oil spill is a useful measure as it allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is net cash provided by operating activities.
Organic free cash flow is operating cash flow excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments less organic capital expenditure.
Operating cash margin
Operating cash margin is operating cash flow divided by the applicable number of barrels of oil equivalent produced, at $52/bbl flat oil prices. Expected operating cash margins are calculated over the period 2016-2025.
Operating management system (OMS)
BP’s OMS helps us manage risks in our operating activities by setting out BP’s principles for good operating practice. It brings together BP requirements on health, safety, security, the environment, social responsibility and operational reliability, as well as related issues, such as maintenance, contractor relations and organizational learning, into a common management system.
Organic capital expenditure
A subset of capital expenditure and is a non-GAAP measure. Organic capital expenditure comprises capital expenditure less inorganic capital expenditure. BP believes that this measure provides useful information as it allows investors to understand how BP’s management invests funds in developing and maintaining the group’s assets. An analysis of organic capital expenditure by segment and region, and a reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 275.
We are unable to present reconciliations of forward-looking information for organic capital expenditure to total cash capital expenditure, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately the adjusting item, inorganic capital expenditure, that is difficult to predict in advance in order to derive the nearest GAAP estimate.
Organic sources of cash and organic uses of cash
Non-GAAP measure. Organic sources of cash is the sum of operating cash flow, excluding Gulf of Mexico oil spill payments, and proceeds of loan repayments. Organic uses of cash is the sum of organic capital expenditure, dividends and share buybacks. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for organic sources of cash is net cash provided by operating activities and the nearest equivalent measures on an IFRS basis for organic uses of cash are total cash capital expenditure, dividends paid to BP shareholders and net issue (repurchase) of shares.
Production-sharing agreement (PSA) / Production-sharing contract
An arrangement through which an oil and gas company bears the risks and costs of exploration, development and production. In return, if exploration is successful, the oil company receives entitlement to variable physical volumes of hydrocarbons, representing recovery of the costs incurred and a stipulated share of the production remaining after such cost recovery.
Readily marketable inventory (RMI)
RMI is inventory held and price risk-managed by our integrated supply and trading function (IST) which could be sold to generate funds if required. It comprises oil and oil products for which liquid markets are available and excludes inventory which is required to meet operational requirements and other inventory which is not price risk-managed. RMI is reported at fair value. Inventory held by the Downstream fuels business for the purpose of sales and marketing, and all inventories
 
relating to the lubricants and petrochemicals businesses, are not included in RMI. BP believes that disclosing the amounts of RMI and paid-up RMI is useful to investors as it enables them to better understand and evaluate the group’s inventories and liquidity position by enabling them to see the level of discretionary inventory held by IST and to see builds or releases of liquid trading inventory.
Paid-up RMI excludes RMI which has not yet been paid for. For inventory that is held in storage, a first-in first-out (FIFO) approach is used to determine whether inventory has been paid for or not. Unpaid RMI is RMI which has not yet been paid for by BP. RMI, RMI at fair value, Paid-up RMI and Unpaid RMI are non-GAAP measures. A reconciliation of total inventory as reported on the group balance sheet to paid-up RMI is provided on page 322.
Realizations
Realizations are the result of dividing revenue generated from hydrocarbon sales, excluding revenue generated from purchases made for resale and royalty volumes, by revenue generating hydrocarbon production volumes. Revenue generating hydrocarbon production reflects the BP share of production as adjusted for any production which does not generate revenue. Adjustments may include losses due to shrinkage, amounts consumed during processing, and contractual or regulatory host committed volumes such as royalties. For the Upstream segment, realizations include transfers between businesses.
Refining availability
Represents Solomon Associates’ operational availability, which is defined as the percentage of the year that a unit is available for processing after subtracting the annualized time lost due to turnaround activity and all planned mechanical, process and regulatory downtime.
Refining marker margin (RMM)
The average of regional indicator margins weighted for BP’s crude refining capacity in each region. Each regional marker margin is based on product yields and a marker crude oil deemed appropriate for the region. The regional indicator margins may not be representative of the margins achieved by BP in any period because of BP’s particular refinery configurations and crude and product slate.
Refining net cash margin per barrel
Refining net cash margin is defined by Solomon Associates as the net margin achieved after subtracting cash operating expenses and adding any refinery revenue from other sources. Net cash margin is expressed in US dollars per barrel of net refinery input.
Refinery utilization
Refinery utilization is calculated as annual throughput (thousands of barrels per day) divided by crude distillation capacity.
Replacement cost (RC) profit or loss
Reflects the replacement cost of inventories sold in the period and is arrived at by excluding inventory holding gains and losses from profit or loss. RC profit or loss is the measure of profit or loss that is required to be disclosed for each operating segment under IFRS. RC profit or loss for the group is a non-GAAP measure. Management believes this measure is useful to illustrate to investors the fact that crude oil and product prices can vary significantly from period to period and that the impact on our reported result under IFRS can be significant. Inventory holding gains and losses vary from period to period due to changes in prices as well as changes in underlying inventory levels. In order for investors to understand the operating performance of the group excluding the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories, and to make comparisons of operating performance between reporting periods, BP’s management believes it is helpful to disclose this measure. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. See Financial statements – Note 5. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 274.
RC profit or loss per share
Non-GAAP measure. Earnings per share is defined in Financial statements – Note 11. RC profit or loss per share is calculated using the same denominator. The numerator used is RC profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders rather than profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the RC profit

318
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


or loss per share because this measure excludes the impact of price changes on the replacement of inventories and allows for more meaningful comparisons between reporting periods. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is basic earnings per share based on profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.
Reserves replacement ratio
The extent to which the year’s production has been replaced by proved reserves added to our reserve base. The ratio is expressed in oil-equivalent terms and includes changes resulting from discoveries, improved recovery and extensions and revisions to previous estimates, but excludes changes resulting from acquisitions and disposals.
Return on average capital employed
Non-GAAP measure. Return on average capital employed (ROACE) is underlying replacement cost profit, after adding back non-controlling interest and interest expense net of tax (for the comparative periods interest expense was net of notional tax at an assumed 35%), divided by average capital employed, excluding cash and cash equivalents and goodwill. Interest expense is finance costs excluding the unwinding of the discount on provisions and other payables before tax. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the ROACE because this measure gives an indication of the company's capital efficiency. The nearest GAAP measures of the numerator and denominator are profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders and average capital employed respectively. The reconciliation of the numerator and denominator is provided on page 321.
We are unable to present forward-looking information of the nearest GAAP measures of the numerator and denominator for ROACE, because without unreasonable efforts, we are unable to forecast accurately certain adjusting items required to calculate a meaningful comparable GAAP forward-looking financial measure. These items include inventory holding gains or losses and interest net of tax, that are difficult to predict in advance in order to include in a GAAP estimate.
Subsidiary
An entity that is controlled by the BP group. Control of an investee exists when an investor is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee.
Tier 1 process safety events
Losses of primary containment from a process of greatest consequence - causing harm to a member of the workforce, costly damage to equipment or exceeding defined quantities. This represents reported incidents occurring within BP’s operational HSSE reporting boundary. That boundary includes BP’s own operated facilities and certain other locations or situations.
Tight oil and gas
Natural oil and gas reservoirs locked in hard sandstone rocks with low permeability, making the underground formation extremely tight.
UK National Balancing Point
A virtual trading location for sale, purchase and exchange of UK natural gas. It is the pricing and delivery point for the Intercontinental Exchange natural gas futures contract.
Unconventionals
Resources found in geographic accumulations over a large area, that usually present additional challenges to development such as low permeability or high viscosity. Examples include shale gas and oil, coalbed methane, gas hydrates and natural bitumen deposits. These typically require specialized extraction technology such as hydraulic fracturing or steam injection.
Underlying production
Production after adjusting for acquisitions and divestments and entitlement impacts in our production-sharing agreements.
Underlying RC profit or loss
Non-GAAP measure. RC profit or loss after adjusting for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects. See page 276 and 320 for additional information on the non-operating items and fair value accounting effects that are used to arrive at underlying RC profit
 
or loss in order to enable a full understanding of the events and their financial impact. BP believes that underlying RC profit or loss is a useful measure for investors because it is a measure closely tracked by management to evaluate BP’s operating performance and to make financial, strategic and operating decisions and because it may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, year on year, by adjusting for the effects of these non-operating items and fair value accounting effects.
The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for the group is profit or loss for the year attributable to BP shareholders. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis for segments is RC profit or loss before interest and taxation. Underlying profit in the group chief executive’s letter on page 8 refers to full year underlying RC profit for the group. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 274.
Underlying replacement cost (RC) profit or loss per share
Non-GAAP measure. Earnings per share is defined Financial statements – Note 11. Underlying RC profit or loss per share is calculated using the same denominator. The numerator used is underlying RC profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders rather than profit or loss attributable to BP shareholders. BP believes it is helpful to disclose the underlying RC profit or loss per share because this measure may help investors to understand and evaluate, in the same manner as management, the underlying trends in BP’s operational performance on a comparable basis, period on period. The nearest equivalent measure on an IFRS basis is basic earnings per share based on profit or loss for the period attributable to BP shareholders. A reconciliation to GAAP information is provided on page 320.
Upstream plant reliability
BP-operated Upstream plant reliability is calculated taking 100% less the ratio of total unplanned plant deferrals divided by installed production capacity. Unplanned plant deferrals are associated with the topside plant and where applicable the subsea equipment (excluding wells and reservoir). Unplanned plant deferrals include breakdowns, which does not include Gulf of Mexico weather related downtime.
Upstream unit production cost
Upstream unit production cost is calculated as production cost divided by units of production. Production cost does not include ad valorem and severance taxes. Units of production are barrels for liquids and thousands of cubic feet for gas. Amounts disclosed are for BP subsidiaries only and do not include BP’s share of equity-accounted entities.
Wellwork
Activities undertaken on previously completed wells with the primary objective to restore or increase production.
West Texas Intermediate (WTI)
A light sweet crude oil, priced at Cushing, Oklahoma, which serves as a benchmark price for purchases of oil in the US.
Working capital
Movements in inventories and other current and non-current assets and liabilities as stated in the group cash flow statement.
Trade marks
Trade marks of the BP group appear throughout this report. They include: ACTIVE, Aral, ARCO, BP, BPme, BP Ultimate, Castrol, Castrol EDGE BIO-SYNTHETIC, Castrol GTX ECO, Castrol Opitgear, PTAir
Trade marks:
Butamax – a registered trade mark of Butamax Advance Biofuels LLC.
Fulcrum and Fulcrum BioEnergy – registered trade marks of Fulcrum BioEnergy, Inc.
M&S Simply Food – a registered trade mark of Marks & Spencer plc.
MyAuchan – a registered trade mark of Auchan.
REWE to Go – a registered trade mark of REWE.

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
319


Non-GAAP measures reconciliations
Non-GAAP information on fair value accounting effects
The impacts of fair value accounting effects, relative to management’s internal measure of performance, and a reconciliation to GAAP information is set out below. Further information on fair value accounting effects is provided on page 316.
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Upstream
 
 
 
 
Unrecognized (gains) losses brought forward from previous perioda
 
(419
)
(393
)
263

Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance
 
(39
)
27

(637
)
Exchange translation gains (losses) on fair value accounting effects
 
3

2

(19
)
Unrecognized (gains) losses carried forward
 
(455
)
(364
)
(393
)
Downstreamb
 


 
Unrecognized (gains) losses brought forward from previous perioda
 
(151
)
(71
)
377

Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance
 
95

(135
)
(448
)
Unrecognized (gains) losses carried forward
 
(56
)
(206
)
(71
)
 
 
 
 
 
Favourable (adverse) impact relative to management’s measure of performance – by region
 
 
 
 
Upstream
 
 
 
 
US
 
(35
)
192

(379
)
Non-US
 
(4
)
(165
)
(258
)
 
 
(39
)
27

(637
)
Downstreamb
 


 
US
 
(155
)
(29
)
(321
)
Non-US
 
250

(106
)
(127
)
 
 
95

(135
)
(448
)
 
 
56

(108
)
(1,085
)
Taxation credit (charge)
 
12

12

329

 
 
68

(96
)
(756
)
a 
2018 brought forward fair value accounting effect balances include a $55-million adjustment between Upstream and Downstream as part of the transfer of the NGL business between segments. 2016 brought forward fair value accounting effect balances include a $33-million adjustment between Upstream and Downstream as part of the transfer of certain emission trading balances between these segments.
b 
Fair value accounting effects arise solely in the fuels business.
Reconciliation of non-GAAP information
 
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

Upstream
 
 
 
 
RC profit (loss) before interest and tax adjusted for fair value accounting effects
 
14,367

5,194

1,211

Impact of fair value accounting effects
 
(39
)
27

(637
)
RC profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
14,328

5,221

574

Downstream
 





RC profit before interest and tax adjusted for fair value accounting effects
 
6,845

7,356

5,610

Impact of fair value accounting effects
 
95

(135
)
(448
)
RC profit before interest and tax
 
6,940

7,221

5,162

Total group
 





Profit (loss) before interest and tax adjusted for fair value accounting effects
 
19,322

9,582

655

Impact of fair value accounting effects
 
56

(108
)
(1,085
)
Profit (loss) before interest and tax
 
19,378

9,474

(430
)

Reconciliation of basic earnings per ordinary share to RC profit (loss) per share and to underlying RC profit per share
 
 
Per ordinary share – cents
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

2015

2014

Profit (loss) for the yeara
 
46.98

17.20

0.61

(35.39
)
20.55

Inventory holding (gains) losses, before tax
 
4.01

(4.32
)
(8.52
)
10.31

33.78

Taxation charge (credit) on inventory holding gains and losses
 
(0.99
)
1.14

2.58

(3.10
)
(10.43
)
RC profit (loss) for the year
 
50.00

14.02

(5.33
)
(28.18
)
43.90

Net (favourable) adverse impact of non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, before tax
 
16.93

18.94

35.99

82.23

44.79

Taxation charge (credit) on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(3.23
)
(1.65
)
(16.87
)
(21.83
)
(22.69
)
Underlying RC profit for the year
 
63.70

31.31

13.79

32.22

66.00

a 
Profit attributable to BP shareholders.


320
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Reconciliation of effective tax rate (ETR) to ETR on RC profit or loss and adjusted ETR
Taxation (charge) credit
 
 
$ million
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

2015

2014

Taxation on profit or loss for the year
 
(7,145
)
(3,712
)
2,467

3,171

(947
)
Adjusted for taxation on inventory holding gains and losses
 
198

(225
)
(483
)
569

1,917

Taxation on a RC profit or loss basis
 
(7,343
)
(3,487
)
2,950

2,602

(2,864
)
Adjusted for taxation on non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
522

1,184

3,162

4,000

4,171

Adjusted for the impact of US tax reform
 
121

(859
)



Adjusted for the impact of the reduction in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge
 


434

915


Adjusted taxation
 
(7,986
)
(3,812
)
(646
)
(2,313
)
(7,035
)

Effective tax rate
 
 
%
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

2015

2014

ETR on profit or loss for the year
 
43

52

107

33

19

Adjusted for inventory holding gains and losses
 
(1
)
3

(31
)
1

7

ETR on RC profit or loss
 
42

55

76

34

26

Adjusted for non-operating items and fair value accounting effects
 
(5
)
(9
)
(69
)
(15
)
10

Adjusted for the impact of US tax reform
 
1

(8
)



Adjusted for the impact of the reduction in the rate of the UK North Sea supplementary charge
 


16

12


Adjusted ETR
 
38

38

23

31

36


Return on average capital employed (ROACE)
 
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

2016

2015

2014

Profit (loss) for the year attributable to BP shareholders
 
9,383

3,389

115

(6,482
)
3,780

Inventory holding (gains) losses, net of tax
 
603

(628
)
(1,114
)
1,320

4,293

Non-operating items and fair value accounting effects, net of tax
 
2,737

3,405

3,584

11,067

4,063

Underlying RC profit
 
12,723

6,166

2,585

5,905

12,136

Interest expense, net of taxa
 
1,583

924

635

576

546

Non-controlling interests
 
195

79

57

82

223

Adjusted underlying RC profit
 
14,501

7,169

3,277

6,563

12,905

Total equity
 
101,548

100,404

96,843

98,387

112,642

Gross debt
 
65,799

63,230

58,300

53,168

52,854

Capital employed (2018 average $165,491 million)
 
167,347

163,634

155,143

151,555

165,496

Less: Goodwill
 
12,204

11,551

11,194

11,627

11,868

Cash and cash equivalents
 
22,468

25,586

23,484

26,389

29,763

 
 
132,675

126,497

120,465

113,539

123,865

Average capital employed excluding goodwill and cash and cash equivalents
 
129,586

123,481

117,002

118,702

133,882

ROACE
 
11.2
%
5.8
%
2.8
%
5.5
%
9.6
%
a 
Calculated on a post-tax basis (for 2017 interest expense was net of notional tax at an assumed 35%).

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
321


Readily marketable inventory (RMI)
Readily marketable inventory (RMI) is oil and oil products inventory held and price risk-managed by BP`s integrated supply and trading function (IST) which could be sold to generate funds if required. Details of RMI balances and a reconciliation to GAAP information is set out below. Further information on RMI, RMI at fair value, paid-up RMI and unpaid RMI is provided on page 318.
At 31 December
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

RMI at fair value
 
4,202

5,661

Paid-up RMI
 
1,641

2,688

Reconciliation of non-GAAP information
At 31 December
 
 
$ million

 
 
2018

2017

Reconciliation of total inventory to paid-up RMI
 
 
 
Inventories as reported on the group balance sheet
 
17,988

19,011

Less: (a) inventories which are not oil and oil products and (b) oil and oil product inventories which are not risk-managed by IST
 
(14,066
)
(13,929
)
RMI on IFRS basis
 
3,922

5,082

Plus: difference between RMI at fair value and RMI on an IFRS basis
 
280

579

RMI at fair value
 
4,202

5,661

Less: unpaid RMI at fair value
 
(2,561
)
(2,973
)
Paid-up RMI
 
1,641

2,688


































The Directors’ report on pages 57-86, 210-237 and 273-322 was approved by the board and signed on its behalf by Jens Bertelsen, company secretary on 29 March 2019.
BP p.l.c.
Registered in England and Wales No. 102498

322
 
«See Glossary
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Signatures
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

BP p.l.c.
(Registrant)

/s/ Jens Bertelsen
Company secretary
29 March 2019


 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 
323


Cross reference to Form 20-F
 
 
 
 
 
 
Page
Item 1.
 
 
 
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors
 
n/a
Item 2.
 
 
 
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable
 
n/a
Item 3.
 
 
 
Key Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Selected financial data
 
274, 306
 
 
B.
 
Capitalization and indebtedness
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds
 
n/a
 
 
D.
 
Risk factors
 
55-56
Item 4.
 
 
 
Information on the Company
 
 
 
 
A.
 
History and development of the company
 
2-3, 19-42, 151-160, 165, 168-170, 278-283, 291, 309
 
 
B.
 
Business overview
 
2-36, 43-54, 139, 156-159, 279-283, 291-296, 301
 
 
C.
 
Organizational structure
 
200, 325
 
 
D.
 
Property, plants and equipment
 
21, 26-27, 36, 137, 165, 169-170, 235-237, 279-290, 300
Item 4A.
 
 
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
None
Item 5.
 
 
 
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Operating results
 
16-17, 19-36, 55-56, 130, 133-150, 151-153, 156-159, 168-170, 179, 181-191, 275-277, 291-296, 298-299
 
 
B.
 
Liquidity and capital resources
 
16, 20, 132-133, 140, 165, 170-173, 179-185, 232-234, 277-278
 
 
C.
 
Research and development, patent and licenses
 
9, 40, 44, 159
 
 
D.
 
Trend information
 
9-11, 18, 19-21, 25-27, 30
 
 
E.
 
Off-balance sheet arrangements
 
180-181, 277-278
 
 
F.
 
Tabular disclosure of contractual commitments
 
278
 
 
G.
 
Safe harbor
 
303-304
Item 6.
 
 
 
Directors, Senior Management and Employees
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Directors and senior management
 
58-67, 71
 
 
B.
 
Compensation
 
16-17, 87-109, 198
 
 
C.
 
Board practices
 
58-62, 68-86, 198
 
 
D.
 
Employees
 
51, 199
 
 
E.
 
Share ownership
 
51, 87-109, 172-178, 198-199
Item 7.
 
 
 
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Major shareholders
 
308-309
 
 
B.
 
Related party transactions
 
168-170, 300
 
 
C.
 
Interests of experts and counsel
 
n/a
Item 8.
 
 
 
Financial Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Consolidated statements and other financial information
 
126-128, 129-209, 296-298, 306
 
 
B.
 
Significant changes
 
n/a
Item 9.
 
 
 
The Offer and Listing
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Offer and listing details
 
306
 
 
B.
 
Plan of distribution
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Markets
 
306
 
 
D.
 
Selling shareholders
 
n/a
 
 
E.
 
Dilution
 
n/a
 
 
F.
 
Expenses of the issue
 
n/a
Item 10.
 
 
 
Additional Information
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Share capital
 
n/a
 
 
B.
 
Memorandum and articles of association
 
309-312
 
 
C.
 
Material contracts
 
300
 
 
D.
 
Exchange controls
 
306
 
 
E.
 
Taxation
 
306-308
 
 
F.
 
Dividends and paying agents
 
n/a
 
 
G.
 
Statements by experts
 
n/a
 
 
H.
 
Documents on display
 
313
 
 
I.
 
Subsidiary information
 
n/a
Item 11.
 
 
 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
181-185
Item 12.
 
 
 
Description of securities other than equity securities
 
 
 
 
A.
 
Debt Securities
 
n/a
 
 
B.
 
Warrants and Rights
 
n/a
 
 
C.
 
Other Securities
 
n/a
 
 
D.
 
American Depositary Shares
 
313
Item 13.
 
 
 
Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies
 
None
Item 14.
 
 
 
Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds
 
None
Item 15.
 
 
 
Controls and Procedures
 
126-127, 300-301
Item 16A.
 
 
 
Audit Committee Financial Expert
 
62, 75, 300
Item 16B.
 
 
 
Code of Ethics
 
300
Item 16C.
 
 
 
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
80, 199, 301
Item 16D.
 
 
 
Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees
 
None
Item 16E.
 
 
 
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
 
312
Item 16F.
 
 
 
Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant
 
n/a
Item 16G.
 
 
 
Corporate governance
 
300
Item 17.
 
 
 
Financial Statements
 
n/a
Item 18.
 
 
 
Financial Statements
 
129-209
Item 19.
 
 
 
Exhibits
 
314

324
 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
 


Information about this report

Registered office and our worldwide
headquarters:

BP p.l.c.
1 St James’s Square
London SW1Y 4PD
UK
Tel +44 (0)20 7496 4000

Registered in England and Wales
No. 102498.
London Stock Exchange symbol ‘BP.’

Our agent in the US:

BP America Inc.
501 Westlake Park Boulevard
Houston, Texas 77079
US
Tel +1 281 366 2000
 
This document constitutes the Annual Report and Accounts in accordance with UK requirements and the Annual Report on Form 20-F in accordance with the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, for BP p.l.c. for the year ended 31 December 2018. A cross reference to Form 20-F requirements is included on page 324.

This document contains the Strategic report on the inside front cover and pages 1-56 and the Directors’ report on pages 57-86, 210-237 and 273-322. The Strategic report and the Directors’ report together include the management report required by DTR 4.1 of the UK Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules. The Directors’ remuneration report is on pages 87-109. The consolidated financial statements of the group are on pages 113-209 and the corresponding reports of the auditor are on pages 126-128.

BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 may be downloaded from bp.com/annualreport. No material on the BP website, other than the items identified as BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018, forms any part of this document. References in this document to other documents on the BP website, such as BP Energy Outlook, BP Sustainability Report, Advancing the energy transition, BP Statistical Review of World Energy and BP Technology Outlook are included as an aid to their location and are not incorporated by reference into this document.

BP p.l.c. is the parent company of the BP group of companies. The company was incorporated in 1909 in England and Wales and changed its name to BP p.l.c. in 2001. Where we refer to the company, we mean BP p.l.c. Unless otherwise stated, the text does not distinguish between the activities and operations of the parent company and those of its subsidiaries«, and information in this document reflects 100% of the assets and operations of the company and its subsidiaries that were consolidated at the date or for the periods indicated, including non-controlling interests.

BP’s primary share listing is the London Stock Exchange. In the US, the company’s securities are traded on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) in the form of ADSs (see page 306 for more details) and in Germany in the form of a global depositary certificate representing BP ordinary shares traded on the Frankfurt, Hamburg and Dusseldorf Stock Exchanges.

The term ‘shareholder’ in this report means, unless the context otherwise requires, investors in the equity capital of BP p.l.c., both direct and indirect. As BP shares, in the form of ADSs, are listed on the NYSE, an Annual Report on Form 20-F is filed with the SEC. Ordinary shares are ordinary fully paid shares in BP p.l.c. of 25 cents each. Preference shares are cumulative first preference shares and cumulative second preference shares in BP p.l.c. of £1 each.
 
 
Acknowledgements
Design: SALTERBAXTER MSLGROUP
Typesetting: BP and SALTERBAXTER MSLGROUP
Printing: Pureprint Group Limited, UK, ISO 14001, FSC® certified and CarbonNeutral®
Photography: Aaron Tait, Andrew Gombert, Arnhel De Serra, Bob Wheeler, Christopher Churchill, Graham Trott, Marc Morrison, Richard Davies, Rupert Warren, Stuart Conway, Yesenia Rodriguez
Paper: This document is printed on Revive 100 Offset paper and board. Revive 100 Offset is paper from 100% recycled pulp, a large percentage of which is de-inked. It is manufactured at a mill with ISO 9001 and 14001 accreditation and is FSC® (Forest Stewardship Council®) certified. This document has been printed using vegetable inks. 
 recycledlandscapeblacka06.jpg

 
BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018
«See Glossary
 
325

BP’s corporate reporting suite includes information about our financial and operating BP performance, sustainability performance and Annual Report and Form 20-F 2018 also on global energy trends and projections. Annual Report Sustainability Advancing the Financial and Operating and Form 20-F 2018 Report 2018 energy transition Information 2014-2018 Details of our financial Details of our sustainability How the energy world is Five-year financial and and operating performance performance with additional changing, our low carbon operating data in PDF in print and online. information online. ambitions and how we're and Excel format. bp.com/annualreport bp.com/sustainability helping advance the bp.com/financialandoperating transition. bp.com/energytransition BP Energy Outlook Statistical Review Technology Outlook BP social media Provides our projections of World Energy 2019 How technology could Join the conversation, of future energy trends An objective review of influence the way we meet get the latest news, see and factors that could key global energy trends. the energy challenge into photos and films from affect them out to 2040. the future. the field and find out bp.com/statisticalreview about working with us. bp.com/energyoutlook bp.com/technologyoutlook You can order BP’s UK and rest of world Feedback You can also telephone printed publications BP Distribution Services Your feedback is important +44 (0)20 7496 4000 free of charge from Tel: +44 (0)870 241 3269 to us. You can email the bp.com/papercopies bpdistributionservices@ corporate reporting team at or write to bp.com corporatereporting@bp.com Corporate reporting BP p.l.c. US and Canada 1 St James’s Square Issuer Direct London SW1Y 4PD, UK Toll-free: +1 888 301 2505 bpreports@issuerdirect.com © BP p.l.c. 2019